Micom p40

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 962

GE

Grid Solutions

MiCOM P40 Agile


P446SV

Technical Manual
Distance Protection IED

Hardware Version: P
Software Version: 80
Publication Reference: P446SV-TM-EN-1
Contents

Chapter 1 Introduction 1
1 Chapter Overview 3
2 Foreword 4
2.1 Target Audience 4
2.2 Typographical Conventions 4
2.3 Nomenclature 5
2.4 Compliance 5
3 Product Scope 6
3.1 Product Versions 6
3.2 Ordering Options 7
4 Features and Functions 8
4.1 Distance Protection Functions 8
4.2 Protection Functions 8
4.3 Control Functions 9
4.4 Measurement Functions 9
4.5 Communication Functions 9
5 Logic Diagrams 11
6 Functional Overview 13

Chapter 2 Safety Information 15


1 Chapter Overview 17
2 Health and Safety 18
3 Symbols 19
4 Installation, Commissioning and Servicing 20
4.1 Lifting Hazards 20
4.2 Electrical Hazards 20
4.3 UL/CSA/CUL Requirements 21
4.4 Fusing Requirements 21
4.5 Equipment Connections 22
4.6 Protection Class 1 Equipment Requirements 22
4.7 Pre-energisation Checklist 23
4.8 Peripheral Circuitry 23
4.9 Upgrading/Servicing 24
5 Decommissioning and Disposal 25
6 Regulatory Compliance 26
6.1 EMC Compliance: 2014/30/EU 26
6.2 LVD Compliance: 2014/35/EU 26
6.3 R&TTE Compliance: 2014/53/EU 26
6.4 UL/CUL Compliance 26
6.5 ATEX Compliance: 2014/34/EU 26

Chapter 3 Hardware Design 29


1 Chapter Overview 31
2 Hardware Architecture 32
3 Mechanical Implementation 33
3.1 Housing Variants 33
3.2 List of Boards 34
4 Front Panel 35
4.1 40TE Front Panel 35
4.1.1 Front Panel Compartments 35
4.1.2 Keypad 36
Contents P446SV

4.1.3 Front Serial Port (SK1) 36


4.1.4 Front Parallel Port (SK2) 37
4.1.5 Fixed Function LEDs 37
4.1.6 Programable LEDs 37
5 Rear Panel 38
6 Boards and Modules 39
6.1 PCBs 39
6.2 Main Processor Board 40
6.3 Power Supply Board 41
6.3.1 Watchdog 43
6.3.2 Rear Serial Port 44
6.4 IEC61850-9-2LE Ethernet Board 45
6.5 Standard Output Relay Board 46
6.6 IRIG-B Board 47
6.7 Fibre Optic Board 48
6.8 Rear Communication Board 49
6.9 Ethernet Board 49
6.10 Redundant Ethernet Board 51
6.11 Coprocessor Board 53
6.11.1 Coprocessor board with 1PPS input 53
6.12 High Break Output Relay Board 54

Chapter 4 Software Design 57


1 Chapter Overview 59
2 Sofware Design Overview 60
3 System Level Software 61
3.1 Real Time Operating System 61
3.2 System Services Software 61
3.3 Self-Diagnostic Software 61
3.4 Startup Self-Testing 61
3.4.1 System Boot 61
3.4.2 System Level Software Initialisation 62
3.4.3 Platform Software Initialisation and Monitoring 62
3.5 Continuous Self-Testing 62
4 Platform Software 64
4.1 Record Logging 64
4.2 Settings Database 64
4.3 Interfaces 64
5 Protection and Control Functions 65
5.1 Acquisition of Samples 65
5.2 Frequency Tracking 65
5.3 Direct Use of Sample Values 65
5.4 Distance Protection 65
5.5 Fourier Signal Processing 66
5.6 Programmable Scheme Logic 67
5.7 Event Recording 67
5.8 Disturbance Recorder 68
5.9 Fault Locator 68
5.10 Function Key Interface 68

Chapter 5 Configuration 69
1 Chapter Overview 71
2 Settings Application Software 72
3 Using the HMI Panel 73
3.1 Navigating the HMI Panel 74

ii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

3.2 Getting Started 74


3.3 Default Display 75
3.4 Default Display Navigation 76
3.5 Password Entry 77
3.6 Processing Alarms and Records 78
3.7 Menu Structure 78
3.8 Changing the Settings 79
3.9 Direct Access (The Hotkey menu) 80
3.9.1 Setting Group Selection Using Hotkeys 80
3.9.2 Control Inputs 81
3.9.3 Circuit Breaker Control 81
3.10 Function Keys 82
4 Line Parameters 84
4.1 Tripping Mode 84
4.1.1 CB Trip Conversion Logic Diagram 85
4.2 Residual Compensation 85
4.3 Mutual Compensation 86
5 Date and Time Configuration 88
5.1 Using an SNTP Signal 88
5.2 Using an IRIG-B Signal 88
5.3 Using an IEEE 1588 PTP Signal 88
5.4 Without a Timing Source Signal 89
5.5 Time Zone Compensation 89
5.6 Daylight Saving Time Compensation 90
6 Settings Group Selection 91

Chapter 6 Sampled Value Operation 93


1 Chapter Overview 95
2 Introduction To Sampled Values 96
3 Data Resampling 97
4 Sampled Value Alignment 98
4.1 Channel mappings for SAV Test, SAV Questionable, SAV Invalid 98
4.2 Data Quality 98
4.2.1 Impact of Data Quality on Protection Functions 99
4.3 Process Bus Performance 99
4.3.1 Sample Loss Data 100
4.4 VT Switching 100
4.5 Virtual Inputs and Outputs 101
4.5.1 P446, P546, P841B Virtual Inputs and Outputs DDBs 101
4.5.2 Virtual CT and VT Ratio Settings 101
4.6 IED Alarms 102
4.6.1 P446, P546, P841B Alarms 102

Chapter 7 Distance Protection 105


1 Chapter Overview 107
2 Introduction 108
2.1 Distance Protection Principle 108
2.2 Performance Influencing Factors 108
2.3 Impedance Calculation 109
2.4 Implementation with Comparators 109
2.5 Polarization of Distance Characteristics 109
3 Distance Measuring Zones Operating Principles 110
3.1 Mho Characteristics 111
3.1.1 Directional Mho Characteristic for Phase Faults 111
3.1.2 Offset Mho Characteristic for Phase Faults 111

P446SV-TM-EN-1 iii
Contents P446SV

3.1.3 Directional Self-Polarized Mho Characteristic for Earth Faults 112


3.1.4 Offset Mho Characteristic for Earth Faults 114
3.1.5 Memory Polarization of Mho Characteristics 116
3.1.6 Dynamic Mho Expansion and Contraction 116
3.1.7 Cross Polarization of Mho Characteristics 119
3.1.8 Implementation of Mho Polarization 120
3.2 Quadrilateral Characteristic 121
3.2.1 Directional Quadrilaterals 122
3.2.2 Quadrilateral Characteristic for Phase Faults 126
3.2.3 Earth Fault Quadrilateral Characteristics 130
4 Phase and Earth Fault Distance Protection Implementation 139
4.1 Phase Fault Characteristics 139
4.2 Earth Fault Characteristics 139
4.3 Distance Protection Tripping Decision 139
4.4 Distance Protection Phase Selection 140
4.4.1 Faulted Phase Selection 140
4.5 Biased Neutral Current Detector 141
4.6 Distance Element Zone Settings 142
4.6.1 Directionalizing the Distance Elements 142
4.6.2 Advanced Distance Zone Settings 143
4.6.3 Distance Zone Sensitivities 143
4.7 Capacitor VT Applications 144
4.7.1 CVTs with Passive Suppression of Ferroresonance 144
4.7.2 CVTs with Active Suppression of Ferroresonance 144
4.8 Load Blinding 145
4.9 Cross Country Fault Protection 146
5 Delta Directional Element 147
5.1 Delta Directional Principle and Setup 147
5.2 Delta Directional Decision 148
6 Application Notes 150
6.1 Setting Mode Choice 150
6.2 Operating Characteristic Selection 150
6.2.1 Phase Characteristic 150
6.2.2 Earth Fault Characteristic 151
6.3 Zone Reach Setting Guidelines 151
6.3.1 Quadrilateral Resistive Reaches 152
6.4 Earth Fault Resistive Reaches and Tilting 152
6.4.1 Dynamic Tilting 153
6.4.2 Fixed Tilting 154
6.5 Phase Fault Zone Settings 154
6.6 Directional Element for Distance Protection 155
6.7 Filtering Setup 155
6.7.1 Distance Digital Filter 155
6.7.2 Setting up CVTs 155
6.8 Load Blinding Setup 156
6.9 Polarizing Setup 156
6.10 Delta Directional Element Setting Guidelines 157
6.10.1 Delta Thresholds 157
6.11 Distance Protection Worked Example 157
6.11.1 Line Impedance Calculation 158
6.11.2 Residual Compensation for Earth Fault Elements 159
6.11.3 Zone 1 Phase and Ground Reach Settings 159
6.11.4 Zone 2 Phase and Ground Reach Settings 159
6.11.5 Zone 3 Phase and Ground Reach Settings 160
6.11.6 Zone 3 Reverse Reach Settings 160
6.11.7 Zone 4 Reverse Reach Settings 160
6.11.8 Load Avoidance 161
6.11.9 Quadrilateral Resistive Reach Settings 161

iv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

6.12 Teed Feeder Applications 162

Chapter 8 Carrier Aided Schemes 165


1 Chapter Overview 167
2 Introduction 168
3 Carrier Aided Schemes Implementation 169
3.1 Carrier Aided Scheme Types 169
3.2 Default Carrier Aided Schemes 170
4 Aided Distance Scheme Logic 171
4.1 Permissive Underreach Scheme 171
4.2 Permissive Over-reach Scheme 172
4.2.1 Permissive Overreach Trip Reinforcement 174
4.2.2 Permissive Overreach Weak Infeed Features 175
4.3 Permissive Scheme Loss Of Guard 175
4.4 Current Reversal Guard Logic 176
4.5 Aided Distance Blocking Schemes 177
4.6 Aided Distance Unblocking Schemes 178
4.7 Aided Distance Logic Diagrams 180
4.7.1 Aided Distance Send Logic 180
4.7.2 Carrier Aided Schemes Receive Logic 180
4.7.3 Aided Distance Tripping Logic 181
4.7.4 PUR Aided Tripping logic 181
4.7.5 POR Aided Tripping logic 182
4.7.6 Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 183
4.7.7 Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 183
5 Aided DEF Scheme Logic 184
5.1 Aided DEF Introduction 184
5.2 Implementation 184
5.3 Aided DEF Polarization 184
5.3.1 Zero Sequence Polarizing 185
5.3.2 Negative Sequence Polarizing 186
5.4 Aided DEF Setting Guidelines 187
5.5 Aided DEF POR Scheme 188
5.6 Aided DEF Blocking Scheme 189
5.7 Aided DEF Logic Diagrams 190
5.7.1 DEF Directional Signals 190
5.7.2 Aided DEF Send Logic 191
5.7.3 Carrier Aided Schemes Receive Logic 191
5.7.4 Aided DEF Tripping Logic 192
5.7.5 POR Aided Tripping logic 193
5.7.6 Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 194
5.7.7 Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 194
6 Aided Delta Scheme Logic 195
6.1 Aided Delta POR Scheme 195
6.2 Aided Delta Blocking Scheme 196
6.3 Aided Delta Logic Diagrams 198
6.3.1 Aided Delta Send Logic 198
6.3.2 Carrier Aided Schemes Receive Logic 198
6.3.3 Aided Delta Tripping Logic 199
6.3.4 POR Aided Tripping logic 200
6.3.5 Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 201
6.3.6 Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 201
7 Application Notes 202
7.1 Aided Distance PUR Scheme 202
7.2 Aided Distance POR Scheme 202
7.3 Aided Distance Blocking Scheme 202
7.4 Aided DEF POR Scheme 203

P446SV-TM-EN-1 v
Contents P446SV

7.5 Aided DEF Blocking Scheme 203


7.6 Aided Delta POR Scheme 203
7.7 Aided Delta Blocking Scheme 203
7.8 Teed Feeder Applications 204
7.8.1 POR Schemes for Teed Feeders 205
7.8.2 PUR Schemes for Teed Feeders 205
7.8.3 Blocking Schemes for Teed Feeders 206

Chapter 9 Non-Aided Schemes 209


1 Chapter Overview 211
2 Non-Aided Schemes 212
3 Basic Schemes 213
3.1 Basic Scheme Modes 213
3.2 Basic Scheme Setting 215
4 Trip On Close Schemes 217
4.1 Switch On To Fault (SOTF) 218
4.1.1 Switch Onto Fault Mode 218
4.1.2 SOTF Tripping 219
4.1.3 SOTF Tripping with CNV 219
4.2 Trip On Reclose (TOR) 219
4.2.1 Trip On Reclose Mode 220
4.2.2 TOR Tripping Logic for Appropriate Zones 220
4.2.3 TOR Tripping Logic with CNV 220
4.3 Polarisation during Circuit Engergisation 220
5 Zone1 Extension Scheme 221
6 Loss of Load Scheme 222

Chapter 10 Power Swing Functions 225


1 Chapter Overview 227
2 Introduction to Power Swing Blocking 228
3 Power Swing Blocking 230
3.1 Power Swing Detection 230
3.1.1 Settings-Free Power Swing Detection 230
3.1.2 Slow Power Swing Detection 232
3.2 Detection of a Fault During a Power Swing 234
3.3 Power Swing Blocking Configuration 234
3.4 Power Swing Load Blinding Boundary 235
3.5 Power Swing Blocking Logic 236
3.6 Power Swing Blocking Setting Guidelines 237
3.6.1 Setting the Resistive Limits 238
3.6.2 Setting the Reactive Limits 238
3.6.3 PSB Timer Setting Guidelines 239
4 Out of Step Protection 241
4.1 Out of Step Detection 241
4.2 Out of Step Protection Operataing Principle 242
4.3 Out of Step Logic Diagram 243
4.4 OST Application Notes 243
4.4.1 Setting the OST Mode 243

Chapter 11 Autoreclose 249


1 Chapter Overview 251
2 Introduction to Autoreclose 252
3 Autoreclose Implementation 253
3.1 Autoreclose Logic Inputs from External Sources 254
3.1.1 Circuit Breaker Healthy Input 254

vi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

3.1.2 Inhibit Autoreclose Input 254


3.1.3 Block Autoreclose Input 254
3.1.4 Reset Lockout Input 255
3.1.5 Pole Discrepancy Input 255
3.1.6 External Trip Indication 255
3.2 Autoreclose Logic Inputs 255
3.2.1 Trip Initiation Signals 255
3.2.2 Circuit Breaker Status Inputs 255
3.2.3 System Check Signals 255
3.3 Autoreclose Logic Outputs 255
3.4 Autoreclose Operating Sequence 256
3.4.1 AR Timing Sequence - Transient Fault 256
3.4.2 AR Timing Sequence - Evolving/Permanent Fault 256
3.4.3 AR Timing Sequence - Evolving/Permanent Fault Single-phase 257
3.4.4 AR Timing Sequence - Transient Fault Dual CB 257
3.4.5 AR Timing Sequence - Evolving/Permanent Fault Dual CB 258
3.4.6 AR Timing Sequence - Persistent Fault 259
4 Autoreclose System Map 261
4.1 Autoreclose System Map Diagrams 263
4.2 Autoreclose Internal Signals 272
4.3 Autoreclose DDB Signals 277
5 Logic Modules 289
5.1 Circuit Breaker Status Monitor 289
5.1.1 CB State Monitor 290
5.2 Circuit Breaker Open Logic 290
5.2.1 Circuit Breaker Open Logic Diagram 291
5.3 Circuit Breaker in Service Logic 291
5.3.1 Circuit Breaker in Service Logic Diagram 292
5.4 Autoreclose Enable Logic 292
5.4.1 Autoreclose Enable Logic Diagram 292
5.5 Autoreclose Leader/Follower 292
5.5.1 Leader/Follower CB Selection Logic Diagram 293
5.5.2 Leader Follower Logic Diagram 294
5.6 Autoreclose Modes 295
5.6.1 Single-Phase and Three-Phase Autoreclose 295
5.6.2 Autoreclose Modes Enable Logic Diagram 296
5.7 AR Force Three-Phase Trip Logic 297
5.7.1 Force Three-Phase Trip Logic Diagram 297
5.8 Autoreclose Initiation Logic 298
5.8.1 Autoreclose Initiation Logic Diagram 299
5.8.2 Autoreclose Trip Test Logic Diagram 299
5.8.3 External Trip Logic Diagram for CB1 300
5.8.4 External Trip Logic Diagram for CB2 301
5.8.5 Protection Reoperation and Evolving Fault Logic Diagram 302
5.8.6 Fault Memory Logic Diagram 302
5.9 Autoreclose In Progress 302
5.9.1 Autoreclose In Progress Logic Diagram for CB1 303
5.9.2 Autoreclose In Progress Logic Diagram for CB2 304
5.10 Sequence Counter 304
5.10.1 Autoreclose Sequence Counter Logic Diagram 305
5.11 Autoreclose Cycle Selection 305
5.11.1 Single Phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection Logic Diagram 306
5.11.2 3-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection 307
5.12 Dead Time Control 307
5.12.1 Dead Time Start Enable Logic Diagram 308
5.12.2 Single-phase Leader Dead Time Logic Diagram 309
5.12.3 3-phase Leader Dead Time Logic Diagram 310
5.12.4 Follower Enable Logic Diagram 311

P446SV-TM-EN-1 vii
Contents P446SV

5.12.5 Single-phase Follower Timing Logic Diagram 312


5.12.6 Three-phase Follower Timing Logic Diagram 313
5.13 Circuit Breaker Autoclose 313
5.13.1 Circuit Breaker Autoclose Logic Diagram 314
5.14 Reclaim Time 314
5.14.1 Prepare Reclaim Initiation Logic Diagram 315
5.14.2 Reclaim Time Logic Diagram 316
5.14.3 Succesful Autoreclose Signals Logic Diagram 317
5.14.4 Autoreclose Reset Successful Indication Logic Diagram 318
5.15 CB Healthy and System Check Timers 318
5.15.1 CB Healthy and System Check Timers Logic Diagram 319
5.16 Autoreclose Shot Counters 319
5.16.1 Autoreclose Shot Counters Logic Diagram 321
5.17 Circuit Breaker Control 322
5.17.1 CB Control Logic Diagram 322
5.18 Circuit Breaker Trip Time Monitoring 323
5.18.1 CB Trip Time Monitoring Logic Diagram 324
5.19 Autoreclose Lockout 325
5.19.1 CB Lockout Logic Diagram 326
5.20 Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout 327
5.20.1 Reset CB Lockout Logic Diagram 329
5.21 Pole Discrepancy 329
5.21.1 Pole Discrepancy Logic Diagram 330
5.22 Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion 330
5.22.1 CB Trip Conversion Logic Diagram 331
5.23 Monitor Checks for CB Closure 331
5.23.1 Voltage Monitor for CB Closure 332
5.23.2 Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB Closure 333
5.24 Synchronisation Checks for CB Closure 334
5.24.1 Three-phase Autoreclose Leader Check Logic Diagram 336
5.24.2 Three-phase Autoreclose Follower Check Logic Diagram 338
5.24.3 CB Manual Close System Check Logic Diagram 340
6 Setting Guidelines 341
6.1 De-ionising Time Guidance 341
6.2 Dead Timer Setting Guidelines 341
6.2.1 Example Dead Time Calculation 341
6.3 Reclaim Time Setting Guidelines 342
6.4 Autoreclose Shot Counters 342

Chapter 12 CB Fail Protection 345


1 Chapter Overview 347
2 Circuit Breaker Fail Protection 348
3 Circuit Breaker Fail Implementation 349
3.1 Circuit Breaker Fail Timers 349
3.2 Zero Crossing Detection 349
4 Circuit Breaker Fail Logic 351
4.1 Circuit Breaker Fail Logic - Part 1 351
4.2 Circuit Breaker Fail Logic - Part 2 352
4.3 Circuit Breaker Fail Logic - Part 3 353
4.4 Circuit Breaker Fail Logic - Part 4 354
5 Application Notes 355
5.1 Reset Mechanisms for CB Fail Timers 355
5.2 Setting Guidelines (CB fail Timer) 355
5.3 Setting Guidelines (Undercurrent) 356

Chapter 13 Current Protection Functions 357

viii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

1 Chapter Overview 359


2 Phase Fault Overcurrent Protection 360
2.1 POC Implementation 360
2.2 Directional Element 360
2.3 POC Logic 362
3 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection 363
3.1 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection Implementation 363
3.2 Directional Element 363
3.3 NPSOC Logic 364
3.4 Application Notes 364
3.4.1 Setting Guidelines (Current Threshold) 364
3.4.2 Setting Guidelines (Time Delay) 364
3.4.3 Setting Guidelines (Directional element) 364
4 Earth Fault Protection 366
4.1 Earth Fault Protection Implementation 366
4.2 IDG Curve 366
4.3 Directional Element 367
4.3.1 Residual Voltage Polarisation 367
4.3.2 Negative Sequence Polarisation 368
4.4 Earth Fault Protection Logic 369
4.5 Application Notes 369
4.5.1 Residual Voltage Polarisation Setting Guidelines 369
4.5.2 Setting Guidelines (Directional Element) 369
5 Sensitive Earth Fault Protection 371
5.1 SEF Protection Implementation 371
5.2 EPATR B Curve 371
5.3 Sensitive Earth Fault Protection Logic 372
5.4 Application Notes 373
5.4.1 Insulated Systems 373
5.4.2 Setting Guidelines (Insulated Systems) 374
6 High Impedance REF 376
6.1 High Impedance REF Principle 376
7 Thermal Overload Protection 378
7.1 Single Time Constant Characteristic 378
7.2 Dual Time Constant Characteristic 378
7.3 Thermal Overload Protection Implementation 379
7.4 Thermal Overload Protection Logic 379
7.5 Application Notes 379
7.5.1 Setting Guidelines for Dual Time Constant Characteristic 379
7.5.2 Setting Guidelines for Single Time Constant Characteristic 381
8 Broken Conductor Protection 382
8.1 Broken Conductor Protection Implementation 382
8.2 Broken Conductor Protection Logic 382
8.3 Application Notes 382
8.3.1 Setting Guidelines 382

Chapter 14 Voltage Protection Functions 385


1 Chapter Overview 387
2 Undervoltage Protection 388
2.1 Undervoltage Protection Implementation 388
2.2 Undervoltage Protection Logic 389
2.3 Application Notes 390
2.3.1 Undervoltage Setting Guidelines 390
3 Overvoltage Protection 391
3.1 Overvoltage Protection Implementation 391
3.2 Overvoltage Protection Logic 392

P446SV-TM-EN-1 ix
Contents P446SV

3.3 Application Notes 393


3.3.1 Overvoltage Setting Guidelines 393
4 Compensated Overvoltage 394
5 Residual Overvoltage Protection 395
5.1 Residual Overvoltage Protection Implementation 395
5.2 Residual Overvoltage Logic 396
5.3 Application Notes 396
5.3.1 Calculation for Solidly Earthed Systems 396
5.3.2 Calculation for Impedance Earthed Systems 397
5.3.3 Setting Guidelines 398

Chapter 15 Frequency Protection Functions 399


1 Chapter Overview 401
2 Frequency Protection 402
2.1 Underfrequency Protection 402
2.1.1 Underfrequency Protection Implementation 402
2.1.2 Underfrequency Protection logic 403
2.1.3 Application Notes 403
2.2 Overfrequency Protection 403
2.2.1 Overfrequency Protection Implementation 403
2.2.2 Overfrequency Protection logic 404
2.2.3 Application Notes 404
3 Independent R.O.C.O.F Protection 405
3.1 Indepenent R.O.C.O.F Protection Implementation 405
3.2 Independent R.O.C.O.F Protection Logic 405

Chapter 16 Monitoring and Control 407


1 Chapter Overview 409
2 Event Records 410
2.1 Event Types 410
2.1.1 Opto-input Events 411
2.1.2 Contact Events 411
2.1.3 Alarm Events 411
2.1.4 Fault Record Events 412
2.1.5 Maintenance Events 412
2.1.6 Protection Events 412
2.1.7 Security Events 413
2.1.8 Platform Events 413
3 Disturbance Recorder 414
4 Measurements 415
4.1 Measured Quantities 415
4.2 Measurement Setup 415
4.3 Fault Locator 415
4.4 Opto-input Time Stamping 415
5 CB Condition Monitoring 416
5.1 Broken Current Accumulator 417
5.2 CB Trip Counter 418
5.3 CB Operating Time Accumulator 419
5.4 Excessive Fault Frequency Counter 420
5.5 Reset Lockout Alarm 421
5.6 CB Condition Monitoring Logic 422
5.7 Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout 423
5.7.1 Reset CB Lockout Logic Diagram 425
5.8 Application Notes 425
5.8.1 Setting the Thresholds for the Total Broken Current 425
5.8.2 Setting the thresholds for the Number of Operations 426

x P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

5.8.3 Setting the thresholds for the Operating Time 426


5.8.4 Setting the Thresholds for Excesssive Fault Frequency 426
6 CB State Monitoring 427
6.1 CB State Monitor 428
7 Circuit Breaker Control 429
7.1 CB Control using the IED Menu 429
7.2 CB Control using the Hotkeys 430
7.3 CB Control using the Function Keys 430
7.4 CB Control using the Opto-inputs 431
7.5 Remote CB Control 431
7.6 CB Healthy Check 432
7.7 Synchronisation Check 432
7.8 CB Control AR Implications 432
7.9 CB Control Logic Diagram 433
8 Pole Dead Function 435
8.1 Pole Dead Logic 435
9 System Checks 436
9.1 System Checks Implementation 436
9.1.1 VT Connections 436
9.1.2 Voltage Monitoring 437
9.1.3 Check Synchronisation 437
9.1.4 Check Syncronisation Vector Diagram 437
9.2 Voltage Monitor for CB Closure 439
9.3 Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB Closure 440
9.4 System Check PSL 442
9.5 Application Notes 442
9.5.1 Predictive Closure of Circuit Breakers 442
9.5.2 Voltage and Phase Angle Correction 442

Chapter 17 Supervision 445


1 Chapter Overview 447
2 Voltage Transformer Supervision 448
2.1 Loss of One or Two Phase Voltages 448
2.2 Loss of all Three Phase Voltages 448
2.3 Absence of all Three Phase Voltages on Line Energisation 448
2.4 VTS Implementation 449
2.5 VTS Logic 450
3 Current Transformer Supervision 452
3.1 CTS Implementation 452
3.2 Standard CTS Logic 453
3.3 CTS Blocking 453
3.4 Application Notes 453
3.4.1 Setting Guidelines 453
4 Trip Circuit Supervision 454
4.1 Trip Circuit Supervision Scheme 1 454
4.1.1 Resistor Values 454
4.1.2 PSL for TCS Scheme 1 455
4.2 Trip Circuit Supervision Scheme 2 455
4.2.1 Resistor Values 456
4.2.2 PSL for TCS Scheme 2 456
4.3 Trip Circuit Supervision Scheme 3 456
4.3.1 Resistor Values 457
4.3.2 PSL for TCS Scheme 3 457

Chapter 18 Digital I/O and PSL Configuration 459

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xi
Contents P446SV

1 Chapter Overview 461


2 Configuring Digital Inputs and Outputs 462
3 Scheme Logic 463
3.1 PSL Editor 464
3.2 PSL Schemes 464
3.3 PSL Scheme Version Control 464
4 Configuring the Opto-Inputs 465
5 Assigning the Output Relays 466
6 Fixed Function LEDs 467
6.1 Trip LED Logic 467
7 Configuring Programmable LEDs 468
8 Function Keys 470
9 Control Inputs 471

Chapter 19 Fibre Teleprotection 473


1 Chapter Overview 475
2 Protection Signalling Introduction 476
2.1 Unit Protection Schemes 476
2.2 Teleprotection Commands 476
2.3 Transmission Media and Interference 477
3 Fibre Teleprotection Implementation 478
3.1 Setting up the IM64 Scheme 478
3.1.1 Fibre Teleprotection Scheme Terminal Addressing 479
3.1.2 Setting up IM64 480
3.1.3 Two-Terminal IM64 Operation 480
3.1.4 Dual Redundant Two-Terminal IM64 Operation 480
3.1.5 Three-Terminal IM64 Operation 480
3.1.6 Physical Connection 481
4 IM64 Logic 485
5 Application Notes 487
5.1 Alarm Management 487
5.2 Alarm Logic 487
5.3 Two-ended Scheme Extended Supervision 488
5.4 Three-ended Scheme Extended Supervision 488

Chapter 20 Electrical Teleprotection 491


1 Chapter Overview 493
2 Introduction 494
3 Teleprotection Scheme Principles 495
3.1 Direct Tripping 495
3.2 Permissive Tripping 495
4 Implementation 496
5 Configuration 497
6 Connecting to Electrical InterMiCOM 499
6.1 Short Distance 499
6.2 Long Distance 499
7 Application Notes 500

Chapter 21 Communications 503


1 Chapter Overview 505
2 Communication Interfaces 506
3 Serial Communication 507
3.1 EIA(RS)232 Bus 507
3.2 EIA(RS)485 Bus 507

xii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

3.2.1 EIA(RS)485 Biasing Requirements 508


3.3 K-Bus 508
4 Standard Ethernet Communication 510
4.1 Hot-Standby Ethernet Failover 510
5 Redundant Ethernet Communication 511
5.1 Supported Protocols 511
5.2 Parallel Redundancy Protocol 512
5.3 High-Availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) 513
5.3.1 HSR Multicast Topology 513
5.3.2 HSR Unicast Topology 513
5.3.3 HSR Application in the Substation 514
5.4 Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol 515
5.5 Self Healing Protocol 516
5.6 Dual Homing Protocol 517
5.7 Configuring IP Addresses 519
5.7.1 Configuring the IED IP Address 520
5.7.2 Configuring the REB IP Address 520
5.8 PRP/HSR Configurator 522
5.8.1 Connecting the IED to a PC 523
5.8.2 Installing the Configurator 523
5.8.3 Starting the Configurator 523
5.8.4 PRP/HSR Device Identification 524
5.8.5 Selecting the Device Mode 524
5.8.6 PRP/HSR IP Address Configuration 524
5.8.7 SNTP IP Address Configuration 524
5.8.8 Check for Connected Equipment 524
5.8.9 PRP Configuration 524
5.8.10 HSR Configuration 525
5.8.11 Filtering Database 525
5.8.12 End of Session 526
5.9 RSTP Configurator 526
5.9.1 Connecting the IED to a PC 526
5.9.2 Installing the Configurator 527
5.9.3 Starting the Configurator 527
5.9.4 RSTP Device Identification 527
5.9.5 RSTP IP Address Configuration 528
5.9.6 SNTP IP Address Configuration 528
5.9.7 Check for Connected Equipment 528
5.9.8 RSTP Configuration 528
5.9.9 End of Session 529
5.10 Switch Manager 529
5.10.1 Installation 530
5.10.2 Setup 531
5.10.3 Network Setup 531
5.10.4 Bandwidth Used 531
5.10.5 Reset Counters 531
5.10.6 Check for Connected Equipment 531
5.10.7 Mirroring Function 532
5.10.8 Ports On/Off 532
5.10.9 VLAN 532
5.10.10 End of Session 532
6 Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 533
6.1 SNMP Management Information Bases 533
6.2 Main Processor MIBS Structure 533
6.3 Redundant Ethernet Board MIB Structure 534
6.4 Accessing the MIB 538
6.5 Main Processor SNMP Configuration 538
7 Data Protocols 540

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xiii
Contents P446SV

7.1 Courier 540


7.1.1 Physical Connection and Link Layer 540
7.1.2 Courier Database 541
7.1.3 Settings Categories 541
7.1.4 Setting Changes 541
7.1.5 Event Extraction 541
7.1.6 Disturbance Record Extraction 543
7.1.7 Programmable Scheme Logic Settings 543
7.1.8 Time Synchronisation 543
7.1.9 Courier Configuration 544
7.2 IEC 60870-5-103 545
7.2.1 Physical Connection and Link Layer 545
7.2.2 Initialisation 546
7.2.3 Time Synchronisation 546
7.2.4 Spontaneous Events 546
7.2.5 General Interrogation (GI) 546
7.2.6 Cyclic Measurements 546
7.2.7 Commands 546
7.2.8 Test Mode 547
7.2.9 Disturbance Records 547
7.2.10 Command/Monitor Blocking 547
7.2.11 IEC 60870-5-103 Configuration 547
7.3 DNP 3.0 548
7.3.1 Physical Connection and Link Layer 548
7.3.2 Object 1 Binary Inputs 549
7.3.3 Object 10 Binary Outputs 549
7.3.4 Object 20 Binary Counters 550
7.3.5 Object 30 Analogue Input 550
7.3.6 Object 40 Analogue Output 551
7.3.7 Object 50 Time Synchronisation 551
7.3.8 DNP3 Device Profile 551
7.3.9 DNP3 Configuration 559
7.4 IEC 61850 560
7.4.1 Benefits of IEC 61850 561
7.4.2 IEC 61850 Interoperability 561
7.4.3 The IEC 61850 Data Model 561
7.4.4 IEC 61850 in MiCOM IEDs 562
7.4.5 IEC 61850 Data Model Implementation 563
7.4.6 IEC 61850 Communication Services Implementation 563
7.4.7 IEC 61850 Peer-to-peer (GOOSE) communications 563
7.4.8 Mapping GOOSE Messages to Virtual Inputs 563
7.4.9 Ethernet Functionality 564
7.4.10 IEC 61850 Configuration 564
7.4.11 IEC 61850 Edition 2 565
8 Read Only Mode 569
8.1 IEC 60870-5-103 Protocol Blocking 569
8.2 Courier Protocol Blocking 569
8.3 IEC 61850 Protocol Blocking 570
8.4 Read-Only Settings 570
8.5 Read-Only DDB Signals 570
9 Time Synchronisation 571
9.1 Demodulated IRIG-B 571
9.1.1 IRIG-B Implementation 571
9.2 SNTP 572
9.2.1 Loss of SNTP Server Signal Alarm 572
9.3 IEEE 1588 Precision time Protocol 572
9.3.1 Accuracy and Delay Calculation 572
9.3.2 PTP Domains 573
9.4 Time Synchronsiation using the Communication Protocols 573

xiv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

Chapter 22 Cyber-Security 575


1 Overview 577
2 The Need for Cyber-Security 578
3 Standards 579
3.1 NERC Compliance 579
3.1.1 CIP 002 580
3.1.2 CIP 003 580
3.1.3 CIP 004 580
3.1.4 CIP 005 580
3.1.5 CIP 006 580
3.1.6 CIP 007 581
3.1.7 CIP 008 581
3.1.8 CIP 009 581
3.2 IEEE 1686-2007 581
4 Cyber-Security Implementation 583
4.1 NERC-Compliant Display 583
4.2 Four-level Access 584
4.2.1 Blank Passwords 585
4.2.2 Password Rules 586
4.2.3 Access Level DDBs 586
4.3 Enhanced Password Security 586
4.3.1 Password Strengthening 586
4.3.2 Password Validation 587
4.3.3 Password Blocking 587
4.4 Password Recovery 588
4.4.1 Password Recovery 588
4.4.2 Password Encryption 589
4.5 Disabling Physical Ports 589
4.6 Disabling Logical Ports 589
4.7 Security Events Management 590
4.8 Logging Out 592

Chapter 23 Installation 593


1 Chapter Overview 595
2 Handling the Goods 596
2.1 Receipt of the Goods 596
2.2 Unpacking the Goods 596
2.3 Storing the Goods 596
2.4 Dismantling the Goods 596
3 Mounting the Device 597
3.1 Flush Panel Mounting 597
3.2 Rack Mounting 598
4 Cables and Connectors 600
4.1 Terminal Blocks 600
4.2 Power Supply Connections 601
4.3 Earth Connnection 601
4.4 Watchdog Connections 601
4.5 EIA(RS)485 and K-Bus Connections 601
4.6 IRIG-B Connection 602
4.7 Opto-input Connections 602
4.8 Output Relay Connections 602
4.9 Ethernet Metallic Connections 602
4.10 Ethernet Fibre Connections 602
4.11 RS232 connection 603
4.12 Download/Monitor Port 603

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xv
Contents P446SV

4.13 GPS Fibre Connection 603


4.14 Fibre Communication Connections 603
5 Case Dimensions 604
5.1 Case Dimensions 40TE 604

Chapter 24 Commissioning Instructions 605


1 Chapter Overview 607
2 General Guidelines 608
3 Commissioning Test Menu 609
3.1 Opto I/P Status Cell (Opto-input Status) 609
3.2 Relay O/P Status Cell (Relay Output Status) 609
3.3 Test Port Status Cell 609
3.4 Monitor Bit 1 to 8 Cells 609
3.5 Test Mode Cell 610
3.6 Test Pattern Cell 610
3.7 Contact Test Cell 610
3.8 Test LEDs Cell 610
3.9 Test Autoreclose Cell 610
3.10 Static Test Mode 611
3.11 Loopback Mode 611
3.12 IM64 Test Pattern 612
3.13 IM64 Test Mode 612
3.14 Red and Green LED Status Cells 612
3.15 Using a Monitor Port Test Box 612
4 Commissioning Equipment 613
4.1 Recommended Commissioning Equipment 613
4.2 Essential Commissioning Equipment 613
4.3 Advisory Test Equipment 614
5 Product Checks 615
5.1 Product Checks with the IED De-energised 615
5.1.1 Visual Inspection 616
5.1.2 Current Transformer Shorting Contacts 616
5.1.3 Insulation 616
5.1.4 External Wiring 616
5.1.5 Watchdog Contacts 617
5.1.6 Power Supply 617
5.2 Product Checks with the IED Energised 617
5.2.1 Watchdog Contacts 617
5.2.2 Test LCD 618
5.2.3 Date and Time 618
5.2.4 Test LEDs 619
5.2.5 Test Alarm and Out-of-Service LEDs 619
5.2.6 Test Trip LED 619
5.2.7 Test User-programmable LEDs 619
5.2.8 Test Opto-inputs 619
5.2.9 Test Output Relays 619
5.2.10 Test Serial Communication Port RP1 620
5.2.11 Test Serial Communication Port RP2 621
5.2.12 Test Ethernet Communication 621
5.3 Secondary Injection Tests 622
5.3.1 Test Current Inputs 622
5.3.2 Test Voltage Inputs 622
6 Electrical Intermicom Communication Loopback 624
6.1 Setting up the Loopback 624
6.2 Loopback Test 624
6.2.1 InterMicom Command Bits 625
6.2.2 InterMicom Channel Diagnostics 625

xvi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

6.2.3 Simulating a Channel Failure 625


7 Intermicom 64 Communication 626
7.1 Checking the Interface 626
7.2 Setting up the Loopback 627
7.3 Loopback Test 627
8 Setting Checks 628
8.1 Apply Application-specific Settings 628
8.1.1 Transferring Settings from a Settings File 628
8.1.2 Entering settings using the HMI 628
9 IEC 61850 Edition 2 Testing 630
9.1 Using IEC 61850 Edition 2 Test Modes 630
9.1.1 IED Test Mode Behaviour 630
9.1.2 Sampled Value Test Mode Behaviour 630
9.2 Simulated Input Behaviour 631
9.3 Testing Examples 631
9.3.1 Test Procedure for Real Values 632
9.3.2 Test Procedure for Simulated Values - No Plant 632
9.3.3 Test Procedure for Simulated Values - With Plant 633
9.3.4 Contact Test 634
10 Distance Protection 635
10.1 Single-ended Testing 635
10.1.1 Preliminaries 635
10.1.2 Zone 1 Reach Check 635
10.1.3 Zone 2 Reach Check 636
10.1.4 Zone 3 Reach Check 636
10.1.5 Zone 4 Reach Check 636
10.1.6 Zone P Reach Check 636
10.1.7 Resistive Reach 637
10.1.8 Load Blinder 637
10.2 Operation and Contact Assignment 637
10.2.1 Phase A 637
10.2.2 Phase B 637
10.2.3 Phase C 637
10.2.4 Time Delay Settings 638
10.3 Scheme Testing 638
10.3.1 Scheme Trip Test for Zone 1 Extension 639
10.3.2 Scheme Trip Tests for Permissive Schemes 639
10.3.3 Scheme Trip Tests for Blocking Scheme 639
10.3.4 Signal Send Test for Permissive Schemes 640
10.3.5 Signal Send Test for Blocking Scheme 640
10.3.6 Scheme Timer Settings 640
11 Delta Directional Comparison 641
11.1 Single-ended Testing 641
11.1.1 Preliminaries 641
11.1.2 Single-ended Injection Test 641
11.1.3 Forward Fault Preparation 641
11.2 Operation and Contact Assignment 642
11.2.1 Phase A 642
11.2.2 Phase B 642
11.2.3 Phase C 642
11.3 Delta Protection Scheme Testing 643
11.3.1 Signal Send Test for Permissive Schemes 643
11.3.2 Signal Send Test for Blocking Schemes 643
12 DEF Aided Schemes 644
12.1 Earth Current Pilot Scheme 644
12.1.1 Preliminaries 644
12.1.2 Perform the Test 644
12.1.3 Forward Fault Trip Test 645

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xvii
Contents P446SV

12.2 Scheme Testing 645


12.2.1 Signal Send Test for Permissive Schemes 645
12.2.2 Signal Send Test for Blocking Schemes 645
13 Out of Step Protection 646
13.1 OST Setting 646
13.2 Predictive OST Setting 647
13.3 Predictive and OST Setting 647
13.4 OST Timer Test 647
14 Protection Timing Checks 648
14.1 Overcurrent Check 648
14.2 Connecting the Test Circuit 648
14.3 Performing the Test 648
14.4 Check the Operating Time 648
15 System Check and Check Synchronism 650
15.1 Check Synchronism Pass 650
15.2 Check Synchronism Fail 650
16 Check Trip and Autoreclose Cycle 651
17 End-to-End Communication Tests 652
17.1 Remove Local Loopbacks 652
17.1.1 Restoring Direct Fibre Connections 652
17.1.2 Restoring C37.94 Fibre Connections 653
17.1.3 Communications using P59x Interface Units 653
17.2 Remove Remote Loopbacks 653
17.3 Verify Communication between IEDs 653
18 End-to-End Scheme Tests 655
18.1 Aided Scheme 1 655
18.1.1 Preparation at Remote End 655
18.1.2 Performing the Test 655
18.1.3 Channel Check in the Opposite Direction 655
18.2 Aided Scheme 2 655
19 Onload Checks 657
19.1 Confirm Current Connections 657
19.2 Confirm Voltage Connections 657
19.3 On-load Directional Test 658
20 Final Checks 659
21 Commmissioning the P59x 660
21.1 Visual Inspection 660
21.2 Insulation 660
21.3 External Wiring 660
21.4 P59x Auxiliary Supply 660
21.5 P59x LEDs 661
21.6 Received Optical Signal Level 661
21.7 Optical Transmitter Level 661
21.8 Loopback Test 662

Chapter 25 Maintenance and Troubleshooting 663


1 Chapter Overview 665
2 Maintenance 666
2.1 Maintenance Checks 666
2.1.1 Alarms 666
2.1.2 Opto-isolators 666
2.1.3 Output Relays 666
2.1.4 Measurement Accuracy 666
2.2 Replacing the Device 667
2.3 Repairing the Device 668
2.4 Removing the front panel 668

xviii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

2.5 Replacing PCBs 669


2.5.1 Replacing the main processor board 669
2.5.2 Replacement of communications boards 670
2.5.3 Replacement of the input module 671
2.5.4 Replacement of the power supply board 671
2.5.5 Replacement of the I/O boards 672
2.6 Recalibration 672
2.7 Changing the battery 672
2.7.1 Post Modification Tests 673
2.7.2 Battery Disposal 673
2.8 Cleaning 673
3 Troubleshooting 674
3.1 Self-Diagnostic Software 674
3.2 Power-up Errors 674
3.3 Error Message or Code on Power-up 674
3.4 Out of Service LED on at power-up 675
3.5 Error Code during Operation 676
3.5.1 Backup Battery 676
3.6 Mal-operation during testing 676
3.6.1 Failure of Output Contacts 676
3.6.2 Failure of Opto-inputs 676
3.6.3 Incorrect Analogue Signals 677
3.7 Coprocessor board failures 677
3.7.1 Signalling failure alarm (on its own) 677
3.7.2 C diff failure alarm (on its own) 677
3.7.3 Signalling failure and C diff failure alarms together 677
3.7.4 Incompatible IED 677
3.7.5 Comms changed 677
3.7.6 IEEE C37.94 fail 678
3.8 PSL Editor Troubleshooting 678
3.8.1 Diagram Reconstruction 678
3.8.2 PSL Version Check 678
3.9 Repair and Modification Procedure 678

Chapter 26 Technical Specifications 681


1 Chapter Overview 683
2 Interfaces 684
2.1 Front Serial Port 684
2.2 Download/Monitor Port 684
2.3 Rear Serial Port 1 684
2.4 Fibre Rear Serial Port 1 684
2.5 Rear Serial Port 2 685
2.6 Optional Rear Serial Port (SK5) 685
2.7 IRIG-B (Demodulated) 685
2.8 IRIG-B (Modulated) 685
2.9 Rear Ethernet Port Copper 686
2.10 Rear Ethernet Port Fibre 686
2.10.1 100 Base FX Receiver Characteristics 686
2.10.2 100 Base FX Transmitter Characteristics 687
2.11 1 PPS Port 687
2.12 Fibre Teleprotection Interface 687
3 Protection Functions 688
3.1 Distance Protection 688
3.2 Power Swing Blocking 688
3.3 Out Of Step Protection 689
3.4 Fibre Teleprotection Transfer Times 689
3.5 Autoreclose and Check Synychronism 689

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xix
Contents P446SV

3.6 Phase Overcurrent Protection 689


3.6.1 Transient Overreach and Overshoot 690
3.6.2 Phase Overcurrent Directional Parameters 690
3.7 Earth Fault Protection 690
3.7.1 Earth Fault Directional Parameters 690
3.8 Sensitive Earth Fault Protection 691
3.8.1 Sensitive Earth Fault Protection Directional Element 691
3.9 High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault Protection 691
3.10 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection 691
3.10.1 NPSOC Directional Parameters 692
3.11 Circuit Breaker Fail and Undercurrent Protection 692
3.12 Broken Conductor Protection 692
3.13 Thermal Overload Protection 692
4 Monitoring, Control and Supervision 693
4.1 Voltage Transformer Supervision 693
4.2 Standard Current Transformer Supervision 693
4.3 Differential Current Transformer Supervision 693
4.4 CB State and Condition Monitoring 693
4.5 PSL Timers 694
5 Measurements and Recording 695
5.1 General 695
5.2 Disturbance Records 695
5.3 Event, Fault and Maintenance Records 695
5.4 Fault Locator 695
6 Ratings 696
6.1 AC Measuring Inputs 696
6.2 Current Transformer Inputs 696
6.3 Voltage Transformer Inputs 696
6.4 Auxiliary Supply Voltage 696
6.5 Nominal Burden 697
6.6 Power Supply Interruption 697
6.7 Battery Backup 698
7 Input / Output Connections 699
7.1 Isolated Digital Inputs 699
7.1.1 Nominal Pickup and Reset Thresholds 699
7.2 Standard Output Contacts 699
7.3 High Break Output Contacts 700
7.4 Watchdog Contacts 700
8 Mechanical Specifications 701
8.1 Physical Parameters 701
8.2 Enclosure Protection 701
8.3 Mechanical Robustness 701
8.4 Transit Packaging Performance 701
9 Type Tests 702
9.1 Insulation 702
9.2 Creepage Distances and Clearances 702
9.3 High Voltage (Dielectric) Withstand 702
9.4 Impulse Voltage Withstand Test 702
10 Environmental Conditions 703
10.1 Ambient Temperature Range 703
10.2 Temperature Endurance Test 703
10.3 Ambient Humidity Range 703
10.4 Corrosive Environments 703
11 Electromagnetic Compatibility 704
11.1 1 MHz Burst High Frequency Disturbance Test 704
11.2 Damped Oscillatory Test 704
11.3 Immunity to Electrostatic Discharge 704

xx P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents

11.4 Electrical Fast Transient or Burst Requirements 704


11.5 Surge Withstand Capability 704
11.6 Surge Immunity Test 705
11.7 Immunity to Radiated Electromagnetic Energy 705
11.8 Radiated Immunity from Digital Communications 705
11.9 Radiated Immunity from Digital Radio Telephones 705
11.10 Immunity to Conducted Disturbances Induced by Radio Frequency Fields 705
11.11 Magnetic Field Immunity 706
11.12 Conducted Emissions 706
11.13 Radiated Emissions 706
11.14 Power Frequency 706
12 Regulatory Compliance 707
12.1 EMC Compliance: 2014/30/EU 707
12.2 LVD Compliance: 2014/35/EU 707
12.3 R&TTE Compliance: 2014/53/EU 707
12.4 UL/CUL Compliance 707
12.5 ATEX Compliance: 2014/34/EU 707

Appendix A Ordering Options 709

Appendix B Settings and Signals 711

Appendix C Wiring Diagrams 713

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxi
Contents P446SV

xxii P446SV-TM-EN-1
Table of Figures
Figure 1: P40L family - version evolution 7
Figure 2: Key to logic diagrams 12
Figure 3: Functional Overview 13
Figure 4: Hardware architecture 32
Figure 5: Exploded view of IED 33
Figure 6: Front panel (40TE) 35
Figure 7: Rear view of populated case 38
Figure 8: Rear connection to terminal block 39
Figure 9: Main processor board 40
Figure 10: Power supply board 41
Figure 11: Power supply assembly 42
Figure 12: Power supply terminals 43
Figure 13: Watchdog contact terminals 44
Figure 14: Rear serial port terminals 45
Figure 15: IEC 61850-9-2LE board 45
Figure 16: Standard output relay board - 8 contacts 46
Figure 17: IRIG-B board 47
Figure 18: Fibre optic board 48
Figure 19: Rear communication board 49
Figure 20: Ethernet board 49
Figure 21: Redundant Ethernet board 51
Figure 22: Fully populated Coprocessor board 53
Figure 23: High Break relay output board 54
Figure 24: High Break contact operation 55
Figure 25: Software Architecture 60
Figure 26: Frequency response of FIR filters 66
Figure 27: Frequency Response (indicative only) 67
Figure 28: Navigating the HMI 74
Figure 29: Default display navigation 76
Figure 30: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63) 85
Figure 31: Comparison of Conventional IED and Sampled Values IED 96
Figure 32: Data sampling using an IEC 61850-9-2LE interface 97
Figure 33: System Impedance Ratio 108
Figure 34: Directional mho element construction 111
Figure 35: Offset Mho characteristic 112
Figure 36: Directional Mho element construction – impedance domain 113
Figure 37: Offset Mho characteristics – impedance domain 114
Figure 38: Offset mho characteristics – voltage domain 115
Table of Figures P446SV

Figure 39: Simplified forward fault 116


Figure 40: Mho expansion – forward fault 117
Figure 41: Simplified Reverse Fault 118
Figure 42: Mho contraction – reverse fault 119
Figure 43: Simplified quadrilateral characteristics 121
Figure 44: General Quadrilateral Characteristic Limits 122
Figure 45: Directional Quadrilateral Characteristic 123
Figure 46: Quadrilateral Characteristic featuring 2 directional forward zones and 1 offset zone 123
Figure 47: Five-sided polygon formed by Quadrilateral characteristic with Directional-Line 124
intersection of Reverse Impedance Reach Line
Figure 48: Impedance Reach line construction 126
Figure 49: Reverse impedance reach line construction 127
Figure 50: Resistive reach of phase elements 128
Figure 51: Resistive Reach line construction 128
Figure 52: Reverse resistive reach line construction 129
Figure 53: Phase Fault Quadrilateral characteristic summary 129
Figure 54: Impedance Reach line in Z1 plane 132
Figure 55: Impedance Reach line in ZLP plane 133
Figure 56: General characteristic in ZLP plane 134
Figure 57: Phase relations between I2 and Iph for leading and lagging polarizing currents 135
Figure 58: General characteristic in Z1 plane 136
Figure 59: Simplified characteristic in Z1 plane 137
Figure 60: Phase to phase current changes for C phase-to-ground (CN) fault 141
Figure 61: Biased Neutral Current Detector Characteristic 142
Figure 62: Load Blinder Characteristics 145
Figure 63: Sequence networks connection for an internal A-N fault 148
Figure 64: - DV Forward and Reverse tripping regions 149
Figure 65: Settings required to apply a quadrilateral zone 150
Figure 66: Settings required to apply a mho zone 151
Figure 67: Over-tilting effect 153
Figure 68: Example power system 158
Figure 69: Apparent Impedances seen by Distance Protection on a Teed Feeder 163
Figure 70: Scheme Assignment 169
Figure 71: Aided Distance PUR scheme 172
Figure 72: Aided Distance POR scheme 174
Figure 73: Example of fault current reversal of direction 176
Figure 74: Aided Distance Blocking scheme (BOP) 178
Figure 75: Aided Distance Send logic 180
Figure 76: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic 180
Figure 77: Aided Distance Tripping logic 181

xxiv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures

Figure 78: PUR Aided Tripping logic 181


Figure 79: POR Aided Tripping logic 183
Figure 80: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 183
Figure 81: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 183
Figure 82: Virtual Current Polarization 186
Figure 83: Directional criteria for residual voltage polarization 187
Figure 84: Aided DEF POR scheme 189
Figure 85: Aided DEF Blocking scheme 190
Figure 86: DEF Directional Signals 190
Figure 87: Aided DEF Send logic 191
Figure 88: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic 191
Figure 89: Aided DEF Tripping logic 192
Figure 90: POR Aided Tripping logic 194
Figure 91: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 194
Figure 92: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 194
Figure 93: Aided Delta POR scheme 196
Figure 94: Aided Delta Blocking scheme 197
Figure 95: Aided Delta Send logic 198
Figure 96: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic 198
Figure 97: Aided Delta Tripping logic 199
Figure 98: POR Aided Tripping logic 201
Figure 99: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic 201
Figure 100: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic 201
Figure 101: Apparent Impedances seen by Distance Protection on a Teed Feeder 204
Figure 102: Problematic Fault Scenarios for PUR Scheme Application to Teed Feeders 206
Figure 103: Any Distance Start 214
Figure 104: Standard basic scheme mode logic 214
Figure 105: Alternative basic timer start scheme mode logic 215
Figure 106: Basic time stepped distance scheme 216
Figure 107: Trip On Close logic 217
Figure 108: Trip On Close based on CNV level detectors 218
Figure 109: SOTF Tripping 219
Figure 110: SOTF Tripping with CNV 219
Figure 111: TOR Tripping logic for appropriate zones 220
Figure 112: TOR Tripping logic with CNV 220
Figure 113: Zone 1 extension scheme 221
Figure 114: Zone 1 extension logic 221
Figure 115: Loss of load accelerated trip scheme 222
Figure 116: Loss of Load Logic 223
Figure 117: Power transfer related to angular difference between two generation sources 228

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxv
Table of Figures P446SV

Figure 118: Phase selector timing for power swing condition 231
Figure 119: Phase selector timing for fault condition 231
Figure 120: Phase selector timing for fault during a power swing 232
Figure 121: Slow Power Swing detection characteristic 233
Figure 122: Load Blinder Boundary Conditions 236
Figure 123: Power swing blocking logic 237
Figure 124: Setting the resistive reaches 238
Figure 125: Reactive reach settings 239
Figure 126: PSB timer setting guidelines 240
Figure 127: Out of Step detection characteristic 241
Figure 128: Out of Step logic diagram 243
Figure 129: OST setting determination for the positive sequence resistive component OST R5 244
Figure 130: OST R6max determination 245
Figure 131: Example of timer reset due to MOVs operation 248
Figure 132: Autoreclose sequence for a Transient Fault 256
Figure 133: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault 257
Figure 134: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault - single-phase operation 257
Figure 135: Dual CB Autoreclose Sequence for a Transient Fault 258
Figure 136: Autoreclose Sequence for an evolving/permanent fault on a dual CB application 259
Figure 137: Autoreclose Sequence for a persistent fault on a multishot dual CB application set 259
for single-phase operation
Figure 138: Key to logic diagrams 262
Figure 139: Autoreclose System Map - part 1 263
Figure 140: Autoreclose System Map - part 2 264
Figure 141: Autoreclose System Map - part 3 265
Figure 142: Autoreclose System Map - part 4 266
Figure 143: Autoreclose System Map - part 5 267
Figure 144: Autoreclose System Map - part 6 268
Figure 145: Autoreclose System Map - part 7 269
Figure 146: Autoreclose System Map - part 8 270
Figure 147: Autoreclose System Map - part 9 271
Figure 148: Autoreclose System Map - part 10 272
Figure 149: CB State logic diagram (Module 1) 290
Figure 150: Circuit Breaker Open logic diagram (Module 3) 291
Figure 151: CB In Service logic diagram (Module 4) 292
Figure 152: Autoreclose Enable logic diagram (Module 5) 292
Figure 153: Leader/Follower CB Selection Logic Diagram (Module 6) 293
Figure 154: Leader/Follower logic diagram (Module 7 & 8) 294
Figure 155: Autoreclose Modes Enable logic diagram (Module 9) 296
Figure 156: Force three-phase trip logic diagram (Module 10) 297

xxvi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures

Figure 157: Autoreclose Initiation logic diagram (Module 11) 299


Figure 158: Autoreclose Trip Test logic diagram (Module 12) 299
Figure 159: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB1 300
(Module 13)
Figure 160: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB2 301
(Module 14)
Figure 161: Protection Reoperation and Evolving Fault logic diagram (Module 20) 302
Figure 162: Fault Memory logic diagram (Module 15) 302
Figure 163: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB1 (Module 16) 303
Figure 164: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB2 (Module 17) 304
Figure 165: Autoreclose Sequence Counter logic diagram (Module 18) 305
Figure 166: Single-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 19) 306
Figure 167: Three-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 21) 307
Figure 168: Dead time Start Enable logic diagram (Module 22) 308
Figure 169: Single-phase Leader Dead Time logic diagram (Module 24) 309
Figure 170: Three-phase Leader CB Dead Time logic diagram (Module 25) 310
Figure 171: Follower Enable logic diagram (Module 27) 311
Figure 172: Single-phase Follower CB timing logic diagram (Module 28) 312
Figure 173: Three-phase Follower CB timing logic diagram (Module 29) 313
Figure 174: Circuit Breaker Autoclose Logic Diagram (Modules 32 & 33) 314
Figure 175: Prepare Reclaim Initiation logic diagram (Module 34) 315
Figure 176: Reclaim Time logic diagram (Module 35) 316
Figure 177: Successful Autoreclose Signals logic diagram (Module 36) 317
Figure 178: Autoreclose Reset Successful Indication logic diagram (Modules 37 & 38) 318
Figure 179: Circuit Breaker Healthy and System Check Timers Healthy logic diagram (Module 39) 319
Figure 180: Autoreclose Shot Counters logic diagram (Modules 41 & 42) 321
Figure 181: CB1 Control Logic (Module 43) 322
Figure 182: CB2 Control Logic (Module 44) 323
Figure 183: Circuit Breaker Trip Time Monitoring logic diagram (Modules 53 & 54) 324
Figure 184: CB1 Lockout Logic Diagram (Module 55) 326
Figure 185: CB2 Lockout Logic Diagram (Module 56) 327
Figure 186: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58) 329
Figure 187: Pole Discrepancy Logic Diagram (Module 62) 330
Figure 188: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63) 331
Figure 189: Voltage Monitor for CB Closure (Module 59) 332
Figure 190: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60) 333
Figure 191: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61) 334
Figure 192: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB1 as leader (Module 45) 336
Figure 193: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as leader (Module 46) 337
Figure 194: Three-phase AR System Check logic d for CB1 as follower (Module 47) 338
Figure 195: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as follower (Module 48) 339

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxvii
Table of Figures P446SV

Figure 196: CB Manual Close System Check Logic Diagram (Modules 51 & 52) 340
Figure 197: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 1 351
Figure 198: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 2 352
Figure 199: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 3 353
Figure 200: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 4 354
Figure 201: CB Fail timing 356
Figure 202: Phase Overcurrent Protection logic diagram 362
Figure 203: Negative Phase Sequence Overcurrent Protection logic diagram 364
Figure 204: IDG Characteristic 367
Figure 205: Earth Fault Protection logic diagram 369
Figure 206: EPATR B characteristic shown for TMS = 1.0 372
Figure 207: Sensitive Earth Fault Protection logic diagram 372
Figure 208: Current distribution in an insulated system with C phase fault 373
Figure 209: Phasor diagrams for insulated system with C phase fault 374
Figure 210: Positioning of core balance current transformers 375
Figure 211: High Impedance REF principle 376
Figure 212: High Impedance REF Connection 377
Figure 213: Thermal overload protection logic diagram 379
Figure 214: Spreadsheet calculation for dual time constant thermal characteristic 380
Figure 215: Dual time constant thermal characteristic 380
Figure 216: Broken conductor logic 382
Figure 217: Undervoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage) 389
Figure 218: Overvoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage) 392
Figure 219: Residual Overvoltage logic 396
Figure 220: Residual voltage for a solidly earthed system 397
Figure 221: Residual voltage for an impedance earthed system 398
Figure 222: Underfrequency logic (single stage) 403
Figure 223: Overfrequency logic (single stage) 404
Figure 224: Rate of change of frequency logic (single stage) 405
Figure 225: Fault recorder stop conditions 412
Figure 226: Broken Current Accumulator logic diagram 417
Figure 227: CB Trip Counter logic diagram 418
Figure 228: Operating Time Accumulator 419
Figure 229: Excessive Fault Frequency logic diagram 420
Figure 230: Reset Lockout Alarm logic diagram 421
Figure 231: CB1 Condition Monitoring logic diagram 422
Figure 232: CB2 Condition Monitoring logic diagram 423
Figure 233: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58) 425
Figure 234: CB State logic diagram (Module 1) 428
Figure 235: Hotkey menu navigation 430

xxviii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures

Figure 236: Default function key PSL 431


Figure 237: Remote Control of Circuit Breaker 432
Figure 238: CB1 Control Logic (Module 43) 433
Figure 239: CB2 Control Logic (Module 44) 434
Figure 240: Pole Dead logic 435
Figure 241: Check Synchronisation vector diagram 438
Figure 242: Voltage Monitor for CB Closure (Module 59) 439
Figure 243: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60) 440
Figure 244: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61) 441
Figure 245: System Check PSL 442
Figure 246: VTS logic 450
Figure 247: Standard CTS 453
Figure 248: TCS Scheme 1 454
Figure 249: PSL for TCS Scheme 1 455
Figure 250: TCS Scheme 2 455
Figure 251: PSL for TCS Scheme 2 456
Figure 252: TCS Scheme 3 456
Figure 253: PSL for TCS Scheme 3 457
Figure 254: Scheme Logic Interfaces 463
Figure 255: Trip LED logic 467
Figure 256: Fibre Teleprotection connections for a three-terminal Scheme 479
Figure 257: Interfacing to PCM multiplexers 483
Figure 258: IM64 channel fail and scheme fail logic 485
Figure 259: IM64 general alarm signals logic 485
Figure 260: IM64 communications mode and IEEE C37.94 alarm signals 486
Figure 261: IM64 two-terminal scheme extended supervision 488
Figure 262: IM64 three-terminal scheme extended supervision 488
Figure 263: Example assignment of InterMiCOM signals within the PSL 498
Figure 264: Direct connection 499
Figure 265: Indirect connection using modems 499
Figure 266: RS485 biasing circuit 508
Figure 267: Remote communication using K-Bus 509
Figure 268: IED attached to separate LANs 512
Figure 269: HSR multicast topology 513
Figure 270: HSR unicast topology 514
Figure 271: HSR application in the substation 515
Figure 272: IED attached to redundant Ethernet star or ring circuit 515
Figure 273: IED, bay computer and Ethernet switch with self healing ring facilities 516
Figure 274: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches 516

P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxix
Table of Figures P446SV

Figure 275: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches 517
after failure
Figure 276: Dual homing mechanism 518
Figure 277: Application of Dual Homing Star at substation level 519
Figure 278: IED and REB IP address configuration 520
Figure 279: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter 523
Figure 280: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter 527
Figure 281: Control input behaviour 550
Figure 282: Data model layers in IEC61850 562
Figure 283: Edition 2 system - backward compatibility 566
Figure 284: Edition 1 system - forward compatibility issues 566
Figure 285: Example of Standby IED 567
Figure 286: Standby IED Activation Process 568
Figure 287: GPS Satellite timing signal 571
Figure 288: Timing error using ring or line topology 573
Figure 289: Default display navigation 584
Figure 290: Location of battery isolation strip 597
Figure 291: Rack mounting of products 598
Figure 292: Terminal block types 600
Figure 293: 40TE case dimensions 604
Figure 294: RP1 physical connection 620
Figure 295: Remote communication using K-bus 621
Figure 296: InterMicom loopback testing 624
Figure 297: Simulated input behaviour 631
Figure 298: Test example 1 632
Figure 299: Test example 2 633
Figure 300: Test example 3 634
Figure 301: State impedances 646
Figure 302: Possible terminal block types 668
Figure 303: Front panel assembly 670

xxx P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 1

INTRODUCTION
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides some general information about the technical manual and an introduction to the device(s)
described in this technical manual.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 3
Foreword 4
Product Scope 6
Features and Functions 8
Logic Diagrams 11
Functional Overview 13

P446SV-TM-EN-1 3
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

2 FOREWORD
This technical manual provides a functional and technical description of General Electric's P446SV, as well as a
comprehensive set of instructions for using the device. The level at which this manual is written assumes that you
are already familiar with protection engineering and have experience in this discipline. The description of principles
and theory is limited to that which is necessary to understand the product. For further details on general
protection engineering theory, we refer you to Alstom's publication NPAG, which is available online or from our
contact centre.
We have attempted to make this manual as accurate, comprehensive and user-friendly as possible. However we
cannot guarantee that it is free from errors. Nor can we state that it cannot be improved. We would therefore be
very pleased to hear from you if you discover any errors, or have any suggestions for improvement. Our policy is to
provide the information necessary to help you safely specify, engineer, install, commission, maintain, and
eventually dispose of this product. We consider that this manual provides the necessary information, but if you
consider that more details are needed, please contact us.
All feedback should be sent to our contact centre via the following URL:
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact

2.1 TARGET AUDIENCE


This manual is aimed towards all professionals charged with installing, commissioning, maintaining,
troubleshooting, or operating any of the products within the specified product range. This includes installation and
commissioning personnel as well as engineers who will be responsible for operating the product.
The level at which this manual is written assumes that installation and commissioning engineers have knowledge
of handling electronic equipment. Also, system and protection engineers have a thorough knowledge of protection
systems and associated equipment.

2.2 TYPOGRAPHICAL CONVENTIONS


The following typographical conventions are used throughout this manual.
● The names for special keys appear in capital letters.
For example: ENTER
● When describing software applications, menu items, buttons, labels etc as they appear on the screen are
written in bold type.
For example: Select Save from the file menu.
● Filenames and paths use the courier font
For example: Example\File.text
● Special terminology is written with leading capitals
For example: Sensitive Earth Fault
● If reference is made to the IED's internal settings and signals database, the menu group heading (column)
text is written in upper case italics
For example: The SYSTEM DATA column
● If reference is made to the IED's internal settings and signals database, the setting cells and DDB signals are
written in bold italics
For example: The Language cell in the SYSTEM DATA column
● If reference is made to the IED's internal settings and signals database, the value of a cell's content is
written in the Courier font
For example: The Language cell in the SYSTEM DATA column contains the value English

4 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

2.3 NOMENCLATURE
Due to the technical nature of this manual, many special terms, abbreviations and acronyms are used throughout
the manual. Some of these terms are well-known industry-specific terms while others may be special product-
specific terms used by General Electric. The first instance of any acronym or term used in a particular chapter is
explained. In addition, a separate glossary is available on the General Electric website, or from the General Electric
contact centre.
We would like to highlight the following changes of nomenclature however:
● The word 'relay' is no longer used to describe the device itself. Instead, the device is referred to as the 'IED'
(Intelligent Electronic Device), the 'device', or the 'product'. The word 'relay' is used purely to describe the
electromechanical components within the device, i.e. the output relays.
● British English is used throughout this manual.
● The British term 'Earth' is used in favour of the American term 'Ground'.

2.4 COMPLIANCE
The device has undergone a range of extensive testing and certification processes to ensure and prove
compatibility with all target markets. A detailed description of these criteria can be found in the Technical
Specifications chapter.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 5
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

3 PRODUCT SCOPE
Unlike a conventional IED, a device with an IEC61850-9-2 interface, or Sampled Value (SV) device accepts current
and voltage measurement inputs, which have already been digitized in accordance with the IEC 61850-9-2LE
standard.
The P446SV is such a device. It accepts sampled analogue values from merging units. It does not accept analogue
values directly and therefore does not have any current or voltage transformers. This provides a number of
advantages over conventional devices, which are discussed throughout this technical manual.
The P446SV has been designed for distance protection of overhead line and underground cable applications,
where the network is solidly grounded. It is used for dual circuit breaker applications, such as breaker-and-a-half,
or ring bus topologies, where two circuit breakers feed each line. As well as distance protection, this device can
also be used for 4-shot phase-segregated Autoreclose protection and a range of standard current, voltage, power
and frequency backup protection applications.

3.1 PRODUCT VERSIONS


This product belongs to the P40L family. Although this technical manual is specific to this product, it is useful to
know where the product fits into the family and to describe the evolution path of the entire product family. The
following diagram attempts to do this:

6 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

P445: J37
P54x No Distance: K47
P841A: K47
All other products: K57
Conventional Stream NCIT Stream

P445: P41
P54x No Distance: M61
P446, P546, P841B: M72
P841A: M61
All other products: M71
 XCPU3
 Cyber-security
 NCIT (now obsolete)
 New Protection
functions
Sub-cycle Diff Stream

P445: P45
P54x No Distance: M65 P543, P545: M63
P446, P546, P841B: M74
P841A: M65 Non-distance
All other products: M75

 XCPU3
 New Protection  Sub-cycle differential for
 Cyber-security
functions non-distance versions
 NCIT (9-2LE interface)

P445: P46
P54x No Distance: M66
P841A: M66
All other products: M76

 Current Differential
Starters for P54x
 Other improvements
Multi-end subcycle stream

P54A, P54B: P01


Non-distance products: M81 P543, P545: M83
P54C, P54E: M01 P446, P546, P841B: P80
Distance products: M82 Non-distance
Non-distance

 IEC 61850 Edition 2


 IEC 61850 Edition 2  Multi-end  IEC 61850 Edition 2
 IEEE 1588 support
 IEEE 1588 support  Sub-cycle  IEEE 1588 support
 40TE case

V00062

Figure 1: P40L family - version evolution

3.2 ORDERING OPTIONS


All current models and variants for this product are defined in an interactive spreadsheet called the CORTEC. This is
available on the company website.
Alternatively, you can obtain it via the Contact Centre at the following URL:
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact
A copy of the CORTEC is also supplied as a static table in the Appendices of this document. However, it should only
be used for guidance as it provides a snapshot of the interactive data taken at the time of publication.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 7
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

4 FEATURES AND FUNCTIONS

4.1 DISTANCE PROTECTION FUNCTIONS

Feature IEC 61850 ANSI


Distance zones, full-scheme protection (5) DisPDIS 21/21N
Phase characteristic (Mho and quadrilateral)
Ground characteristic (Mho and quadrilateral)
CVT transient overreach elimination
Load blinder
Easy setting mode
Communication-aided schemes, PUTT, POTT, Blocking, Weak
DisPSCH 85
Infeed
Accelerated tripping – loss of load and Z1 extension
Switch on to fault and trip on reclose – elements for fast fault
SofPSOF/ TorPSOF 50SOTF/27SOTF
clearance on breaker closure
Power swing blocking PsbRPSB 68
Directional earth fault (DEF) unit protection 67N
Out of step OstRPSB 78
Delta directional comparison - fast channel schemes operating
78DCB/78DCUB
on fault generated superimposed quantities
Mutual compensation (for fault locator and distance zones)
InterMiCOM64 teleprotection for direct device-to-device
communication (optional)

4.2 PROTECTION FUNCTIONS

Feature IEC 61850 ANSI


Tripping Mode (1 & 3 pole) PTRC
ABC and ACB phase rotation
Phase overcurrent , with optional directionality (4 stages) OcpPTOC/RDIR 50/51/67
Earth/Ground overcurrent stages, with optional directionality (4
EfdPTOC/RDIR 50N/51N/ 67N
stages)
Sensitive earth fault (SEF) (4 stages) SenPTOC/RDIR 50N/51N/67N
High impedance restricted earth fault (REF) SenRefPDIF 64
Negative sequence overcurrent stages, with optional
NgcPTOC/RDIR 67/46
directionality (4 stages)
Broken conductor, used to detect open circuit faults 46
Thermal overload protection ThmPTTR 49
Undervoltage protection (2 stages) VtpPhsPTUV 27
Overvoltage protection (2 stages) VtpPhsPTOV 59
Remote overvoltage protection (2 stages) VtpCmpPTOV 59R
Residual voltage protection (2 stages) VtpResPTOV 59N
Underfrequency protection (4 stages) FrqPTUF 81
Overfrequency protection (2 stages) FrqPTOF 81

8 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

Feature IEC 61850 ANSI


Rate of change of frequency protection (4 stages) DfpPFRC 81
High speed breaker fail suitable for re-tripping and back-
RBRF 50BF
tripping (2 stages)
Current Transformer supervision 46
Voltage transformer supervision 47/27
Auto-reclose (4 shots) RREC 79
Check synchronisation (2 stages) RSYN 25

4.3 CONTROL FUNCTIONS

Feature IEC 61850 ANSI


Watchdog contacts
Read-only mode
Function keys FnkGGIO
Programmable LEDs LedGGIO
Programmable hotkeys
Programmable allocation of digital inputs and outputs
Fully customizable menu texts
Circuit breaker control, status & condition monitoring XCBR 52
CT supervision
VT supervision
Trip circuit and coil supervision
Control inputs PloGGIO1
Power-up diagnostics and continuous self-monitoring
Dual rated 1A and 5A CT inputs
Alternative setting groups (4)
Graphical programmable scheme logic (PSL)
Fault locator RFLO

4.4 MEASUREMENT FUNCTIONS

Measurement Function IEC 61850 ANSI


Measurement of all instantaneous & integrated values
MET
(Exact range of measurements depend on the device model)
Disturbance recorder for waveform capture – specified in samples per cycle RDRE DFR
Fault Records
Maintenance Records
Event Records / Event logging Event records
Time Stamping of Opto-inputs Yes Yes

4.5 COMMUNICATION FUNCTIONS

Feature ANSI
NERC compliant cyber-security

P446SV-TM-EN-1 9
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

Feature ANSI
Front RS232 serial communication port for configuration 16S
Rear serial RS485 communication port for SCADA control 16S
2 Additional rear serial communication ports for SCADA control and
16S
teleprotection (fibre and copper) (optional)
Ethernet communication (optional) 16E
Redundant Ethernet communication (optional) 16E
Courier Protocol 16S
IEC 61850 edition 2 16E
IEC 60870-5-103 (optional) 16S
DNP3.0 over serial link (optional) 16S
DNP3.0 over Ethernet (optional) 16E
SNMP 16E
IRIG-B time synchronisation (optional) CLK
IEEE 1588 PTP (Edition 2 devices only)

10 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

5 LOGIC DIAGRAMS
This technical manual contains many logic diagrams, which should help to explain the functionality of the device.
Although this manual has been designed to be as specific as possible to the chosen product, it may contain
diagrams, which have elements applicable to other products. If this is the case, a qualifying note will accompany
the relevant part.
The logic diagrams follow a convention for the elements used, using defined colours and shapes. A key to this
convention is provided below. We recommend viewing the logic diagrams in colour rather than in black and white.
The electronic version of the technical manual is in colour, but the printed version may not be. If you need coloured
diagrams, they can be provided on request by calling the contact centre and quoting the diagram number.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 11
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

Key:
Energising Quantity AND gate &

Internal Signal OR gate 1

DDB Signal XOR gate XOR

Internal function NOT gate

Setting cell Logic 0 0

Setting value Timer

Hardcoded setting
Pulse / Latch

Measurement Cell S
SR Latch Q
R
Internal Calculation
S
SR Latch Q
Derived setting Reset Dominant RD

HMI key Latched on positive edge

Connection / Node Inverted logic input


1
Switch Soft switch 2

Switch Multiplier X

Bandpass filter
Comparator for detecting
undervalues

Comparator for detecting


V00063 overvalues

Figure 2: Key to logic diagrams

12 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction

6 FUNCTIONAL OVERVIEW
This diagram is applicable to three products in the P40L family; P443, P445 and P446. Use the key on the diagram
to determine the features relevant to the product described in this technical manual.

BUS

IEC 2 ndRemote Remote Local Fault records Disturbance


61850 comm. port comm. port Communication Record
Measurements
Self monitoring
X 50/27
21P 21G 50/51 50N/ ∆I /∆V 67 67N 67N 64 67/ 68 78 46BC C TS
49 51N SEF REF 46
V ref SOTF/TOR

I
I

LINE
V

V ref

I 50BF-2 79-2 25- 2


E sen
X I
M

27/ 85 LEDs
59N FL 50BF VTS 79 25 PSL
LINE 59

Neutral current
(if present) Conventional Inter MiCOM Protection
from parallel line communication Always Optional P443 & P446 P446
signalling available only only P443,P445 & P446
X

BUS
V00010

Figure 3: Functional Overview

P446SV-TM-EN-1 13
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV

14 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 2

SAFETY INFORMATION
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

16 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the safe handling of the equipment. The equipment must be properly
installed and handled in order to maintain it in a safe condition and to keep personnel safe at all times. You must
be familiar with information contained in this chapter before unpacking, installing, commissioning, or servicing the
equipment.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 17
Health and Safety 18
Symbols 19
Installation, Commissioning and Servicing 20
Decommissioning and Disposal 25
Regulatory Compliance 26

P446SV-TM-EN-1 17
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

2 HEALTH AND SAFETY


Personnel associated with the equipment must be familiar with the contents of this Safety Information.
When electrical equipment is in operation, dangerous voltages are present in certain parts of the equipment.
Improper use of the equipment and failure to observe warning notices will endanger personnel.
Only qualified personnel may work on or operate the equipment. Qualified personnel are individuals who are:
● familiar with the installation, commissioning, and operation of the equipment and the system to which it is
being connected.
● familiar with accepted safety engineering practises and are authorised to energise and de-energise
equipment in the correct manner.
● trained in the care and use of safety apparatus in accordance with safety engineering practises
● trained in emergency procedures (first aid).

The documentation provides instructions for installing, commissioning and operating the equipment. It cannot,
however cover all conceivable circumstances. In the event of questions or problems, do not take any action
without proper authorisation. Please contact your local sales office and request the necessary information.

18 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

3 SYMBOLS
Throughout this manual you will come across the following symbols. You will also see these symbols on parts of
the equipment.

Caution:
Refer to equipment documentation. Failure to do so could result in damage to the
equipment

Warning:
Risk of electric shock

Earth terminal. Note: This symbol may also be used for a protective conductor (earth) terminal if that terminal
is part of a terminal block or sub-assembly.

Protective conductor (earth) terminal

Instructions on disposal requirements

Note:
The term 'Earth' used in this manual is the direct equivalent of the North American term 'Ground'.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 19
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

4 INSTALLATION, COMMISSIONING AND SERVICING

4.1 LIFTING HAZARDS


Many injuries are caused by:
● Lifting heavy objects
● Lifting things incorrectly
● Pushing or pulling heavy objects
● Using the same muscles repetitively

Plan carefully, identify any possible hazards and determine how best to move the product. Look at other ways of
moving the load to avoid manual handling. Use the correct lifting techniques and Personal Protective Equipment
(PPE) to reduce the risk of injury.

4.2 ELECTRICAL HAZARDS

Caution:
All personnel involved in installing, commissioning, or servicing this equipment must be
familiar with the correct working procedures.

Caution:
Consult the equipment documentation before installing, commissioning, or servicing
the equipment.

Caution:
Always use the equipment as specified. Failure to do so will jeopardise the protection
provided by the equipment.

Warning:
Removal of equipment panels or covers may expose hazardous live parts. Do not touch
until the electrical power is removed. Take care when there is unlocked access to the
rear of the equipment.

Warning:
Isolate the equipment before working on the terminal strips.

Warning:
Use a suitable protective barrier for areas with restricted space, where there is a risk of
electric shock due to exposed terminals.

Caution:
Disconnect power before disassembling. Disassembly of the equipment may expose
sensitive electronic circuitry. Take suitable precautions against electrostatic voltage
discharge (ESD) to avoid damage to the equipment.

20 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

Caution:
NEVER look into optical fibres or optical output connections. Always use optical power
meters to determine operation or signal level.

Warning:
Testing may leave capacitors charged to dangerous voltage levels. Discharge
capacitors by rediucing test voltages to zero before disconnecting test leads.

Caution:
Operate the equipment within the specified electrical and environmental limits.

Caution:
Before cleaning the equipment, ensure that no connections are energised. Use a lint
free cloth dampened with clean water.

Note:
Contact fingers of test plugs are normally protected by petroleum jelly, which should not be removed.

4.3 UL/CSA/CUL REQUIREMENTS


The information in this section is applicable only to equipment carrying UL/CSA/CUL markings.

Caution:
Equipment intended for rack or panel mounting is for use on a flat surface of a Type 1
enclosure, as defined by Underwriters Laboratories (UL).

Caution:
To maintain compliance with UL and CSA/CUL, install the equipment using UL/CSA-
recognised parts for: cables, protective fuses, fuse holders and circuit breakers,
insulation crimp terminals, and replacement internal batteries.

4.4 FUSING REQUIREMENTS

Caution:
Where UL/CSA listing of the equipment is required for external fuse protection, a UL or
CSA Listed fuse must be used for the auxiliary supply. The listed protective fuse type is:
Class J time delay fuse, with a maximum current rating of 15 A and a minimum DC
rating of 250 V dc (for example type AJT15).

Caution:
Where UL/CSA listing of the equipment is not required, a high rupture capacity (HRC)
fuse type with a maximum current rating of 16 Amps and a minimum dc rating of 250 V
dc may be used for the auxiliary supply (for example Red Spot type NIT or TIA).
For P50 models, use a 1A maximum T-type fuse.
For P60 models, use a 4A maximum T-type fuse.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 21
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

Caution:
Digital input circuits should be protected by a high rupture capacity NIT or TIA fuse with
maximum rating of 16 A. for safety reasons, current transformer circuits must never be
fused. Other circuits should be appropriately fused to protect the wire used.

Caution:
CTs must NOT be fused since open circuiting them may produce lethal hazardous
voltages

4.5 EQUIPMENT CONNECTIONS

Warning:
Terminals exposed during installation, commissioning and maintenance may present a
hazardous voltage unless the equipment is electrically isolated.

Caution:
Tighten M4 clamping screws of heavy duty terminal block connectors to a nominal
torque of 1.3 Nm.
Tighten captive screws of terminal blocks to 0.5 Nm minimum and 0.6 Nm maximum.

Caution:
Always use insulated crimp terminations for voltage and current connections.

Caution:
Always use the correct crimp terminal and tool according to the wire size.

Caution:
Watchdog (self-monitoring) contacts are provided to indicate the health of the device
on some products. We strongly recommend that you hard wire these contacts into the
substation's automation system, for alarm purposes.

4.6 PROTECTION CLASS 1 EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS

Caution:
Earth the equipment with the supplied PCT (Protective Conductor Terminal).

Caution:
Do not remove the PCT.

Caution:
The PCT is sometimes used to terminate cable screens. Always check the PCT’s integrity
after adding or removing such earth connections.

22 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

Caution:
Use a locknut or similar mechanism to ensure the integrity of stud-connected PCTs.

Caution:
The recommended minimum PCT wire size is 2.5 mm² for countries whose mains supply
is 230 V (e.g. Europe) and 3.3 mm² for countries whose mains supply is 110 V (e.g. North
America). This may be superseded by local or country wiring regulations.
For P60 products, the recommended minimum PCT wire size is 6 mm². See product
documentation for details.

Caution:
The PCT connection must have low-inductance and be as short as possible.

Caution:
All connections to the equipment must have a defined potential. Connections that are
pre-wired, but not used, should be earthed, or connected to a common grouped
potential.

4.7 PRE-ENERGISATION CHECKLIST

Caution:
Check voltage rating/polarity (rating label/equipment documentation).

Caution:
Check CT circuit rating (rating label) and integrity of connections.

Caution:
Check protective fuse or miniature circuit breaker (MCB) rating.

Caution:
Check integrity of the PCT connection.

Caution:
Check voltage and current rating of external wiring, ensuring it is appropriate for the
application.

4.8 PERIPHERAL CIRCUITRY

Warning:
Do not open the secondary circuit of a live CT since the high voltage produced may be
lethal to personnel and could damage insulation. Short the secondary of the line CT
before opening any connections to it.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 23
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

Note:
For most Alstom equipment with ring-terminal connections, the threaded terminal block for current transformer termination
is automatically shorted if the module is removed. Therefore external shorting of the CTs may not be required. Check the
equipment documentation and wiring diagrams first to see if this applies.

Caution:
Where external components such as resistors or voltage dependent resistors (VDRs) are
used, these may present a risk of electric shock or burns if touched.

Warning:
Take extreme care when using external test blocks and test plugs such as the MMLG,
MMLB and P990, as hazardous voltages may be exposed. Ensure that CT shorting links
are in place before removing test plugs, to avoid potentially lethal voltages.

4.9 UPGRADING/SERVICING

Warning:
Do not insert or withdraw modules, PCBs or expansion boards from the equipment
while energised, as this may result in damage to the equipment. Hazardous live
voltages would also be exposed, endangering personnel.

Caution:
Internal modules and assemblies can be heavy and may have sharp edges. Take care
when inserting or removing modules into or out of the IED.

24 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

5 DECOMMISSIONING AND DISPOSAL

Caution:
Before decommissioning, completely isolate the equipment power supplies (both poles
of any dc supply). The auxiliary supply input may have capacitors in parallel, which may
still be charged. To avoid electric shock, discharge the capacitors using the external
terminals before decommissioning.

Caution:
Avoid incineration or disposal to water courses. Dispose of the equipment in a safe,
responsible and environmentally friendly manner, and if applicable, in accordance with
country-specific regulations.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 25
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

6 REGULATORY COMPLIANCE
Compliance with the European Commission Directive on EMC and LVD is demonstrated using a technical file.

6.1 EMC COMPLIANCE: 2014/30/EU


The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the relevant harmonised standard(s) or conformit
assessment used to demonstrate compliance with the EMC directive.

6.2 LVD COMPLIANCE: 2014/35/EU


The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the relevant harmonized standard(s) or conformity
assessment used to demonstrate compliance with the LVD directive.
Safety related information, such as the installation I overvoltage category, pollution degree and operating
temperature ranges are specified in the Technical Data section of the relevant product documentation and/or on
the product labelling .
Unless otherwise stated in the Technical Data section of the relevant product documentation, the equipment is
intended for indoor use only. Where the equipment is required for use in an outdoor location, it must be mounted
in a specific cabinet or housing to provide the equipment with the appropriate level of protection from the
expected outdoor environment.

6.3 R&TTE COMPLIANCE: 2014/53/EU


Radio and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) directive 2014/53/EU.
Conformity is demonstrated by compliance to both the EMC directive and the Low Voltage directive, to zero volts.

6.4 UL/CUL COMPLIANCE


If marked with this logo, the product is compliant with the requirements of the Canadian and USA Underwriters
Laboratories.
The relevant UL file number and ID is shown on the equipment.

6.5 ATEX COMPLIANCE: 2014/34/EU


Products marked with the 'explosion protection' Ex symbol (shown in the example, below) are compliant with the
ATEX directive. The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the Notified Body, Type Examination
Certificate, and relevant harmonized standard or conformity assessment used to demonstrate compliance with
the ATEX directive.
The ATEX Equipment Protection level, Equipment group, and Zone definition will be marked on the
product.
For example:

26 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information

Where:

'II' Equipment Group: Industrial.

'(2)G' High protection equipment category, for control of equipment in gas atmospheres in Zone 1 and 2.
This equipment (with parentheses marking around the zone number) is not itself suitable for operation
within a potentially explosive atmosphere.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 27
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV

28 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 3

HARDWARE DESIGN
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

30 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the product's hardware design.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 31
Hardware Architecture 32
Mechanical Implementation 33
Front Panel 35
Rear Panel 38
Boards and Modules 39

P446SV-TM-EN-1 31
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE
The main components comprising an General Electric Sampled Values device are as follows:
● The housing, consisting of a front panel and connections at the rear
● The Main processor module consisting of the main CPU (Central Processing Unit), memory and an interface
to the front panel HMI (Human Machine Interface)
● A selection of plug-in boards and modules with presentation at the rear for the sampled values inputs,
power supply, communication functions, digital I/O and time synchronisation connectivity
All boards and modules are connected by a parallel data and address bus, which allows the processor module to
send and receive information to and from the other modules as required. There is also a separate serial data bus
for conveying sampled data from the input module to the CPU. These parallel and serial databuses are shown as a
single interconnection module in the following figure, which shows typical modules and the flow of data between
them.

Keypad
Output relay boards Output relay contacts
Processor module
Front panel HMI

LCD
Opto-input boards Digital inputs
LEDs
I/O
Front port

Memory IEC 61850-9-2LE


Interconnection

Sampled Values
Flash memory for settings
input board
Sample Value Inputs
Battery-backed SRAM
for records

RS485 modules RS485 communication


Watchdog
contacts Watchdog module
IRIG-B module Time synchronisation
+ LED

Ethernet modules Ethernet communication


Auxiliary
PSU module
Supply Communications

Note: Not all modules are applicable to all products

V00280

Figure 4: Hardware architecture

32 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

3 MECHANICAL IMPLEMENTATION
All products based on the Px4x platform have common hardware architecture. The hardware is modular and
consists of the following main parts:
● Case and terminal blocks
● Boards and modules
● Front panel
The case comprises the housing metalwork and terminal blocks at the rear. The boards fasten into the terminal
blocks and are connected together by a ribbon cable. This ribbon cable connects to the processor in the front
panel.
The following diagram shows an exploded view of a typical product. The diagram shown does not necessarily
represent exactly the product model described in this manual.

Figure 5: Exploded view of IED

3.1 HOUSING VARIANTS


The Px4x range of products are implemented in a range of case sizes. Case dimensions for industrial products
usually follow modular measurement units based on rack sizes. These are: U for height and TE for width, where:
● 1U = 1.75 inches = 44.45 mm
● 1TE = 0.2 inches = 5.08 mm

The products are available in panel-mount or standalone versions. All products are nominally 4U high. This equates
to 177.8 mm or 7 inches.
The cases are pre-finished steel with a conductive covering of aluminium and zinc. This provides good grounding
at all joints, providing a low resistance path to earth that is essential for performance in the presence of external
noise.
The case width depends on the product type and its hardware options. There are three different case widths for
the described range of products: 40TE, 60TE and 80TE. The case dimensions and compatibility criteria are as
follows:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 33
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

Case width (TE) Case width (mm) Case width (inches)


40TE 203.2 8
60TE 304.8 12
80TE 406.4 16

Note:
Not all case sizes are available for all models.

3.2 LIST OF BOARDS


The product's hardware consists of several modules drawn from a standard range. The exact specification and
number of hardware modules depends on the model number and variant. Depending on the exact model, the
product in question will use a selection of the following boards.
Board Use
Main Processor board - 40TE or smaller Main Processor board – without support for function keys
Power supply board - 24/54V DC Power supply input. Accepts DC voltage between 24V and 54V
Power supply board - 48/125V DC Power supply input. Accepts DC voltage between 48V and 125V
Power supply board - 110/250V DC Power supply input. Accepts DC voltage between 110V and 125V
IEC 61850 9-2LE board Ethernet board for accepting IEC 61850 sampled values
IRIG-B board - modulated input Interface board for modulated IRIG-B timing signal
IRIG-B board - demodulated input Interface board for demodulated IRIG-B timing signal
Fibre board Interface board for fibre-based RS485 connection
Fibre board + IRIG-B Interface board for fibre-based RS485 connection + demodulated IRIG-B
2nd rear communications board Interface board for RS232 / RS485 connections
2nd rear communications board with IRIG-B input Interface board for RS232 / RS485 + IRIG-B connections
100MhZ Ethernet board Standard 100MHz Ethernet board for LAN connection (fibre + copper)
100MhZ Ethernet board with modulated IRIG-B Standard 100MHz Ethernet board (fibre / copper) + modulated IRIG-B
100MhZ Ethernet board with demodulated IRIG-B Standard 100MHz Ethernet board (fibre / copper)+ demodulated IRIG-B
High-break output relay board Output relay board with high breaking capacity relays
Redundant Ethernet SHP+ modulated IRIG-B Redundant SHP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + modulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet SHP + demodulated IRIG-B Redundant SHP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet RSTP + modulated IRIG-B Redundant RSTP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + modulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet RSTP+ demodulated IRIG-B Redundant RSTP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet DHP+ modulated IRIG-B Redundant DHP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + modulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet DHP+ demodulated IRIG-B Redundant DHP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet PRP+ modulated IRIG-B Redundant PRP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + modulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet PRP+ demodulated IRIG-B Redundant PRP Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet HSR + modulated IRIG-B Redundant HSR Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Redundant Ethernet HSR+ demodulated IRIG-B Redundant HSR Ethernet board (2 fibre ports) + demodulated IRIG-B input
Output relay output board Standard output relay board

34 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

4 FRONT PANEL

4.1 40TE FRONT PANEL


The following diagram shows a 40TE case. The hinged covers at the top and bottom of the front panel are shown
closed. An optional transparent front cover physically protects the front panel.

Figure 6: Front panel (40TE)

The front panel consists of:


● Top and bottom compartments with hinged cover
● LCD display
● Keypad
● Fixed function LEDs
● 9 pin D-type serial port (behind hinged cover)
● 25 pin D-type download port (behind hinged cover)

4.1.1 FRONT PANEL COMPARTMENTS


The top compartment contains labels for the:
● Serial number
● Current and voltage ratings.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 35
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

The bottom compartment contains:


● A compartment for a 1/2 AA size backup battery (used to back up the real time clock and event, fault, and
disturbance records).
● A 9-pin female D-type front port for an EIA(RS)232 serial connection to a PC.
● A 25-pin female D-type parallel port for monitoring internal signals and downloading software and
language text.

4.1.2 KEYPAD
The keypad consists of the following keys:

4 arrow keys to navigate the menus (organised around the Enter key)

An enter key for executing the chosen option

A clear key for clearing the last command

A read key for viewing larger blocks of text (arrow keys now used for
scrolling)

2 hot keys for scrolling through the default display and for control of
setting groups. These are situated directly below the LCD display.

4.1.2.1 LIQUID CRYSTAL DISPLAY


The LCD is a high resolution monochrome display with 16 characters by 3 lines and controllable back light.

4.1.3 FRONT SERIAL PORT (SK1)


The front serial port is a 9-pin female D-type connector, providing RS232 serial data communication. It is situated
under the bottom hinged cover, and is used to communicate with a locally connected PC. It is used to transfer
settings data between the PC and the IED.
The port is intended for temporary connection during testing, installation and commissioning. It is not intended to
be used for permanent SCADA communications. This port supports the Courier communication protocol only.
Courier is a proprietary communication protocol to allow communication with a range of protection equipment,
and between the device and the Windows-based support software package.
This port can be considered as a DCE (Data Communication Equipment) port, so you can connect this port device
to a PC with an EIA(RS)232 serial cable up to 15 m in length.
The inactivity timer for the front port is set to 15 minutes. This controls how long the unit maintains its level of
password access on the front port. If no messages are received on the front port for 15 minutes, any password
access level that has been enabled is cancelled.

36 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

Note:
The front serial port does not support automatic extraction of event and disturbance records, although this data can be
accessed manually.

4.1.3.1 FRONT SERIAL PORT (SK1) CONNECTIONS


The port pin-out follows the standard for Data Communication Equipment (DCE) device with the following pin
connections on a 9-pin connector.
Pin number Description
2 Tx Transmit data
3 Rx Receive data
5 0 V Zero volts common

You must use the correct serial cable, or the communication will not work. A straight-through serial cable is
required, connecting pin 2 to pin 2, pin 3 to pin 3, and pin 5 to pin 5.
Once the physical connection from the unit to the PC is made, the PC’s communication settings must be set to
match those of the IED. The following table shows the unit’s communication settings for the front port.
Protocol Courier
Baud rate 19,200 bps
Courier address 1
Message format 11 bit - 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 parity bit (even parity), 1 stop bit

4.1.4 FRONT PARALLEL PORT (SK2)


The front parallel port uses a 25 pin D-type connector. It is used for commissioning, downloading firmware updates
and menu text editing.

4.1.5 FIXED FUNCTION LEDS


Four fixed-function LEDs on the left-hand side of the front panel indicate the following conditions.
● Trip (Red) switches ON when the IED issues a trip signal. It is reset when the associated fault record is
cleared from the front display. Also the trip LED can be configured as self-resetting.
● Alarm (Yellow) flashes when the IED registers an alarm. This may be triggered by a fault, event or
maintenance record. The LED flashes until the alarms have been accepted (read), then changes to
constantly ON. When the alarms are cleared, the LED switches OFF.
● Out of service (Yellow) is ON when the IED's functions are unavailable.
● Healthy (Green) is ON when the IED is in correct working order, and should be ON at all times. It goes OFF if
the unit’s self-tests show there is an error in the hardware or software. The state of the healthy LED is
reflected by the watchdog contacts at the back of the unit.

4.1.6 PROGRAMABLE LEDS


The device has a number of programmable LEDs, which can be associated with PSL-generated signals. The
programmable LEDs for most models are tri-colour and can be set to RED, YELLOW or GREEN. However the
programmable LEDs for some models are single-colour (red) only. The single-colour LEDs can be recognised by
virtue of the fact they are large and slightly oval, whereas the tri-colour LEDs are small and round.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 37
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

5 REAR PANEL
The MiCOM P40Agile Modular series uses a modular construction. Most of the internal workings are on boards and
modules which fit into slots. Some of the boards plug into terminal blocks, which are bolted onto the rear of the
unit. However, some boards such as the communications boards have their own connectors. The rear panel
consists of these terminal blocks plus the rears of the communications boards.
The back panel cut-outs and slot allocations vary. This depends on the product, the type of boards and the
terminal blocks needed to populate the case. The following diagram shows the rear view of a 40TE. The IEC
61850-9-2LE interface is highlighted in grey.

E00283

Figure 7: Rear view of populated case

Note:
This diagram is a typical example and may not show the exact same arrangement of boards as your particular model. Refer
to the Cortec for product details.

38 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

6 BOARDS AND MODULES


Each product comprises a selection of PCBs (Printed Circuit Boards) and subassemblies, depending on the chosen
configuration.

6.1 PCBS
A PCB typically consists of the components, a front connector for connecting into the main system parallel bus via
a ribbon cable, and an interface to the rear. This rear interface may be:
● Directly presented to the outside world (as is the case for communication boards such as Ethernet Boards)
● Presented to a connector, which in turn connects into a terminal block bolted onto the rear of the case (as is
the case for most of the other board types)

Figure 8: Rear connection to terminal block

P446SV-TM-EN-1 39
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

6.2 MAIN PROCESSOR BOARD

Figure 9: Main processor board

The main processor board performs all calculations and controls the operation of all other modules in the IED,
including the data communication and user interfaces. This is the only board that does not fit into one of the slots.
It resides in the front panel and connects to the rest of the system using an internal ribbon cable.
The LCD and LEDs are mounted on the processor board along with the front panel communication ports.
The memory on the main processor board is split into two categories: volatile and non-volatile. The volatile
memory is fast access SRAM, used by the processor to run the software and store data during calculations. The
non-volatile memory is sub-divided into two groups:
● Flash memory to store software code, text and configuration data including the present setting values.
● Battery-backed SRAM to store disturbance, event, fault and maintenance record data.

There are two board types available depending on the size of the case:
● For models in 40TE cases
● For models in 60TE cases and larger

40 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

6.3 POWER SUPPLY BOARD

Figure 10: Power supply board

The power supply board provides power to the unit. One of three different configurations of the power supply
board can be fitted to the unit. This is specified at the time of order and depends on the magnitude of the supply
voltage that will be connected to it.
There are three board types, which support the following voltage ranges:
● 24/54 V DC
● 48/125 V DC or 40-100V AC
● 110/250 V DC or 100-240V AC
The power supply board connector plugs into a medium duty terminal block. This terminal block is always
positioned on the right hand side of the unit looking from the rear.
The power supply board is usually assembled together with a relay output board to form a complete subassembly,
as shown in the following diagram.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 41
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

Figure 11: Power supply assembly

The power supply outputs are used to provide isolated power supply rails to the various modules within the unit.
Three voltage levels are used by the unit’s modules:
● 5.1 V for all of the digital circuits
● +/- 16 V for the analogue electronics such as on the input board
● 22 V for driving the output relay coils.
All power supply voltages, including the 0 V earth line, are distributed around the unit by the 64-way ribbon cable.
The power supply board incorporates inrush current limiting. This limits the peak inrush current to approximately
10 A.
Power is applied to pins 1 and 2 of the terminal block, where pin 1 is negative and pin 2 is positive. The pin
numbers are clearly marked on the terminal block as shown in the following diagram.

42 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

Figure 12: Power supply terminals

6.3.1 WATCHDOG
The Watchdog contacts are also hosted on the power supply board. The Watchdog facility provides two output
relay contacts, one normally open and one normally closed. These are used to indicate the health of the device
and are driven by the main processor board, which continually monitors the hardware and software when the
device is in service.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 43
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

Figure 13: Watchdog contact terminals

6.3.2 REAR SERIAL PORT


The rear serial port (RP1) is housed on the power supply board. This is a three-terminal EIA(RS)485 serial
communications port and is intended for use with a permanently wired connection to a remote control centre for
SCADA communication. The interface supports half-duplex communication and provides optical isolation for the
serial data being transmitted and received.
The physical connectivity is achieved using three screw terminals; two for the signal connection, and the third for
the earth shield of the cable. These are located on pins 16, 17 and 18 of the power supply terminal block, which is
on the far right looking from the rear. The interface can be selected between RS485 and K-bus. When the K-Bus
option is selected, the two signal connections are not polarity conscious.
The polarity independent K-bus can only be used for the Courier data protocol. The polarity conscious MODBUS,
IEC 60870-5-103 and DNP3.0 protocols need RS485.
The following diagram shows the rear serial port. The pin assignments are as follows:
● Pin 16: Earth shield
● Pin 17: Negative signal
● Pin 18: Positive signal

44 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

Figure 14: Rear serial port terminals

An additional serial port with D-type presentation is available as an optional board, if required.

6.4 IEC61850-9-2LE ETHERNET BOARD

RX
Fibre optic
Ethernet
connections
TX

LINK RJ45
1 TX+
2 TX- RJ45 service
3 RX+
4
port for
ACTIVITY 5 commissioning
6 RX- and testing only
7
8

E00227

Figure 15: IEC 61850-9-2LE board

Optical Fibre Connectors


The board uses 1300 nm multi mode 100BaseFx with ST connectors.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 45
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

RJ45 Connector
This is a service port for commissioning and testing only. Do not use this for permanent connections.

LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity Traffic

Note:
The 9-2LE interface fibre port does not support auto negotiation. Ensure the Ethernet port of the device connected to the 9-2
LE interface fibre port is set to 100Mbps full duplex.

6.5 STANDARD OUTPUT RELAY BOARD

Figure 16: Standard output relay board - 8 contacts

This output relay board has 8 relays with 6 Normally Open contacts and 2 Changeover contacts.
The output relay board is provided together with the power supply board as a complete assembly, or
independently for the purposes of relay output expansion.
There are two cut-out locations in the board. These can be removed to allow power supply components to
protrude when coupling the output relay board to the power supply board. If the output relay board is to be used
independently, these cut-out locations remain intact.
The terminal numbers are as follows:
Terminal Number Output Relay
Terminal 1 Relay 1 NO
Terminal 2 Relay 1 NO
Terminal 3 Relay 2 NO

46 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

Terminal Number Output Relay


Terminal 4 Relay 2 NO
Terminal 5 Relay 3 NO
Terminal 6 Relay 3 NO
Terminal 7 Relay 4 NO
Terminal 8 Relay 4 NO
Terminal 9 Relay 5 NO
Terminal 10 Relay 5 NO
Terminal 11 Relay 6 NO
Terminal 12 Relay 6 NO
Terminal 13 Relay 7 changeover
Terminal 14 Relay 7 changeover
Terminal 15 Relay 7 common
Terminal 16 Relay 8 changeover
Terminal 17 Relay 8 changeover
Terminal 18 Relay 8 common

6.6 IRIG-B BOARD

Figure 17: IRIG-B board

The IRIG-B board can be fitted to provide an accurate timing reference for the device. The IRIG-B signal is
connected to the board via a BNC connector. The timing information is used to synchronise the IED's internal real-
time clock to an accuracy of 1 ms. The internal clock is then used for time tagging events, fault, maintenance and
disturbance records.
IRIG-B interface is available in modulated or demodulated formats.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 47
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

The IRIG-B facility is provided in combination with other functionality on a number of additional boards, such as:
● Fibre board with IRIG-B
● Second rear communications board with IRIG-B
● Ethernet board with IRIG-B
● Redundant Ethernet board with IRIG-B

There are two types of each of these boards; one type which accepts a modulated IRIG-B input and one type
which accepts a demodulated IRIG-B input.

6.7 FIBRE OPTIC BOARD

Figure 18: Fibre optic board

This board provides an interface for communicating with a master station. This communication link can use all
compatible protocols (Courier, IEC 60870-5-103, MODBUS and DNP 3.0). It is a fibre-optic alternative to the metallic
RS485 port presented on the power supply terminal block. The metallic and fibre optic ports are mutually exclusive.
The fibre optic port uses BFOC 2.5 ST connectors.
The board comes in two varieties; one with an IRIG-B input and one without:

48 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

6.8 REAR COMMUNICATION BOARD

Figure 19: Rear communication board

The optional communications board containing the secondary communication ports provide two serial interfaces
presented on 9 pin D-type connectors. These interfaces are known as SK4 and SK5. Both connectors are female
connectors, but are configured as DTE ports. This means pin 2 is used to transmit information and pin 3 to receive.
SK4 can be used with RS232, RS485 and K-bus. SK5 can only be used with RS232 and is used for electrical
teleprotection. The optional rear communications board and IRIG-B board are mutually exclusive since they use
the same hardware slot. However, the board comes in two varieties; one with an IRIG-B input and one without.

6.9 ETHERNET BOARD

Figure 20: Ethernet board

P446SV-TM-EN-1 49
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

This is a communications board that provides a standard 100-Base Ethernet interface. This board supports one
electrical copper connection and one fibre-pair connection.
There are several variants for this board as follows:
● 100 Mbps Ethernet board
● 100 Mbps Ethernet with on-board modulated IRIG-B input
● 100 Mbps Ethernet with on-board unmodulated IRIG-B input
Two of the variants provide an IRIG-B interface. IRIG-B provides a timing reference for the unit – one board for
modulated IRIG-B and one for demodulated. The IRIG B signal is connected to the board with a BNC connector.
The Ethernet and other connection details are described below:

IRIG-B Connector
● Centre connection: Signal
● Outer connection: Earth

LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity Traffic

Optical Fibre Connectors


Connector Function
Rx Receive
Tx Transmit

RJ45connector
Pin Signal name Signal definition
1 TXP Transmit (positive)
2 TXN Transmit (negative)
3 RXP Receive (positive)
4 - Not used
5 - Not used
6 RXN Receive (negative)
7 - Not used
8 - Not used

50 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

6.10 REDUNDANT ETHERNET BOARD

IRIG-B

Link Fail
Pin3 connector
Pin 2

Pin 1
Link channel Link channel B
A (green LED) (green LED)
Activity channel Activity channel B
A (yellow LED) (yellow LED)
A
C

V01009

Figure 21: Redundant Ethernet board

This board provides dual redundant Ethernet (supported by two fibre pairs) together with an IRIG-B interface for
timing.
Different board variants are available, depending on the redundancy protocol and the type of IRIG-B signal
(unmodulated or modulated). The available redundancy protocols are:
● SHP (Self healing Protocol)
● RSTP (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol)
● DHP (Dual Homing Protocol)
● PRP (Parallel Redundancy Protocol)

There are several variants for this board as follows:


● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running RSTP, with on-board modulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running RSTP, with on-board unmodulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running SHP, with on-board modulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running SHP, with on-board unmodulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running DHP, with on-board modulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running DHP, with on-board unmodulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running PRP, with on-board modulated IRIG-B
● 100 Mbps redundant Ethernet running PRP, with on-board demodulated IRIG-B
The Ethernet and other connection details are described below:

IRIG-B Connector
● Centre connection: Signal
● Outer connection: Earth

P446SV-TM-EN-1 51
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

Link Fail Connector (Ethernet Board Watchdog Relay)


Pin Closed Open
1-2 Link fail Channel 1 (A) Link ok Channel 1 (A)
2-3 Link fail Channel 2 (B) Link ok Channel 2 (B)

LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity SHP running PRP, RSTP or DHP traffic

Optical Fibre Connectors (ST)


Connector DHP RSTP SHP PRP
A RXA RX1 RS RXA
B TXA TX1 ES TXA
C RXB RX2 RP RXB
D TXB TX2 EP TXB

RJ45connector
Pin Signal name Signal definition
1 TXP Transmit (positive)
2 TXN Transmit (negative)
3 RXP Receive (positive)
4 - Not used
5 - Not used
6 RXN Receive (negative)
7 - Not used
8 - Not used

52 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

6.11 COPROCESSOR BOARD

Figure 22: Fully populated Coprocessor board

Note:
The above figure shows a coprocessor complete with GPS input and 2 fibre-optic serial data interfaces, and is not necessarily
representative of the product and model described in this manual. These interfaces will not be present on boards that do not
require them.

Where applicable, a second processor board is used to process the special algorithms associated with the device.
This second processor board provides fast access (zero wait state) SRAM for use with both program and data
memory storage. This memory can be accessed by the main processor board via the parallel bus. This is how the
software is transferred from the flash memory on the main processor board to the coprocessor board on power
up. Further communication between the two processor boards is achieved via interrupts and the shared SRAM.
The serial bus carrying the sample data is also connected to the co-processor board, using the processor’s built-in
serial port, as on the main processor board.
There are several different variants of this board, which can be chosen depending on the exact device and model.
The variants are:
● Coprocessor board with current differential inputs and GPS input
● Coprocessor board with current differential inputs only
● Coprocessor board with GPS input only

6.11.1 COPROCESSOR BOARD WITH 1PPS INPUT


In some applications, where the communication links between two remote devices are provided by a third party
telecommunications partner, the transmit and receive paths associated with one channel may differ considerably
in length, resulting in very different transmission and receive times.
If, for example, Device A is transmitting to Device B information about the value of its measured current, the
information Device A is receiving from Device B about the current measured at the same time, may reach device B
at a different time. This has to be compensated for. A 1pps GPS timing signal applied to both devices will help the
IEDs achieve this, because it is possible to measure the exact time taken for both transmission and receive paths.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 53
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

Note:
The 1 pps signal is always supplied by a GPS receiver (such as a P594).

Note:
This signal is used to control the sampling process, and timing calculations and is not used for time stamping or real time
synchronisation.

6.12 HIGH BREAK OUTPUT RELAY BOARD

Figure 23: High Break relay output board

A High Break output relay board is available as an option. It comprises four normally open output contacts, which
are suitable for high breaking loads.
A High Break contact consists of a high capacity relay with a MOSFET in parallel with it. The MOSFET has a varistor
placed across it to provide protection, which is required when switching off inductive loads. This is because the
stored energy in the inductor causes a high reverse voltage that could damage the MOSFET, if not protected.
When there is a control input command to operate an output contact the miniature relay is operated at the same
time as the MOSFET. The miniature relay contact closes in nominally 3.5 ms and is used to carry the continuous
load current. The MOSFET operates in less than 0.2 ms, but is switched off after 7.5 ms.
When the control input is reset, the MOSFET is again turned on for 7.5 mS. The miniature relay resets in nominally
3.5 ms before the MOSFET. This means the MOSFET is used to break the load. The MOSFET absorbs the energy
when breaking inductive loads and so limits the resulting voltage surge. This contact arrangement is for switching
DC circuits only.
The board number is:
● ZN0042 001

High Break Contact Operation


The following figure shows the timing diagram for High Break contact operation.

54 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design

Databus on off
control input

MOSFET operate 7ms 7ms


on on

MOSFET reset

Relay contact
Closed

3.5ms + contact bounce 3.5ms

Load current

V00246

Figure 24: High Break contact operation

High Break Contact Applications


● Efficient scheme engineering
In traditional hard wired scheme designs, High Break capability could only be achieved using external
electromechanical trip relays. Instead, these internal High Break contacts can be used thus reducing space
requirements.
● Accessibility of CB auxiliary contacts
It is common practise to use circuit breaker 52a (CB Closed) auxiliary contacts to break the trip coil current
on breaker opening, thereby easing the duty on the protection contacts. In some cases (such as operation
of disconnectors, or retrofitting), it may be that 52a contacts are either unavailable or unreliable. In such
cases, High Break contacts can be used to break the trip coil current in these applications.
● Breaker fail
In the event of failure of the local circuit breaker (stuck breaker), or defective auxiliary contacts (stuck
contacts), it is incorrect to use 52a contact action. The interrupting duty at the local breaker then falls on the
relay output contacts, which may not be rated to perform this duty. High Break contacts should be used in
this case to avoid the risk of burning out relay contacts.
● Initiation of teleprotection
The High Break contacts also offer fast making, which results in faster tripping. In addition, fast keying of
teleprotection is a benefit. Fast keying bypasses the usual contact operation time, such that permissive,
blocking and intertrip commands can be routed faster.

Warning:
These relay contacts are POLARITY SENSITIVE. External wiring must comply with the polarity
requirements described in the external connection diagram to ensure correct operation.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 55
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV

56 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 4

SOFTWARE DESIGN
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

58 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the software design of the IED.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 59
Sofware Design Overview 60
System Level Software 61
Platform Software 64
Protection and Control Functions 65

P446SV-TM-EN-1 59
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

2 SOFWARE DESIGN OVERVIEW


The device software can be conceptually categorized into several elements as follows:
● The system level software
● The platform software
● The protection and control software

These elements are not distinguishable to the user, and the distinction is made purely for the purposes of
explanation. The following figure shows the software architecture.

Protection and Control Software Layer


Protection Task
Programmable & fixed Coprocessor protection
scheme logic algorithms
Fault locator Disturbance
Signal processing Protection algorithms task recorder task

Supervisor task

Records

and control
Protection

settings
Platform Software Layer

Event, fault,
Remote
disturbance,
Settings database communications
maintenance record
Sampling function interfaces
logging

Front panel Local


interface communications
(LCD + Keypad) interfaces

Sample data + digital Control of interfaces to keypad , LCD, LEDs,


logic inputs front & rear ports.
Control of output contacts
and programmable LEDs Self-checking maintenance records

System Level Software Layer


System services (e.g. device drivers) / Real time operating system / Self-diagnostic software

Hardware Device Layer


LEDs / LCD / Keypad / Memory / FPGA

V00307

Figure 25: Software Architecture

The software, which executes on the main processor, can be divided into a number of functions as illustrated
above. Each function is further broken down into a number of separate tasks. These tasks are then run according
to a scheduler. They are run at either a fixed rate or they are event driven. The tasks communicate with each other
as and when required.

60 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design

3 SYSTEM LEVEL SOFTWARE

3.1 REAL TIME OPERATING SYSTEM


The real-time operating system is used to schedule the processing of the various tasks. This ensures that they are
processed in the time available and in the desired order of priority. The operating system also plays a part in
controlling the communication between the software tasks, through the use of operating system messages.

3.2 SYSTEM SERVICES SOFTWARE


The system services software provides the layer between the hardware and the higher-level functionality of the
platform software and the protection and control software. For example, the system services software provides
drivers for items such as the LCD display, the keypad and the remote communication ports. It also controls things
like the booting of the processor and the downloading of the processor code into RAM at startup.

3.3 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC SOFTWARE


The device includes several self-monitoring functions to check the operation of its hardware and software while in
service. If there is a problem with the hardware or software, it should be able to detect and report the problem, and
attempt to resolve the problem by performing a reboot. In this case, the device would be out of service for a short
time, during which the ‘Healthy’ LED on the front of the device is switched OFF and the watchdog contact at the
rear is ON. If the restart fails to resolve the problem, the unit takes itself permanently out of service; the ‘Healthy’
LED stays OFF and watchdog contact stays ON.
If a problem is detected by the self-monitoring functions, the device attempts to store a maintenance record to
allow the nature of the problem to be communicated to the user.
The self-monitoring is implemented in two stages: firstly a thorough diagnostic check which is performed on boot-
up, and secondly a continuous self-checking operation, which checks the operation of the critical functions whilst
it is in service.

3.4 STARTUP SELF-TESTING


The self-testing takes a few seconds to complete, during which time the IED's measurement, recording, control,
and protection functions are unavailable. On a successful start-up and self-test, the ‘health-state’ LED on the front
of the unit is switched on. If a problem is detected during the start-up testing, the device remains out of service
until it is manually restored to working order.
The operations that are performed at start-up are:
1. System boot
2. System software initialisation
3. Platform software initialisation and monitoring

3.4.1 SYSTEM BOOT


The integrity of the Flash memory is verified using a checksum before the program code and stored data is loaded
into RAM for execution by the processor. When the loading has been completed, the data held in RAM is compared
to that held in the Flash memory to ensure that no errors have occurred in the data transfer and that the two are
the same. The entry point of the software code in RAM is then called. This is the IED's initialisation code.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 61
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

3.4.2 SYSTEM LEVEL SOFTWARE INITIALISATION


The initialization process initializes the processor registers and interrupts, starts the watchdog timers (used by the
hardware to determine whether the software is still running), starts the real-time operating system and creates
and starts the supervisor task. In the initialization process the device checks the following:
● The status of the backup battery
● The integrity of the battery-backed SRAM that is used to store event, fault and disturbance records
● The operation of the LCD controller
● The watchdog operation

At the conclusion of the initialization software the supervisor task begins the process of starting the platform
software. Coprocessor board checks are also made as follows:
● A check is made for the presence of the coprocessor board

● The RAM on the coprocessor board is checked with a test bit pattern before the coprocessor board is
transferred from flash memory

If any of these checks produces an error, the coprocessor board is left out of service. The other protection
functions provided by the main processor board are left in service.

3.4.3 PLATFORM SOFTWARE INITIALISATION AND MONITORING


When starting the platform software, the IED checks the following:
● The integrity of the data held in non-volatile memory (using a checksum)
● The operation of the real-time clock
● The optional IRIG-B function (if applicable)
● The presence and condition of the input board
● The analog data acquisition system (it does this by sampling the reference voltage)

At the successful conclusion of all of these tests the unit is entered into service and the application software is
started up.

3.5 CONTINUOUS SELF-TESTING


When the IED is in service, it continually checks the operation of the critical parts of its hardware and software. The
checking is carried out by the system services software and the results are reported to the platform software. The
functions that are checked are as follows:
● The Flash memory containing all program code and language text is verified by a checksum.
● The code and constant data held in system memory is checked against the corresponding data in Flash
memory to check for data corruption.
● The system memory containing all data other than the code and constant data is verified with a checksum.
● The integrity of the digital signal I/O data from the opto-inputs and the output relay coils is checked by the
data acquisition function every time it is executed.
● The operation of the analog data acquisition system is continuously checked by the acquisition function
every time it is executed. This is done by sampling the reference voltages.
● The operation of the optional Ethernet board is checked by the software on the main processor card. If the
Ethernet board fails to respond an alarm is raised and the card is reset in an attempt to resolve the problem.
● The operation of the optional IRIG-B function is checked by the software that reads the time and date from
the board.
In the event that one of the checks detects an error in any of the subsystems, the platform software is notified and
it attempts to log a maintenance record.

62 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design

If the problem is with the battery status or the IRIG-B board, the device continues in operation. For problems
detected in any other area, the device initiates a shutdown and re-boot, resulting in a period of up to 10 seconds
when the functionality is unavailable.
A restart should clear most problems that may occur. If, however, the diagnostic self-check detects the same
problem that caused the IED to restart, it is clear that the restart has not cleared the problem, and the device takes
itself permanently out of service. This is indicated by the ‘’health-state’ LED on the front of the device, which
switches OFF, and the watchdog contact which switches ON.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 63
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

4 PLATFORM SOFTWARE
The platform software has three main functions:
● To control the logging of records generated by the protection software, including alarms, events, faults, and
maintenance records
● To store and maintain a database of all of the settings in non-volatile memory
● To provide the internal interface between the settings database and the user interfaces, using the front
panel interface and the front and rear communication ports

4.1 RECORD LOGGING


The logging function is used to store all alarms, events, faults and maintenance records. The records are stored in
non-volatile memory to provide a log of what has happened. The IED maintains four types of log on a first in first
out basis (FIFO). These are:
● Alarms
● Event records
● Fault records
● Maintenance records

The logs are maintained such that the oldest record is overwritten with the newest record. The logging function
can be initiated from the protection software. The platform software is responsible for logging a maintenance
record in the event of an IED failure. This includes errors that have been detected by the platform software itself or
errors that are detected by either the system services or the protection software function. See the Monitoring and
Control chapter for further details on record logging.

4.2 SETTINGS DATABASE


The settings database contains all the settings and data, which are stored in non-volatile memory. The platform
software manages the settings database and ensures that only one user interface can modify the settings at any
one time. This is a necessary restriction to avoid conflict between different parts of the software during a setting
change.
Changes to protection settings and disturbance recorder settings, are first written to a temporary location SRAM
memory. This is sometimes called 'Scratchpad' memory. These settings are not written into non-volatile memory
immediately. This is because a batch of such changes should not be activated one by one, but as part of a
complete scheme. Once the complete scheme has been stored in SRAM, the batch of settings can be committed to
the non-volatile memory where they will become active.

4.3 INTERFACES
The settings and measurements database must be accessible from all of the interfaces to allow read and modify
operations. The platform software presents the data in the appropriate format for each of the interfaces (LCD
display, keypad and all the communications interfaces).

64 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design

5 PROTECTION AND CONTROL FUNCTIONS


The protection and control software processes all of the protection elements and measurement functions. To
achieve this it has to communicate with the system services software, the platform software as well as organise its
own operations.
The protection task software has the highest priority of any of the software tasks in the main processor board. This
ensures the fastest possible protection response.
The protection and control software provides a supervisory task, which controls the start-up of the task and deals
with the exchange of messages between the task and the platform software.

5.1 ACQUISITION OF SAMPLES


After initialization, the protection and control task waits until there are enough samples to process. The acquisition
of samples on the main processor board is controlled by a ‘sampling function’ which is called by the system
services software.
This sampling function takes samples from the input module and stores them in a two-cycle FIFO buffer. These
samples are also stored concurrently by the coprocessor. The sample rate is 48 samples per cycle. This results in a
nominal sample rate of 2,400 samples per second for a 50 hz system and 2,880 samples per second for a 60 Hz
system. However the sample rate is not fixed. It tracks the power system frequency as described in the next
section.
In normal operation, the protection task is executed 16 times per cycle.

5.2 FREQUENCY TRACKING


The device provides a frequency tracking algorithm so that there are always 48 samples per cycle irrespective of
frequency drift. The frequency range in which 48 samples per second are provided is between 45 Hz and 66 z. If
the frequency falls outside this range, the sample rate reverts to its default rate of 2,400 Hz for 50 Hz or 2,880 Hz
for 60 Hz.
The frequency tracking of the analog input signals is achieved by a recursive Fourier algorithm which is applied to
one of the input signals. It works by detecting a change in the signal’s measured phase angle. The calculated value
of the frequency is used to modify the sample rate being used by the input module, in order to achieve a constant
sample rate per cycle of the power waveform. The value of the tracked frequency is also stored for use by the
protection and control task.
The frequency tracks off any voltage or current in the order VA, VB, VC, IA, IB, IC, down to 10%Vn for voltage and
5%In for current.

5.3 DIRECT USE OF SAMPLE VALUES


Most of the IED’s protection functionality uses the Fourier components calculated by the device’s signal processing
software. However RMS measurements and some special protection algorithms available in some products use
the sampled values directly.
The disturbance recorder also uses the samples from the input module, in an unprocessed form. This is for
waveform recording and the calculation of true RMS values of current, voltage and power for metering purposes.
In the case of special protection algorithms, using the sampled values directly provides exceptionally fast response
because you do not have to wait for the signal processing task to calculate the fundamental. You can act on the
sampled values immediately.

5.4 DISTANCE PROTECTION


The current and voltage inputs are filtered using Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filters. This reduces the
effects of non-power frequency components in the input signals, such as DC offsets in current waveforms, and

P446SV-TM-EN-1 65
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

capacitor voltage transformer (CVT) transients in the voltages. The device uses a combination of a 1/4 cycle filter
using 12 coefficients, a 1/2 cycle filter using 24 coefficients, and a single cycle filter using 48 coefficients. The
device automatically performs intelligent switching in the application of the filters, to select the best balance of
removal of transients with fast response. The protection elements themselves then perform additional filtering,
implemented for example, by the trip count strategy.
The following figure shows the frequency response of the 12, 24 and 48 coefficient filters, noting that all have a
gain of unity at the fundamental frequency:

Filter Response

2.5

2
Full
1.5
Gain Half
1
Quarter
0.5
0
0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21

Harmonic
E00308

Figure 26: Frequency response of FIR filters

5.5 FOURIER SIGNAL PROCESSING


All backup protection and measurement functions use single-cycle fourier digital filtering to extract the power
frequency component. This filtering is performed on the main processor board.
When the protection and control task is re-started by the sampling function, it calculates the Fourier components
for the analog signals. Although some protection algorithms use some Fourier-derived harmonics (e.g. second
harmonic for magnetizing inrush), most protection functions are based on the Fourier-derived fundamental
components of the measured analog signals. The Fourier components of the input current and voltage signals are
stored in memory so that they can be accessed by all of the protection elements’ algorithms.
The Fourier components are calculated using single-cycle Fourier algorithm. This Fourier algorithm always uses
the most recent 48 samples from the 2-cycle buffer.
Most protection algorithms use the fundamental component. In this case, the Fourier algorithm extracts the power
frequency fundamental component from the signal to produce its magnitude and phase angle. This can be
represented in either polar format or rectangular format, depending on the functions and algorithms using it.
The Fourier function acts as a filter, with zero gain at DC and unity gain at the fundamental, but with good
harmonic rejection for all harmonic frequencies up to the nyquist frequency. Frequencies beyond this nyquist
frequency are known as alias frequencies, which are introduced when the sampling frequency becomes less than
twice the frequency component being sampled. However, the Alias frequencies are significantly attenuated by an
anti-aliasing filter (low pass filter), which acts on the analog signals before they are sampled. The ideal cut-off point
of an anti-aliasing low pass filter would be set at:
(samples per cycle) ´ (fundamental frequency)/2
At 48samples per cycle, this would be nominally 1200 Hz for a 50 Hz system, or 1440 Hz for a 60 Hz system.
The following figure shows the nominal frequency response of the anti-alias filter and the Fourier filter for a 48-
sample single cycle fourier algorithm acting on the fundamental component:

66 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design

1
Ideal anti-alias filter response
0.8
Fourier Response
0.6 Real anti-alias filter without anti-alias filter
response
0.4
Fourier Response
0.2 with anti-alias filter

1 2 3... 24 Alias frequency


50 Hz 1200 Hz 2400 Hz
V00306

Figure 27: Frequency Response (indicative only)

5.6 PROGRAMMABLE SCHEME LOGIC


The purpose of the programmable scheme logic (PSL) is to allow you to configure your own protection schemes to
suit your particular application. This is done with programmable logic gates and delay timers. To allow greater
flexibility, different PSL is allowed for each of the four setting groups.
The input to the PSL is any combination of the status of the digital input signals from the opto-isolators on the
input board, the outputs of the protection elements such as protection starts and trips, and the outputs of the fixed
protection scheme logic (FSL). The fixed scheme logic provides the standard protection schemes. The PSL consists
of software logic gates and timers. The logic gates can be programmed to perform a range of different logic
functions and can accept any number of inputs. The timers are used either to create a programmable delay,
and/or to condition the logic outputs, such as to create a pulse of fixed duration on the output regardless of the
length of the pulse on the input. The outputs of the PSL are the LEDs on the front panel of the relay and the output
contacts at the rear.
The execution of the PSL logic is event driven. The logic is processed whenever any of its inputs change, for
example as a result of a change in one of the digital input signals or a trip output from a protection element. Also,
only the part of the PSL logic that is affected by the particular input change that has occurred is processed. This
reduces the amount of processing time that is used by the PSL. The protection & control software updates the logic
delay timers and checks for a change in the PSL input signals every time it runs.
The PSL can be configured to create very complex schemes. Because of this PSL desing is achieved by means of a
PC support package called the PSL Editor. This is available as part of the settings application software MiCOm S1
Agile, or as a standalone software module.

5.7 EVENT RECORDING


A change in any digital input signal or protection element output signal is used to indicate that an event has taken
place. When this happens, the protection and control task sends a message to the supervisor task to indicate that
an event is available to be processed and writes the event data to a fast buffer controlled by the supervisor task.
When the supervisor task receives an event record, it instructs the platform software to create the appropriate log
in non-volatile memory (battery backed-up SRAM). The operation of the record logging to battery backed-up SRAM
is slower than the supervisor buffer. This means that the protection software is not delayed waiting for the records
to be logged by the platform software. However, in the rare case when a large number of records to be logged are
created in a short period of time, it is possible that some will be lost, if the supervisor buffer is full before the
platform software is able to create a new log in battery backed-up SRAM. If this occurs then an event is logged to
indicate this loss of information.
Maintenance records are created in a similar manner, with the supervisor task instructing the platform software to
log a record when it receives a maintenance record message. However, it is possible that a maintenance record
may be triggered by a fatal error in the relay in which case it may not be possible to successfully store a
maintenance record, depending on the nature of the problem.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 67
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV

For more information, see the Monitoring and Control chapter.

5.8 DISTURBANCE RECORDER


The disturbance recorder operates as a separate task from the protection and control task. It can record the
waveforms for up to 12 calibrated analog channels and the values of up to 32 digital signals. The recording time is
user selectable. Up to 50 seconds of data can be recorded. A minimum number of 5 records with a capacity of 10
seconds each, up to a maximum of 50 records with a capacity of 10 seconds each can be set. The disturbance
recorder is supplied with data by the protection and control task once per cycle. The disturbance recorder collates
the data that it receives into the required length disturbance record. The disturbance records can be extracted by
settings application software such as MiCOM S1 Agile, which can also store the data in COMTRADE format,
therefore allowing the use of other packages to view the recorded data.
For more information, see the Monitoring and Control chapter.

5.9 FAULT LOCATOR


The fault locator uses 12 cycles of the analog input signals to calculate the fault location. The result is returned to
the protection and control task, which includes it in the fault record. The pre-fault and post-fault voltages are also
presented in the fault record. When the fault record is complete, including the fault location, the protection and
control task sends a message to the supervisor task to log the fault record.
The Fault Locator is not available on all models.

5.10 FUNCTION KEY INTERFACE


The function keys interface directly into the PSL as digital input signals. A change of state is only recognized when
a key press is executed on average for longer than 200 ms. The time to register a change of state depends on
whether the function key press is executed at the start or the end of a protection task cycle, with the additional
hardware and software scan time included. A function key press can provide a latched (toggled mode) or output
on key press only (normal mode) depending on how it is programmed. It can be configured to individual protection
scheme requirements. The latched state signal for each function key is written to non-volatile memory and read
from non-volatile memory during relay power up thus allowing the function key state to be reinstated after power-
up, should power be inadvertently lost.

68 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 5

CONFIGURATION
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

70 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
Each product has different configuration parameters according to the functions it has been designed to perform.
There is, however, a common methodology used across the entire product series to set these parameters.
Some of the communications setup can only be carried out using the HMI, and cannot be carried out using
settings applications software. This chapter includes concise instructions of how to configure the device,
particularly with respect to the communications setup, as well as a description of the common methodology used
to configure the device in general.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 71
Settings Application Software 72
Using the HMI Panel 73
Line Parameters 84
Date and Time Configuration 88
Settings Group Selection 91

P446SV-TM-EN-1 71
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

2 SETTINGS APPLICATION SOFTWARE


To configure this device you will need to use the Settings Application Software. The settings application software
used in this range of IEDs is called MiCOM S1 Agile. It is a collection of software tools, which is used for setting up
and managing the IEDs.
Although you can change many settings using the front panel HMI, some of the features cannot be configured
without the Settings Application Software; for example the programmable scheme logic, or IEC61850
communications.
If you do not already have a copy of the Settings Application Software, you can obtain it from General Electric
contact centre.
To configure your product, you will need a data model that matches your product. When you launch the Settings
Application Software, you will be presented with a panel that allows you to invoke the “Data Model Manager”. This
will close the other aspects of the software in order to allow an efficient import of the chosen data model. If you
don’t have, or can’t find, the data model relating to your product, please call the General Electric contact centre.
When you have loaded all the data models you need, you should restart the Settings Application Software and
start to create a model of your system using the “System Explorer” panel.
The software is designed to be intuitive, but help is available in an online help system and also the Settings
Application Software user guide P40-M&CR-SAS-UG-EN-n, where 'Language' is a 2 letter code designating the
language version of the user guide and 'n' is the latest version of the settings application software.

72 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

3 USING THE HMI PANEL


Using the HMI, you can:
● Display and modify settings
● View the digital I/O signal status
● Display measurements
● Display fault records
● Reset fault and alarm indications

The keypad provides full access to the device functionality using a range of menu options. The information is
displayed on the LCD.
Keys Description Function

To change the menu level or change between settings in a


Up and down cursor keys
particular column, or changing values within a cell

To change default display, change between column


Left and right cursor keys
headings, or changing values within a cell

ENTER key For changing and executing settings

For executing commands and settings for which shortcuts


Hotkeys
have been defined

Cancel key To return to column header from any menu cell

Read key To read alarm messages

Function keys (not all models) For executing user programmable functions

P446SV-TM-EN-1 73
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

Note:
As the LCD display has a resolution of 16 characters by 3 lines, some of the information is in a condensed mnemonic form.

3.1 NAVIGATING THE HMI PANEL


The cursor keys are used to navigate the menus. These keys have an auto-repeat function if held down
continuously. This can be used to speed up both setting value changes and menu navigation. The longer the key is
held pressed, the faster the rate of change or movement.
The navigation map below shows how to navigate the menu items.

Default display Default display


option option

Alarm message

Default display options


C

Column 00 Subsequent column headings Last Column


System data

Vertical cursor keys move


Horizontal cursor
between setting rows
keys move
Row 01
Language C between values
within a cell
Row 01

The Cancel key


returns to
column header
Subsequent rows Subsequent rows

V00400

Figure 28: Navigating the HMI

3.2 GETTING STARTED


When you first start the IED, it will go through its power up procedure. After a few seconds it will settle down into
one of the top level menus. There are two menus at this level:
● The Alarms menu for when there are alarms present
● The default display menu for when there are no alarms present.

If there are alarms present, the yellow Alarms LED will be flashing and the menu display will read as follows:

74 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

Alarms / Faults
Present
HOTKEY

Even though the device itself should be in full working order when you first start it, an alarm could still be present,
for example, if there is no network connection for a device fitted with a network card. If this is the case, you can
read the alarm by pressing the 'Read' key.

ALARMS
NIC Link Fail

If the device is fitted with an Ethernet card, you will first need to connect the device to an active Ethernet network
to clear the alarm and get the default display.
If there are other alarms present, these must also be cleared before you can get into the default display menu
options.

3.3 DEFAULT DISPLAY


The HMI contains a range of possible options that you can choose to be the default display. The options available
are:

NERC Compliant banner


If the device is a cyber-security model, it will provide a NERC-compliant default display. If the device does not
contain the cyber-security option, this display option is not available.

ACCESS ONLY FOR


AUTHORISED USERS
HOTKEY

Date and time


For example:

11:09:15
23 Nov 2011
HOTKEY

Description (user-defined)
For example:

Description
MiCOM P14NB
HOTKEY

Plant reference (user-defined)


For example:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 75
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

Plant Reference
MiCOM
HOTKEY

Access Level
For example:

Access Level
3
HOTKEY

In addition to the above, there are also displays for the system voltages, currents, power and frequency etc.,
depending on the device model.

3.4 DEFAULT DISPLAY NAVIGATION


The following diagram is an example of the default display navigation. In this example, we have used a cyber-
secure model. This is an example only and may not apply in its entirety to all models. The actual display options
available depend on the exact model.
Use the horizontal cursor keys to step through from one display to the next.

NERC compliant
banner

NERC Compliance NERC Compliance


Warning Warning

System Current
Access Level
Measurements

System Voltage
System Frequency
Measurements

System Power
Plant Reference
Measurements

Description Date & Time

V00403

Figure 29: Default display navigation

If the device is cyber-secure but is not yet configured for NERC compliance (see Cyber-security chapter), a warning
will appear when moving from the "NERC compliant" banner. The warning message is as follows:

76 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

DISPLAY NOT NERC


COMPLIANT. OK?

You will have to confirm with the Enter button before you can go any further.

Note:
Whenever the IED has an uncleared alarm the default display is replaced by the text Alarms/ Faults present. You cannot
override this default display. However, you can enter the menu structure from the default display, even if the display shows
the Alarms/Faults present message.

3.5 PASSWORD ENTRY


Configuring the default display (in addition to modification of other settings) requires level 3 access. You will be
prompted for a password before you can make any changes, as follows. The default level 3 password is AAAA.

Enter Password

1. A flashing cursor shows which character field of the password can be changed. Press the up or down cursor
keys to change each character (tip: pressing the up arrow once will return an upper case "A" as required by
the default level 3 password).
2. Use the left and right cursor keys to move between the character fields of the password.
3. Press the Enter key to confirm the password. If you enter an incorrect password, an invalid password
message is displayed then the display reverts to Enter password. On entering a valid password a message
appears indicating that the password is correct and which level of access has been unlocked. If this level is
sufficient to edit the selected setting, the display returns to the setting page to allow the edit to continue. If
the correct level of password has not been entered, the password prompt page appears again.
4. To escape from this prompt press the Clear key. Alternatively, enter the password using the Password
setting in the SYSTEM DATA column. If the keypad is inactive for 15 minutes, the password protection of the
front panel user interface reverts to the default access level.
To manually reset the password protection to the default level, select Password, then press the CLEAR key instead
of entering a password.

Note:
In the SECURITY CONFIG column, you can set the maximum number of attemps, the time window in which the failed attempts
are counted and the time duration for which the user is blocked.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 77
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

3.6 PROCESSING ALARMS AND RECORDS


If there are any alarm messages, they will appear on the default display and the yellow alarm LED flashes. The
alarm messages can either be self-resetting or latched. If they are latched, they must be cleared manually.
1. To view the alarm messages, press the Read key. When all alarms have been viewed but not cleared, the
alarm LED changes from flashing to constantly on, and the latest fault record appears (if there is one).
2. Scroll through the pages of the latest fault record, using the cursor keys. When all pages of the fault record
have been viewed, the following prompt appears.

Press Clear To
Reset Alarms

3. To clear all alarm messages, press the Clear key. To return to the display showing alarms or faults present,
and leave the alarms uncleared, press the Read key.
4. Depending on the password configuration settings, you may need to enter a password before the alarm
messages can be cleared.
5. When all alarms are cleared, the yellow alarm LED switches off. If the red LED was on, this will also be
switched off.

Note:
To speed up the procedure, you can enter the alarm viewer using the Read key and subsequently pressing the Clear key. This
goes straight to the fault record display. Press the Clear key again to move straight to the alarm reset prompt, then press the
Clear key again to clear all alarms.

3.7 MENU STRUCTURE


Settings, commands, records and measurements are stored in a local database inside the IED. When using the
Human Machine Interface (HMI) it is convenient to visualise the menu navigation system as a table. Each item in
the menu is known as a cell, which is accessed by reference to a column and row address. Each column and row is
assigned a 2-digit hexadecimal numbers, resulting in a unique 4-digit cell address for every cell in the database.
The main menu groups are allocated columns and the items within the groups are allocated rows, meaning a
particular item within a particular group is a cell.
Each column contains all related items, for example all of the disturbance recorder settings and records are in the
same column.
There are three types of cell:
● Settings: this is for parameters that can be set to different values
● Commands: this is for commands to be executed
● Data: this is for measurements and records to be viewed, which are not settable

Note:
Sometimes the term "Setting" is used generically to describe all of the three types.

The table below, provides an example of the menu structure:


SYSTEM DATA (Col 00) VIEW RECORDS (Col 01) MEASUREMENTS 1 (Col 02) …
Language (Row 01) "Select Event [0...n]" (Row 01) IA Magnitude (Row 01) …
Password (Row 02) Menu Cell Ref (Row 02) IA Phase Angle (Row 02) …
Sys Fn Links (Row 03) Time & Date (Row 03) IB Magnitude (Row 03) …
… … … …

78 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

It is convenient to specify all the settings in a single column, detailing the complete Courier address for each
setting. The above table may therefore be represented as follows:
Setting Column Row Description
SYSTEM DATA 00 00 First Column definition
Language (Row 01) 00 01 First setting within first column
Password (Row 02) 00 02 Second setting within first column
Sys Fn Links (Row 03) 00 03 Third setting within first column
… … …
VIEW RECORDS 01 00 Second Column definition
Select Event [0...n] 01 01 First setting within second column
Menu Cell Ref 01 02 Second setting within second column
Time & Date 01 03 Third setting within second column
… … …
MEASUREMENTS 1 02 00 Third Column definition
IA Magnitude 02 01 First setting within third column
IA Phase Angle 02 02 Second setting within third column
IB Magnitude 02 03 Third setting within third column
… … …

The first three column headers are common throughout much of the product ranges. However the rows within
each of these column headers may differ according to the product type. Many of the column headers are the
same for all products within the series. However, there is no guarantee that the addresses will be the same for a
particular column header. Therefore you should always refer to the product settings documentation and not make
any assumptions.

3.8 CHANGING THE SETTINGS


1. Starting at the default display, press the Down cursor key to show the first column heading.
2. Use the horizontal cursor keys to select the required column heading.
3. Use the vertical cursor keys to view the setting data in the column.
4. To return to the column header, either press the Up cursor key for a second or so, or press the Clear key
once. It is only possible to move across columns at the column heading level.
5. To return to the default display, press the Up cursor key or the Clear key from any of the column headings. If
you use the auto-repeat function of the Up cursor key, you cannot go straight to the default display from
one of the column cells because the auto-repeat stops at the column heading.
6. To change the value of a setting, go to the relevant cell in the menu, then press the Enter key to change the
cell value. A flashing cursor on the LCD shows that the value can be changed. You may be prompted for a
password first.
7. To change the setting value, press the Up and Down cursor keys. If the setting to be changed is a binary
value or a text string, select the required bit or character to be changed using the horizontal cursor keys.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 79
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

8. Press the Enter key to confirm the new setting value or the Clear key to discard it. The new setting is
automatically discarded if it is not confirmed within 15 seconds.
9. For protection group settings and disturbance recorder settings, the changes must be confirmed before
they are used. When all required changes have been entered, return to the column heading level and press
the Down cursor key. Before returning to the default display, the following prompt appears.

Update settings?
ENTER or CLEAR

10. Press the Enter key to accept the new settings or press the Clear key to discard the new settings.

Note:
For the protection group and disturbance recorder settings, if the menu time-out occurs before the changes have been
confirmed, the setting values are discarded. Control and support settings, howeverr, are updated immediately after they are
entered, without the Update settings? prompt.

3.9 DIRECT ACCESS (THE HOTKEY MENU)


For settings and commands that need to be executed quickly or on a regular basis, the IED provides a pair of keys
directly below the LCD display. These so called Hotkeys can be used to execute specified settings and commands
directly.
The functions available for direct access using these keys are:
● Setting group selection
● Control inputs
● Circuit Breaker (CB) control functions

The availability of these functions is controlled by the Direct Access cell in the CONFIGURATION column. There are
four options: Disabled, Enabled, CB Ctrl only and Hotkey only.
For the Setting Group selection and Control inputs, this cell must be set to either Enabled or Hotkey only. For
CB Control functions, the cell must be set to Enabled or CB Ctrl only.

3.9.1 SETTING GROUP SELECTION USING HOTKEYS


In some models you can use the hotkey menu to select the settings group. By default, only Setting group 1 is
enabled. Other setting groups will only be available if they are first enabled. To be able to select a different setting
group, you must first enable them in the CONFIGURATION column.
To access the hotkey menu from the default display, you press the key directly below the HOTKEY text on the LCD.
The following screen will appear.

¬User32 STG GP®


HOTKEY MENU
EXIT

Use the right cursor keys to enter the SETTING GROUP menu.

¬Menu User01®
SETTING GROUP 1
Nxt Grp Select

80 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

Select the setting group with Nxt Grp and confirm by pressing Select. If neither of the cursor keys is pressed within
20 seconds of entering a hotkey sub menu, the device reverts to the default display.

3.9.2 CONTROL INPUTS


The control inputs are user-assignable functions. You can use the CTRL I/P CONFIG column to configure the control
inputs for the hotkey menu. In order to do this, use the first setting Hotkey Enabled cell to enable or disable any of
the 32 control inputs. You can then set each control input to latched or pulsed and set its command to On/Off,
Set/Reset, In/Out, or Enabled/Disabled.
By default, the hotkey is enabled for all 32 control inputs and they are set to Set/Reset and are Latched.
To access the hotkey menu from the default display, you press the key directly below the HOTKEY text on the LCD.
The following screen will appear.

¬User32 STG GP®


HOTKEY MENU
EXIT

Press the right cursor key twice to get to the first control input, or the left cursor key to get to the last control input.

¬STP GP User02®
Control Input 1
EXIT SET

Now you can execute the chosen function (Set/Reset in this case).
If neither of the cursor keys is pressed within 20 seconds of entering a hotkey sub menu, the device reverts to the
default display.

3.9.3 CIRCUIT BREAKER CONTROL


You can open and close the controlled circuit breaker with the hotkey to the right, if enabled as described above.
By default, hotkey access to the circuit breakers is disabled.
If hotkeyaccess to the circuit breakers has been enabled, the bottom right hand part of the display will read "Open
or Close" depending on whether the circuit breaker is closed or open respectively:
For example:

Plant Reference
MiCOM
HOTKEY CLOSE

To close the circuit breaker (in this case), press the key directly below CLOSE. You will be given an option to cancel
or confirm.

Execute
CB CLOSE
Cancel Confirm

More detailed information on this can be found in the Monitoring and Control chapter.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 81
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

3.10 FUNCTION KEYS


Most products have a number of function keys for programming control functionality using the programmable
scheme logic (PSL).
Each function key has an associated programmable tri-colour LED that can be programmed to give the desired
indication on function key activation.
These function keys can be used to trigger any function that they are connected to as part of the PSL. The function
key commands are in the FUNCTION KEYS column.
The first cell down in the FUNCTION KEYS column is the Fn Key Status cell. This contains a binary string, which
represents the function key commands. Their status can be read from this binary string.

FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key Status
0000000000

The next cell down (Fn Key 1) allows you to activate or disable the first function key (1). The Lock setting allows a
function key to be locked. This allows function keys that are set to Toggled mode and their DDB signal active
‘high’, to be locked in their active state, preventing any further key presses from deactivating the associated
function. Locking a function key that is set to the Normal mode causes the associated DDB signals to be
permanently off. This safety feature prevents any inadvertent function key presses from activating or deactivating
critical functions.

FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1
Unlocked

The next cell down (Fn Key 1 Mode) allows you to set the function key to Normal or Toggled. In the Toggle mode
the function key DDB signal output stays in the set state until a reset command is given, by activating the function
key on the next key press. In the Normal mode, the function key DDB signal stays energised for as long as the
function key is pressed then resets automatically. If required, a minimum pulse width can be programmed by
adding a minimum pulse timer to the function key DDB output signal.

FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1 Mode
Toggled

The next cell down (Fn Key 1 Label) allows you to change the label assigned to the function. The default label is
Function key 1 in this case. To change the label you need to press the enter key and then change the text on
the bottom line, character by character. This text is displayed when a function key is accessed in the function key
menu, or it can be displayed in the PSL.

FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1 Label
Function Key 1

Subsequent cells allow you to carry out the same procedure as above for the other function keys.
The status of the function keys is stored in non-volatile memory. If the auxiliary supply is interrupted, the status of
all the function keys is restored. The IED only recognises a single function key press at a time and a minimum key

82 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

press duration of approximately 200 ms is required before the key press is recognised. This feature avoids
accidental double presses.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 83
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

4 LINE PARAMETERS
This product requires information about the circuit to which it is applied. This includes line impedance, residual
compensation, and phase rotation sequence. For this reason circuit parameter information must be input using
the LINE PARAMETERS settings. These LINE PARAMETERS settings are used by protection elements as well as by the
fault locator.

4.1 TRIPPING MODE


The Tripping Mode setting selects whether the product should trip single-phase or three-phase when
instantaneous protection elements detect single-phase faults.
Selecting 1 and 3 Pole means that the product will only trip the affected phase for a single-phase fault. For
faults involving more than one phase the product will always trip all three phases.
Selecting 3 Pole means that the product will always trip all three phases.
For products controlling more than one circuit breaker, the tripping mode is independent for each circuit breaker.
The product features an autorecloser that can be used for single-phase autoreclose. In that case, if a single-phase
fault evolves into a multi-phase fault during the autoreclose cycle, the product will switch to three-phase tripping.

84 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

4.1.1 CB TRIP CONVERSION LOGIC DIAGRAM


530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
523
Q CB1 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
524
Q CB1 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
525
Q CB1 Trip OutputC
R
CB1Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
526
Q CB1 Trip 3ph
858 R
AR Force CB1 3P 1
533
Force 3PTrip CB1
529
CB1 Trip I/P 3Ph

530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
1601
Q CB2 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
1602
Q CB2 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
1603
Q CB2 Trip OutputC
R
CB2Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
1600
Q CB2 Trip 3ph
1485 R
AR Force CB2 3P 1
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604

1608
CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph
Dwell
522
1 Any Trip
530 100 ms
Trip Inputs A
531
Trip Inputs B
≥ S
Trip Inputs C 532 2 Q 527
2/3 Ph Fault
R
892
Pole Dead A &
1 S
528
Q 3 Ph Fault
R

893
& 1
Pole Dead B 1

&
894 1
Pole Dead C
&
V03387

Figure 30: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63)

4.2 RESIDUAL COMPENSATION


To improve accuracy of impedance measuring elements such as those used in distance protection and fault
locators, the total loop impedance calculation ZLP/IA can be calibrated by the positive sequence impedance
between the relaying point and the fault (ZF1) using the following equation:

VA
ZF1 =
I A + k ZN ⋅ I N
where:
● VA is the phase A voltage
● IA is the phase A current
● IN is the residual current, derived from the phase currents by the equation:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 85
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

I N = I A + I B + IC

● kZN is the residual compensation coefficient given by the complex equation:

Z L 0 − Z L1
k ZN =
3Z L1
where:
● ZL0 is the total zero sequence impedance of the line (a complex value)
● ZL1 is the total positive sequence impedance of the protected line (a complex value)

The complex residual compensation coefficient is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp (the absolute value) and
kZN Res Angle (the angle in degrees).

Caution:
The kZN Res Angle is different to that in LFZP, SHNB, and LFZR products: If importing
settings from these products, you must subtract angle ÐZL1

4.3 MUTUAL COMPENSATION


On parallel circuits, mutual flux coupling can alter the impedance seen by fault locators and distance zones. A
current input (the Mutual Compensation input) is provided to compensate.
If you want to use Mutual Compensation, the connection polarity must match that shown in the connection
diagram and the element must be Enabled in the settings.
Consider for example an A-phase to earth fault on one circuit of a parallel circuit. The positive sequence
impedance between the relaying point and the fault can be calculated using the following equation:

VA
Z F1 =
I A + kZN ⋅ I N + k Zm ⋅ I M

where:
● VA is the phase A voltage
● IA is the phase A current
● IN is the residual current of the protected line (derived from phase currents)
● IM is the residual current of the parallel line (measured)
● kZN is the residual compensation coefficient
● kZm is the mutual compensation coefficient

In the above equation:

I N = I A + I B + IC

Z L 0 − Z L1
k ZN =
3Z L1

Zm0
k Zm =
3Z L1

86 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

where:
● ZL0 is the total zero sequence impedance of the line (a complex value)
● ZL1 is the total positive sequence impedance of the protected line (complex value)
● Zm0 is the zero sequence mutual impedance between the two circuits (complex value).

If used, you must set the mutual compensation feature kZm using the settings:
● kZm Mutual Set (the absolute value) and
● kZm Mutual Angle (the angle in degrees).

Note:
The following paragraph applies only to distance products and so may not be applicable to your model

In applications where the Mutual Compensation is used to reduce errors in the distance elements, a third setting,
Mutual Cut Off, is used for a fast dynamic control. The ratio IM/IN is compared with the Mutual Cut Off setting. If
the ratio is higher, mutual compensation is suppressed to prevent false-tripping for faults on the parallel line.
Typically a Mutual Cut Off factor of 1.5 is chosen to give a good margin of safety between the requirements of
correct mutual compensation for faults on the protected circuit whilst avoiding maloperations for faults on the
parallel circuit.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 87
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

5 DATE AND TIME CONFIGURATION


The date and time setting will normally be updated automatically by the chosen UTC (Universal Time Co-
ordination) time synchronisation mechanism when the device is in service. You can also set the date and time
manually using the Date/Time cell in the DATE AND TIME column.

5.1 USING AN SNTP SIGNAL


When using SNTP to maintain the clock, the IED must first be connected to the SNTP server, which should be
energized and functioning.
1. In the DATE AND TIME column, check that either the Primary Source or Secondary Source setting is set to
SNTP.
2. Ensure that the IED is receiving valid time synchronisation messages by checking that the SNTP Status cell
reads Server 1 OK or Server 2 OK.
3. Check that the Act. Time Source cell reads SNTP. This indicates that the IED is using PTP as the source for
its time. Note that If IRIG-B or PTP have been selected as the Primary Source, these must first be
disconnected before the device can switch to SNTP as the active source.
4. Once the IED is using SNTP as the active time source, adjust the time offset of the universal coordinated
time on the SNTP Server equipment, so that local time is displayed.
5. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell.

5.2 USING AN IRIG-B SIGNAL


When using IRIG-B to maintain the clock, the IED must first be connected to the timing source equipment (usually a
P594), which should be energized and functioning.
1. In the DATE AND TIME column, check that either the Primary Source or Secondary Source setting is set to
IRIG-B.
2. Ensure the IED is receiving the IRIG-B signal by checking that IRIG-B Status cell reads Active
3. Check that the Act. Time Source cell reads IRIG-B. This indicates that the IED is using IRIG-B as the
source for its time. Note that If SNTP or PTP have been selected as the Primary Source, these must first be
disconnected before the device can switch to IRIG-B as the active source.
4. Once the IED is using IRIG-B as the active time source, adjust the time offset of the universal coordinated
time (satellite clock time) on the satellite clock equipment, so that local time is displayed.
5. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell. The IRIG-B signal does not contain
the current year so this also needs to be set manually in this cell.
6. If the auxiliary supply fails, the time and date are maintained by the auxiliary battery. Therefore, when the
auxiliary supply is restored, you should not have to set the time and date again. To test this, remove the
IRIG-B signal, and then remove the auxiliary supply. Leave the device de-energized for approximately 30
seconds. On re-energization, the time should be correct.
7. Reconnect the IRIG-B signal.

5.3 USING AN IEEE 1588 PTP SIGNAL


When using IEEE 1588 PTP to maintain the clock, the IED must first be connected to the PTP Grandmaster, which
should be energized and functioning.
1. In the DATE AND TIME column, check that either the Primary Source or Secondary Source setting is set to
PTP.
2. Set the Domain Number setting. The domain defines which clocks the IED will use for synchronisation.
Therefore this number must match the domain used by the other clocks on the network.

88 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

3. Ensure that the IED is receiving valid time synchronisation messages by checking that the PTP Status cell
reads Valid Master.
4. Check that Act. Time Source cell reads PTP. This indicates that the IED is using PTP as the source for its
time. Note that If IRIG-B or SNTP have been selected as the Primary Source, these must first be
disconnected before the device can switch to PTP as the active source.
5. Once the IED is using PTP as the active time source, adjust the time offset of the universal coordinated time
on the Master Clock equipment, so that local time is displayed.
6. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell.

5.4 WITHOUT A TIMING SOURCE SIGNAL


If the time and date is not being maintained by an IRIG-B, PTP or SNTP signal, in the DATE AND TIME column, ensure
that both the Primary Source and Secondary Source are set to NONE.
1. Check that Act. Time Source cell reads Free Running.
2. Set the date and time to the correct local time and date using the Date/Time cell or the serial protocol.
3. If the auxiliary supply fails, the time and date are maintained by the auxiliary battery. Therefore, when the
auxiliary supply is restored, you should not have to set the time and date again. To test this, remove the
auxiliary supply. Leave the device de-energized for approximately 30 seconds. On re-energization, the time
should be correct.

5.5 TIME ZONE COMPENSATION


The UTC time standard uses Greenwich Mean Time as its standard. Without compensation, the date and time
would be displayed on the device irrespective of its location.
You may wish to display the local time corresponding to its geographical location. You can do this with the settings
LocalTime Enable and LocalTime Offset.
The LocalTime Enable has three setting options; Disabled, Fixed, and Flexible.
With Disabled, no local time zone is maintained. Time synchronisation from any interface will be used to directly
set the master clock. All times displayed on all interfaces will be based on the master clock with no adjustment.
With Fixed, a local time zone adjustment is defined using the LocalTime Offset setting and all non-IEC 61850
interfaces, which uses the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), are compensated to display the local time.
With Flexible, a local time zone adjustment is defined using the LocalTime Offset setting. The non-local and
non-IEC 61850 interfaces can be set to either the UTC zone or the local time zone. The local interfaces are always
set to the local time zone and the Ethernet interface is always set to the UTC zone.
The interfaces where you can select between UTC and Local Time are the serial interfaces RP1, RP2, DNP over
Ethernet (if applicable) and Tunnelled Courier (if applicable). This is achieved by means of the following settings,
each of which can be set to UTC or Local.:
● RP1 Time Zone
● RP2 Time Zone
● DNPOE Time Zone
● Tunnel Time Zone

The LocalTime Offset setting allows you to enter the local time zone compensation from -12 to + 12 hours at 15
minute intervals.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 89
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

5.6 DAYLIGHT SAVING TIME COMPENSATION


It is possible to compensate for Daylight Saving time using the following settings
● DST Enable
● DST Offset
● DST Start
● DST Start Day
● DST Start Month
● DST Start Mins
● DST End
● DST End Day
● DST End Month
● DST End Mins

These settings are described in the DATE AND TIME settings table in the configuration chapter.

90 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration

6 SETTINGS GROUP SELECTION


You can select the setting group using opto inputs, a menu selection, and for some models the hotkey menu or
function keys. You choose which method using the Setting Group setting in the CONFIGURATION column. There are
two possibilities; Select via Menu, or Select via PSL. If you choose Select via Menu, you set the settings group using
the Active Settings setting or with the hotkeys. If you choose Select via PSL , you set the settings group with DDB
signals according to the following table:

SG Select 1X SG Select X1 Selected Setting Group


0 0 1
0 1 2
1 0 3
1 1 4

Each setting group has its own PSL. Once a PSL configuration has been designed it can be allocated to any one of
the 4 setting groups. When downloading or extracting a PSL configuration, you will be prompted to enter the
required setting group to which it will allocated.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 91
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV

92 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 6

SAMPLED VALUE OPERATION


Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

94 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 95
Introduction To Sampled Values 96
Data Resampling 97
Sampled Value Alignment 98

P446SV-TM-EN-1 95
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION TO SAMPLED VALUES


IEC 61850 Sampled Value specifications such as IEC 61850-9-2LE or IEC 61850-9-9, define Process Bus
communications between the different components of the substation automation system. IEDs with compatible
interfaces can communicate with the Process Bus and receive sampled value data from Merging Units. Analog
Merging Units digitize analog values from conventional CTs and VTs, replacing analog inputs. This simplifies the
installation by replacing the analog measurement wiring with the Process Bus Local Area Network. Using a fibre
optic network instead of heavy copper cables between the measuring device and the IED provides safer and more
economical cross-site cabling. It also allows IEDs to receive current and voltage sampled data through Digital
Merging Units from Low Power Instrument Transformers such as optical and Rogowski devices.
IEDs, which accept digital sampled values rather than analog signals have no need for expensive and heavy on-
board scaling CTs and VTs, making them smaller, lighter, safer and cheaper. An SV IED with the same size case as a
conventional IED would have more room for digital I/O, because valuable space is not taken up by the on-board
CTs and VTs.
The following figure shows the difference between a conventional IED with analog inputs and a Sampled Values
IED with digital inputs:

Conventional IED
IA Fast
Direct
IB protection
CT Inputs comparison
IC algorithms
IN A/D Sampled
Scaling Values
VA Conversion
VB Standard
VT Inputs Filtering and
VC protection
Processing
VN algorithms

Conventional Protection IED

SV IED
IA
IB
IC
IN Analog Sampled Values IEC 61850
Merging Unit (in IEC61850 Ethernet frames) SV Processing
VA
Interface
VB
VC
VN

IEC61850 Sampled Value Protection System V03700

Figure 31: Comparison of Conventional IED and Sampled Values IED

96 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation

3 DATA RESAMPLING
An IEC 61850-9-2LE SV interface receives 80 Sampled Values per cycle from the Process Bus. This is the same for
both 50 and 60 Hz. The SV interface then resamples these Sampled Values to make the data appear the same to
the IED as analogue signals would do on its normal inputs from CTs and VTs. The resampling frequency depends
on the device.
The IEC 61850-9-2LE interface also tracks the supply frequency. This is because the Sampled Values from the
Process Bus are fixed at 4000 samples/sec for 50 Hz and 4800 samples/sec at 60 Hz.

SV IED
IA
IB
IC
Analog Sampled Values IEC 61850
IN Resampling
Merging Unit (80 samples per cycle) SV CPU
VA
Interface
VB
VC
VN

Process Bus
V03701

Figure 32: Data sampling using an IEC 61850-9-2LE interface

P446SV-TM-EN-1 97
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

4 SAMPLED VALUE ALIGNMENT


Sampled Value frames from different Merging Units on the Process Bus may not arrive at the same time at the IED.
The transmission delay depends on the background Ethernet traffic and how many switches are used in the
Process Bus network.
Transmission delays do not usually matter for functions such as three-phase overcurrent protection where current
signals are all received in a single frame. However, a function such as distance protection uses voltage and current
signals which may be from different merging units with different transmission delays. The SV interface
synchronises the voltage and current samples that are sent to the IED’s distance protection function. The IED then
uses the Merge Unit Delay setting, which is set to the maximum expected delay between the first and last
Sampled Value.
The following examples show how you would need to set the delay.
● If the IED receives one Logical Node only, no delay is needed so set the merging unit delay to 0 ms.
● If the IED receives several Logical Nodes at the same time, no delay is needed so set the merging unit delay
to 0 ms.
● If the IED receives several Logical Nodes but not at the same time, set the merging unit delay to an
appropriate non-zero value.
If all the Logical Nodes configured in the IED are not received during the merging unit delay time, an alarm is
raised.
To set the merging unit delay during commissioning, set MUs Delay Search to Yes. The IED then monitors the
Sampled Value frames received for the next two seconds and displays the maximum delay between identical
samples.

4.1 CHANNEL MAPPINGS FOR SAV TEST, SAV QUESTIONABLE, SAV INVALID
These signals correspond to the analogue channels in a conventional MiCOM IED. The channel name appears on
the IED display against each bit.

P446, P546, P841B


0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
VA VB VC VSC1 IA1 IB1 IC1 IM INSEN IA2 IB2 IC2 VSC2

4.2 DATA QUALITY


Any degradation in the measurement or transmission of Sampled Values means that the protection function of the
IED may not operate correctly. Data frames from a typical Logical Node have quality flags assigned to each of the
channels. The device adapts the behaviour of protection functions according to these quality flags. The available
quality flags are Good, Invalid and Questionable. A Test flag is also available for test purposes.
A protection function operates normally when all the necessary Sampled Value inputs are available and have a
Good Quality flag. When the flag for one or more of the Sampled Value inputs changes to Invalid, the protection
function is inhibited. When the flag for one or more of the Sampled Value inputs changes to Questionable, the
protection function can either be inhibited or not, depending on the chosen options in the Trus Ques Data setting.
The options are:
● Bit 0:Out of Range
● Bit 1:Bad Reference
● Bit 2:Oscillatory
● Bit 3:Old Data
● Bit 4:Inconsistent
● Bit 5:Inaccurate

98 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation

The protection function will be trusted and NOT inhibited for questionable data for the items above which have
been set.
The protection function returns to the Normal state when the quality flags for all the necessary Sampled Value
inputs are Good. The quality flags can change with each sample, therefore there is a one-cycle transition delay
between the Normal and Inhibit states for each protection function.

4.2.1 IMPACT OF DATA QUALITY ON PROTECTION FUNCTIONS


The following table shows how Sampled Value errors affect protection functions in the IED.
For example, overcurrent protection can be configured as directional, in which case the voltage inputs have an
impact on the function. The quality of the voltage input is not important if the overcurrent is non-directional.
X means the SV input affects the Normal and Inhibit states of the protection function.
# means the protection function is affected where configured to work with this input.
$ means that frequency protection operates if any one current or voltage phase is good quality.
[IA1 IB1 IC1] [IA2 IB2 IC2] [VA VB VC] VSC1 VSC2 IN SEN IM
Differential
X # #
Protection
Distance
X # X
Protection
Directional
X # X
Earth Fault
Overcurrent
X # #
Protection
Negative
X # #
Sequence
Broken
X #
Conductor
Earth Fault
X # #
Protection
REF
X
Protection
SEF
X
Protection
Residual
X
Overvoltage
Voltage
X
Protection
Frequency
$ $ $
Protection

4.3 PROCESS BUS PERFORMANCE


Ethernet networks sometimes lose frames, so the IED tolerates some loss of samples to ensure availability of its
protection functions. The IED calculates a Frame Loss Rate every cycle for each Merging Unit (Logical Node) with
which it communicates. If the Frame Loss Rate is less than the Loss Rate Level setting (set in %), the IED tolerates
network losses of up to three consecutive samples. If the Frame Loss Rate is greater than the Loss Rate Level
setting (set in %), the protection functions are temporarily inhibited.
The IED display shows information about Sampled Value losses on the Process Bus for each Logical Node
associated with the IED in the following cells in the IEC61850-9.2LE column. This is useful during testing or
commissioning to identify and resolve any network problems which could degrade the protection scheme.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 99
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

The following data is provided:


LNx LossRate Sec: This is the percentage of SV frames missing during the past second for LNx.
LNx FrmLoss Cuml: This is the number of frames lost since the last reset. The most recent reset time is listed in the
IED menu.
LNx Error Second: The Frame Error Seconds is a cumulative value since the last reset. If the Frame Loss Rate
exceeds 1.25% (one sample per cycle on average for one second), the IED records this as an Error Second.
where x is the number of the node (e.g. LN1)
The Sampled Value loss data can be reset manually with the LossRate Reset command in the IEC61850-9.2LE
column.

4.3.1 SAMPLE LOSS DATA


The Sampled Value loss data can be reset manually. The following data is provided:
LNx LossRate Sec: This is the percentage of SV frames missing during the past second for LNx.
LNx FrmLoss Cuml: This is the number of frames lost since the last reset. The most recent reset time is listed in the
IED menu.
LNx Error Second: The Frame Error Seconds is a cumulative value since the last reset. If the Frame Loss Rate
exceeds 1.25% (one sample per cycle on average for one second), the IED records this as an Error Second.
where x is the number of the node (e.g. LN1)

4.4 VT SWITCHING
This function is used in the P442, P444, P446, P546 and P841B IEDs which have an IEC 61850-9-2LE interface. It
allows the user to switch the three-phase voltage input between two independent Sampled Value frames while the
IED is in service. This may correspond to two separate voltage transformers in the primary system. The VT Switch
function also allows the single-phase check synchronising voltages to be selected from three independent
Sampled Value frames.
The VT switching function is disabled by default. To enabled it, in the IED menu IEC 61850-9-2LE, select VT Switch
Mode then Enabled.

Three-Phase Voltage Input Switching


The three-phase voltage can be switched between two Sampled Value frames. These are [VA1 VB1 VC1] and [VA2
VB2 VC2]. The switching is controlled by the status of the DDB VABC Select x. The logic is shown in the following
table.
DDB
VABC Select x VA VB VC Selection
0 VA1 VB1 VC1
1 VA2 VB2 VC2
The change of VT input is accepted only if the DDB status change is effective for a minimum of 20 ms. The selected
three-phase voltage is only displayed when VT Switch Mode is enabled.

Single-Phase Voltage Input Switching


There are two single-phase voltages associated with the System Check function. These are Vsc1 and Vsc2. The
selection of voltage Vsc1 is controlled by the combined status of two DDBs, Vsc1 Select x1 and Vsc1 Select 1x as
shown in the following table.
DDB DDB
Vsc1 Select x1 Vsc1 Select 1x Vsc1 Selection
0 0 Vcs1

100 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation

DDB DDB
Vsc1 Select x1 Vsc1 Select 1x Vsc1 Selection
0 1 Vcs2
1 0 Vcs3
1 1 Unused
The selection of voltage Vsc2 is controlled by the combined status of two DDBs, Vsc2 Select x1 and Vsc2 Select 1x
as shown in the following table.
DDB DDB
Vsc2 Select x1 Vsc2 Select 1x Vsc2 Selection
0 0 Vcs2
0 1 Vcs3
1 0 Vcs1
1 1 Unused
The selected single-phase voltages are only displayed when VT Switch Mode is enabled.

4.5 VIRTUAL INPUTS AND OUTPUTS


Sampled Value IEDs have additional virtual inputs and virtual outputs. These are mapped as new DDBs in the IED’s
PSL and are used as triggers for GOOSE messages to and from the IED. The GOOSE Control Blocks can be
configured using the IEC 61850 Configurator software tool, which is part of the Settings Application Software.
The additional inputs and outputs make it easier to apply the IEDs in full Digital Substations where switchgear
status, controls and commands are exchanged as GOOSE messages between the IEDs and Merging Units.

4.5.1 P446, P546, P841B VIRTUAL INPUTS AND OUTPUTS DDBS

Ordinal Signal Name Source Type Response


Description
1792 to 1823 GOOSEIN_33-64 Software GOOSEIN Protection Event
Virtual Input received from GOOSE message.
1888 to 1919 GOOSEOUT_33-64 PSL GOOSEOUT Protection Event
Virtual outputs. These allow you to control binary signals which can be mapped using the SCADA protocol output to other devices.

4.5.2 VIRTUAL CT AND VT RATIO SETTINGS


The Sampled Value frames are primary measurements. These come from Merging Units (MU) connected to
conventional CTs and VTs or Non-Conventional Instrument Transformers (NCITs). Alternatively they may come
directly from NCITs. The IED algorithms are typically based on secondary values. If primary values are needed, they
are calculated by the IED based on set CT or VT ratios.
The amplitudes for 1A CT inputs are limited to 64 A secondary. The amplitudes for 5A CT inputs are limited to 320 A
secondary. The VT secondary is limited to 200 V phase-to-earth. Therefore it is necessary to set appropriate CT and
VT ratios for the protection functions to operate correctly. The instrument transformer ratios are set in the IED
menu CT AND VT RATIOS, which is common to both conventional and Sampled Value IEDs.

Measurement from a Merging Unit connected to a CT


As this has a real CT ratio, set the real primary CT ratio.

Direct measurement from an NCIT


There is no physical CT ratio. Set the CT ratio high enough so the maximum primary current (maximum fault level)
when converted to secondary is not clamped.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 101
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

For example if the maximum primary current is 50 kA:


● If the CT ratio is set to 1000:1 the converted secondary current is up to 50 A. This is less than 64 A so is
acceptable.
● If the CT ratio is set to 500:1 the converted secondary current is up to 100 A. This is above 64 A so is not
acceptable.

4.6 IED ALARMS


Sampled Value IEDs have additional alarms.

9-2 Configuration Alarm (9-2 Sample Alarm)


This alarm is raised if analogue channels in the IED are assigned incorrectly (Illegal Channel Map). For example, if
you assign two current inputs to the same Logical Node.

Sampled Value quality alarm (9-2LE Cfg Alarm)


This alarm is raised if any of the following conditions exist:
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames received are not synchronised as required by the IED
configuration.
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames expected are not received.
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames received are of Invalid quality.
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames received are of Questionable quality and the IED is configured not
to accept such Sampled Value frames.
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames received has a test flag, and the IED is configured to inhibit
protection functions when receiving frames with a test flag.
● One or more of the Sampled Value frames received does not have a test flag, and the IED is configured to
receive only frames with a test flag.
● Sampled Values received have a nominal frequency different to that set in the IED.
● The secondary current or voltage exceeds the acceptable limit.

4.6.1 P446, P546, P841B ALARMS

Sampled Value global synchronisation alarm (GLOBALAV_SYN_FAIL)


This alarm is raised if the global synchronisation for Sampled Values has failed, inhibiting the current differential
function.

Inverse settings alarm (ALARM_INV_SETTING_SAV)


This alarm is raised if Phase Diff is set to Enabled but GPS Sync is set to GPS disabled.

4.6.1.1 ALARM SIGNAL SETTINGS


MENU TEXT Col Row Default Setting Available Setting
Description
Process Bus Alarm 18 45 Self Reset Self-Reset, Alarm Latched
This alarm shows there is an error on the Process Bus.
SAV Absence 18 51 00000000
This is a data cell with 8 binary flags. It shows the presence or absence of Sampled Values from each of the Merging Units the
IED is communicating with. There is a maximum of 8 Logical Nodes. The cell data for each Logical Node is continuously
refreshed.
0: No Sampled Values being received from the Merging Unit.
1: Sampled Values being received from the Merging Unit.

102 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation

MENU TEXT Col Row Default Setting Available Setting


Description
SAV No SmpSynch 18 52 00000000
This is a data cell with 8 binary flags. It indicates the healthiness of the Sampled Values being received from each of the
configured Merging Units.
0: Sampled Values received are synchronised and any loss of samples is within acceptable limits.
1: Sampled Values received are not synchronised (Setting :Synchro Alarm) or the Sampled Value delay exceeds the acceptable
value (Merging Unit Delay setting). The IED raises a 9-2 Sample Alarm when any one of the binary flags is 1.
00000000 00000000
SAV Questionable 18 54
00000000
This is a data cell with 24 binary flags. It indicates the status of the IEC 61850 Quality attribute ‘Questionable’ in the Sampled
Value frames for each of the analogue channels. The channel assignment depends on the IED.
00000000 00000000
SAV Invalid 18 55
00000000
This is a data cell with 24 binary flags. It indicates the status of the IEC 61850 Quality attribute ‘Invalid’ in the Sampled Value
frames for each of the analogue channels. The channel assignment depends on the IED.

4.6.1.2 ALARM SIGNALS DDB TABLE


Ordinal Signal Name Source Type Response
Description
340 ALARM_9_2_SAV Software PFSO Self reset alarm
Sampled Value error.
Alarm latched with protection
341 GLOBAL_SYN_FAIL Software PFSO
function
This alarm is raised if the global synchronisation for Sampled Values has failed, inhibiting the current differential function.
342 9_2_SAV_CFG_ALARM Software PFSO Self reset alarm
This alarm is triggered when the LN name is less than 10 characters or greater than 34 characters.
343 ALARM_INV_SETTING_SAV Software PFSO Self reset alarm
This alarm is raised if Phase Diff is set to Enabled but GPS Sync is set to GPS disabled.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 103
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV

104 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 7

DISTANCE PROTECTION
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

106 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter introduces the principles and theory behind the protection and describes how it is implemented in this
product. Guidance for applying this protection is also provided.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 107
Introduction 108
Distance Measuring Zones Operating Principles 110
Phase and Earth Fault Distance Protection Implementation 139
Delta Directional Element 147
Application Notes 150

P446SV-TM-EN-1 107
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION
Amongst protection engineers, the basic principles of Distance Protection are widely documented and understood.
If you are reading this chapter, we assume that you are familiar with the principles of distance protection and
associated components such as Aided Schemes. However, to help you choose suitable settings, some of the
principles of operation of the Distance Measuring Zones is included in this chapter.

2.1 DISTANCE PROTECTION PRINCIPLE


The principle behind Distance protection is based on using measured values of voltage and current to calculate
impedance seen from a relaying point. If the impedance calculated is an unexpected value, this may indicate a
fault.
The impedance of a transmission line is proportional to its length. If voltage and current signals are available at a
relaying point, they can be used to calculate the impedance value seen from the relaying point. Impedance values
looking forward into the line, as well as values looking in the reverse direction behind the relaying point can be
calculated. The calculated impedance is compared with so called 'Reach Points'. Reach Points are impedance
values, which are used to define zones of protection. The device contains settings by which you can configure
these Reach Points. The zones are usually numbered (for example: Zone 1, Zone 2, Zone 3). By comparing the
calculated impedance with the zone reach points, the device can determine whether a fault is present and if
necessary, trip the associated circuit breakers.

2.2 PERFORMANCE INFLUENCING FACTORS


As well as the accuracy of the signals presented by the input transducers, an important factor that influences the
performance of distance protection is the relationship between the source and line impedance. This is the System
Impedance Ratio (SIR), and is defined by ZS/ZL.
The following figure represents a fault condition on an electrical power system, and can be used to demonstrate
the relationship.

R
Source Line

VS IR VL=VR
ZL
V VR

V02753

Figure 33: System Impedance Ratio

The voltage V applied to the impedance loop is the open circuit voltage of the power system. Point R represents the
protection location; IR and VR are the current and voltage measured by the relay, respectively.
The impedances Zs and ZL are described as source and line impedances because of their position with respect to
the protection location. Source impedance Zs is a measure of the fault level at the relaying point. For faults
involving earth it is dependent on the method of system earthing behind the relaying point. Line impedance ZL is a
measure of the impedance of the protected section. The voltage VR applied to the relay is, therefore, IRZL. For a
fault at the reach point, this may be expressed in terms of the System Impedeance Ratio, using the following
expression:
VR = V/(SIR+1)
where SIR = ZS/ZL

108 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

From the equation above, it can be seen that the measured voltage has a significant impact on the decision
making process.
The ability of distance protection to measure accurately for a given reach point fault, depends on the voltage at
the relaying location being above a minimum value at the time of the fault. If the voltage is above this minimum
value, it is generally used to polarize the distance protection and indicate the direction of the fault. This is called
self-polarization.
If the voltage collapses below the minimum threshold necessary to make a sensible decision, alternative methods
of polarization to determine the direction of the fault are needed. Two methods that are applied are cross-
polarization and memory polarization. If a fault doesn’t affect all phases, the voltage signals on the healthy phases
can be used for the directional decision. This is called cross-polarization. If the fault causes all phase voltages to
collapse, a stored record of the pre-fault voltage can be used to make the directional decision. This is called
memory polarization. Memory polarization, cross-polarization, and self-polarization can sometimes be used in
combination.

2.3 IMPEDANCE CALCULATION


Careful selection of the reach settings and tripping times for the various measurement zones enables correct
coordination between Distance protection devices. Basic Distance protection will comprise instantaneous
directional Zone 1 protection and one or more time delayed zones. A basic distance protection scheme is likely to
feature 3 zones of protection, but numerical distance protection devices may have several more zones, some set
to measure in the forward direction and some set to measure in the reverse direction.
Some numerical distance protection devices measure the fault voltage and current directly then calculate the
impedance, after which they determine whether operation is required according to impedance boundaries defined
on an R/X diagram. Many numerical IEDs emulate their traditional electro-mechanical counterparts. Rather than
calculating the absolute impedance, they compare the measured fault voltage with a replica voltage derived from
the fault current and the zone impedance setting to determine whether the fault is within zone or out-of-zone.
Typically, a comparator will compare either the relative amplitude or relative phase of input quantities to
determine impedance limits. Limits may be either straight line characteristics (quadrilaterals), or circular
characteristics (Mhos).

2.4 IMPLEMENTATION WITH COMPARATORS


The distance protection in this product uses measured values of voltage and current, together with setting values
such as line impedance, to determine whether fault conditions exist. The determination as to whether a fault
condition exists is performed by so-called ‘comparators’. These comparators use voltage and current inputs in
conjunction with impedance settings to decide whether a fault is in a particular zone. Multiple zones can provide
protection for the protected line as well as providing back-up protection for connected lines.
All distance zone calculations in this product are constructed using one or more comparators. Each comparator
uses two vector quantities which are generally referenced as S1 and S2. S1 and S2 comparators are used to
construct either circular (Mho) and/or Quadrilateral characteristics. In the case of Mho characteristics, a single
comparator is used to make a tripping decision. In the case of Quadrilateral characteristics, multiple comparators
are used to make a tripping decision.

2.5 POLARIZATION OF DISTANCE CHARACTERISTICS


The distance zone characteristics are polarized (directionalized) to reflect the characteristic angle of the line. Some
of the zones of the distance protection are forward looking, some are reverse looking, and some are of the offset
type. Polarization is generally achieved by directional self-polarization, but memory-polarization, or cross-
polarization, might be adopted for close-up zero-voltage faults.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 109
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

3 DISTANCE MEASURING ZONES OPERATING PRINCIPLES


All distance zone characteristics in this product are constructed with one or more comparators. The comparators
are used to construct either Mho, or Quadrilateral characteristics. This section outlines the principles behind the
construction of the characteristics in order to provide an understanding of how best to set them.
The following table details signal definitions used to construct the measuring zone characteristics.
Name Description
I Current
I Current used by the Distance protection measuring element
IM Residual current of parallel line (mutual current)
IN Neutral Current (derived)
Iph Faulted phase current (for example IA for A-N fault)
j The complex operator
kM Mutual compensation co-efficient
kZN Residual compensation co-efficient
Distance polarizing factor. A percentage of the memory voltage polarizing signal that is added to the self-
p
polarizing voltage signal to dictate the level of Mho expansion and help establish a directional decision.
R Resistance
R Forward Resistance Reach
R’ Reverse Resistance Reach
S A voltage vector value comprising one or more voltage components
S1 A voltage vector input to a comparator
S2 A second voltage vector input to a comparator
V Voltage
V Voltage used by the Distance protection measuring element
V/I Impedance measured by the Distance protection element
Vmem Voltage memory signal used for polarization
Vph Faulted phase voltage (for example VA for A-N fault)
Vph/Iph Loop impedance measurement
VS Source voltage
X Reactance
Z Impedance Reach setting
Z’ Reverse Impedance Reach setting
Z1 Positive sequence impedance
ZLP Loop impedance
Zreplica Forward replica reach in the loop impedance plane = Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph)
Z’replica Reverse replica reach in the loop impedance plane = Z’(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph)
ZS Source impedance
σ An angle (in degrees) usually associated with the tilt of a reactive line on a Quadrilateral characteristic
Ðσ A vectorial operator that rotates a vector quantity by an angle of σº (alternative representation ejσ)

110 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Note:
The faulted phase current (I) is generally used as the reference (0º) for the vector diagrams.

3.1 MHO CHARACTERISTICS


There are different types of Mho characteristic, but two specific ones are well suited to introducing the defining
principles. These are the directional Self-polarized Mho and the Offset Mho. Both types are used for both phase
faults and earth faults.
In practice, self-polarized Mhos are rarely used since voltage collapses for close-up faults render self-polarization
unreliable. Rather, memory-polarization components and/or cross-polarization components are usually used to
provide a polarizing reference. Directional Self-Polarized Mhos, however, are simpler to understand and are used
by way of introduction.

3.1.1 DIRECTIONAL MHO CHARACTERISTIC FOR PHASE FAULTS


The following diagram illustrates how the Directional Self-Polarized Mho characteristic for phase Distance
protection is created.

V IZ

IZ

V 90°

V02710
Figure 34: Directional mho element construction

The two signals provided to the comparator are:


S1 = V
S2 = V - I.Z
Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°

3.1.2 OFFSET MHO CHARACTERISTIC FOR PHASE FAULTS


The following diagram illustrates how the Offset Mho characteristic for phase Distance protection is created:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 111
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

V IZ

IZ
90°

V
V  I  Z
I
I  Z

V02711

Figure 35: Offset Mho characteristic

The two signals provided to the comparator are:


S1 = V - IZ'
S2 = V - IZ
Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°

3.1.3 DIRECTIONAL SELF-POLARIZED MHO CHARACTERISTIC FOR EARTH FAULTS


Characteristics of earth-fault elements can be represented in two different complex planes - the positive sequence
impedance plane (Z1 -plane) and the loop impedance plane (ZLP -plane). The reach impedance setting defines the
reach in positive sequence impedance terms. The characteristic in the ZLP -plane is generally dynamic because it
depends on fault currents. However, the ZLP–plane representation is often more convenient for reference,
especially if an injection test kit is used, which cannot apply the residual compensation to the impedance plot, or in
the case that the load blinders have to be verified.
The following diagram illustrates how a directional Mho characteristic for earth-faults is created.

112 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Z1 Plane ZLP Plane

jX Z  k ZN  I N I ph
 jX
V ph I ph  Z replica

V IZ
Z Z

Z replica

90°
90°

R R
V I V ph I ph
V02712

Figure 36: Directional Mho element construction – impedance domain

The two signals provided to the comparator are:


S1 = V
S2 = V - IZ
where (for an A-N fault for example) with residual compensation applied:
V = VA
I = IA + kZN.IN
where kZN = (Z0 - Z1) / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp and KZN Res Angle.
and if mutual compensation is applied:
I = IA + kZN.IN + kZM.IM
where kZM = 3ZM / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZm Mutual Set and kZm Mutual Angle.
Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°.
To obtain a ZLP-plane representation in the directional Mho element construction, V is replaced with Vph and I is
replaced with Iph + kZN.IN, where Vph and Iph are the faulty phase voltage and current respectively (assuming no
mutual current compensation).
The two signals provided to the comparator in this case are:
S1 = Vph
S2 = Vph - Iph.Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph)
We can define a replica impedance reach, Zreplica, as:

Zreplica = Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph)
or if mutual compensation is applied:
Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 113
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Then if healthy phase currents are much less then the current of the faulty phase and the mutual compensation is
disabled:
IN @ Iph
so that
Zreplica @ Z(1 + kZN)
Thus the ZLP plane representation of the characteristic becomes static.

3.1.4 OFFSET MHO CHARACTERISTIC FOR EARTH FAULTS


The diagram below illustrates how the Offset Mho characteristic for earth-fault distance protection is created in
the impedance domain.

 jX Z1 -plane

V IZ
Z

90°
V I

V I  Z

R
Z

V02713
Figure 37: Offset Mho characteristics – impedance domain

The two signals provided to the comparator are:


S1 = V - I.Z'
S2 = V - I.Z
Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°.
The following diagram below how the Offset Mho characteristic for earth-fault distance protection translates to
the loop impedance domain.

114 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Z LP -plane

 jX Z  k ZN  I N I ph

V ph I ph  Z replica

Z Z replica
90°
h
h / Ip
Vp


Z replica R

Z


V ph I ph  Z replica
Z   k ZN  I N I ph
V02714
Figure 38: Offset mho characteristics – voltage domain

where: Zreplica is the replica forward reach and Z'replica is the replica reverse reach.
With mutual compensation applied:
Zreplica = Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph + kZM.IM/Iph)
Z'replica = Z'(1+kZN.IN/Iph + kZM.IM/Iph)
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, then the neutral current is
approximately the same as the phase current, and the terms can be simplified as follows:
Zreplica = Z(1+kZN + kZM.IM/Iph)
Z'replica = Z'(1+kZN + kZM.IM/Iph)
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, and mutual current compensation
is not applied, then these terms can be simplified as follows:
Zreplica @ Z(1+kZN)
Z'replica @ Z'(1+kZN)
So, as with the Directional Self-Polarized Mho characteristic for earth-faults, the ZLP plane representation of the
characteristic becomes static.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 115
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

3.1.5 MEMORY POLARIZATION OF MHO CHARACTERISTICS


Self-Polarized Directional Mho characteristics require sufficient polarizing voltage to detect the voltage angle.
Therefore such a characteristic is unable to operate for close-up faults where there would be insufficient polarizing
voltage. To ensure the correct Mho element response for zero-voltage faults, the protection algorithm adds a
percentage of voltage from the memory to the main polarizing voltage as a substitute phase reference.
This technique is called memory polarizing. Not only does it preserve the directional property of the Mho
characteristic, it actually enhances it by dynamically expanding or contracting the characteristic.

3.1.6 DYNAMIC MHO EXPANSION AND CONTRACTION


The signals provided to the Mho comparators for memory polarization are:
S1 = V + pVmem
S2 = V - IZ
where:
● V is the self-polarization voltage
● Vmem is the memory polarization voltage

Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°.
The memory voltage Vmem is the pre-fault voltage. Assuming the pre-fault current is close to zero at the relaying
point, he pre-fault voltage is equal to the source voltage. Therefore:
Vmem = VS

Dynamic Mho Expansion for Forward Faults


The contribution of additional polarizing input creates dynamic Mho expansion for forward faults and increases
the fault arc resistance coverage.
Referring to the diagram below:

IED
Dist
VS Bus I
Line
ZS ZF
V
V02715
Figure 39: Simplified forward fault

For a fault condition we can write the following equations:


VS = V + I.ZS

 p 
90° ≤ ∠  V I + ⋅ Z S  − ∠ ( V I − Z ) ≤ −90°
 1+ p 
The Mho expansion for a forward fault is illustrated in the following diagram:

116 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

 jX
Self-polarised

V IZ
Z

V I 90°

R
p
  ZS
1 p p
V I  ZS
1 p
V02716
Figure 40: Mho expansion – forward fault

The Mho expansion associated with forward faults is as follows:


Mho Expansion = ZS.p/(1 +p)
where ZS is the impedance of the source behind the relaying point.
Using the source and line impedances is a simple way of representing the Mho expansion. The protection
algorithm does not calculate ZS internally, it only deals with the signals S1 and S2 provided to the Mho
comparators. In some cases the source and line impedances are different from their actual values used in various
power system studies. This is mainly due to pre-fault current and the residual compensation for phase-to-ground
loops. To plot an accurate impedance characteristic, calculate the values of ZS as follows:

ZS = (Vmem - V)/I

Dynamic Mho Contraction for Reverse Faults


The contribution of additional polarizing input creates dynamic Mho contraction for reverse faults and enhances
the directional decision
Referring to the following diagram:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 117
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

IED
Dist
Bus VS
I
Network
ZF ZL ZS
V
V02717

Figure 41: Simplified Reverse Fault

For a fault condition we can write the following equations:


VS = V - I(ZS + ZL)

 p 
90° ≤ ∠  V I − ⋅ ( Z S + Z L )  − ∠ ( V I − Z ) ≤ −90°
 1+ p 
The Mho contraction for a reverse fault is illustrated in the following diagram:

118 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

p
V I  (ZS  ZL )
1 p
 jX
90°

V IZ

p
 (Z S  Z L )
1 p

V I

R

Self-polarised

V02718
Figure 42: Mho contraction – reverse fault

The Mho contraction associated with reverse faults is as follows:


Mho Contraction = (ZS + ZL).p/(1 + p)
where ZS + ZL is the impedance of the line and the source ahead of the relaying point.
Using the source and line impedances is a simple way of representing the Mho contraction. The protection does
not calculate ZS + ZL internally, it only deals with the signals S1 and S2 provided to the Mho comparators. In some
cases the source and line impedances are different from their actual values used in various power system studies.
This is mainly due to pre-fault current and the residual compensation for phase-to-ground loops. To plot an
accurate impedance characteristic, calculate the values of ZS + ZL as follows:

ZS + ZL = (V - Vmem)/I

3.1.7 CROSS POLARIZATION OF MHO CHARACTERISTICS


If the voltage collapses on a faulted phase, it may be possible to use healthy phase voltage components to derive
a polarizing signal to make the directional decision. This process is called cross-polarization.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 119
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

The cross-polarization voltage is generated using phase(s) not otherwise used for the particular distance or
directional measurement. While one pole is dead, and the memory is not available, the elements associated with
the remaining phases are polarized as shown in the following table:
Cross Polarizing Signal Cross Polarizing Signal Cross Polarizing Signal
Loop
(No poles dead) Lagging Pole Dead Leading Pole Dead
A-N 0.5(aVB + a2VC) αVB α2VC
B-N 0.5(aVC + a2VA) αVC α2VA
C-N 0.5(aVA + a2VB) αVA α2VB
A-B √3VC Ð -90º 0 0
B-C √3VA Ð -90º 0 0
C-A √3VB Ð -90º 0 0
where a is a mathematical operator which rotates a vector through 120° and a2 denotes a rotation of 240°.
The table shows polarizing signal contributions for each loop under the different operating conditions. The
proportion of cross-polarization voltage used is defined by the Dist. Polarizing (p) setting.

Note:
Cross polarization is used only when there is no memory polarization quantity available.

3.1.8 IMPLEMENTATION OF MHO POLARIZATION


This product does not allow the directional Mho characteristics to be purely self-polarized or purely memory-
polarized. The polarizing voltage always contains the directly measured self-polarized voltage, onto which a
percentage of the pre-fault memory voltage is added.

Note:
If no memory voltage is available then the cross-polarized quantity is used instead.

The setting Dist. Polarizing (p) defines the amount of memory polarization (or if need be, cross polarization
voltage), which should be added with respect to the existing self-polarizing voltage so that:
S1 = V + pVmem.
The value "p" can be set from 0.2 (20%) to 5 (500%).
This will have an affect on the characteristic where operation occurs when the fault impedance lies inside a circle
whose diameter is set by the points IZ and p/(1+p)IZsource
This means for example:
● If p = 1, the characteristic will have an expansion of 50% IZsource
● If p = 5, the characteristic will have an expansion of 83.3% IZsource

The memory algorithm works as follows:


1. Memory voltage is stored for two cycles after line energisation, whereafter the voltage signals are
considered valid and stored in the voltage memory buffers. The voltage memory used for polarizing is taken
from a buffer corresponding to a value taken two cycles previously, so the voltage memory can be used
after four cycles following line energisation.
2. Following fault inception, voltage signals buffered in the polarizing memory can be recycled and re-used for
a period set with the Mem Volt Dura setting. This can be set between 16 and 32 cycles.
3. If a power swing condition is detected, the voltage memory signal expires after a reduced period of 3.2
cycles.

120 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

4. If the fault is cleared before the voltage memory signal expires, the memory algorithm resets and restarts
the two/four cycle validation process.
5. If there is no voltage memory available (either because the line has just been energised, or because the
memory voltage has expired), cross polarization is used instead. The contribution of cross polarizing signals
is only used when memory polarizing is invalid and is only valid for certain pole dead conditions.
6. If neither memory polarization voltage nor cross-polarization voltage is available (pole dead condition for
phase-to-phase element), then the phase-to-phase elements are self polarized. If the polarizing voltage is
less than 1V, only zone 1 is allowed to operate. In this case a Mho characteristic with a reverse offset of 25%
is applied. This ensures operation when closing on to a close-up three-phase fault (SOTF/ TOR condition).
One of the additional benefits of adding memory into the polarizing mix is that Mho characteristics offer dynamic
expansion if there is a forward fault, therefore covering greater fault arc resistance

3.2 QUADRILATERAL CHARACTERISTIC


A number of zones are provided to make up the Quadrilateral characteristics. The following diagram shows
examples of Directional Forward, Directional Reverse, and Offset zones:

jX

Zone 3
(offset)

Zone 2
(forward)
Directional line

Zone 1

-R θ +R

Zone 4 Forward direction


(reverse)

Reverse direction

-jX V02700

Figure 43: Simplified quadrilateral characteristics

A programmable zone (zone P) is also available. Similar to Zone 3, the programmable zone can be configured as
Offset, Directional Forward, or Directional Reverse.
A combination of simple comparators, each using signals derived from measured currents and voltages,
determines whether measured impedance is within a tripping zone. A separate comparator is used for each line of
each Quadrilateral.
Each tripping zone is constructed from a Quadrilateral based on that depicted in the following diagram:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 121
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

jX Z Impedance Reach line

Reverse Resistive
Reach line Tripping
Region
Resistive
Reach line

R’ θ R +R

Z’

-jX Reverse Impedance Reach line


V02721

Figure 44: General Quadrilateral Characteristic Limits

In the figure, an Offset Quadrilateral characteristic is defined by its Impedance Reach, Z, (and Reverse Impedance
Reach, Z’), its Resistive Reach, R, (and Reverse Resistive Reach, R’), and the zone angle (θ).
The two near-horizontal lines (Impedance Reach Line and Reverse Impedance Reach Line) set the reactive
impedance limits of the tripping zone. The two near-vertical lines (Resistive Reach Line and Reverse Resistive
Reach Line) set the resistive impedance limits.
The Resistive Reach Lines (also called Resistive Blinders) are parallel and set at the angle of the zone’s
characteristic impedance.
The Impedance Reach Lines exhibit a characteristic tilt (slope). A line that tilts to reduce the reactive reach
(negative tilt/tilt down) encourages underreaching; A line that tilts to increase the reactive reach (positive tilt/tilt up)
encourages overreaching. The tilt can be used to reinforce the overreaching/underreaching requirements of the
zone. For example, for an underreaching Forward zone, a negative tilt will ensure that the measurement continues
to underreach, even with increasing fault resistance.
The Impedance Reach, Z, and the Resistive Reach, R, apply in the context of the direction of the protection. For a
Forward Zone, or an Offset Zone, Z and R look into the protected plant. For a Reverse Zone, Z and R look behind the
protected plant. Reactive Line tilts follow the same convention.

3.2.1 DIRECTIONAL QUADRILATERALS


A Directional Line overlaid onto an Offset characteristic is used to create a Directional one as shown in the
following figure:

122 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

jX Z

Tripping
Region
Directional Line

R’ θ R +R

Z’ Forward direction
60°

-jX

V02720 Reverse direction

Figure 45: Directional Quadrilateral Characteristic

This product has a Delta Directional element that is normally used to directionalise the Distance protection.
By default, the Delta Directional element is enabled (Dir. Status in DELTADIRECTIONAL set to Enabled). In this
case, the Directional Line for the Quadrilateral is derived using superimposed fault-current (Delta I). When using the
Delta Directional element, the Directional Line angle has a default value of 60º, but you can change it with the Dir.
Char Angle setting.
If you want to use a conventional directional technique, then you can do this by disabling the Delta Directional
element. The protection will then use a conventional directional element with a fixed angle of 60º.
The following figure illustrates two Offset zones that have been converted into Directional Forward zones by the
overlay of a Directional Line. An Offset zone is also shown for reference.

jX

Offset zone

Directional zone

Directional zone
Directional Line

-R +R

Forward direction

-jX

V02772 Reverse direction

Figure 46: Quadrilateral Characteristic featuring 2 directional forward zones and 1 offset zone

P446SV-TM-EN-1 123
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Directional Quadrilateral Limits


The implementation of Directional Quadrilaterals in this product produces Directional Zone characteristics that are
formed by the combination of five comparators. Each comparator produces a straight line on the complex
impedance plane. The lines produced are:
● Impedance Reach Line
● Reverse Impedance Reach Line
● Resistance Reach Line
● Reverse Resistance Reach Line
● Directional Line.

Each of the lines produced by the comparators defines a tripping limit: Impedance on one side of the line prevents
tripping whereas impedance on the other side of the line may, if the other comparators agree, allow tripping. For
example, impedance beyond the Impedance Reach Line will not allow tripping.
The combination of the comparator outputs produces a polygon shaped tripping region. The polygon may be
either 4-sided or 5-sided. The shape depends according to the settings that are applied by the five comparators
and how the Directional Line interacts with the reach lines (usually the Reverse Impedance Reach Line):
● The Directional Line may completely mask a reach line. If that is the case, the polygon will be 4-sided
(quadrilateral).
● If the Directional Line intersects a reach line, the polygon will be 5-sided.

Creation of a 5-sided polygon is illustrated in the following figure:

jX

Directional Line

-R R

Forward direction
-jX

V02773 Reverse direction

Figure 47: Five-sided polygon formed by Quadrilateral characteristic with Directional-Line intersection of
Reverse Impedance Reach Line

The applied settings will determine the intersection point. When the settings have been chosen, the following
values will affect the line intersection point:
● Impedance Reach
● Reverse Impedance Reach
● Resistive Reach

124 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

● Reverse Resistive Reach


● Directional Line Angle
● Zone Characteristic Impedance Angle
● Tilt Angles of Impedance Reach Lines

The Impedance Reach, the Resistive Reach, and the Zone Characteristic Impedance Angle, can be freely assigned.
The Directional Line Angle is 60º by default but can be varied if the Delta Directional element is enabled. The Tilt
Angle of the impedance lines has a default setting of -3º, but some variation is allowed if the Advanced setting
option is chosen.
The Reverse Impedance Reach, and the Reverse Resistive Reach are applied as a fixed ratio of the Impedance
Reach and the Resistive Reach for Directional characteristics. The ratios used vary according to the zone type. The
following tables present the different values for phase-phase characteristics and phase-earth characteristics. For
completion, the reach limit values for Offset zones are also included (although the overlaid Directional line does not
apply and the Offset characteristics will always be quadrilateral).

Phase-to-phase Element Reaches


Reverse Impedance Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Resistive Reach R
Reach Z’ Reach R’
1 Ph-Ph Forward Z1 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R1 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Ph Forward Z2 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R2 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Forward Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Reverse Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Offset Z3 Ph. Reach Z3’ Ph Rev Reach ½*R3 Ph. Resistive ½*R3’ Ph Res. Rev.
4 Ph-Ph Reverse Z4 Ph. Reach Z ½*R4 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Forward ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Reverse ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZP’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RP Ph Resistive ½*RP’ Ph. Res. Rev.
Q Ph-Ph Forward ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Reverse ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZQ’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RQ Ph Resistive ½*RQ’ Ph. Res. Rev.

Phase-to-earth Element Reaches


Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Reverse Impedance Reach Z’ Resistive Reach R
Reach R’
1 Ph-Earth Forward Z1 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R1 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Earth Forward Z2 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R2 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Forward Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Reverse Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Offset Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z3’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) R3 Gnd Resistive R3’ Ph Res. Rev
4 Ph-Earth Reverse Z4 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z R4 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Forward ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Reverse ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZP’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RP Gnd Resistive RP’ Gnd Res. Rev
Q Ph-Earth Forward ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Earth Reverse ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R

P446SV-TM-EN-1 125
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Reverse Impedance Reach Z’ Resistive Reach R
Reach R’
Q Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZQ’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RQ Gnd Resistive RQ’ Gnd Res. Rev

where kZN = (Z0 - Z1) / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp and KZN Res Angle.

Note:
Not all products feature all zones.

Note:
With default settings applied, Directional Zones 1, 2, and 4 should appear Quadrilateral.

3.2.2 QUADRILATERAL CHARACTERISTIC FOR PHASE FAULTS


Quadrilateral characteristics are available for phase fault protection. A mix of Directional Forward, Directional
Reverse, and Offset characteristics is available. Zone 1 and Zone 2 are Directional Forward. Zone 4 is Directional
Reverse. Other zones can be set independently as Offset, Directional Forward, or Directional Reverse. Each zone is
independent and is defined by an Impedance Reach Line, a Reverse Impedance Reach Line, and two resistive
blinders. The two resistive blinders (Resistive Reach Line and Reverse Resistive Reach Line) are parallel to the zone
characteristic impedance angle. The two reactance lines of each Quadrilateral exhibit a characteristic tilt. In the
phase fault characteristics the tilt of the Reverse Impedance Reach Line is preset, whilst you can choose the tilt
angle for the Impedance Reach Line.

3.2.2.1 PHASE FAULT IMPEDANCE REACH LINE


The tilt of the top line can be set independently for each zone. It is defined by a reach setting, Z, and a tilt angle, σ,
as shown in the following diagram:

+jX
V IZ


Z V I

+R

V02722

Figure 48: Impedance Reach line construction

Referenced to the fault current I, the angle of tilt is equal to the setting σ. A negative angle sets a downward tilt
and a positive angle sets an upward tilt. Operation can occur when the operating signal lags the polarizing signal.
A negative angle sets a downward tilt and a positive angle sets an upward tilt.
For all V/I vectors below the Impedance Reach line, the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I - Z) £ σ

126 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

or
Ð (V - I.Z) £ Ð I.Ð σ
The resultant two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.Z
S2 = I.Ð σ
Impedance on the tripping side of the Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is less
than 0°.

3.2.2.2 PHASE FAULT REVERSE IMPEDANCE REACH LINE


The Reverse Impedance Reach line of the phase quadrilateral elements has a tilt that is fixed at -3° as shown in the
following diagram:

+jX

+R
+Z’ V/I

-3°
V / I - Z’
V02723

Figure 49: Reverse impedance reach line construction

For an Offset zone, Z’ is the settable reverse reach. For a directional zone Z’ is a fixed percentage (either 25% or
100%) of the forward reach (Z) in the opposite direction.
The signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.Z’
S2 = I.Ð -3°
Impedance on the tripping side of the Reverse Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between S1 and
S2 is greater than 0°.

3.2.2.3 PHASE FAULT RESISTIVE REACH LINE


Refer to the following figure:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 127
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

IED
Dist V I  Half of the loop
Bus
A

ZF
R LP
B
Network Line

V02725

Figure 50: Resistive reach of phase elements

The setting Rx Ph. Resistive defines the complete loop resistive reach RLP of the Distance Protection.
Since a phase-to-phase distance element measures half of the loop, the right-hand resistive reach R, of the
characteristic is equal to half of the setting value.
R = ½ Rx Ph. Resistive

+jX

V/I
V/I-R

R ÐZ +R

V02724

Figure 51: Resistive Reach line construction

For all V/I vectors which are on the left side of the right blinder the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I - R) £ Z
or
Ð (V - I.R) £ Ð I. Z
The two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.R
S2 = I.Z

128 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

The impedance on the left side of the right hand resistive line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is
greater than 0°.

3.2.2.4 PHASE FAULT REVERSE RESISTIVE REACH LINE

+jX

ÐZ
V/I
V / I - R’ +R
R’

V02726

Figure 52: Reverse resistive reach line construction

For an offset zone, R’ is the settable reverse resistive reach (=½*Rx’ Ph Res. Rev.). . For a directional zone, R’ is fixed
at 25% of the Resistive Reach (=½*Rx Ph Res. Rev.), acting in the opposite direction.
The two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.R
S2 = I.Z
The impedance on the right side of the left hand resistive line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is less
than 0°.

3.2.2.5 PHASE FAULT QUADRILATERAL CHARACTERISTIC SUMMARY


The phase fault Quadrilateral characteristics are summarised in the following figure and tables:

+jX

V/I

R’ R +R
Z’
3°

V02727

Figure 53: Phase Fault Quadrilateral characteristic summary

P446SV-TM-EN-1 129
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

The comparators used for the Phase-Fault Quadrilateral zones are summarised in the following table:
Condition
Zone Line S1 S2
(∠S1 - ∠S2)
Forward/Offset Impedance Reach Line V – I.Z I.Ð σº <0º
Forward/Offset Reverse Impedance Reach Line V – I.Z’ I.Ð 3º >0º
Forward/Offset Resistive Reach Line V – I.R I.Z >0º
Forward/Offset Reverse Resistive Reach Line V – I.R’ I.Z <0º
Reverse Impedance Reach Line V + I.Z -I.Ð σº <0º
Reverse Reverse Impedance Reach Line V + I.Z’ -I.Ð 3º >0º
Reverse Resistive Reach Line V + I.R -I.Z >0º
Reverse Reverse Resistive Reach Line V + I.R’ -I.Z <0º

The positive sequence reach settings used for the Phase-Fault Quadrilateral characteristics are summarised in the
following table:
Reverse Impedance Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Resistive Reach R
Reach Z’ Reach R’
1 Ph-Ph Forward Z1 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R1 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Ph Forward Z2 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R2 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Forward Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Reverse Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Offset Z3 Ph. Reach Z3’ Ph Rev Reach ½*R3 Ph. Resistive ½*R3’ Ph Res. Rev.
4 Ph-Ph Reverse Z4 Ph. Reach Z ½*R4 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Forward ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Reverse ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZP’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RP Ph Resistive ½*RP’ Ph. Res. Rev.
Q Ph-Ph Forward ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Reverse ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZQ’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RQ Ph Resistive ½*RQ’ Ph. Res. Rev.

Note:
Not all zones feature in all product variations.

3.2.3 EARTH FAULT QUADRILATERAL CHARACTERISTICS


Quadrilateral characteristics are available for earth-fault protection. A mix of Directional Forward, Directional
Reverse, and Offset characteristics is available. Zone 1 and Zone 2 are Directional Forward. Zone 4 is Directional
Reverse. Other zones can be set independently as Offset, Directional Forward, or Directional Reverse. Each zone is
independent and is defined by an Impedance Reach line, a Reverse Impedance Reach Line, and two resistive
blinders. The two resistive blinders (Resistive Reach Line and Reverse Resistive Reach Line) are parallel to the zone
characteristic impedance angle.
The two reactance lines of each Phase-Earth Quadrilateral exhibit a characteristic tilt. The tilts of the Impedance
Reach Line and the Reverse Impedance Reach Line are independent. The tilt of both may be fixed. Alternatively,
the lines may be allowed to vary the tilt angle according to system conditions (dynamic tilting). If the tilt of the
Reverse Impedance Reach Line is fixed, the value is -3º. If the tilt of the Impedance Reach Line is fixed, the value is
fixed according to the setting, σ, -(user settable between +/- 30º). To use the dynamic tilting option you must
enable it. Enabling the dynamic tilt causes the slope of the reactance lines to deviate from the set values to
compensate, automatically, for angular difference between fault current and polarizing current.

130 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

3.2.3.1 EARTH FAULT REACTANCE LINES


Both forward and reverse reach reactance lines feature a fixed tilt. For the Impedance Reach line, the fixed tilt can
be set to reinforce underreaching or overreaching preferences for the zone. For the Reverse Impedance Reach line,
the fixed tilt is preset at -3º.
The tilting of the reactance lines can be set such that tilting will be affected by the choice of polarizing quantity. If
dynamic tilting is selected, the protection automatically chooses the best polarizing quantity from either the phase
current or negative sequence current. The choice depends on which line is being polarized and on the relationship
of measured currents I2 and Iph. When I2 is used as the polarizing quantity, the tilt can dynamically vary according
to the angle of I2. If Iph is used, the tilt remains fixed at the set angle.
Consider polarization of the reactance lines for the case of a phase-earth fault:
For a phase-earth fault:
V = Vph
and assuming that mutual compensation is not applied:
I = Iph + kZN.IN.
To avoid overreaching or underreaching due to the voltage drop in the arc resistance, the top line of the
characteristic should be ideally tilted by an angle:
Ð (Ifault / I)
So that the total angle of tilt should be:
Ð (Ifault / I) + σ
where Ifault is the fault current and σ is the fixed tilt of the reactance line (user setting for the Impedance Reach
line, fixed -3º preset for the Reverse Impedance Reach line.
If Z is the zone reach setting then the reactance line is formed by phase comparison between an operating signal
V – I Z (S1), and a polarizing quantity, IPOL (S2).
Ifault should be used to determine S2, but, because the Distance protection cannot measure the fault current
directly (due to the unknown infeed from the remote end), Ifault cannot be used as the polarizing current. Instead,
the angle of Ifault must be estimated. Two proven methods to estimate the angle of Ifault are:
1. The angle of Ifault can be assumed to be close to the angle of Iph
2. The angle of Ifault can be assumed to be close to the angle of the negative sequence current I2.
In case 1, the angle of Iph can be used to polarize the Quadrilateral characteristic and so the tilt of the reactance
line is fixed.
In case 2 the angle of I2 can be used to polarize the Quadrilateral characteristic. In this case, the reactance line tilt
varies dynamically according to the angle of I2.
The reactance line follows the fault resistance impedance and tilts up or down, starting from the set initial tilt angle
(σ) to avoid underreaching or overreaching.
For both fixed and dynamic tilting the validity of current polarization is controlled by the following condition:
|Ð I2 - Ð Iph | < 45º
If this condition is not fulfilled, the assumptions that the angle of Ifault is close to the angle of Iph or close to the
angle of I2 cannot be considered valid. Under such conditions the Quadrilateral characteristic could significantly
overreach or underreach. To avoid this, the distance protection automatically switches from Quadrilateral to Mho
characteristics to provide stable operation.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 131
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

3.2.3.2 EARTH FAULT FIXED REACTANCE LINE TILTING


Each zone has an independent setting to set the tilt angle (σ) of the Impedance Reach line of the quadrilateral
characteristic. If dynamic tilting is disabled, the characteristic uses this setting to apply a fixed tilt to the top line.
The tilting angle is with reference to the fault current I, and is defined by:
Tilt angle = setting (σ) = Ð Iph/I
The setting range is +/- 30°. A negative angle sets a downward tilt and a positive angle sets an upward tilt.
Operation occurs when the operating current I lags the polarizing current Iph.
The Impedance Reach line of the characteristic in the Z1 plane is shown in the following diagram:

Z 1-plane

 Iph j 
+jX Ð e 
 I 
V IZ

Z V I

+R

V02731

Figure 54: Impedance Reach line in Z1 plane

For all V/I vectors below the Impedance Reach line, the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I-Z) ≤ σ
or
Ð (V – I.Z) ≤ I + σ
If mutual compensation is not applied, for an earth-fault loop
V = Vph
and
I = Iph + kZN.IN
so the signals fed into comparator are:
S1 = Vph – Iph.Zreplica
S2 = Iph Ð σ
where: Zreplica is the replica forward reach
The impedance below the Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between the signals is less than 0°:
For products that have mutual compensation, if the mutual compensation is applied, then
Zreplica =Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph).

132 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

The following figure shows the ZLP-plane representation of the characteristic:

Z LP -plane

+jX Z  k ZN  I N I ph V ph I ph  Z replica

Z replica
Z

V ph I ph

+R

V02732

Figure 55: Impedance Reach line in ZLP plane

The Impedance Reach line tilting angle in the ZLP plane is fixed at σ (Zx Tilt Top Line setting).
The Impedance Reach line tilting angle in the Z1 plane is defined as follows:
Tilt angle = Ð(Iph/I) + σ = Ð(Iph/(Iph + kZN.IN)) + σ
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, then IN ≈ Iph. The tilting angle in
this case is fixed at the following value:
Tilt angle = Ð((1/(1 + kZN)) + σ
For products that have mutual compensation, if the mutual compensation is enabled, the tilting angle is:
Tilt angle = Ð(Iph/(Iph + kZN.IN+ kZM.IM)) + σ
The replica reach Zreplica depends on the ratio of IN/Iph. If IN ≈ Iph (and if mutual compensation is not applied)
then:
Zreplica =Z (1 + kZN)
So the characteristic is static.
The general characteristic in the ZLP plane is shown in the following figure:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 133
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

ZLP plane
+jX

Zreplica

Vph / Iph

R’ LP R LP
+R

3°
Z’ replica

V02733

Figure 56: General characteristic in ZLP plane

The comparators used for the reactance lines are as per the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
Forward or Offset Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Zreplica Iph∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Forward or Offset Reverse Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Z’replica Iph∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Zreplica -Iph∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Z’replica -Iph ∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º

3.2.3.3 EARTH FAULT DYNAMIC REACTANCE LINE TILTING


If you enable dynamic tilting, the reactance lines of the earth-fault Distance Quadrilateral characteristic can
dynamically tilt on the positive sequence impedance (Z1) plane. If the line is polarized with negative sequence
current (I2), the total tilt is made up of the difference between the angle of I2 and the angle of the Distance
protection current (I), plus the user-settable fixed tilt angle σ:
Dynamic Tilt Angle = ∠(I2 / I) + σ
The default value of the fixed tilt is -3°. It is introduced to reduce the possibility of overreach caused by any small
differences between the negative sequence source impedances, and general CT/VT angle tolerances.
The tilting of Earth-Fault Quadrilateral characteristic reactance lines are constrained to prevent inappropriate
excessive tilting according to the following criteria:
● The Zone 1 Impedance Reach line dynamic tilt can only be applied to bring the Resistive Reach end of the
line towards the +R-axis. This ensures that Zone 1 does not overreach and maintains grading/selectivity
with downstream protection.
● For the other zones (including Zone 1X and Zone 4) the dynamic tilt of the Impedance Reach line can only
act in the sense to prevent underreaching. (This is particularly important for zones used to key channel-
aided distance schemes).
● For Forward operating zones (except Zone 1) the Impedance Reach line dynamic tilt is applied to tilt the
Resistive Reach end of the line away from the +R axis.

134 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

● For Reverse operating zones the dynamically tilting line is in the opposite quadrant of the characteristic
compared with Forward/Offset Zones and the dynamic tilt moves the line away from the resistive axis.
● For Offset zones, the Impedance Reach lines tilt away from the R-axis, whilst the Reverse Impedance Reach
Lines tilt towards the +R axis. This avoids overreaching in the reverse direction.
● For products that feature single-phase tripping, when one circuit breaker pole is open during a single-pole
autoreclose sequence, dynamic tilting is automatically disabled. The fault current is used as the polarizing
signal and a fixed -7° tilt is applied. The additional tilt reduces the possibility of overreach caused by using
the faulted phase as the reference.

Note:
Zone 1X used in Zone 1 Extension Schemes uses the Zone 2 tilt settings to ensure that it does not underreach.

Dynamic tilting of reactance lines only occurs when the line is polarized with I2. If Iph is used as the polarizing
quantity the tilt of the Impedance Reach line is fixed. If fixed tilting is selected, Iph is always used. If dynamic tilting
is enabled, then the protection will decide whether to use I2 or Iph (and hence whether dynamic tilting will apply)
according to the angular relationship between I2 and Iph.
The following criteria are applied:
● If the angle between I2 and Iph is more than 45°, the Quadrilateral characteristics are disabled and Mho
characteristics are used instead.
● If the angle between I2 and Iph is less than 45°, Leading and lagging polarizing currents are allocated
according to the phase relations between I2 and Iph as presented in the diagram below:

I LEAD  I ph I ph I LEAD  I 2
I LAG  I 2 I LAG  I ph

I2
I ph
I2

V02728

Figure 57: Phase relations between I2 and Iph for leading and lagging polarizing currents

The comparators used for the reactance lines are allocated as per the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition

Zone 1 Vph - IphZreplica ILAG∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º


Impedance Reach
Reverse Impedance
Zone 1 Vph - IphZ’replica ILAG∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reach
Forward or Offset zones (except Zone
Impedance Reach Vph - IphZreplica ILEAD∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
1)
Forward or Offset zones (except Zone Reverse Impedance
Vph - IphZ’replica ILAG∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
1) Reach
Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + IphZreplica -ILEAD∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Impedance
Reverse Vph + Iph Z’replica -ILAG∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reach

If ILEAD is I2 the lines are dynamically tilted up from the fixed angle.
If ILEAD is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 135
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

If ILAG is I2, the lines are dynamically tilted down from the fixed angle.
If ILAG is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.

3.2.3.4 EARTH FAULT RESISTIVE BLINDERS


The Resistive Reach settings are used to select the resistive limits of the Quadrilaterals.
The Earth Fault reach settings are set according to the positive sequence line impedance, so are generally identical
to the settings of the Phase Fault elements.
Since the Earth Fault reach settings are set according to the positive sequence line impedances, the relationship
between the positive sequence impedances and the earth-fault loop impedances needs to be understood.
Consider the general characteristic in the Z1 plane shown in the following figure:

+jX
Z1 plane
Ð (Iph / I) + 

V/I

R’
+R
Z’ R

Ð (I ph / I) – 3°
V02734

Figure 58: General characteristic in Z1 plane

R = RLP (Iph/I) and R’ = R’LP.(Iph/I)


I = Iph +kZN.IN
For products that have mutual compensation, if the mutual compensation is enabled, then
I = Iph +kZN.IN +kZM.IM
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase and the mutual compensation is
disabled, then IN ≈ Iph (the faulty phase current) and the characteristic in the Z1 plane is simplified:

136 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

+jX Z1 plane

 1 
Ð  
 1  k ZN 
Z
 1 
R 'LP   
 1  k ZN   1 
RLP   
 1  k ZN 
R’reach Rreach
+R
Z’
 1 
Ð   3°
 1  k ZN 
V02735

Figure 59: Simplified characteristic in Z1 plane

Rreach = ((RLP./(1 + kZN)).sin( Z + a)),


R’reach = ((R’LP./(1 + kZN)).sin( Z + a)),
where: a is the angle of 1/(1 + kZN):

a = (1/(1 + kZN))
In typical cases the sine ratio coefficient term is close to unity so the simplified equations can be used:
Rreach = RLP / ǀ (1 + kZN) ǀ,
R’reach = R’LP / ǀ (1 + kZN) ǀ,
So in terms of replica impedances and loop resistances, the comparators used for the resistance lines are as per
the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
Forward or Offset Resistive reach Vph - Iph.RLP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Forward or Offset Reverse resistive reach Vph - Iph.R’LP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Resistive reach Vph + Iph.RLP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reverse Reverse resistive reach Vph + Iph.R’LP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º

The Resistive Impedance Reach side of the earth zone is controlled by the Resistive Reach setting applied (Rx Gnd
Resistive). This defines the fault arc resistance that can be detected for a single phase-earth fault. For such a fault,
the fault resistance appears in the total fault loop (out and return loop), in which the line impedance is Z1 x (1 +
kZN), if IN @ Iph.
Most injection test sets plot impedance characteristics in positive sequence terms, so that the right-hand intercept
appears less than the setting applied (Rn Gnd Resistive /(1+ kZN)). The left hand side is set by the Rn Gnd Res Rev
setting and acts similarly.

Note:
The resistive reach lines of earth-fault Quadrilateral characteristics are not affected by the type of tilting used by the reactive
lines (fixed or dynamic), nor by the angle values.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 137
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

3.2.3.5 EARTH FAULT QUADRILATERAL CHARACTERISTICS SUMMARY


The inputs to the comparators used for the earth-fault Quadrilaterals are summarised in the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
Zone 1 Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Zreplica ILAG ∠ σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Zone 1 Reverse Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Z’replica ILAG ∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Forward or Offset zones (except
Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Zreplica ILEAD ∠ σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Zone 1)
Forward or Offset zones (except
Reverse Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Z’replica ILAG ∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Zone 1)
Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Zreplica -ILEAD ∠ σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Z’replica -ILAG ∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Forward or Offset Resistive Reach Vph - Iph.RLP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Forward or Offset Reverse Resistive Reach Vph - Iph.R’LP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Resistive Reach Vph + Iph.RLP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reverse Reverse Resistive Reach Vph + Iph.R’LP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º

If dynamic tilting is selected, then:


If ILEAD is I2 the lines are dynamically tilted up from the fixed angle (Forward sense)
● If ILEAD is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.
● If ILAG is I2, the lines are dynamically tilted down from the fixed angle (Forward sense)
● If ILAG is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.

If fixed tilting is selected, then he current input quantity for S2 is Iph in all cases.
The positive sequence reach settings used for the Earth-Fault Quadrilateral characteristics are summarised in the
table below:
Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Reverse Impedance Reach Z’ Resistive Reach R
Reach R’
1 Ph-Earth Forward Z1 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R1 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Earth Forward Z2 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R2 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Forward Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Reverse Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Offset Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z3’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) R3 Gnd Resistive R3’ Ph Res. Rev
4 Ph-Earth Reverse Z4 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z R4 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Forward ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Reverse ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZP’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RP Gnd Resistive RP’ Gnd Res. Rev
Q Ph-Earth Forward ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Earth Reverse ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZQ’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RQ Gnd Resistive RQ’ Gnd Res. Rev
where kZN = (Z0 - Z1) / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp and KZN Res Angle.

138 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

4 PHASE AND EARTH FAULT DISTANCE PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


The Distance protection requires line data to be input to operate correctly. You must first input the data using the
settings in the LINE PARAMETERS column.
The Distance protection has a Setting Mode which is set to Simple by default. We recommend the default for
most applications. Instead of entering distance zone impedance reaches in ohms, zone settings are simply entered
in terms of percentage of the protected line data specified in the Line Impedance setting in the LINE PARAMETERS.
The setting assumes that the residual compensation factor is equal for all zones. The protection calculates the
required reach settings from the percentage settings. The calculated zone reaches are available for viewing but
you cannot change the values.
An Advanced Setting Mode allows individual distance ohmic reaches and residual compensation factors to be
entered for each zone. When advanced mode is selected, all 'percentage' settings associated with the Simple
setting mode are hidden and the Distance zone settings need to be entered for each zone in the DIST. ELEMENTS
column.

4.1 PHASE FAULT CHARACTERISTICS


Each phase zone can be Enabled or Disabled using the Zone Ph Status settings in the DISTANCE SETUP
column.
Characteristics can be either 'Quadrilateral' (polygon), or Mho (circular). The chosen characteristic applies to all
zones. All distance elements are directionalized and use residual compensation of the corresponding phase fault
reach.

4.2 EARTH FAULT CHARACTERISTICS


Each ground zone can be Enabled or Disabled using the Zone Gnd Status settings in the DISTANCE SETUP
column.
Characteristics can be either 'Quadrilateral' (polygon), or Mho (circular). The chosen characteristic applies to all
zones. All distance elements are directionalized and use residual compensation of the corresponding phase fault
reach.

4.3 DISTANCE PROTECTION TRIPPING DECISION


A fault is detected if the phase voltage drops below 70%, or if the phase selector picks up. When a fault is detected,
the protection stores values recorded over the two previous cycles. These are used to provide a reference for
memory polarization, etc, as the fault is processed.
For security, a number of criteria must be satisfied before the distance protection issues a trip command. These
are as follows:
● The phase selector needs to identify the faulted phases and ensure that only the correct distance
measuring zones can issue a trip. Possible phase selections are AN, BN, CN, AB, BC, CA, and ABC. For double
phase-earth faults, the selection is AB, BC or CA, with N (neutral) for indication only.
● For the selected phase-earth elements the phase and the neutral currents must exceed the minimum
sensitivity threshold. For the selected phase-to-phase elements the loop current must exceed the minimum
sensitivity threshold. By default, this sensitivity is 5%In for phase-earth faults and, for phase-to-phase faults
both of the faulted phases must exceed 5%In. You can raise this minimum sensitivity if necessary, but this is
not normally required.
● For an earth-fault distance element to operate, the corresponding biased neutral current detector must
have picked up.
● The faulted phase impedance must appear in a tripping (measuring) zone, corresponding to the phase
selection.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 139
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

● For directional zones, the directionality element must agree with the tripping zone. Zones 1, 2, and 4 are
always directional whereas other zones are only directional if set as directional. In directional zones the
directionality element must agree with the tripping zone. For example, Zone 1 is a Forward Directional zone
and must not trip for Reverse faults. Therefore a Zone 1 trip is only allowed if the directionality element
issues a Forward decision. Zone 4 is reverse-looking so needs a Reverse decision by the directionality
element.
● The set time delay for the measuring zone must expire, with the measured fault impedance remaining
inside the zone characteristic for the duration of the delay time. Typically, Zone 1 has no time delay
(instantaneous), whereas all other zones have time delays.
● Where channel-aided distance schemes are used, the time delay tZ2 for overreaching Zone 2 may be
bypassed for some of the schemes.

4.4 DISTANCE PROTECTION PHASE SELECTION


Phase selection allows the product to identify exactly which phases are involved in a fault and enables the correct
measuring zones to trip.
Operation of the distance elements is controlled by a Superimposed Current Phase Selector. For a period of two-
cycles after pick-up of the phase selector, only elements associated with the fault type selected by the phase
selector are allowed to operate. If these elements do not operate, all elements are enabled for the following five
cycles, before the phase selector returns to its quiescent state.
Operation of an enabled distance element during the two-cycle, or five-cycle period, causes the phase selector
state to be maintained until the element resets. An exception to this is when the phase selector changes decision
while an element is operated. In this case, the selected elements are reset and the two cycle period restarts with
the new selection.

Note:
Any existing trip decision is not reset under this condition. After the first cycle following a selection, the phase selector is only
permitted to change to a selection involving additional phases.

On double phase-to-earth faults, only the phase-to-phase elements are enabled. This is because they are
generally more accurate under these conditions than earth fault elements. A biased neutral current level detector
operates to indicate the involvement of earth in the fault.

4.4.1 FAULTED PHASE SELECTION


The faulted phase or phases are selected by comparing the magnitudes of the three phase-to-phase
superimposed currents. A single phase-to-earth fault produces the same superimposed current on two of these
signals and zero on the third. A phase-to-phase or double-phase-to-earth fault produces one signal which is larger
than the other two. A three phase fault produces three superimposed currents which are the same size. The figure
below shows how the change in current can be used to select the faulted phases for a C phase-to-ground (CN)
fault.

140 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

AB

BC

CA

V02702

Figure 60: Phase to phase current changes for C phase-to-ground (CN) fault

As default, phase selection is made when any superimposed current exceeds 5% of nominal current (0.05 In).
Any superimposed current greater than 80% of the largest superimposed current is included in the phase selection
logic.
For applications which might experience high levels of sub-synchronous currents, the phase selector automatically
raises the threshold from the default 5% of In, in order to prevent sporadic operation whilst maintaining high
sensitivity to faults.

Note:
If you test the distance elements using test sets, which do not provide a dynamic model to generate true fault delta
conditions, you need to set Static Test Mode to Enabled in the COMMISSION TESTS column. This disables phase selector
control and forces the distance protection to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.

The phase selector picks up on fault detection, and enables Distance protection on all elements which have been
selected by the pick-up. These elements are enabled for 2 cycles, and normally this will result in tripping. On double
ground-to-phase faults, only appropriate phase elements are enabled. This is because they are generally more
accurate than ground elements under these conditions. If, however, tripping is not initiated within the 2 cycles, for
the following 5 cycles all Distance elements (including all phase-earth elements) are enabled. During these five
cycles, this could lead to incorrect operation of earth-fault elements in case of an out-of-zone double-phase-earth
fault. This is because one of the phase-earth elements could demonstrate significant overreach, which may result
in maloperation. To help prevent this, a Biased Neutral Current Detector is incorporated.

4.5 BIASED NEUTRAL CURRENT DETECTOR


The Biased Neutral Current Detector permits the earth-fault elements to operate only if sufficient neutral current is
detected. The Biased Neutral Current Detector characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 141
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

I N  I A  I B  IC

Neutral current
K  10%

Bias current I BIAS  max  I A  I B , I B  I C , I C  I A 


V02777

Figure 61: Biased Neutral Current Detector Characteristic

The neutral current detector uses the maximum of the three phase current differences as a biasing value. The
slope of the characteristic is fixed at 10%.
Biasing the neutral current detector assures that the detector is sensitive enough to operate for any single-phase
fault, without the risk of picking up on neutral spill current during phase-to-phase faults. The neutral spill current
might arise from mismatched current transformers or current transformer saturation. The biasing also ensures
that the earth fault distance elements are generally disabled for double-phase-to-earth faults with high resistance
in the neutral. Such faults can occur in resistively earthed systems, or in solidly earthed systems due to high arc
resistance. Given that these conditions are very similar to pure phase-to-phase faults, the earth fault distance
elements can exhibit high measuring errors which the use of the neutral current detector overcomes.

4.6 DISTANCE ELEMENT ZONE SETTINGS


The settings for the Distance protection are contained in the DISTANCE SETUP and DIST. ELEMENTS columns of the
relevant settings group.
The Distance protection has a Setting Mode which is set to Simple by default. We recommend the default for
most applications.. Instead of entering distance zone impedance reaches in ohms, zone settings are simply
entered in terms of percentage of the protected line data specified with the Line Impedance setting in the LINE
PARAMETERS column. The setting assumes that the residual compensation factor is equal for all zones. The
protection calculates the required reach settings from the percentage settings. The calculated zone reaches are
available for viewing but you cannot change a value.
An ‘Advanced’ Setting Mode allows individual distance ohmic reaches and residual compensation factors to be
entered for each zone. When ‘Advanced’ mode is selected, all ‘percentage’ settings that are associated to ‘Simple’
setting mode in the DISTANCE SETUP column will be hidden and the Distance zone settings need to be entered for
each zone in the DIST. ELEMENTS column.
If you use the ‘Simple’ Settings Mode, the DISTANCE ELEMENTS column contains a list of what settings have been
automatically calculated and applied. This list is useful as a reference for commissioning and periodic injection
testing. If you use the ‘Advanced’ Setting Mode, however, you must enter all settings for each zone.

Note:
Distance zones are directionalized by a Delta Directional decision. The characteristic angle for this decision is set with the
Delta Directional configuration, in the DISTANCE SETUP column. The default setting is 60°.

4.6.1 DIRECTIONALIZING THE DISTANCE ELEMENTS


By default a Delta technique is used for directionalizing the Distance protection. It acts on step-changes (Deltas) of
current and voltage to determine whether potential fault conditions are in the forward or reverse direction. The
Delta voltage and current thresholds used in the Distance Directional decision are fixed for optimum performance.
The Directional characteristic angle, (also known as the relay characteristic angle – RCA) is set to 60° by default,
but you can change this to suit your application using the Dir. Char Angle setting in the DISTANCE SETUP column.

142 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

The Delta Directional technique needs the changes in voltage and current to exceed the preset thresholds, in order
to determine forward and reverse decisions. If these thresholds are not exceeded, but a potential fault is detected,
the Distance protection reverts to a conventional directional technique with memory polarization of the voltage.
If you don’t want to use the Delta directional technique, set Dir. Status in the DISTANCE SETUP column to
Disabled in which case memory polarization is used.

4.6.2 ADVANCED DISTANCE ZONE SETTINGS


The Setting Mode is set in the DISTANCE SETUP column. There are two possible modes; simple and advanced.
If set to Simple, you need only to enter the line parameters such as length, impedances and residual
compensation found in the LINE PARAMETERS column. You set the reach in terms of percentage of the protected
line.
We recommend the Advanced setting for networks where the protected and adjacent lines are of dissimilar
construction, requiring independent zone characteristic angles and residual compensation. In this setting mode all
individual distance ohmic reach and residual compensation settings and operating current thresholds per each
zone are accessible.
If you use the advanced setting mode, you also need to set the minimum current sensitivity for each zone (Zn
Sensit. Iph>n, and Zn Sensit. Ignd>n).
The current sensitivity setting for each zone is used to set the minimum current that must flow in each of the
faulted phases before a trip can occur. For example, if a phase A-B line fault is present, the protection must
measure both currents Ia and Ib above the minimum set sensitivity.
The default setting is 7.5% In for Zones 1 and 2, and 5% In for other zones, ensuring that distance element
operation is not constrained, right through to an SIR ratio of 60.
When quadrilateral characteristics are used, you can set the tilt angle of the impedance reach lines.
In Advanced setting mode, the impedance reach lines of the quadrilateral characteristics are fixed, but not as
horizontal reactance lines. To account for phase angle tolerances in the current and voltage transformers, etc., the
lines are tilted downwards at a droop of -3°.
In Advanced setting mode, the tilt of the top lines can be changed from these values.

4.6.3 DISTANCE ZONE SENSITIVITIES


In the Simple Setting Mode a minimum current sensitivity applies but the value is automatically calculated and
applied based on the data entered in the ‘Simple’ settings fields. The criteria used to calculate the setting value are
needed for a minimum value of current flowing in the faulted loop and for the Zone reach point voltage. For Zones
other than 1 or 2, the minimum current must be greater than 5% of the rated current and the minimum voltage at
the Zone reach point must be 0.25V. The current equating to the reach point criteria can be expressed as 0.25/
Zone reach and the sensitivity can be expressed as:
Sensitivity = max (5%In, (0.25/Zone reach))
Zones 1 and 2 are set less sensitive than the reverse Zone 4. This ensures stability of the protection in either an
overreaching or a blocking scheme. For Zones 1 and 2, the same criteria are applied as for the other Zones. Also a
minimum sensitivity criterion is applied, depending on the Zone 4 sensitivity. The sensitivity must exceed 1.5 x Zone
4 sensitivity and can be expressed as:-
Sensitivity (Z1, Z2) = max (5%In, (0.25/Zone reach), (1.5 x Zone 4 sensitivity))
Or
Sensitivity (Z1, Z2) = max (5%In, (0.25/Zone reach), (1.5 x (0.25/Zone 4 reach)))
The dependency on the Zone 4 element always applies, even if Zone 4 is disabled.
The default reach setting for Zones 1, 2, and 4 are 80%, 120%, and 150% respectively. For these settings the zone-
dependent terms can be reduced to:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 143
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

0.25/Zone 1 reach = 0.25/(0.8 x line impedance)


0.25/Zone 2 reach = 0.25/(1.2 x line impedance)
1.5 x (0.25/Zone 4 reach) = 0.25/line impedance
In such cases, for Zone 1, the dominant Zone reach term is that of Zone 1 and the equation can be reduced to:
Sensitivity (Z1) = max (5%In, (0.25/(0.8 x line impedance)))
For lines with an impedance of less than 6.25 Ω the Zone 1 reach term dominates and the sensitivity is greater
than 5% In. Above this line impedance the sensitivity is 5% In.
Similarly, for Zone 2, the dominant Zone reach term is that of Zone 4 and the equation can be reduced to:
Sensitivity (Z2) = max (5%In, (0.25/line impedance))
For lines with an impedance of less than 5 Ω the Zone reach term dominates and the sensitivity is greater than 5%
In. Above this line impedance the sensitivity is 5% In.
In Advanced setting mode the same qualifications for distance zone minimum sensitivity as minimum sensitivity
should be applied to ensure distance element accuracy.

4.7 CAPACITOR VT APPLICATIONS


The device provides a setting for capacitor-coupled voltage transformer (CVT) applications. This setting is CVT
Filters and is found in the DISTANCE SETUP column. The default setting is Disabled which us used for
conventional wound voltage transformers. If CVTs are used you can set CVT Filters to either Passive, or Active
to reduce the effects of transient components caused by close up faults.

4.7.1 CVTS WITH PASSIVE SUPPRESSION OF FERRORESONANCE


Passive suppression to reduce the effects of transient components that could be caused by close up faults uses an
anti-resonance design and the resulting transient distortion is fairly small. Passively suppressed CVTs are
sometimes classed as type 2. In passive CVT applications, the effect on characteristic accuracy is generally
negligible for source to line impedance ratios of less than 30 (SIR < 30). However, with a high Source-to-Line
Impedance Ratio (SIR), it is advisable to set CVT Filters to Passive.
By setting CVT Filters to Passive, the protection can trip at sub-cycle speeds, unless the actual SIR is above that
which is set. If the SIR is estimated to be higher than the setting, the instantaneous operating time is increased by
about a quarter of a power frequency cycle. The protection estimates the SIR as the ratio of nominal rated voltage
Vn to the size of the comparator vector IZ (in volts):
SIR = Vn/IZ
where:
● Vn = Nominal phase to neutral voltage
● I = Fault current
● Z = Reach setting for the zone concerned

Therefore, for slower operation, I needs to be low, as restricted by a relatively weak infeed and Z needs to be small,
as for a short line.

4.7.2 CVTS WITH ACTIVE SUPPRESSION OF FERRORESONANCE


Active suppression to reduce the effects of transient components that could be caused by close up faults uses a
tuned L-C circuit in the CVT. The damping of transients is not as efficient as for passive suppression. Active
suppression CVTs are often called type 1 CVTs. In active CVT applications, to ensure reach point accuracy, the CVT
Filters setting should be set to Active. The protection varies according to the calculated source to line
impedance ratio SIR (= Vn / IZ).

144 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

where:
● Vn = Nominal phase to neutral voltage
● I = Fault current
● Z = Reach setting for the zone concerned

Sub-cycle tripping is maintained for lower SIRs, up to a ratio of 2. The instantaneous operating time is increased by
about a quarter of a power frequency cycle at higher SIRs.
Transients caused by voltage dips, however severe, do not affect the protection’s directional measurement
because it uses voltage memory.

4.8 LOAD BLINDING


Load blinders are provided for both phase and earth fault distance elements, to prevent incorrect-tripping for
heavy load flow. A blinder envelope which surrounds the expected worst case load limits should be configured to
block tripping for any impedance measured in the blinded region. Only a fault impedance which is outside the area
bounded by the load blinders is allowed to cause a trip. The blinder characteristics are shown in the following
figure:

jX

Operate area

Blind area Blind area


β R

Operate area

V00645

Figure 62: Load Blinder Characteristics

● Z denotes the Load/B Impedance setting. This sets the radius of the under-impedance circle.
● ß denotes the Load/B Angle setting. This sets the angle of the two blinder boundary lines - the gradient of
the rise or fall with respect to the resistive axis.
The protection can allow the load blinder to be bypassed any time that the measured voltage for the phase in
question falls below an undervoltage setting. Under such circumstances, the low voltage could not be attributed to
normal voltage excursion tolerances on load. A fault must be present on the phase in question, so it is acceptable
to override the blinder action and allow the Distance protection to trip for an in-zone measurement. The
advantage of bypassing the load blinders is that the resistive coverage for faults near to the protection location
can be higher.
To use the load blinders you must set the Load Blinders setting to Enabled. You then set appropriate values for
the blinder impedance using the Z< Blinder Imp setting, the b value using the Load/B Angle setting, and the
undervoltage threshold using the Load Blinder V< setting.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 145
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

4.9 CROSS COUNTRY FAULT PROTECTION


"Cross country fault" is a term that has been adopted to cover a fault scenario where two separate single-phase
faults occur on a system together. For example, where single-pole tripping is employed, if a single phase-to-earth
fault occurs, the voltages on the other phases can rise above normal. This may cause a breakdown elsewhere on
the system and result in another fault involving a different phase to the one on which the original fault occurred.
The distance protection in this product features cross-country override logic, which is built into the phase selector.
The logic is dedicated to providing Cross-Country fault protection for solidly-earthed systems. It ensures correct
operation a fault in Zone 1 that may evolve to involve a different phase. For isolated or compensated earthing
systems a settable phase preferential logic will be used for cross-country faults instead.
The cross-country override logic:
● Prevents possible false operation of the phase-phase distance elements whilst allowing the appropriate
Zone1 phase-earth element to trip.
● Acts when the distance protection makes a multiple phase selection (where more than one phase is
involved in the fault), but only one Zone 1 phase-earth element picks up. Only "on-angle" operation of the
Zone 1 phase-earth element can activate the logic. this prevents incorrect operation due to impedance
encroachment.
● Allows only one Zone 1 phase-earth element to operate. The operation of that element must match the
phase pick-up indication of the phase selector. For example, if the original phase selection indicated
involvement of only B and C phases, the logic could allow a BN trip or a CN trip to override the phase-phase
selection, but override by the AN element is not allowed.
● Does not apply if more than one forward Zone 1 element picks up. In this case the fault is considered multi-
phase and the protection trips three-pole.

Note:
Load blinding can be applied for phase and earth characteristics. Residual compensation is not applied. Phase characteristics
use phase-to-phase voltage and phase-to-phase current. Earth fault characteristics use phase-to-neutral voltage and phase-
to-neutral current.

146 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

5 DELTA DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT


Where Distance protection is being applied, a ‘Delta’ algorithm is provided to directionalize the distance elements.
If used in conjunction with aided schemes, this Delta algorithm can also provide additional protection in the form
of directional comparison protection.

5.1 DELTA DIRECTIONAL PRINCIPLE AND SETUP

Note:
The characteristic angle set in this section is also used by the Distance protection. This is because distance zones are
directionalized by the delta decision.

Delta directional comparison looks at the relative phase angle of the superimposed current DI (delta I) compared to
the superimposed voltage DV (delta V), at the instant of fault inception. The delta is only present when a fault
occurs and a step change from the pre-fault steady-state load is generated by the fault. The element issues a
forward or reverse decision which can be input into an aided channel unit protection scheme.
Under healthy network conditions the system voltage is close to Vn nominal and load current flows. Under such
steady-state conditions, if the voltage measured on each phase now is compared with a stored memory from
exactly two power-system cycles previously, the difference between them is zero. Zero voltage change (DV = 0) and
zero current change (DI = 0), except when there are changes in load current.
When a fault occurs on the system, the delta changes measured are:
DV = fault voltage (time “t”) - pre-fault healthy voltage (t-2 cycles)
DI = fault current (time “t”) - pre-fault load current (t-2 cycles)
The delta measurements are a vector difference, resulting in a delta magnitude and angle. Under healthy system
conditions the pre-fault values are those measured 2 cycles earlier. When a fault is detected the pre-fault values
are retained for the duration of the fault.
The changes in magnitude are used to detect the presence of the fault and the angles are used to determine
whether the fault is in the Forward or Reverse direction.
The following figure shows a single phase to earth fault.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 147
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

IF1

ZS1 I1 ZL1 ZR1

V1

IF/3
IF2

ZS2 I2 ZL2 ZR2

V2
voltage
generator
represents
voltage change
IF0 at fault location

ZS0 I0 ZL0 ZR0

V0

E02704

Figure 63: Sequence networks connection for an internal A-N fault

The fault is shown near to the busbar at end R of the line, and results in a connection of the positive, negative, and
zero sequence networks in series. The delta diagram shows that any fault is a generator of D, connected at the
location of the fault inception. The characteristics of the deltas are:
● The DI generated by the fault is equal to the total fault arc current.
● The DI splits into parallel paths, with part contribution from source “S” and part from remote end “R” of the
line. Therefore each element measures a lower proportion of DI.
● The DV generated by the fault is equal to the fault arc voltage minus the pre-fault voltage, so it is in anti-
phase with the pre-fault voltage.
● The DV measured by the protection is the voltage drop across the source impedance behind the protection
location. This is generally smaller than the DV measured at the fault location, because the voltage collapse
is smaller nearer to the source than at the fault.
● For fault detection, the measured DI and DV associated with the fault must be greater than the Dir I Fwd
and Dir V Fwd settings respectively.

5.2 DELTA DIRECTIONAL DECISION


Delta quantities are generated when a fault starts. The following criteria characterise the fault direction:

148 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

For a forward fault:


DV is a decrease in voltage, so it is in the negative sense. DI is a forward current flow, so it is in the positive sense.
Where DI and DV are approximately in anti-phase, the fault is forward. The exact angle relationship for the forward
fault is:
DV / DI = - (Source impedance Zs)

For a reverse fault


DV is a decrease in voltage, so it is in the negative sense. DI is an outfeed flowing in the reverse direction, so it is in
the negative sense. Where DI and DV are approximately in phase, the fault is reverse. The exact angle relationship
for the reverse fault is:
DV / DI = (Remote Source impedance Zs’ + ZL)
where ZL is the protected line impedance and Zs’ source impedance behind the protection.
A directional characteristic angle (RCA) setting (Dir. Char Angle) allows you to set the centre of the directional
characteristic according to the amount by which the current nominally lags the reference DV. The characteristic
boundary is then +/- 90° either side of the set characteristic angle.

Note:
If Delta directional aided scheme are not used, Distance zone directionalizing uses fixed operating thresholds: DV=0.5V and
DI=5%In. If the fault DV is below the setting of 0.5V, a conventional distance line ensures correct forward/reverse polarizing.
For Delta directional aided schemes, sufficient DV must be present for tripping to occur.

The delta directional element will produce a forward decision when the angle between the delta volts and delta
current shifted by the Dir. Char Angle setting is greater than 90°. The Dir. Char Angle setting is the characteristic
angle of the source impedance, Zs.

Forward

Reverse
DI

Zs

RCA

RCA = Characteristic angle setting (Dir. Char Angle)


V02706

Figure 64: - DV Forward and Reverse tripping regions

To facilitate testing of the distance elements using test sets, which do not provide a dynamic model to generate
true fault delta conditions, set the Static Test Mode setting in the COMMISSIONING TESTS column to Enabled.
This disables phase selector control and forces the protection to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 149
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

6 APPLICATION NOTES

6.1 SETTING MODE CHOICE


This product has two setting modes for distance protection: Simple, or Advanced. In the majority of cases, we
recommend the Simple setting. Using the Simple mode, you need only enter the line parameters such as
length, impedances and residual compensation. You set the reach in terms of percentage of the protected line.
We recommend the Advanced setting mode for networks where the protected and adjacent lines are of
dissimilar construction, requiring independent zone characteristic angles and residual compensation. In
Advanced setting mode all individual distance ohmic reach and residual compensation settings and operating
current thresholds are accessible for every zone.

6.2 OPERATING CHARACTERISTIC SELECTION


In general, we recommend the following characteristics:
● For short line applications: Select Mho for phase fault zones and quadrilateral for earth fault zones.
● For open delta (vee-connected) voltage transformer applications: Set Mho for phase fault distance
protection. For Earth Fault protection, disable the Earth Fault Distance elements and use Directional Earth
Fault instead.
● For series compensated lines: Select Mho characteristics for both phase- and earth-faults.

6.2.1 PHASE CHARACTERISTIC


The phase characteristic selection is common to all zones, allowing Mho or quadrilateral selection. Generally, the
characteristic chosen matches utility practice. Generally we would recommend a Mho characteristic for line
protection and a quadrilateral characteristic for cable applications.
The following figure shows the basic settings needed to configure a forward-looking quadrilateral zone (blinder not
shown).

Zone Reach
Z

Tilt Angle

Time
Delay
t
Line
Angle
Resistive
Reach
R

E02746

Figure 65: Settings required to apply a quadrilateral zone

The following figure shows the basic settings needed to configure a forward-looking mho zone, assuming that the
load blinder is enabled.

150 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Variable mho
Zone Reach Z
expansion by
polarizing ratio

Time
Delay
t

Load
Line Blinder
Angle
Angle β

Blinder Radius

E02747

Figure 66: Settings required to apply a mho zone

6.2.2 EARTH FAULT CHARACTERISTIC


The earth fault characteristic selection is common to all zones, allowing Mho or quadrilateral selection. Generally,
the characteristic chosen matches utility practice. Generally we would recommend a Mho characteristic for line
protection and a quadrilateral characteristic for cable applications.
Quadrilateral earth-fault characteristics are also recommended for all lines shorter than 10miles (16km). This
ensures that the resistive fault arc coverage does not depend on Mho circle dynamic expansion and is a known set
value.

6.3 ZONE REACH SETTING GUIDELINES


The Zone 1 elements of a Distance protection should be set to cover as much of the protected line as possible,
allowing instantaneous tripping for as many faults as possible. In most applications the Zone 1 reach (Z1) should
not be able to respond to faults beyond the protected line. For an underreaching application the Zone 1 reach
must therefore be set to account for any possible overreaching errors. These errors come from measuring errors,
the current and voltage transformers, and inaccurate line impedance data. We therefore recommend that the
reach of the Zone 1 distance elements is restricted to 80% of the protected line impedance (positive phase
sequence line impedance), with Zone 2 elements set to cover the final 20% of the line.
The Zone 2 elements should be set to cover the 20% of the line not covered by Zone 1. Allowing for underreaching
errors, the Zone 2 reach (Z2) should be set in excess of 120% of the protected line impedance for all fault
conditions. Where aided tripping schemes are used, fast operation of the Zone 2 elements is required. It is
therefore beneficial to set Zone 2 to reach as far as possible, such that faults on the protected line are well within
reach. A constraining requirement is that, where possible, Zone 2 does not reach beyond the Zone 1 reach of
adjacent line protection. For this reason the Zone 2 reach should be set to cover up to 50% of the shortest
adjacent line impedance, if possible.
The Zone 3 elements would usually be used to provide overall back-up protection for adjacent circuits. The Zone 3
reach (Z3) is therefore set to approximately 120% of the combined impedance of the protected line plus the
longest adjacent line. A higher apparent impedance of the adjacent line may need to be allowed where fault
current can be fed from multiple sources or flow through parallel paths.
Zone 3 may also be programmed with a slight reverse (“rev”) offset, in which case its reach in the reverse direction
is set as a percentage of the protected line impedance too. This would typically provide back-up protection for the
local busbar, where the offset reach is set to 20% for short lines (<30km) or 10% for longer lines.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 151
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Zone 3 may also be set as a reverse directional zone. The setting chosen for Zone 3, if used, depends on its
application. Typical applications include its use as an additional time delayed zone or as a reverse back-up
protection zone for busbars and transformers.
Programmable zone elements can be set with the same options as Zone 3 (Forward, Reverse or Offset). A
programmable zone can be used as an additional forward protection zone if custom and practice requires using
more than three forward zones of Distance protection.
The Zone 4 elements may also provide back-up protection for the local busbar. Where Zone 4 is used to provide
reverse directional decisions for Blocking or Permissive Overreach schemes, Zone 4 must reach further behind the
protection than Zone 2 for the remote end protection. In such cases the reverse reach should be:
● Mho: Z4 > Remote Zone 2 reach x 120%
● Quadrilateral: Z4 > (Remote Zone 2 reach x 120%) minus the protected line impedance

Note:
In the case of the Mho, the line impedance is not subtracted. This ensures that whatever the amount of dynamic expansion of
the circle, the reverse looking zone always detects all solid and resistive faults capable of detection by Zone 2 at the remote
line end.

6.3.1 QUADRILATERAL RESISTIVE REACHES


Two setting modes are possible for resistive reach coverage, which can be set by the Quad Resistance Setting:
Common: In this mode, all zones share one common fault resistive reach setting
Proportional: With this mode, the ratio of zone reach to resistive reach is the same for all zones. The Fault
Resistance setting defines a reference fault at the remote end of the line. The resistive reach is set at the same
percentage of the fault resistance as the Zone Reach setting. For example, if the Zone 1 reach is 80% of the
protected line, its resistive reach is 80% of the reference fault resistance.
The Proportional setting is used to avoid zones being excessively broad (width of the resistive reach compared
to the length of the impedance reach). In general, for easiest injection testing, the aspect ratio of any zone is best
within the 1 to 15 range:
1/15th <= Z reach / R reach setting <= 15
The resistive reach settings should be selected according to utility practice. If no such guidance exists, a starting
point for Zone 1 is:
● Cables: Resistive Reach = 3 x Zone 1 reach
● Overhead lines: Resistive Reach = [2.3 - 0.0045 x Line length (km)] x Zone 1 reach
● Lines longer than 400km: 0.5 x Zone 1 reach

Note:
Because the fault current for an earth fault may be limited by tower footing resistance, high soil resistivity, and weak
infeeding; any arcing resistance is often higher than for a corresponding phase fault at the same location. It maybe necessary
to set the Rn Gnd Resistive settings to be higher than the Rn Ph Resistive setting. A setting of Rn Gnd Resistive three times that
of Rn Ph Resistive is not uncommon.

6.4 EARTH FAULT RESISTIVE REACHES AND TILTING


The protection allows two different methods of tilting the Impedance Reach line.
● Automatic adjustment of the top reactance line angle (dynamic tilting)
● Fixed setting of the top line that overrides dynamic tilting (fixed tilting)

152 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

6.4.1 DYNAMIC TILTING


The dynamic tilting requirements are different for long lines and short lines:

Long lines
In the case of medium and long line applications where quadrilateral distance earth-fault characteristics are used,
Zn Dynamic Tilt should be enabled and the starting tilt angle should be -3° (as per the default settings). This tilt
compensates for possible current and voltage transformer and line data errors.
For high resistive faults during power exporting, the underreaching Zone 1 is only allowed to tilt down by the angle
difference between the faulted phase and negative sequence current Ð(Iph-I2) starting from the –3° set angle. This
ensures stability of Zone 1 for high resistance faults beyond the Zone 1 reach even during heavy load conditions
(high load angle between two voltage sources) and sufficient sensitivity for high resistance internal faults. The tilt
angle for all other zones (that are by nature overreaching zones) remain at -3°.
In the case of power importing, Zone 1 remains at –3° while all other zones are allowed to tilt up by the Ð(Iph-I2)
angle difference, starting from –3°. This increases the Zone 2 and Zone 4 resistive reaches and secures correct
operation in permissive overreach and blocking type schemes.

Short lines
For very short lines, typically below 10Miles (16km), the ratio of resistive to reactance reach setting (R/X) could
easily exceed 10. For such applications the geometrical shape of the quadrilateral characteristic could be such
that the top reactance line is close or even crosses the resistive axis as presented in the following figure:

jX
High resistive internal fault
Total dynamic tilt starting from zero

Total dynamic tilt starting from -3°

Z1

-3 ° Iph -I 2
Line angle R

Iph -I 2

V02748

Figure 67: Over-tilting effect

In the case of high resistance external faults on a short line, particularly under heavy power exporting conditions,
Zone 1 remains stable due to dynamic downwards tilting of the impedance reach line. However, the detection of
high resistance internal faults especially towards the end of the line needs consideration. In such applications you
can choose to detect high resistance faults using highly sensitive Aided Directional Earth Fault scheme, or to clear
the fault with Distance ground protection. For the Distance to operate, it is necessary to eliminate over-tilting for
internal faults by reducing the initial -3° tilting angle to zero so that the overall impedance reach line tilt is equal to
Ð(Iph-I2) angle only.
As shown in the previous figure, the internal resistive fault then falls in the Zone 1 operating characteristic.
However, for short lines the load angle is relatively low when compared to long transmission lines for the same
transfer capacity and therefore the impedance reach line dynamic tilting may be moderate. Therefore it may be
necessary to reduce the Zone 1 reach to guarantee Zone 1 stability. This is particularly recommended if the
distance protection is operating in an aided scheme. To summarise, for very short lines with large R/X setting
ratios, we recommend settiing the initial tilt angle to zero and the Zone 1 reach to 70-75% of the line impedance.
The above discussion assumes homogenous networks where the angle of the negative sequence current derived
at relaying point is very close to the total fault current angle. If the network is non-homogenous, there is a
difference in angle that causes inaccurate dynamic tilting. Therefore in such networks either quadrilateral with
fixed tilt angle or mho characteristic should be considered to avoid Zone 1 overreach.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 153
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Note:
You can also use Delta Directional schemes to detect high resistance faults.

6.4.2 FIXED TILTING


As an alternative to dynamic tilting, you can set a fixed tilt angle. This is used for applications where the power flow
direction is unidirectional.

Exporting End
To secure stability, the tilt angle of Zone 1 at the exporting end has to be set negative and above the maximum
angle difference between sources feeding the resistive faults. This data should be known from load flow study, but
if unavailable, the minimum recommended setting would be the angle difference between voltage and current
measured at local end during the heaviest load condition coupled with reduced Zone 1 reach of 70-75% of the line
impedance.

Note:
With a sharp fixed tilt angle, the effective resistive coverage would be significantly reduced. Therefore for short lines, dynamic
tilting (with variable tilt angle depending on fault resistance and location) is preferred. For all other overreaching zones, set the
tilting angle to zero.

Importing End
Set zone 1 tilt angle to zero and for all other zones the typical setting should be positive and between +5° and +10°.

Note:
The setting accuracy for overreaching zones is not crucial because it does not pose a risk for distance maloperation. The
purpose is to boost Zone 2 and Zone 4 reach and improve the performance of Aided Schemes.

6.5 PHASE FAULT ZONE SETTINGS


If you use the Advanced Setting Mode, in addition to the reach and compensation settings, you have additional
settings to enter.
Each zone has a minimum current sensitivity setting (Zn Sensit. Iph>) which sets the minimum current that must
be flowing in each of the faulted phases before a trip can occur. It is recommended to leave these settings at their
default. An exception is where the protection is made less sensitive to match with other protection existing on the
power system, or to grade with the pickup setting of any ground overcurrent protection for tee-off circuits.
When quadrilateral characteristics are used, the tilt angles of the impedance reach lines can be set.
By factory default, the impedance reach lines of the quadrilateral characteristics are not fixed as horizontal
reactance lines. To account for phase angle tolerances in the line transformers, etc., the lines are tilted downwards
at a droop of -3°. This tilt down helps to prevent Zone 1 overreach.
The fixed tilt setting on the phase elements may also be used to compensate for overreach effects when pre-fault
heavy load export is flowing. In such cases, fault arc resistance is phase shifted on the impedance polar plot, tilting
down towards the resistive axis and not appearing to be fully resistive in nature. For long lines with heavy power
flow, the zone 1 top line might be tilted downwards in the range –5° to –15°, mimicking the phase shift of the
resistance.

Note:
A negative angle is used to set a downwards tilt gradient, and a positive angle to tilt upwards.

154 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Note:
Mho characteristics have an inherent tendency to avoid unwanted overreaching, making them very desirable for long line
protection.

6.6 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT FOR DISTANCE PROTECTION


Distance zones are directionalized by the Delta decision. For Delta directional decisions, the relay characteristic
angle (RCA) settings must be based on the average source + line impedance angle for a fault anywhere internal or
external to the line. Typically, the Dir Char Angle is set to 60°, as it is not essential for this setting to be precise.
When a fault occurs, the delta current is never close to the characteristic boundary, so an approximate setting is
good enough.
The 60° angle is associated with mainly inductive sources and suits most applications. However, in series
compensated line applications where the capacitor is physically located behind the line voltage transformer, the
Delta directional characteristic angle needs adjusting. In such applications the capacitor is included in the
equivalent source impedance. Then the overall source impedance seen by the protection becomes predominantly
capacitive if the inductance of the normally strong source is less than the capacitor value. In this case, the
calculated operating angle during an internal fault may not fall within the default 60° Delta directional line
operating boundary. This could lead to an incorrect (reverse) directional decision. A zero degree shift is most
suitable for such a fault. However, the constraining factor is the case of external faults for which the source is
always inductive regardless of the degree of compensation and for which the 60° shift is most appropriate. To
ensure correct, reliable and fast operation for both fault locations in the case of predominantly capacitive source,
we recommend a Dir Char Angle setting of 30°.

6.7 FILTERING SETUP


A number of filters and features are provided to help avoid false tripping during conditions that can be challenging
to distance protection.

6.7.1 DISTANCE DIGITAL FILTER


In most applications, we recommend setting the Digital Filter setting to Standard. This ensures that the
protection provides fast, sub-cycle tripping. In certain rare cases, such as where lines are immediately adjacent to
High Voltage DC (HVDC) transmission, the current and voltage inputs may be severely distorted under fault
conditions. The resulting non-fundamental harmonics could affect the reach point accuracy of the protection. To
prevent the protection being affected, you should select the Special Applics setting to enable the special
applications filter.

Note:
When using the Special Applications filter the instantaneous operating time is increased by about a quarter of a power
frequency cycle.

6.7.2 SETTING UP CVTS

CVTs with Passive Suppression of Ferroresonance


Set CVT Filters to Passive for any type 2 CVT (those with an anti-resonance design). You need to apply an SIR
cut-off setting, above which the protection operation is deliberately slowed by a quarter of a cycle. A typical SIR
setting is 30, below which the protection trips sub-cycle, and if the infeed is weak the CVT filter adapts to slow the
protection and prevent transient overreach.

CVTs with Active Suppression of Ferroresonance


Set CVT Filters to Active for any type 1 CVT.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 155
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

6.8 LOAD BLINDING SETUP


We strongly recommend enabling the load blinder, especially for lines above 150km (90miles) and for any networks
where power swings might be experienced. This will prevent non-harmonic low-frequency transients causing load
encroachment problems.
The impedance radius must be set lower than the worst-case loading, and this is often taken as 120% overloading
in one line, multiplied by two to account for increased loading during outages or fault clearance in an adjacent
parallel circuit. Then an additional allowance for measuring tolerances results in a recommended setting typically
between a quarter and one third of the rated full load current:
Z <= (Rated phase voltage Vn)/(IFLC x 3)
When the load is at the worst-case power factor, it should remain below the beta (b setting. So, if we assume a
typical worst case 0.85 power factor, then:

b >= Cos-1 (0.85) + 15° margin >= 47°


and to ensure that line faults are detected:
b <= (Line Angle -15°).
In practice, an angle half way between the worst-case leading load angle, and the protected line impedance
angle, is often used.
This product has a facility to allow the load blinder to be bypassed any time that the measured voltage for the
phase in question falls below an undervoltage (Load Blinder V<) setting. Under such circumstances, the low
voltage would not be explained by normal voltage excursion tolerances on-load. A fault must be present on the
phase in question, and it is acceptable to override the blinder action and allow the distance zones to trip according
to the entire zone shape. The benefit is that the resistive coverage for faults near to the protection location can be
higher.
The undervoltage setting must be lower than the lowest phase-neutral voltage under heavy load flow and
depressed system voltage conditions. The recommended Load Blinder V< setting is 70% Vn.

6.9 POLARIZING SETUP


You can choose how much memory polarization to mix with self-polarization using the Dist. Polarizing setting.
Some recommendations are:

Cable applications
Use 20% (0.2) memory. This results in minimum Mho expansion and keeps the protected line section well within the
expanded Mho, thereby ensuring better accuracies and faster operating times for close-up faults. This matches
the guidance previously provided for LFZP123 or LFZR applications for cable feeders

Series compensated lines


Use a mho with the maximum memory polarization (setting = 5). The large memory content ensures correct
operation even with the negative reactance effects of the compensation capacitors seen either within the zones,
or within the line impedance.

Short lines
For lines shorter than 10miles (16km), or with an SIR higher than 15, use the maximum memory polarization
(setting = 5). This ensures sufficient characteristic expansion to cover fault arc resistance.

General line applications


Use any setting between 0.2 and 1.

156 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

6.10 DELTA DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT SETTING GUIDELINES


For the Delta directional element, the relay characteristic angle (RCA) settings must be based on the average
source + line impedance angle for a fault anywhere internal or external to the line. Typically, the Dir Char Angle is
set to 60°, as it is not essential for this setting to be precise. When a fault occurs, the delta current will never be
close to the characteristic boundary, so an approximate setting can be applied.

6.10.1 DELTA THRESHOLDS


For best performance, set the Dir. I Fwd current threshold at 10 to 20% In. This ensures detection of all fault types
if the fault current contribution to an earth fault at the remote end of the line generates at least this amount of
delta. To select the correct Delta V Forward setting, refer to the following table which compares SIR (Source to Line
impedance ratio) with recommended Delta V Forward setting (DV Fwd).
Lowest SIR ratio of the system Recommended DV Fwd (as a % of Vn)
>= 0.3 4%
>= 0.5 6%
>= 1 9%
>= 2 13%
>= 3 15%
>= 5 17%
>= 10 19%
25 – 60 21%

The reverse fault detectors must be set more sensitively, as they are used to invoke the blocking and current
reversal guard elements. We suggest that all reverse detectors are set at 66 to 80% of the setting of the forward
detector, typically:
● Dir. V Rev = Dir. V Fwd x 0.66
● Dir. I Rev = Dir. I Fwd x 0.66
Due to the implementation method, Deltas are present only for 2 cycles on fault inception. If any distance elements
are enabled, these will automatically allow the delta forward or reverse decisions to seal-in, until such time as the
fault is cleared from the system. Therefore as a minimum, some distance zone(s) must be enabled in the DISTANCE
SETUP column as fault detectors. It does not matter what time delay is applied for the zone(s). This can either be
the typical distance delay for that zone or set to ‘Disabled’ in the SCHEME LOGIC column, if no distance tripping is
required. As a minimum, Zone 3 must be enabled, with a reverse reach such as to allow seal-in of Dir. Rev, and a
forward reach to allow seal-in of Dir. Fwd.
The applicable reaches would be:
● Zone 3 Forward: Set at least as long as a conventional Zone 2 (120-150% of the protected line)
● Zone 3 Reverse: Set at least as long as a conventional Zone 4, or supplement by assigning Zone 4 if a large
reverse reach is not preferred for Zone 3.
We generally advise a Mho characteristic in such starter applications, although quadrilaterals are acceptable. As
the Mho starter is likely to have a large radius, we strongly advise applying the Load Blinder.

6.11 DISTANCE PROTECTION WORKED EXAMPLE


This section presents a worked example of how to set the Distance protection. For this case study, we assume that
Zone 1 Extension is not used, and that only three zones are required for basic Distance protection (Zones 1 and 2
Forward Directional, and Zone 3 Forward Offset). The following settings are derived:
● Line Impedance
● Residual Compensation

P446SV-TM-EN-1 157
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

● Zone 1 reach settings for phase-faults and earth-faults


● Zone 2 reach settings for phase-faults and earth-faults
● Zone 3 reach settings for phase-faults and earth-faults
● Zone 3 reverse reach settings
● Zone 4 reach settings (for use with Permissive Overreach or Blocking schemes if needed)
● Load avoidance

The settings are applicable whether the Distance protection characteristics are set to Mho, or Quadrilateral. If you
choose Quadrilateral however, you will need to consider the Resistive reaches of Quadrilaterals.
For this study, we wish to protect one line of a double 230kV, 100km line between a substation at Green Valley and
a substation at Blue river. There are generating sources at Tiger Bay, 80 km from Green Valley and at Rocky Bay, 60
km from Blue River.
The single-line diagram for the system is shown in the following figure:

Green Valley Blue River


Tiger Bay Rocky Bay

100 km
80 km 60 km

IED IED

E02705

Figure 68: Example power system

The system data is as follows:


● System Voltage: 230kV
● System earthing: Solid
● CT ratio: 1200 : 5
● VT ratio: 230 000 : 115
● Line length: 100km
● Positive sequence line impedance (Z1): 0.089 + j0.476 ohms/km = 0.484Ð79.4°
● Zero sequence line impedance (Z0): 0.426 + j1.576 ohms/km = 1.632Ð74.8°
● Z0/Z1: 3.372Ð4.6°
● Green Valley substation fault level: 2000 MVA to 5000 MVA
● Blue river substation fault level: 1000 MVA to 3000 MVA
● Circuit continuous rating: 400 MVA
● Worst case power factor of load: 0.85

6.11.1 LINE IMPEDANCE CALCULATION


Ratio of secondary to primary impedance = (1200/5)/(230000/115) = 0.12
Total primary line impedance (for 100 km length) = 100 x 0.484Ð79.4° W
Total secondary impedance = (0.12 x 100 x 0.484)Ð79.4° = 5.81Ð79.4° W
Therefore set secondary values as follows:
Line Angle = 80°

158 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

Line Impedance = 5.81 W

6.11.2 RESIDUAL COMPENSATION FOR EARTH FAULT ELEMENTS


The residual compensation factor can be applied independently to certain zones if required. This is a useful feature
where line impedance characteristics change between sections or where hybrid circuits are used. In this example
this is not the case, so a common kZN factor can be applied to each zone. This is set as ratio kZN Res Comp, and
angle KZN Res Angle:
We know that
kZN = (Z0 - Z1)/3Z1
Now, performing the calculations iwht the given values ...
|Z0 - Z1| = 1.15
|3Z1| = 1.452
Ð(Z0-Z1) = 72.9°
Ð3Z1 = 79.4°
Thus ...
kZN = 0.79 Ð 6.5°

Therefore set:
kZN Res Comp = 0.79
KZN Res Angle = -6.5°

6.11.3 ZONE 1 PHASE AND GROUND REACH SETTINGS


For the protection at Green Valley:
The required Zone 1 reach is to be 80% of the line impedance between Green Valley and Blue River substations.
Using the Setting Mode Simple:
● Set Zone 1 Ph Status and Zone 1 Gnd Stat. to Enabled
● Set Zone 1 Ph Reach and Zone 1 Gnd Reach to 80%

From this the protection algorithm automatically calculates the required Ohmic reaches.
Alternatively, using the Setting Mode Advanced, the values can be calculated and entered manually as follows:
Required Zone 1 reach = 0.8 x 100 x 0.484Ð79.4° x 0.12 = 4.64Ð79.4° W secondary
So:
● Set Z1 Ph. Reach and Z1 Gnd. Reach = 4.64 W
● Set Z1 Ph. Angle and Z1 Gnd. Angle = 80°

6.11.4 ZONE 2 PHASE AND GROUND REACH SETTINGS


For the protection at Green Valley:
In Advanced mode:
Required Zone 2 impedance = line impedance of Green Valley to Blue River + 50% line impedance
from Blue River to Rocky Bay

P446SV-TM-EN-1 159
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

= (100+30) x 0.484Ð79.4° x 0.12


= 7.56 Ð79.4° W secondary
So:
● Set Z2 Ph. Reach and Z2 Gnd. Reach = 7.56 W
● Set Z2 Ph. Angle and Z2 Gnd. Angle = 80°

Alternatively, in Simple setting mode, this reach can be set as a percentage of the protected line. Typically a
figure of at least 120% of the line between Green Valley and Blue River is used.

6.11.5 ZONE 3 PHASE AND GROUND REACH SETTINGS


For the protection at Green Valley:
In Advanced mode:
Required Zone 3 impedance = 1.2(line impedance of Green Valley to Blue River) + line impedance
from Blue River to Rocky Bay
= 1.2*(100+60) x 0.484Ð79.4° x 0.12
= 11.15 Ð79.4° W secondary
So:
● Set Z3 Ph. Reach and Z2 Gnd. Reach = 11.15 W
● Set Z2 Ph. Angle and Z2 Gnd. Angle = 80°

Alternatively, in Simple setting mode, this reach can be set as a percentage of the protected line.

6.11.6 ZONE 3 REVERSE REACH SETTINGS


For the protection at Green Valley:
In the absence of special requirements, because the protected line length is more than 30km, Zone 3 can be given
a small reverse reach – say 10%.
Using Advanced mode, in the DISTANCE SETUP column, set:
● Z3' Ph Rev Reach and Z3' Gnd Rev Rch = 0.1*5.81 = 0.58 W

6.11.7 ZONE 4 REVERSE REACH SETTINGS


For the protection at Green Valley:
Where Zone 4 is used to provide reverse directional decisions for Blocking or Permissive Overreach schemes, Zone
4 must reach further behind the local protection than Zone 2 of the remote protection. This can be achieved by
setting Zone 4 ³ 1.2 x Remote Zone 2 reach, where mho characteristics are used.
Remote Zone 2 Reach = line impedance of Green Valley to Blue River + 50% line impedance from
Green valley to Tiger Bay
= (100 + 40) x 0.484Ð79.4° x 0.12
= 8.13Ð79.4° W secondary
Zone 4 Reach ³ (8.13Ð79.4° x 120%) - 5.81Ð79.4°
= 3.95Ð79.4° W secondary

160 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

This is the minimum Zone 4 Reach setting, so:


● Set Z4 Ph. Reach and Z4 Gnd. Reach = 3.96 W
● Set Z4 Ph. Angle and Z4 Gnd. Angle = 80°

6.11.8 LOAD AVOIDANCE


The maximum full load current of the line can be determined from the calculation:
IFLC = [(Rated MVAFLC) / (Ö3 x Line kV)]
The settings must allow for a level of overloading, typically a maximum current of 120% IFLC prevailing on the
system transmission lines. Also, for a double circuit line, during the auto-reclose dead time of fault clearance on
the adjacent circuit, twice this level of current may flow on the healthy line for a short period of time. Therefore the
circuit current loading could be 2.4 x IFLC.
With such a heavy load flow, the system voltage may be depressed, typically with phase voltages down to 90% of
Vn nominal.
Allowing for a tolerance in the measuring circuit inputs (line CT error, VT error, protection accuracy, and safety
margin), this results in a load impedance which might be 3 times the expected rating.
To avoid the load, the blinder impedance needs to be set:
Z £ (Rated phase-ground voltage Vn) / (IFLC x 3)
= (115/√3) / (IFLC x 3)
Set the V< Blinder voltage threshold at the recommended 70% of Vn = 66.4 x 0.7 = 45 V.

6.11.9 QUADRILATERAL RESISTIVE REACH SETTINGS


If applying Quadrilateral characteristics, as well as the Impedance Reaches, the Resistive Reaches also need to be
considered. The Resistive reaches of the phase-fault elements must be set to cover the maximum expected phase-
to-phase fault resistance. The Resistive reaches of the earth-fault elements should take into account the arc-
resistance and the tower footing resistance.

Phase-Fault Elements
Ideally, the Resistive reach should be set greater than the maximum fault arc resistance for a phase-phase fault
(Ra), calculated in terms of the minimum expected phase-phase fault current, the maximum phase conductor
separation, according to the formula developed by (van) Warrington as:
Ra = (28710 x L)/If x 1.4
where:
● If = Minimum expected phase-phase fault current (A)
● L = Maximum phase conductor separation (m)

Typical figures for Ra are given, for different values of minimum expected phase fault currents, in the following
table:

Conductor spacing Typical system Ra for Ra for Ra for


(m) voltage (kV) If = 1 kA If = 2 kA If = 3 kA
4 110 - 132 7.2 W (primary) 2.8 W (primary) 1.6 W (primary)
8 220 - 275 14.5 W (primary) 5.5 W (primary) 3.1 W (primary)
11 380 - 400 19.9 W (primary) 7.6 W (primary) 4.3 W (primary)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 161
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

Note:
For circuits with infeed from more than one terminal, the fault resistance will appear greater. This is because the protection
cannot measure the current contribution from a remote terminal. The apparent fault resistance increase could be between 2
to 8 times the calculated resistance. For this reason, we recommended setting the zone Resistive reaches to 4 times the
calculated arc resistance.

In this example, the minimum phase fault level is 1000 MVA. This is equivalent to an effective short-circuit fault
feeding impedance of:

Z = kV2/MVA = 2302/1000 = 53 W (primary)


The lowest phase fault current level is equivalent to:
Ifault = (MVA x 1000)/(Ö3 x kV)
= (1000 x 1000)/(Ö3 x 230)
= 2.5 kA
Giving, according to the (van) Warrington formula, an arc resistance of:
Ra = 4 W
Iterative calculations could be performed to refine the expected fault current (which decreases as refined values of
Ra are included in the calculation), but as Ra is relatively small compared to the initially calculated value of Z, this
value is acceptable.
To compensate for remote infeed a small additional factor can be added to account for the expected fault current
being lower than that used in the calculation. So rather than set the zone Resistive reaches to 4 times the
calculated arc resistance, a factor of 5 could be used.
Using a factor of 5 gives a minimum setting of:
Phase Resistive Reach = 5 x Ra = 20 W (primary value)
The Phase Resistive Reach could be set higher than this (for example using the rule-of-thumb: [2.3 - 0.0045 x Line
length (km)] x Zone 1 reach), so typically it would be set higher than 20Ω but lower than the Load Avoidance
setting.

Earth-Fault Elements
Fault resistance would comprise arc-resistance and tower footing resistance. A typical resistive reach coverage
setting would be 40 W (primary).
For high resistance earth faults, the situation could arise where no distance elements would operate. In such
cases, supplementary earth fault protection (for example Aided DEF protection) should be applied. If
supplementary earth fault protection is used, large resistive reaches for Earth-Fault Distance protection do not
need to be used so that the Earth-Fault Resistive reach can be set according to the utility practice. In the absence
of specific guidance, a recommendation for setting Zone 1 is:
● Cables: Resistive Reach = 3 x Zone 1 reach
● Overhead lines: Choose Resistive Reach in the range [2.3 - 0.0045] x Line length(km) x Zone 1 Reach
● Lines longer than 400 km: Choose Resistive Reach = 0.5 x Zone 1 Reach

6.12 TEED FEEDER APPLICATIONS


Distance protection can be applied to protect three terminal lines (teed feeders). Interconnecting three terminals,
however, affects the apparent impedances seen by the distance elements and creates certain problems.
Consider, as an example, the following figure which represents a teed feeder with terminals A, B, and C, with a fault
applied near to terminal B:

162 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection

A B
Ia Ib

Zat
Zbt

Ic
Zct

Va
Va = Ia Zat + Ib Zbt C Impedance seen by relay A =
Ia
Ia = Ia + Ic

E03524

Figure 69: Apparent Impedances seen by Distance Protection on a Teed Feeder

The impedance seen by the distance elements at terminal A is given by:


Za = Zat + Zbt + [Zbt.(Ic/Ia)]
For faults beyond the Tee point, with infeed from terminals A and C, the distance elements at A (and C) will
underreach. If terminal C is a relatively strong source, the underreaching effect at A can be substantial. If Zone 2
was set to a typical value of 120% of line AB, the element may fail to operate for internal faults. To compensate,
the Zone 2 element must be set to further overreach by a factor which takes into account the effect of the infeed
from the tee-point.
So, if infeed is present on a teed circuit, all Zone 2 elements should be set to overreach both of their remote
terminals by a factor which takes into account the effect of the infeed from the tee-point.
Like overreaching of Zone 2 elements, underreaching of Zone 1 elements must also be assured. Zone 1 elements
at each terminal must be set to underreach the true impedance to their nearest terminal (limiting case = no infeed
to the tee-point - hence no overreach contribution).
Changing the reach requirements to match the infeed expectations is possible using the alternative setting group
feature. Tailoring setting group contents to the different conditions, coupled with appropriate setting group
switching, enables the changing reach requirements to be met.
Carrier aided schemes can also be used in conjunction with distance elements to protect teed feeders. Although
Permissive Overreaching and Permissive Underreaching schemes may be used, they suffer some limitations.
Blocking schemes are generally considered to be the most suitable.
For a full explanation of Teed Feeders applications in carrier aided schemes, please refer to the Carrier Aided
Schemes chapter.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 163
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV

164 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 8

CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES


Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

166 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 167
Introduction 168
Carrier Aided Schemes Implementation 169
Aided Distance Scheme Logic 171
Aided DEF Scheme Logic 184
Aided Delta Scheme Logic 195
Application Notes 202

P446SV-TM-EN-1 167
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION
The provision of communication channels between the terminals of a protected transmission line or distribution
feeder enables unit protection to be applied.
Protection devices located at different terminals can be configured to communicate with one another in order to
implement unit protection schemes. The exchange of simple ON/OFF command signals allows unit protection to
be achieved with Distance Protection schemes (Aided Distance), Directional Earth Fault schemes (Aided DEF) and if
applicable, Delta Directional Comparison Protection schemes (Aided Delta). Schemes where a communication
channel is used to send command signals between line ends are known as Carrier Aided Schemes.
The terms ‘simplex’ and ‘duplex’ are used to describe the type of communication channel used. Simplex
communication, also sometimes referred to as half-duplex, requires only a single communication channel
between line ends. Signals can be sent in both directions but not at the same time. Duplex communication requires
two communication channels between line ends (one in each direction). Duplex communication allows signals to
be sent and received at the same time.

168 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

3 CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES IMPLEMENTATION


With Aided Distance protection, tripping schemes are used to connect similar devices at different terminals on the
protected line to provide fast clearance for faults anywhere along the line.
For distance protection It is typical to set Zone 1 distance protection elements to cover only 80% of a line from the
relaying point. Faults on the other 20% of the line would generally be cleared by a delayed Zone 2 element, which
could be hundreds of milliseconds after the fault inception. There is, however, a limit to the amount of arc reistance
and tower footing resistance that can be adequately covered by distance IEDs, since the coverage is limited by
their ohmic reach. If extremely high values of ground fault resistance are expected, then an optional directional
comparison earth fault scheme (Aided DEF) can be used to complement the distance schemes.
Aided distance schemes assure fast clearance for faults on the entire circuit by communicating command signals.
For the the communication between local and remote terminals InterMiCOM 64 (IM64) can be used.

3.1 CARRIER AIDED SCHEME TYPES


This product has two independent Carrier Aided Schemes (Aided Scheme 1 and Aided Scheme 2). The two schemes
are independent, but the design of both is the same. Each of the two Carrier Aided Schemes provides the following
options:
● Permissive Underreaching Schemes (PUR, PUTT)
● Permissive Overreaching Schemes (POR, POTT)
● Blocking Scheme (Block 1)
● Blocking Scheme (Block 2)
● Unblocking POR Scheme
● Unblocking PUR Schemes
● Programmable
● Programmable Unblocking

The underreaching options can be used to implement Carrier Aided Distance schemes. The other options can be
used with any Carrier Aided scheme application.
The following diagram shows how the schemes can be assigned.

Scheme Aided 1 Aided 2

Scheme Category Underreaching Overreaching


Scheme Mode PUR PUR Unblocking POR POR Unblocking Block 1 Block 2 Prog Unblock Prog

Scheme Function Aided Distance Aided Distance Aided DEF Aided Delta*

*Not P445
V03500

Figure 70: Scheme Assignment

P446SV-TM-EN-1 169
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

3.2 DEFAULT CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES


This product provides support for two Carrier Aided schemes, which can operate in parallel. The schemes are
referred to as ‘Aided Scheme 1’ and ‘Aided Scheme 2’. The schemes have been designed to operate independently
with a separate communication channel dedicated to each one, but they can share a single communication
channel if necessary. If both schemes are used and they share a common channel then, if one of the schemes
initiates transmission of a command signal, both schemes will receive the command and act upon it.
If you don’t want to use the Aided schemes, you should set the relevant Aid. 1 Selection and Aid.2 Selection
settings (in the SCHEME LOGIC column) to Disabled. If the setting(s) are enabled, you are provided with a choice
of schemes; standard transfer tripping schemes, blocking schemes, or custom programmable schemes.
You select the type of scheme you want to use, and then you choose whether to use it in conjunction with the
Distance protection, and/or the Aided DEF protection.
The scheme options are:
● Disabled: No scheme is implemented
● PUR: Permissive Underreach Transfer Tripping (PUPP, PUR, or PUTT) scheme
● PUR Unblocking: Perrmissive Underreach Unblocking scheme
● POR: Permissive Overreach Transfer Tripping (POP, POR, or POTT) scheme
● POR Unblocking: Permissive Overreach Unblocking scheme
● Blocking1: Current reversal guard signal is sent to qualify reverse looking Zone 4 elements
● Blocking2: Received current reversal guard signal qualifies reverse looking Zone 4 elements
● Prog. Unblocking: Allows you to define which elements are used to assert signals for Overreach
Unblocking.
● Programmable: Allows you to define which elements are used to assert signals for Overreach Transfer
Tripping, by using a custom send mask

Note:
The PUR schemes are only suitable for Distance protection. Therefore, if a PUR scheme is selected, the option to allocate to
other protection is not available.

170 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

4 AIDED DISTANCE SCHEME LOGIC


When the Carrier Aided schemes are used in conjunction with the Distance protection, you can choose whether to
use them with the phase distance elements only, the earth-fault (ground) distance elements only, or for both
phase and earth fault elements.

4.1 PERMISSIVE UNDERREACH SCHEME


The simplest Carrier Aided scheme mode for use with distance-type applications is the Permissive Under-reach
Protection scheme, variously referred to as PUR, PUP, and PUTT. We normally use the term PUR.
To use this scheme, you need to set the relevant setting (Aid. 1 Selection or Aid. 2 Selection) in the SCHEME LOGIC
column to PUR.
The channel for a PUR scheme is keyed (that means that the aiding signal is asserted) if an under-reaching Zone 1
element operates. If the remote device detects a forward fault and this signal is received, then the remote
protection operates without further delay. Faults in the last 20% of the protected line are therefore cleared with
minimal time delay.

Note:
This assumes a 20% typical end-zone when Zone 1 is set to 80% of the protected line.

The following are some of the main features and requirements for a permissive under-reaching scheme.
● Only a simplex channel is required.
● Scheme security is high, because the signalling channel is only keyed for faults in the protected line.
● If the circuit breaker at the remote terminal is open, faults in the remote 20% of the line are cleared using
the Zone 2 time delay of the local protection.
● If there is a weak-infeed, or zero-infeed from the remote terminal, (current below the protection sensitivity),
faults in the remote 20% of the line are cleared using the Zone 2 time delay of the local protection.
● If the signalling channel fails, basic distance scheme tripping remains available.
The PUR logic is:
● Send logic: Assert signal if Zone 1 element operates
● Permissive trip logic: Trip if the Zone 2 element picks up AND the Carrier Aided signal is received

The figure below shows the simplified scheme logic:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 171
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
A B
Z

Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3

CRx CRx
CTx CTx

& &

Z1 Z1
TZ1 TZ1
Trip A Trip B 1
1
Zp TZp Zp
TZp

Z2 TZ2 Z2
TZ2

Z3 TZ3 Z3
TZ3

Z4 TZ4 Z4
TZ4

Optional features of scheme

E03501

Figure 71: Aided Distance PUR scheme

4.2 PERMISSIVE OVER-REACH SCHEME


Permissive Over-reach schemes are variously referred to as POR, POP, POTT. We normally use the term POR.
In a Permissive Overreach scheme the channel is keyed (that means that the aiding signal is asserted) by the
pickup of an over-reaching Zone 2 element.
To use this scheme, you need to set the relevant setting (Aid. 1 Selection or Aid. 2 Selection) in the SCHEME LOGIC
column to POR.
If a remote protection element detects a forward fault and receives a POR signal, the protection operates without
further delay. Faults in the last 20% of the protected line are therefore cleared with minimal time delay.

Note:
This assumes a 20% typical end-zone when Zone 1 is set to 80% of the protected line.

172 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

The following are some of the main features and requirements for a POR scheme:
● The scheme requires a duplex signalling channel to prevent possible maloperation if a carrier is keyed for an
external fault. Because the signalling channel can be keyed for faults external to the protected zone, it is
vital that they are only received by, and acted upon by, the intended recipient. A simplex channel cannot
assure this.
● A POR scheme may be more advantageous than a PUR scheme for the protection of short transmission
lines. This is because the resistive coverage of the Zone 2 elements may be greater than that of the Zone 1
elements (in the case of Mho elements)
● Current reversal guard logic prevents healthy-line protection maloperation for high speed current reversals
that can be experienced on double circuit line applications, which can be caused by sequential opening of
circuit breakers.
● If the signalling channel fails, basic distance scheme tripping remains available.

The POR logic is:


● Send logic: Assert signal if Zone 2 element picks up.
● Permissive trip logic: Trip if the Zone 2 element operates AND the Channel Aided signal is received.

The POR scheme also uses the reverse looking zone 4 as a reverse fault detector. This is used in the current
reversal logic and in the weak infeed echo feature, shown dotted in the figure below:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 173
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Zone 4

Zone 3
Zone 2

Zone 1
Z B

Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 4

CB Open & & CB Open

CRx CRx
Zone 4 & & Zone 4
CTx CTx
1 1

LD0V LD0V
& &

& &

Z1 Z1
TZ1 Trip A Trip B
TZ1
1 1

ZP TZP ZP
TZP

Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2

Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3

Z4 TZ4 TZ4 Z4

Selectable features
E03502

Figure 72: Aided Distance POR scheme

The POR scheme is enhanced by POR Trip Reinforcement, and POR Weak Infeed features.

4.2.1 PERMISSIVE OVERREACH TRIP REINFORCEMENT


The send logic in the POR scheme is arranged so that for any trip command at a local end, the local protection
sends a Channel Aided signal to the remote end(s). This facilitates fault isolation at each terminal as quickly as
possible. The send signal is generated by the Any Trip command, and it is sent on any channel that is being used.

174 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

This feature is called permissive trip reinforcement. It is designed to ensure that synchronous tripping occurs at all
protected terminals.

4.2.2 PERMISSIVE OVERREACH WEAK INFEED FEATURES


Special weak infeed logic (WI) can be used with the POR schemes. The Weak Infeed setting can be found in the
SCHEME LOGIC column. Weak Infeed can be set to Echo, Echo and Trip, or Disabled.

Weak Infeed Echo


For a POR scheme, a signal is normally sent only if the appropriate signal associated with the pick up of the
sending zone detects a fault. However, under some circumstances, the fault current infeed at one line end may be
so low that it is insufficient to operate any of the distance zones. In another scenario, if a circuit breaker at one of
the terminals is in an open state, the current infeed will be zero. These scenarios are termed Weak Infeed (WI)
conditions. Without special attention they could result in slow fault clearance at the terminal that is feeding the
fault current (called the ‘strong infeed’ terminal). This would typically result in tripping after the Zone 2 time delay
(tZ2). To avoid Zone 2 delayed tripping, a device subject to Weak Infeed conditions can be set to echo signals
received on the Channel Aided link back to the initiating IED without delay. This allows the devices at points of
strong infeed to permissively trip instantaneously.
The Weak Infeed Echo Send logic is:
● No Distance Zone Operation has been detected, but a POR Aided signal has been received.

Weak Infeed Echo and Trip


The Weak infeed echo logic will produce an aided trip at a strong infeed terminal, but it does not produce a trip at
the weak infeed. Setting Weak Infeed to Echo and Trip allows tripping of the weak infeed circuit breaker of a
faulted line. Three undervoltage elements, Va<, Vb< and Vc< are used to detect the line fault at the weak infeed
terminal. This voltage check prevents tripping during spurious operations of the channel or during channel testing.
The Weak Infeed Echo and Trip logic is:
● No Distance Zone Operation has been detected, but a POR signal has been received, AND a V< condition
exists.
Weak infeed tripping is time delayed according to the value set in the WI Trip Delay settingin the SCHEME LOGIC
column. Due to the use of phase segregated undervoltage elements, single-phase tripping can be enabled for WI
trips if required. If single-phase tripping is disabled, under Weak Infeed conditions, three-phase tripping will occur
after the WI Trip Delay time has expired.

4.3 PERMISSIVE SCHEME LOSS OF GUARD


This scheme is intended for use with frequency shift keyed (FSK) power line carrier (PLC) communications.
When the protected line is healthy, a guard frequency is sent between line ends to verify the channel is in service.
However, when a line fault occurs and a permissive trip signal must be sent over the line, the power line carrier
frequency is shifted to a different (trip) frequency. Therefore the distance function should receive either the guard
frequency or the trip frequency, but not both together. For certain fault types, the line fault can attenuate the PLC
signals so the permissive signal is lost and not received at the other line end. To overcome this problem, when the
guard is lost and no trip frequency is received, the protection opens a window of time during which the permissive
scheme logic acts as though a trip signal had been received. Two opto-isolated inputs need to be assigned: One is
for Channel Receive; The second is designated Loss of Guard (the inverse function to guard received).
The Loss of Guard logic is described in the table below:
Permissive channel Permissive Alarm
System condition Loss of guard
received trip allowed generated
Healthy Line No No No No
Internal Line Fault Yes Yes Yes No

P446SV-TM-EN-1 175
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Permissive channel Permissive Alarm


System condition Loss of guard
received trip allowed generated
Yes, during a 150 ms Yes, delayed on pickup by
Unblock No Yes
window 150 ms
Yes, delayed on pickup by
Signalling Anomaly Yes No No
150 ms

The window of time during which the unblocking logic is enabled starts 10ms after the guard signal is lost, and
continues for 150ms. The 10ms delay gives time for the signalling equipment to change frequency, as in normal
operation. For the duration of any alarm condition, Zone 1 extension logic is invoked if the Z1 Ext Scheme setting is
set to operate for channel failure.

4.4 CURRENT REVERSAL GUARD LOGIC


For double circuit lines, the fault current direction can change in one circuit when circuit breakers open
sequentially to clear the fault on the parallel circuit. The change in current direction causes the overreaching
distance elements to see the fault in the opposite direction to the direction in which the fault was initially detected
(settings of these elements exceed 150% of the line impedance at each terminal). The race between operation and
resetting of the overreaching distance elements at each line terminal can cause permissive overreach, and
blocking schemes to trip the healthy line. A system configuration that could result in current reversals is shown in
the figure below. For a fault on line L1 close to circuit breaker B, as circuit breaker B trips it causes the direction of
current flow in line L2 to reverse. Current reversal guard logic is incorporated in this product to prevent POR and
Blocking schemes from tripping incorrectly during current reversal conditions.

t2(C) t2(D)
Fault Fault
A L1 B A L1 B

Strong Weak
source C L2 D source C L2 D

Note how after circuit breaker B on line L1 opens


the direction of current flow in line L2 is reversed.
E03503

Figure 73: Example of fault current reversal of direction

The current reversal guard incorporated in the permissive overreach scheme logic is initiated when the reverse
looking Zone 4 elements operate on a healthy line.
Once the reverse looking Zone 4 elements have operated, the permissive trip logic and signal send logic are
inhibited at substation D. The reset of the current reversal guard timer is initiated when the reverse looking Zone 4
resets. A time delay tReversal Guard is required in case the overreaching trip element at end D operates before
the signal send from the protection at end C has reset. Otherwise this would cause the product at D to overreach.
Permissive tripping for the products at D and C substations is enabled again once the faulted line is isolated and
the current reversal guard time has expired.
The current reversal guard incorporated in the blocking scheme logic is initiated when a blocking element picks-up
to inhibit the channel-aided trip. When the current reverses and the reverse looking Zone 4 elements reset, the
blocking signal is maintained by the timer tReversal Guard. Therefore, the protections in the healthy line are
prevented from overreaching due to the sequential opening of the circuit breakers in the faulted line. After the
faulted line is isolated, the reverse-looking Zone 4 elements at substation C and the forward looking elements at
substation D reset.

176 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

Two variants of Blocking scheme are available:


● Blocking 1 (Reversal Guard applied to the Signal Send)
● Blocking 2 (Reversal Guard applied to the Signal Receive)

4.5 AIDED DISTANCE BLOCKING SCHEMES


Two default Blocking schemes are provided:
● Blocking 1
● Blocking 2

The two schemes are similar. Both schemes feature current reversal guard signals used in conjunction with reverse
looking Zone 4 elements. In the Blocking 1 scheme, the current reversal guard signal applies to the send signal,
whereas in the Blocking 2 scheme, the current reversal guard signal applies to the receive signal.
The signalling channel is keyed from operation of the reverse-looking Zone 4 elements. If the remote zone 2
element picks up, it operates after the trip delay if no block is received. Listed below are some of the main features
and requirements for a Blocking scheme:
● Blocking schemes require only a simplex communication channel.
● Reverse-looking Zone 4 is used to send a blocking signal to the remote end to prevent unwanted tripping.
● When a simplex channel is used, a blocking scheme can easily be applied to a multi-terminal line provided
that outfeed does not occur for any internal faults.
● The blocking signal is transmitted over a healthy line, and so problems associated with power line carrier
signals failing are avoided.
● Blocking schemes provide similar resistive coverage to the permissive overreach schemes.
● Fast tripping occurs at a strong source line end, for faults along the protected line section, even if there is
weak- or zero- infeed at the other end of the protected line.
● If a line terminal is open, fast tripping still occurs for faults along the whole of the protected line length.
● If the signalling channel fails to send a blocking signal during a fault, fast tripping occurs for faults along the
whole of the protected line, but also for some faults in the next line section.
● If the signalling channel is taken out of service, the protection operates in the conventional basic mode.
● A current reversal guard timer is included in the logic to prevent unwanted tripping on healthy circuits
during current reversal situations on a parallel circuits.

The Blocking scheme logic is:


● Send logic: Assert carrier if Reverse Zone 4 element picks up
● Trip logic: Trip if the Zone 2 element picks up if no carrier is received, but only after the Aided Signal Delay
time out
The figure below shows the simplified scheme logic.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 177
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Zone 4

Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
A Z B

Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 4

CRx CRx
Fast Z4 Fast Z4
CTx CTx &
&

& &

Z1 Z1
TZ1 Trip B
TZ1
Trip A
1 1

ZP TZP ZP
TZP

Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2

Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3

Z4 Z4
TZ4 TZ4
Selectable features
E03504

Figure 74: Aided Distance Blocking scheme (BOP)

4.6 AIDED DISTANCE UNBLOCKING SCHEMES


The Unblocking schemes are specifically designed for use with Power Line Carrier (PLC) communications where
different frequencies are used to indicate that a guard (no-fault condition) or a trip (fault condition) signal should
be transmitted to the remote terminal(s). Normally, either a guard signal or a trip signal should be transmitted and
received. Under certain fault conditions however, the PLC signal can be heavily attenuated or even lost completely.
In such conditions, Permissive Overreach Unblocking schemes allow the permissive tripping to operate for a short
period after the carrier is lost. This ensures fast, selective fault clearance.
To use this scheme you need to assign two inputs. Generally, the inputs are mapped to opto-inputs in the default
PSL. The table below shows a default mapping for Aided Scheme 1.

178 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

DDB signal (Opto-input) DDB signal


Input L3 (DDB: 34) Aided 1 Scheme Rx (DDB: 493)
Input L4 (DDB: 35) Aided 1 COS/LGS (DDB: 492)

The Aided 1 Scheme RX signal corresponds to a 'channel-receive' signal for scheme 1. The Aided 1 COS/LGS signal
corresponds to a 'channel out of service' or 'loss of guard' signal ('Loss of guard' is the inverse signal to 'guard
received').
As well as the default mapping, it is possible to map the signals to other inputs if required.
The window during which the unblocking logic is enabled starts 10ms after the guard signal is lost and continues
for 150ms. The 10ms delay gives time for the signalling equipment to change frequency.

Note:
If the Z1 Ext Scheme setting is set to operate for channel failure, the Zone 1 extension logic will be invoked if a channel failure
is detected.

This scheme type also provides Loss of Guard logic as described below.
Permissive Permissive Alarm
System condition Loss of guard
channel received trip allowed generated
Healthy Line No No No No
Internal Line Fault Yes Yes Yes No
Unblock No Yes Yes, during a 150 ms window Yes, delayed on pickup by 150 ms
Signalling Anomaly Yes No No Yes, delayed on pickup by 150 ms

P446SV-TM-EN-1 179
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

4.7 AIDED DISTANCE LOGIC DIAGRAMS

4.7.1 AIDED DISTANCE SEND LOGIC

Aid 1 Distance
Scheme options *

Custom Send Mask


394
Masking options * Aid1 InhibitDist

960
Zone1 AN Element
961 &
Zone1 BN Element 1 1 &
1
962
Zone1 CN Element
963
Zone1 AB Element
964
&
Zone1 BC Element 1
965
Zone1 CA Element 1
&
966
Zone2 AN Element
967 &
Zone2 BN Element 1 1
968
Zone2 CN Element
969
Zone2 AB Element Signal Send
970 &
Zone2 BC Element 1 Echo Send
971
Zone2 CA Element 1
& 498
Zone4 AN Element 984 1
& Aided 1 Send
985
& tRG
Zone4 BN Element 1 1
986
Zone4 CN Element From Aided 1 DEF
987 From Aided 1 Delta
Zone4 AB Element
& (if applicable)
988
Zone4 BC Element 1
989 Blk Send
Zone4 CA Element
497
Aid1 Custom Send

496
Notes: Aid1 Block Send
This example assumes zone 2 distance phase and distance ground
elements are enabled .
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V03505

Figure 75: Aided Distance Send logic

4.7.2 CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES RECEIVE LOGIC

& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR

&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&

493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508

Figure 76: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic

180 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

4.7.3 AIDED DISTANCE TRIPPING LOGIC


394
Aid1 InhibitDist

501
Aid1 Trip Enable
1
502
Aid1 Custom Trip tDST
1
503
1 Aid 1 Dist Trip
966
Zone2 AN Element
&
1 & 633
& 1 Aided 1 Trip A
967
Zone2 BN Element
&
1 & 634
& 1 Aided 1 Trip B
968
Zone 2 CN Element
&
1 & 635
& 1 Aided 1 Trip C

Aid 1 Distance
1 1 & 636
Ground Only & 1 Aided 1 Trip N
Phase And Ground From Aided 1 Def Trip A
Phase Only 1 From Aided 1 Delta Trip A (if applicable)
From Aided 1 Def Trip B
From Aided 1 Delta Trip B (if applicable)
969
From Aided 1 Def Trip C
Zone2 AB Element From Aided 1 Delta Trip C (if applicable)
&
From Aided 1 Def Trip N
970
From Aided 1 Delta Trip N (if applicable )
Zone2 BC Element
& Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown.
971
Zone2 CA Element
&
V03509

Figure 77: Aided Distance Tripping logic

4.7.4 PUR AIDED TRIPPING LOGIC

Aid. 1 Selection
PUR
501
& Aid1 Trip Enable
Aided 1 Receive 494 100 ms

V03512

Figure 78: PUR Aided Tripping logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 181
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

4.7.5 POR AIDED TRIPPING LOGIC


494
Aided 1 Receive
& 501
Aid. 1 Selection & Aid1 Trip Enable

POR

Distance signal send

DEF signal send 1


tReversal Guard
Delta signal send

Any Zone 4 element

Delta reverse element 1 & Blk Send


1 tRGD
DEF reverse element

522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send

Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms

Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639

Echo 1 Aid 1 WI Trip C

Echo and Trip


& S
Signal Send Q
100 ms R

&

Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514

182 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

Figure 79: POR Aided Tripping logic

4.7.6 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 1 TRIPPING LOGIC


498
Aided 1 Send
1
494 501
Aided 1 Receive 1 Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03516

Figure 80: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic

4.7.7 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 2 TRIPPING LOGIC

tReversal Guard

498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03517

Figure 81: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 183
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

5 AIDED DEF SCHEME LOGIC

5.1 AIDED DEF INTRODUCTION


High resistance faults may be difficult to detect using distance protection. A Directional Earth Fault DEF element is
sometimes used in conjunction with a communication scheme to provide protection against such faults. The use
of Aided-Trip logic in conjunction with the DEF element allows faster trip times, and can facilitate single-phase
tripping, if needed.
To use the Aided DEF protection you will need appropriate communication channels between terminals in the
scheme. The Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL) allows you to map signals for communication over the channels.
The signals you map may be signals to be sent to a remote terminal, or signals expected to be received from a
remote terminal. Two Aided DEF schemes are available.
With Aided DEF protection, the residual current (earth fault current) is compared with a threshold to determine the
presence of a fault, and a directionalising quantity to determine its direction. Directional measurements from
protecting terminals are then used in conjunction with teleprotection signals between the terminals, and aided
scheme logic to determine whether the fault is within the protected line (and hence trip), or outside the protected
line (and hence restrain).

5.2 IMPLEMENTATION
Aided DEF protection can be used with permissive over-reach schemes or blocking schemes.
The Aided DEF protection is enabled using the Directional E/F setting in the CONFIGURATION column. This makes
the settings in the AIDED DEF column visible.
The Aided DEF requires a polarizing quantity (selected in the DEF Polarizing setting) in conjunction with a
characteristic angle setting (DEF Char. Angle) to make the directional decision.
For all models a signal derived from the phase voltage inputs can be used for polarization. For certain models with
more VT inputs, a directly measured input can be used.
You have a choice between Zero Sequence Polarizing or Negative Sequence Polarizing for the Aided DEF element.
If you choose Zero Sequence Polarization, you have a choice to enable an innovative feature known as Virtual
Current Polarization to enhance the Aided DEF function.
Aided DEF protection is blocked if any of the following conditions are met:
● An Any Trip signal is asserted by one of the integrated protection functions
● The phase selector picks up on more than one phase
● Any of the signals Pole Dead A, Pole Dead B, or Pole Dead C are asserted

5.3 AIDED DEF POLARIZATION


There are essentially two ways of esablishing the direction of an earth fault:
● Zero sequence polarization
● Negative sequence polarization

Zero Sequence polarization normally uses the measurement of residual voltage (VN). This can only be achieved if a
5-limb VT or three single-phase VTs are used. A special form of zero sequence polarization called Virtual Current
Polarization is also possible with this device. Virtual Current Polarization allows directionalisation for low levels of
polarization voltage.

184 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

5.3.1 ZERO SEQUENCE POLARIZING


Residual voltage is generated during earth faults. This zero-sequence quantity can be used to polarize the
directional decision of Aided DEF protection. This device can derive residual voltage if connected to a suitable
voltage transformer (VT) arrangement.
For the Aided DEF to use a derived voltage signal, the three phase voltage inputs must be supplied from a 5-limb
VT, or from three single-phase VTs having the primary star-point earthed. These VT arrangements allow the
passage of residual flux and hence allow the device to derive the required residual voltage. A 3-limb VT has no
path for residual flux and is therefore unsuitable for zero-sequence Polarization.
Small levels of residual voltage may be present under normal system conditions due to system imbalances, VT
inaccuracies and device tolerances. You can set a threshold (DEF VNPol Set) to provide stability against Aided DEF
operation under these conditions. Residual voltage (Vres) is nominally 180° out of phase with residual current so
Aided DEF elements are polarized from the -Vres quantity. This 180° phase shift is automatically compensated in
this device.
For products designed to control dual circuit breaker applications you can choose to re-allocate the second check-
synchronism VT to provide a measured voltage input to the Aided DEF function. To do this you need to set VT2
Selection to Broken Delta in the CT AND VT RATIOS COLUMN. This then reveals the DEF Vnpol Input setting in
the AIDED DEF column which can be set to Measured or Derived.

5.3.1.1 VIRTUAL CURRENT POLARIZING


A technique called Virtual Current Polarizing can allow the Aided DEF protection to operate even if the Polarizing
voltage is below the DEF VNPol Set threshold. If the superimposed current phase selector associated with the
Distance protection has identified a faulted phase, for example phase A, it removes that phase voltage from the
residual calculation Va + Vb + Vc, leaving only Vb + Vc. The resultant Polarizing voltage has a large magnitude and
is in the same direction as –Vres. This allows the protection to be applied even where very solid earthing behind
the protection prevents residual voltage from being developed.
This technique of subtracting the faulted phase is described as Virtual Current Polarizing because it removes the
need to use current Polarizing from a current transformer (CT) in a transformer star (wye)-earth connection behind
the device.
If you don’t want to use this feature you should set Virtual I Pol to Disabled so that removal of the faulted
phase voltage from the residual voltage calculation does not happen. The Aided DEF protection is then Polarized
by the residual voltage only.
The directional criteria with zero sequence (virtual current) Polarization are as follows:

Directional forward
90° < (angle(VNpol) +180°) - (angle(IN )- RCA) < 90°

Directional reverse
90° > (angle(VNpol) +180° - (angle(IN) - RCA) > 90°
This is represented in the following figure:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 185
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

IN angle -RCA

IN

For a forward direction, -VN hs to be in the shaded area


V03522 For a reverse direction, -VN has to be in unshaded area

Figure 82: Virtual Current Polarization

The Polarizing voltage (VNpol) is as per the table below and RCA is the relay characteristic angle defined by the
DEF Char. Angle setting.
Phase selector pickup VNpol
A Phase Fault VB + VC
B Phase Fault VA + VC
C Phase Fault VA + VB
No Selection VN = VA + VB + VC

5.3.2 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE POLARIZING


In certain applications, residual voltage polarization of Aided DEF may not be possible, or it may be problematic.
Example cases are:
● Where a 3-limb voltage transformer is fitted, which has no path for residual flux.
● Where the application features a parallel line and zero sequence mutual coupling may exist.

The problems in these applications can be alleviated using negative phase sequence (nps) voltage for polarization.
The nps voltage threshold must be set in the cell DEF V2pol Set.

Note:
The current quantity used for operation of the Aided DEF when it is nps Polarized is the residual current not the nps current.

The directional criteria with negative sequence polarization are as follows:

Directional forward
-90° < [(angle(V2) +180°) - (angle(I2) - RCA) ] < 90°

Directional reverse
-90° > [ (angle(V2) +180°) - angle(I2) - RCA) ] > 90°
where RCA is the relay characteristic angle set in the DEF Char. Angle setting.

186 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

This is represented in the following figure:

I2 angle -RCA

I2

For a forward direction, -V2 hs to be in the shaded area


V03523 For a reverse direction, -V2 has to be in the unshaded area

Figure 83: Directional criteria for residual voltage polarization

5.4 AIDED DEF SETTING GUIDELINES


To use Aided DEF protection you need to set the polarization and the thresholds. Polarization can be achieved
using either zero sequence signals or negative sequence signals.
For zero sequence polarized Aided DEF, the typical zero sequence voltage on a healthy system can be as high as
1% (i.e.: 3% residual), and the voltage transformer (VT) error could be 1% per phase. A VNpol Set setting between
1% and 4%.Vn is typical, to avoid spurious detection on standing signals. The residual voltage measurement
provided in the MEASUREMENTS 1 column may assist in determining the required threshold setting during
commissioning, as this will indicate the level of standing residual voltage present. The Virtual Current Polarizing
feature will create a polarizing voltage, which is always large regardless of whether actual VN is present.
With Aided DEF, the residual current under fault conditions lies at an angle lagging the polarized voltage. Hence,
negative characteristic angle settings are required for Aided DEF applications. This is set in cell DEF Char. Angle in
the EARTH FAULT settings.
The following angle settings are recommended for a residual voltage polarized device:-
● Solidly earthed distribution systems: -45°
● Solidly earthed transmissions systems: -60°

If Virtual I Pol is set to ‘Disabled’ it prevents checking of the faulted phase and subsequent removal of the faulted
phase voltage. The aided DEF protection is then polarized by the residual voltage only.
For negative sequence polarization, the relay characteristic angle settings (DEF Char. Angle) must be based on the
angle of the upstream negative phase sequence source impedance. A typical setting is -60°.
The Aided DEF Forward setting determines the current sensitivity (trip sensitivity) of the aided DEF aided scheme.
This setting must be set higher than any standing residual current unbalance. A typical setting will be between
10% and 20% In.
The Aided DEF Reverse setting determines the current sensitivity for the reverse earth fault. The setting must
always be below the aided DEF forward threshold for correct operation of blocking schemes and to provide
stability for current reversal in parallel line applications. The recommended setting is 2/3 of the Aided DEF forward
setting.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 187
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Note:
The Aided DEF Reverse setting has to be above the maximum steady state residual current imbalance.

5.5 AIDED DEF POR SCHEME


The scheme has the same features and requirements as the corresponding Distance scheme and provides
sensitive protection for high resistance earth faults.
The signalling channel is keyed from operation of the forward DEF Fwd Set element. If the remote device has also
detected a forward fault, it operates with no additional delay when it receives this signal.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Key channel if DEF Fwd Set picks up
● Permissive trip logic: Trip if DEF Fwd Set picks up AND the channel key is received
The figure below shows the element reaches, and the simplified scheme logic of the Aided DEF POR scheme.

188 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

DEF Forward

ZL
A B

DEF Forward

CB Open & & CB Open

CRx CRx
DEF-Reverse & CTx CTx
& DEF-Reverse
1 1

LD0V & LD0V


&

DEF-Forward & & DEF-Forward

Trip Trip
DEF Inst DEF Inst
1 A B
1

DEF Bu1 t
Bu1 t
Bu1 DEF Bu1

DEF Bu2 t DEF Bu2


t
Bu2 Bu2

DEF IDMT t DEF IDMT


t
IDMT IDMT

E03518 Selectable features

Figure 84: Aided DEF POR scheme

5.6 AIDED DEF BLOCKING SCHEME


The scheme has the same features/requirements as the corresponding Distance scheme and provides sensitive
protection for high resistance earth faults.
The signalling channel is keyed from operation of the reverse Aided DEF element (DEF REV Set). If the remote
device’s forward Aided DEF element (DEF FWD Set) has picked up, it operates after the Aid. 1 DEF Dly. expires if no
block is received.
Where ‘t’ is shown in the diagram this signifies the time delay associated with an element. To allow time for a
blocking signal to arrive, a short time delay on aided tripping must be used.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Key channel if DEF REV Set picks up
● Trip logic: Trip if DEF FWD Set AND Channel NOT Received, after Aid. 1 DEF Dly. expires.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 189
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

The figures below show the element reaches, and the simplified scheme logic of the Aided Directional Earth Fault
(Aided DEF) Blocking scheme.

DEF-Forward

DEF-Reverse
ZL
A B

DEF-Forward
DEF-Reverse

CRx CRx
DEF-Reverse Start Start DEF-Reverse
CTx CTx
Stop Stop

DEF-Forward & & DEF-Forward

DEF Inst Trip Trip DEF Inst


1 A B 1

DEF Bu1 t
Bu1 t
Bu1 DEF Bu1

DEF Bu2 t
Bu2 t
Bu2 DEF Bu2

DEF IDMT t
IDMT t
IDMT DEF IDMT

E03519

Figure 85: Aided DEF Blocking scheme

5.7 AIDED DEF LOGIC DIAGRAMS

5.7.1 DEF DIRECTIONAL SIGNALS

DEF Forward element


892 996
Pole Dead A & DEF Forward
893
Pole Dead B 1
894 997
Pole Dead C & DEF Reverse

DEF Reverse element

V03526

Figure 86: DEF Directional Signals

190 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

5.7.2 AIDED DEF SEND LOGIC


From Aided 1 Distance
From Aided 1 Delta
Signal Send
Aid. 1 DEF
Enabled Echo Send
&
Custom Send Mask 1 1
& &
DEF Fwd. 1 498
& Aided 1 Send
996 tRG
DEF Forward
&
Custom Send Mask
DEF Rev.
997
DEF Reverse
395
Aid 1 Inhibit DEF
877
TOC Active

Blk Send
497
Aid1 Custom Send
496
Aid1 Block Send

Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
P445 does not provide an Aided Delta function .
V03506

Figure 87: Aided DEF Send logic

5.7.3 CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES RECEIVE LOGIC

& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR

&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&

493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508

Figure 88: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 191
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

5.7.4 AIDED DEF TRIPPING LOGIC

395
Aid 1 DEF Trip
Aid1 Inhibit DEF
3 Pole
501 1
Aid1 Trip Enable 1 And 3 Pole
1
502
Aid1 Custom Trip
1 tDEF & 641
Aid1 DEF Trip3 Ph
DEF Status &
505
Enabled 1 Aid 1 DEF Trip
&
996
DEF Forward
& 633
& 1 Aided 1 Trip A
1010
Phase Select A
& 634
1011 & 1 Aided 1 Trip B
Phase Select B
& 635
& 1 Aided 1 Trip C
1012
Phase Select C
& 636
1013 & 1 Aided 1 Trip N
Phase Select N

&
1
From Aided 1 Distance Trip A
& From Aided 1 Delta Trip A (if applicable)
From Aided 1 Distance Trip B
From Aided 1 Delta Trip B (if applicable)
& From Aided 1 Distance Trip C
From Aided 1 Delta Trip C (if applicable )
1013
Phase Select N From Aided 1 Distance Trip N
From Aided 1 Delta Trip N (if applicable )
Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
V03510

Figure 89: Aided DEF Tripping logic

192 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

5.7.5 POR AIDED TRIPPING LOGIC


494
Aided 1 Receive
& 501
Aid. 1 Selection & Aid1 Trip Enable

POR

Distance signal send

DEF signal send 1


tReversal Guard
Delta signal send

Any Zone 4 element

Delta reverse element 1 & Blk Send


1 tRGD
DEF reverse element

522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send

Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms

Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639

Echo 1 Aid 1 WI Trip C

Echo and Trip


& S
Signal Send Q
100 ms R

&

Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514

P446SV-TM-EN-1 193
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Figure 90: POR Aided Tripping logic

5.7.6 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 1 TRIPPING LOGIC


498
Aided 1 Send
1
494 501
Aided 1 Receive 1 Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03516

Figure 91: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic

5.7.7 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 2 TRIPPING LOGIC

tReversal Guard

498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03517

Figure 92: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic

194 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

6 AIDED DELTA SCHEME LOGIC


If either a Permissive Overreaching scheme or a Blocking schemes is selected, it can be used to implement
Directional Comparison(Aided Delta) protection.

Caution:
Aided Delta should not be used on a communications channel if that channel is being used to
implement an Aided Distance Scheme or an Aided DEF scheme. You should ensure that the Aided
Distance and Aided DEF elements are disabled if you want to apply the Aided Delta (Directional
Comparison Protection).

6.1 AIDED DELTA POR SCHEME


The channel for an Aided Delta POR scheme is keyed by operation of the overreaching Delta Forward elements. If
the remote device has also detected a forward fault upon receipt of this signal, the protection operates.
If the signalling channel fails, Basic distance scheme tripping is available.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Key channel if a Detla Fault Forward is detected
● Permissive trip logic: Trip if a Delta Fault Forward AND a keyed channel is received.

This scheme is shown in the figure below.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 195
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

DIR REV DIR FWD


Z (T)
H
G

R R

Z (T)

DIR FWD DIR REV

DIR FWD DIR FWD


1 CTX CTX 1

CRX CRX
CB CB
OPEN & Signalling Signalling & OPEN
Equipment Equipment

DIR FWD & & DIR FWD

Trip G Trip H
1 1

TZ (T) TZ (T)
END G END H t
Z t Z
0 0

E03520

Figure 93: Aided Delta POR scheme

6.2 AIDED DELTA BLOCKING SCHEME


The signalling channel is keyed from operation of the Delta Reverse elements. If the remote device has detected
Delta Forward, it operates after the trip delay if no block is received.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Key channel if a Delta Fault Reverse condition is detected
● Trip logic: Trip if a Delta Fault Forward condition is detected, AND a keyed channel signal is NOT received,
before the Aided Delta Delay timer expires.

This scheme is shown in the figure below.

196 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

DIR REV DIR FWD


Z (T)
H
G

R R

Z (T)

DIR FWD DIR REV

DIR REV DIR REV


CTX CTX

CRX CRX
Signalling Signalling
Equipment Equipment

DIR FWD & & DIR FWD

Trip G Trip H
1 1

TZ (T) END G END G TZ (T)


Z t t Z
0 0

E03521

Figure 94: Aided Delta Blocking scheme

P446SV-TM-EN-1 197
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

6.3 AIDED DELTA LOGIC DIAGRAMS

6.3.1 AIDED DELTA SEND LOGIC

Aid. 1 Delta
Enabled

Custom Send Mask


Dir Comp Fwd. From Aided 1 Distance

998
From Aided 1 DEF
Delta Dir Fwd AN
Signal Send
999
Delta Dir Fwd BN
Echo Send
1000
Delta Dir Fwd CN &
1 1 1
Delta Dir Fwd AB 1001 & &
1 498
1002
& Aided 1 Send
Delta Dir Fwd BC tRG
1003
Delta Dir Fwd CA

Custom Send Mask


Dir Comp Rev.

Delta Dir Rev AN 1004 Blk Send

1005
Delta Dir Rev BN Aid1 Custom Send 497

1006
Delta Dir Rev CN &
1 Aid1 Block Send 496
Delta Dir Rev AB 1007

1008
Delta Dir Rev BC
Notes:
1009
Delta Dir Rev CA Aided 1 scheme only shown .
396
Aid1 Inhib Delta V03507

Figure 95: Aided Delta Send logic

6.3.2 CARRIER AIDED SCHEMES RECEIVE LOGIC

& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR

&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&

493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508

Figure 96: Carrier Aided Schemes Receive logic

198 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

6.3.3 AIDED DELTA TRIPPING LOGIC


396
Aid1 Inhib Delta
Aid. 1 DeltaTrip
501
Aid1 Trip Enable 3 Pole
1 1
502
1 And 3 Pole & 640
Aid1 Delta Tr3Ph
Aid1 Custom Trip

Aid. 1 Delta tDIR 504


1 1 Aid 1 Delta Trip
Enabled

& 633
Delta Dir FWD AN 998 & 1 Aided 1 Trip A
1
& 634
Delta Dir FWD BN 999 & 1 Aided 1 Trip B
1
& 635
Delta Dir FWD CN 1000 & 1 Aided 1 Trip C
1
1001
Delta Dir FWD AB & 636
& 1 Aided 1 Trip N
1002
Delta Dir FWD BC 1
From Aided 1 Def Trip A
1003
Delta Dir FWD CA From Aided 1 Distance Trip A
From Aided 1 Def Trip B
From Aided 1 Distance Trip B
Notes: From Aided 1 Def Trip C
Aided 1 scheme only shown . From Aided 1 Distance Trip C
From Aided 1 Def Trip N
V03511 From Aided 1 Distance Trip N

Figure 97: Aided Delta Tripping logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 199
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

6.3.4 POR AIDED TRIPPING LOGIC


494
Aided 1 Receive
& 501
Aid. 1 Selection & Aid1 Trip Enable

POR

Distance signal send

DEF signal send 1


tReversal Guard
Delta signal send

Any Zone 4 element

Delta reverse element 1 & Blk Send


1 tRGD
DEF reverse element

522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send

Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms

Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639

Echo 1 Aid 1 WI Trip C

Echo and Trip


& S
Signal Send Q
100 ms R

&

Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514

200 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

Figure 98: POR Aided Tripping logic

6.3.5 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 1 TRIPPING LOGIC


498
Aided 1 Send
1
494 501
Aided 1 Receive 1 Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03516

Figure 99: Aided Scheme Blocking 1 Tripping logic

6.3.6 AIDED SCHEME BLOCKING 2 TRIPPING LOGIC

tReversal Guard

498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable

492
Aided 1 COS/LGS

V03517

Figure 100: Aided Scheme Blocking 2 Tripping logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 201
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

7 APPLICATION NOTES

7.1 AIDED DISTANCE PUR SCHEME


This scheme allows an instantaneous Zone 2 trip on receipt of the signal from the underreaching element of the
remote end protection.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Zone 1
● Permissive Trip logic: Zone 2 plus channel received

The time delay setting (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.2 Dist. Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.

7.2 AIDED DISTANCE POR SCHEME


This scheme allows This scheme allows an instantaneous Zone 2 trip on receipt of the signal from the
overreaching element of the remote end protection.
The logic is
● Send logic: Zone 2
● Permissive Trip logic: Zone 2 plus channel received

The time delay setting (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.2 Dist. Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.
The POR scheme also uses the reverse looking zone 4 IED as a reverse fault detector. This is used in the current
reversal logic and in the optional weak infeed echo feature.

Weak Infeed
Where weak infeed tripping is employed, a typical voltage setting is 70% of rated phase-neutral voltage. Weak
infeed tripping is time delayed according to the WI Trip Delay value, usually set at 60ms.

Current Reversal Guard


The recommended setting is:
● tReversal Guard = Maximum signalling channel reset time + 60 ms.

7.3 AIDED DISTANCE BLOCKING SCHEME


This scheme uses a reverse looking zone 4 element to block operation of a forward looking zone 2 element at the
remote end protection.
The logic is:
● Send logic: Reverse Zone 4
● Trip logic: Zone 2, plus Channel NOT Received

To allow time for a blocking signal to arrive, a short time delay must be allowed before tripping (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.
2 Dist. Dly). The recommended delay is as follows:
● Recommended setting = Maximum signalling channel operating time + one power frequency cycle.

Note:
Two variants of a Blocking scheme are provided, Blocking 1 and Blocking 2. Both schemes operate similarly, except that the
reversal guard timer location in the logic changes. Blocking 2 may sometimes allow faster unblocking when a fault evolves
from external to internal, and hence a faster trip.

202 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

Current Reversal Guard


The recommended settings are as follows:
● Where Duplex signalling channels are used: Set tReversal Guard to the maximum signalling channel
operating time + 20ms.
● Where Simplex signalling channel is used: Set tReversal Guard to the combination of the maximum
signalling channel operating time, minus the minimum signalling channel reset time, and add 20ms.

7.4 AIDED DEF POR SCHEME


This scheme allows an instantaneous DEF trip of a local terminal if it sees a forward fault AND it receives a signal
from the remote end protection indicating that it is too has seen a forward fault.
The logic is:
● Send logic: DEF forward
● Permissive Trip logic: DEF forward plus channel received

The time delay would normally be set to 0 ms.

7.5 AIDED DEF BLOCKING SCHEME


This scheme prevents DEF tripping of a local terminal if it receives a signal from the remote end protection
indicating that the fault is in the reverse direction, and hence out of zone.
The logic is:
● Send logic: DEF reverse
● Trip logic: DEF forward plus channel NOT received, with a small set delay

To allow time for a blocking signal to arrive, a short time delay on aided tripping must be used. The recommended
delay time setting (Aid. 1 DEF Dly., Aid. 2 DEF Dly.) is the maximum signalling channel operating time +20 ms.

7.6 AIDED DELTA POR SCHEME


This scheme allows an instantaneous Delta trip of a local terminal if it sees a forward fault AND it receives a signal
from the remote end protection indicating that it is too has seen a forward fault.
● Send logic: Delta fault Forward
● Permissive Trip logic: Delta fault Forward plus channel received

The time delay (Aid. 1 Delta Dly, Aid. 2 Delta Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.

Current Reversal Guard


Current reversals during fault clearances on adjacent parallel lines need to be treated with care.To prevent
maloperation, a current reversal guard timer must be set.
The recommended setting (tReversal Guard) is the maximum signalling channel reset time + 35 ms.

7.7 AIDED DELTA BLOCKING SCHEME


This scheme prevents Delta tripping of a local terminal if it receives a signal from the remote end protection
indicating that the fault is in the reverse direction, and hence out of zone.
● Send logic: Delta fault reverse
● Trip logic: Delta fault forward plus channel NOT received, delayed by Tp (a short time delay)

Recommended delay setting (Aid. 1 Delta Dly, Aid. 2 Delta Dly): Maximum signalling channel operating time
+ 6ms.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 203
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

Current Reversal Guard


Current reversals during fault clearances on adjacent parallel lines need to be treated with care.To prevent
maloperation, a current reversal guard timer must be set.
The recommended setting (tReversal Guard) is the maximum signalling channel reset time + 35 ms.

7.8 TEED FEEDER APPLICATIONS


Distance protection can be applied to protect three terminal lines (teed feeders). Interconnecting three terminals,
however, affects the apparent impedances seen by the distance elements and creates certain problems.
Consider, as an example, the following figure which represents a teed feeder with terminals A, B, and C, with a fault
applied near to terminal B:

A B
Ia Ib

Zat
Zbt

Ic
Zct

Va
Va = Ia Zat + Ib Zbt C Impedance seen by relay A =
Ia
Ia = Ia + Ic

E03524

Figure 101: Apparent Impedances seen by Distance Protection on a Teed Feeder

The impedance seen by the distance elements at terminal A is given by:


Za = Zat + Zbt + [Zbt.(Ic/Ia)]
For faults beyond the Tee point, with infeed from terminals A and C, the distance elements at A (and C) will
underreach. If terminal C is a relatively strong source, the underreaching effect at A can be substantial. If Zone 2
was set to a typical value of 120% of line AB, the element may fail to operate for internal faults. To compensate,
the Zone 2 element must be set to further overreach by a factor which takes into account the effect of the infeed
from the tee-point.
So, if infeed is present on a teed circuit, all Zone 2 elements should be set to overreach both of their remote
terminals by a factor which takes into account the effect of the infeed from the tee-point.
Like overreaching of Zone 2 elements, underreaching of Zone 1 elements must also be assured. Zone 1 elements
at each terminal must be set to underreach the true impedance to their nearest terminal (limiting case = no infeed
to the tee-point - hence no overreach contribution).
Changing the reach requirements to match the infeed expectations is possible using the alternative setting group
feature. Tailoring setting group contents to the different conditions, coupled with appropriate setting group
switching, enables the changing reach requirements to be met.

204 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

Carrier aided schemes can also be used in conjunction with distance elements to protect teed feeders. Although
Permissive Overreaching and Permissive Underreaching schemes may be used, they suffer some limitations.
Blocking schemes are generally considered to be the most suitable.

7.8.1 POR SCHEMES FOR TEED FEEDERS


A Permissive Overreach (POR) scheme requires the use of two signalling channels between each pair of terminals.
On a teed feeder, a permissive trip is issued only if local Zone 2 operation is accompanied by receipt of signals from
both remote terminals. The 'AND' function of received signals can either be implemented using external logic, or
within the internal Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL).
To ensure operation for internal faults in a POR scheme, the protection at each of the three terminals should be
able to see a fault anywhere on the protected feeder. This may demand very large Zone 2 reach settings to
address the apparent impedances seen by the Distance elements.
Although POR schemes are feasible for teed feeders, the signalling requirements and the very large Zone 2
settings can make its use unattractive.

7.8.2 PUR SCHEMES FOR TEED FEEDERS


For a Permissive Underrreaching (PUR) scheme, the signalling channel is only keyed for internal faults. The channel
is keyed by Zone 1 operation. Aided tripping will occur at a receiving terminal if its overreaching Zone 2 setting
requirements have been met.
On teed feeder applications, a permissive trip is issued at a terminal if that terminal’s Zone 2 operation is
accompanied by receipt of a signal from EITHER remote terminal. This makes the signalling channel requirements
for a PUR scheme less demanding than for a Permissive Overreach (POR) scheme. Either a common power line
carrier (PLC) signalling channel or a triangulated signalling arrangement can be used, making a PUR scheme
generally more attractive than a POR scheme for protecting for a teed feeder.
It must be recognised, however, that there are cases where instantaneous tripping will not occur with PUR
schemes. The following figure illustrates three cases for which delayed tripping will occur:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 205
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

(i) A B

= area where no zone 1 overlap exists


Z1A Z1C

(ii) A C

Z1A Z1B

Fault Fault seen by A & B in zone 2

(iii) A C B
No infeed

Relay at C sees reverse fault until B opens


E03525

Figure 102: Problematic Fault Scenarios for PUR Scheme Application to Teed Feeders

● Scenario (i) shows a short tee connected to one nearby terminal and one distant terminal. In this case, Zone
1 elements set to 80% of the shortest connected feeder length don’t all overlap, resulting in a section not
covered by any Zone 1 element. Any fault in this section would rely on delayed Zone 2 tripping.
● Scenario (ii) shows an example where terminal C has no infeed. Distance elements at C may not operate for
faults close to the terminal. As the fault is outside the Zone 1 reaches of A and B, clearance will rely on
delayed Zone 2 tripping at A and B.
● Scenario (iii) shows an example where outfeed from terminal C feeds an internal fault via terminal B. In this
case, terminal C will not see the fault until the breaker at B has operated. The result would be sequential
(and hence delayed) tripping.

7.8.3 BLOCKING SCHEMES FOR TEED FEEDERS


With Blocking schemes, high speed operation can be achieved for circuits where there is no current infeed from
one or more terminals. This makes Blocking schemes particularly suitable for protection of teed feeders. The
scheme also has the advantage that the signalling requirement can be realised with one simplex channel.

Note:
Triangulated simplex channels could be used in place of a common simplex one if prefered.

As with Permissive Underreaching (PUR) schemes, a limitation of a Blocking scheme implementation is a scenario
where outfeed from one terminal feeds an internal fault via another terminal. The terminal with the outfeed sees a

206 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes

reverse fault condition. This results in a blocking signal being sent to the two remote terminals. Although the fault
will be cleared, tripping will be prevented until the Zone 2 time delay has expired.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 207
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV

208 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 9

NON-AIDED SCHEMES
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

210 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the distance schemes that do not require communication between the ends (Non-Aided
Schemes).
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 211
Non-Aided Schemes 212
Basic Schemes 213
Trip On Close Schemes 217
Zone1 Extension Scheme 221
Loss of Load Scheme 222

P446SV-TM-EN-1 211
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

2 NON-AIDED SCHEMES
This product provides Distance protection. The Distance protection has been designed for use as a standalone
non-unit protection, or for use with communications systems to provide unit protection (Carrier Aided schemes).
Standalone operation provides basic scheme Distance protection (e.g. instantaneous Zone 1 operation, delayed
Zone 2 protection and further delayed Back-up protection, etc.). It also implements some special standalone
schemes that don’t require communications. These are known as Non-Aided Distance Schemes.
The non-aided schemes provided in this product can be divided into the following categories:
● Basic schemes
● Trip On Close schemes
● Zone 1 Extension scheme
● Loss of Load scheme

The settings for these Non-Aided Distance Schemes are located in the SCHEME LOGIC column.

212 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

3 BASIC SCHEMES
Basic Scheme operation is always executed if distance elements are enabled. It is the process by which the
measured line impedance is compared against the Distance measuring zone configuration (reach settings and
timers). Instantaneous or time delayed tripping or blocking signals may be issued for a specific zone according to
its settings and the measured impedance values.
There are five basic scheme zones; Zone 1, Zone 2, Zone 3, Zone 4 and Zone P
The Basic Scheme settings include:
● A mode setting, which is common to all zones
● Zone Tripping settings for each zone
● Zone phase delay settings for each zone
● Zone ground delay settings for each zone

On a per-zone basis, phase and earth-fault elements may be set to have different time delays.
To supplement Basic Scheme operation, there are also standalone scheme designs (Non-Aided Distance Schemes)
that provide timely clearance for particular fault scenarios where carrier aided signalling is either not available, or
is unnecessary. These scenarios cover Trip on Closure (including Switch On to Fault, and Trip on Reclose), Loss of
Load, and Zone1 Extension.
The Basic Scheme is continually executed, regardless of any carrier-aided acceleration schemes which may be
enabled.

3.1 BASIC SCHEME MODES


The operation of distance zones according to their set time delays is called the basic scheme. The basic scheme
always runs, regardless of any channel-aided acceleration schemes which may be enabled.
The BasicScheme Mode setting defines how the timers associated with the different Distance zones in the Basic
Scheme are initiated by pick up (start) of zone elements.
In Standard mode, a zone timer starts only when the corresponding distance zone start occurs.
In Alternative mode, if a condition causes any of the enabled Distance elements to start, then the Any
Distance Start DDB signal is asserted. This starts the timers associated with all enabled zones (phase zone timers
and earth zone timers are started). The timers are reset if the Any Distance Start signal resets. If a Distance zone
measuring element is picked up when its associated zone timer times-out, a trip is issued for that zone element.
The Alternative mode is especially suitable for evolving faults, since all zone timers will be initiated at initial
fault inception, rather than waiting to start a timer as additional phases become faulted. This minimises the overall
fault clearance time as the fault develops.
The two modes are described by the following logic diagrams.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 213
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

Zone 1 Gnd Stat . Zone 1 Ground Elements

Enabled
&
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element & 1
962
Zone 1 CN Element

384 &
Block Zone 1 Gnd

Zone 1 Ph Status Zone 1 Phase Elements

Enabled
&
963
Zone1 AB Element
964
Zone1 BC Element & 1
965
Zone1 CA Element

385 &
Block Zone 1 Phs

Zone 2 Ground Elements

Zone 2 Phase Elements


1691
1 Any Dist Start
Zone 3 Ground Elements

Zone 3 Phase Elements

Zone 4 Ground Elements

Zone 4 Phase Elements

Zone P Ground Elements

Zone P Phase Elements

Note: The logic circuits for Zone 2 to Zone P follow the same principles as Zone 1 V02738-1

Figure 103: Any Distance Start

tZ1 Gnd. Delay


960
Zone1 AN Element
&
1 608
1 Zone 1 Trip
961
Zone1 BN Element
& & 609
Zone 1 A Trip
1
961
Zone1 CN Element
& & 610
Zone 1 B Trip
384
Block Zone 1 Gnd

Zone 1 Gnd Stat . & 611


Zone 1 C Trip
Enabled

tZ1 Ph. Delay & 612


Zone 1 N Trip

741
Zone1 Ph Status 1 Zone 1 A Start

Enabled
742
963
1 Zone 1 B Start
Zone1 AB Element &

743
963
1 Zone 1 C Start
Zone1 BC Element &

744
965
1 Zone 1 N Start
Zone1 CA Element &
385
Block Zone 1 Phs Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only . The other zones follow the same principles . V02737

Figure 104: Standard basic scheme mode logic

214 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

tZ1 Gnd. Delay

1691
Any Dist Start
608
Zone 1 Ground Elements 1 Zone 1 Trip

Zone 1 Gnd Stat .


Enabled & 609
& 1 Zone 1 A Trip
960
Zone1 AN Element
961 & 610
Zone1 BN Element & 1 Zone 1 B Trip
962
Zone 1 CN Element
& 611
384
& 1 Zone 1 C Trip
Block Zone 1 Gnd

612
1 Zone 1 N Trip
tZ1 Ph. Delay

&

&

&

Zone 1 Phase Elements 1 741


Zone 1 A Start
Zone 1 Ph Status
Enabled 742
& 1 Zone 1 B Start
963
Zone1 AB Element
964 743
Zone1 BC Element & 1 Zone 1 C Start
965
Zone1 CA Element
744
385 & 1 Zone 1 N Start
Block Zone 1 Phs

Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same principles . V02738-2

Figure 105: Alternative basic timer start scheme mode logic

3.2 BASIC SCHEME SETTING


The Zone 1 time delay (tZ1) is generally set to zero, giving instantaneous operation.
The Zone 2 time delay (tZ2) is set to co-ordinate with Zone 1 fault clearance time for adjacent lines. The total fault
clearance time consists of the downstream Zone 1 operating time plus the associated breaker operating time.
Allowance must also be made for the Zone 2 elements to reset following clearance of an adjacent line fault and
also for a safety margin. A typical minimum Zone 2 time delay is of the order of 200 ms.
The Zone 3 time delay (tZ3) is typically set with the same considerations made for the Zone 2 time delay, except
that the delay needs to co-ordinate with the downstream Zone 2 fault clearance. A typical minimum Zone 3
operating time would be in the region of 400 ms.
The Zone 4 time delay (tZ4) needs to coordinate with any protection for adjacent lines in the protection’s reverse
direction.
Separate time delays can be applied to both phase and ground fault zones, for example where ground fault delays
are set longer to time grade with external ground/earth overcurrent protection.
Any zone (#) which may reach through a power transformer reactance, and measure secondary side faults within
that impedance zone should have a small time delay applied. This is to avoid tripping on the inrush current when
energizing the transformer.
As a general rule, if the Zone Reach setting is greater than 50% of the transformer reactance, set the Zone delay to
be 100 ms or greater. Alternatively, the 2nd harmonic detector output (which is available in the Programmable
Scheme Logic) may be used to block zones that may be at risk of tripping on inrush current. Settings for the inrush
detector are found in the SUPERVISION column.
The figure below shows the typical application of the Basic scheme.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 215
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
Z B

Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3

Typical application
Relay A Relay B
Z1 TZ1 TZ1 Z1
Trip A Trip B
1 1
ZP TZP TZP ZP

Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2

Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3

Z4 Z4
TZ4 TZ4

Note: All timers can be set instantaneous


E02749

Figure 106: Basic time stepped distance scheme

216 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

4 TRIP ON CLOSE SCHEMES


Logic is provided for situations where special tripping may be necessary following closure of the associated circuit
breaker. Two cases of Trip on Close (TOC) logic are catered for:
● Switch on to Fault (SOTF).
● Trip on Reclose (TOR)

SOTF provides instantaneous operation of selected elements if a fault is present when manual closure of the circuit
breaker is performed.
TOR provides instantaneous operation of selected elements if a persistent fault is present when the circuit breaker
attempts autoreclosure
The SOTF and TOR functions are known as Trip on Close logic. Both methods operate in parallel if mapped to the
SOTF and TOR Tripping matrix in the setting file.
The settings for Switch on to Fault (SOTF) and Trip on Reclose (TOR) are located in the TRIP ON CLOSE section of the
SCHEME LOGIC column.
SOTF and TOR are complemented by Current No Voltage level detectors (also known as CNV level detectors). These
CNV level detectors are set using the voltage and current settings located in the CB FAIL & P.DEAD column. The
same settings are used for pole dead logic detection. A 20ms time delay in the logic avoids a possible race
between very fast overvoltage and undercurrent level detectors.
The following figures show the Trip On Close function in relation to the Distance zones and the Trip On Close
function when driven by Current No Volt level detectors.

TOR Status
Enabled
878
Inhibit TOR 485 & TOR Active

891
Any Pole Dead S 877
Q TOC Active
R
TOC Delay

TOC Reset Delay &


486
Inhibit SOTF 1 879
SOTF Active
890
All Poles Dead
& S
Q
R
SOTF Delay

SOTF Pulse

SOTF Status
Enabled PoleDead 1
En Pdead + Pulse
Enabled ExtPulse 1
488 &
Set SOTF

V02742

Figure 107: Trip On Close logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 217
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

559
Fast OV PHA
864
&
IA < Start

560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0

561
Fast OV PHC
866 &
IC< Start

TOR Tripping
Current No Volts

556 557
CNV ACTIVE & TOR Trip CNV

878
TOR Active

SOTF Tripping
Current No Volts

556 558
CNV ACTIVE & SOTF Trip CNV

879
SOTF Active
V02743

Figure 108: Trip On Close based on CNV level detectors

The Current No Volt (‘CNV’) level detectors can be set in the CB FAIL & P.DEAD column The same settings are used
for pole dead logic detection. A 20ms time delay in the logic avoids a possible race between very fast overvoltage
and undercurrent level detectors.

4.1 SWITCH ON TO FAULT (SOTF)


You can use the SOTF Status setting to activated SOTF in in three different ways. It can be:
● Enabled using the pole dead detection logic. If an ‘All Pole Dead’ condition is detected, the SOTF Delay timer
starts. Once this timer expires, SOTF is enabled and stays active for the period set in the TOC Reset Delay
setting.
● Enabled by an external pulse. SOTF is enabled after an external pulse linked to DDB Set SOTF is ON. The
external pulse could be a circuit breaker close command, for example. The function stays active for the
duration of the SOTF Pulse setting.
● Enabled using both pole dead detection logic and an external pulse.
Three pole instantaneous tripping (and auto-reclose blocking) occurs for any fault detected by the selected zones
or Current No Volt level detectors when in SOTF mode. Whether this feature is enabled or disabled, the normal time
delayed elements or aided channel scheme continues to function and can trip the circuit.
The SOTF Delay is a pick up time delay that starts after opening all three poles of a circuit breaker (CB). If the CB is
then closed after the set time delay has expired, SOTF protection is active. SOTF provides enhanced protection for
manual closure of the breaker (not for auto-reclosure). This setting is visible only if Enabled PoleDead or En
Pdead + Pulse are selected to enable SOTF.
While the Switch on to Fault Mode is active, the protection trips instantaneously for pick up of any zone selected in
these links. To operate for faults on the entire circuit length, you should select at least Zone 1 and Zone 2 using the
SOTF Tripping setting . If no elements are selected, the normal time delayed elements and aided scheme provide
the protection.
A user settable time window during which the SOTF protection is available through the SOTF Pulse setting This
setting is visible only if Enabled ExtPulse or En Pdead + Pulse are selected to enable SOTF.

4.1.1 SWITCH ONTO FAULT MODE


To ensure fast isolation of faults (for example a closed three phase earthing switch), on energisation enable this
feature with appropriate zones or Current No Volt (CNV) level detectors, depending on utility practices.

218 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

When busbar voltage transformers are used, the Pole Dead’ signal is not produced. Connect circuit breaker
auxiliary contacts for correct operation. This is not necessary if the SOTF is activated by an external pulse.
● SOTF Delay: The time chosen should be longer than the slowest delayed-auto-reclose dead time, but
shorter than the time in which the system operator might re-energise a circuit once it had opened/tripped.
We recommend 110 seconds as a typical setting.
● SOTF Pulse: Typically this could be set to at 500ms. This time is enough to establish completely the voltage
memory of distance protection.
● TOC Reset Delay: We recommend 500ms as a typical setting (chosen to be in excess of the 16 cycles length
of memory polarizing, allowing full memory charging before normal protection resumes).

4.1.2 SOTF TRIPPING

SOTF Tripping
Zone 1 709
& SOTF Trip Zone 1
879
SOTF Active
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same
Zone1 CN Element 962 principles.
963 1
Zone 1 AB Element
964
Zone1 BC Element
965
Zone1 CA Element V02756

Figure 109: SOTF Tripping

4.1.3 SOTF TRIPPING WITH CNV


559
Fast OV PHA
864
&
IA < Start

560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0

561
Fast OV PHC
866 & 558
IC< Start & SOTF Trip CNV

879
SOTF Active

SOTF Tripping
Current No Volts V02758

Figure 110: SOTF Tripping with CNV

4.2 TRIP ON RECLOSE (TOR)


Trip On Reclose (TOR) is special protection following auto-reclosure. The TOR status setting is used to enable or
disable TOR. When enabled, TOR is activated after the TOC Delay expires, ready for application when an auto-
reclose shot occurs.
When this feature is enabled, the protection operates in ‘Trip on Reclose mode’ for a period following circuit
breaker (CB) closure. Three-phase instantaneous tripping occurs for any fault detected by the selected zones or
CNV level detectors. Whether this feature is enabled or disabled, the normal time-delayed elements or aided
channel scheme continue to function and can trip the circuit.
The SOTF and TOR features stay in service for the duration of the TOC Reset Delay time, once the circuit is
energised. The delay timer starts on CB closure and is common for SOTF and TOR protection. Once this timer
expires after successful closure, all protection reverts to normal.
A user settable time delay (TOC Delay) starts when the CB opens, after which TOR is enabled. The time delay must
not exceed the minimum Dead Time setting of the auto-reclose because both times start simultaneously and TOR
protection must be ready by the time the CB closes on potentially persistent faults.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 219
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

While the Trip on Reclose Mode is active, the protection trips instantaneously for pick up of any selected Distance
zone. You select the zone with the TOR Tripping setting. For example, Zone 2 could operate without waiting for the
usual time delay if a fault is in Zone 2 on CB closure. Also Current No Volts can be mapped for fast fault clearance
on line reclosure on a permanent fault. To operate for faults on the entire circuit length, at least Zone 1 and Zone 2
should be selected. If no elements are selected, the normal time delayed elements and aided scheme provide the
protection. TOR tripping is three-phase and auto-reclose is blocked.

4.2.1 TRIP ON RECLOSE MODE


To ensure fast isolation of all persistent faults following the circuit breaker reclosure, enable this feature with
appropriate zones selected or Current No Volt (CNV) level detectors.
● TOC Delay: The Trip on Reclose (TOR) is activated after TOC Delay has expired. The setting must not exceed
the minimum autoreclose Dead Time setting to make sure that the TOR is active immediately on reclose
command.
● TOC Reset Delay: We recommend 500ms as a typical setting.

4.2.2 TOR TRIPPING LOGIC FOR APPROPRIATE ZONES

TOR Tripping
Zone 1 704
& TOR Trip Zone 1
878
TOR Active
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element
962
Zone1 CN Element Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same
963 1
Zone 1 AB Element principles.
964
Zone1 BC Element
965
Zone1 CA Element V02755

Figure 111: TOR Tripping logic for appropriate zones

4.2.3 TOR TRIPPING LOGIC WITH CNV


559
Fast OV PHA
864
&
IA < Start

560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0

561
Fast OV PHC
866 & 557
IC< Start & TOR Trip CNV

878
TOR Active

TOR Tripping
Current No Volts V02757

Figure 112: TOR Tripping logic with CNV

4.3 POLARISATION DURING CIRCUIT ENGERGISATION


While the Switch on to Fault (SOTF) and Trip on Reclose (TOR) modes are active, the directionalised distance
elements are partially cross polarised from other phases. The same proportion of healthy phase to faulted phase
voltage, as given by the Distance Polarizing setting in the DISTANCE SETUP menu, is used.
Partial cross polarisation is therefore substituted for the normal memory polarising, for the duration of the TOC
Delay. If insufficient polarising voltage is available, a slight reverse offset (approximately 10% of the forward reach)
is included in the Zone 1 characteristic to enable fast clearance of close up three-phase faults.

220 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

5 ZONE1 EXTENSION SCHEME


Auto-reclosure is widely used on radial overhead line circuits to re-establish supply following a transient fault. A
Zone 1 extension scheme may be applied to a radial overhead feeder to provide high speed protection for
transient faults along the whole of the protected line. The figure below shows the alternative reach selections for
zone 1: Z1 or the extended reach Z1X.

Z1 Extension (A)

ZL
A Z1A B

Z1 Extension (B)

E02739

Figure 113: Zone 1 extension scheme

In this scheme Zone 1X is enabled and set to overreach the protected line. A fault on the line, including one in the
end 20% not covered by Zone 1, results in instantaneous tripping followed by autoreclosure. Zone 1X has resistive
reaches and residual compensation similar to Zone 1. The autorecloser is used to inhibit tripping from Zone 1X so
that on reclosure the device operates with Basic scheme logic only, to co-ordinate with downstream protection for
permanent faults. Therefore transient faults on the line are cleared instantaneously, which reduces the probability
of a transient fault becoming permanent. However, the scheme can operate for some faults on an adjacent line,
although this is followed by autoreclosure with correct protection discrimination. Increased circuit breaker
operations would occur, together with transient loss of supply to a substation.
Fault trip Z1X time delay
First fault trip = tZ1
Fault trip for persistent fault on auto-reclose = tZ2
The Zone 1 extension scheme can be disabled, permanently enabled or just brought into service when the
communication channel fails and the aided scheme is inoperative. If used in conjunction with a channel-aided
scheme, Z1X can be set to be enabled when Ch1 or Ch2 fails, or when all channels fail, or when any channel fails.
490
Reset Zone 1 Ext 876
& Z1 X Active
Z1 Ext Scheme
Enabled
En. on Ch 1 Fail 1
&
En. on Ch 2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail &

&

&
317
Aid 1 Chan Fail
318 1
Aid 2 Chan Fail
V02754

Figure 114: Zone 1 extension logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 221
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

6 LOSS OF LOAD SCHEME


The Loss of Load Scheme provides fast unit protection performance for most fault types occurring on a double-
end fed line or feeder, but it does not need communications.
It is used on circuits that are designed for three-pole tripping, and provides protection for faults involving one or
two phases. It is not suitable for single-pole tripping applications, and it cannot protect against three-phase faults.
The scheme does not require communications, but it can be used alongside carrier aided schemes if
communications are available.
The Loss-of-Load scheme can be permanently enabled, permanently disabled, or enabled if communication failure
compromises channel-aided scheme operation. If used in conjunction with a channel-aided scheme, loss of load
can be set to be enabled if only Channel 1 fails, or if only Channel 2 fails, or if both channels fail, or if either channel
fails. Aided scheme communication failure is detected by permissive scheme unblocking logic, or the presence of a
Channel Out of Service (COS) input.

Zone 2 IED1
Zone 1 IED 1
Zone 1 IED 2

Zone 2 IED 2

IED 1 IED 2
V02740

Figure 115: Loss of load accelerated trip scheme

Any fault in the reach of Zone 1 results in fast tripping of the local circuit breaker. For an end zone fault for IED 1
(near IED 2) with remote infeed (from IED 2), the remote breaker is tripped in Zone 1 by the remote device at IED 2.
The local device (IED 1) can recognise this by detecting loss of load current in the healthy phases. This condition, in
conjunction with operation of a Zone 2 comparator at IED 1P, can be used to trip the local circuit breaker.
Before an accelerated trip can occur, load current must be detected before the fault. The loss of load current
opens a window during which time a trip occurs if a Zone 2 comparator operates. A typical setting for this window
is 40ms as shown in the figure below, although this can be altered in the LoL Window setting. The accelerated trip
is delayed by 18ms to prevent initiation of a loss of load trip due to circuit breaker pole discrepancy occurring for
clearance of an external fault. The local fault clearance time can be deduced as follows:
t = Z1d + 2CB + LDr + 18ms
where:
● Z1d = Maximum downstream zone 1 trip time
● CB = Breaker operating time
● LDr = Upstream level detector (LOL <1) reset time
For circuits with load tapped off the protected line, care must be taken in setting the loss of load feature to ensure
that the undercurrent level detector setting is above the tapped load current. When selected, the loss of load
feature operates with the main distance scheme that is selected. This provides high speed clearance for end zone
faults when the Basic scheme is selected or, with permissive signal aided tripping schemes, it provides high speed
back up clearance for end zone faults if the channel fails.

Note:
Loss of load tripping is only available where three pole tripping is used.

222 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes

Note:
Assertion of the Any Trip DDB signal or the Inhibit LOL DDB signal will prevent LOL tripping.

The detailed Loss of Load logic diagram is shown below:

LOL Scheme
Enabled
En. On Ch1 Fail 1
&
En. On Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail &

&

&
317
Aid 1 Chan Fail
318 1
Aid 2 Chan Fail

Tripping Mode
3 Pole
491 1 18 ms
Inhibit LoL & SD
654
Q Loss ofLoad Trip
Any trip 522 R

LOL Window
1365
I> LoL A
1366
I> LoL B &
1367
tLOL
I> LoL C

966 &
Zone2 AN Element

967 &
Zone2 BN Element

968 &
Zone2 CN Element
1

969 &
Zone2 AB Element

970 &
Zone2 BC Element

971 &
Zone2 CA Element V02741

Figure 116: Loss of Load Logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 223
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV

224 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 10

POWER SWING FUNCTIONS


Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

226 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes special blocking and protection functions, which use Power swing Analysis.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 227
Introduction to Power Swing Blocking 228
Power Swing Blocking 230
Out of Step Protection 241

P446SV-TM-EN-1 227
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION TO POWER SWING BLOCKING


Power swings are variations in power flow that occur when the voltage phase angles at different points of
generation shift relative to each other. They can be caused by events such as fault occurrences and subsequent
clearance. Power swings may be classified as stable or unstable.
A stable power swing is one where, following a disturbance, all sources of generation return to a state where they
are all generating synchronous voltages. An unstable power swing is one where at least one source of generation
cannot restore operation that is synchronous with the rest of the system. In this case the poles of one source of
generation slip with respect to those of another. This condition is known as Pole Slipping.
A power swing may cause the impedance presented to Distance protection to move away from the normal load
area and into one or more of its tripping characteristics. Without attention this could lead to unwanted or
uncontrolled tripping.

Note:
Power swings do not involve earth, so only phase-phase impedances are affected.

For stable power swings, distance protection should not trip. To prevent tripping, a Power Swing Blocking (PSB)
function is usually provided to compliment Distance protection.
For unstable power swings, there may be a strategy for instigating a controlled system split. In this case, distance
protection should not trip during loss of stability. If unstable power swings or Pole-Slipping conditions might be
expected, certain points on the network may be designated as split points, where the network should be split if
unstable (or potentially unstable) conditions occur. Strategic splitting of the system can be achieved by means of
dedicated Out-of-Step Tripping protection (OOS or OST protection). Or it may be possible to achieve splitting by
strategically limiting the duration for which the operation of a specific distance protection is blocked during power
swing conditions.
A method often used to help understand power system stability and Pole Slipping is called Equal Area Criterion.
This is based on a number of operational curves as outlined in the figure below:

Power Curve 1

Area 2

F Area 1
A E G
Po
Out of step
D

Curve 2
Curve 3
C
B
θ
0º θ0 θ1 90º θ2 θ3 180º
Phase angle difference between two ends
V02762

Figure 117: Power transfer related to angular difference between two generation sources

The figure describes the behaviour of a power system with parallel lines connecting two sources of generation.
● Curve 1 represents pre-fault system operation through parallel lines where the transmitted power is Po.
● Curve 2 represents transmitted power during a phase-phase-earth fault.
● Curve 3 represents a new power curve when the faulted line is tripped.

228 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

At fault inception, the operating point A moves to B, which is a reduced power transfer level. There is, therefore, a
surplus of power (A to B) at that sending end and a corresponding deficit of power at the receiving end. The
sending end generators start to speed up, and the receiving end generators start to slow down, so the phase
angle θ increases, and the operating point moves along curve 2 until the fault is cleared (point C). At this point, the
phase angle is θ1. The operating point now moves to point D on curve 3 which represents the power transfer curve
when just one line is in service. There is still a power surplus at the sending end and a deficit at the receiving end,
so the generators continue to lose synchronism and the operating point moves further along curve 3.
If, at some point between E and G (point F) the generators are rotating at the same speed, the phase angle will
stop increasing. According to the Equal Area Criterion, this occurs when Area 2 is equal to Area 1. The sending end
will now start to slow down and receiving end to speed up. Therefore, the phase angle starts to decrease and the
operating point moves back towards E. As the operating point passes E, the net sending end deficit again becomes
a surplus and the receiving end surplus becomes a deficit, so the sending end generators begin to speed up and
the receiving end generators begin to slow down. With no losses, the system operating point will oscillate around
point E on curve 3, but in practise the oscillation is damped, and the system eventually settles at operating point E.
So, if Area 1 is less than Area 2, the system will oscillate but will stay in synchronism. This swing is usually called a
recoverable, or stable, power swing. If, on the contrary, the system passes point G with a further increase in angle
difference between sending and receiving ends, the system loses synchronism and becomes unstable. This will
happen if the initial power transfer Po is so high that the Area 1 is greater than Area 2. This power swing is not
recoverable and is usually called an Out-of-Step condition or a Pole Slip condition. In such a case, only system
separation and subsequent re-synchronising of the generators can restore normal system operation.
The point G is shown at approximately 120°, but this can vary. If, for example, the pre-fault transmitted power (Po)
was high and the fault clearance was slow, Area 1 would be greater. For the system to recover from this case, the
angle θ would be closer to 90º. Similarly, if the pre-fault transmitted power Po was low and fault clearance fast,
Area 1 would be small, and the angle θ could go closer to 180º with the system remaining stable.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 229
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

3 POWER SWING BLOCKING


A power swing may cause the impedance presented to the distance function to move away from the normal load
area and into one or more of its tripping zones. Stable power swings should not cause the distance protection to
trip. Therefore, if the power swing is deemed to be stable, the distance protection function for the zone in question
is blocked. Unstable power swings should result in either tripping of the relevant protection element, or a system
split. Therefore, the distance protection element should also be blocked for unstable power swings if there is a
strategy for a controlled system split.

3.1 POWER SWING DETECTION


This product uses a combination of two techniques to detect power swings. To detect power swings in the normal
to fast frequency range (>0.5Hz), a superimposed current technique (also known as a delta technique) is used. To
detect slower power swings (<0.5Hz), a supplementary technique based on impedance characteristics is used. This
so called slow swing technique will invoke the power swing blocking function should the power swing be to slow
for the delta technique to operate.
Once a power swing is detected the following actions occur:
● Relevant distance elements are blocked (if blocking is enabled).
● All zones are switched to self-polarised mho characteristics with 10% offset reach for maximum stability
during the swing.

3.1.1 SETTINGS-FREE POWER SWING DETECTION


By "Settings-Free", we mean that there is no need to define any characteristic criteria. The only settings needed are
to define what to do in the event of a power swing (Allow trip, block, or unblock with a delay).
The settings-free power swing detection technique uses a superimposed current detector (DI), as used in the phase
selector. For each phase loop (A-B, B-C, C-A), the actual measured current is compared with the measured current
from exactly two cycles earlier (present in a 2-cycle FIFO buffer). If there is a difference between the two (DI), this
indicates that something is happening on that current loop.
The superimposed current (DI) is compared with a set threshold (set at 5%In) to produce a switching signal PH1.
This switching signal is used as an input to the power swing blocking function. It also triggers the current sample
values in the 2-cycle FIFO butter to be stored in memory for further current comparisons.
Superimposed currents appear during both fault conditions, and power swings. For fault conditions, superimposed
components will not normally extend beyond two cycles. Under power swing conditions however, superimposed
components persist beyond two cycles. We can use this fact to differentiate between faults and power swings.
During a power swing (in the absence of a fault), the phase selector will indicate a three-phase selection, or a
phase-phase selection if one pole is dead. So if superimposed components persist for three cycles, and a “faulted-
phase” indication of “three-phase with one pole dead” is present during those three cycles, a power swing has
been detected and the relevant signals are asserted.
After a power swing condition has been detected, the DI threshold used by the phase selector is increased and the
current values present in the two cycle buffer are stored. This provides coverage for faults that might occur whilst
a power swing is in progress.
For a fault condition, the superimposed current detector should reset after two cycles, because once the fault
current values enter the FIFO buffer, this will be compared with the present fault current and the superimposed
current will return to zero. This will allow the power swing detection function to reset.

Configuring Settings-Free Power Swing Detection


The power swing detection based on superimposed current requires no system study. You just need to decide
whether a zone should be blocked or allowed to trip if a power swing is detected. You do this zone by zone using
the zone specific settings. For example the zone 1 setting is Zone 1 Ph. PSB. The available options are Blocking,
Allow Trip, or Delayed Unblock.

230 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

3.1.1.1 TIMING OF THE PHASE SELECTOR SIGNALS

Start of
power swing End of
power swing

i (t)

3 cycles

PH1

PH2
t1 t2 t3

t 1: D i exceeds threshold 1 (5%In), so PH1 and PH2 go high

t 2: Threshold 2 invoked. PH2 goes low on account of threshold being increased . PH1 remains high,
because there continues to be a D i

t 3: PH1 goes low as power swing has diminished and D i goes below threshold 1
V02769
Figure 118: Phase selector timing for power swing condition

Fault inception Fault cleared

i (t)

PH1

PH2
t1 t2 t3

t1: D i exceeds threshold 1 (5%In), so PH1 and PH2 go high

t2: Fault current value appears in 2 cycle buffer . This equals present fault current value so D i is reduced to
zero. PH1 therefore goes low. PH2 remains high because value in PH 2 memory is a stored value .

t3: Fault is cleared so PH 2 goes low. PH1 stays low even though there is a new D I, because the absolute
current value is also taken into consideration .
V02770

Figure 119: Phase selector timing for fault condition

P446SV-TM-EN-1 231
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

Start of
power swing

i (t)

3 cycles

PH1

PH2
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5

t1: D i exceeds threshold 1 (5%In), so PH1 and PH2 go high

t2: Threshold 2 invoked (10%In). PH2 goes low on account of threshold being increased (from 5%IN to 10%In).
PH1 remains high, because there continues to be a D i

t3: Fault inception. D i exceeds threshold 2 (10%In), so PH2 goes high

t4: 2 cycles after fault inception , PH1 goes low

t5: Fault cleared, so PH2 goes low


V02771

Figure 120: Phase selector timing for fault during a power swing

3.1.2 SLOW POWER SWING DETECTION


For slow power swings (0.5Hz and below) where the superimposed current may remain below the minimum 5%In
threshold needed for the superimposed current (DI) detector, a different detection method is used. This method is
called Slow Swing detection. This method requires the Slow Swing setting to be enabled.

Note:
If the Slow Swing feature is not Enabled, very slow power swings (< 0.5 Hz) may not be detected.

The Slow Swing method is based on changing impedance measurements and uses a pair of configurable
concentric quadrilateral zones on the impedance plane (Zone 7 and Zone 8). Since power swings don’t involve
earth, the impedance measurements are based on positive sequence quantities and only phase-phase
measurements are necessary. The characteristic is shown in the following figure:

232 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

+jX
PSB Z8 Zone 8

PSB Z7 Zone 7

Dt
ZL
Z1 = V1/I1

PSB R8' PSB R7' PSB R7 α


Resistive reverse (R’) PSB R8 Resistive forward (+R)

PSB Z7'

PSB Z8'

V02744

Figure 121: Slow Power Swing detection characteristic

The elapsed time defines the rate of change of impedance. If the rate of change is high, the change is due to a
fault. If the rate of change is low, the protection indicates a slow power swing. So, if the time taken for the
impedance trajectory to pass through zone 8 into zone 7 is greater than the time defined by the PSB timer, a slow
power swing is deemed to be in progress. If the time taken for the impedance trajectory to pass through zone 8
into zone 7 is less than that defined by the PSB timer, it is deemed to be a fault.
In other words, a power swing is indicated if the following condition is true:
Dt > PSB Timer
Both Zone 7 and Zone 8 characteristics are based on the positive sequence impedance measurement; Z1 = V1/I1.
The minimum current (sensitivity) needed for Zone 7 and Zone 8 measurements is 5%In.

Configuring Slow Swing Detection


Slow Swing power swing detection and blocking must first be enabled with the Slow Swing setting. After this, you
need to configure the resistive and impedance reach settings to define the concentric quadrilateral characteristics
for zones 7 and 8:
PSB R7: forward resistive reach for zone 7
PSB R7': reverse resistive reach for zone 7
PSB R8: forward resistive reach for zone 8
PSB R8': reverse resistive reach for zone 8
PSB Z7: forward impedance reach for zone 7
PSB Z7': reverse impedance reach for zone 7
PSB Z8: forward impedance reach for zone 8
PSB Z8': reverse impedance reach for zone 8
You also need to configure the impedance phase angle a. This is the same for zone 7 and zone 8. To do this you
need to set Alpha between 20° and 90°.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 233
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

The PSB timer setting defines the minimum time that the impedance trajectory must take to cross through zone 8
into zone 7 (Dt) before a power swing is deemed to have taken place. A power swing is indicated if Dt > PSB Timer.

3.2 DETECTION OF A FAULT DURING A POWER SWING


Faults are characterised by step changes in superimposed current (ΔI) rather than more gradual transitions
symptomatic of a power swing.
When a power swing is in progress, the threshold for the phase selector is increased to a value twice that of the
maximum prevailing superimposed current caused by the swing. A fault will cause a ΔI greater than this raised
threshold, so the fault will be detected by the phase selector. Operation of the phase selector in this condition
unblocks the PSB function, to allow tripping of Distance elements.
To provide stability for external faults, the blocking signal is only removed from zones that start within two cycles
of the phase detector recognising the fault:
Any Distance element measuring an impedance inside its characteristic before the phase selector detects the fault
remains blocked. This prevents tripping for a swing impedance that may be coincidentally passing through a fast-
acting zone, and which could cause spurious tripping if all elements were unblocked without qualification.
Any Distance element that measures an impedance inside its characteristic after the two cycle ΔI window of the
phase selector has expired, remains blocked. This prevents tripping for a continued swing that may pass through a
fast acting zone which could cause spurious tripping if the element was allowed to unblock by an unqualified
phase selector reset.

3.3 POWER SWING BLOCKING CONFIGURATION


To use the Power Swing function, you must ensure that the PowerSwing Block setting in the CONFIGURATION
column is set to Enabled. You can set Power Swing Blocking to Indication (where alarms are raised but no
blocking is imposed), or to Blocking (where blocking actions are imposed).
To define what the action the PSB function should take, you need to set the distance zones. The available distance
zones are:
Zone 1 Ph. PSB: Zone 1 phase
Zone 2 Ph. PSB: Zone 2 phase
Zone 3 Ph. PSB: Zone 3 phase
Zone 4 Ph. PSB: Zone 4 phase
Zone P Ph. PSB: Zone P phase
Zone 1 Gnd. PSB: Zone 1 ground
Zone 2 Gnd. PSB: Zone 2 ground
Zone 3 Gnd. PSB: Zone 3 ground
Zone 4 Gnd. PSB: Zone 4 ground
Zone P Gnd. PSB: Zone P ground
The following options are available for each of the above zones:
Allow Trip: If a power swing locus stays in the Distance characteristic for a duration equal to the element time
delay, the trip is allowed.
Blocking: Prevents tripping for that element, even if a power swing locus enters the element’s characteristic.
Delayed Unblock: This maintains the block for a set duration after a power swing has been detected. To use it,
you must set PSB Unblocking to Enabled, and then set the desired PSB Unblock dly time for removing the block.

234 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

Note:
The PSB Unblock dly timer is common to all elements.

The PSB Unblock dly is used to time the duration for which the swing is present. The intention is to allow the
distinction between a stable and an unstable swing. If after the timeout period the swing has still not stabilised, the
block for selected zones can be released (unblocking), giving the opportunity to split the system. If no unblocking is
required, set to maximum (10 s).
There is a further timer associated with the PSB function. This is the PSB Reset Delay timer. This timer is provided to
maintain the power swing detection for a period after the superimposed current detection (ΔI) has reset. ΔI
naturally tends to zero twice during each power swing cycle (around the current maxima and minima in the swing
element). A short time delay ensures continued PSB pick-up during these ΔI minima.
The PSB Reset Delay is used to maintain the PSB status when DI naturally is low during the swing cycle (near the
current maxima and minima in the swing envelope). A typical setting of 0.2s is used to seal-in the detection until DI
has chance to appear again.
The WI Trip PSB setting determines what will happen if a power swing is detected whilst the Weak Infeed (WI)
tripping feature is being used and the WI condition is present for longer than the WI Trip Delay time. If Blocking
is selected, the weak infeed operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing. If Delayed Unblock is
chosen, the weak infeed element block will be removed after drop off timer PSB Unblock dly has expired, even if
the swing is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilise. In Allow trip mode, the
weak infeed element is unaffected by power swing detection.

3.4 POWER SWING LOAD BLINDING BOUNDARY


If the product has load blinding enabled, the following applies for phase-to-phase loops:
Impedance values, which are inside the load blinder boundaries and close to it for more than one cycle, are
indicative of a power swing. The power swing region is represented by the shaded area in the following diagram.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 235
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

jX

Zone x

Power Swing region


(shaded area)
Operate Region

-10°
Blind Region
Blind Region
20%

-R Load blinder boundary R

-jX
V02775

Figure 122: Load Blinder Boundary Conditions

The area is defined by lines created with angles fixed at 10° closer to the resistive axis than those created by the
load blinder angle setting (Load/B Angle - 10°) and a circular arc with a radius concentric with, and equivalent
to 20% greater than, the load blinder impedance setting (Z< Blinder Imp + 20%).
This is clearly indicated with reference to the diagram.

Note:
This power swing conditions are completely independent of the slow swing associated with Zone 7 and Zone 8.

3.5 POWER SWING BLOCKING LOGIC


The Power Swing function follows the logic diagram below:

236 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

Power Swing
Blocking

PSB Reset Delay

1691
Any Dist Start 3 cycles
t 0 1014
& P Swing Detector
Ph1 0 t

t
1 & Block selected element
0 &

Fault detection 1015


PSB Fault
during power swing
Ph2
297
Power Swing
PSB Unblock Dly

PSB Unblocking
Enabled

Slow Swing Slow Swing PSB Detector


Enable
V Impedance
I Calculator
PSB Timer PSB Timer

PSB Z7
PSB Z8 607
Slow PSB
PSB Z 7' Detector
PSB Z 8' Module
Quad
PSB R7 characteristic
PSB R8 definition

PSB R7'
PSB R8'
Alpha

V02745

Figure 123: Power swing blocking logic

Note:
This is a simplified representation to highlight the outputs of the Power Swing Blocking function.

3.6 POWER SWING BLOCKING SETTING GUIDELINES


Power sing blocking (PSB) should normally only be enabled in transmission system applications. Power swings are
not expected to occur at distribution level.
The main power swing detection technique used in this product can detect power swings faster than 0.5Hz
without you having to set any parameters. This method relies on superimposed current (ΔI) component techniques
to automatically detect power swings. The threshold to detect a power swing is 5%In. During power oscillations
slower than 0.5Hz the continuous ∆I phase current integral to the detection technique may be less than the 5%In
threshold. So it may not operate. Slow swings usually occur following sudden load changes or single pole tripping
on weak systems where the displacement of initial power transfer is not severe. Generally, swings of up to 1Hz are
recoverable, but the swing impedance may stay longer inside the Distance characteristics than might be expected
before the oscillations are damped by the power system. Therefore, to guarantee system stability during very slow
swings, we recommend setting Slow Swing to Enabled to complement the automatic setting-free detection
algorithm.
To configure the slow power swing function you need to set the resistive and reactive limits of the Zone 7 and Zone
8 quadrilaterals. You also need to set the PSB Timer which defines the critical time period of the transition between
the two zones and which is characteristic of the slow swing.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 237
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

Whichever power swing detector is responsible for applying PSB, the removal of PSB is defined by two settings –
the PSB Reset Delay and (if an unblocking philosophy is employed) the PSB Unblock dly.

3.6.1 SETTING THE RESISTIVE LIMITS


The Zone 7 quadrilateral should encompass all distance elements to be blocked during a power swing condition.
The Zone 8 quadrilateral should be set smaller than the minimum possible load impedance. The security margin
for both conditions should be at least 20%, also a margin of at least 10% should be provided between Zone 7 and
Zone 8:
R8 > 1.1(R7)
We recommend setting the magnitudes of R7’ and R8’ equal to R7 and R8 respectively:
R7’ = -R7, R8’ = -R8.

Distance zones to be blocked


+jX (only phase-to-phase)
Zone 8
Zone 7

Maximum Load

½ Rx Ph. Resistive

Resistive reverse (R’) Resistive forward (+R)

V02750

Figure 124: Setting the resistive reaches

3.6.2 SETTING THE REACTIVE LIMITS


The inner Zone 7 should be set in excess of total impedance ZT , which include local source impedance ZS , line
impedance ZL and remote source impedance ZR. Only positive sequence impedances should be considered. The
security margin for this condition should be at least 20%. The recommended margin between Z7 and Z8 settings is
10%:
Z8 = 1.1(Z7)
We recommend setting the magnitudes of Z7’ and Z8’ equal to Z7 and Z8 respectively
Z7’ = -Z7, Z8’ = -Z8
The angle Alpha should be set equal to the angle of the total impedance ZT:

a = ÐZT

238 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

+jX
Zone 8

Zone 7

ZR

ZL α = ÐZ T
ZT
Resistive reverse (R’) Resistive forward (+R)

ZS

V02751

Figure 125: Reactive reach settings

3.6.3 PSB TIMER SETTING GUIDELINES


The Setting PSB Time setting can be calculated as follows:

(θ1 − θ 2 ) ⋅ f nom
∆t =
f PS
where
● angles q1 and q2 are defined in the following figure
● fnom is the nominal frequency
● fPS is the maximum Power Swing frequency to be taken into account
Since any power swing with fPS >= 0.5Hz can be detected by the setting-free delta current algorithm, only power
swings with fPS < 0.5Hz Hz need to be considered for Slow Power Swing detection. We recommended setting fPS to
1Hz because this value provides sufficient security margin.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 239
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

ZR Zone 7 Zone 8

ZL

ZT
2 q1
q2
ZT

ZS

V02752

Figure 126: PSB timer setting guidelines

240 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

4 OUT OF STEP PROTECTION


Out-of-Step detection is based on the speed and trajectory of measured positive sequence impedance passing
through a particular characteristic. During power system disturbances such as faults and power swings, measured
impedance moves away from normal load values. Power swings, where the system voltage angles change relative
to each other, can be either stable (recoverable) or unstable (non-recoverable). It is the unstable power swings that
result in an Out-of-Step condition.
For stable power swings the relative phase angles will oscillate, but these oscillations will fade and synchronism
between generating sources will be maintained. Detecting stable power swings is necessary to prevent unwanted
tripping of impedance measuring protection elements if the swing impedance transiently passes through the fault
impedance zone.
Unstable power swings (which can be destructive) result in sources of generation losing synchronism. This is called
pole slipping. Detecting unstable power swings allows controlled tripping to split the systems into stable areas so
that synchronism is maintained in each area. This is called Out-of-Step tripping (OOS or OST).
As well as tripping for Out-of-Step conditions, it is possible to predict OST conditions. This allows controlled tripping
and consequent splitting of the system to recover stable operation before pole slipping occurs. This is called
Predictive Out-of-Step tripping (Predictive OST).
Out-of-Step and Predictive Out-of-Step protection is based on changing impedance measurements, and uses a
pair of configurable quadrilateral characteristics in the impedance plane (Zone 5 and Zone 6).
Out of Step protection is used to split the power system into more stable areas of generation and load balance
during unstable power oscillations. The points at which the system should be split are determined by detailed
system stability studies.

4.1 OUT OF STEP DETECTION


The Out of Step detection is based on the well proven ∆Z/∆t principle associated with two concentric polygon
characteristic, as shown below:

+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6

OST Z5 Zone 5

Predictive OST trip

OST trip Recoverable swing


ZL

OST R6' OST R5' OST R5 α


Resistive reverse (R’) OST R6 Resistive forward (+R)

OST Z5'

OST Z6'

V02760

Figure 127: Out of Step detection characteristic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 241
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

The OST principle uses positive sequence impedances. The positive sequence impedance is calculated as Z1 =
V1/I1, where V1 and I1 are the positive sequence voltage and current quantities derived from the measured phase
quantities. The concentric quadrilaterals are designated Zone 5 and Zone 6. Zone 5 encompasses possible system
fault impedances and sits within Zone 6. Because OST and Predictive OST quadrilaterals are based on positive
sequence impedances, all OST conditions are covered by a single measurement. Both quadrilaterals are
independent and have independent reach settings.
All four resistive blinders are parallel, using the common angle setting (a) that corresponds to the angle of the total
system impedance (ZT = ZS + ZL + ZR), where ZS and ZR are equivalent positive sequence impedances at the
sending and receiving ends and ZL positive sequence line impedance. The reactance lines are also parallel as
neither reactance line tilting nor esidual compensation is implemented.
In the figure, the purple solid impedance trajectory represents the locus for the non-recoverable power sawing,
known as a pole slip or Out Of Step condition. The dotted green impedance trajectory represents a recoverable
power swing.

4.2 OUT OF STEP PROTECTION OPERATAING PRINCIPLE


The Out of Step function has four different setting options, which are only visible if the PowerSwing Block is
enabled in the CONFIGURATION column:
● Disabled: Disables the Out of Step function.
● Pred. OST: Splits the system in advance. It minimizes the angle shift between two ends and aids stability
in the split areas.
● OST: Splits the system when an out of step condition is detected, which is when a pole slip occurs.
● Pred. OST or OST: Splits the system in advance or when an out of step condition is detected.
The Out-of-Step detection algorithm is based on the speed of the positive sequence impedance passing through
the characteristic. When the positive sequence impedance enters the outer quadrilateral (Zone 6) a timer is
started. The timer is stopped after the positive sequence impedance passes through the inner quadrilateral (zone
5). Let us call this time the zone 6 to zone 5 transition time.
If this time is less than 25 ms, the protection considers this to be a power system fault, not an Out-of-Step
condition. This 25 ms time is fixed and cannot be set. During a power system fault, the speed of change from a
load impedance to a fault impedance is fast, but the protection may operate slower for marginal faults close to a
zone boundary. This is particularly the case for high resistive faults inside the zone operating characteristic and
close to the Zone 5 boundary. The fixed time of 25 ms is implemented to provide sufficient time for a distance
element to operate and therefore to distinguish between a fault and an extremely fast power swing.
If the zone 6 to zone 5 transition time takes more than 25 ms but less than the set delta T time, this is treated as a
very fast power swing and the protection will trip if either the Pred. OST Trip or the Pred. & OST Trip
options are selected and the Out-of-Step tripping time delay (Tost) has expired. The minimum delta T setting is 30
ms, allowing 5 ms margin with the fixed 25 ms timer.
If the zone 6 to zone 5 transition time takes longer than the set delta T time, it is considered as a slow power
swing. On entering Zone 5, the protection records the polarity of the resistive part of the positive sequence
impedance. From this state, two outcomes are possible:
● If the resistive part of the positive sequence impedance leaves Zone 5 with the same polarity as previously
recorded on entering Zone 5, it is considered to be a recoverable swing. In this case, the protection does not
trip.
● If, when exiting Zone 5, the resistive part of the positive sequence impedance has the opposite polarity to
that of the recorded polarity on entering Zone 5, an Out-of-Step condition is recognised. This is followed by
tripping if either Pred. OST Trip or Pred. & OST Trip is selected.

As the tripping mode for the detected Out-of-Step condition is always three-phase, the Pred. OST and OST DDB
signals are mapped to the three-phase tripping signal in the default programmable scheme logic.

242 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

The Out-of-Step tripping time delay (Tost), delays the OST tripping command until the angle between internal
voltages between the two ends are at 240 degrees closing towards 360 degrees. This limits the voltage stress
across the circuit breaker. If a fault occurs during the swing condition, the Out-of-Step tripping function is blocked.
The Out-of-Step algorithm is completely independent from the distance elements and the power swing detection
function. The load blinder does not affect the OST characteristics. In common with other similar functions, a
minimum positive sequence current of 5%In is needed for Out-of-Step operation.

4.3 OUT OF STEP LOGIC DIAGRAM


554
Start Z5
& Fault detected
555
Start Z6 25ms
&
0
tost
t
0
& 551
& Pred. OST
delta T ≥ t
1 0

OST Mode
553
OST Disabled & OST
& Polarity Reversed?
Pred. OST Trip
1 & Polarity detector
Pred. & OST Trip Reset function
& Not reversed
OST Trip & ≥
1 1 &
555
Start Z6

Note : R1 is measured resistive component of positive sequence impedance Reset function


V02761

Figure 128: Out of Step logic diagram

4.4 OST APPLICATION NOTES


This product provides integrated Out-of-Step protection, which avoids the need for a separate stand alone Out-of-
Step device. This section provides guidance on how to configure Out of Step protection.
If you are going to use either of the predictive OST options (Pred. OST Trip or Pred. & OST Trip) you
must conduct detailed system studies to determine accurate settings. This is because high setting accuracy is
needed to avoid premature system splitting in the case of severe power oscillations that do not lead to pole slip
conditions.
Using the non-predictive OST Trip setting is simpler. You can can set it by knowing just the total system impedance,
ZT, and the system split points.

4.4.1 SETTING THE OST MODE


The OST Mode setting provides four options:
● OST Disabled
● Pred. OST Trip
● OST Trip
● Pred. & OST Trip

Setting OST Trip is the most commonly used approach when this protection is applied. OST Trip should be
used when Out-of-Step conditions are probable. If Out-of-Step conditions are detected, the OST command will be
issued to split the system at the pre-determined points. A disadvantage of the OST Trip option compared with
the ‘Predictive’ options is that tripping will take a little longer so that the power oscillations may escalate further
after separation and the split parts may become separately unstable. An advantage, however, is that the decision

P446SV-TM-EN-1 243
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

to split the system will always be valid even if the accurate system data and setting parameters cannot be
obtained.
The predictive setting options Pred. OST Trip and Pred. & OST Trip are recommended for systems
where Out-of-Step conditions could possibly occur, and where an early system split should minimise the phase
shift between generation sources. This should maximise the chances for the separated parts of the system to
stabilise as quickly as possible. Special care must be taken when these settings are used to ensure that the circuit
breakers at the different terminals do not open when the voltages at different ends are in anti-phase. This is
because most circuit breakers are not designed to break current at double the nominal voltage. Attempting to
break the current at double the nominal voltage could lead to flash-over and circuit breaker damage.
‘Predictive’ settings are designed to detect and trip for fast power oscillations. When predictive tripping is used
with a circuit breaker capable of operating in typically two-cycles, the two voltages angles may rapidly move in
opposite directions at the time of opening the circuit breaker. So, if you use the predictive settings you need to
apply settings that will ensure that the circuit breaker opening occurs well before the phase difference between
the different terminals approaches 180º. This means that accurate settings can only be determined by exhaustive
system studies.
The setting Pred. & OST Trip provides two stages of OST. If a power system oscillation is very fast, the
combination of ∆R (the difference between the Zone 5 and Zone 6 resistive reaches), and the Delta T settings, must
be set so that Pred. OST Trip operates. If the oscillation is slower, the condition for the predictive OST is not
met and so tripping is dictated by the OST condition being met. For the OST condition to be met, the resistive
component of the impedance must leave Zone 5 with opposite polarity compared with when it entered. If the
polarity is opposite when Zone 5 resets, OST will trip. If the polarity is the same when Zone 5 resets, OST will not
trip. This distinguishes between a slower non-recoverable oscillation and recoverable swings.
You should disable OST for applications on lines where unrecoverable power oscillations are not expected, or not
expected to be severe. This is likely to apply to strong interconnected systems operating with three-phase tripping.

4.4.1.1 DETERMINING THE LIMITS OF THE OST CHARACTERISTIC


The figure below shows the OST characteristic in conjunction with the system impedance, ZT, and particularly the
relationship with the resistive reach of the Zone 5 element.

+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6

OST Z5 Zone 5

Predictive OST trip


ZT
ZR
OST trip
θ
ZL
OST R6' OST R5' α
Resistive reverse (R’) ZS OST R5 OST R6
Resistive forward (+R)

OST Z5'

OST Z6'

V02763

Figure 129: OST setting determination for the positive sequence resistive component OST R5

244 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

ZT is the total system positive sequence impedance equal to ZS + ZL + ZR, where ZS and ZR are the equivalent
positive sequence impedances at the sending and receiving ends and ZL is the positive sequence line impedance.
θ is the angular difference between the voltages at the sending and receiving ends beyond which no system
recovery is possible.
To determine the settings for OST, the minimum inner resistive reach of OST R5 (R5min) needs to be calculated.
The figure above shows that:
R5min = (ZT/2) / tan(θ/2
Next the maximum (limit value) for the outer resistive reach OST R6 (R6 max) needs to be calculated. Referring to
the figure below, point A must not overlap with the load area for the worst assumed power factor of 0.85 and the
lowest possible ZT angle α.

+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6

ZT LOAD

OST R6' O 32° β α


Resistive reverse (R’) OST R6
Resistive forward (+R)

OST Z6'

V02764

Figure 130: OST R6max determination

β = 32 + 90 – α
Z load min = OA
Where:
● Z load min is the minimum load impedance radius
● 32º is the load angle that corresponds to the lower power factor of 0.85
● α is the load blinder angle (Blinder Angle) that matches the ZT angle
Therefore:
R6max < Z load min(Cos β)
Starting from the limit values R5min and R6max, the actual OST R5 and OST R6 reaches will be set in conjunction
with the Delta T setting.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 245
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

Note:
The R6max reach must be greater than the maximum resistive reach of any distance zone to ensure correct initiation of the
25 ms and Delta T timers. However, the R5min reach could be set below the distance maximum resistive reach (inside the
distance characteristic) if an extensive resistive coverage is required, meaning that Out-of-Step protection does not pose a
restriction to the quadrilateral applications.

For each zone, we receommend setting the positive and negative limits to be the same so, OST R5’ = OST R5, OST
Z5’ = OST Z5, OST R6’ = OST R6, and OST Z6’ = OST Z6.

4.4.1.2 SETTING OST Z5 AND OST Z6


Setting of the reactance lines OST Z5 and OST Z6 depends on how far from the protection location the power
oscillations are to be detected. Normally, there is only one point for initial splitting of the system; and that point will
be determined by system studies. For that reason, the Out-of-Step protection must be enabled at that location and
disabled on all others. To detect the Out-of-Step conditions, the OST Z5’, OST Z5, OST Z6’, and OST Z6 settings must
be set to comfortably encompass the total system impedance ZT. A typical setting could be:

OST Z5 = OST Z5’ = ZT


The OST Z6 and OST Z6’ settings are not of great importance and could be set to 1.1 x OST Z5.

4.4.1.3 SETTING OST R5, OST R6 AND DELTA T


The R5min and R6max settings determined above represent limit values. The actual OST R5 and OST R6 values
need to be determined in relation to the Delta T timer.

Predictive OST setting


For the Pred. OST Trip setting, it is important to:
● Set OST R6 equal to R6max
● Set OST R5 as close as practical to R6max
The aim of pushing the OST R5 setting to the right is to detect fast oscillations as soon as possible, in order to gain
sufficient time to operate the breaker before the two source voltages are in opposite directions. The only restriction
is the limitation of the Delta T minimum time delay of 30ms and the speed of oscillation.
You should set Delta T such that it does not expire after the positive sequence impedance has passed the OST R6
– OST R5 region.
For this setting, you need to know the rate-of-change of swing impedance when crossing the OST R6 – OST R5
region. This must therefore be based on system studies.

Note:
You cannot assume that the rate-of-change of positive sequence impedance while crossing the OST R6 – OST R5 region is the
same as the average rate-of-change of positive sequence impedance for the whole swing cycle. A false assumumption could
lead to incorrect predictive OST operation.

Note:
For a fault, the OST R6 – OST R5 region will be crossed faster than 25ms, therefore even very fast oscillations up to 7Hz will
not be mistaken as a fault condition and predictive OST will not operate.

OST setting
For the OST Trip setting option, such a precise setting of the blinders and Delta T is not necessary. This is
because for a wide ∆R region and a short Delta T setting, any oscillation will be successfully detected. However,
the fault impedance must pass through the ∆R region faster than the Delta T setting.

246 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions

Therefore, for the OST Trip setting, assume that θ = 120° and set:
● OST R5 = OST R5’ = R5min = ZT/3.46
● OST R6 = OST R6’ = R6max
● Delta T = 30 ms
Delta T always expires. Therefore, the setting value given above will secure the detection of a wide range of
oscillations, starting from very slow oscillations (caused by recoverable swings) up to a fastest oscillation limit of
7Hz. Note that any fault impedance will pass the OST R6 – OST R5 region faster than the minimum settable Delta T
time of 30ms.

Predictive and OST setting


The recommendations for Pred. & OST Trip are the same as for Pred. OST Trip.

4.4.1.4 SETTING THE OST TIME DELAY


For either of the predictive OST settings, the OST time delay setting (Tost) must be set zero.
For the OST Trip setting, Tost would normally be set to zero, but if you want to operate the breaker at an angle
closer to 360º (when voltages are in phase) you could apply a time delay.

4.4.1.5 BLINDER ANGLE SETTING


Set Blinder Angle, α, the same as the total system impedance angle, ZT.

4.4.1.6 OST FOR SERIES COMPENSATED LINES


The maximum phase currents during an Out-of-Step condition rarely exceed 2In, which corresponds to the
minimum swing impedance passing through Zone 1. Since the Metal-Oxide Varistors (MOV) bypass level is
normally set between 2-3In, they will not operate during the power oscillations and therefore in the majority of
applications they will not make any impact on Out-of-Step operation.
In the worst case, power oscillations are triggered on fault clearance on a parallel line. Approximately twice the
load current starts flowing through the remaining circuit. This increases further and eventually exceeds the MOV
threshold. The OST R6 - OST R5 region is usually set far from Zone 1, therefore it is unlikely that the positive
sequence impedance’s trajectory can traverse in and out of the set ∆R region due to the operation of MOVs. If
MOVs do operate in the ∆R region, a timer that has been initiated may reset and be reinitiated, or the impedance
may remain in the ∆R region for slightly longer. This is because resistive and capacitive components are added to
the measured impedance during MOV operation as shown in the figure below. This effect may have an impact on
the Delta T measurement if the Pred. OST Trip setting is used. If the recommendation to set R5min as close
as practically possible to R6max is followed, it is unlikely that the swing currents will exceed the MOV threshold in
the ∆R region. If a study shows that the MOVs could operate within the ∆R region, we recommend setting Pred.
& OST Trip operating mode to cover all eventualities.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 247
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV

+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6

OST Z5 Zone 5

DR

OST trip
MOVs operation
ZL
OST R6' OST R5'
Resistive reverse (R’) OST R5 OST R6
Resistive forward (+R)

OST Z5'

OST Z6'

V02765

Figure 131: Example of timer reset due to MOVs operation

Note:
If the OST Trip setting is chosen, the timer when triggered, will eventually expire as the power oscillations progress, therefore
the MOV operation will not have any impact on Out-of-Step operation.

248 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 11

AUTORECLOSE
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

250 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
Selected models of this product provide sophisticated Autoreclose (AR) functionality. The purpose of this chapter is
to describe the operation of this functionality including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 251
Introduction to Autoreclose 252
Autoreclose Implementation 253
Autoreclose System Map 261
Logic Modules 289
Setting Guidelines 341

P446SV-TM-EN-1 251
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION TO AUTORECLOSE
Approximately 80 - 90% of faults on transmission lines and distribution feeders are transient in nature. This means
that most faults do not last long, and are self-clearing if isolated. A common example of a transient fault is an
insulator flashover, which may be caused, for example, by lightning, clashing conductors, or wind-blown debris.
Protection functions detecting the flashover will cause one or more circuit breakers to trip and may also remove
the fault. If the source is removed, the fault does not recur if the line is re-energised.
The remaining 10 – 20% of faults are either semi-permanent or permanent. A small tree branch falling onto the
line for example, could cause a semi-permanent fault. Here the cause of the fault would not be removed by
immediate tripping of the circuit, but could possibly be burnt away during a time-delayed trip. Permanent faults
could be broken conductors, transformer faults, cable faults or machine faults, which must be located and
repaired before the power supply can be restored. In many fault incidents, if the faulty line is immediately tripped
out, and time is allowed for the fault arc to de-ionise, reclosing the circuit breakers will result in the line being
successfully re-energised.
Autoreclose schemes are used to automatically reclose a circuit breaker a set time after it has been opened due to
operation of a protection element. On EHV transmission networks, Autoreclose is usually characterised by high-
speed single-phase operation for the first attempt at reclosure. This is intended to help maintain system stability
during a transient fault condition. On HV/MV distribution networks, Autoreclose is applied mainly to radial feeders,
where system stability problems do not generally arise, and is generally characterised by delayed three-phase
operation with potentially multiple reclosure attempts.
Autoreclosing provides an important benefit on circuits using time-graded protection, in that it allows the use of
instantaneous protection to provide a high speed first trip. With fast tripping, the duration of the power arc
resulting from an overhead line fault is reduced to a minimum. This lessens the chance of damage to the line,
which might otherwise cause a transient fault to develop into a permanent fault. Using instantaneous protection
also prevents blowing of fuses in teed feeders, as well as reducing circuit breaker maintenance by eliminating pre-
arc heating. When instantaneous protection is used with Autoreclose, the scheme is normally arranged to block
the instantaneous protection after the first trip. Therefore, if the fault persists after re-closure, the time-graded
protection will provide discriminative tripping resulting in the isolation of the faulted section. However, for certain
applications, where the majority of the faults are likely to be transient, it is common practise to allow more than
one instantaneous trip before the instantaneous protection is blocked.
Some schemes allow a number of re-closures and time-graded trips after the first instantaneous trip, which may
result in the burning out and clearance of semi-permanent faults. Such a scheme may also be used to allow fuses
to operate in teed feeders where the fault current is low.
When considering feeders that are partly overhead line and partly underground cable, any decision to install
Autoreclose should be subject to analysis of the data (knowledge of the frequency of transient faults). This is
because this type of arrangement probably has a greater proportion of semi-permanent and permanent
faults than for purely overhead feeders. In this case, the advantages of Autoreclose are small. It can even be
disadvantageous because re-closing on to a faulty cable is likely to exacerbate the damage.

252 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

3 AUTORECLOSE IMPLEMENTATION
Before describing this function it is first necessary to understand the following terminology:
● A Shot is an attempt to close a circuit breaker using the Autoreclose function.
● Multi-shot is where more than one Shot is attempted.
● Single-shot is where only one Shot is attempted.
● Dead Time denotes the time between initiation of the Autoreclose operation and the attempt to close the
circuit breaker.
● Reclaim time is the time following the initiation of the circuit breaker closing and the resetting of the
Autoreclose scheme should the Autoreclose attempt be successful and the protection does not detect a
subsequent fault condition.
● High-speed Autoreclose is generally regarded as an Autoreclose application where the Dead Time is less
than 1 second.
● Delayed Autoreclose is generally regarded as an Autoreclose application where the Dead Time is greater
than 1 second.

This product features a multiple-shot Autoreclose function, which is suitable for both High-speed Autoreclose and
Delayed Autoreclose.
The Autoreclose function can be set to perform a single-shot, two-shot, three-shot or four-shot cycle. Dead Times
for all shots can be adjusted independently.
If a circuit breaker closes successfully at the end of the Dead Time, a Reclaim Time starts. If the circuit breaker
does not trip again, the Autoreclose function resets at the end of the Reclaim Time. If the protection trips again
during the Reclaim Time, the sequence advances to the next shot in the programmed cycle. If all programmed
reclose attempts have been made and the circuit breaker does not remain closed, the Autoreclose function goes
into Lockout, whereupon manual intervention is required.
An Autoreclose cycle can be initiated by operation of an internal or external protection element provided it is
mapped correctly, and that the circuit breaker is closed when the protection operates.
You can choose to initiate the Dead Time on:
● Protection operation
● A protection reset
● A Line Dead condition
● Circuit breaker operation
At the end of the relevant Dead Time, provided system conditions are suitable, a circuit breaker close signal is
given. The system conditions to be met for closing are that:
● the system voltages are in synchronism
● or that the dead line/live bus or live line/dead bus conditions exist as indicated by the internal system check
synchronising element
● and that the circuit breaker closing spring, or other energy source, is fully charged as indicated by the circuit
breaker healthy input.
The circuit breaker close signal is removed when the circuit breaker closes.
If the protection trips and the circuit breaker opens during the Reclaim Time, the Autoreclose function either
advances to the next shot in the programmed cycle, or if all programmed reclose attempts have been made, goes
into Lockout. Each time a closure is attempted, a sequence counter is incremented by 1 and the Reclaim Time
starts again.
Autoreclose is configured in the AUTORECLOSE column of the relevant settings group. The function is disabled by
default. If you wish to use it you must enable it first in the CONFIGURATION column.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 253
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

The Autoreclose function is a logic controller implemented in software. It takes inputs and processes them
according to defined logic to generates appropriate outputs. The logic is controlled by user prescribed settings and
commands. The controlling logic is complex and so, in order to facilitate its design and understanding, it is
decomposed into smaller logic functions which, when combined together implement the complete scheme. This
section concludes with a summary of:
● the logic inputs to the Autoreclose function,
● the logic outputs from the Autoreclose function
● the Autoreclose operating sequence
● the high-level design of the system logic functionality

3.1 AUTORECLOSE LOGIC INPUTS FROM EXTERNAL SOURCES


Logic inputs control the operation of the Autoreclose function. The logic inputs are mapped using DDB signals in
the PSL.
Generally the inputs are from external equipment connected to opto-isolated inputs. They can also come from
communications inputs, and some are internally derived.
This section provides an overview of the logic inputs originating from external sources.

3.1.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER HEALTHY INPUT


For circuit breakers to close, it needs energy. This energy usually comes from a spring (spring-charged circuit
breakers) or from gas pressure (gas pressurised circuit breakers). After closing, it is necessary to re-establish
sufficient energy in the circuit breaker before it can be closed again.
DDB signal inputs to the Autoreclose function allow the health of circuit breakers to be mapped to the logic. when
asserted, these signals demonstrate that there is sufficient energy available to close and trip the circuit breaker
before initiating a circuit breaker close command. If the signal indicating the health of the circuit breaker is low,
and remains low for a defined period set in the circuit breaker healthy timer, the circuit breaker locks out and stays
open.
If the circuit breaker healthy signal is not mapped in the PSL, the DDB signal defaults to high so that Autoreclose
may proceed.

3.1.2 INHIBIT AUTORECLOSE INPUT


A logic input can be used to inhibit the Autoreclose function. The signal is mapped to the DDB signal Inhibit AR in
the PSL.
Energising the input inhibits any auto-switching of connected circuit breakers. Any Autoreclose in progress is reset
and inhibited but not locked out. This function ensures that auto-switching does not interfere with any manual
switching. A typical application is on a mesh-corner scheme where manual switching is being performed on the
mesh, for which any Autoreclose would cause interference.
For products that are capable of single-phase tripping and Autoreclose, if a single-phase Autoreclose cycle is in
progress and a single pole of the circuit breaker is tripped when the inhibit Autoreclose signal is raised, the circuit
breaker is instructed to trip all phases, ensuring that all poles are in the same state (and avoiding a pole stuck
condition) when subsequent closing of the circuit breaker is attempted.

3.1.3 BLOCK AUTORECLOSE INPUT


External inputs can be used to block the Autoreclose function. If Autoreclose is in progress when the signal is
asserted, it forces a lockout.
Typically this feature is used where Autoreclose may be required for some protections functions but not required
for others. An example is on a transformer feeder, where Autoreclose can be initiated from the feeder protection
but blocked from the transformer protection.

254 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

It can also be used if an Autoreclose cycle is likely to fail for conditions associated with the protected circuit, such
as during the Dead Time, if a circuit breaker indicates that it is not healthy to switch.

3.1.4 RESET LOCKOUT INPUT


If a condition that forced a lockout has been removed, the lockout can be reset by energising a logic input
appropriately mapped in the PSL. Energising the input will also reset any Autoreclose alarms.

3.1.5 POLE DISCREPANCY INPUT


Circuit breakers with independent mechanisms for each pole (phase), normally incorporate a mechanism to cater
for cases where the phases are not together. This automatically trips all three phases if they are either not all open,
or not all closed.
During single-phase Autoreclosing a pole discrepancy condition is necessarily introduced, but the pole discrepancy
device should not operate for this condition. This can be achieved using a delayed action pole discrepancy device
with a delay longer than the single-pole Autoreclose Dead Time (SP AR Dead Time setting).
Alternatively, an input can be used for external devices to indicate a pole discrepancy condition. The pole
discrepancy input is activated by an external device to indicate that all three poles of a circuit breaker are not in
the same position. If mapped in the PSL, energising the input forces three-phase tripping (providing there is not a
single-phase Autoreclose in progress). Otherwise, a signal indicating single-phase Autoreclose in progress can be
used to inhibit the external pole discrepancy device.

3.1.6 EXTERNAL TRIP INDICATION


Protection operation from a different device can be used to initiate the Autoreclose function. By default these
external trip inputs are mapped to initiate Autoreclose and to initiate breaker failure protection (if the functions are
enabled). These inputs are not mapped to the trip outputs. With appropriate mapping in the PSL however, the
external device can use this product to trip connected circuit breakers.

3.2 AUTORECLOSE LOGIC INPUTS


This section provides an overview of the logic inputs, which are derived internally.

3.2.1 TRIP INITIATION SIGNALS


The phase A, phase B and phase C trip inputs are used to initiate single-phase and three-phase autoreclose. For
the Autoreclose to work, you must ensure that these Trip Input signals remain appropriately mapped in the PSL.

3.2.2 CIRCUIT BREAKER STATUS INPUTS


Circuit breaker status information must be available as logic input(s) for Autoreclose to work. You can select
whether to use CB open, CB closed, or both, as inputs. The settings are made in the CB CONTROL column of the
menu, and you need to ensure that the PSL mapping of the chosen input(s) is correct.

3.2.3 SYSTEM CHECK SIGNALS


System Check and Check Synchronization functions produce signals which are used by the Autoreclose logic
ensure that the Autoreclose function is applied only when the system is in a suitable condition.

3.3 AUTORECLOSE LOGIC OUTPUTS


Output signals are provided to provide indication of an Autoreclose in progress (ARIP). An ARIP signal is asserted
when an Autoreclose sequence starts. It remains high from initiation, either until lockout, or until successful
Autoreclose.
An Autoreclose lockout condition resets any ‘Autoreclose in progress’ and associated signals. Signals are available
to indicate that Autoreclose is in progress and that a circuit breakers has been successfully closed.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 255
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

3.4 AUTORECLOSE OPERATING SEQUENCE


The Autoreclose sequence is controlled by so-called Dead Timers. Dead Time Control settings are used to select
the conditions that initiate Dead Timers in the Autoreclose sequence (for example protection operate, protection
reset, CB open, etc.). This section describes typical AR operation sequences in which Dead Timers start when
protection operation resets.

Note:
In a multi-shot AR sequence, a number of Dead Timers are used (one for each shot). All Dead Timers are enabled when the
sequence is initiated, but each timer only starts when the particular shot with which it is associated is triggered.

3.4.1 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - TRANSIENT FAULT


The figure below describes the operating sequence for a single-shot Autorecloser for a transient fault that clears
when the faulted line is isolated.

Protection Trip

AR in Progress

CB Open

Dead Time

Auto -close

Reclaim Time

Successful Autoreclose

V03395

Figure 132: Autoreclose sequence for a Transient Fault

Following fault inception, the protection operates and issues a trip signal. At the same time the Autoreclose in
Progress signal is asserted. Shortly afterwards the circuit breaker will open as indicated by the CB Open signal.
Opening of the CB clears the fault and the protection resets. When this happens, the Dead Timer is started and the
output remains high until the Dead Time setting expires, whereupon it resets and the Autorecloser issues the Auto-
close command to close the circuit breaker. As the fault has been cleared, the circuit breaker closes and remains
closed. When the Auto-close pulse is removed, the Reclaim Timer starts. If no further fault is detected before the
Reclaim Timer expires, the Autoreclose is considered to be successful and this is indicated by the Successful
Autoreclose signal.

3.4.2 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - EVOLVING/PERMANENT FAULT


The figure below shows a single-shot AR operating sequence where the fault is not cleared by the first AR cycle.
The sequence starts in a similar way to that of a transient fault, but in this case the fault is not transient (it may be
permanent, or it may evolve into a fault involving more than one phase). This case shows an evolving fault
inception occurring before the Reclaim Time has expired. When the Autorecloser recognises that the protection
has tripped, the cycle is terminated. The Autorecloser goes into Lockout, and the Autoreclose in Progress signal is
reset.

256 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Protection Trip

AR in Progress

CB Open

Dead Time

Auto-close

Reclaim Time

Successful Autoreclose

Autoreclose Lockout

V03396

Figure 133: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault

3.4.3 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - EVOLVING/PERMANENT FAULT SINGLE-PHASE


If the Autorecloser is set for single-phase operation, then single phase operation is only allowed on the first shot.
Subsequent tripping will be three-phase only until the AR has been successful or until AR has locked out as shown
in the figure below.

Protection Trip 1-ph 3-ph

AR in Progress

CB Open

Dead Time

Auto -close

Reclaim Time

Successful Autoreclose

Autoreclose Lockout

V03397

Figure 134: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault - single-phase operation

3.4.4 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - TRANSIENT FAULT DUAL CB


The figure below describes the operating sequence for a single-shot on a dual CB (2CB) Autorecloser for a transient
fault that clears when the faulted line is isolated.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 257
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Protection Trip

CB1 AR in Progress

CB2 AR in Progress

CB1 Open

CB2 Open

Dead Time

Auto -close CB1

Follower Time

Auto -close CB2

Reclaim Time

CB1 Successful close

CB2 Successful close

V03398

Figure 135: Dual CB Autoreclose Sequence for a Transient Fault

Following fault inception, the protection operates and issues a trip signal. At the same time an Autoreclose in
Progress signal is asserted for each CB. Shortly afterwards, CB1 will open as indicated by the CB1 Open signal and
after a short delay CB2 opens. Opening of CB2 clears the fault and the protection resets. When this happens, the
Dead Timer is started and the output remains high until the Dead Time setting expires, whereupon it resets and the
Autorecloser issues the Auto-close command to close CB1. When CB1 closes, the Follower Timer starts. When the
Follower Timer expires, the Autorecloser issues the Autoclose command to close CB2. After CB2 has closed, as the
fault has been cleared, both CBs remain closed. When the Auto-close 2 pulse is removed, the Reclaim Timer starts.
If no further fault is detected before the Reclaim Timer expires, the Autoreclose is considered to be successful and
this is indicated by the Successful Autoreclose signals.

3.4.5 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - EVOLVING/PERMANENT FAULT DUAL CB


The figure below shows a single-shot AR operating sequence where the fault is not cleared by the first AR cycle.
The sequence starts in a similar way to that of a transient fault, but in this case the fault is not transient (it may be
permanent, or it may evolve into a fault involving more than one phase). This case shows an evolving fault
inception occurring before the Reclaim Time has expired. When the Autorecloser recognises that the protection
has tripped, the cycle is terminated. The Autorecloser goes to Lockout, and the AR in Progress signals are reset

258 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Protection Trip

CB1/CB2 AR in Progress

CB1 Open

CB2 Open

Dead Time Shot 1

Auto -close CB1

Follower Time

Auto -close CB2

Reclaim Time

Lockout

V03399

Figure 136: Autoreclose Sequence for an evolving/permanent fault on a dual CB application

3.4.6 AR TIMING SEQUENCE - PERSISTENT FAULT


The figure below shows the start of a multi-shot AR operating sequence where a single-phase fault is not cleared
by the first AR cycle. The sequence starts in a similar way to that of a transient fault, but in this case the fault is not
transient (it may be permanent, or it may evolve into a fault involving more than one phase). This case shows a
second fault inception occurring before the Reclaim Time has expired. The significant point here is that after the
first trip has occurred, the Autorecloser forces the 2 CBs into three-pole operation and different Dead Timers are
used for the single-phase cycle compared with the three-phase cycle.

Protection Trip 1-ph 3-ph

CB1/CB2 AR 1 -ph in
Progress
CB1/CB2 AR 3-ph in
Progress

CB1 Open 1 -ph

CB1 Open 3 -ph

CB2 Open 1 -ph

CB2 Open 3 -ph

Dead Time 1 -ph

AR Force CB1 3 -ph

AR Force CB2 3 -ph

Auto -close CB1

Follower Time 1 -ph

Auto -close CB2

Reclaim Time 1 -ph

Dead Time 3 -ph

V03400

Figure 137: Autoreclose Sequence for a persistent fault on a multishot dual CB application set for single-phase
operation

P446SV-TM-EN-1 259
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Note:
For three-phase Autoreclosing, for the first shot only, Autoreclose can be performed without checking that the voltages are in
synchronism using a setting. This setting, CB1L SC Shot 1 or CB2L SC Shot 1, can be enabled to perform synch-checks on shot
1 for CB1 or CB2, or disabled to not perform the checks.

260 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

4 AUTORECLOSE SYSTEM MAP


The Autoreclose System Map describes the System Design of the Autoreclose Logic implemented in this product.
The Autoreclose is implemented in logical software modules. The logical software modules interact by exchanging
signals between themselves, and with other software processes in the product. Interchange between modules is
limited to digital signals which are realised as either DDB signals or so called “internal signals” (IntSigs). DDB signals
are available for mapping in the PSL. Internal signals are similar to DDBs but they are self-contained within the
device's functions and are not user-accessible.
The Autoreclose System Map shows the interconnection of the logic modules that are used in the Autoreclose
system.
The logic diagrams follow a convention for the elements used, using defined colours and shapes. A key to this
convention is provided below. We recommend viewing the logic diagrams in colour rather than in black and white.
The electronic version of the technical manual is in colour, but the printed version is not. However, coloured
diagrams can be provided on request.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 261
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Key:
Energising Quantity AND gate &

Internal Signal OR gate 1

DDB Signal XOR gate XOR

Internal function NOT gate

Setting cell Logic 0 0

Setting value Timer

Hardcoded setting
Pulse / Latch

Measurement Cell S
SR Latch Q
R
Internal Calculation
S
SR Latch Q
Derived setting Reset Dominant RD

HMI key Latched on positive edge

Connection / Node Inverted logic input


1
Switch Soft switch 2

Switch Multiplier X

Bandpass filter
Comparator for detecting
undervalues

Comparator for detecting


V00063 overvalues

Figure 138: Key to logic diagrams

262 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

4.1 AUTORECLOSE SYSTEM MAP DIAGRAMS


CB Status Time CB1 Closed 3 ph AR In Service CB1 NoAR
CB1 Status Input CB1 Open 3 ph ARIP CB2 NoAR
CB1 Closed A ph Leader CB1 Leader CB1
CB1Aux 3ph(52-A)
CB1Aux 3ph(52-B) CB1 Open A ph Leader CB2 Follower CB1
CB1 Closed B ph CB1 Close Fail Leader CB2
CB1Aux A (52-A) Module 1
CB1 State Monitor CB1 Open B ph CB2 Close Fail Follower CB2
CB1Aux A (52-B)
CB1 Closed C ph AR CB1 Unhealthy
CB1Aux B (52-A) CB1LFRC
CB1 Open C ph AR CB2 Unhealthy
CB1Aux B (52-B) CB2 LFRC
CB1Aux C (52- A) CB1 Status Alm CB1 NoAR
SetLCB 1
CB1Aux C (52- B) CB2 NoAR
SetLCB 2
CB1 ARIP
CB Status Time CB2 Closed 3 ph
CB2 ARIP
CB2 Status Input CB2 Open 3 ph CB1 In Service
CB2 Aux3ph(52-A) CB2 Closed A ph CB2 In Service
CB2 Open A ph Module 7 & 8
CB2 Aux3ph(52-B) AR Enable CB1 Leader/Follower
CB2 Aux A(52-A) CB2 Closed B ph AR Enable CB2 Logic 1 & 2
Module 2
CB2 State Monitor CB2 Open B ph
CB2 Aux A(52-B) CB1 AR Lockout
CB2 Closed C ph
CB2 Aux B(52-A) CB2 AR Lockout
CB2 Aux B(52-B) CB2 Open C ph
ResetL-F
CB2 Aux C(52- A) CB2 Status Alm
PrefLCB1
CB2 Aux C(52- B) PrefLCB2

CB1 Open A ph CB1OP1P SetLCB1

CB1 Open B ph CB1OPAny SetLCB2

CB1 Open C ph CB1OP2/3P FollSPAROK

CB1 Open 3 ph Foll3PAROK


Module 3
CB2 Open A ph CB Open CB2OP1P CB2 LFRC
CB2 Open B ph CB2OPAny CB1 LFRC
CB2 Open C ph CB2OP2/3P BARCB1

CB2 Open 3 ph BARCB2

AR Mode Invalid AR Mode


CB1 AR Lockout CB1 In Service
CB1 Closed 3 ph Num CBs
CB1 CRLo Invalid_AR_Mode
CB1 ARIP Lead/Foll ARMode CB1 LSPAROK
Module 4
CB2 AR Lockout CB In Service CB2 In Service AR In Service CB1L3 PAROK
CB2 Closed 3 ph CB2 CRLo AR Enable CB1 FollSPAROK
CB2 ARIP AR Enable CB2 Foll3PAROK
AR Mode 1P CB2 LSPAROK
Auto-Reclose AR In Service
AR Mode 3P CB2L3 PAROK
HMI Command ARDisabled Seq Counter = 0 CB1FSPAROK
IEC 60870 Command
Seq Counter = 1 Module 9 CB1F3PAROK
AR On Pulse Module 5 Foll AR Mode 1P AR Modes Enable CB2FSPAROK
AR Enable
AR OFF Pulse Foll AR Mode 3P CB2F3PAROK
AR Enable Leader CB1
AR Enable CB1 Leader CB2
AR Enable CB2 FollCB1

Leader Select By PrefLCB1 CB2 LSPAROK

Select Leader PrefLCB2 FolSPAROK

CB2 Lead Module 6 FollCB2


Leader/Follower CB Selection
Num CBs
CB1 LSPAROK
Foll3PAROK
CB2 Lead

V03393-1

Figure 139: Autoreclose System Map - part 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 263
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

NUM CBs AR Force CB1 3P NUM CBs CB1 Trip AR MemA


CB1Tripping Mode AR Force CB2 3P CB1 Trip AR MemB
CB1 Trip OutputA
CB2Tripping Mode CB1 Ext Trip A
CB1 Trip AR MemC

CB1 ARIP CB1 Trip OutputB TAR2 /3PH


CB2 ARIP CB1 Ext Trip B TARAny
Inhibit AR CB1 Trip OutputC TARA
AR In Service CB1 Ext Trip C TARB
Seq Counter= 1 CB1 Ext Trip3ph TARC
Seq Counter= 2 ARIP ResPRMem
Seq Counter= 3 CB2 Trip AR MemA TMemAny
Module 13
Seq Counter= 4 CB2 Trip AR MemB
CB1-pole / 3-pole trip
TMEM1Ph
Module 10
CB1 AR Lockout
Force 3- phase Trip CB2 Trip AR MemC TMEM2/3Ph
CB2 AR Lockout CB1 Trip AR MemA TMEM3Ph
AR CB1 Unhealthy CB1 Trip AR MemB
AR CB2 Unhealthy CB1 Trip AR MemC
Leader CB1
CB2TARA
Leader CB2 CB2TARB
ARDisabled CB2TARC
TARAny InitAR
CB1LSPAROK ARDisabled
CB1FSPAROK TARAny
CB21LSPAROK
NUM CBs CB2 Trip AR MemA
CB2FSPAROK
CB2 Trip OutputA CB2 Trip AR MemB
Protection function 1 Trip ProtARBlock CB2 Trip AR MemC
CB2 Ext Trip A
Protection function n Trip InitAR CB2 Trip OutputB CB2TAR2/3PH
CB2 Ext Trip B CB2TARA
IA< Start
IB< Start CB2 Trip OutputC CB2TARB
Module 11 Module 14
IC< Start CB2 Ext Trip C CB2TARC
AR Initiation CB2 1-pole / 3- pole trip
AR Trip Test A CB2 Ext Trip3ph CB2 TMEM1Ph

AR Trip Test B CB2 Trip AR MemA CB2TMEM2/3 Ph

AR Trip Test C CB2 Trip AR MemB CB2 TMEM3Ph

Any Trip CB2 Trip AR MemC

ResPRMem
Test Autoreclose AR Trip Test A
InitAR
AR Trip Test B
Init APh AR Test
Module 12 AR Trip Test C Trip Inputs A FltMem2 P
Init BPh AR Test Trip Test
Init CPh AR Test AR Trip Test 3Ph Ext Fault Aph FltMem3 P
Trip Inputs B
Init 3P AR Test
Ext Fault BPh
Module 15
Trip Inputs C Fault Memory

Ext Fault CPh


AR Start

V03393-2 ResPRMem

Figure 140: Autoreclose System Map - part 2

264 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

CB2 Ext Trip A AR Start Single Pole Shot Seq Counter= 0


CB2 Ext Trip B CB1 AR Init Three Pole Shot Seq Counter= 1
CB2 Ext Trip C CB1 ARIP CB1 AR Init Seq Counter= 2
CB2 Ext Trip 3ph ARIP CB2 AR Init Seq Counter= 3
CB1 Ext Trip A Module 18 Seq Counter= 4
CB1LARIP ARIP
Sequence Counter
CB1 Ext Trip B CB1FARIP AR Start Seq Counter> 4
CB1 Ext Trip C Seq Counter>Set
1P Dtime
CB1 Ext Trip 3ph
Seq Counter= 1 SCIncrement
Inhibit AR
ProtRe_Op LastShot
CB1 LO Alarm
CB1 NoAR ARIP CB1 AR 1p InProg
CB1 ARIP ResetL-F CB2 AR 1p InProg
AR Start
ProtRe_Op LeaderSPAR
Set CB1 Close Module 16
CB1 AR In Progress TMEM1Ph CB1LSPAR
CB1 Closed 3 ph
CB2TMEM1PH CB2LSPAR
CB2 ARIP
CB1L 3PAR CB1FSPAR
Leader CB1 CB2L3PAR CB2FSPAR
Follower CB1 CB1F3PAR
InitAR CB2F3PAR
Module 19
TMEM2/3 Ph CB1 LARIP 1-phase AR Cycle Selection
TMEM1 Ph CB1FARIP
CB1Op2 /3P CB2 LARIP
CB1L3PAROK CB2FARIP
CB1F3PAROK CB1 LSPAROK
CB1ARSucc CB2 LSPAROK
CBARCancel CB1FSPAROK
CB1OPAny CB2FSPAROK
CB1LSPAR
CB2 Ext Trip A CB2 AR Init
CB2LSPAR
CB2 Ext Trip B CB2 ARIP
CB2 Ext Trip C CB2LARIP Discrim Time Evolve 3Ph
CB2 Ext Trip 3ph CB2FARIP 1P Dtime CB1 Failed AR
Inhibit AR Seq Counter= 1 CB2 Failed AR
CB2 LO Alarm CB1 AR Lockout ProtRe_Op
CB2 NoAR
CB2 AR Lockout EvolveLock
CB2 ARIP CB1 Closed 3 ph ResetL-F
AR Start
CB2 Closed 3 ph
Set CB2 Close Module 20
CB1 ARIP
Evolving Fault
CB2 Closed 3 ph CB2 ARIP
Module 17
Leader CB2 CB2 AR In Progress
TMemAny
Follower CB2
TARAny
InitAR ProtRe_Op
CB2TMEM2/3Ph LastShot
CB2TMEM1Ph SetCB1Cl
CB2OP2/3 P SetCB2Cl
CB2L3PAROK
CB2F3PAROK
CB2ARSucc
CBARCancel
CB2OPAny

V03393-3

Figure 141: Autoreclose System Map - part 3

P446SV-TM-EN-1 265
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Evolve 3Ph CB1 AR 3p InProg 3P AR DT Shot 1 OK Time 3P

CB1LARIP CB2 AR 3p InProg 3P AR DT Shot 2 3P DTime1


3P AR DT Shot 3 3P DTime2
CB1 L3PAROK CB1L3 PAR
TMEM3 P CB2L3 PAR 3P AR DT Shot 4 3P DTime3
3P DTime4
CB1OP2/3 P CB1F3PAR DTOK CB1L 3P
TMemAny CB2F 3PAR DTOK CB2L 3P 3P Dead Time IP
CB1 3P DTime
CB1LSPAROK DTOK All
Module 25 CB2 3P DTime
CB2LARIP AR Start
3-phase AR Dead Time
CB2 L3PAROK Module 21 Seq Counter= 1 3PDTCOMP
3-phase AR cycle selection
CB2TMEM3P Seq Counter= 2 CB13PDTComp
CB2OP2/3 P Seq Counter= 3 CB23PDTComp
CB2LSPAROK Seq Counter= 4
CB1FARIP CB1L3PAR
CB1F3PAROK CB2L3PAR
CB1FSPAROK 3PDTCOMP
CB2FARIP
CB2F3PAROK BF if LFail Cls En CB1 Follower

CB2FSPAROK AR Start En CB2 Follower

Control CloseCB1
DT Start by Prot DTOK All
CB1 AR Lockout
3PDTStart WhenLD DTOK CB1L 1P
CB1 Closed 3 ph
DTStart by CB Op DTOK CB1L 3P
CB1 Close Fail
Num CBs DTOK CB2L 1P
Control CloseCB2 Module 27
AR Start DTOK CB2L 3P Follower CB AR Enable
CB2 AR Lockout
OK Time 3P DeadLineLockout CB2 Close Fail
ARIP CB2 Closed 3 ph
CB1 AR Init
CB1FSPAR
CB2 AR Init
Module 22 CB1F3PAR
Dead Line
Dead Time Start Enable CB2FSPAR
CB1 AR 1p InProg
CB2F3PAR
CB2 AR 1p InProg
CB1 Open 3 ph Dynamic F/L 1PF TComp
CB2 Open 3 ph Follower Time 1P Follower Time

OKTimeSP En CB1 Follower CB1SPFTComp


CB1OP1P En CB2 Follower CB2SPFTComp
CB1OPAny 1PF TComp
CB2OP1P Seq Counter= 1
CB2OPAny AR Start
Module 28
DT Start by Prot 1P Dtime CB1LFRC Follower 1- phase CB AR Time

1 Pole Dead Time


CB2LFRC
OKTimeSP
CB1 OP1P
DTOK CB1L 1P CB1SPDTComp
CB2 OP1P
DTOK CB2L 1P CB2SPDTComp
CB1FSPAR
Seq Counter= 1
Module 24 CB2FSPAR
DTOK All
1-phase AR Dead Time CB1OP2/3P
AR Start
CB2OP2/3P
CB1 LSPAR
CB2 LSPAR
CB1OP2/3 P
CB2OP2/3 P

V03393-4

Figure 142: Autoreclose System Map - part 4

266 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Dynamic F /L 3PF TComp Set CB1 Close SetCB1SPCl


Follower Time 3P Follower Time Set CB2 Close SetCB13 PCl

CB1 open 3 ph CB13PFTComp CB1L SCOK SetCB2SPCl

CB2 open 3 ph CB23PFTComp CB2L SCOK SetCB23 PCl


CB1 Fast SCOK
En CB1 Follower
En CB2 Follower CB2 Fast SCOK
OK Time 3P
3PF TComp Module 29
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time CB1F SCOK
AR Start
CB2F SCOK Module 34
CB1FSPAR Prepare Reclaim Initiation

CB2FSPAR CB1SPDTComp

CB1F3PAR CB1SPFTComp

CB2F3PAR CB13PDTComp

CB1LFRC CB13PFTComp

CB2LFRC CB2SPDTComp
CB2SPFTComp
Any Trip Set CB1 Close
CB23PDTComp
CB1 AR Lockout Auto Close CB1 CB23PFTComp
CB1 Healthy CB1 Control
CB1 Open 3 ph Set CB2 Close Dynamic F/L 1P Reclaim TComp

CB1L SCOK Auto Close CB2 Close Pulse Time 1P Reclaim Time

CB1 Fast SCOK CB2 Control SPAR ReclaimTime 3P Reclaim TComp


OK Time 3P 3PAR ReclaimTime 3P Reclaim Time

CB1F SCOK Auto Close CB1 CBARCancel


ARIP Auto Close CB2
CB1 ARIP 1P Reclaim Time

CB1 Closed 3 ph 3P Reclaim Time


CB2 AR Lockout CB1 Closed 3 ph
CB2 Healthy CB2 Closed 3 ph
CB2 Open 3 ph CB1 ARIP
CB2L SCOK CB2 ARIP Module 35
CB2 Fast SCOK Reclaim Time
SetCB 1SPCl
CB2F SCOK
SetCB 2SPCl
CB2 ARIP
Module 32 & 33 SetCB13PCl
CB2 Closed 3 ph CB Autoclose
SetCB23 PCl
CB1SPDTComp CB1FARIP
CB1OP1P CB2FARIP
CB1L3PAR CB1LARIP
CB13 PDTComp CB2LARIP
CB1FSPAR CB1LFRC
CB1SPFTComp CB2LFRC
CB1F3PAR LeaderSPAR
CB13 PFTComp ProtRe_Op
ProtRe_ Op
CB2SPDTComp
CB2OP1P
CB2L3PAR
CB23 PDTComp
CB2FSPAR
CB2SPFTComp
CB2F3PAR
CB23 PFTComp

V03393-5

Figure 143: Autoreclose System Map - part 5

P446SV-TM-EN-1 267
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

1P Reclaim TComp CB1 Succ 1P AR CB Healthy Time AR CB1 Unhealthy


3P Reclaim TComp CB1 Succ 3P AR Check Sync Time AR CB1 No C/S
CB1 Closed 3 ph CB2 Succ 1P AR OK Time 3P AR CB2 Unhealthy
CB2 Closed 3 ph CB2 Succ 3P AR CB1 Fast SCOK AR CB2 No C/S

SetCB1SPCl CB1 ARSucc CB1 Healthy


SetCB13 PCl CB2 ARSucc CB1 AR Lockout

CB1OP1P Module 36 CB1 Closed 3 ph


Successful AR Signals
CB1OP2/3 P CB1L SCOK
ResCB1ARSucc CB1F SCOK

SetCB2SPCl CB2 Fast SCOK


SetCB23 PCl CB2 Healthy
CB2OP1P CB2 AR Lockout
Module 39 & 40
CB2OP2/3 P CB2 Closed 3 ph CB Healthy and System Check
Timers
ResCB2ARSucc CB2L SCOK
CB2F SCOK
Res AROK by UI ResCB1ARSucc
Reset AROK Ind ResCB2ARSucc CB1L3PAR

Res AROK by NoAR CB1SPDTComp

Res AROK by Ext CB1SPFTComp

Res AROK by Tdly CB13PDTComp

AROK Reset Time CB13PFTComp

Num CBs CB2L3PAR


Module 37 & 38 CB2SPDTComp
AR Start
AR Reset Successful CB2SPFTComp
Ext Rst CB1 AROK
CB23PDTComp
Ext Rst CB2 AROK
CB23 PFTComp
CB1OPAny
CB Control by Control TripCB1
CB2OPAny
Trip Pulse Time CB1 Trip Fail
CB1ARSucc
CB2ARSucc Man Close Delay CB1 Close inProg
Close Pulse Time Control CloseCB1
ARDisabled
CB Healthy Time CB1 Close Fail
Reset CB Shots CB1 Total Shots Counter Check Sync Time ManCB1 Unhealthy
Set CB1 Close CB1 Successful SPAR HMI Trip NoCS CB1ManClose
CB1 Succ 1P AR Shot 1 Counter
HMI Close
CB1 Successful 3PAR
CB1 Succ 3P AR Shot 1 Counter Init Trip CB1
Seq Counter= 1 CB1 Successful 3PAR
Init close CB1
Seq Counter= 2 Shot 2 Counter
CB1 Successful 3PAR CB1 Arip
Seq Counter= 3
Shot 3 Counter Auto Close CB1
Seq Counter= 4 CB1 Successful 3PAR
Shot 4 Counter Rst CB1 CloseDly
CB1 Arip
Any Trip
CB1 AR Lockout CB1 Failed Counter Module 43
Module 41 & 42 Control TripCB1 CB Control (CB1)
Ext Rst CB1Shots AR Shot Counters
CB2 Total Shots Counter CB1 Ext Trip3Ph
CB2 Arip
CB2 Successful SPAR CB1 Ext Trip A
CB2 AR Lockout
Shot 1 Counter CB1 Ext Trip B
Ext Rst CB2Shots CB2 Successful 3PAR
CB1 Ext Trip C
Set CB2 Close Shot 1 Counter
CB2 Successful 3PAR CB1 Open 3 ph
CB2 Succ 1P AR
Shot 2 Counter CB1 Open A ph
CB2 Succ 3P AR CB2 Successful 3PAR
CB1 Open B ph
Shot 3 Counter
CB2 Successful 3PAR CB1 Open C ph
Shot 4 Counter CB1 Closed 3 ph
CB2 Failed Counter CB1 Closed A ph
CB1 Closed B ph
CB1 Closed C ph
CB1 Healthy

V03393-6 CB1 Man SCOK

Figure 144: Autoreclose System Map - part 6

268 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

CB Control by Control TripCB2 CB2L SC ClsNoDly CB2 Fast SCOK


Trip Pulse Time CB2 Trip Fail CB2L SC CS1 CB2L SCOK
Man Close Delay CB2 Close inProg CB2L SC CS2
Close Pulse Time Control CloseCB2 CB2L SC DLLB
CB Healthy Time CB2 Close Fail CB2L SC LLDB
Check Sync Time ManCB2 Unhealthy CB2L SC DLDB

HMI Trip NoCS CB2ManClose CB2L SC Shot 1

HMI Close CB2L SC all


Module 46
CB2 CS1 OK 3 Phase AR System Check
Init Trip CB2 Leader(CB2)
Init close CB2 CB2 CS2 OK
Dead Line
CB2 ARIP
Live Bus 2
Auto Close CB2
Live Line
Rst CB2 CloseDly
Any Trip Dead Bus 2
Module 44
Control TripCB2 Dead Line
CB Control (CB2)
CB2 Ext Trip 3Ph Seq Counter= 1

CB2 Ext Trip A CB2 Ext CS OK

CB2 Ext Trip B CB1 Fast SCOK


CB2 Ext Trip C CB1F SC CS1 CB1F SCOK
CB2 Open 3 ph CB1F SC CS2
CB2 Open A ph
CB1F SC DLLB
CB2 Open B ph CB1F SC LLDB
CB2 Open C ph
CB1F SC DLDB
CB2 Closed 3 ph CB1F SC Shot 1
CB2 Closed A ph CB1F SC all Module 47
CB2 Closed B ph 3 Phase AR System Check
CB1 CS1 OK Follower (CB1)
CB2 Closed C ph
CB1 CS2 OK
CB2 Healthy
Live Bus 1
CB2 Man SCOK
Live Line

CB1L SC ClsNoDly CB1 Fast SCOK Dead Bus 1


CB1L SC CS1 CB1L SCOK Dead Line
CB1L SC CS2 Seq Counter= 1
CB1L SC DLLB CB1 Ext CS OK
CB1L SC LLDB
CB2 Fast SCOK
CB1L SC DLDB
CB2F SC CS1 CB2F SCOK
CB1L SC Shot 1
CB2F SC CS2
CB1L SC all Module 45
3 Phase AR System Check CB2F SC DLLB
CB1 CS1 OK Leader( CB1)
CB2F SC LLDB
CB1 CS2 OK CB2F SC DLDB
Live Bus 1 CB2F SC Shot 1
Live Line CB2F SC all Module 48
Dead Bus1 3 Phase AR System Check
CB2 CS1 OK Follower (CB2)
Dead Line
CB2 CS2 OK
Seq Counter= 1
Live Bus 2
CB1 Ext CS OK
Live Line
Dead Bus 2
Dead Line
Seq Counter= 1

V03393-7 CB2 Ext CS OK

Figure 145: Autoreclose System Map - part 7

P446SV-TM-EN-1 269
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

CB1M SC CS1 CB1 Man SCOK Multi Phase AR CB1 AR Lockout


CB1M SC CS2 CB2 Man SCOK BF if LFail Cls BARCB1
CB1M SC DLLB Num CBs
CB1M SC LLDB Trip Pulse Time
CB1M SC DLDB
CB1 Close Fail
CB1M SC required CB2 AR Lockout
CB2M SC CS1
CB1 Fail Pr Trip
CB2M SC CS2
CB2 Fail Pr Trip
CB2M SC DLLB Block CB1 AR
CB2M SC LLDB AR CB1 Unhealthy
CB2M SC DLDB AR In Service
CB2M SC required AR CB1 No C/S
Module 51 & 52
CB Manual Close System Check
CB1 CS1 OK Evolve 3Ph
CB1 CS2 OK CB1 In Service
CB2 CS1 OK CB2 In Service
CB2 CS2 OK Seq Counter>Set
Live Bus 1 CB1 Status Alm
Live Bus 2 Set CB1 Close
Live Line Set CB2 Close
Dead Bus1 CB1 AR Init
Dead Bus2 CB1 ARIP Module 55
Autoreclose Lockout
Dead Line FltMem2P (CB1)
CB1 Ext CS OK FltMem3P
CB2 Ext CS OK
CB2LFRC

Trip Pulse Time CB1 Fail Pr Trip CB1FARIP

CB2 Fail Pr Trip CB1OPAny


CB1 Open 3 ph
ProtRe_Op
CB1 Closed 3 ph
LastShot
CB2 Open 3 ph
EvolveLock
CB2 Closed 3 ph Module 53 & 54
CB Trip Time Monitor ProtARBlock
TARA TMEM1Ph
TARB TMEM2/3Ph
TARC CB1L3 PAROK
TAR2 /3Ph CB1F3PAROK
TMEM2/3 Ph CB1LSPAROK
CB1FSPAROK
CB1LARIP
CB1FARIP
CB2OPAny
Invalid_AR_Mode
DeadLineLockout
V03393-8 ResCB1Lo

Figure 146: Autoreclose System Map - part 8

270 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Multi Phase AR CB2 AR Lockout Res LO by CB IS ResCB1Lo


BF if LFail Cls BARCB2 Res LO by UI ResCB2Lo
Num CBs Reset CB1 LO
Trip Pulse Time Reset CB2 LO
Res LO by NoAR
CB2 Close Fail
CB1 AR Lockout Res LO by ExtDDB
Res LO by TDelay
CB1 Fail Pr Trip
LO Reset Time
CB2 Fail Pr Trip Module 57 & 58
Block CB2 AR Num CBs Reset CB Lockout

AR CB2 Unhealthy Rst CB1 Lockout


AR In Service Rst CB2 Lockout
AR CB2 No C/S CB1 AR Lockout
Evolve 3Ph CB2 AR Lockout
CB1 In Service CB1CRLo
CB2 In Service CB2CRLo
Seq Counter>Set
ARDisabled
CB2 Status Alm
Set CB1 Close System Checks Live Line

Set CB2 Close VAN Dead line


VBN Live Bus 1
CB2 AR Init
VCN Dead Bus 1
CB2 ARIP Module 56
Autoreclose Lockout VAB
VBC Live Bus 2
FltMem2P (CB2)
VCA Dead Bus 2
FltMem3P VBus
CB2LFRC MCB/VTS Module 59
CB2FARIP MCB/VTS CB1 CS System Checks Voltage Monitor
CB2OPAny MCB/VTS CB2 CS
ProtRe_ Op Inhibit LL
LastShot Inhibit DL
EvolveLock Inhibit LB1
ProtARBlock Inhibit LB2
TMEM1 Ph Inhibit DB1
TMEM2/3 Ph Inhibit DB2
CB2 L3PAROK
CB2F3PAROK
CB2LSPAROK
CB2FSPAROK
CB2LARIP
CB2FARIP
CB2OPAny
Invalid_AR_Mode
DeadLineLockout
ResCB2Lo

V03393-9

Figure 147: Autoreclose System Map - part 9

P446SV-TM-EN-1 271
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Sys checks CB1 SChksInactiveCB1 CB1 AR Lockout Pole Discrep CB1


CB1 CS1 Status CB1 CS1 SlipF > CB2 AR Lockout Pole Discrep CB2
CB1 CS2 Status CB1 CS1 SlipF < CB1 LO Alarm
VAN CB1 CS2 SlipF > CB2 LO Alarm
VBN CB1 CS2 SlipF < Pol Disc CB1 Ext
VCN
CS Vline> Pol Disc CB2 Ext
VAB
VAB
VBC CS Vbus> CB1 AR 1p InProg Module 62
VCA CS Vline< CB2 AR 1p InProg Pole Discrepancy
VBus
VBus1
CS Vbus< CB1 Open A ph
MCB/VTS CB1 CS
CB1 CS1 Vl>Vb CB1 Open B ph
MCB/VTS
CB1 CS1 Vl<Vb CB1 Open C ph
VTS Fast Block
CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb CB2 Open A ph
Module 60
F out of Range Check Sync Signals CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb CB2 Open B ph
CB1 CS1 Enabled (CB1)
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ CB2 Open C ph
CB1 CS2 Enabled
CB1 CS1 AngHigh-
CB1Tripping Mode CB1 Trip OutputA
CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2Tripping Mode CB1 Trip OutputB
CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb
Trip Inputs A CB1 Trip OutputC
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 Trip OutputA
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- Trip Inputs B
Trip Inputs C CB2 Trip OutputB
CB1 CS AngRotACW
CB2 Trip OutputC
CB1 CS AngRotCW AR Force CB1 3P
AR Force CB2 3P CB1 Trip 3ph
CB1 CS2 Vl>Vb Module 63
Force 3PTrip CB1 CB Trip Conversion CB2 Trip 3ph
CB1 CS2 Vl<Vb
Any Trip
CB1 CS1 OK Force 3PTrip CB2
CB1 Trip I/P 3Ph 2/3 Ph Fault
CB1 CS2 OK
CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph 3 Ph Fault
Sys checks CB2 SChksInactiveCB2 Pole Dead A
CB2 CS1 Status CB2 CS1 SlipF > Pole Dead B
CB2 CS2 Status CB2 CS1 SlipF <
Pole Dead C
VAN
VAN CB2 CS2 SlipF >
VBN CB2 CS2 SlipF <
VCN
CS Vbus2>
VAB
VBC CS Vbus2<
VCA CB2 CS1 Vl>Vb
VBus1
VBus CB2 CS1 Vl<Vb
MCB/VTS CB2 CS
CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb
MCB/VTS CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb
Module 61
VTS Fast Block Check Sync Signals CB2 CS1 AngHigh+
F out of Range (CB2 ) CB2 CS1 AngHigh-
CB2 CS1 Enabled
CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS2 Enabled CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 CS2 AngHigh-
CB2 CS AngRotACW
CB2 CS AngRotCW
CB2 CS2 Vl>Vb
CB2 CS2 Vl<Vb
CB2 CS1 OK

V03393-10 CB2 CS2 OK

Figure 148: Autoreclose System Map - part 10

4.2 AUTORECLOSE INTERNAL SIGNALS


The following table lists all the internal signals used in the CB control and Autoreclose logic system:
Signal Name Source Destination Description
3PDTCOMP 3-phase AR Dead Time (25) 3-phase AR Dead Time (25) Three phase dead time complete
Reset CB Lockout (57)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
ARDisabled AR Enable (5) Overall autoreclosing disabled
CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
AR Reset Successful (37)
BARCB1 Autoreclose Lockout (55) Leader/Follower (7) Block Autoreclose for CB1

272 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Signal Name Source Destination Description


BARCB2 Autoreclose Lockout (55) Leader/Follower (7) Block Autoreclose for CB2
CB Autoclose (32)
Three-pole Autoreclose dead time is
CB13PDTComp 3-phase AR Dead Time (25) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
complete for CB1
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Autoclose (32)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Three-pole Autoreclose follower time is
CB13PFTComp Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
Time (29) complete for CB1
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
AR Reset Successful (37)
CB1ARSucc Successful AR Signals (36) Autoreclose successful for CB1
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Autoreclose Lockout (55) Autoreclose in progress for CB1 acting as
CB1FARIP CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Reclaim Time (35) follower
Autoreclose Lockout (55) Autoreclose in progress for CB1 acting as
CB1LARIP CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Reclaim Time (35) leader
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
CB1OP1P CB Open (3) CB1 is open on 1 phase
CB Autoclose (32)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
CB1OP2/3P CB Open (3) CB1 is open on 2 or 3 phases
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB1OPAny CB Open (3) Autoreclose Lockout (55) CB1 is open on 1, 2 or 3 phases
CB1 is OK for single-phase autoreclosure
CB1SPOK
(either as leader or follower)
CB1CRLo CB In Service (4) Reset CB Lockout (57) Reset CB1 lockout
3-phase AR cycle selection Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29) Three-phase Autoreclose is active for CB1
CB1F3PAR
(21) CB Autoclose (32) as follower
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 is OK to perform three-phase
CB1F3PAROK AR Modes Enable (9) 3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
Autoreclose as follower
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Follower CB AR Enable (27
1-phase AR Cycle Selection Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28) Single-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB1FSPAR
(19) Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29) CB1 as follower
CB Autoclose (32)
Force 3-phase Trip (10), 1-phase AR Cycle
Selection (19) CB1 is OK to perform single-phase
CB1FSPAROK AR Modes Enable (9)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21) Autoreclose as follower
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
3-phase AR cycle selection 3-phase AR Dead Time (25) Three-phase Autoreclose is active for CB1
CB1L3PAR
(21) CB Autoclose (32) (CB1 as leader)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 is OK to perform three-phase
CB1L3PAROK AR Modes Enable (9) 3-phase AR cycle selection (21),
Autoreclose (as leader)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Leader/Follower
Logic 1 & 2 (7)
Leader/Follower
CB1LFRC Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28) CB1 failed to reclose (as leader)
Logic 1 & 2 (7)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
Reclaim Time (35)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 273
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Signal Name Source Destination Description


1-phase AR Cycle Selection 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19) Single-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB1LSPAR
(19) 1-phase AR Dead Time (24) CB1 (as leader)
AR Modes Enable (9), Force 3-phase Trip
(10)
CB1 is OK to perform single-phase
CB1LSPAROK AR Modes Enable (9) 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Autoreclose (as leader)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
CB Autoclose (32)
CB1SPDTComp 1-phase AR Dead Time (24) CB1 single-phase dead time is complete
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Autoclose (32), Prepare Reclaim
Follower 1-phase CB AR
CB1SPFTComp Initiation (34) CB1 single-phase follower time is complete
Time (28)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB2 three-phase Autoreclose dead time is
CB23PDTComp 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
complete
Follower 3-phase CB AR CB2 three-phase Autoreclose time is
CB23PFTComp
Time (29) complete
CB2 is OK for three-phase Autoreclose as
CB23POK
leader or follower
CB2ARSucc CB2 AR In Progress (17) Autoreclose successful for CB2
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Autoreclose is in progress for CB2 as
CB2FARIP CB2 AR In Progress (17) 3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
follower
Reclaim Time (35)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
CB2LARIP CB2 AR In Progress (17) 3-phase AR cycle selection (21) Autoreclose is in progress for CB2 as leader
Reclaim Time (35)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB2OP1P CB Open (3) CB2 is open on 1 phase
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
CB2OP2/3P CB Open (3) CB2 is open on 2 or 3 phases
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB2OpAny CB Open (3) Dead Time Start Enable (22) CB2 is open on 1, 2 or 3 phases
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 is OK for single-phase Autoreclose as
CB2SPOK
leader or follower
A 2-phase or 3-phase trip has initiated
CB2TAR2/3Ph CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
Autoreclose for CB2
An A-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose
CB2TARA CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
for CB2
A B-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose for
CB2TARB CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2
A C-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose for
CB2TARC CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19) A single-phase trip initiated Autoreclose for
CB2TMEM1Ph CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB2 AR In Progress (17) CB2
A 2-phase or 3-phase trip initiated
CB2TMEM2/3Ph CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Autoreclose for CB2
CB2TMEM3Ph CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) A 3-phase trip initiated Autoreclose for CB2

274 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Signal Name Source Destination Description


CB2CRLo CB In Service (4) Reset lockout for CB2
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Three-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB2F3PAR Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB2 as a follower
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
CB2 AR In Progress (17) CB2 is OK to perform three-phase
CB2F3PAROK AR Modes Enable (9)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21) Autoreclose as follower
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection Single-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB2FSPAR Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
(19) CB2 as follower
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
CB2 is OK to perform single-phase
CB2FSPAROK AR Modes Enable (9) 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Autoreclose as follower
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
3-phase AR cycle selection Three-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB2L3PAR 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
(21) CB2 as leader
CB2 AR In Progress (17) CB2 is OK to perform three-phase
CB2L3PAROK AR Modes Enable (9)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21) Autoreclose as leader
Leader/Follower (7)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
Leader/Follower
CB2LFRC Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29) CB2 failed to reclose as leader
Logic 1 & 2 (7)
Reclaim Time (35)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
AR Modes Enable (9)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection Single-phase Autoreclose is in progress for
CB2LSPAR 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
(19) CB2 as leader
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
AR Modes Enable (9)
CB2 is OK to perform single-phase
CB2LSPAROK AR Modes Enable (9) 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Autoreclose as leader
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
CB2SPDTComp 1-phase AR Dead Time (24) CB2 single-phase dead time is complete
Follower 1-phase CB AR
CB2SPFTComp CB2 single-phase follower time is complete
Time (28)
Signal to force the auto-reclose sequence
DeadLineLockout Dead Time Start Enable (22) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
to lockout
Enable dead time for three-phase
ENABLE CB13PDT
Autoreclose for CB1
Enable dead time for single-phase
ENABLE CB1SPDT
Autoreclose for CB1
Enable dead time for three-phase
ENABLE CB23PDT
Autoreclose for CB2
Enable dead time for single-phase
ENABLE CB2SPDT
Autoreclose for CB2
Lockout for 2nd trip after the "Discrim
EvolveLock Evolving Fault (20) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Time" has expired
Signal from the frequency tracking logic
F Out of Range Check Sync Signals (60) indicating that the measured power system
frequency is outside the operational range
A signal to indicate that the initiating fault
FltMem2P Fault Memory (15) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
involved 2 phases
A signal to indicate that the initiating fault
FltMem3P Fault Memory (15) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
involved 3 phases
Leader/Follower (7) The follower circuit breaker is Ok for three-
Foll3PAROK AR Modes Enable (9)
AR Modes Enable (9) phase Autoreclose

P446SV-TM-EN-1 275
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Signal Name Source Destination Description


The follower circuit breaker is Ok for single-
FollSPAROK AR Modes Enable (9) Leader/Follower (7)
phase Autoreclose
AR Initiation (11)
CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
Internally derived signal to initiate
InitAR AR Initiation (11) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
Autoreclose (external triggers not included)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
An invalid state is being indicated by the
Invalid_AR_Mode AR Modes Enable (9) Autoreclose Lockout (55) logic that uses opto-inputs to determine
the Autoreclose mode.
Evolving Fault (20) Idicates tha the Autoreclose sequence has
LastShot Sequence Counter (18)
Autoreclose Lockout (55) reached the last shot
The dead time for single pole Autoreclose is
OKTimeSP 1-phase AR Dead Time (24) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
OK
Leader/Follower CB
PrefLCB1 Leader/Follower (7) CB1 is the preferred leader
Selection (6)
Leader/Follower CB
PrefLCB2 Leader/Follower (7) CB2 is the preferred leader
Selection (6)
Signal to block Autoreclose for selected
ProtARBlock AR Initiation (11) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
host protection elements
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Sequence Counter (18) Signal to indicate that further protection
ProtRe_Op Evolving Fault (20)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19) operation has occurred during Autoreclose
Evolving Fault (20)
Successful AR Signals (36) Reset the indication of successful
ResCB1ARSucc Successful AR Signals (36)
AR Reset Successful (37) Autoreclose for CB1
ResCB1Lo Reset CB Lockout (57) Autoreclose Lockout (55) Reset the indication of lockout for CB1
Reset the indication of successful
ResCB2ARSucc
Autoreclose for CB2
ResCB2Lo Reset the indication of lockout for CB2
Leader/Follower (7) Used to reset the allocation of leader/
ResetL-F Evolving Fault (20)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19) follower functionality
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) Reset the signal that indicates the faulted
ResPRMem CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
Fault Memory (15) phases that initiated the Autoreclose
SCIncrement Sequence Counter (18) Increment the sequence counter
SCCountoveqShots Sequence counter has exceeded setting
Leader/Follower
SetLCB1 Leader/Follower (7) CB1 has been selected as leader
Logic 1 & 2 (7)
Leader/Follower
SetLCB2 Leader/Follower (7) CB2 has been selected as leader
Logic 1 & 2 (7)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation Reclaim Time (35)
SetCB13PCl Three-phase close command to CB1
(34) Successful AR Signals (36)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation Reclaim Time (35)
SetCB1SPCl Single-phase close command to CB1
(34) Successful AR Signals (36)
SetCB23PCl Reclaim Time (35) Three-phase close command to CB2
SetCB2SPCl Reclaim Time (35) Single-phase close command to CB2
SPDTComp Single-phase dead time complete
CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13), A 2-phase or 3-phase trip has initiated
TAR2/3Ph CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14) Autoreclose for CB1 (as leader)

276 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Signal Name Source Destination Description


TARA CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) CB Trip Time Monitor (53) An A-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
TARAny CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) Any trip has initiated Autoreclose
Evolving Fault (20)
TARB CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) CB Trip Time Monitor (53) A B-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose
TARC CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) CB Trip Time Monitor (53) A C-phase trip has initiated Autoreclose
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Signal to remember that Autoreclose was
TMEM1Ph CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) CB1 AR In Progress (16)
initiated by a single-phase fault
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB Trip Time Monitor (53) Signal to remember that Autoreclose was
TMEM2/3Ph CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13) Autoreclose Lockout (55) initiated by a 2-phase fault or a 3-phase
CB1 AR In Progress (16) fault
Signal to remember that Autoreclose was
TMEM3Ph CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
initiated by a 3-phase fault
Evolving Fault (20) Signal to remember that Autoreclose was
TMemAny CB1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21) initiated by an AnyTrip

4.3 AUTORECLOSE DDB SIGNALS


The following table lists all the DDB signals used in the CB control and Autoreclose logic system:
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
Sequence Counter (18)
1P DTime 1554 1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
Evolving Fault (20)
1P Follower Time 1446 Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
1P Reclaim TComp 1568 Reclaim Time (35) Successful AR Signals (36)
1P Reclaim Time 1567 Reclaim Time (35) Reclaim Time (35)
1PF TComp 1561 Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28) Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
2/3 Ph Fault 527 CB Trip Conversion (63)
3 Ph Fault 528 CB Trip Conversion (63)
3P Dead Time IP 853 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
3P DTime1 1556 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
3P DTime2 1557 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
3P DTime3 1558 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
3P DTime4 1559 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
3P Follower Time 1447 Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
3P Reclaim TComp 1570 Reclaim Time (35) Successful AR Signals (36)
3P Reclaim Time 1569 Reclaim Time (35) Reclaim Time (35)
3PF TComp 1562 Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29) Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (29)
AR Initiation (11)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
Any Trip 522 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB Control (43)
CB2 Control (44)
AR CB1 No C/S 308 CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
AR CB1 Unhealthy 307 CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Leader Follower Logic (7)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 277
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
AR CB2 No C/S 330 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
AR CB2 Unhealthy 329 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Enable 1384 AR Enable (5)
AR Enable (5)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
AR Enable CB1 1609
AR Modes Enable (9)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Enable (5)
AR OK (8)
AR Enable CB2 1605
AR Modes Enable (9)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Force CB1 3P 858 Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB Trip Conversion (63)
AR Force CB2 3P 1485 Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB Trip Conversion (63)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
AR Modes Enable (9)
AR In Service 1385 AR Enable (5)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Mode 1P 1497 AR Modes Enable (9)
AR Mode 3P 1498 AR Modes Enable (9)
AR OFF Pulse 1383 AR Enable (5)
AR On Pulse 1382 AR Enable (5)
Fault Memory (15)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Sequence Counter (18)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
AR Start 1541 CB1 AR In Progress (16)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
AR Reset Successful (37)
CB2 AR Reset Successful (38)
AR Trip Test 3ph 576 Trip Test (12)
AR Trip Test A 577 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
AR Trip Test B 578 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
AR Trip Test C 579 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19),
1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
Sequence Counter (18)
ARIP 1542 CB1 AR In Progress (16) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Reclaim Time (35)
Auto Close CB1 854 CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB Control (43)

278 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
Reclaim Time (35)
Auto Close CB2 1448 CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 Control (44)
Block CB1 AR 448 Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Block CB2 AR 1421 CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB1 3P Dtime 1560 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 AR 1p InProg 845 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19),
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 AR 3p InProg 844 3-phase AR Cycle Selection (21)
Sequence Counter (18)
CB1 AR Init 1543 CB1 AR In Progress (16) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB In Service (4)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR Lockout 306 Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
AR Shot Counters (41)
Reset CB Lockout (57)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB In Service (4)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 ARIP 1544 CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Reclaim Time (35)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB Control (43)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB1Aux 3ph(52-A) 420 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux 3ph(52-B) 424 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux A(52-A) 421 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux A(52-B) 425 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux B(52-A) 422 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux B(52-B) 426 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux C(52-A) 423 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux C(52-B) 427 CB1 State Monitor (1)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Close Fail 303 CB Control (43) Leader Follower Logic (7)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Close inProg 842 CB Control (43)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 279
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB In Service (4)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Closed 3 ph 907 CB State Monitor (1)
Reclaim Time (35)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Control (43)
CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB1 Closed A ph 908 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Closed B ph 909 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Closed C ph 910 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Control 1566 CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 Enabled 881 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 FL>FB 1590 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 CS1 OK 883 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 CS1 SlipF< 1579 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 SlipF> 1578 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 VL<VB 1588 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 VL>VB 1586 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 Enabled 882 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 FL<FB 1494 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 FL>FB 1493 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 CS2 OK 884 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 CS2 SlipF< 1465 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 SlipF> 1464 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 VL<VB 1589 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 VL>VB 1587 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 Ext CS OK 900
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip A 535 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip B 536 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)

280 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip C 537 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 534 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575 CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB1 Failed AR 1550 Evolving Fault (20)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader (45)
CB1 Fast SCOK 1572 Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
3 Phase AR System Check Follower (47)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 Healthy 436 CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Control (43)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 In Service 1526 CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 LO Alarm 860
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 Man SCOK 1574 Manual Close System Check (51) CB Control (43)
Leader Follower Logic (8) CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 NoAR 1528
Leader Follower Logic (7) Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB Open (3)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
CB1 Open 3 ph 903 CB State Monitor (1)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB Control (43)
CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open A ph 904 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open B ph 905 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open C ph 906 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 Status Alarm 301 CB State Monitor (1) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Succ 1P AR 1571 Successful AR Signals (36) AR Shot Counters (41)
CB1 Succ 3P AR 852 Successful AR Signals (36) AR Shot Counters (41)
CB1 Trip 3ph 526 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB1 Trip AR MemA 1535 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip AR MemB 1536 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip AR MemC 1537 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip Fail 302 CB Control (43)
CB1 Trip IP 3Ph 529 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB1 Trip Output A 523 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 281
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB1 Trip Output B 524 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB1 Trip Output C 525 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1F SCOK 1491 3 Phase AR System Check (45) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1L SCOK 1573 3 Phase AR System Check (45) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB2 3P Dtime 1444 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB2 AR 1p InProg 855 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 AR 3p InProg 1411 3-phase AR Cycle Selection (21)
Sequence Counter (18)
CB2 AR Init 1434 CB2 AR In Progress (17) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB In Service (4)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 AR Lockout 328 CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Reset CB2 Lockout (58)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB In Service (4)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 ARIP 1435 CB2 AR In Progress (17) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Reclaim Time (35)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Control (44)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Aux3ph(52-A) 428 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux3ph(52-B) 432 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux A(52-A) 429 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux A(52-B) 433 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux B(52-A) 430 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux B(52-B) 434 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux C(52-A) 431 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux C(52-B) 435 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Close Fail 325 CB Control (44) Leader Follower Logic (7
Follower CB AR Enable (27))
CB2 Close inProg 1453 CB Control (44)

282 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB2 Closed 3 ph 915 CB2 State Monitor (1)
Reclaim Time (35)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB2 Closed A ph 916 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Closed B ph 917 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Closed C ph 918 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Control 1450 CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Enabled 1426 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Fl<FB 1476 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Fl>FB 1474 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 CS1 OK 1577 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61) 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 CS1 SlipF< 1467 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 SlipF> 1466 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 VL<VB 1472 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 VL>VB 1470 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 Enabled 1427 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 FL<FB 1476 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 FL>FB 1475 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 CS2 OK 1463 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61) 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 CS2 SlipF< 1469 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 SlipF> 1468 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 VL<VB 1473 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 VL>VB 1471 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 Ext CS OK 901 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip A 539
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 283
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip B 540
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip C 541
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 538
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459 CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Failed AR 1441 Evolving Fault (20)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46) CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 Fast SCOK 1454
3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48) CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Autoclose (32)
CB2 Healthy 437 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Control (44)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 In Service 1428 CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Lead 1408 Leader/Follower CB Selection (6)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB2 LO Alarm 1599
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 Man SCOK 1458 CB2 Manual Close System Check (52) CB Control (44)
Leader Follower Logic (8) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB2 NoAR 1429
Leader Follower Logic (7) Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB Open (3)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
CB2 Open 3 ph 911 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open A ph 912 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open B ph 913 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open C ph 914 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 Status Alm 323 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Succ 1P AR 1451 Successful AR Signals (36) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Succ 3P AR 1452 Successful AR Signals (36) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Trip 3ph 1600 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB2 Trip AR MemA 1499 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)

284 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB2 Trip AR MemB 1500 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB2 Trip AR MemC 1501 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB2 Trip Fail 324 CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip IP 3Ph 1608 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB2 Trip Output A 1601 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Trip Output B 1602 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Trip Output C 1603 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2F SCOK 1456 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2L SCOK 1455 3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
Control CloseCB1 839 CB Control (43) Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Control CloseCB2 841 CB Control (44) Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Control TripCB1 838 CB Control (43) CB Control (43)
Control TripCB2 840 CB Control (44) CB2 Control (44)
CS VBus1> 1583 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VBus1< 1582 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VBus2< 1585 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CS VBus2> 1584 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CS VLine< 1580 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VLine> 1581 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
Dead Bus 1 887 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Dead Bus 2 1462 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Dead Line 889 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check (47)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK All 1551 Dead Time Start Enable (22)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
DTOK CB1L 1P 1552 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK CB1L 3P 1553 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
DTOK CB2L 1P 1442 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK CB2L 3P 1443 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
En CB1 Follower 1488 Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
En CB2 Follower 1455 Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
Evolve 3Ph 1547 Evolving Fault (20) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 285
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
Ext Fault Aph 1508 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Fault BPh 1509 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Fault CPh 1510 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Rst CB1 AROK 1517 AR Reset Successful (37)
Ext Rst CB1Shots 1518 AR Shot Counters (41)
Ext Rst CB2 AROK 1417 AR Reset Successful (37)
Ext Rst CB2Shots 1418 CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Check Sync Signals (60)
F out of Range 319
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
Foll AR Mode 1P 1409 AR Modes Enable (9)
Foll AR Mode 3P 1410 AR Modes Enable (9)
Follower CB1 1432 Leader Follower Logic (7) CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Follower CB2 1433 Leader Follower Logic (7) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Force 3PTrip CB1 533 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604 CB Trip Conversion (63)
IA< Start 864 AR Initiation (11)
IB< Start 865 AR Initiation (11)
IC< Start 866 AR Initiation (11)
Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB1 AR In Progress (16), CB2
Inhibit AR 1420
AR In Progress (17)
Inhibit DB1 1525 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit DB2 1425 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit DL 1523 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LB1 1524 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LB2 1424 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LL 1522 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Init 3P AR Test 1507 Trip Test (12)
Init APh AR Test 1504 Trip Test (12)
Init BPh AR Test 1505 Trip Test (12)
Init Close CB1 440 CB Control (43)
Init Close CB2 442 CB2 Control (44)
Init CPh AR Test 1506 Trip Test (12)
Init Trip CB1 439 CB Control (43)
Init Trip CB2 441 Init Trip CB2
Invalid AR Mode 331 AR Modes Enable (9)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Leader CB1 1530 Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Leader CB2 1431 Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
Live Bus 1 886 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check (47)
CB1 Manual Close System Check (51)

286 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Live Bus 2 1461 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check (46)
3 Phase AR System Check (47)
Live Line 888 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
3 Phase AR System Check (48)
CB1 Manual Close System Check (51)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
ManCB1 Unhealthy 304 CB Control (43)
ManCB2 Unhealthy 326 CB Control (44)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS 438 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS CB1 CS 1521
Check Sync Signals (60)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS CB2 CS 1423
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
NoCS CB1ManClose 305 CB Control (43)
NoCS CB2ManClose 327 CB Control (44)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
OK Time 3P 1555 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB1 Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
Pole Dead A 892 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Dead B 893 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Dead C 894 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Disc. CB1 Ext 451 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Disc. CB2 Ext 1606 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Discrep. CB1 699 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Discrep. CB2 1607 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Rst CB1 CloseDly 443 CB Control (43)
Rst CB2 CloseDly 1419 CB2 Control (44)
Rst CB1 Lockout 446 Reset CB Lockout (57)
Rst CB2 Lockout 1420 Reset CB2 Lockout (58)
SChksInactiveCB1 880 Check Sync Signals (60)
SChksInactiveCB2 1484 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
Seq Counter = 0 846 Sequence Counter (18) AR Modes Enable (9)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 287
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Sequence Counter (18)
Evolving Fault (20)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 1 847 Sequence Counter (18) Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
3 Phase AR System Check (47)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 2 848 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 3 849 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 4 850 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Seq Counter > 4 851 Sequence Counter (18)
Autoreclose Lockout (55
Seq Counter>Set 1546 Sequence Counter (18)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56))
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
Set CB1 Close 1565 CB1 Autoclose (32) AR Shot Counters (41)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
Set CB2 Close 1449 CB2 Autoclose (33) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs A 530
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs B 531
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs C 532
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Check Sync Signals (60)
VTS Fast Block 832
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)

288 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5 LOGIC MODULES
This section contains a complete set of logic diagrams, which will help to explain the Autoreclose function. Most of
the logic diagrams shown are logic modules that comprise the overall Autoreclose system. Some of the diagrams
shown are not directly related to Autoreclose functionality, however, they may use some inputs are produce
outputs that are used by the Autoreclose system. These diagrams are shown in this section for the sake of
completeness.

5.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER STATUS MONITOR


The Circuit Breaker State Monitor logic is part of the Monitoring and Control functionality and is fully described in
that chapter. The logic diagram is repeated in this section because some of the outputs of this logic module are
used as inputs to some of the Autoreclose logic modules.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 289
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.1.1 CB STATE MONITOR


420
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-A)
&

424
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-B)
& 1 907
1 CB1 Closed 3 ph
XOR

&

CB1 Status Input


&
52A 3 pole
52B 3 pole
52A & 52B 3 pole & 1 903
1 CB1 Open 3 ph

&

&

421
CB1 Aux A(52-A)
&

425 908
CB1 Aux A(52-B) 1 CB1 Closed A ph
& 1
XOR
&
&

CB1 Status Input


&
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
904
1 CB1 Open A ph
52A & 52B 1 pole & 1

&
&

&

422 909
CB1 Aux B(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed B ph

CB1 Aux B(52-B) 426

905
Phase B 1 CB1 Open B ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole

423 910
CB1 Aux C(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed C ph

CB1 Aux C(52-B) 427

906
Phase C 1 CB1 Open C ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole 301
1 CB1 Status Alm
52A & 52B 1 pole

V01265 CB1 Status Time

Figure 149: CB State logic diagram (Module 1)

5.2 CIRCUIT BREAKER OPEN LOGIC


The Circuit Breaker Open logic module produces internal signals indicating the open status of one or more phases.
These signals are used by some of the Autoreclose logic modules.

290 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.2.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER OPEN LOGIC DIAGRAM


904
CB1 Open A ph

905
CB1 Open B ph 1 CB1Op1P

906
CB1 Open C ph

1 CB1OpAny
903
CB1 Open 3 ph

1 CB1 Op2/3P
³2
912
CB2 Open A ph

913
CB2 Open B ph 1 CB2Op1P

914
CB2 Open C ph

1 CB2OpAny
911
CB2 Open 3 ph

1 CB2 Op2/3P
³2
V03390

Figure 150: Circuit Breaker Open logic diagram (Module 3)

5.3 CIRCUIT BREAKER IN SERVICE LOGIC


For Autoreclose to proceed, a circuit breaker has to be in service when the Autoreclose is initiated. A circuit breaker
is considered to be in service if it has been closed for more than the CB IS Time setting.
For applications with fast-acting circuit breaker auxiliary switches, a time delay setting CB IS Memory Time is
provided. This is used to ensure correct operation if a delay between the circuit breaker tripping and recognition by
the protection, is expected.
When an Autoreclose cycle starts, the “in service” signal for a circuit breaker stays set until the Autoreclose cycle
finishes.
The circuit breaker “in service” signal resets if the circuit breaker opens, or if the corresponding Autoreclose in
progress (ARIP) signal resets.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 291
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.3.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER IN SERVICE LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1 AR Lockout CBIST


& CB1CRLO
0
Num CBs
CB1 Only
1 CBIST
Both CB 1&CB2 &
CBISMT & S
Q CB1 In Service
CB1 Closed 3 ph R
Logic 1 1
CB1 ARIP

CB2 AR Lockout CBIST


& CB2CRLO
0
Num CBs
CB2 Only
1 CBIST
Both CB 1&CB2 &
CBISMT & S
Q CB2 In Service
CB2 Closed 3 ph R
Logic 1 1
CB2 ARIP

V03303

Figure 151: CB In Service logic diagram (Module 4)

5.4 AUTORECLOSE ENABLE LOGIC


The Autoreclose function must be enabled in the CONFIGURATION column before it can be brought into service. It
can be brought into service by:
● using an opto-input mapped to the AR Enable DDB signal
● pulsing the DDB signal AR On Pulse (use AR Off Pulse to bring it out of service)
● programming a function key on the HMI.
● if applicable, using IEC 60870-5-103 communications
Further validation signals are also required to switch on Autoreclose. These are the DDB signals AR Enable CB1
and AR Enable CB2. Once Autoreclose is in service, the AR In Service DDB signal is asserted and the AR Status cell
in the CB CONTROL column is set accordingly.

5.4.1 AUTORECLOSE ENABLE LOGIC DIAGRAM

Auto-Reclose
Enable
& AR DISABLED
HMI Comand

IEC 60870 Comand 1385 AR In Service


Autoreclose
Status
1382 Default = ON 1
AR On Pulse

1383
AR OFF Pulse

1384
AR Enable

1609
AR Enable CB1 *
1
1605
AR Enable CB2 *
*Defaults to High if not mapped in PSL
V03301

Figure 152: Autoreclose Enable logic diagram (Module 5)

5.5 AUTORECLOSE LEADER/FOLLOWER


You can select either CB1 or CB2 to be the leader, with CB2 or CB1 as the follower respectively.

292 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.5.1 LEADER/FOLLOWER CB SELECTION LOGIC DIAGRAM

Leader Select By
Menu
&
Select Leader
1 Pref LCB1
CB1
CB2
&

Leader Select By
Opto
&
1408 1 Pref LCB2
CB2 Lead

&

Leader Select By
Control
&
CB2 Lead
Set

Num CBs &


Both CB 1&CB2
CB1 Only
CB2 Only

V03306

Figure 153: Leader/Follower CB Selection Logic Diagram (Module 6)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 293
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.5.2 LEADER FOLLOWER LOGIC DIAGRAM


1530
Leader CB1
&
CB1 Close Fail
303 1 CB1 LFRC
307 1 &
AR CB1 Unhealthy
1542
ARIP
Leader CB2 1431
&
CB2 Close Fail 325 1 CB2 LFRC
329 1 &
AR CB2 Unhealthy
ARIP 1542

Reset L -F 1 & S
0.1s Q
R 1 SET LCB1
Pref LCB1
&
1429
CB2 NoAR
0.1 &
1544
CB1 ARIP
0 1
&

& S
Pref LCB2 Q
R 1 SET LCB2

&
CB1 NoAR 1528
0.1 &
1435
CB2 ARIP
0 1
&
1385
AR in Service
AR Enable CB 1 1609
1526 1528
CB1 in Service & CB1 NoAR
CB1 AR Lockout 306

BAR CB1
ARIP 1542 &
1 S 1530
& Q Leader CB1
Set LCB1 R
&
Reset L -F
0 .1s

Foll SPAROK &


1 1
Foll 3 PAROK
1431 &
Leader CB2
1 & 1432 Follower CB1
CB2 LFRC
1385
AR in Service
AR Enable CB 2 1605
1428 1429
CB2 in Service & CB2 NoAR
328
CB2 AR Lockout
BAR CB2
ARIP 1542 &
1 S
1431
& R
Q Leader CB2
Set LCB2
&
Reset L -F
0. 1s
&
1
Foll SPAROK
1
Foll 3 PAROK &
1530 1433
Leader CB1 & Follower CB2
1
CB1 LFRC V03307

Figure 154: Leader/Follower logic diagram (Module 7 & 8)

294 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.6 AUTORECLOSE MODES


The device can provide Single-phase and/or Three-phase Autoreclose. The Autoreclose mode is configured by the
AR Mode setting in the AUTORECLOSE column. You can choose from:
● Single-phase (AR 1P)
● Three-phase (AR 3P)
● Single-phase and Three-phase (AR 1/3P)
● Controlled by commands from DDB signals that must be mapped to opto-isolated inputs in the PSL (AR
Opto).
Single-phase Autoreclosing is permitted only for the first shot of an Autoreclose cycle. In a multi-shot Autoreclose
cycle the second and subsequent trips will always be three-phase.
For multi-phase faults, you can use the Multi Phase AR setting in the AUTORECLOSE column to configure the
following options:
● Allow Autoreclose for all fault types (Allow Autoclose)
● Block Autoreclose for 2-phase and 3-phase faults (BAR 2 and 3 ph)
● Block Autoreclose for 3-phase faults (BAR 3 Phase)

5.6.1 SINGLE-PHASE AND THREE-PHASE AUTORECLOSE


This section applies to dual-CB devices. Where there are signals and settings for each of the two circuit breakers,
only the first CB (CB1) is shown, to improve clarity and save repetition. Where settings and signals include "CB1",
there is a "CB2" equivalent.

Single-phase Autoreclose Only


If single-phase Autoreclose is enabled, the logic allows only a single shot Autoreclose. For a single-phase fault, the
single phase dead timer SP AR Dead Time starts, and the DDB signal CB1 AR 1p Inprog is asserted, which indicates
that single-phase Autoreclose is in progress. In this case, for a multi-phase fault the logic triggers a three-phase
trip and goes to lockout.

Three-phase Autoreclose Only


During three-phase Autoreclose, for any fault, the three-phase dead timers: 3P AR DT Shot 1, 3P AR DT Shot 2, 3P
AR DT Shot 3 and 3P AR DT Shot 4 are started and the DDB signal is CB1 AR 3p InProg is asserted, which indicates
that three-phase Autoreclose is in progress.
If three-phase only Autoreclose is enabled, the logic forces a three-phase trip by setting the DDB signal AR Force
CB1 3P for any single-phase fault.

Single-phase and Three-phase Autoreclose


With single-phase and three-phase Autoreclose enabled then, if the first fault is a single-phase fault the single-
phase dead time SP AR Dead Time is started and the single-phase Autoreclose in progress signal is asserted. If the
first fault is a multi-phase fault the three phase dead timer 3P AR DT Shot 1 is started and the three-phase
Autoreclose in progress signal is asserted. If set to allow more than one reclose (AR Shots > 1) then any subsequent
faults are converted to three-phase trips by setting the force three-pole tripping signal. The three-phase dead
times 3P AR DT Shot 2, 3P AR DT Shot 3 and 3P AR DT Shot 4 (Dead Times 2, 3, 4) are started for the 2nd, 3rd and
4th trips (shots) respectively. The DDB signal CB1 AR 3p InProg is asserted. If a single-phase fault evolves to a
multi-phase fault during the single-phase dead time (SP AR Dead Time), single-phase Autoreclose is stopped. The
single-phase Autoreclose in progress signal is reset, the three-phase Autoreclose in progress signal is set, and the
three-phase dead timer 3P AR DT Shot 1 is started.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 295
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.6.2 AUTORECLOSE MODES ENABLE LOGIC DIAGRAM


1385
AR in Service
& * If not mapped in PSL, AR Enable
Num CBs & CB1 and AR Enable CB 2 default to
CB1 only high
&
CB2 only & When Leader/Follower AR mode is
Both CB 1&CB2
& set via opto -inputs, there are 7
1609
AR Enable CB1 invalid combinations. This logic
1 &
AR Enable CB2 1605 detects these combinations and on
a trip forces both CB 1 and CB2 to
AR Mode lockout.
1 &
AR 1 P
AR 1/ 3P 1P 3P 1P 3P
AR 3 P 1 0 0 0 1
AR Opto 0 0 1 0
&
1497
0 0 1 1
AR Mode 1P
0 1 1 0
1498 & 0 1 1 1
AR Mode 3P
1 0 1 1
&
Lead /Foll ARMode 1 1 1 1 0
L 1P, F 1 P
L 1P, F 3 P
&
L 3P, F 3 P 1
L 1/3P, F 1 /3P
L 1/3P , F 3P
& Foll SPAROK
AR Opto 1

& Foll3 PAROK


1

1497
&
AR Mode 1P Invalid AR Mode

1498 & 5s
AR Mode 3P 331
See Note Invalid AR Mode
1409 & 0
Foll AR Mode 1P

1410
&
Foll AR Mode 3P

Seq Counter = 0 846


847 1
Seq Counter = 1 & CB1LSPAROK
1530
Leader CB 1 1
1609
&
AR Enable CB1
& CB2LSPAROK
1
&
Leader CB 2 1431

1 CB1L3PAROK
1605 &
AR Enable CB2
& 1 CB2L3PAROK
846
Seq Counter = 0
847 1
Seq Counter = 1

AR Enable CB1 1609


& CB1 FSPAROK
&
Foll CB1

CB2L SPAROK
& CB1F3PAROK
Fol SPAROK
1605
AR Enable CB2 & CB2 FSPAROK
&
Foll CB2
CB1L SPAROK
& CB2F3PAROK
Foll 3 PAROK
V03310

Figure 155: Autoreclose Modes Enable logic diagram (Module 9)

296 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.7 AR FORCE THREE-PHASE TRIP LOGIC


Following single-phase tripping, while the Autoreclose cycle is in progress, and upon resetting of the protection
elements, tripping switches to three-phase.
Any protection operations that occur for subsequent faults while the Autoreclose cycle remains in progress will be
tripped three-phase.

5.7.1 FORCE THREE-PHASE TRIP LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1 L SPAROK
1
CB1 F SPAROK
1554
CB1 ARIP
&
TARANY

847 &
Seq Counter = 1
1
Seq Counter = 2 848 &
1 858
849
& AR Force CB1 3P
Seq Counter = 3

Seq Counter = 4 850

306
CB1 AR Lockout
307
AR CB1 Unhealthy
1420
Inhibit AR

CB2Tripping Mode
3 Pole
&
1 and 3 pole
1431
Leader CB2

CB21 L SPAROK
1
CB2 F SPAROK
1435
CB2 ARIP
&
TARANY

847 &
Seq Counter = 1
1
Seq Counter = 2 848 &
1 1485
849 & AR Force CB2 3P
Seq Counter = 3
850
Seq Counter = 4

CB2 AR Lockout 328

329
AR CB2 Unhealthy
1420
Inhibit AR

CB1Tripping Mode
3 Pole
&
1 and 3 pole
1530
Leader CB1

1585
AR In Service

NUM CBs
1
CB1 Only
Both CB1&CB2
1
CB2 Only

V03314

Figure 156: Force three-phase trip logic diagram (Module 10)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 297
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.8 AUTORECLOSE INITIATION LOGIC


Autoreclose initiation starts Autoreclose for a circuit breaker only if Autoreclose is enabled for the circuit breaker,
and the circuit breaker is in service. When an Autoreclose cycle is started, Autoreclose in progress (ARIP) is
indicated. The indication remains until the end of the cycle. The end of the cycle is signified by successful
Autoreclose, or by lockout.
Autoreclose cycles can be initiated by:
● Protection functions internal to the product
● A Trip Test feature
● External protection equipment

● Evolving fault combinations

Internal Protection Functions


Many of the protection functions in the product can be programmed to initiate or block Autoreclose. The
associated settings are found in the Autoreclose column and the available options are No Action, Initiate
AR, or Block AR. If set to Block AR operation of the protection function blocks the Autoreclose function and
forces a lockout.

Trip Test Feature


The Test Autoreclose command cell in the COMMISSION TESTS column can be used to initiate an Autoreclose
cycle. Each option provides a 100 ms pulse output. There is also a ‘No Operation’ option to exit the command field
without initiating a test.

External Protection Equipment


Protection operation from a different device can be used to initiate Autoreclose via PSL. By default these external
trip input signals are mapped to initiate Autoreclose. These inputs are not mapped to the trip outputs. With
appropriate mapping in the PSL, however, the external device can use this product to trip connected circuit
breakers.

Evolving Fault Combinations


The Autoreclose function would normally be initiated by a single condition (such as a single-phase fault). If,
however, the system conditions evolve such that other conditions that could initiate Autoreclose, then the
dynamics of the Autoreclose logic need to adapt. For example, if a single-phase fault evolves into a multi-phase
fault, then the operation of the Autorecloser must consequently adapt. To achieve this signals are generated to
indicate conditions such as evolving faults, re-operation of protection, combinations of initiation by internal
protection, external protection, or test features, which control the Autoreclose sequencing.
Records of initiating conditions are stored and used to control the sequencing. Initiation can be from a protection
function integrated in the product, from external protection and internal sources such as the Autoreclose test
function. Initiation can be further qualified by the phases causing the initiation. These conditions are stored in
signals that generally feature “MEM”- memory, or “AR” – Autoreclose, in the signal name.

298 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.8.1 AUTORECLOSE INITIATION LOGIC DIAGRAM

Protection function 1 Trip

Block AR
Initiate AR 1 Prot AR Block

Protection function n Trip

Block AR 1 S
Q
Initiate AR R 1 INIT AR

864
IA< Start &
1
865
IB< Start

866
IC< Start

577
AR Trip Test A
1
578 &
AR Trip Test B

579
AR Trip Test C

522
Any Trip

V03315

Figure 157: Autoreclose Initiation logic diagram (Module 11)

5.8.2 AUTORECLOSE TRIP TEST LOGIC DIAGRAM


1504
Init APh AR Test
1 577
1 AR Trip Test A

1505
Init BPh AR Test
1 578
1 AR Trip Test B

1506
Init CPh AR Test
1 579
1 AR Trip Test C

1507
Init 3P AR Test 576
1 AR Trip Test 3Ph

Test Autoreclose
No Operation
Trip Pole A
Trip Pole B
Trip Pole C
Trip 3 Pole

V03304

Figure 158: Autoreclose Trip Test logic diagram (Module 12)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 299
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.8.3 EXTERNAL TRIP LOGIC DIAGRAM FOR CB1

CB2 TARA

CB2 TARB 1
CB2 TARC

Num CBs
CB1 only ≥
TAR2/ 3PH
CB2 only 1 2
Both CB1&CB2
1 TARANY
Init AR
523
&
CB1 Trip OutputA 1 TARA
535 S
CB1 Ext Trip A 1535
Q CB1 Trip AR MemA
Init AR R
524
&
CB1 Trip OutputB 1 TARB

CB1 Ext Trip B 536 S 1536


Q CB1 Trip AR MemB
Init AR R
525
&
CB1 Trip OutputC 1 TARC
537
CB1 Ext Trip C S 1537
Q CB1 Trip AR MemC
CB1 Ext Trip3 ph 534 R

1542 0.01
ARIP
0.1
&
1 RESPRMEM

1 0.2
AR Disabled & S
0 Q
R

1
TARANY

1499
CB2 Trip AR MemA
1500
CB2 Trip AR MemB 1
1 TMEMANY
1501
CB2 Trip AR MemC

CB1 Trip AR MemA 1535

1536
CB1 Trip AR MemB 1
1537
CB1 Trip AR MemC

=
TMEM1Ph
1

TMEM2 /3Ph
2

& TMEM3Ph
V03318

Figure 159: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB1 (Module 13)

Note:
For single-phase Autoreclose, these signals must be mapped as shown in the default PSL scheme.

300 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.8.4 EXTERNAL TRIP LOGIC DIAGRAM FOR CB2

Num CBs
CB1 only ≥
CB2 TAR2/3PH
CB2 only 1 2
Both CB1&CB2

Init AR
&
CB2 Trip OutputA 1 CB2 TARA

CB2 Ext Trip A S


Q CB2 Trip AR MemA
R
Init AR
&
CB2 Trip OutputB 1 CB2 TARB

CB2 Ext Trip B S


Q CB2 Trip AR MemB
R
Init AR
&
CB2 Trip OutputC 1 CB2 TARC

CB2 Ext Trip C S


Q CB2 Trip AR MemC
R
CB2 Ext Trip3 ph

RESPRMEM

CB2 Trip AR MemA


=
CB2 Trip AR MemB CB2 TMEM1Ph
1
CB2 Trip AR MemC


CB2 TMEM2/3 Ph
2

& CB2 TMEM3Ph


V03325

Figure 160: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB2 (Module 14)

Note:
For single-phase Autoreclose, these signals must be mapped as shown in the default PSL scheme.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 301
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.8.5 PROTECTION REOPERATION AND EVOLVING FAULT LOGIC DIAGRAM

TMEMANY 0
&
0.02 &
1 Prot ReOp

TARANY
&

& RESETL-F

Discrim Time
t
1554 &
1P DTime 0
Prot ReOp & Evolve Lock

847
Seq Counter = 1
576
& Evolve 3Ph

0
LastShot & S
0.02 Q 1550
306
R & CB1 Failed AR
CB1 AR Lockout
328 1
CB2 AR Lockout

Set CB1 CL
907 0 1
CB1 Closed 3 ph &
0.02
1544
CB1 ARIP

Set CB2 CL & 1441


CB2 Failed AR
915 0 1
CB2 Closed 3 ph &
0.02
1544
CB2 ARIP

V03332

Figure 161: Protection Reoperation and Evolving Fault logic diagram (Module 20)

5.8.6 FAULT MEMORY LOGIC DIAGRAM

Trip Inputs A
1
Ext Fault APh & S
Q =
R FLTMEM 2P
Trip Inputs B 2
1
Ext Fault BPh & S
Q
R & FLTMEM 3P
Trip Inputs C
1
Ext Fault CPh & S
Q
R
AR Start

RESPRMEM

V03320

Figure 162: Fault Memory logic diagram (Module 15)

5.9 AUTORECLOSE IN PROGRESS


The AR In Progress module produces various signals to indicate to other modules and functions that an
Autoreclose operation is currently in progress.

302 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.9.1 AUTORECLOSE IN PROGRESS LOGIC DIAGRAM FOR CB1

CB2 Ext Trip A

CB2 Ext Trip B 1 AR Start

CB2 Ext Trip C

CB2 Ext Trip3 ph

Init AR

CB1 Ext Trip A 1


CB1 Ext Trip B

CB1 Ext Trip C

CB1 Ext Trip3 ph

TMEM2/3Ph
1
TMEM1Ph &
& & CB1 AR Init
CB1 Op2/3P
S
CB1L3 PAROK Q CB1 ARIP
1 R
CB1F3 PAROK
1 ARIP
Inhibit AR 1
CB1 LO Alarm

CB1 NoAR

CB1 ARSUCC

CBARCancel
0.02
CB1 OpAny
0 &
CB1 ARIP 1

AR Start &
Set CB1 Close
&
CB1 Closed 3 ph

CB2 ARIP
& CB1 LARIP
Leader CB1

1
& CB1 FARIP
Follower CB1

V03322

Figure 163: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB1 (Module 16)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 303
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.9.2 AUTORECLOSE IN PROGRESS LOGIC DIAGRAM FOR CB2

Init AR

CB2 Ext Trip A 1


CB2 Ext Trip B

CB2 Ext Trip C

CB2 Ext Trip 3ph

CB2 TMEM2/3 Ph
1
CB2 TMEM1Ph &
& & CB2 AR Init
CB2 Op2/3P
S
CB2L3 PAROK Q CB2 ARIP
1 R
CB2 F3 PAROK

Inhibit AR 1
CB2 LO Alarm

CB2 NoAR

CB2 ARSUCC

CBARCancel
0.02
CB2 OpAny
0 &
CB2 ARIP 1

AR Start &
Set CB2 Close
&
CB2 Closed 3 ph

& CB2 LARIP


Leader CB2

1
& CB2 FARIP
Follower CB2

V03324

Figure 164: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB2 (Module 17)

5.10 SEQUENCE COUNTER


The Autoreclose logic includes a counter for counting the number of Autoreclose shots. This is referred to as the
sequence counter. The sequence counter has a value of zero if Autoreclose is not in progress. Following a trip, and
subsequent Autoreclose initiation, the sequence counter is incremented. The counter provides output signals
indicating how many initiation events have occurred in any Autoreclose cycle. These signals are available as user
indications and are used in the logic to select the appropriate dead times or, for a persistent fault, force a lockout.
It is possible to skip the first Autoreclose attempt by enabling the AR Skip Shot 1 setting. If this is set, the sequence
counter will skip the first Autoreclose attempt (Shot 1) and move to the second (Shot 2) immediately upon
Autoreclose initiation. Each time the protection trips the sequence counter is incremented by 1. The Autoreclose
logic compares the sequence counter value to the number of Autoreclose shots setting AR Shots. If the counter
value exceeds this setting then the Autoreclose is locked out. If Autoreclose is successful, the sequence counter
resets to zero.

304 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.10.1 AUTORECLOSE SEQUENCE COUNTER LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1 AR Init
1
CB2 AR Init &
1
ARIP &

AR Start
&

1P Dtime
&
Seq Counter = 1

Seq Counter = 0

Increment on rising edge Seq Counter = 1

Reset on falling edge Seq Counter = 2

Single Pole Shot Seq Counter = 3


Sequence Counter
Three Pole Shot Seq Counter = 4

Seq Counter > 4

Seq Counter >Set

& S
Prot Re-op Q LastShot
R

V03327

Figure 165: Autoreclose Sequence Counter logic diagram (Module 18)

5.11 AUTORECLOSE CYCLE SELECTION


The Autoreclose cycle selection logic is responsible for determining whether the Autoreclose will start as single-
phase or three-phase.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 305
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.11.1 SINGLE PHASE AUTORECLOSE CYCLE SELECTION LOGIC DIAGRAM

ARIP S
Q LeaderSPAR
1 R
CB1 L 3 PAR

CB2 L 3 PAR

RESETL-F 1

CB1 L ARIP
& S
CB1 L SPAROK Q CB1 L SPAR
R
TMEM1PH
1
CB1 L 3 PAR

CB2 L ARIP
& S
CB2 L SPAROK Q CB2 L SPAR
R
CB2 TMEM1 PH
1
CB2 L 3 PAR 1 CB1 AR 1p InProg

CB1F ARIP
& S
CB2L SPAR Q CB1F SPAR
R
CB1F SPAROK

TMEM1PH

CB1F 3PAR
1 1 CB2 AR 1p InProg
CB2L 3PAR

CB2F ARIP
& S
CB1L SPAR Q CB2F SPAR
R
CB2F SPAROK

CB2 TMEM1 PH

CB2F 3PAR
1
CB1L 3PAR

V03330

Figure 166: Single-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 19)

306 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.11.2 3-PHASE AUTORECLOSE CYCLE SELECTION

CB1L ARIP
& S
CB1 L3 PAROK Q CB1L3PAR
R

Evolve 3Ph

TMEM3P 1
CB1 OP2 /3P

TMEM ANY
&
CB1 L SPAROK 1 CB1 AR 3p InProg

CB2L ARIP
& S
CB2L 3PAROK Q CB2L3PAR
R
CB2 TMEM 3 P
1
CB2 OP 2 /3P
1 CB2 AR 3p InProg
&
CB2L SPAROK

CB1F ARIP
& S
Q CB1F3PAR
CB1 F 3 PAROK R

1
CB1 OP 2 /3P

&
CB1F SPAROK

CB2F ARIP
& S
Q CB2F 3PAR
CB2F 3 PAROK R

1
CB2 OP 2 /3P

&
CB2F SPAROK

V03335

Figure 167: Three-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 21)

5.12 DEAD TIME CONTROL


Once an Autoreclose cycle has started, the conditions to enable the dead time to run are determined by the menu
settings, the circuit breaker status, the protection status, the nature of the AR cycle (single-phase or three-phase),
and the opto-isolated inputs from external sources.
Three settings are involved in controlling the dead time start:
● DT Start by Prot
● 3PDTStart WhenLD
● DTStart by CB Op

The DT Start by Prot determines how the protection action will initiate a dead time. The setting is always visible
and has three options Protection Reset, Protection Op (protection operation), and Disable which
should be selected if you don’t want protection action to start the dead time. These options set the basic
conditions for starting the dead time.
Selecting protection operation to start the dead time can, optionally, be qualified by a check that the line is dead.
Selecting protection reset to start the dead time can, optionally, be qualified by a check, that the circuit breaker is
open (DTStart by CB Op) before starting the dead time. For three-phase tripping applications, there is a further
option to check that the line is dead (3PDTStart WhenLD) before starting the dead time.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 307
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

If DT Start by Prot is disabled, the circuit breaker must be open for the dead time to start. For three-phase tripping
applications, there is an option to check that the line is dead (3PDTStart WhenLD) before starting the dead time. To
check that the line is dead, set 3PDTStart WhenLD to enabled. To check that the circuit breaker is open, set
DTStart by CB Op to Enabled.

5.12.1 DEAD TIME START ENABLE LOGIC DIAGRAM

DT Start by Prot
Disable
1
Protection Reset & DTOK All
&
Protection Op

AR Start
Dead Line Time
OKTimeSP &
S
Q
OK Time 3P 1 R
& S t
Q DeadLineLockout
ARIP R 0
CB1 AR Init 0 1
1
CB2 AR Init 0.02
Dead Line
1
3 PDTStart WhenLD
&
Enabled
Disabled

DT Start by Prot
Protection Reset
1
Disable &
CB1 AR 1p InProg

CB2 AR 1 p InProg &

&
DTStart by CB Op
Disabled
1
Enabled

1 DTOK CB1L 1P
CB1OP1 P &
CB2OPAny
1
1 DTOK CB1L 3P
CB1 Open 3 ph &
CB2 Open 3 ph
1
1 DTOK CB2L 1P
CB2OP1P &
CB1OPAny
1
1 DTOK CB2L 3P
CB2 Open 3 ph &
CB1 Open 3 ph
1
Num CBs
CB1 Only
CB2 Only

V03338

Figure 168: Dead time Start Enable logic diagram (Module 22)

308 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.12.2 SINGLE-PHASE LEADER DEAD TIME LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1LSPAR
&
DTOK CB1L 1P 1
& S
CB2LSPAR Q
& R & OKTimeSP
DTOK CB2L 1P

Seq Counter = 1

DTOK All

AR Start
1
DT Start by Prot
&
Protection Reset

CB1LSPAR
1
CB2LSPAR

CB1OP2/ 3P
&
CB2OP2/ 3P

Logic 1
&
CB1LSPAR 1
Logic 1
&
CB2LSPAR

t
0
1 Pole Dead Time

CB1LSPAR &
1 1P DTime

& CB1SPDTCOMP

CB2LSPAR &

& CB2SPDTCOMP

V03343

Figure 169: Single-phase Leader Dead Time logic diagram (Module 24)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 309
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.12.3 3-PHASE LEADER DEAD TIME LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1L 3PAR
&
DTOK CB1L 3P
1
CB2L3PAR
&
DTOK CB2L 3P
& S
DTOK All Q
R & OK Time 3P
3PDTCOMP

DT Start by Prot &


Protection Reset 1

AR Start

CB1L3PAR
1
CB2L3PAR Logic 1
&
1

Logic 1
&

3P AR DT Shot 1

t 1 3PDTCOMP
&
Seq Counter = 1 0
& 3P DTime1

3P AR DT Shot 2

t
&
Seq Counter = 2 0
& 3P DTime2

3P AR DT Shot 3

t
&
Seq Counter = 3 0
& 3P DTime3

3P AR DT Shot 4

t
&
Seq Counter = 4 0
& 3P DTime4

1 3P Dead Time IP

3PDTCOMP

CB1L 3PAR & CB1 3 P DTime

& CB13 PDTCOMP

CB2L3PAR & CB2 3 P DTime

& CB23 PDTCOMP


V03341

Figure 170: Three-phase Leader CB Dead Time logic diagram (Module 25)

310 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.12.4 FOLLOWER ENABLE LOGIC DIAGRAM

Control CloseCB1
& S
CB2 F SPAR Q
1 RD & En CB 2 Follower
CB2F 3PAR

CB2 Closed 3 ph 1
CB2 Close Fail

AR Start

BF if LFail Cls
Disabled
&
1
CB1 AR Lockout

CB1 Closed 3 ph
Logic 1
&
CB2 F SPAR 1
Logic 1
&
CB2F 3PAR

Control CloseCB2
& S
CB2 F SPAR Q
1 RD & En CB1 Follower
CB2F 3PAR

CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
CB1 Close Fail

AR Start

BF if LFail Cls
Disabled
&
1
CB2 AR Lockout

CB2 Closed 3 ph
Logic 1
&
CB1 F SPAR 1

Logic 1
&
CB1F 3PAR

V03346

Figure 171: Follower Enable logic diagram (Module 27)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 311
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.12.5 SINGLE-PHASE FOLLOWER TIMING LOGIC DIAGRAM

Dynamic F/L
Enabled
&
CB1 LFRC
1
CB2 LFRC

CB1OP1P

CB1FSPAR &
1
En CB 1 Follower
&
1PF TComp 1 1PF TComp

CB2OP1P & S
Q
R
CB2FSPAR

En CB 2 Follower

Seq Counter = 1
1 t
AR Start
0
CB1FSPAR
1
CB2FSPAR

CB1OP2/ 3P
&
CB2OP2/ 3P

Follower Time

CB1FSPAR &
1 1 P Follower Time

& CB1SPFTCOMP

CB2FSPAR &

& CB2SPFTCOMP

V03347

Figure 172: Single-phase Follower CB timing logic diagram (Module 28)

312 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.12.6 THREE-PHASE FOLLOWER TIMING LOGIC DIAGRAM

Dynamic F/L
Enabled
&
CB1 LFRC
1
CB2 LFRC

CB1 open 3 ph

CB1F3PAR &
1
En CB 1 Follower
&
3PF TComp 1 3PF TComp

CB2 open 3 ph & S


Q
R
CB2F3PAR

En CB 2 Follower

1 t
AR Start
0
CB1FSPAR
1
CB2FSPAR

Follower Time

CB1F3PAR &
1 3 P Follower Time

& CB13 PFTCOMP

CB2F3PAR &

& CB23 PFTCOMP

V03348

Figure 173: Three-phase Follower CB timing logic diagram (Module 29)

5.13 CIRCUIT BREAKER AUTOCLOSE


Autoclose logic takes effect when dead times have expired.
The Autoclose logic checks that all necessary conditions are satisfied before issuing an Autoclose command to the
circuit breaker control scheme.
Before a circuit breaker can be closed, it must be healthy (sufficient energy to close, and if necessary re-trip) and it
must not be in a lockout condition.
For three-phase Autoreclose, the circuit breaker must be open on all three phases and the appropriate system
check conditions must be met. For single-phase Autoreclose, the circuit breaker must be open on that phase.
The Autoclose command is a pulse lasting 100 milliseconds. Another command (Set CB Close) to set the circuit
breaker to close is asserted as well as the Autoclose command. This signal will remain set either until the end of
the Autoreclose cycle, or until the next protection operation. These commands are used to initiate the Reclaim
Time logic and the Autoreclose Shot Counter logic.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 313
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.13.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER AUTOCLOSE LOGIC DIAGRAM


522
Any Trip
306
CB1 AR Lockout &
&
CB1 Healthy 436 If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
High.
CB1SPDTComp
CB1OP1P &
CB1L3PAR
903
CB1 Open 3 ph

CB13PDTComp
1573 &
CB1 L SCOK 1
CB1 Fast SCOK 1572

1555
&
OK Time 3P

CB1FSPAR &
CB1SPFTComp
CB1F3PAR 1
&
CB13PFTComp
1491
CB1F SCOK
1562
Set CB1 Close
306 & S
CB1 AR Lockout Logic 1 Q 854
Auto Close CB1
R
ProtRe_Op
0.1s
1542
1
ARIP
1544
CB1 ARIP
1566
907 & CB1 Control
CB1 Closed 3 ph

522
Any Trip
328
CB2 AR Lockout &
&
CB2 Healthy 437

CB2SPDTComp If the DDB signal CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
High.
CB2OP1P &
CB2L3PAR
911
CB2 Open 3 ph

CB23PDTComp
1455 &
CB2 L SCOK 1
1454
CB2 Fast SCOK
1555 &
OK Time 3P

CB2FSPAR &
CB2SPFTComp
CB2F3PAR 1
&
CB23PFTComp
1456
CB2F SCOK
1449
Set CB2 Close
328 & S
CB2 AR Lockout Logic 1 Q
1448
Auto Close CB2
R
ProtRe_Op
0.1s
1542 1
ARIP
1435
CB2 ARIP
1450
915
& CB2 Control
CB2 Closed 3 ph
V03350

Figure 174: Circuit Breaker Autoclose Logic Diagram (Modules 32 & 33)

5.14 RECLAIM TIME


If the protection operates again before the reclaim time has expired, the corresponding sequence counter is
incremented. At the same time, any “dead time complete” (….DTCOMP) signals are reset and the logic is prepared

314 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

for the next dead time to start when conditions are suitable. The operation also resets the signal that would set the
circuit breaker to close, and stops and resets the reclaim timer. The reclaim time starts again if the signal to set a
circuit breaker to close goes high following completion of a dead time in a subsequent Autoreclose cycle.
If the circuit breaker is closed and has not tripped again when the reclaim time expires, signals are generated to
indicate successful Autoreclose. These signals increment the relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot
counters and reset the relevant Autoreclose in progress signal.
The “successful Autoreclose” signals generated from the logic can be reset by various commands and settings
options available under CB CONTROL menu settings as follows:
If Res AROK by UI is set to Enabled, all the signals can be reset by user interface command Reset AROK Ind from
the CB CONTROL menu.
If Res AROK by NoAR is set to Enabled, the signals for each circuit breaker can be reset by temporarily
generating an Autoreclose disabled signal according to the logic shown.
If Res AROK by Ext is set to Enabled, the signals can be reset by activation of an external input signal
appropriately mapped in the PSL.
If Res AROK by TDly is set to Enabled, the signals are automatically reset after a time delay set in AROK Reset
Time.

5.14.1 PREPARE RECLAIM INITIATION LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1SPDTComp
1
CB1 SPFTComp & S
1565
Q SETCB1SPCl
Set CB1 Close R

CB13 PDTComp
1573
&
CB1 L SCOK

1572
CB1 Fast SCOK &
1555 & 1 S
OK Time 3P Q SETCB13 PCl
R
CB13PFTComp
1491 &
CB1F SCOK

CB2SPDTComp
1
CB2 SPFTComp & S
1449
Q SETCB2SPCl
Set CB2 Close R

CB23 PDTComp
1455
&
CB2 L SCOK

1454
CB2 Fast SCOK & S
1555 & 1
OK Time 3P Q SETCB23 PCl
R
CB23PFTComp
1456 &
CB2F SCOK

V03353

Figure 175: Prepare Reclaim Initiation logic diagram (Module 34)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 315
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.14.2 RECLAIM TIME LOGIC DIAGRAM

SETCB1SPCL

CB2FARIP
SETCB2SPCL 1
TpsRécup RéencSP
SETCB23 PCL
Logique 1
CB1 LARIP
854
Réenc. DJ1 & t 1568
& T récup 1P term
Réenc. DJ2 1448 1 0

CB1FARIP
SETCB1SPCL 1
1567
SETCB13PCL & Tempo récup . 1P

SETCB2SPCL &
CB2LARIP

CB2 LFRC
&
SETCB1SPCL 1
&
CB1 LFRC
&
SETCB2SPCL 1
&
CB2 LFRC &
&
SETCB13 PCL
&
CB1 LFRC 1
&
SETCB23PCL

S/M dynamique
En Service
&
LeaderSPAR

SETCB13PCL

CB2FARIP T.récup réenc .3P


1
SETCB23 PCL Logique 1

CB1LARIP t 1570
854 & T récup 3P term
Réenc. DJ1 & 1 0
1448
Réenc. DJ2

CB1FARIP 1569
1 & Tempo récup . 3P
SETCB13 PCL

SETCB2SPCL &
CB2 LARIP

Durée ordre enc .

1567
Tempo récup . 1P t
1569 1
Tempo récup. 3P 0
&
Prot Re-op & CBARCancel
907
DJ1 fermé 3 ph
1544
&
RÉENC EN CRS DJ1
915
DJ fermé 3 ph 1
1435
&
RÉENC EN CRS DJ2

V03356

Figure 176: Reclaim Time logic diagram (Module 35)

316 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.14.3 SUCCESFUL AUTORECLOSE SIGNALS LOGIC DIAGRAM


1570
3P Reclaim TComp
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 1571
Q CB1 Succ 1P AR
RD
SetCB1SPCl 0
&
CB1OP1P 0.02S
907 & S
CB1 Closed 3 ph Q
R

ResCB1ARSucc 1 CB1ARSucc

1570
3P Reclaim TComp
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 852
Q CB1 Succ 3P AR
RD
SetCB13PCl 0
&
CB1OP2/3P 0.02S
907 & S
CB1 Closed 3 ph Q
R

3P Reclaim TComp 1570

1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 1451
Q CB2 Succ 1P AR
RD
SetCB2SPCl 0
&
CB2OP1P 0.02S
915 & S
CB2 Closed 3 ph Q
R

ResCB2ARSucc 1 CB2ARSucc

1570
3P Reclaim TComp
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 1452
Q CB2 Succ 3P AR
RD
SetCB23PCl 0
&
CB2OP2/3P 0.02S
915 & S
CB2 Closed 3 ph Q
R

1
V03359

Figure 177: Successful Autoreclose Signals logic diagram (Module 36)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 317
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.14.4 AUTORECLOSE RESET SUCCESSFUL INDICATION LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1OPAny
1541 1
AR Start
1 ResCB1 ARSucc
Res AROK by UI
Enabled
&
Reset AROK Ind
Yes

Res AROK by NoAR


Enabled
&
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB1 Only
1517
Ext Rst CB1 AROK
&
Res AROK by Ext
Enabled

Res AROK by TDly


Enabled
&
AROK Reset Time
t
CB1 ARSucc
0

CB2OPAny
1541
1
AR Start
1 ResCB2 ARSucc
Res AROK by UI
Enabled
&
Reset AROK Ind
Yes

Res AROK by NoAR


Enabled
&
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB1 Only
1417
Ext Rst CB2 AROK
&
Res AROK by Ext
Enabled

Res AROK by TDly


Enabled
&
AROK Reset Time
t
CB2 ARSucc
0 V03362

Figure 178: Autoreclose Reset Successful Indication logic diagram (Modules 37 & 38)

5.15 CB HEALTHY AND SYSTEM CHECK TIMERS


This logic provides signals to cancel Autoreclose if the circuit breaker is not healthy (for example low gas pressure)
or system check conditions are not satisfied (for example required line & bus voltage conditions) when the scheme
is ready to close the circuit breaker.
At the completion of a dead time, the logic starts an Autoreclose healthy timer. If a circuit breaker healthy signal
becomes high before the Autoreclose healthy time is complete, the timer stops and, if all other relevant circuit
breaker closing conditions are satisfied, the scheme issues a circuit breaker Autoclose signal. If the circuit breaker
healthy signal stays low, then, at the end of the Autoreclose healthy time, a circuit breaker unhealthy alarm is
raised. This forces the Autoreclose sequence to be cancelled.
Additionally, at the completion of any three-phase dead time, the logic starts an Autoreclose check synchronism
timer. If the circuit breaker synchronism-check OK signal goes high before the time is complete, the timer stops
and, if all other relevant circuit breaker closing conditions are satisfied, the scheme issues a circuit breaker

318 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Autoclose signal. If the circuit breaker synchronism-check OK signal stays low, then when the Autoreclose check
synchronism timer expires, an alarm is set to inform that the check synchronism is not satisfied and cancels the
Autoreclose cycle.

5.15.1 CB HEALTHY AND SYSTEM CHECK TIMERS LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB Healthy Time

CB1L 3PAR
1555
OK Time 3P 1
1572
CB1 Fast SCOK

CB1SPDTComp
1
CB1 SPFTComp & S t 307
Q AR CB1 Unhealthy
RD 0
CB13 PDTComp

CB13PFTComp

CB1 Healthy 436

306
CB1 AR Lockout 1
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph

Check Sync Time

CB13 PDTComp
1573
1 S
CB1 L SCOK Q t 308
RD 1 AR CB1 No C/S
0
306
CB1 AR Lockout
907 1
CB1 Closed 3 Ph

CB13PFTComp
1491
1 S Note : If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
CB1F SCOK Q
RD
306
CB1 AR Lockout
907
1
CB1 Closed 3 Ph

CB Healthy Time

CB2L 3PAR
1555
OK Time 3P 1
1454
CB2 Fast SCOK

CB2SPDTComp
1
CB2 SPFTComp & S t 329
Q AR CB2 Unhealthy
RD 0
CB23 PDTComp

CB23PFTComp

437
CB2 Healthy
328
CB2 AR Lockout 1
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph

Check Sync Time

CB23 PDTComp
1455
1 S
CB2 L SCOK Q t 330
RD 1 AR CB2 No C/S
0
328
CB2 AR Lockout
915 1
CB2 Closed 3 Ph

CB23PFTComp
1456 1 S Note : If the DDB signal CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
CB2F SCOK Q
RD
328
CB2 AR Lockout
915
1
CB2 Closed 3 Ph V03364

Figure 179: Circuit Breaker Healthy and System Check Timers Healthy logic diagram (Module 39)

5.16 AUTORECLOSE SHOT COUNTERS


A number of counters are provided to enable analysis of circuit breaker Autoreclose history. The counters are
stored in non-volatile memory, so that the data is maintained even in the event of a failure of the auxiliary supply.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 319
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

The counter values are accessible through the CB CONTROL column. The counters can be reset manually, or by
activation of an input appropriately mapped in the PSL.
The logic provides the following summary information for each circuit breaker
● Overall total number of shots (Number of Autoreclose attempts)
● Number of successful 1st shot single-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 1st shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 2nd shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 3rd shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 4th shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of failed Autoreclose cycles which forced a circuit breaker to lockout

320 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.16.1 AUTORECLOSE SHOT COUNTERS LOGIC DIAGRAM

1565
Set CB1 Close Increment
CB1 Total Shots Counter
Reset
1571
CB1 Succ 1P AR Increment
CB1 Successful SPAR Shot 1 Counter
852 Reset
CB1 Succ 3P AR

847 & Increment


Seq Counter = 1 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 1 Counter
Reset

& Increment
848
Seq Counter = 2 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 2 Counter
Reset

849
& Increment
Seq Counter = 3 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 3 Counter
Reset

850
& Increment
Seq Counter = 4 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 1 Counter
Reset
1544
0
CB1 Arip
0.02 & Increment
CB1 Failed AR Counter
Reset
306
CB1 AR Lockout

1518
Ext Rst CB1Shots
1
Reset CB Shots
Yes

1449
Set CB2 Close Increment
CB2 Total Shots Counter
Reset
1451
CB2 Succ 1P AR Increment
CB2 Successful SPAR Shot 1 Counter
1452 Reset
CB2 Succ 3P AR

847 & Increment


Seq Counter = 1 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 1 Counter
Reset

& Increment
848
Seq Counter = 2 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 2 Counter
Reset

849
& Increment
Seq Counter = 3 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 3 Counter
Reset

850 & Increment


Seq Counter = 4 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 1 Counter
Reset
1435
0
CB2 Arip
0.02 & Increment
CB2 Failed AR Counter
Reset
328
CB2 AR Lockout

1418
Ext Rst CB2Shots
1
Reset CB Shots
Yes V03367

Figure 180: Autoreclose Shot Counters logic diagram (Modules 41 & 42)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 321
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.17 CIRCUIT BREAKER CONTROL

5.17.1 CB CONTROL LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB Control by
Opto
Note : If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy or CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it
Opto +Local defaults to High .
1
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
838
HMI Trip Control TripCB1
1
& S t
439
& Q 302
Init Trip CB1 RD 0 & CB1 Trip Fail

440 &
Init close CB1 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 842
CB1 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB1 ARIP 1544 Q 839
RD 0 & Control CloseCB1

854
1 S t
Auto Close CB1 Q
RD 0
443
Rst CB1 CloseDly
522 303
Any Trip & CB1 Close Fail
1
838
Control TripCB1

534
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
535
CB1 Ext Trip A

536
CB1 Ext Trip B

537
CB1 Ext Trip C
1 1
903
CB1 Open 3 ph

904
CB1 Open A ph
905
CB1 Open B ph &
906
CB1 Open C ph
907
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
908
CB1 Closed A ph

CB1 Closed B ph 909


1 CB Healthy Time

910
CB1 Closed C ph
t 304
436
& ManCB1 Unhealthy
CB1 Healthy 0

Check Sync Time

t 305
1574
& NoCS CB1ManClose
CB1 Man SCOK 0

V03370

Figure 181: CB1 Control Logic (Module 43)

322 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

CB Control by
Opto
Opto +Local Note: If the DDB signal CB 1 Healthy, or CB2 healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
1 High.
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
840
HMI Trip Control TripCB2
1
& S t
441
& Q 324
Init Trip CB2 RD 0 & CB2 Trip Fail

442 &
Init close CB2 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 1453
CB2 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB2 ARIP 1435 Q 841
RD 0 & Control CloseCB2

1448
1 S t
Auto Close CB2 Q
RD 0
1419
Rst CB2 CloseDly

522 325
Any Trip & CB2 Close Fail
1
840
Control TripCB2

538
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
539
CB2 Ext Trip A

540
CB2 Ext Trip B

541
CB2 Ext Trip C
1 1
911
CB2 Open 3 ph

912
CB2 Open A ph
913
CB2 Open B ph &
914
CB2 Open C ph

915
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
916
CB2 Closed A ph

CB2 Closed B ph 917


1 CB Healthy Time

918
CB2 Closed C ph
t 326
437
& ManCB2 Unhealthy
CB2 Healthy 0

Check Sync Time

t 327
1458
& NoCS CB2ManClose
CB2 Man SCOK 0

V03344

Figure 182: CB2 Control Logic (Module 44)

5.18 CIRCUIT BREAKER TRIP TIME MONITORING


The circuit breaker trip time monitoring logic checks for correct circuit breaker tripping following the issue of a
protection trip signal. When the protection trip signal is issued, a timer controlled by the Trip Pulse Time setting in
the CB CONTROL column is started.
If the circuit breaker trips correctly the timer resets. If Autoreclose is enabled and the timer resets, the cycle
continues. If the circuit breaker fails to trip correctly within the set time, the Autoreclose cycle is forced to lock out
and a signal is issued indicating that the circuit breaker failed to trip in response to the protection operation.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 323
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.18.1 CB TRIP TIME MONITORING LOGIC DIAGRAM

Trip Pulse Time

TAR2/3Ph S t
Q 1575
RD 0 1 CB1 Fail Pr Trip
903
& S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph

Trip Pulse Time

TARA
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q t
RD 1
0
903 & S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1

TARB
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD

903
& S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1

TARC
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
903 & S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1

Trip Pulse Time

TAR2/3Ph S t
Q 1459
RD 0 1 CB2 Fail Pr Trip
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph

Trip Pulse Time

TARA
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q t
RD 1
0
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1

TARB
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD

911
& S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1

TARC
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1
V03377

Figure 183: Circuit Breaker Trip Time Monitoring logic diagram (Modules 53 & 54)

324 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.19 AUTORECLOSE LOCKOUT


A number of events will cause Autoreclose lockout. If this happens an Autoreclose lockout alarm is raised. In this
condition, Autoreclose cannot be initiated until the corresponding lockout has been reset.
The following events force Autoreclose lockout:
● Protection operation during reclaim time. Following the final Autoreclose attempt, if the protection operates
during the reclaim time, the AR cycle goes to AR lockout and the Autoreclose function is disabled until the
AR lockout condition is reset.
● Persistent fault. A fault is considered persistent if the protection re-operates after the last permitted shot.
● Block Autoreclose. If the block Autoreclose DDB is asserted whilst Autoreclose is in progress, the cycle goes
to lockout.
● Protection function selection. Setting ‘Block AR’ against a particular protection function in the AUTORECLOSE
column means that operation of the protection will block Autoreclose and force lockout.
● Circuit breaker failure to close. If a circuit breaker fails to close Autoreclose is blocked and forced to lockout.
● Circuit breaker remains open at the end of the reclaim time. An Autoreclose lockout is forced if the circuit
breaker is open at the end of the reclaim time.
● Circuit breaker fails to close when the close command is issued.
● Circuit breaker fails to trip correctly.
● Three-phase dead time started by ‘line dead’ violation. If the line does not go dead within the Dead Line
Time setting, the logic forces the Autoreclose sequence to lockout. Determination of when to start the timer
is made in the 3PDTStart WhenLD setting.
● Block Follower if Leader fails to close is set. If the setting BF if Lfail Cls in the AUTORECLOSE column is set to
Enable, the active Follower circuit breaker will lockout if the Leader circuit breaker fails to reclose.
● Leader/Follower invalid selection using opto-isolated input. If the Leader/Follower Autoreclose mode in the
AUTORECLOSE settings is set to be selected using the opto-isolated inputs, then if the logic detects an invalid
Autoreclose mode combination, it forces both circuit breakers to lockout if a trip occurs.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 325
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.19.1 CB LOCKOUT LOGIC DIAGRAM

FLTMEM3P
&
Multi Phase AR
BAR 3 Phase
1
BAR 2 and 3 ph
&
FLTMEM2P
303
CB1 Close Fail

BF if LFail Cls
& 306
CB1 AR Lockout
Enabled

CB2 LFRC
& 1385
CB1 FARIP AR In Service
&
CB2 AR Lockout 328
Num CBs & S
Q
R
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575 Both CB 1&CB2
1
CB1 Only
CB1OpAny
1544
CB1 ARIP & RESCB1LO
Block CB1 AR 448 &
307
AR CB1 Unhealthy
308
AR CB1 No C/S
1547 S
Evolve 3Ph
Q
PROTRE-OP R

LastShot &
1544
CB1 ARIP

EVOLVELOCK & 1 BARCB1

ProtARBlock
1526
CB1 In Service
&
TMEM2/3Ph

CB1L3 PAROK 0
1
CB1F3 PAROK 0.02s
1526
CB1 In Service
&
TMEM1Ph

CB1 LSPAROK 0 Note: This diagram shows the logic for CB 1 only. The logic for CB2 follows the same
1 principles and is not repeated .
CB1 FSPAROK 0.02s
1546
Seq Counter >Set
301
CB1 Status Alm

CB1 LARIP Trip Pulse Time


1
CB1 FARIP

Set CB1 Close 1565 t


&
Set CB2 Close 1449 0

CB2OpAny
1428
&
CB2 In Service
1526
CB1 In Service
&
Num CBs
&
Both CB1&CB2
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459

InvalidAR Mode
&
1543
CB1 AR Init
1544 1
CB1 ARIP

DeadLineLockout V03380

Figure 184: CB1 Lockout Logic Diagram (Module 55)

326 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

FltMem3P
&
Multi Phase AR
BAR 3 Phase
1
BAR 2 and 3 ph
&
FltMem2P
325
CB2 Close Fail

BF if LFail Cls
& 328
CB2 AR Lockout
Enabled

CB1 LFRC
& 1385
CB2FARIP AR In Service
&
CB1 AR Lockout 306
Num CBs & S
Q
R
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459 Both CB 1&CB2
1
CB1 Only
CB2OpAny
1435
CB2 ARIP & ResCB2Lo
Block CB2 AR 1421 &
329
AR CB2 Unhealthy
330
AR CB2 No C/S
1547 S
Evolve 3Ph
Q
ProtRe_Op R

LastShot &
1435
CB2 ARIP

EvolveLock & 1 BARCB2

ProtARBlock
1428
CB2 In Service
&
TMEM2/3Ph

CB2L3PAROK 0
1
CB2 F3PAROK 0.02s
1428
CB2 In Service
&
TMEM1Ph

CB2LSPAROK 0
1
CB2FSPAROK 0.02s
1546
Seq Counter >Set
323
CB2 Status Alm

CB2LARIP Trip Pulse Time


1
CB2FARIP

Set CB2 Close 1449 t


&
Set CB1 Close 1565 0

CB1OpAny
1526
&
CB1 In Service
1428
CB2 In Service
&
Num CBs
&
Both CB1&CB2
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575

Invalid_AR_Mode
&
1434
CB2 AR Init
1435 1
CB2 ARIP

DeadLineLockout V03403

Figure 185: CB2 Lockout Logic Diagram (Module 56)

5.20 RESET CIRCUIT BREAKER LOCKOUT


Lockout conditions caused by the circuit breaker condition monitoring functions can be reset according to the
condition of the Rst CB mon LO by setting found in the CB CONTROL column. There are two options; CB Close
and User interface.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 327
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

If set to CB Close, a timer setting, CB mon LO RstDly, becomes visible. When the circuit breaker closes, the CB
mon LO RstDly time starts. The lockout is reset when the timer expires.
If set to User Interface then a command, CB mon LO reset, becomes visible. This command can be used to
reset the lockout from a user interface.
An Autoreclose lockout generates an Autoreclose lockout alarm. Autoreclose lockout conditions can be reset by
various commands and setting options found under the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by CB IS is set to Enabled, a lockout is reset if the circuit breaker is successfully closed manually. For
this, the circuit breaker must remain closed long enough so that it enters the “In Service” state.
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset from a user interface using the reset
circuit breaker lockout command in the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by NoAR is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by temporarily generating an AR
disabled signal.
If Res LO by TDelay is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout is automatically reset after a time delay set in
the LO Reset Time setting.
If Res LO by ExtDDB is Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by activation of an external input
mapped in the PSL to the relevant reset lockout DDB signal.

328 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.20.1 RESET CB LOCKOUT LOGIC DIAGRAM

Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB1CRLo

Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB1 LO
Yes

Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB1Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only

Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
446
Rst CB1 Lockout

Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time

306
t
CB1 AR Lockout
0
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB2CRLo

Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB2 LO
Yes

Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB2Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only

Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
1422
Rst CB2 Lockout

Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time

328
t
CB2 AR Lockout
0
V03383

Figure 186: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58)

5.21 POLE DISCREPANCY


In a three-pole CB, certain combinations of poles open and closed are indicative of a problem. The Pole
Discrepancy Logic combines an indication of a Pole Discrepancy condition from the CB Monitoring logic with
signals from the internal Autoreclose logic to produce a combined Pole Discrepancy indication for the CB.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 329
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.21.1 POLE DISCREPANCY LOGIC DIAGRAM


306
CB1 AR Lockout
1 0.04 699
CB1 LO Alarm 860 & Pole Discrep CB1
0
451
Pol Disc CB1 Ext
845 &
CB1 AR 1 p InProg

904
CB1 Open A ph
1
905
CB1 Open B ph
906
CB1 Open C ph
&

328
CB2 AR Lockout
1 0.04 1607
CB2 LO Alarm 1599 & Pole Discrep CB2
0
1606
Pol Disc CB2 Ext
855 &
CB2 AR 1p InProg

912
CB2 Open A ph
1
913
CB2 Open B ph
914
CB2 Open C ph
&
V03385

Figure 187: Pole Discrepancy Logic Diagram (Module 62)

5.22 CIRCUIT BREAKER TRIP CONVERSION


Circuit breakers should only trip single-pole or three-pole. The trip conversion logic ensures that the tripping is
either single-pole or three-pole. The trip conversion logic ensures that all conditions that should cause three-pole
tripping do so. Indication of the number of phases that caused tripping is provided.

330 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.22.1 CB TRIP CONVERSION LOGIC DIAGRAM


530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
523
Q CB1 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
524
Q CB1 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
525
Q CB1 Trip OutputC
R
CB1Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
526
Q CB1 Trip 3ph
858 R
AR Force CB1 3P 1
533
Force 3PTrip CB1
529
CB1 Trip I/P 3Ph

530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
1601
Q CB2 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
1602
Q CB2 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
1603
Q CB2 Trip OutputC
R
CB2Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
1600
Q CB2 Trip 3ph
1485 R
AR Force CB2 3P 1
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604

1608
CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph
Dwell
522
1 Any Trip
530 100 ms
Trip Inputs A
531
Trip Inputs B
≥ S
Trip Inputs C 532 2 Q 527
2/3 Ph Fault
R
892
Pole Dead A &
1 S
528
Q 3 Ph Fault
R

893
& 1
Pole Dead B 1

&
894 1
Pole Dead C
&
V03387

Figure 188: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63)

5.23 MONITOR CHECKS FOR CB CLOSURE


For single-phase Autoreclose neither voltage nor synchronisation checks are needed as synchronising power
should be flowing in the two healthy phases. For three-phase Autorelcose, for the first shot (and only the first shot),
you can choose to attempt reclosure without performing a synchronisation check. The setting to permit
Autoreclose without checking synchronising conditions is CB SC Shot 1.
Otherwise, synchronising checks on voltages, relative frequencies, and relative phase angles are needed to ensure
that sympathetic conditions exist before CB closure is attempted.
The following diagrams detail the Monitor Checks for CB closure.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 331
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.23.1 VOLTAGE MONITOR FOR CB CLOSURE

System Checks
Enabled

VAN 888
Live Line & Live Line
VBN

VCN 889
Select Dead Line & Dead line
VAB

VBC 886
Live Bus 1 & Live Bus 1
VCA

VBus1 Dead Bus 1 & 887


Dead Bus 1

VBus 2
1461
Live Bus 2 & Live Bus 2
MCB/VTS 438

1521 1462
MCB/VTS CB1 CS Dead Bus 2 & Dead Bus 2

1423
MCB/VTS CB2 CS
Voltage Monitors

1522 1
Inhibit LL

1523 1
Inhibit DL

1524 1
Inhibit LB 1

1525
1
Inhibit DB 1

1424 1
Inhibit LB 2

1425 1
Inhibit DB 2

V 01258

Figure 189: Voltage Monitor for CB Closure (Module 59)

332 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

5.23.2 CHECK SYNCHRONISATION MONITOR FOR CB CLOSURE

Sys checks CB 1
880
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 1
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &
VBN CS2 Criteria OK
&
VCN
Select CB1 CS1 SlipF> 1578
VAB & CB1 CS1 SlipF>

VBC CB1 CS1 SlipF< 1579


& CB1 CS1 SlipF<
VCA CB1 CS2 SlipF> 1464
& CB1 CS2 SlipF>
VBus1
CB1 CS2 SlipF< 1465
& CB1 CS2 SlipF<
CS Vline> 1581
& CS Vline>
CS Vbus1> 1583
& CS Vbus1>
CS Vline< 1580
& CS Vline<
Check Synchronisation Function

CS Vbus1< 1582
& CS Vbus<
CB1 CS1 Vl>Vb 1586
& CB1 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB1 CS1 Vl<Vb 1588
& CB1 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb 1590
& CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb 1591
& CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh+
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh-
CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb 1493
& CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb 1494
& CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh+
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh-
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594
& CB1 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595
438 & CB1 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB1 CS2 Vl>Vb 1587
VTS Fast Block & CB1 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB1 CS2 Vl<Vb 1589
& CB1 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Status
883
Enabled & CB1 CS1 OK
881
CB1 CS1 Enabled
CB1 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
882
CB1 CS2 Enabled V01260

Figure 190: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 333
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

Sys checks CB 2
1484
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 2
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &

VBN CS1 Criteria OK


&
VCN
Select CB2 CS1 SlipF> 1466
VAB & CB2 CS1 SlipF>

VBC CB2 CS1 SlipF< 1467


& CB2 CS1 SlipF<
VCA CB2 CS2 SlipF> 1468
& CB2 CS2 SlipF>
VBus2
CB2 CS2 SlipF< 1469
& CB2 CS2 SlipF<

&

CS Vbus2> 1585
& CS Vbus2>

&

CS Vbus2<
Check Synchronisation Function

1584
& CS Vbus2<
CB2 CS1 Vl>Vb 1470
& CB2 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB2 CS1 Vl<Vb 1472
& CB2 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb 1474
& CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb 1476
& CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh+
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh-
CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb 1475
& CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb 1477
& CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh-
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482
& CB2 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483
438 & CB2 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB2 CS2 Vl>Vb 1471
VTS Fast Block & CB2 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB2 CS2 Vl<Vb 1473
& CB2 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Status
1577
Enabled & CB2 CS1 OK
1426
CB2 CS1 Enabled
CB2 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
1427
CB2 CS2 Enabled V01268

Figure 191: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61)

5.24 SYNCHRONISATION CHECKS FOR CB CLOSURE


Logical checking of the outputs from the CB closure monitors is performed to generate signals to indicate that it is
OK to close circuit breakers.
Signals are provided to indicate that manual CB closure conditions are OK (CB Man SCOK), as are signals to
indicate that automatic CB closure conditions are OK (CB SCOK and CB Fast SCOK). The CB Fast SCOK signal
allows CB autoreclosure without waiting for the Dead Time to expire.

334 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

For single-phase Autoreclose no voltage or synchronism check is required as synchronising power is flowing in the
two healthy phases. Three-phase Autoreclose can be performed without checking that voltages are in
synchronism for the first shot (and only the first shot). The settings to permit Autoreclose without checking voltage
synchronism on the first shot are:
● CB1L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 1 as a leader,
● CB1F SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 1 as a follower,
● CB2L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 2 as a leader,
● CB2L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 2 as a follower.

When the circuit breaker has closed, the Autoreclose function asserts a DDB signal Set CB1 Close, which indicates
that an attempt has been made to close the circuit breaker. At this point, the Reclaim Time starts. If the circuit
breaker remains closed after the reclaim timer expires, the Autoreclose cycle is complete, and signals are
generated to indicate that Autoreclose was successful. These are:
● CB1 Succ 1P AR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB2 Succ 1P AR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB2)
● CB1 Succ 3P AR (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB2 Succ 3P AR (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2)

These signals increment the relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot counters, as well as resetting the
Autoreclose in progress signal.
The relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot counters are:
● CB1 SUCC SPAR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot1 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 1)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot2 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 2)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot3 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 3)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot4 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 4)
● CB2 SUCC SPAR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB2)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot1 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 1)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot2 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 2)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot3 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 3)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot4 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 4)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 335
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.24.1 THREE-PHASE AUTORECLOSE LEADER CHECK LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1L SC ClsNoDly
Enabled 1572
& CB1 Fast SCOK
CB1 L SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK

CB1 L SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK

CB1L SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1

CB1L SC LLDB
Enabled
1573
888 & 1 CB1 L SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1
CB1L SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
887 Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
Dead Bus 1

CB1L SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1

CB1L SC all
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK V03373

Figure 192: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB1 as leader (Module 45)

336 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

CB2L SC ClsNoDly
Enabled 1454
& CB2 Fast SCOK
CB2 L SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK

CB2 L SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK

CB2L SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2

CB2L SC LLDB
Enabled
1455
888 & 1 CB2 L SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1
CB2L SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
1462
Dead Bus 2

CB2L SC Shot 1 Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
High.
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1

CB2L SC all
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03345

Figure 193: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as leader (Module 46)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 337
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.24.2 THREE-PHASE AUTORECLOSE FOLLOWER CHECK LOGIC DIAGRAM

&
CB1F SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK

CB1F SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK

CB1F SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1

CB1F SC LLDB
Enabled
1491
888
& 1 CB1F SCOK
Live Line

Dead Bus 1 887

CB1 F SC DLDB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line

Dead Bus 1 887 Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
CB1 F SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1

CB1F SC all
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK V03401

Figure 194: Three-phase AR System Check logic d for CB1 as follower (Module 47)

338 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

&
CB2F SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK

CB2F SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK

CB2F SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2

CB2F SC LLDB
Enabled
1456
888
& 1 CB2F SCOK
Live Line

Dead Bus 1 887

CB2 F SC DLDB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line

Dead Bus 2 1462 Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
CB2 F SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1

CB2F SC all
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03402

Figure 195: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as follower (Module 48)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 339
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

5.24.3 CB MANUAL CLOSE SYSTEM CHECK LOGIC DIAGRAM

CB1 M SC CS1
Enabled
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK

CB1 M SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK

CB1M SC DLLB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1

CB1M SC LLDB
Enabled
1574
888 & 1 CB1 Man SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1

CB1M SC DLDB
Enabled Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
& defaults to High .
889
Dead Line

Dead Bus 1 887

CB1M SC required
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK

CB2M SC CS1
Enabled
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK

CB2 M SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK

CB2M SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2

CB2M SC LLDB
Enabled
1458
888 & 1 CB2 Man SCOK
Live Line
1462
Dead Bus 2

CB2 M SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
1462
Dead Bus 2

CB2M SC required
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03375

Figure 196: CB Manual Close System Check Logic Diagram (Modules 51 & 52)

340 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

6 SETTING GUIDELINES

6.1 DE-IONISING TIME GUIDANCE


The de-ionisation time of a fault arc depends on several factors such as circuit voltage, conductor spacing, fault
current and duration, atmospheric conditions, wind speed and capacitive coupling from adjacent conductors. For
this reason it is difficult to estimate the de-ionisation time. Circuit voltage is, generally the most significant factor
and experience tells us that typical minimum de-ionising times for a three-phase fault are as follows:
● 66 kV: 100 ms
● 110 kV: 150 ms
● 132 kV: 170 ms
● 220 kV: 280 ms
● 275 kV: 300 ms
● 400 kV: 500 ms
Where single-pole high speed Autoreclose is used, the capacitive current induced between the healthy phases and
the faulty phase tends to maintain the arc. This significantly increases the de-ionisation time and hence required
dead time.
Single-pole Autoreclose is generally only used at transmission voltages. A typical de-ionisation time at 220 kV may
be as high as 560 ms.

6.2 DEAD TIMER SETTING GUIDELINES


High speed Autoreclose may need to maintain stability on a network with two or more power sources. For high
speed Autoreclose the system disturbance time should be minimised by using fast protection (typically <30 ms)
and fast circuit breakers (typically <60 ms). For stability between two sources a system dead time of ≤300 ms may
typically be required.
The minimum system dead time (considering just the circuit breaker) is the trip mechanism reset time plus the
circuit breaker closing time.
The Autoreclose minimum dead time settings are governed primarily by two factors:
● Time taken for de-ionisation of the fault path
● Circuit breaker characteristics
It is essential that the protection fully resets during the dead time, so that correct time discrimination will be
maintained after Autoreclose onto a fault. For high speed Autoreclose instantaneous reset of protection is
required.
For highly interconnected systems synchronism is unlikely to be lost by the tripping out of a single line. Here the
best policy may be to adopt longer dead times, to allow time for power swings resulting from the fault to settle.

6.2.1 EXAMPLE DEAD TIME CALCULATION


The following circuit breaker and system characteristics can be used for the minimum dead time calculation:
● a) Circuit breaker Operating time (Trip coil energized to Arc interruption): 50 ms
● b) Circuit breaker Opening + Reset time (Trip coil energized to trip mechanism reset): 200 ms
● c) Protection reset time: < 80 ms
● d) Circuit breaker Closing time (Close command to Contacts make): 85 ms
● e) De-ionisation time (280 ms for 3-phase, or 560 ms for 1-phase)
Three-phase de-ionisation time for 220 kV line is typically 280 ms.
The minimum Autoreclose dead time setting is therefore the greater of:
(a) + (c) = 50 ms + 80 ms = 130 ms, to allow protection reset

P446SV-TM-EN-1 341
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

(a) + (e) - (d) = 50 ms + 280 ms - 85 ms = 245 ms, to allow de-ionising


In practice a few additional cycles would be added to allow for tolerances, so Dead Time 1 could be set to 300 ms
or greater. The overall system dead time is found by adding (d) to the chosen settings then subtracting (a). This
gives 335 ms.
A typical de-ionising time value for single-phase trip on a 220 kV line is 560 ms, so the 1 Pole Dead Time could be
chosen as 600 ms or greater. The overall system dead time is found by adding (d) to the chosen settings then
subtracting (a). This gives 635 ms.

6.3 RECLAIM TIME SETTING GUIDELINES


Several factors influence the choice of the reclaim timer, such as:
● Fault incidence/Past experience: Small reclaim times may be required where there is a high incidence of
recurrent lightning strikes to prevent unnecessary lockout for transient faults.
● Spring charging time: For high speed Autoreclose the reclaim time may be set longer than the spring
charging time. A minimum reclaim time of more than 5s may be needed to allow the circuit breaker time to
recover after a trip and close before it can perform another trip-close-trip cycle. This time will depend on the
duty (rating) of the circuit breaker. For delayed Autoreclose this may not be needed as the dead time can be
extended by an extra circuit breaker healthy check / Autoreclose Inhibit Time window time if there is
insufficient energy in the circuit breaker.
● Switchgear Maintenance: Excessive operation resulting from short reclaim times can mean shorter
maintenance intervals.
When used in conjunction with distance protection, the Reclaim Time setting is generally set greater than the zone
2 delay.

6.4 AUTORECLOSE SHOT COUNTERS


In dual circuit breaker applications, the two circuit breakers are normally arranged to reclose sequentially with one
designated the Leader circuit breaker reclosing after a set dead time. If the Leader circuit breaker remains closed
after the dead time, the second circuit breaker referred to as the Follower recloses after a further delay, the
Follower Time.
The Follower Time is provided to prevent un-necessary operation of the Follower circuit breaker. The Follower Time
should be set sufficiently long as to avoid an un-necessary closure of the Follower circuit breaker where conditions
are such that it would be required to trip again.
After expiry of the dead time, the Leader circuit breaker will attempt Autoreclose. The minimum value of the
Follower time should allow sufficient time for the Autoreclose of the Leader circuit breaker to be considered
successful.
An extreme case may be where instantaneous protection is only provided by distance elements and where
Autoreclose is onto a dead line with a persistent fault at the remote end of the line.
Local end protection (Time delayed Back up protection, like distance Z2 element) may detect this fault after a time
delay (typically > 200 ms). In addition to the delays associated with the back-up protection (typically >200 ms), time
must be allowed for the Leader circuit breaker to re-trip (50 - 100 ms), and a safety margin needs to be added so
that a minimum Follower time could be around 500 ms.
If the Autoreclose of the Leader circuit breaker is successful, the Follower circuit breaker can be allowed to
Autoreclose. Delaying the Autoreclose of the Follower circuit breaker will allow any transients to decay before the
switching. If the transient decay figure is known, it can be used to determine a minimum Follower Time value. The
larger of the two values can then be used as the minimum Follower Time.

342 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose

Note:
The Follower circuit breaker should only be reclosed if the system is healthy. In a dual circuit breaker scheme where the
system is healthy, the Follower circuit breaker acts more like a bus coupler. In this case there is no need for fast switching and
a time delay in excess of 1s is often appropriate. The default Follower time in this product is chosen as 5 s and this can
comfortably be applied to most applications.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 343
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV

344 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 12

CB FAIL PROTECTION
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

346 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a Circuit Breaker Fail Protection function. This chapter describes the operation of this function
including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 347
Circuit Breaker Fail Protection 348
Circuit Breaker Fail Implementation 349
Circuit Breaker Fail Logic 351
Application Notes 355

P446SV-TM-EN-1 347
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

2 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL PROTECTION


When a fault occurs, one or more protection devices will operate and issue a trip command to the relevant circuit
breakers. Operation of the circuit breaker is essential to isolate the fault and prevent, or at least limit, damage to
the power system. For transmission and sub-transmission systems, slow fault clearance can also threaten system
stability.
For these reasons, it is common practice to install Circuit Breaker Failure protection (CBF). CBF protection monitors
the circuit breaker and establishes whether it has opened within a reasonable time. If the fault current has not
been interrupted following a set time delay from circuit breaker trip initiation, the CBF protection will operate,
whereby the upstream circuit breakers are back-tripped to ensure that the fault is isolated.
CBF operation can also reset all start output contacts, ensuring that any blocks asserted on upstream protection
are removed.

348 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection

3 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL IMPLEMENTATION


Circuit Breaker Failure Protection is implemented in the CB FAIL & P.DEAD column of the relevant settings group.

3.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL TIMERS


The circuit breaker failure protection incorporates two timers, CB Fail 1 Timer and CB Fail 2 Timer, allowing
configuration for the following scenarios:
● Simple CBF, where only CB Fail 1 Timer is enabled. For any protection trip, the CB Fail 1 Timer is started, and
normally reset when the circuit breaker opens to isolate the fault. If breaker opening is not detected, the CB
Fail 1 Timer times out and closes an output contact assigned to breaker fail (using the programmable
scheme logic). This contact is used to back-trip upstream switchgear, generally tripping all infeeds
connected to the same busbar section.
● A retripping scheme, plus delayed back-tripping. Here, CB Fail 1 Timer is used to issue a trip command to a
second trip circuit of the same circuit breaker. This requires the circuit breaker to have duplicate circuit
breaker trip coils. This mechanism is known as retripping. If retripping fails to open the circuit breaker, a
back-trip may be issued following an additional time delay. The back-trip uses CB Fail 2 Timer, which was
also started at the instant of the initial protection element trip.

You can configure the CBF elements CB Fail 1 Timer and CBF Fail 2 Timer to operate for trips triggered by
protection elements within the device. Alternatively you can use an external protection trip by allocating one of the
opto-inputs to the External Trip DDB signal in the PSL.
You can reset the CBF from a breaker open indication (from the pole dead logic) or from a protection reset. In these
cases resetting is only allowed if the undercurrent elements have also been reset. The resetting mechanism is
determined by the settings Volt Prot Reset and Ext Prot Reset.
The resetting options are summarised in the following table:
Initiation (Menu Selectable) CB Fail Timer Reset Mechanism
The resetting mechanism is fixed (e.g. 50/51/46/21/87)
Current based protection
IA< operates AND IB< operates AND IC< operates AND IN< operates
The resetting mechanism is fixed.
Sensitive Earth Fault element
ISEF< Operates
Three options are available:
● All I< and IN< elements operate
Non-current based protection (e.g. 27/59/81/32L)
● Protection element reset AND all I< and IN< elements operate
● CB open (all 3 poles) AND all I< and IN< elements operate
Three options are available.
● All I< and IN< elements operate
External protection
● External trip reset AND all I< and IN< elements operate
● CB open (all 3 poles) AND all I< and IN< elements operate

3.2 ZERO CROSSING DETECTION


When there is a fault and the circuit breaker interrupts the CT primary current, the flux in the CT core decays to a
residual level. This decaying flux introduces a decaying DC current in the CT secondary circuit known as
subsidence current. The closer the CT is to its saturation point, the higher the subsidence current.
The time constant of this subsidence current depends on the CT secondary circuit time constant and it is generally
long. If the protection clears the fault, the CB Fail function should reset fast to avoid maloperation due to the
subsidence current. To compensate for this the device includes a zero-crossing detection algorithm, which ensures
that the CB Fail re-trip and back-trip signals are not asserted while subsidence current is flowing. If all the samples
within half a cycle are greater than or smaller than 0 A (10 mS for a 50 Hz system), then zero crossing detection is
asserted, thereby blocking the operation of the CB Fail function. The zero-crossing detection algorithm is used

P446SV-TM-EN-1 349
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

after the circuit breaker in the primary system has opened ensuring that the only current flowing in the AC
secondary circuit is the subsidence current.

350 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection

4 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL LOGIC

4.1 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL LOGIC - PART 1

WI Prot Reset
Enabled

ExtTrip Only Ini


Enabled
&
642
Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph &
1
652
Aid2 WI Trip 3Ph 1 WIINFEEDA
&
637
Aid 1 WI Trip A &
1
647
Aid 2 WI Trip A 1 WIINFEEDB
&
638
Aid 1 WI Trip B &
1
648
Aid 2 WI Trip B 1 WIINFEEDC
&
639
Aid 1 WI Trip C &
1
649
Aid 2 WI Trip C
Note: This part is not relevant for non -distance models

ExtTrip Only Ini


Enabled
& S
CurrentProtSEFTrip Q TripStateSEF
RD

ISEF<FastUndercurrent

ZCDStateA

ZCDStateB
ZCD function
ZCDStateC

ZCDStateSEF

V00729

Figure 197: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 351
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

4.2 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL LOGIC - PART 2

CB1 Ext Trip A 535


S
4 Q TripStateExtACB1
1 RD

3
1
CB1 Ext Prot Rst
2 I< Only
&
CB Open & I<
904
CB1 Open A ph 1 Prot Reset & I<
&
Prot Reset OR I<
0 Rst OR CBOp & I<
IA<FastUndercurrent

4
LatchATripResetIncompCB1

2
&

1
&

0
Logic 0

V00740

Figure 198: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 2

Note:
This diagram shows only phase-A for the first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for phases B and C and for the
second CB (CB2) follow the same principle and are not repeated here.

352 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection

4.3 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL LOGIC - PART 3

WIINFEEDA

TripStateExtA 1 TripStateACB1

ExtTrip Only Ini


Enabled

& S
AnyTripPhaseA Q
RD
IA<FastUndercurrent

CB1 Ext Trip 3ph 534


S
4 Q
1 1
RD
3
1
CB1 Ext Prot Rst
2 I< Only
&
534
CB Open & I<
CB1 Open 3 ph
1 1 Prot Reset& I<
904
&
CB1 Open A ph Prot Reset OR I<

905 0 Rst OR CBOp & I<


CB1 Open B ph &
CB1 Open C ph 906

4
Latch3PhTripResetIncompCB1
3

2
&
IA<FastUndercurrent

IB<FastUndercurrent & 1
&
IC<FastUndercurrent
0
ExtTrip Only Ini 0
Enabled

874 & S
CBF Non I Trip
2 Q
&
RD
890
All Poles Dead
1 1
892 &
Pole Dead A CB1 Ext Prot Rst

893
0 I< Only
Pole Dead B &
CB Open & I<
894
Pole Dead C Prot Reset& I<
Prot Reset OR I<
IA<FastUndercurrent Rst OR CBOp & I<

IB<FastUndercurrent &
2
&
IC<FastUndercurrent LatchNonITripResetIncompCB1

1
&

0
Logic 0

V00741

Figure 199: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 3

Note:
This diagram shows only first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for the second CB (CB2) follow the same principle
and are not repeated here..

P446SV-TM-EN-1 353
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

4.4 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL LOGIC - PART 4

From phase B equivalent


LatchATripResetIncomp
From phase C equivalent 1 834
CB1 Fail1 Trip
Latch3PhTripResetIncomp 1
298
1 CB1 Fail Alarm
LatchNonITripResetIncomp

835
1 CB1 Fail2 Trip
CB1 ZCD State A

WI INFEED A

1
TripStateA CB1
& & 1672
t 1 CB1 Fail1 Trip A
CB1 Fail1 Status
0
Enabled

CB1 Fail1 Timer

1
& 1675
TripStateA t 1 CB1 Fail2 Trip A
&
0
CB1 Fail2 Status
Enabled

CB1 Fail2 Timer

ZCD StateSEF

1
TripStateSEF
& &
t
CB1 Fail1 Status
0
Enabled

CB1 Fail1 Timer

1
&
TripStateSEF t
&
0
CB1 Fail2 Status
Enabled

CB1 Fail2 Timer

V00742

Figure 200: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 4

Note:
This diagram shows only phase-A for the first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for phases B and C and for the
second CB (CB2) follow the same principle and are not repeated here.

354 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection

5 APPLICATION NOTES

5.1 RESET MECHANISMS FOR CB FAIL TIMERS


It is common practise to use low set undercurrent elements to indicate that circuit breaker poles have interrupted
the fault or load current. This covers the following situations:
● Where circuit breaker auxiliary contacts are defective, or cannot be relied on to definitely indicate that the
breaker has tripped.
● Where a circuit breaker has started to open but has become jammed. This may result in continued arcing at
the primary contacts, with an additional arcing resistance in the fault current path. Should this resistance
severely limit fault current, the initiating protection element may reset. Therefore, reset of the element may
not give a reliable indication that the circuit breaker has opened fully.

For any protection function requiring current to operate, the device uses operation of undercurrent elements to
detect that the necessary circuit breaker poles have tripped and reset the CB fail timers. However, the
undercurrent elements may not be reliable methods of resetting CBF in all applications. For example:
● Where non-current operated protection, such as under/overvoltage or under/overfrequency, derives
measurements from a line connected voltage transformer. Here, I< only gives a reliable reset method if the
protected circuit would always have load current flowing. In this case, detecting drop-off of the initiating
protection element might be a more reliable method.
● Where non-current operated protection, such as under/overvoltage or under/overfrequency, derives
measurements from a busbar connected voltage transformer. Again using I< would rely on the feeder
normally being loaded. Also, tripping the circuit breaker may not remove the initiating condition from the
busbar, and so drop-off of the protection element may not occur. In such cases, the position of the circuit
breaker auxiliary contacts may give the best reset method.

5.2 SETTING GUIDELINES (CB FAIL TIMER)


The following timing chart shows the CB Fail timing during normal and CB Fail operation. The maximum clearing
time should be less than the critical clearing time which is determined by a stability study. The CB Fail back-up trip
time delay considers the maximum CB clearing time, the CB Fail reset time plus a safety margin. Typical CB
clearing times are 1.5 or 3 cycles. The CB Fail reset time should be short enough to avoid CB Fail back-trip during
normal operation. Phase and ground undercurrent elements must be asserted for the CB Fail to reset. The
assertion of the undercurrent elements might be delayed due to the subsidence current that might be flowing
through the secondary AC circuit.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 355
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV

CBF resets:
1. Undercurrent element asserts
2. Undercurrent element asserts and the
breaker status indicates an open position
3. Protection resets and the undercurrent
Fault occurs element asserts

CBF Safety
Protection Maximum breaker reset margin
Normal operating time clearing time time time
operation
t

Protection Local Bks clearing


Breaker failure operating time CBF back-up trip time delay time
operation

Local 86 Remote CB
operating clearing time
time

Maximum fault clearing time

V00693 Fault occurs

Figure 201: CB Fail timing

The following examples consider direct tripping of a 2-cycle circuit breaker. Typical timer settings to use are as
follows:
Typical Delay For 2 Cycle Circuit
CB Fail Reset Mechanism tBF Time Delay
Breaker
CB interrupting time + element reset time (max.) + error in tBF
Initiating element reset 50 + 50 + 10 + 50 = 160 ms
timer + safety margin
CB auxiliary contacts opening/ closing time (max.) + error in tBF
CB open 50 + 10 + 50 = 110 ms
timer + safety margin
CB interrupting time + undercurrent element (max.) + safety
Undercurrent elements 50 + 25 + 50 = 125 ms
margin operating time

Note:
All CB Fail resetting involves the operation of the undercurrent elements. Where element resetting or CB open resetting is
used, the undercurrent time setting should still be used if this proves to be the worst case.
Where auxiliary tripping relays are used, an additional 10-15 ms must be added to allow for trip relay operation.

5.3 SETTING GUIDELINES (UNDERCURRENT)


The phase undercurrent settings (I<) must be set less than load current to ensure that I< operation correctly
indicates that the circuit breaker pole is open. A typical setting for overhead line or cable circuits is 20%In. Settings
of 5% of In are common for generator CB Fail.
The earth fault undercurrent elements must be set less than the respective trip. For example:
IN< = (IN> trip)/2

356 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 13

CURRENT PROTECTION FUNCTIONS


Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

358 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The primary purpose of this product is not overcurrent protection. It does however provide a range of current
protection functions to be used as backup protection. This chapter assumes you are familiar with overcurrent
protection principles and does not provide detailed information here. If you require further information about
general overcurrent protection principles, please refer either to General Electric's NPAG publication, earlier
incarnations of this technical manual, or one of our technical manuals from our P40 Agile Modular distribution
range of products such as the P14x.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 359
Phase Fault Overcurrent Protection 360
Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection 363
Earth Fault Protection 366
Sensitive Earth Fault Protection 371
High Impedance REF 376
Thermal Overload Protection 378
Broken Conductor Protection 382

P446SV-TM-EN-1 359
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

2 PHASE FAULT OVERCURRENT PROTECTION


Phase fault overcurrent protection is provided as a form of back-up protection that could be:
● Permanently disabled
● Permanently enabled
● Enabled only in case of VT fuse/MCB failure
● Enabled only in case of protection communication channel failure
● Enabled if VT fuse/MCB or protection communication channel fail
● Enabled if VT fuse/MCB and protection communication channel fail

In addition, each stage may be disabled by a DDB signal.


It should be noted that phase overcurrent protection is phase segregated, but the operation of any phase is
mapped to 3 phase tripping in the default PSL.
The VTS element of the IED can be selected to either block the directional element or simply remove the directional
control.

2.1 POC IMPLEMENTATION


Phase Overcurrent Protection is configured in the OVERCURRENT column of the relevant settings group.
The product provides four stages of three-phase overcurrent protection, each with independent time delay
characteristics. The settings are independent for each stage, but for each stage, the settings apply to all phases.
Stages 1 and 2 provide a choice of operate and reset characteristics, where you can select between:
● A range of IDMT (Inverse Definite Minimum Time) curves based on IEC and IEEE standards
● A range of programmable user-defined curves
● DT (Definite Time) characteristic

This is achieved using the cells:


● I>(n) Function for the overcurrent operate characteristic
● I>(n) Reset Char for the overcurrent reset characteristic
● I>(n) Usr Rst Char for the reset characteristic for user-defined curves

where (n) is the number of the stage.


The IDMT-equipped stages, (1 and 2) also provide a Timer Hold facility. This is configured using the cells I>(n)
tReset, where (n) is the number of the stage. This does not apply to IEEE curves.
Stages 3 and 4 have definite time characteristics only.

2.2 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT


If fault current can flow in both directions through a protected location, you will need to use a directional
overcurrent element to determine the direction of the fault. Once the direction has been determined the device
can decide whether to allow tripping or to block tripping. To determine the direction of a phase overcurrent fault,
the device must compare the phase angle of the fault current with that of a known reference quantity. The phase
angle of this known reference quantity must be independent of the faulted phase. Typically this will be the line
voltage between the other two phases.
The phase fault elements of the IEDs are internally polarized by the quadrature phase-phase voltages, as shown in
the table below:
Phase of protection Operate current Polarizing voltage
A Phase IA VBC

360 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Phase of protection Operate current Polarizing voltage


B Phase IB VCA
C Phase IC VAB

Under system fault conditions, the fault current vector lags its nominal phase voltage by an angle depending on
the system X/R ratio. The IED must therefore operate with maximum sensitivity for currents lying in this region. This
is achieved by using the IED characteristic angle (RCA). This is the is the angle by which the current applied to the
IED must be displaced from the voltage applied to the IED to obtain maximum sensitivity.
The device provides a setting I> Char Angle, which is set globally for all overcurrent stages. It is possible to set
characteristic angles anywhere in the range –95° to +95°.
A directional check is performed based on the following criteria:

Directional forward
-90° < (angle(I) - angle(V) - RCA) < 90°

Directional reverse
-90° > (angle(I) - angle(V) - RCA) > 90°
For close up three-phase faults, all three voltages will collapse to zero and no healthy phase voltages will be
present. For this reason, the device includes a synchronous polarisation feature that stores the pre-fault voltage
information and continues to apply this to the directional overcurrent elements for a time period of a few seconds.
This ensures that either instantaneous or time-delayed directional overcurrent elements will be allowed to operate,
even with a three-phase voltage collapse.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 361
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

2.3 POC LOGIC


762
IA I>1 Start A

I>1 Current Set 656


& & I>1 Trip A

VBC
I>1 Direction
Directional
VTS Fast Block 832 check Timer Settings
I> Blocking &
VTS Blocks I>1
763
I>1 Start B
IB

I>1 Current Set 657


& & I>1 Trip B

VCA
I>1 Direction
Directional
VTS Fast Block 832 check Timer Settings
I> Blocking &
VTS Blocks I>1
764
I>1 Start C
IC

I>1 Current Set 658


& & I >1 Trip C

VAB 761
I>1 Direction
Directional 1 I>1 Start

VTS Fast Block 832 check Timer Settings


655
I> Blocking &
1 I>1 Trip
VTS Blocks I>1

401
I>1 Timer Block
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V00735

Figure 202: Phase Overcurrent Protection logic diagram

362 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

3 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OVERCURRENT PROTECTION


When applying standard phase overcurrent protection, the overcurrent elements must be set significantly higher
than the maximum load current. This limits the element’s sensitivity. Most protection schemes also use an earth
fault element operating from residual current, which improves sensitivity for earth faults. However, certain faults
may arise which can remain undetected by such schemes. Negative Phase Sequence Overcurrent elements can
help in such cases.
Any unbalanced fault condition will produce a negative sequence current component. Therefore, a negative phase
sequence overcurrent element can be used for both phase-to-phase and phase-to-earth faults. Negative Phase
Sequence Overcurrent protection offers the following advantages:
● Negative phase sequence overcurrent elements are more sensitive to resistive phase-to-phase faults,
where phase overcurrent elements may not operate.
● In certain applications, residual current may not be detected by an earth fault element due to the system
configuration. For example, an earth fault element applied on the delta side of a delta-star transformer is
unable to detect earth faults on the star side. However, negative sequence current will be present on both
sides of the transformer for any fault condition, irrespective of the transformer configuration. Therefore, a
negative phase sequence overcurrent element may be used to provide time-delayed back-up protection for
any uncleared asymmetrical faults downstream.

3.1 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OVERCURRENT PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection is implemented in the NEG SEQ O/C column of the relevant settings
group.
The product provides four stages of negative sequence overcurrent protection with independent time delay
characteristics.
Stages 1, 2 provide a choice of operate and reset characteristics, where you can select between:
● A range of standard IDMT (Inverse Definite Minimum Time) curves
● DT (Definite Time)

This is achieved using the cells


● I2>(n) Function for the overcurrent operate characteristic
● I2>(n) Reset Char for the overcurrent reset characteristic
where (n) is the number of the stage.
The IDMT-capable stages, (1 and 2) also provide a Timer Hold. This is configured using the cells I2>(n) tReset, where
(n) is the number of the stage. This is not applicable for curves based on the IEEE standard.
Stages 3 and 4 have definite time characteristics only.

3.2 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT


Where negative phase sequence current may flow in either direction, directional control should be used.
Directionality is achieved by comparing the angle between the negative phase sequence voltage and the negative
phase sequence current. A directional element is available for all of the negative sequence overcurrent stages.
This is found in the I2> Direction cell for the relevant stage. It can be set to non-directional, directional forward, or
directional reverse.
A suitable characteristic angle setting (I2> Char Angle) is chosen to provide optimum performance. This setting
should be set equal to the phase angle of the negative sequence current with respect to the inverted negative
sequence voltage (–V2), in order to be at the centre of the directional characteristic.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 363
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

3.3 NPSOC LOGIC

567 I2>1 Start


I2

IDMT/DT
I2>1 Current Set 571
& & & I2>1 trip
928
CTS Block

562
I2 > Inhibit

I2>1 Direction

V2

Directional
I2> V2pol Set
check

833
VTS Slow block
I 2> VTS Blocking &
VTS Blocks I2>1

563
I2>1 Tmr Blk
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V 00736

Figure 203: Negative Phase Sequence Overcurrent Protection logic diagram

3.4 APPLICATION NOTES

3.4.1 SETTING GUIDELINES (CURRENT THRESHOLD)


A negative phase sequence element can be connected in the primary supply to the transformer and set as
sensitively as required to protect for secondary phase-to-earth or phase-to-phase faults. This function will also
provide better protection than the phase overcurrent function for internal transformer faults. The NPS overcurrent
protection should be set to coordinate with the low-side phase and earth elements for phase-to-earth and phase-
to-phase faults.
The current pick-up threshold must be set higher than the negative phase sequence current due to the maximum
normal load imbalance. This can be set practically at the commissioning stage, making use of the measurement
function to display the standing negative phase sequence current. The setting should be at least 20% above this
figure.
Where the negative phase sequence element needs to operate for specific uncleared asymmetric faults, a precise
threshold setting would have to be based on an individual fault analysis for that particular system due to the
complexities involved. However, to ensure operation of the protection, the current pick-up setting must be set
approximately 20% below the lowest calculated negative phase sequence fault current contribution to a specific
remote fault condition.

3.4.2 SETTING GUIDELINES (TIME DELAY)


Correct setting of the time delay for this function is vital. You should also be very aware that this element is applied
primarily to provide back-up protection to other protection devices or to provide an alarm. It would therefore
normally have a long time delay.
The time delay set must be greater than the operating time of any other protection device (at minimum fault level)
that may respond to unbalanced faults such as phase overcurrent elements and earth fault elements.

3.4.3 SETTING GUIDELINES (DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT)


Where negative phase sequence current may flow in either direction through an IED location, such as parallel lines
or ring main systems, directional control of the element should be employed (VT models only).

364 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Directionality is achieved by comparing the angle between the negative phase sequence voltage and the negative
phase sequence current and the element may be selected to operate in either the forward or reverse direction. A
suitable relay characteristic angle setting (I2> Char Angle) is chosen to provide optimum performance. This setting
should be set equal to the phase angle of the negative sequence current with respect to the inverted negative
sequence voltage (–V2), in order to be at the centre of the directional characteristic.
The angle that occurs between V2 and I2 under fault conditions is directly dependent on the negative sequence
source impedance of the system. However, typical settings for the element are as follows:
● For a transmission system the relay characteristic angle (RCA) should be set equal to –60°
● For a distribution system the relay characteristic angle (RCA) should be set equal to –45°

For the negative phase sequence directional elements to operate, the device must detect a polarising voltage
above a minimum threshold, I2> V2pol Set. This must be set in excess of any steady state negative phase
sequence voltage. This may be determined during the commissioning stage by viewing the negative phase
sequence measurements in the device.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 365
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

4 EARTH FAULT PROTECTION


Earth faults are overcurrent faults where the fault current flows to earth. Earth faults are the most common type of
fault.
Earth faults can be measured directly from the system by means of:
● A separate current Transformer (CT) located in a power system earth connection
● A separate Core Balance Current Transformer (CBCT), usually connected to the SEF transformer input
● A residual connection of the three line CTs, where the Earth faults can be derived mathematically by
summing the three measured phase currents.

Depending on the device model, it will provide one or more of the above means for Earth fault protection.

4.1 EARTH FAULT PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Earth fault protection is implemented in the EARTH FAULT column of the relevant settings group. The element uses
quantities derived internally from summing the three-phase currents.
The product provides four stages of Earth Fault protection with independent time delay characteristics, for each
EARTH FAULT column.
Stages 1 and 2 provide a choice of operate and reset characteristics, where you can select between:
● A range of IDMT (Inverse Definite Minimum Time) curves
● DT (Definite Time)

This is achieved using the cells:


● IN>(n) Function for the overcurrent operate characteristics
● IN>(n) Reset Char for the overcurrent reset characteristic

where (n) is the number of the stage.


Stages 1 and 2 provide a Timer Hold facility. This is configured using the cells IN>(n) tReset
Stages 3 and 4 can have definite time characteristics only.
Earth fault Overcurrent IN> can be set to:
● Permanently disabled
● Permanently enabled
● Enabled only if VT fuse/MCB fails
● Enabled only if protection communication channel fails
● Enabled if VT fuse/MCB or protection communication channel fail
● Enabled if VT fuse/MCB and protection communication channel fail
Each stage can be individually inhibited with a DDB signal Inhibit IN>(n), where n is the stage number.

4.2 IDG CURVE


The IDG curve is commonly used for time delayed earth fault protection in the Swedish market. This curve is
available in stage 1 of the Earth Fault protection.
The IDG curve is represented by the following equation:

 I 
top = 5.8 − 1.35 log e  
 IN > Setting 
where:

366 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

top is the operating time


I is the measured current
IN> Setting is an adjustable setting, which defines the start point of the characteristic

Note:
Although the start point of the characteristic is defined by the "ΙN>" setting, the actual current threshold is a different setting
called "IDG Ιs". The "IDG Ιs" setting is set as a multiple of "ΙN>".

Note:
When using an IDG Operate characteristic, DT is always used with a value of zero for the Rest characteristic.

An additional setting "IDG Time" is also used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.

10

8 IDGIsIsSetting
IDG SettingRange
Range
time (seconds)
(seconds)

6
Operating time

5
Operating

3
IDG Time
IDG Time Setting
Setting Range
Range
2

0
1 10 100
I/IN>

V00611

Figure 204: IDG Characteristic

4.3 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT


If Earth fault current can flow in both directions through a protected location, you will need to use a directional
overcurrent element to determine the direction of the fault. Typical systems that require such protection are
parallel feeders and ring main systems.
A directional element is available for all of the Earth Fault stages. These are found in the direction setting cells for
the relevant stage. They can be set to non-directional, directional forward, or directional reverse.
Directional control can be blocked by the VTS element if required.
For standard earth fault protection, two options are available for polarisation; Residual Voltage (zero sequence) or
Negative Sequence.

4.3.1 RESIDUAL VOLTAGE POLARISATION


With earth fault protection, the polarising signal needs to be representative of the earth fault condition. As residual
voltage is generated during earth fault conditions, this quantity is commonly used to polarise directional earth
fault elements. This is known as Zero Sequence Voltage polarisation, Residual Voltage polarisation or Neutral
Displacement Voltage (NVD) polarisation.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 367
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

Small levels of residual voltage could be present under normal system conditions due to system imbalances, VT
inaccuracies, device tolerances etc. For this reason, the device includes a user settable threshold (IN> VNPol set),
which must be exceeded in order for the DEF function to become operational. The residual voltage measurement
provided in the MEASUREMENTS 1 column of the menu may assist in determining the required threshold setting
during the commissioning stage, as this will indicate the level of standing residual voltage present.

Note:
Residual voltage is nominally 180° out of phase with residual current. Consequently, the DEF elements are polarised from the
"-Vres" quantity. This 180° phase shift is automatically introduced within the device.

The directional criteria with residual voltage polarisation is given below:


● Directional forward: -90° < (angle(IN) - angle(VN + 180°) - RCA) < 90°
● Directional reverse : -90° > (angle(IN) - angle(VN + 180°) - RCA) > 90°

4.3.2 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE POLARISATION


In some applications, the use of residual voltage polarisation may be not possible to achieve, or at the very least,
problematic. For example, a suitable type of VT may be unavailable, or an HV/EHV parallel line application may
present problems with zero sequence mutual coupling.
In such situations, the problem may be solved by using Negative Phase Sequence (NPS) quantities for polarisation.
This method determines the fault direction by comparing the NPS voltage with the NPS current. The operating
quantity, however, is still residual current.
This can be used for both the derived and measured standard earth fault elements. It requires a suitable voltage
and current threshold to be set in cells IN> V2pol set and IN> I2pol set respectively.
Negative phase sequence polarising is not recommended for impedance earthed systems regardless of the type
of VT feeding the relay. This is due to the reduced earth fault current limiting the voltage drop across the negative
sequence source impedance to negligible levels. If this voltage is less than 0.5 volts the device will stop providing
directionalisation.
The directional criteria with negative sequence polarisation is given below:
● Directional forward: -90° < (angle(I2) - angle(V2 + 180°) - RCA) < 90°
● Directional reverse : -90° > (angle(I2) - angle(V2 + 180°) - RCA) > 90°

368 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

4.4 EARTH FAULT PROTECTION LOGIC

777 IN>1 Start


IN

IDMT/ DT
IN>1 Current Set 671
& & & IN>1 Trip
CTS Block 928

467
Inhibit IN >1

IN>1 Directional

VN

IN> VNpol Set

IN Directional
check
Low Current

Residual voltage polarisation

833
VTS Slow Block
IN> Blocking &
VTS Blocks IN>1

405
IN>1 Timer Blk

V2

IN> V2pol Set

I2

IN> I2pol Set

Negative Sequence Polarisation


Note: For the purpose of clarity, this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V00737

Figure 205: Earth Fault Protection logic diagram

4.5 APPLICATION NOTES

4.5.1 RESIDUAL VOLTAGE POLARISATION SETTING GUIDELINES


It is possible that small levels of residual voltage will be present under normal system conditions due to system
imbalances, VT inaccuracies, IED tolerances etc. Hence, the IED includes a user settable threshold (IN> VNPol Set)
which must be exceeded in order for the DEF function to be operational. In practice, the typical zero sequence
voltage on a healthy system can be as high as 1% (i.e. 3% residual), and the VT error could be 1% per phase. A
setting between 1% and 4% is therefore typical. The residual voltage measurement may assist in determining the
required threshold setting during commissioning, as this will indicate the level of standing residual voltage present.

4.5.2 SETTING GUIDELINES (DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT)


With directional earth faults, the residual current under fault conditions lies at an angle lagging the polarising
voltage. Hence, negative RCA settings are required for DEF applications. This is set in the cell I> Char Angle in the
relevant earth fault menu.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 369
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

We recommend the following RCA settings:


● Resistance earthed systems: 0°
● Distribution systems (solidly earthed): -45°
● Transmission systems (solidly earthed): -60°

370 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

5 SENSITIVE EARTH FAULT PROTECTION


With some earth faults, the fault current flowing to earth is limited by either intentional resistance (as is the case
with some HV systems) or unintentional resistance (e.g. in very dry conditions and where the substrate is high
resistance, such as sand or rock).
To provide protection in such cases, it is necessary to provide an earth fault protection system with a setting that is
considerably lower than for normal line protection. Such sensitivity cannot be provided with conventional CTs,
therefore the SEF input would normally be fed from a core balance current transformer (CBCT) mounted around
the three phases of the feeder cable. The SEF transformer should be a special measurement class transformer.

5.1 SEF PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


The product provides four stages of SEF protection with independent time delay characteristics.
Stages 1, 2 provide a choice of operate and reset characteristics, where you can select between:
● A range of IDMT (Inverse Definite Minimum Time) curves
● DT (Definite Time)

This is achieved using the cells


● ISEF>(n) Function for the overcurrent operate characteristic
● ISEF>(n) Reset Chr for the overcurrent reset characteristic

where (n) is the number of the stage.


Stages 1 and 2 also provide a Timer Hold facility. This is configured using the cells ISEF>(n) tReset.
Stages 3 and 4 have definite time characteristics only.
Each stage can be individually inhibited with a DDB signal Inhibit ISEF>(n), where n is the stage number.

5.2 EPATR B CURVE


The EPATR B curve is commonly used for time-delayed Sensitive Earth Fault protection in certain markets. This
curve is only available in the Sensitive Earth Fault protection stages 1 and 2. It is based on primary current settings,
employing a SEF CT ratio of 100:1 A.
The EPATR_B curve has 3 separate segments defined in terms of the primary current. It is defined as follows:
Segment Primary Current Range Based on 100A:1A CT Ratio Current/Time Characteristic
1 ISEF = 0.5A to 6.0A t = 432 x TMS/ISEF 0.655 secs
2 ISEF = 6.0A to 200A t = 800 x TMS/ISEF secs
3 ISEF above 200A t = 4 x TMS secs

where TMS (time multiplier setting) is 0.025 - 1.2 in steps of 0.025.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 371
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

EPATR Curve

1000

100
Time in Secs

10

1
0.1 1 10 100 1000
Current in Primary A (CT Ratio 100A/1A)

V00616

Figure 206: EPATR B characteristic shown for TMS = 1.0

5.3 SENSITIVE EARTH FAULT PROTECTION LOGIC

777 IN>1 Start


IN

IDMT/ DT
ISEF>1 Current 671
& & & IN>1 Trip
CTS Block 928

1724
Inhibit ISEF>1

ISEF>1 Direction

VN

ISEF> VNpol Set

IN Directional
check
Low Current

Residual voltage polarisation

833
VTS Slow Block
ISEF> Blocking &
VTS Blocks IN>1

409
ISEF>1 Timer Blk

ISEF> Blocking
AR Blks ISEF>3 *

Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
V00738 * Stages 3 and 4 only relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .

Figure 207: Sensitive Earth Fault Protection logic diagram

372 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

5.4 APPLICATION NOTES

5.4.1 INSULATED SYSTEMS


When insulated systems are used, it is not possible to detect faults using standard earth fault protection. It is
possible to use a residual overvoltage device to achieve this, but even with this method full discrimination is not
possible. Fully discriminative earth fault protection on this type of system can only be achieved by using a SEF
(Sensitive Earth Fault) element. This type of protection detects the resultant imbalance in the system charging
currents that occurs under earth fault conditions. A core balanced CT must be used for this application. This
eliminates the possibility of spill current that may arise from slight mismatches between residually connected line
CTs. It also enables a much lower CT ratio to be applied, thereby allowing the required protection sensitivity to be
more easily achieved.
The following diagram shows an insulated system with a C-phase fault.

Ia1
Ib1

IR1
jXc1

IH1
Ia2
Ib2

IR2
jXc2

IH2

Ia3
Ib3
IH1 + IH2 + IH3

IR3
jXc3

IR3 = IH1 + IH2 + IH3 - IH3 IH3 IH1 + IH2


IR3 = IH1 + IH2

E00627

Figure 208: Current distribution in an insulated system with C phase fault

The protection elements on the healthy feeder see the charging current imbalance for their own feeder. The
protection element on the faulted feeder, however, sees the charging current from the rest of the system (IH1 and
IH2 in this case). Its own feeder's charging current (IH3) is cancelled out.
With reference to the associated vector diagram, it can be seen that the C-phase to earth fault causes the
voltages on the healthy phases to rise by a factor of √3. The A-phase charging current (Ia1), leads the resultant A
phase voltage by 90°. Likewise, the B-phase charging current leads the resultant Vb by 90°.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 373
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

Vaf
Restrain
Vapf
IR1
Ib1

Operate
Ia1
Vbf

Vcpf Vbpf

Vres
(= 3Vo)

An RCA setting of ±90º shifts the


“centre of the characteristic” to here IR3 = (IH1 + IH2)
E00628

Figure 209: Phasor diagrams for insulated system with C phase fault

The current imbalance detected by a core balanced current transformer on the healthy feeders is the vector
addition of Ia1 and Ib1. This gives a residual current which lags the polariing voltage (–3Vo) by 90°. As the healthy
phase voltages have risen by a factor of Ö3, the charging currents on these phases are also Ö3 times larger than
their steady state values. Therefore, the magnitude of the residual current IR1, is equal to 3 times the steady state
per phase charging current.
The phasor diagram indicates that the residual currents on the healthy and faulted feeders (IR1 and IR3
respectively) are in anti-phase. A directional element (if available) could therefore be used to provide discriminative
earth fault protection.
If the polarising is shifted through +90°, the residual current seen by the relay on the faulted feeder will lie within
the operate region of the directional characteristic and the current on the healthy feeders will fall within the
restrain region.
The required characteristic angle setting for the SEF element when applied to insulated systems, is +90°. This is for
the case when the protection is connected such that its direction of current flow for operation is from the source
busbar towards the feeder. If the forward direction for operation were set such that it is from the feeder into the
busbar, then a –90° RCA would be required.

Note:
Discrimination can be provided without the need for directional control. This can only be achieved, however, if it is possible to
set the IED in excess of the charging current of the protected feeder and below the charging current for the rest of the system.

5.4.2 SETTING GUIDELINES (INSULATED SYSTEMS)


The residual current on the faulted feeder is equal to the sum of the charging currents flowing from the rest of the
system. Further, the addition of the two healthy phase charging currents on each feeder gives a total charging
current which has a magnitude of three times the per phase value. Therefore, the total imbalance current is equal
to three times the per phase charging current of the rest of the system. A typical setting may therefore be in the
order of 30% of this value, i.e. equal to the per phase charging current of the remaining system. Practically though,
the required setting may well be determined on site, where suitable settings can be adopted based on practically
obtained results.
When using a core-balanced transformer, care must be taken in the positioning of the CT with respect to the
earthing of the cable sheath:

374 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Cable gland

Cable box

Cable gland/shealth
earth connection

“Incorrect”

No operation
SEF

“Correct”

Operation
SEF

E00614

Figure 210: Positioning of core balance current transformers

If the cable sheath is terminated at the cable gland and directly earthed at that point, a cable fault (from phase to
sheath) will not result in any unbalanced current in the core balance CT. Therefore, prior to earthing, the
connection must be brought back through the CBCT and earthed on the feeder side. This then ensures correct
relay operation during earth fault conditions.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 375
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

6 HIGH IMPEDANCE REF


The device provides a high impedance restricted earth fault protection function. An external resistor is required to
provide stability in the presence of saturated line current transformers. Current transformer supervision signals do
not block the high impedance REF protection. The appropriate logic must be configured in PSL to block the high
impedance REF when any of the above signals is asserted.

6.1 HIGH IMPEDANCE REF PRINCIPLE


This scheme is very sensitive and can protect against low levels of fault current, typical of winding faults.
High Impedance REF protection is based on the differential principle. It works on the circulating current principle as
shown in the following diagram.

Healthy CT Saturated CT
Protected
circuit

A-G
Zm1 Zm2
I = Is + IF
RCT1 RCT2

I IF

RL1 IS RL3

Vs RST

R
RL2 RL4

V00671

Figure 211: High Impedance REF principle

When subjected to heavy through faults the line current transformer may enter saturation unevenly, resulting in
imbalance. To ensure stability under these conditions a series connected external resistor is required, so that most
of the unbalanced current will flow through the saturated CT. As a result, the current flowing through the device
will be less than the setting, therefore maintaining stability during external faults.
Voltage across REF element Vs = IF (RCT2 + RL3 + RL4)
Stabilising resistor RST = Vs/Is –RR
where:
● IF = maximum secondary through fault current
● RR = device burden
● RCT = CT secondary winding resistance
● RL2 and RL3 = Resistances of leads from the device to the current transformer
● RST = Stabilising resistor

High Impedance REF can be used for either delta windings or star windings in both solidly grounded and
resistance grounded systems. The connection to a modern IED are as follows:

376 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Phase A
Phase A
Phase B
Phase B
Phase C
Phase C

I Phase A

I Phase B

I Phase C
RSTAB I Neutral

I Neutral RSTAB
IED IED

Connecting IED to star winding for High Connecting IED to delta winding for High
Impedance REF Impedance REF

V00680

Figure 212: High Impedance REF Connection

P446SV-TM-EN-1 377
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

7 THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION


The heat generated within an item of plant is the resistive loss. The thermal time characteristic is therefore based
on the equation I2Rt. Over-temperature conditions occur when currents in excess of their maximum rating are
allowed to flow for a period of time.
Temperature changes during heating follow exponential time constants. The device provides two characteristics
for thermal overload protection; a single time constant characteristic and a dual time constant characteristic. You
select these according to the application.

7.1 SINGLE TIME CONSTANT CHARACTERISTIC


This characteristic is used to protect cables, dry type transformers and capacitor banks.
The single constant thermal characteristic is given by the equation:

 I 2 − ( KI FLC )2 
t = −τ log  
 I 2 − I p2 
e  
where:
● t = time to trip, following application of the overload current I
● t = heating and cooling time constant of the protected plant
● I = largest phase current
● IFLC full load current rating (the Thermal Trip setting)
● K = a constant with the value of 1.05
● Ip = steady state pre-loading before application of the overload

7.2 DUAL TIME CONSTANT CHARACTERISTIC


This characteristic is used to protect equipment such as oil-filled transformers with natural air cooling. The thermal
model is similar to that with the single time constant, except that two timer constants must be set.
For marginal overloading, heat will flow from the windings into the bulk of the insulating oil. Therefore, at low
current, the replica curve is dominated by the long time constant for the oil. This provides protection against a
general rise in oil temperature.
For severe overloading, heat accumulates in the transformer windings, with little opportunity for dissipation into
the surrounding insulating oil. Therefore at high current levels, the replica curve is dominated by the short time
constant for the windings. This provides protection against hot spots developing within the transformer windings.
Overall, the dual time constant characteristic serves to protect the winding insulation from ageing and to minimise
gas production by overheated oil. Note however that the thermal model does not compensate for the effects of
ambient temperature change.
The dual time constant thermal characteristic is given by the equation:

( − t / τ1 ) ( −t / τ 2 )
 I 2 − ( KI FLC )2 
0.4e + 0.6e = 2 2

 I − I p 

where:
● t1 = heating and cooling time constant of the transformer windings
● t2 = heating and cooling time constant of the insulating oil

378 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

7.3 THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


The device incorporates a current-based thermal characteristic, using RMS load current to model heating and
cooling of the protected plant. The element can be set with both alarm and trip stages.
Thermal Overload Protection is implemented in the THERMAL OVERLOAD column of the relevant settings group.
This column contains the settings for the characteristic type, the alarm and trip thresholds and the time constants.

7.4 THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION LOGIC

IA
IB Max RMS
Thermal State
IC

Thermal Trip
680
Thermal Trip
Characteristic Thermal trip
Disabled Thermal threshold
Single Calculation
Dual

Time Constant 1

Time Constant 2

445
Reset Thermal
785
Thermal Alarm
Thermal Alarm

V00630

Figure 213: Thermal overload protection logic diagram

The magnitudes of the three phase input currents are compared and the largest magnitude is taken as the input
to the thermal overload function. If this current exceeds the thermal trip threshold setting a start condition is
asserted.
The Start signal is applied to the chosen thermal characteristic module, which has three outputs signals; alarm trip
and thermal state measurement. The thermal state measurement is made available in one of the MEASUREMENTS
columns.
The thermal state can be reset by either an opto-input (if assigned to this function using the programmable
scheme logic) or the HMI panel menu.

7.5 APPLICATION NOTES

7.5.1 SETTING GUIDELINES FOR DUAL TIME CONSTANT CHARACTERISTIC


The easiest way of solving the dual time constant thermal equation is to express the current in terms of time and
to use a spreadsheet to calculate the current for a series of increasing operating times using the following
equation, then plotting a graph.

0.4 I p 2 .e( − t /τ 1) + 0.6 I p 2 .e( − t /τ 2) − k 2 .I FLC 2


I=
0.4e( − t / + 0.6e( − t /τ 2) − 1
τ 1)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 379
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

Figures based
on equation

E00728

Figure 214: Spreadsheet calculation for dual time constant thermal characteristic

100000

10000 Time constant 1 = 5 mins


Operating Time (seconds)

Time constant 2 = 120 mins


Pre-overload current = 0.9 pu
Thermal setting = 1 Amp
1000

100

10

1
1 10
Current as a Multiple of Thermal Setting

V00629

Figure 215: Dual time constant thermal characteristic

The current setting is calculated as:


Thermal Trip = Permissible continuous loading of the transformer item/CT ratio.
For an oil-filled transformer with rating 400 to 1600 kVA, the approximate time constants are:
● t1 = 5 minutes
● t2 = 120 minutes
An alarm can be raised on reaching a thermal state corresponding to a percentage of the trip threshold. A typical
setting might be "Thermal Alarm" = 70% of thermal capacity.

380 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Note:
The thermal time constants given in the above tables are typical only. Reference should always be made to the plant
manufacturer for accurate information.

7.5.2 SETTING GUIDELINES FOR SINGLE TIME CONSTANT CHARACTERISTIC


The time to trip varies depending on the load current carried before application of the overload, i.e. whether the
overload was applied from hot or cold.
The thermal time constant characteristic may be rewritten as:

θ − θ p 
e( − t / τ ) =  
e 
θ −1 

where:
● θ = thermal state = I2/K2IFLC2
● θp = pre-fault thermal state = Ip2/K2IFLC2

● Ip is the pre-fault thermal state


● IFLC is the full load current

Note:
A current of 105%Is (KIFLC) has to be applied for several time constants to cause a thermal state measurement of 100%.

The current setting is calculated as:


Thermal Trip = Permissible continuous loading of the plant item/CT ratio.
The following tables show the approximate time constant in minutes, for different cable rated voltages with
various conductor cross-sectional areas, and other plant equipment.

Area mm2 6 - 11 kV 22 kV 33 kV 66 kV
25 – 50 10 minutes 15 minutes 40 minutes –
70 – 120 15 minutes 25 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes
150 25 minutes 40 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes
185 25 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes
240 40 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes
300 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes 90 minutes

Plant type Time Constant (Minutes)


Dry-type transformer <400 kVA 40
Dry-type transformers 400 – 800 kVA 60 - 90
Air-core Reactors 40
Capacitor Banks 10

Overhead Lines with cross section > 100 mm2 10


Overhead Lines 10
Busbars 60

P446SV-TM-EN-1 381
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

8 BROKEN CONDUCTOR PROTECTION


One type of unbalanced fault is the 'Series' or 'Open Circuit' fault. This type of fault can arise from, among other
things, broken conductors. Series faults do not cause an increase in phase current and so cannot be detected by
overcurrent protection. However, they do produce an imbalance, resulting in negative phase sequence current,
which can be detected.
It is possible to apply a negative phase sequence overcurrent element to detect broken conductors. However, on a
lightly loaded line, the negative sequence current resulting from a series fault condition may be very close to, or
less than, the full load steady state imbalance arising from CT errors and load imbalances, making it very difficult
to distinguish. A regular negative sequence element would therefore not work at low load levels. To overcome this,
the device incorporates a special Broken Conductor protection element.
The Broken Conductor element measures the ratio of negative to positive phase sequence current (I2/I1). This ratio
is approximately constant with variations in load current, therefore making it more sensitive to series faults than
standard negative sequence protection.

8.1 BROKEN CONDUCTOR PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Broken Conductor protection is implemented in the BROKEN CONDUCTOR column of the relevant settings group.
This column contains the settings to enable the function, for the pickup threshold and the time delay.

8.2 BROKEN CONDUCTOR PROTECTION LOGIC


The ratio of I2/I1 is calculated and compared with the threshold setting. If the threshold is exceeded, the delay
timer is initiated. The CTS block signal is used to block the operation of the delay timer.

I2/I1

679
I2/I1 Setting & Broken Wire Trip

I2

Low Current

928
CTS Block

V00739

Figure 216: Broken conductor logic

8.3 APPLICATION NOTES

8.3.1 SETTING GUIDELINES


For a broken conductor affecting a single point earthed power system, there will be little zero sequence current
flow and the ratio of I2/I1 that flows in the protected circuit will approach 100%. In the case of a multiple earthed
power system (assuming equal impedance’s in each sequence network), the ratio I2/I1 will be 50%.
In practise, the levels of standing negative phase sequence current present on the system govern this minimum
setting. This can be determined from a system study, or by making use of the measurement facilities at the
commissioning stage. If the latter method is adopted, it is important to take the measurements during maximum
system load conditions, to ensure that all single-phase loads are accounted for.

382 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions

Note:
A minimum value of 8% negative phase sequence current is required for successful operation.

Since sensitive settings have been employed, we can expect that the element will operate for any unbalanced
condition occurring on the system (for example, during a single pole autoreclose cycle). For this reason, a long time
delay is necessary to ensure co-ordination with other protection devices. A 60 second time delay setting may be
typical.
The following example was recorded by an IED during commissioning:
Ifull load = 500A
I2 = 50A
therefore the quiescent I2/I1 ratio = 0.1
To allow for tolerances and load variations a setting of 20% of this value may be typical: Therefore set:
I2/I1 = 0.2
In a double circuit (parallel line) application, using a 40% setting will ensure that the broken conductor protection
will operate only for the circuit that is affected. A setting of 0.4 results in no pick-up for the parallel healthy circuit.
Set I2/I1 Time Delay = 60 s to allow adequate time for short circuit fault clearance by time delayed protections.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 383
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV

384 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 14

VOLTAGE PROTECTION FUNCTIONS


Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

386 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a wide range of voltage protection functions. This chapter describes the operation of these
functions including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 387
Undervoltage Protection 388
Overvoltage Protection 391
Compensated Overvoltage 394
Residual Overvoltage Protection 395

P446SV-TM-EN-1 387
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

2 UNDERVOLTAGE PROTECTION
Undervoltage conditions may occur on a power system for a variety of reasons, some of which are outlined below:
● Undervoltage conditions can be related to increased loads, whereby the supply voltage will decrease in
magnitude. This situation would normally be rectified by voltage regulating equipment such as AVRs (Auto
Voltage Regulators) or On Load Tap Changers. However, failure of this equipment to bring the system
voltage back within permitted limits leaves the system with an undervoltage condition, which must be
cleared.
● If the regulating equipment is unsuccessful in restoring healthy system voltage, then tripping by means of
an undervoltage element is required.
● Faults occurring on the power system result in a reduction in voltage of the faulty phases. The proportion by
which the voltage decreases is dependent on the type of fault, method of system earthing and its location.
Consequently, co-ordination with other voltage and current-based protection devices is essential in order to
achieve correct discrimination.
● Complete loss of busbar voltage. This may occur due to fault conditions present on the incomer or busbar
itself, resulting in total isolation of the incoming power supply. For this condition, it may be necessary to
isolate each of the outgoing circuits, such that when supply voltage is restored, the load is not connected.
Therefore, the automatic tripping of a feeder on detection of complete loss of voltage may be required. This
can be achieved by a three-phase undervoltage element.
● Where outgoing feeders from a busbar are supplying induction motor loads, excessive dips in the supply
may cause the connected motors to stall, and should be tripped for voltage reductions that last longer than
a pre-determined time.

2.1 UNDERVOLTAGE PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Undervoltage Protection is implemented in the VOLT PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group. The
Undervoltage parameters are contained within the sub-heading UNDERVOLTAGE.
The product provides two stages of Undervoltage protection with independent time delay characteristics.
Stage 1 provides a choice of operate characteristics, where you can select between:
● An IDMT characteristic
● DT (Definite Time)

You set this using the V<1 Function setting.


The IDMT characteristic is defined by the following formula:
t = K/( M-1)
where:
● K = Time multiplier setting
● t = Operating time in seconds
● M = Measured voltage / IED setting voltage (V<(n) Voltage Set)

The undervoltage stages can be configured either as phase-to-neutral or phase-to-phase voltages in the V<
Measur't Mode cell.
There is no Timer Hold facility for Undervoltage.
Stage 2 can have definite time characteristics only. This is set in the V<2 Status cell.
Outputs are available for single or three-phase conditions via the V< Operate Mode cell for each stage.

388 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

2.2 UNDERVOLTAGE PROTECTION LOGIC


V< Measur't Mode
789
VA V<1 Start A/AB
VAB
V<1 Voltage Set & 684
& V <1 Trip A/AB

V<1 Time Delay

V< Measur't Mode


790
VB V<1 Start B/BC
VBC
V<1 Voltage Set & 685
& V<1 Trip B/BC

V<1 Time Delay

V< Measur't Mode


791
VC V<1 Start C/CA
VCA
V<1 Voltage Set & 686
& V<1 Trip C/CA

V<1 Time Delay


1
&
890
All Poles Dead 788
1 V<1 Start
V<1 Poledead Inh &
& &
Enabled

832
VTS Fast Block 1
&
414
V<1 Timer Block 1 683
V<1 Trip
&
V< Operate Mode &
Any Phase
Three Phase

Note: This diagram does not show all stages . Other stages follow similar principles.
VTS Fast Block only applies for directional models .
V00803

Figure 217: Undervoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage)

The Undervoltage protection function detects when the voltage magnitude for a certain stage falls short of a set
threshold. If this happens a Start signal, signifying the "Start of protection", is produced. This Start signal can be
blocked by the VTS Fast Block signal and an All Poles Dead signal. This Start signal is applied to the timer module
to produce the Trip signal, which can be blocked by the undervoltage timer block signal (V<(n) Timer Block). For
each stage, there are three Phase undervoltage detection modules, one for each phase. The three Start signals
from each of these phases are OR'd together to create a 3-phase Start signal (V<(n) Start), which can be be
activated when any of the three phases start (Any Phase), or when all three phases start (Three Phase), depending
on the chosen V< Operate Mode setting.
The outputs of the timer modules are the trip signals which are used to drive the tripping output relay. These
tripping signals are also OR'd together to create a 3-phase Trip signal, which are also controlled by the V< Operate
Mode setting.
If any one of the above signals is low, or goes low before the timer has counted out, the timer module is inhibited
(effectively reset) until the blocking signal goes high.
In some cases, we do not want the undervoltage element to trip; for example, when the protected feeder is de-
energised, or the circuit breaker is opened, an undervoltage condition would obviously be detected, but we would
not want to start protection. To cater for this, an All Poles Dead signal blocks the Start signal for each phase. This
is controlled by the V<Poledead Inh cell, which is included for each of the stages. If the cell is enabled, the relevant
stage will be blocked by the integrated pole dead logic. This logic produces an output when it detects either an
open circuit breaker via auxiliary contacts feeding the opto-inputs or it detects a combination of both
undercurrent and undervoltage on any one phase.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 389
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

2.3 APPLICATION NOTES

2.3.1 UNDERVOLTAGE SETTING GUIDELINES


In most applications, undervoltage protection is not required to operate during system earth fault conditions. If this
is the case you should select phase-to-phase voltage measurement, as this quantity is less affected by single-
phase voltage dips due to earth faults.
The voltage threshold setting for the undervoltage protection should be set at some value below the voltage
excursions that may be expected under normal system operating conditions. This threshold is dependent on the
system in question but typical healthy system voltage excursions may be in the order of 10% of nominal value.
The same applies to the time setting. The required time delay is dependent on the time for which the system is able
to withstand a reduced voltage.
If motor loads are connected, then a typical time setting may be in the order of 0.5 seconds.

390 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

3 OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION
Overvoltage conditions are generally related to loss of load conditions, whereby the supply voltage increases in
magnitude. This situation would normally be rectified by voltage regulating equipment such as AVRs (Auto Voltage
Regulators) or On Load Tap Changers. However, failure of this equipment to bring the system voltage back within
permitted limits leaves the system with an overvoltage condition which must be cleared.

Note:
During earth fault conditions on a power system there may be an increase in the healthy phase voltages. Ideally, the system
should be designed to withstand such overvoltages for a defined period of time.

3.1 OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Overvoltage Protection is implemented in the VOLT PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group. The
Overvoltage parameters are contained within the sub-heading OVERVOLTAGE.
The product provides two stages of overvoltage protection with independent time delay characteristics.
Stage 1 provides a choice of operate characteristics, where you can select between:
● An IDMT characteristic
● DT (Definite Time)

You set this using the V>1 Function setting.


The IDMT characteristic is defined by the following formula:
t = K/( M - 1)
where:
● K = Time multiplier setting
● t = Operating time in seconds
● M = Measured voltage setting voltage (V>(n) Voltage Set)

The overvoltage stages can be configured either as phase-to-neutral or phase-to-phase voltages in the V>
Measur't Mode cell.
There is no Timer Hold facility for Overvoltage.
Stage 2 can have definite time characteristics only. This is set in the V>2 Status cell.
Outputs are available for single or three-phase conditions via the V> Operate Mode cell for each stage.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 391
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

3.2 OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION LOGIC


V> Measur't Mode
V>1 Start A/AB
VA
VAB
V>1 Voltage Set & V >1 Trip A/AB

V>1 Time Delay

V> Measur't Mode


V>1 Start B/BC
VB
VBC
V>1 Voltage Set & V>1 Trip B/BC

V>1 Time Delay

V> Measur't Mode


V>1 Start C/CA
VC
VCA
V>1 Voltage Set & V>1 Trip C/CA

V>1 Time Delay 1


&
1 V>1 Start
&
&

1
&
V>1 Timer Block 1 V>1 Trip
&
V> Operate mode &
Any Phase
Three Phase
Notes: This diagram does not show all stages . Other stages follow similar principles.
VTS Fast Block only applies for directional models .
V 00804

Figure 218: Overvoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage)

The Overvoltage protection function detects when the voltage magnitude for a certain stage exceeds a set
threshold. If this happens a Start signal, signifying the "Start of protection", is produced. This Start signal can be
blocked by the VTS Fast Block signal. This start signal is applied to the timer module to produce the Trip signal,
which can be blocked by the overvoltage timer block signal (V>(n) Timer Block). For each stage, there are three
Phase overvoltage detection modules, one for each phase. The three Start signals from each of these phases are
OR'd together to create a 3-phase Start signal (V>(n) Start), which can then be activated when any of the three
phases start (Any Phase), or when all three phases start (Three Phase), depending on the chosen V> Operate Mode
setting.
The outputs of the timer modules are the trip signals which are used to drive the tripping output relay. These
tripping signals are also OR'd together to create a 3-phase Trip signal, which are also controlled by the V> Operate
Mode setting.
If any one of the above signals is low, or goes low before the timer has counted out, the timer module is inhibited
(effectively reset) until the blocking signal goes high.

392 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

3.3 APPLICATION NOTES

3.3.1 OVERVOLTAGE SETTING GUIDELINES


The provision of multiple stages and their respective operating characteristics allows for a number of possible
applications:
● Definite Time can be used for both stages to provide the required alarm and trip stages.
● Use of the IDMT characteristic allows grading of the time delay according to the severity of the overvoltage.
As the voltage settings for both of the stages are independent, the second stage could then be set lower
than the first to provide a time-delayed alarm stage.
● If only one stage of overvoltage protection is required, or if the element is required to provide an alarm only,
the remaining stage may be disabled.

This type of protection must be co-ordinated with any other overvoltage devices at other locations on the system.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 393
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

4 COMPENSATED OVERVOLTAGE
The Compensated Overvoltage function calculates the positive sequence voltage at the remote terminal using the
positive sequence local current and voltage and the line impedance and susceptance. This can be used on long
transmission lines where Ferranti Overvoltages can develop under remote circuit breaker open conditions.
The Compensated overvoltage protection function can be set in the VOLT PROTECTION column under the sub
heading COMP OVERVOLTAGE. The remote voltage is calculated using line impedance settings and the line
charging admittance in the LINE PARAMETERS column.
The IED uses the [A,B,C,D] transmission line equivalent model given the following parameters:
● Total Impedance Z = zÐq ohms
● Total Susceptance Y = yÐ90°
● Line Length l

The remote voltage is calculated using the following equations:

Vr   D − C  Vs 
 = × 
Ir
   − BA   Is 
where
● Vr is the voltage at the receiving end
● Ir is the current at the receiving end
● Vs is the measured voltage at the sending end
● Is is the measured current at the sending end
● A= D = cosh(y.l)
● B = Zc.sinh(y.l)
● C = Yc.sinh(y.l)
● y.l = Ö(Z.Y)
● Zc = 1/Yc = Ö(Z/Y)
● Y = total line capacitive charging susceptance
● Zc = characteristic impedance of the line (surge impedance)

There are two stages to provide both alarm and trip stages where required. Both stages can be set independently.
Stage 1 can be set to IDMT, DT or Disabled, in the V1>1 Cmp Funct cell. Stage 2 is DT only and is enabled or
disabled in the V1>2 Cmp Status cell.
The IDMT characteristic on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K/(M - 1)
where:
● K = Time multiplier setting
● t =Operating time in seconds
● M = Remote Calculated voltage / IED setting voltage

394 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

5 RESIDUAL OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION


On a healthy three-phase power system, the sum of the three-phase to earth voltages is nominally zero, as it is the
vector sum of three balanced vectors displaced from each other by 120°. However, when an earth fault occurs on
the primary system, this balance is upset and a residual voltage is produced. This condition causes a rise in the
neutral voltage with respect to earth. Consequently this type of protection is also commonly referred to as 'Neutral
Voltage Displacement' or NVD for short.
This residual voltage may be derived (from the phase voltages) or measured (from a measurement class open
delta VT). Derived values will normally only be used where the model does not support measured functionality (a
dedicated measurement class VT). If a measurement class VT is used to produce a measured Residual Voltage, it
cannot be used for other features such as Check Synchronisation.
This offers an alternative means of earth fault detection, which does not require any measurement of current. This
may be particularly advantageous in high impedance earthed or insulated systems, where the provision of core
balanced current transformers on each feeder may be either impractical, or uneconomic, or for providing earth
fault protection for devices with no current transformers.

5.1 RESIDUAL OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Residual Overvoltage Protection is implemented in the RESIDUAL O/V NVD column of the relevant settings group.
Some applications require more than one stage. For example an insulated system may require an alarm stage and
a trip stage. It is common in such a case for the system to be designed to withstand the associated healthy phase
overvoltages for a number of hours following an earth fault. In such applications, an alarm is generated soon after
the condition is detected, which serves to indicate the presence of an earth fault on the system. This gives time for
system operators to locate and isolate the fault. The second stage of the protection can issue a trip signal if the
fault condition persists.
The product provides two stages of Residual Overvoltage protection with independent time delay characteristics.
Stage 1 provides a choice of operate characteristics, where you can select between:
● An IDMT characteristic
● DT (Definite Time)

The IDMT characteristic is defined by the following formula:


t = K/( M - 1)
where:
● K= Time multiplier setting
● t = Operating time in seconds
● M = Derived residual voltage setting voltage (VN> Voltage Set)

You set this using the VN>1 Function setting.


Stage 1 also provides a Timer Hold facility.
Stage 2 can have definite time characteristics only. This is set in the VN>2 status cell
The device derives the residual voltage internally from the three-phase voltage inputs supplied from either a 5-limb
VT or three single-phase VTs. These types of VT design provide a path for the residual flux and consequently permit
the device to derive the required residual voltage. In addition, the primary star point of the VT must be earthed.
Three-limb VTs have no path for residual flux and are therefore unsuitable for this type of protection.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 395
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

5.2 RESIDUAL OVERVOLTAGE LOGIC

804
VN>1 Start

VN
VN>1 Voltage Set & 700
& IDMT/DT VN>1 Trip
832
VTS Fast Block

418
VN>1 Timer Blk
V00802

Figure 219: Residual Overvoltage logic

The Residual Overvoltage module (VN>) is a level detector that detects when the voltage magnitude exceeds a set
threshold, for each stage. When this happens, the comparator output produces a Start signal (VN>(n) Start), which
signifies the "Start of protection". This can be blocked by a VTS Fast block signal. This Start signal is applied to the
timer module. The output of the timer module is the VN> (n) Trip signal which is used to drive the tripping output
relay.

5.3 APPLICATION NOTES

5.3.1 CALCULATION FOR SOLIDLY EARTHED SYSTEMS


Consider a Phase-A to Earth fault on a simple radial system.

396 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions

E S IED F
ZS ZL

VA
VA

VC VB VC VB VC VB

VA VRES
VRES
VA
VB VB VB

VC VC VC

VRES = ZS0
X3E
2ZS1 + ZS0 + 2ZL1 + ZL0

E00800

Figure 220: Residual voltage for a solidly earthed system

As can be seen from the above diagram, the residual voltage measured on a solidly earthed system is solely
dependent on the ratio of source impedance behind the protection to the line impedance in front of the protection,
up to the point of fault. For a remote fault far away, the ZS/ZL: ratio will be small, resulting in a correspondingly
small residual voltage. Therefore, the protection only operates for faults up to a certain distance along the system.
The maximum distance depends on the device setting.

5.3.2 CALCULATION FOR IMPEDANCE EARTHED SYSTEMS


Consider a Phase-A to Earth fault on a simple radial system.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 397
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV

E S IED F
ZS ZL
N

ZE

VA - G
S R VA - G
G,F G,F
G,F

VC - G VC - G VC - G
VB - G VB - G VB - G

VRES VRES VRES

VB - G VB - G VB - G
VA - G VA - G
VC - G VC - G VC - G

ZS0 + 3ZE
VRES = X3E
2ZS1 + ZS0 + 2ZL1 + ZL0 + 3Z
E

E00801

Figure 221: Residual voltage for an impedance earthed system

An impedance earthed system will always generate a relatively large degree of residual voltage, as the zero
sequence source impedance now includes the earthing impedance. It follows then that the residual voltage
generated by an earth fault on an insulated system will be the highest possible value (3 x phase-neutral voltage),
as the zero sequence source impedance is infinite.

5.3.3 SETTING GUIDELINES


The voltage setting applied to the elements is dependent on the magnitude of residual voltage that is expected to
occur during the earth fault condition. This in turn is dependent on the method of system earthing employed.
Also, you must ensure that the protection setting is set above any standing level of residual voltage that is present
on the system.

398 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 15

FREQUENCY PROTECTION FUNCTIONS


Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV

400 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a range of frequency protection functions. This chapter describes the operation of these
functions including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 401
Frequency Protection 402
Independent R.O.C.O.F Protection 405

P446SV-TM-EN-1 401
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV

2 FREQUENCY PROTECTION
Power generation and utilisation needs to be well balanced in any industrial, distribution or transmission network.
These electrical networks are dynamic entities, with continually varying loads and supplies, which are continually
affecting the system frequency. Increased loading reduces the system frequency and generation needs to be
increased to maintain the frequency of the supply. Conversely decreased loading increases the system frequency
and generation needs to be reduced. Sudden fluctuations in load can cause rapid changes in frequency, which
need to be dealt with quickly.
Unless corrective measures are taken at the appropriate time, frequency decay can go beyond the point of no
return and cause widespread network collapse, which has dire consequences.
Normally, generators are rated for a particular band of frequency. Operation outside this band can cause
mechanical damage to the turbine blades. Protection against such contingencies is required when frequency does
not improve even after load shedding steps have been taken. This type of protection can be used for operator
alarms or turbine trips in case of severe frequency decay.
Clearly a range of methods is required to ensure system frequency stability. The frequency protection in this device
provides both underfrequency and overfrequency protection.
Frequency Protection is implemented in the FREQ PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group.

2.1 UNDERFREQUENCY PROTECTION


A reduced system frequency implies that the net load is in excess of the available generation. Such a condition can
arise, when an interconnected system splits, and the load left connected to one of the subsystems is in excess of
the capacity of the generators in that particular subsystem. Industrial plants that are dependent on utilities to
supply part of their loads will experience underfrequency conditions when the incoming lines are lost.
Many types of industrial loads have limited tolerances on the operating frequency and running speeds (e.g.
synchronous motors). Sustained underfrequency has implications on the stability of the system, whereby any
subsequent disturbance may damage equipment and even lead to blackouts. It is therefore essential to provide
protection for underfrequency conditions.

2.1.1 UNDERFREQUENCY PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Simple underfrequency Protection is configured in the FREQ PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group.
The device provides 4 stages of underfrequency protection. The function uses the following settings (shown for
stage 1 only - other stages follow the same principles).
● F<1 Status: enables or disables underfrequency protection for the relevant stage
● F<1 Setting: defines the frequency pickup setting
● F<1 Time Delay: sets the time delay

402 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions

2.1.2 UNDERFREQUENCY PROTECTION LOGIC

Freq 1155
Averaging F<1 Start
DT
1161
F<1 Setting & F<1 Trip

F<1 Status
Enabled

890
All Poles Dead
1
Freq Not Found 1370

1149
F<1 Timer Block
V00861

Figure 222: Underfrequency logic (single stage)

If the frequency is below the setting and not blocked the DT timer is started. If the frequency cannot be
determined, the function is blocked.

2.1.3 APPLICATION NOTES

2.1.3.1 SETTING GUIDELINES


In order to minimise the effects of underfrequency, a multi-stage load shedding scheme may be used with the
plant loads prioritised and grouped. During an underfrequency condition, the load groups are disconnected
sequentially, with the highest priority group being the last one to be disconnected.
The effectiveness of each load shedding stage depends on the proportion of power deficiency it represents. If the
load shedding stage is too small compared with the prevailing generation deficiency, then there may be no
improvement in the frequency. This should be taken into account when forming the load groups.
Time delays should be sufficient to override any transient dips in frequency, as well as to provide time for the
frequency controls in the system to respond. These should not be excessive as this could jeopardize system
stability. Time delay settings of 5 - 20 s are typical.
The protection function should be set so that declared frequency-time limits for the generating set are not
infringed. Typically, a 10% underfrequency condition should be continuously sustainable.

2.2 OVERFREQUENCY PROTECTION


An increased system frequency arises when the mechanical power input to a generator exceeds the electrical
power output. This could happen, for instance, when there is a sudden loss of load due to tripping of an outgoing
feeder from the plant to a load centre. Under such conditions, the governor would normally respond quickly to
obtain a balance between the mechanical input and electrical output, thereby restoring normal frequency.
Overfrequency protection is required as a backup to cater for cases where the reaction of the control equipment is
too slow.

2.2.1 OVERFREQUENCY PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


Simple overfrequency Protection is configured in the FREQ PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group.
The device provides 2 stages of overfrequency protection. The function uses the following settings (shown for
stage 1 only - other stages follow the same principles).
● F>1 Status: enables or disables underfrequency protection for the relevant stage
● F>1 Setting: defines the frequency pickup setting
● F>1 Time Delay: sets the time delay

P446SV-TM-EN-1 403
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV

2.2.2 OVERFREQUENCY PROTECTION LOGIC

1159
Freq Averaging F>1 Start
DT
1165
F>1 Setting & F>1 Trip

F>1 Status
Enabled

890
All Poles Dead
1
Freq Not Found 1370

1153
F>1 Timer Block
V00862

Figure 223: Overfrequency logic (single stage)

If the frequency is above the setting and not blocked, the DT timer is started and after this has timed out, the trip is
produced. If the frequency cannot be determined, the function is blocked.

2.2.3 APPLICATION NOTES

2.2.3.1 SETTING GUIDELINES


Following changes on the network caused by faults or other operational requirements, it is possible that various
subsystems will be formed within the power network. It is likely that these subsystems will suffer from a
generation/load imbalance. The "islands" where generation exceeds the existing load will be subject to
overfrequency conditions. Severe over frequency conditions may be unacceptable to many industrial loads, since
running speeds of motors will be affected. The overfrequency element can be suitably set to sense this
contingency.

404 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions

3 INDEPENDENT R.O.C.O.F PROTECTION


Where there are very large loads, imbalances may occur that result in rapid decline in system frequency. The
situation could be so bad that shedding one or two stages of load is unlikely to stop this rapid frequency decline. In
such a situation, standard underfrequency protection will normally have to be supplemented with protection that
responds to the rate of change of frequency. An element is therefore required which identifies the high rate of
decline of frequency, and adapts the load shedding scheme accordingly.
Such protection can identify frequency variations occurring close to nominal frequency thereby providing early
warning of a developing frequency problem. The element can also be used as an alarm to warn operators of
unusually high system frequency variations.

3.1 INDEPENENT R.O.C.O.F PROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


The device provides four independent stages of protection. Each stage can respond to either rising or falling
frequency conditions. This depends on whether the frequency threshold is set above or below the system nominal
frequency. For example, if the frequency threshold is set above nominal frequency, the rate of change of frequency
setting is considered as positive and the element will operate for rising frequency conditions. If the frequency
threshold is set below nominal frequency, the setting is considered as negative and the element will operate for
falling frequency conditions.
The function uses the following settings (shown for stage 1 only - other stages follow the same principles).
● df/dt Avg.Cycles calculates the rate of change of frequency over a fixed period of several cycles.
● df/dt>1 Status: determines whether the stage is for falling or rising frequency conditions
● df/dt>1 Setting: defines the rate of change of frequency pickup setting
● df/dt>1 Time: sets the time delay

● df/dt>1 Dir'n: sets the direction of change you wish to check (positive, negative, or both)

In addition, start, trip and timer block DDB signals are available for each stage, as well as an inhibit signal to inhibit
all four stages.

3.2 INDEPENDENT R.O.C.O.F PROTECTION LOGIC


df /dt>1 Status
Enabled

Frequency 597
V df/dt df/dt >1 Start
determination
& 601
df /dt Avg . Cycles 1 df /dt>1 Trip
-1

df /dt>1 Setting × & df/dt >1 Time

df /dt>1 Dir’n 1
Positive
Both
1
Negative

1370
Freq Not Found
1368
Freq High 1
Freq Low 1369
V00869

Figure 224: Rate of change of frequency logic (single stage)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 405
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV

406 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 16

MONITORING AND CONTROL


Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

408 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
As well as providing a range of protection functions, the product includes comprehensive monitoring and control
functionality.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 409
Event Records 410
Disturbance Recorder 414
Measurements 415
CB Condition Monitoring 416
CB State Monitoring 427
Circuit Breaker Control 429
Pole Dead Function 435
System Checks 436

P446SV-TM-EN-1 409
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

2 EVENT RECORDS
General Electric devices record events in an event log. This allows you to establish the sequence of events that led
up to a particular situation. For example, a change in a digital input signal or protection element output signal
would cause an event record to be created and stored in the event log. This could be used to analyse how a
particular power system condition was caused. These events are stored in the IED's non-volatile memory. Each
event is time tagged.
The event records can be displayed on an IED's front panel but it is easier to view them through the settings
application software. This can extract the events log from the device and store it as a single .evt file for analysis on
a PC.
The event records are detailed in the VIEW RECORDS column. The first event (0) is always the latest event. After
selecting the required event, you can scroll through the menus to obtain further details.
If viewing the event with the settings application software, simply open the extracted event file. All the events are
displayed chronologically. Each event is summarised with a time stamp (obtained from the Time & Date cell) and a
short description relating to the event (obtained from the Event Text cell. You can expand the details of the event
by clicking on the + icon to the left of the time stamp.
The following table shows the correlation between the fields in the setting application software's event viewer and
the cells in the menu database.
Field in Event Viewer Equivalent cell in menu DB Cell reference User settable?
Left hand column header VIEW RECORDS ® Time & Date 01 03 No
Right hand column header VIEW RECORDS ® Event Text 01 04 No
Description SYSTEM DATA ® Description 00 04 Yes
Plant reference SYSTEM DATA ® Plant Reference 00 05 Yes
Model number SYSTEM DATA ® Model Number 00 06 No
Address Displays the Courier address relating to the event N/A No
Event type VIEW RECORDS ® Menu Cell Ref 01 02 No
Event Value VIEW RECORDS ® Event Value 01 05 No
Evt Unique Id VIEW RECORDS ® Evt Unique ID 01 FE No

The device is capable of storing up to 512 event records.


In addition to the event log, there are two logs which contain duplicates of the last 5 maintenance records and the
last 5 fault records. The purpose of this is to provide convenient access to the most recent fault and maintenance
events.

2.1 EVENT TYPES


There are several different types of event:
● Opto-input events (Change of state of opto-input)
● Contact events (Change of state of output relay contact)
● Alarm events
● Fault record events
● Standard events
● Security events

410 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

Standard events are further sub-categorised internally to include different pieces of information. These are:
● Protection events (starts and trips)
● Maintenance record events
● Platform events

Note:
The first event in the list (event 0) is the most recent event to have occurred.

2.1.1 OPTO-INPUT EVENTS


If one or more of the opto-inputs has changed state since the last time the protection algorithm ran (which runs at
several times per cycle), a new event is created, which logs the logic states of all opto-inputs. You can tell which
opto-input has changed state by comparing the new event with the previous one.
The description of this event type, as shown in the Event Text cell is always Logic Inputs # where # is the
batch number of the opto-inputs. This is '1', for the first batch of opto-inputs and '2' for the second batch of opto-
inputs (if applicable).
The event value shown in the Event Value cell for this type of event is a binary string. This shows the logical states
of the opto-inputs, where the Least Significant Bit (LSB), on the right corresponds to the first opto-input Input L1.
The same information is also shown in the Opto I/P Status cell in the SYSTEM DATA column. This information is
updated continuously, whereas the information in the event log is a snapshot at the time when the event was
created.

2.1.2 CONTACT EVENTS


If one or more of the output relays (also known as output contacts) has changed state since the last time the
protection algorithm ran (which runs at several times per cycle), a new event is created, which logs the logic states
of all output relays. You can tell which output relay has changed state by comparing the new event with the
previous one.
The description of this event type, as shown in the Event Text cell is always Output Contacts # where # is the
batch number of the output relay contacts. This is '1', for the first batch of output contacts and '2' for the second
batch of output contacts (if applicable).
The event value shown in the Event Value cell for this type of event is a binary string. This shows the logical states
of the output relays, where the LSB (on the right) corresponds to the first output contact Output R1.
The same information is also shown in the Relay O/P Status cell in the SYSTEM DATA column. This information is
updated continuously, whereas the information in the event log is a snapshot at the time when the event was
created.

2.1.3 ALARM EVENTS


The IED monitors itself on power up and continually thereafter. If it notices any problems, it will register an alarm
event.
The description of this event type, as shown in the Event Text cell is cell dependent on the type of alarm and will be
one of those shown in the following tables, followed by OFF or ON.
The event value shown in the Event Value cell for this type of event is a 32 bit binary string. There are one or more
banks 32 bit registers, depending on the device model. These contain all the alarm types and their logic states (ON
or OFF).
The same information is also shown in the Alarm Status (n) cells in the SYSTEM DATA column. This information is
updated continuously, whereas the information in the event log is a snapshot at the time when the event was
created.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 411
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

2.1.4 FAULT RECORD EVENTS


An event record is created for every fault the IED detects. This is also known as a fault record.
The event type description shown in the Event Text cell for this type of event is always Fault Recorded.
The IED contains a separate register containing the latest fault records. This provides a convenient way of viewing
the latest fault records and saves searching through the event log. You access these fault records using the Select
Fault setting, where fault number 0 is the latest fault.
A fault record is triggered by the Fault REC TRIG signal DDB, which is assigned in the PSL. The fault recorder
records the values of all parameters associated with the fault for the duration of the fault. These parameters are
stored in separate Courier cells, which become visible depending on the type of fault.
The fault recorder stops recording only when:
The Start signal is reset AND the undercurrent is ON OR the Trip signal is reset, as shown below:

Start signal resets


& Fault recorder stops recording
Undercurrent is ON
1
Trip signal resets

Fault recorder trigger

V01234

Figure 225: Fault recorder stop conditions

The event is logged as soon as the fault recorder stops. The time stamp assigned to the fault corresponds to the
start of the fault. The timestamp assigned to the fault record event corresponds to the time when the fault
recorder stops.

Note:
We recommend that you do not set the triggering contact to latching. This is because if you use a latching contact, the fault
record would not be generated until the contact has been fully reset.

2.1.5 MAINTENANCE EVENTS


Internal failures detected by the self-test procedures are logged as maintenance records. Maintenance records are
special types of standard events.
The event type description shown in the Event Text cell for this type of event is always Maint Recorded.
The Event Value cell also provides a unique binary code.
The IED contains a separate register containing the latest maintenance records. This provides a convenient way of
viewing the latest maintenance records and saves searching through the event log. You access these fault records
using the Select Maint setting.
The maintenance record has a number of extra menu cells relating to the maintenance event. These parameters
are Maint Text, Maint Type and Maint Data. They contain details about the maintenance event selected with the
Select Maint cell.

2.1.6 PROTECTION EVENTS


The IED logs protection starts and trips as individual events. Protection events are special types of standard events.
The event type description shown in the Event Text cell for this type of event is dependent on the protection event
that occurred. Each time a protection event occurs, a DDB signal changes state. It is the name of this DDB signal
followed by 'ON' or 'OFF' that appears in the Event Text cell.

412 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

The Event Value cell for this type of event is a 32 bit binary string representing the state of the relevant DDB
signals. These binary strings can also be viewed in the COMMISSION TESTS column in the relevant DDB batch cells.
Not all DDB signals can generate an event. Those that can are listed in the RECORD CONTROL column. In this
column, you can set which DDBs generate events.

2.1.7 SECURITY EVENTS


An event record is generated each time a setting that requires an access level is executed.
The event type description shown in the Event Text cell displays the type of change.

2.1.8 PLATFORM EVENTS


Platform events are special types of standard events.
The event type description shown in the Event Text cell displays the type of change.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 413
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

3 DISTURBANCE RECORDER
The disturbance recorder feature allows you to record selected current and voltage inputs to the protection
elements, together with selected digital signals. The digital signals may be inputs, outputs, or internal DDB signals.
The disturbance records can be extracted using the disturbance record viewer in the settings application software.
The disturbance record file can also be stored in the COMTRADE format. This allows the use of other packages to
view the recorded data.
The integral disturbance recorder has an area of memory specifically set aside for storing disturbance records. The
number of records that can be stored is dependent on the recording duration. The minimum duration is 0.1 s and
the maximum duration is 10.5 s.
When the available memory is exhausted, the oldest records are overwritten by the newest ones.
Each disturbance record consists of a number of analogue data channels and digital data channels. The relevant
CT and VT ratios for the analogue channels are also extracted to enable scaling to primary quantities.
The fault recording times are set by a combination of the Duration and Trigger Position cells. The Duration cell
sets the overall recording time and the Trigger Position cell sets the trigger point as a percentage of the duration.
For example, the default settings show that the overall recording time is set to 1.5 s with the trigger point being at
33.3% of this, giving 0.5 s pre-fault and 1 s post fault recording times.
With the Trigger Mode set to Single, if further triggers occurs whilst a recording is taking place, the recorder will
ignore the trigger. However, with the Trigger Mode set to Extended, the post trigger timer will be reset to zero,
extending the recording time.
You can select any of the IED's analogue inputs as analogue channels to be recorded. You can also map any of the
opto-inputs output contacts to the digital channels. In addition, you may also map a number of DDB signals such
as Starts and LEDs to digital channels.
You may choose any of the digital channels to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to
low transition, via the Input Trigger cell. The default settings are such that any dedicated trip output contacts will
trigger the recorder.
It is not possible to view the disturbance records locally via the front panel LCD. You must extract these using
suitable setting application software such as MiCOM S1 Agile.

414 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

4 MEASUREMENTS

4.1 MEASURED QUANTITIES


The device measures directly and calculates a number of system quantities, which are updated every second. You
can view these values in the relevant MEASUREMENT columns or with the Measurement Viewer in the settings
application software. Depending on the model, the device may measure and display some or more of the following
quantities:
● Measured and calculated analogue current and voltage values
● Power and energy quantities
● Peak, fixed and rolling demand values
● Frequency measurements
● Thermal measurements
● Teleprotection channel measurements

4.2 MEASUREMENT SETUP


You can define the way measurements are set up and displayed using the MEASURE'T SETUP column and the
measurements are shown in the relevant MEASUREMENTS tables.

4.3 FAULT LOCATOR


Some models provide fault location functionality. It is possible to identify the fault location by measuring the fault
voltage and current magnitude and phases and presenting this information to a Fault Locator function. The fault
locator is triggered whenever a fault record is generated, and the subsequent fault location data is included as
part of the fault record. This information is also displayed in the Fault Location cell in the VIEW RECORDS column.
This cell will display the fault location in metres, miles ohms or percentage, depending on the chosen units in the
Fault Location cell of the MEASURE'T SETUP column.
The Fault Locator uses pre-fault and post-fault analogue input signals to calculate the fault location. The result is
included it in the fault record. The pre-fault and post-fault voltages are also presented in the fault record.
When applied to parallel circuits, mutual flux coupling can alter the impedance seen by the fault locator. The
coupling contains positive, negative and zero sequence components. In practise the positive and negative
sequence coupling is insignificant. The effect on the fault locator of the zero sequence mutual coupling can be
eliminated using the mutual compensation feature provided.

4.4 OPTO-INPUT TIME STAMPING


Each opto-input sample is time stamped within a tolerance of +/- 1 ms with respect to the Real Time Clock. These
time stamps are used for the opto event logs and for the disturbance recording. The device needs to be
synchronised accurately to an external clock source such as an IRIG-B signal or a master clock signal provided in
the relevant data protocol.
For both the filtered and unfiltered opto-inputs, the time stamp of an opto-input change event is the sampling time
at which the change of state occurred. If multiple opto-inputs change state at the same sampling interval, these
state changes are reported as a single event.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 415
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

5 CB CONDITION MONITORING
The device records various statistics related to each circuit breaker trip operation, allowing an accurate
assessment of the circuit breaker condition to be determined. These statistics are available in the CB CONDITION
column. The menu cells are register values only and cannot be set directly. They may be reset, however, during
maintenance. The statistics monitored are:
● Total Current Broken: A register stores the total amount of current that the CB has broken is stored in an
accumulator, giving at any time a measure of the total amount of current that the CB has broken since the
value was last reset.
● Number of CB operations: A counter registers the number of CB trips that have been performed for each
phase, giving at any time the total number of trips that the CB has performed since the value was last reset.
● CB Operate Time: A register stores the total amount of time the CB has transitioned from closed to open is
stored in an accumulator, giving at any time a measure of the total time that the CB has spent tripping since
the values was last reset.

● Excessive Fault Frequency: A counter registers the number of CB trips that have been performed for all
phases, giving at any time the total number of trips performed since the value was last reset.

These statistics are available in the CB CONDITION column. The menu cells are register values only and cannot be
set directly. They may be reset, however, during maintenance.

Note:
When in Commissioning test mode the CB condition monitoring registers are not updated.

Circuit breaker lockout, can be caused by the following circuit breaker condition monitoring functions:
● Maintenance lockout
● Excessive fault frequency lockout
● Broken current lockout

If the circuit breaker is locked out, the logic generates a lockout alarm

416 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

5.1 BROKEN CURRENT ACCUMULATOR


CB1PhaseACurrent
Set Set CB1 Cumulative IA broken In
Reset

CB1PhaseBCurrent
Set Set CB1 Cumulative IB broken In
Reset

CB1PhaseCCurrent
Set Set CB 1 Cumulative IC broken In
526
CB1 Trip 3ph t Reset
534
1
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 0
523 Note: Broken current totals not incremented when device is in test mode
CB1 Trip OutputA t 1
535 1
CB1 Ext Trip A 0
524
CB1 Trip OutputB t 1
536 1
CB1 Ext Trip B 0
525
CB1 Trip OutputC t 1
537
1
CB1 Ext Trip C 0

Reset CB Data
447
1
Reset CB Data

CB2PhaseACurrent
Set Set CB2 Cumulative IA broken In
Reset

CB2PhaseBCurrent
Set Set CB2 Cumulative IB broken In
Reset

CB2PhaseCCurrent
Set Set CB 2 Cumulative IC broken In
1600
CB2 Trip 3ph t Reset
538
1
CB2 Ext Trip3 ph 0

CB2 Trip OutputA 1601


t 1 Note: Broken current totals not incremented when device is in test mode
539
1
CB2 Ext Trip A 0
1602
CB2 Trip OutputB t 1
540
1
CB2 Ext Trip B 0
1603
CB2 Trip OutputC t 1
541 1
CB2 Ext Trip C 0
Reset CB Data Note: All timers have 1 cycle pickup delay
447 1
Reset CB Data
V01273

Figure 226: Broken Current Accumulator logic diagram

P446SV-TM-EN-1 417
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

5.2 CB TRIP COUNTER


526
Déc 3ph DJ1
534
1
Déc. ext 3ph DJ1

523
Sortie Déc A DJ1 1 Incrément
535 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext A DJ1
déclenchement Phase A
Réinit

524
Sortie Déc B DJ1 1 Incrément
536 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext B DJ1
déclenchement Phase B
Réinit

525
Sortie Déc C DJ1 1 Incrément
537 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext C DJ1
déclenchement Phase C
Réinit
RAZ Infos DJ1
447
1
RAZ Infos DJ1

1600
Déc 3ph DJ2
538
1
Déc. ext 3ph DJ2

1601
Sortie Déc A DJ2 1 Incrément
539 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern A
déclenchement Phase A
Réinit

1602
Sortie Déc B DJ2 1 Incrément
540 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern B
déclenchement Phase B
Réinit

1603
Sortie Déc C DJ2 1 Incrément
541 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern C
déclenchement Phase C
Réinit
RAZ Infos DJ2
1597
1
RAZ Données DJ2

V01277

Figure 227: CB Trip Counter logic diagram

418 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

5.3 CB OPERATING TIME ACCUMULATOR


526
CB1 Trip 3ph
534
1 Note: CB operating time not accumulated when device is in test mode
CB1 Ext Trip3ph

523
CB1 Trip OutputA 1 Start

CB1 Ext Trip A 535 CB1 operating time phase A Increment


Stop CB1OpTimePhA Counter
IA < fixed threshold Reset
1
Pole Dead A 892

524
CB1 Trip OutputB 1 Start

CB1 Ext Trip B 536 CB1 operating time phase B Increment


Stop CB1OpTimePhB Counter
IB < fixed threshold Reset
1
893
Pole Dead B
525
CB1 Trip OutputC 1 Start

CB1 Ext Trip C 537 CB1 operating time phase C Increment


Stop CB1 OpTimePhC Counter
IC < fixed threshold Reset
1
894
Pole Dead C

Reset CB1 Data


447
1
Rst CB1 Data

1600
CB2 Trip 3ph
538 1
CB2 Ext Trip3ph

1601
CB2 Trip OutputA 1 Start

CB2 Ext Trip A 539 CB2 operating time phase A Increment


Stop CB2OpTimePhA Counter
IA < fixed threshold Reset
1
892
Pole Dead A

1602
CB2 Trip OutputB 1 Start

CB2 Ext Trip B 540 CB2 operating time phase B Increment


Stop CB2OpTimePhB Counter
IB < fixed threshold Reset
1
Pole Dead B 893

1603
CB2 Trip OutputC 1 Start

CB2 Ext Trip C 541 CB2 operating time phase C Increment


Stop CB2 OpTimePhC Counter
IC < fixed threshold Reset
1
894
Pole Dead C

Reset CB2 Data


1597 1
Rst CB2 Data
V01275

Figure 228: Operating Time Accumulator

P446SV-TM-EN-1 419
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

5.4 EXCESSIVE FAULT FREQUENCY COUNTER


CB1 Trip 3ph
1
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 1 Increment
CB1 Trip OutputA CB1 Excessive Fault Frequency Counter
1 Reset
CB1 Ext Trip A

CB1 Trip OutputB


1 S t
CB1 Ext Trip B Q
R 0 1
CB1 Trip OutputC
1
CB1 Ext Trip C

CB1 LO Alarm

CB1FltFreqTime

CB2 Trip 3ph


1
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 1 Increment
CB2 Trip OutputA CB2 Excessive Fault Frequency Counter
1 Reset
CB2 Ext Trip A

CB2 Trip OutputB


1 S t
CB2 Ext Trip B Q
R 0 1
CB2 Trip OutputC
1
CB2 Ext Trip C

CB2 LO Alarm

CB2FltFreqTime

V01279

Figure 229: Excessive Fault Frequency logic diagram

420 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

5.5 RESET LOCKOUT ALARM


CB mon LO reset
Yes
1 Reset CB1 Lockout Alarm
Clear Alarms

CB1 Failed to Trip S


Q
R t
CB1 Open 3 ph &
0
CB1 LO Alarm

CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
CB1 Closed A ph

CB1 Closed B ph &

CB1 Closed C ph

Rst CB mon LO by
CB Close

CB mon LO RstDly

CB mon LO reset
Yes
1 Reset CB2 Lockout Alarm
Clear Alarms

CB2 Failed to Trip S


Q t
R
CB2 Open 3 ph &
0
CB2 LO Alarm

CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
CB2 Closed A ph

CB2 Closed B ph &

CB2 Closed C ph

Rst CB mon LO by
CB Close

CB mon LO RstDly

V01281

Figure 230: Reset Lockout Alarm logic diagram

P446SV-TM-EN-1 421
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

5.6 CB CONDITION MONITORING LOGIC


CB1 I^ Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest broken current total & CB1 I^ Maint

CB1 I^ Maint S
Q 1 CB1 Monitor Alm
R
CB1 I^ Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB1 I^ Lockout

CB1 I^ Lockout

No.CB1 Ops Maint


Alarm Enabled
&
Max no. of CB operations & No.CB1 Ops Maint
S
No.CB1 Ops Maint Q
R
No.CB1 Ops Lock
Alarm Enabled
& No.CB1 Ops Lock

No.CB1 Ops Lock

&
1 CB1 Pre-Lockout
-1
CB1FltFreqLock
Alarm Enabled
& S
Fault frequency count Q CB1 FaultFreqLock
R
CB1FltFreqCount

&
-1 1 CB1 Mon LO Alarm
CB1 Time Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest CB operate time & CB1 Time Maint
S
CB1 Time Maint Q
R
CB1 Time Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB1 Time Lockout

CB1 Time Lockout

Clear Alarms 1

Reset CB1 Data


Yes 1

Rst CB1 Data


S
Q CB1 LO Alarm
Reset CB1 Lockout Alarm R

Control CB1 Unhealthy


CB1 Control no Check Synch

CB1 failed to trip

CB1 failed to close V01283

Figure 231: CB1 Condition Monitoring logic diagram

422 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

CB2 I^ Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest broken current total & CB2 I^ Maint

CB2 I^ Maint S
Q 1 CB2 Monitor Alm
R
CB2 I^ Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB2 I^ Lockout

CB2 I^ Lockout

No.CB2 Ops Maint


Alarm Enabled
&
Max no . of CB operations & No.CB2 Ops Maint
S
No.CB2 Ops Maint Q
R
No.CB2 Ops Lock
Alarm Enabled
& No.CB2 Ops Lock

No.CB2 Ops Lock

&
1 CB2 Pre-Lockout
-1
CB2FltFreqLock
Alarm Enabled
& S
Fault frequency count
Q CB2 FaultFreqLock
R
CB2FltFreqCount

&
-1 1 CB2 Mon LO Alarm
CB2 Time Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest CB operate time & CB2 Time Maint
S
CB2 Time Maint Q
R
CB2 Time Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB2 Time Lockout

CB2 Time Lockout

Clear Alarms 1

Reset CB2 Data


Yes 1

Rst CB2 Data


S
Q CB2 LO Alarm
Reset CB2 Lockout Alarm R

Control CB2 Unhealthy


CB2 Control no Check Synch

CB2 failed to trip

CB2 failed to close V01284

Figure 232: CB2 Condition Monitoring logic diagram

5.7 RESET CIRCUIT BREAKER LOCKOUT


Lockout conditions caused by the circuit breaker condition monitoring functions can be reset according to the
condition of the Rst CB mon LO by setting found in the CB CONTROL column. There are two options; CB Close
and User interface.
If set to CB Close, a timer setting, CB mon LO RstDly, becomes visible. When the circuit breaker closes, the CB
mon LO RstDly time starts. The lockout is reset when the timer expires.
If set to User Interface then a command, CB mon LO reset, becomes visible. This command can be used to
reset the lockout from a user interface.
An Autoreclose lockout generates an Autoreclose lockout alarm. Autoreclose lockout conditions can be reset by
various commands and setting options found under the CB CONTROL column.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 423
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

If Res LO by CB IS is set to Enabled, a lockout is reset if the circuit breaker is successfully closed manually. For
this, the circuit breaker must remain closed long enough so that it enters the “In Service” state.
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset from a user interface using the reset
circuit breaker lockout command in the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by NoAR is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by temporarily generating an AR
disabled signal.
If Res LO by TDelay is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout is automatically reset after a time delay set in
the LO Reset Time setting.
If Res LO by ExtDDB is Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by activation of an external input
mapped in the PSL to the relevant reset lockout DDB signal.

424 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

5.7.1 RESET CB LOCKOUT LOGIC DIAGRAM

Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB1CRLo

Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB1 LO
Yes

Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB1Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only

Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
446
Rst CB1 Lockout

Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time

306
t
CB1 AR Lockout
0
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB2CRLo

Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB2 LO
Yes

Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB2Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only

Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
1422
Rst CB2 Lockout

Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time

328
t
CB2 AR Lockout
0
V03383

Figure 233: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58)

5.8 APPLICATION NOTES

5.8.1 SETTING THE THRESHOLDS FOR THE TOTAL BROKEN CURRENT


Where power lines use oil circuit breakers (OCBs), changing of the oil accounts for a significant proportion of the
switchgear maintenance costs. Often, oil changes are performed after a fixed number of CB fault operations.
However, this may result in premature maintenance where fault currents tend to be low, because oil degradation
may be slower than would normally be expected. The Total Current Accumulator (I^ counter) cumulatively stores
the total value of the current broken by the circuit breaker providing a more accurate assessment of the circuit
breaker condition.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 425
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

The dielectric withstand of the oil generally decreases as a function of I2t, where ‘I’ is the broken fault current and
‘t’ is the arcing time within the interrupter tank. The arcing time cannot be determined accurately, but is generally
dependent on the type of circuit breaker being used. Instead, you set a factor (Broken I^) with a value between 1
and 2, depending on the circuit breaker.
Most circuit breakers would have this value set to '2', but for some types of circuit breaker, especially those
operating on higher voltage systems, a value of 2 may be too high. In such applications Broken I^ may be set
lower, typically 1.4 or 1.5.
The setting range for Broken I^ is variable between 1.0 and 2.0 in 0.1 steps.

Note:
Any maintenance program must be fully compliant with the switchgear manufacturer’s instructions.

5.8.2 SETTING THE THRESHOLDS FOR THE NUMBER OF OPERATIONS


Every circuit breaker operation results in some degree of wear for its components. Therefore routine maintenance,
such as oiling of mechanisms, may be based on the number of operations. Suitable setting of the maintenance
threshold will allow an alarm to be raised, indicating when preventative maintenance is due. Should maintenance
not be carried out, the device can be set to lockout the autoreclose function on reaching a second operations
threshold (No. CB ops Lock). This prevents further reclosure when the circuit breaker has not been maintained to
the standard demanded by the switchgear manufacturer’s maintenance instructions.
Some circuit breakers, such as oil circuit breakers (OCBs) can only perform a certain number of fault interruptions
before requiring maintenance attention. This is because each fault interruption causes carbonising of the oil,
degrading its dielectric properties. The maintenance alarm threshold (setting No. CB Ops Maint) may be set to
indicate the requirement for oil dielectric testing, or for more comprehensive maintenance. Again, the lockout
threshold No. CB Ops Lock may be set to disable autoreclosure when repeated further fault interruptions could
not be guaranteed. This minimises the risk of oil fires or explosion.

5.8.3 SETTING THE THRESHOLDS FOR THE OPERATING TIME


Slow CB operation indicates the need for mechanism maintenance. Alarm and lockout thresholds (CB Time Maint
and CB Time Lockout) are provided to enforce this. They can be set in the range of 5 to 500 ms. This time relates to
the interrupting time of the circuit breaker.

5.8.4 SETTING THE THRESHOLDS FOR EXCESSSIVE FAULT FREQUENCY


Persistent faults will generally cause autoreclose lockout, with subsequent maintenance attention. Intermittent
faults such as clashing vegetation may repeat outside of any reclaim time, and the common cause might never be
investigated. For this reason it is possible to set a frequent operations counter, which allows the number of
operations Fault Freq Count over a set time period Fault Freq Time to be monitored. A separate alarm and lockout
threshold can be set.

426 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

6 CB STATE MONITORING
CB State monitoring is used to verify the open or closed state of a circuit breaker. Most circuit breakers have
auxiliary contacts through which they transmit their status (open or closed) to control equipment such as IEDs.
These auxiliary contacts are known as:
● 52A for contacts that follow the state of the CB
● 52B for contacts that are in opposition to the state of the CB

This device can be set to monitor both of these types of circuit breaker state indication. If the state is unknown for
some reason, an alarm can be raised.
Some CBs provide both sets of contacts. If this is the case, these contacts will normally be in opposite states.
Should both sets of contacts be open, this would indicate one of the following conditions:
● Auxiliary contacts/wiring defective
● Circuit Breaker (CB) is defective
● CB is in isolated position

Should both sets of contacts be closed, only one of the following two conditions would apply:
● Auxiliary contacts/wiring defective
● Circuit Breaker (CB) is defective

If any of the above conditions exist, an alarm will be issued after a 5 s time delay. An output contact can be
assigned to this function via the programmable scheme logic (PSL). The time delay is set to avoid unwanted
operation during normal switching duties.
In the CB CONTROL column there is a setting called CB Status Input. This cell can be set at one of the following
four options:
● None
● 52A
● 52B
● Both 52A and 52B

Where None is selected no CB status is available. Where only 52A is used on its own then the device will assume a
52B signal opposite to the 52A signal. Circuit breaker status information will be available in this case but no
discrepancy alarm will be available. The above is also true where only a 52B is used. If both 52A and 52B are used
then status information will be available and in addition a discrepancy alarm will be possible, according to the
following table:
Auxiliary Contact Position CB State Detected Action
52A 52B
Open Closed Breaker open Circuit breaker healthy
Closed Open Breaker closed Circuit breaker healthy
Alarm raised if the condition persists for greater than
Closed Closed CB failure
5s
Alarm raised if the condition persists for greater than
Open Open State unknown
5s

P446SV-TM-EN-1 427
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

6.1 CB STATE MONITOR


420
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-A)
&

424
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-B)
& 1 907
1 CB1 Closed 3 ph
XOR

&

CB1 Status Input


&
52A 3 pole
52B 3 pole
52A & 52B 3 pole & 1 903
1 CB1 Open 3 ph

&

&

421
CB1 Aux A(52-A)
&

425 908
CB1 Aux A(52-B) 1 CB1 Closed A ph
& 1
XOR
&
&

CB1 Status Input


&
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
904
1 CB1 Open A ph
52A & 52B 1 pole & 1

&
&

&

422 909
CB1 Aux B(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed B ph

CB1 Aux B(52-B) 426

905
Phase B 1 CB1 Open B ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole

423 910
CB1 Aux C(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed C ph

CB1 Aux C(52-B) 427

906
Phase C 1 CB1 Open C ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole 301
1 CB1 Status Alm
52A & 52B 1 pole

V01265 CB1 Status Time

Figure 234: CB State logic diagram (Module 1)

428 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

7 CIRCUIT BREAKER CONTROL


Although some circuit breakers do not provide auxiliary contacts, most provide auxiliary contacts to reflect the
state of the circuit breaker. These are:
● CBs with 52A contacts (where the auxiliary contact follows the state of the CB)
● CBs with 52B contacts (where the auxiliary contact is in the opposite state from the state of the CB)
● CBs with both 52A and 52B contacts

Circuit Breaker control is only possible if the circuit breaker in question provides auxiliary contacts. The CB Status
Input cell in the CB CONTROL column must be set to the type of circuit breaker. If no CB auxiliary contacts are
available then this cell should be set to None, and no CB control will be possible.
For local control, the CB control by cell should be set accordingly.
The output contact can be set to operate following a time delay defined by the setting Man Close Delay. One
reason for this delay is to give personnel time to safely move away from the circuit breaker following a CB close
command.
The control close cycle can be cancelled at any time before the output contact operates by any appropriate trip
signal, or by activating the Reset Close Dly DDB signal.
The length of the trip and close control pulses can be set via the Trip Pulse Time and Close Pulse Time settings
respectively. These should be set long enough to ensure the breaker has completed its open or close cycle before
the pulse has elapsed.
If an attempt to close the breaker is being made, and a protection trip signal is generated, the protection trip
command overrides the close command.
The Reset Lockout by setting is used to enable or disable the resetting of lockout automatically from a manual
close after the time set by Man Close RstDly.
If the CB fails to respond to the control command (indicated by no change in the state of CB Status inputs) an
alarm is generated after the relevant trip or close pulses have expired. These alarms can be viewed on the LCD
display, remotely, or can be assigned to output contacts using the programmable scheme logic (PSL).

Note:
The CB Healthy Time and Sys Check time set under this menu section are applicable to manual circuit breaker operations
only. These settings are duplicated in the AUTORECLOSE menu for autoreclose applications.

The Lockout Reset and Reset Lockout by settings are applicable to CB Lockouts associated with manual circuit
breaker closure, CB Condition monitoring (Number of circuit breaker operations, for example) and autoreclose
lockouts.
The device includes the following options for control of a single circuit breaker:
● The IED menu (local control)
● The Hotkeys (local control)
● The function keys (local control)
● The opto-inputs (local control)
● SCADA communication (remote control)

7.1 CB CONTROL USING THE IED MENU


You can control manual trips and closes with the CB Trip/Close command in the SYSTEM DATA column. This can be
set to No Operation, Trip, or Close accordingly.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 429
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

For this to work you have to set the CB control by cell to option 1 Local, option 3 Local + Remote, option 5
Opto+Local, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB CONTROL column.

7.2 CB CONTROL USING THE HOTKEYS


The hotkeys allow you to manually trip and close the CB without the need to enter the SYSTEM DATA column. For
this to work you have to set the CB control by cell to option 1 Local, option 3 Local+Remote, option 5 Opto
+Local, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB CONTROL column.
CB control using the hotkey is achieved by pressing the right-hand button directly below LCD screen. This button is
only enabled if:
● The CB Control by setting is set to one of the options where local control is possible (option 1,3,5, or 7)
● The CB Status Input is set to '52A', '52B', or 'Both 52A and 52B'

If the CB is currently closed, the command text on the bottom right of the LCD screen will read Trip. Conversely, if
the CB is currently open, the command text will read Close.
If you execute a Trip, a screen with the CB status will be displayed once the command has been completed. If
you execute a Close, a screen with a timing bar will appear while the command is being executed. This screen
also gives you the option to cancel or restart the close procedure. The time delay is determined by the Man Close
Delay setting in the CB CONTROL menu. When the command has been executed, a screen confirming the present
status of the circuit breaker is displayed. You are then prompted to select the next appropriate command or exit.
If no keys are pressed for a period of 5 seconds while waiting for the command confirmation, the device will revert
to showing the CB Status. If no key presses are made for a period of 25 seconds while displaying the CB status
screen, the device will revert to the default screen.
To avoid accidental operation of the trip and close functionality, the hotkey CB control commands are disabled for
10 seconds after exiting the hotkey menu.
The hotkey functionality is summarised graphically below:

Default Display

HOTKEY CB CTRL

Hotkey Menu

CB closed CB open

<CB STATUS> EXECUTE <CB STATUS> EXECUTE EXECUTE CLOSE


CLOSED CB TRIP OPEN CB CLOSE 30 secs

TRIP EXIT CONFIRM CANCEL EXIT CLOSE CANCEL CONFIRM CANCEL RESTART

E01209

Figure 235: Hotkey menu navigation

7.3 CB CONTROL USING THE FUNCTION KEYS


For most models, you can also use the function keys to allow direct control of the circuit breaker. This has the
advantage over hotkeys, that the LEDs associated with the function keys can indicate the status of the CB. The

430 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

default PSL is set up such that Function key 2 initiates a trip and Function key 3 initiates a close. For this to work
you have to set the CB control by cell to option 5 Opto+Local, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB
CONTROL column.
As shown below, function keys 2 and 3 have already been assigned to CB control in the default PSL.

Function Key 2 Init Trip CB

Non- FnKey LED2 Red


Latching FnKey LED2 Grn

Function Key 3 Init Close CB

1 Non- FnKey LED3 Red


Close in Prog
Latching FnKey LED3 Grn
V01245

Figure 236: Default function key PSL

The programmable function key LEDs have been mapped such that they will indicate yellow whilst the keys are
activated.

Note:
Not all models provide function keys.

7.4 CB CONTROL USING THE OPTO-INPUTS


Certain applications may require the use of push buttons or other external signals to control the various CB control
operations. It is possible to connect such push buttons and signals to opto-inputs and map these to the relevant
DDB signals.
For this to work, you have to set the CB control by cell to option 4 opto, option 5 Opto+Local, option 6 Opto
+Remote, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB CONTROL column.

7.5 REMOTE CB CONTROL


Remote CB control can be achieved by setting the CB Trip/Close cell in the SYSTEM DATA column to trip or close by
using a command over a communication link.
For this to work, you have to set the CB control by cell to option 2 Remote, option 3 Local+Remote, option 6
Opto+remote, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB CONTROL column.
We recommend that you allocate separate relay output contacts for remote CB control and protection tripping.
This allows you to select the control outputs using a simple local/remote selector switch as shown below. Where
this feature is not required the same output contact(s) can be used for both protection and remote tripping.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 431
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

Protection Trip

Trip
Remote
Control
Trip Close
Remote
Control
Close

Local

Remote

Trip Close

E01207

Figure 237: Remote Control of Circuit Breaker

7.6 CB HEALTHY CHECK


A CB Healthy check is available if required. This facility accepts an input to one of the opto-inputs to indicate that
the breaker is capable of closing (e.g. that it is fully charged). A time delay can be set with the setting CB Healthy
Time. If the CB does not indicate a healthy condition within the time period following a Close command, the device
will lockout and alarm.

7.7 SYNCHRONISATION CHECK


Where the check synchronism function is set, this can be enabled to supervise manual circuit breaker Close
commands. A circuit breaker Close command will only be issued if the Check Synchronisation criteria are satisfied.
A time delay can be set with the setting Sys Check time. If the Check Synchronisation criteria are not satisfied
within the time period following a Close command the device will lockout and alarm.

7.8 CB CONTROL AR IMPLICATIONS


An Auto Close CB signal from the Auto-close logic bypasses the Man Close Delay time, and the CB Close output
operates immediately to close the circuit breaker.
If Autoreclose is used it may be desirable to block its operation when performing a manual close. In general, the
majority of faults following a manual closure are permanent faults and it is undesirable to allow automatic
reclosure.
To ensure that Autoreclose is not initiated for a manual circuit breaker closure on to a pre-existing fault, the CB IS
Time (circuit breaker in service time) setting in the AUTORECLOSE menu should be set for the desired time window.
This setting ensures that Autoreclose initiation is inhibited for a period equal to setting CB IS Time following a
manual circuit breaker closure. If a protection operation occurs during the inhibit period, Autoreclose is not
initiated.

432 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

Following manual circuit breaker closure, if either a single phase or a three phase fault occur, the circuit breaker is
tripped three phase, but Autoreclose is not locked out for this condition.

7.9 CB CONTROL LOGIC DIAGRAM


CB Control by
Opto
Note : If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy or CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it
Opto +Local defaults to High .
1
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
838
HMI Trip Control TripCB1
1
& S t
439
& Q 302
Init Trip CB1 RD 0 & CB1 Trip Fail

440 &
Init close CB1 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 842
CB1 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB1 ARIP 1544 Q 839
RD 0 & Control CloseCB1

854
1 S t
Auto Close CB1 Q
RD 0
443
Rst CB1 CloseDly
522 303
Any Trip & CB1 Close Fail
1
838
Control TripCB1

534
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
535
CB1 Ext Trip A

536
CB1 Ext Trip B

537
CB1 Ext Trip C
1 1
903
CB1 Open 3 ph

904
CB1 Open A ph
905
CB1 Open B ph &
906
CB1 Open C ph
907
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
908
CB1 Closed A ph

CB1 Closed B ph 909


1 CB Healthy Time

910
CB1 Closed C ph
t 304
436
& ManCB1 Unhealthy
CB1 Healthy 0

Check Sync Time

t 305
1574
& NoCS CB1ManClose
CB1 Man SCOK 0

V03370

Figure 238: CB1 Control Logic (Module 43)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 433
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

CB Control by
Opto
Opto +Local Note: If the DDB signal CB 1 Healthy, or CB2 healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
1 High.
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
840
HMI Trip Control TripCB2
1
& S t
441
& Q 324
Init Trip CB2 RD 0 & CB2 Trip Fail

442 &
Init close CB2 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 1453
CB2 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB2 ARIP 1435 Q 841
RD 0 & Control CloseCB2

1448
1 S t
Auto Close CB2 Q
RD 0
1419
Rst CB2 CloseDly

522 325
Any Trip & CB2 Close Fail
1
840
Control TripCB2

538
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
539
CB2 Ext Trip A

540
CB2 Ext Trip B

541
CB2 Ext Trip C
1 1
911
CB2 Open 3 ph

912
CB2 Open A ph
913
CB2 Open B ph &
914
CB2 Open C ph

915
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
916
CB2 Closed A ph

CB2 Closed B ph 917


1 CB Healthy Time

918
CB2 Closed C ph
t 326
437
& ManCB2 Unhealthy
CB2 Healthy 0

Check Sync Time

t 327
1458
& NoCS CB2ManClose
CB2 Man SCOK 0

V03344

Figure 239: CB2 Control Logic (Module 44)

434 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

8 POLE DEAD FUNCTION


The Pole Dead Logic is used to determine and indicate that one or more phases of the line are not energised. A
Pole Dead condition is determined either by measuring:
● the line currents and/or voltages, or
● by monitoring the status of the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts, as shown by dedicated DDB signals.

It can also be used to block operation of underfrequency and undervoltage elements where applicable.

8.1 POLE DEAD LOGIC


IA 20 ms

I< Current Set &


1 Pole Dead A
VA

V<

CB1 Open A ph
&
CB2 Open A ph

IB 20 ms

I< Current Set &


1 Pole Dead B
VB

V<

CB1 Open B ph
&
CB2 Open B ph

IC 20 ms

I< Current Set &


1 Pole Dead C
VC

1 Any Pole Dead


V<

VTS Slow Block


& All Poles Dead
CB1 Open C ph
&
CB2 Open C ph

CB1 Open 3 ph
&
CB2 Open 3 ph

V01269

Figure 240: Pole Dead logic

If both the line current and voltage values fall below a certain threshold, or a CB Open condition is asserted from
the state control logic, the device initiates a Pole Dead condition. The current and voltage thresholds can be set
with the I< Current Set and the V< settings respectively, in the CBFAIL&P.DEAD column.
If one or more poles are dead, the device indicates which phase is dead and asserts the Any Pole Dead DDB
signal. If all phases are dead the Any Pole Dead signal is accompanied by the All Poles Dead signal.
If the VT fails, a VTS Slow Block signal is taken from the VTS logic to block the Pole Dead indications that would be
generated by the undervoltage and undercurrent thresholds.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 435
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

9 SYSTEM CHECKS
In some situations it is possible for both "bus" and "line" sides of a circuit breaker to be live when a circuit breaker is
open - for example at the ends of a feeder that has a power source at each end. Therefore, it is normally necessary
to check that the network conditions on both sides are suitable, before closing the circuit breaker. This applies to
both manual circuit breaker closing and autoreclosing. If a circuit breaker is closed when the line and bus voltages
are both live, with a large phase angle, frequency or magnitude difference between them, the system could be
subjected to an unacceptable shock, resulting in loss of stability, and possible damage to connected machines.
The System Checks functionality involves monitoring the voltages on both sides of a circuit breaker, and if both
sides are live, performing a synchronisation check to determine whether any differences in voltage magnitude,
phase angle or frequency are within permitted limits.
The pre-closing system conditions for a given circuit breaker depend on the system configuration, and for
autoreclosing, on the selected autoreclose program. For example, on a feeder with delayed autoreclosing, the
circuit breakers at the two line ends are normally arranged to close at different times. The first line end to close
usually has a live bus and a dead line immediately before reclosing. The second line end circuit breaker now sees a
live bus and a live line.
If there is a parallel connection between the ends of the tripped feeder the frequencies will be the same, but any
increased impedance could cause the phase angle between the two voltages to increase. Therefore just before
closing the second circuit breaker, it may be necessary to perform a synchronisation check, to ensure that the
phase angle between the two voltages has not increased to a level that would cause unacceptable shock to the
system when the circuit breaker closes.
If there are no parallel interconnections between the ends of the tripped feeder, the two systems could lose
synchronism altogether and the frequency at one end could "slip" relative to the other end. In this situation, the
second line end would require a synchronism check comprising both phase angle and slip frequency checks.
If the second line-end busbar has no power source other than the feeder that has tripped; the circuit breaker will
see a live line and dead bus assuming the first circuit breaker has re-closed. When the second line end circuit
breaker closes the bus will charge from the live line (dead bus charge).

9.1 SYSTEM CHECKS IMPLEMENTATION


The System Checks function provides Live/Dead Voltage Monitoring, two stages of Check Synchronisation and
System Split indication.
The System Checks function is enabled or disabled by the System Checks setting in the CONFIGURATION column. If
System Checks is disabled, the SYSTEM CHECKS menu becomes invisible, and a SysChks Inactive DDB signal is
set.
The system Checks functionality can also be enabled or disabled individually for each circuit breaker by the
System Checks CB1 and System Checks CB2 settings in the SYSTEM CHECKS column. For the Systems Checks
functionality to be enabled, both the System Checks setting in the CONFIGURATION column AND the relevant
setting (System Checks CB1 and/or System Checks CB2) in the SYSTEM CHECKS column must be enabled. For the
System Checks functionality to be disabled, either the System Checks setting in the CONFIGURATION column OR
the relevant setting (System Checks CB1 and/or System Checks CB2) in the SYSTEM CHECKS column must be be
enabled. In the latter case, the SysChks Inactive DDB signal is set.

9.1.1 VT CONNECTIONS
The device provides inputs for a three-phase "Main VT" and at least one single-phase VT for check synchronisation.
Depending on the primary system arrangement, the Main VT may be located on either the line-side of the busbar-
side of the circuit breaker, with the Check Sync VT on the other. Normally, the Main VT is located on the line-side (as
per the default setting), but this is not always the case. For this reason, a setting is provided where you can define
this. This is the Main VT Location setting, which is found in the CT AND VT RATIOS column.

436 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

The Check Sync VT may be connected to one of the phase-to-phase voltages or phase-to-neutral voltages. This
needs to be defined using the CS Input setting in the CT AND VT RATIOS column. Options are, A-B, B-C, C-A, A-N, B-
N, or C-N.

9.1.2 VOLTAGE MONITORING


The settings in the VOLTAGE MONITORS sub-heading in the SYSTEM CHECKS column allow you to define the
threshold at which a voltage is considered live, and a threshold at which the voltage is considered dead. These
thresholds apply to both line and bus sides. If the measured voltage falls below the Dead Voltage setting, a DDB
signal is generated (Dead Bus, or Dead Line, depending on which side is being measured). If the measured voltage
exceeds the Live Voltage setting, a DDB signal is generated (Live Bus, or Live Line, depending on which side is
being measured).

9.1.3 CHECK SYNCHRONISATION


The device provides two stages of Check Synchronisation. The first stage (CS1) is intended for use in synchronous
systems. This means, where the frequencies and phase angles of both sides are compared and if the difference is
within set limits, the circuit breaker is allowed to close. The second stage (CS2) is similar to stage, but has an
additional adaptive setting. The second stage CS2 is intended for use in asynchronous systems, i.e. where the two
sides are out of synchronism and one frequency is slipping continuously with respect to another. If the closing time
of the circuit breaker is known, the CB Close command can be issued at a definite point in the cycle such that the
CB closes at the point when both sides are in phase.
In situations where it is possible for the voltages on either side of a circuit breaker to be either synchronous or
asynchronous, both CS1 and CS2 can be enabled to provide a CB Close signal if either set of permitted closing
conditions is satisfied.
Each stage can also be set to inhibit circuit breaker closing if selected blocking conditions such as overvoltage,
undervoltage or excessive voltage magnitude difference are detected. CS2 requires the phase angle difference to
be decreasing in magnitude before permitting the circuit breaker to close. CS2 has an optional “Adaptive” closing
feature, which issues the permissive close signal when the predicted phase angle difference immediately prior to
the instant of circuit breaker main contacts closing (i.e. after CB Close time) is as close as practicable to zero.
Slip frequency is the rate of change of phase between each side of the circuit breaker, which is measured by the
difference between the voltage signals on either side of the circuit breaker.
Having two system synchronism check stages available allows the circuit breaker closing to be enabled under
different system conditions (for example, low slip / moderate phase angle, or moderate slip / small phase angle).
The settings specific to Check Synchronisation are found under the sub-heading CHECK SYNC in the SYSTEM
CHECKS column. The only difference between the CS1 settings and the CS2 settings is that CS2 has settings for
predictive closure of each CB (CB1 CS2 Adaptive and CB2 CS2 Adaptive).

9.1.4 CHECK SYNCRONISATION VECTOR DIAGRAM


The following vector diagram represents the conditions for the System Check functionality. The Dead Volts setting
is represented as a circle around the origin whose radius is equal to the maximum voltage magnitude, whereby
the voltage can be considered dead. The nominal line voltage magnitude is represented by a circle around the
origin whose radius is equal to the nominal line voltage magnitude. The minimum voltage magnitude at which the
system can be considered as Live, is the magnitude difference between the bus and line voltages.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 437
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV


Check Sync
Stage 2 Limits
Check Sync
Stage 1 Limits
V
BUS

Live Volts

Rotating
Vector
Nomical
Volts

V LINE

Dead Volts

±180º
System Split
E01204 Limits

Figure 241: Check Synchronisation vector diagram

438 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

9.2 VOLTAGE MONITOR FOR CB CLOSURE


System Checks
Enabled

VAN 888
Live Line & Live Line
VBN

VCN 889
Select Dead Line & Dead line
VAB

VBC 886
Live Bus 1 & Live Bus 1
VCA

VBus1 Dead Bus 1 & 887


Dead Bus 1

VBus 2
1461
Live Bus 2 & Live Bus 2
MCB/VTS 438

1521 1462
MCB/VTS CB1 CS Dead Bus 2 & Dead Bus 2

1423
MCB/VTS CB2 CS
Voltage Monitors

1522 1
Inhibit LL

1523 1
Inhibit DL

1524 1
Inhibit LB 1

1525
1
Inhibit DB 1

1424 1
Inhibit LB 2

1425 1
Inhibit DB 2

V 01258

Figure 242: Voltage Monitor for CB Closure (Module 59)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 439
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

9.3 CHECK SYNCHRONISATION MONITOR FOR CB CLOSURE


Sys checks CB 1
880
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 1
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &
VBN CS2 Criteria OK
&
VCN
Select CB1 CS1 SlipF> 1578
VAB & CB1 CS1 SlipF>

VBC CB1 CS1 SlipF< 1579


& CB1 CS1 SlipF<
VCA CB1 CS2 SlipF> 1464
& CB1 CS2 SlipF>
VBus1
CB1 CS2 SlipF< 1465
& CB1 CS2 SlipF<
CS Vline> 1581
& CS Vline>
CS Vbus1> 1583
& CS Vbus1>
CS Vline< 1580
& CS Vline<
Check Synchronisation Function

CS Vbus1< 1582
& CS Vbus<
CB1 CS1 Vl>Vb 1586
& CB1 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB1 CS1 Vl<Vb 1588
& CB1 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb 1590
& CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb 1591
& CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh+
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh-
CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb 1493
& CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb 1494
& CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh+
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh-
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594
& CB1 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595
438 & CB1 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB1 CS2 Vl>Vb 1587
VTS Fast Block & CB1 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB1 CS2 Vl<Vb 1589
& CB1 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Status
883
Enabled & CB1 CS1 OK
881
CB1 CS1 Enabled
CB1 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
882
CB1 CS2 Enabled V01260

Figure 243: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60)

440 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

Sys checks CB 2
1484
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 2
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &

VBN CS1 Criteria OK


&
VCN
Select CB2 CS1 SlipF> 1466
VAB & CB2 CS1 SlipF>

VBC CB2 CS1 SlipF< 1467


& CB2 CS1 SlipF<
VCA CB2 CS2 SlipF> 1468
& CB2 CS2 SlipF>
VBus2
CB2 CS2 SlipF< 1469
& CB2 CS2 SlipF<

&

CS Vbus2> 1585
& CS Vbus2>

&

CS Vbus2<
Check Synchronisation Function

1584
& CS Vbus2<
CB2 CS1 Vl>Vb 1470
& CB2 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB2 CS1 Vl<Vb 1472
& CB2 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb 1474
& CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb 1476
& CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh+
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh-
CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb 1475
& CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb 1477
& CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh-
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482
& CB2 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483
438 & CB2 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB2 CS2 Vl>Vb 1471
VTS Fast Block & CB2 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB2 CS2 Vl<Vb 1473
& CB2 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Status
1577
Enabled & CB2 CS1 OK
1426
CB2 CS1 Enabled
CB2 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
1427
CB2 CS2 Enabled V01268

Figure 244: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 441
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

9.4 SYSTEM CHECK PSL

SysChks Inactive

Check Sync 1 OK

Check Sync 2 OK

Live Line Man Check Synch


&
Dead Bus 1 AR Sys Checks

&
Dead Line

&
Live Bus
V02028

Figure 245: System Check PSL

9.5 APPLICATION NOTES

9.5.1 PREDICTIVE CLOSURE OF CIRCUIT BREAKERS


The CB1 CS2 Adaptive and CB1 CS2 Adaptive settings compensate for the time taken to close the CB. When set to
provide CB Close Time compensation, a predictive approach is used to close the circuit breaker ensuring that
closing occurs at close to 0º therefore minimising the impact to the power system. The actual closing angle is
subject to the constraints of the existing product architecture, i.e. the protection task runs twice per power system
cycle, based on frequency tracking over the frequency range of 40 Hz to 70 Hz.

9.5.2 VOLTAGE AND PHASE ANGLE CORRECTION


For the Check Synchronisation function, the device needs to convert measured secondary voltages into primary
voltages. In some applications, VTs either side of the circuit breaker may have different VT Ratios. In such cases, a
magnitude correction factor is required.
There are some applications where the main VT is on the HV side of a transformer and the Check Sync VT is on the
LV side, or vice-versa. If the vector group of the transformer is not "0", the voltages are not in phase, so phase
correction is also necessary.
The correction factors are as follows and are located in the CT AND VT RATIOS column:
● C/S V kSM, where kSM is the voltage correction factor.
● C/S Phase kSA, where kSA is the angle correction factor.
Assuming C/S input setting is A-N, then:
The line and bus voltage magnitudes are matched if Va sec = Vcs sec x C/S V kSA
The line and bus voltage angles are matched if ÐVa sec = ÐVcs sec + C/S Phase kSA
The following application scenarios show where the voltage and angular correction factors are applied to match
different VT ratios:
CS Correction
Physical Ratios (ph-N Values) Setting Ratios
Factors
Scenario Main VT Ratio (ph-
Main VT Ratio CS VT Ratio CS VT Ratio
ph) Always kSM kSA
Pri (kV) Sec (V) Pri (kV) Sec (V) Pri (kV) Sec (V) Pri (kV) Sec (V)
1 220/√3 110/√3 132/√3 100/√3 220 110 132 100 1.1 30º

442 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control

2 220/√3 110/√3 220/√3 110 220 110 127 110 0.577 0º


3 220/√3 110/√3 220/√3 110/3 220 110 381 110 1.732 0º

P446SV-TM-EN-1 443
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV

444 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 17

SUPERVISION
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

446 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the supervison functions.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 447
Voltage Transformer Supervision 448
Current Transformer Supervision 452
Trip Circuit Supervision 454

P446SV-TM-EN-1 447
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

2 VOLTAGE TRANSFORMER SUPERVISION


The Voltage Transformer Supervision (VTS) function is used to detect failure of the AC voltage inputs to the
protection. This may be caused by voltage transformer faults, overloading, or faults on the wiring, which usually
results in one or more of the voltage transformer fuses blowing.
If there is a failure of the AC voltage input, the IED could misinterpret this as a failure of the actual phase voltages
on the power system, which could result in unnecessary tripping of a circuit breaker.
The VTS logic is designed to prevent such a situation by detecting voltage input failures, which are NOT caused by
power system phase voltage failure, and automatically blocking associated voltage dependent protection
elements. A time-delayed alarm output is available to warn of a VTS condition.
The following scenarios are possible with respect to the failure of the VT inputs.
● Loss of one or two-phase voltages
● Loss of all three-phase voltages under load conditions
● Absence of three-phase voltages upon line energisation

2.1 LOSS OF ONE OR TWO PHASE VOLTAGES


If the power system voltages are healthy, no Negative Phase Sequence (NPS) current will be present. If however,
one or two of the AC voltage inputs are missing, there will be Negative Phase Sequence voltage present, even if the
actual power system phase voltages are healthy. VTS works by detecting Negative Phase Sequence (NPS) voltage
without the presence of Negative Phase Sequence current. So if there is NPS voltage present, but no NPS current,
it is certain that there is a problem with the voltage transformers and a VTS block should be applied to voltage
dependent protection functions to prevent maloperation. The use of negative sequence quantities ensures correct
operation even where three-limb or V-connected VTs are used.
The Negative Sequence VTS Element is blocked by the Any Pole Dead DDB signal during SP AR Dead Time. The
resetting of the blocking signal is delayed by 240 ms after an Any Pole Dead condition disappears.

2.2 LOSS OF ALL THREE PHASE VOLTAGES


If all three voltage inputs are lost, there will be no Negative Phase Sequence quantities present, but the device will
see that there is no voltage input. If this is caused by a power system failure, there will be a step change in the
phase currents. However, if this is not caused by a power system failure, there will be no change in any of the
phase currents. So if there is no measured voltage on any of the three phases and there is no change in any of the
phase currents, this indicates that there is a problem with the voltage transformers and a VTS block should be
applied to voltage dependent protection functions to prevent maloperation.
To avoid blocking VTS due to changing load condition, the superimposed current signal can only prevent operation
of the VTS during the time window of 40 ms following the voltage collapse.

2.3 ABSENCE OF ALL THREE PHASE VOLTAGES ON LINE ENERGISATION


On line energisation there should be a change in the phase currents as a result of loading or line charging current.
Under this condition we need an alternative method of detecting three-phase VT failure.
If there is no measured voltage on all three phases during line energisation, two conditions might apply:
● A three-phase VT failure
● A close-up three-phase fault.

The first condition would require VTS to block the voltage-dependent functions.
In the second condition, voltage dependent functions should not be blocked, as tripping is required.
To differentiate between these two conditions an overcurrent level detector is used (VTS I> Inhibit). This prevents a
VTS block from being issued in case of a genuine fault. This overcurrent level detector is only enabled for 240 ms

448 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

following line energization (based on an All Poles Dead signal drop off). It must still be set in excess of any non-
fault based currents on line energisation (load, line charging current, transformer inrush current if applicable), but
below the level of current produced by a close-up three-phase fault.
If the line is closed where a three-phase VT failure is present, the overcurrent detector will not operate and a VTS
block will be applied. Closing onto a three-phase fault will result in operation of the overcurrent detector and
prevent a VTS block being applied.

2.4 VTS IMPLEMENTATION


VTS is implemented in the SUPERVISION column of the relevant settings group.
The following settings are relevant for VT Supervision:
● VTS Mode: determines the mode of operation (Measured + MCB, Measured Only, MCB Only)
● VTS Status: determines whether the VTS Operate output will be a blocking output or an alarm indication
only
● VTS Reset Mode: determines whether the Reset is to be manual or automatic
● VTS Time Delay: determines the operating time delay
● VTS I> Inhibit: inhibits VTS operation in the case of a phase overcurrent fault
● VTS I2> Inhibit: inhibits VTS operation in the case of a negative sequence overcurrent fault
For faults with I2 less than the setting VTS I2 Inhibit, VTS will be active and block the associated functions if
sufficient V2 is measured. VTS is only enabled during a live line condition (as indicated by the pole dead logic) to
prevent operation under dead system conditions.

Thresholds
The negative sequence thresholds used by the element are:
● V2 = 10 V (fixed)
● I2 = 0.05 to 0.5 In settable (default 0.05 In).

The phase voltage level detectors are:


● Drop off = 10 V (fixed)
● Pickup = 30 V (fixed)

The sensitivity of the superimposed current elements is fixed at 0.1 In.

Fuse Fail
The device includes a setting (VT Connected ) in the CT AND VT RATIOS column, which determines whether there
are voltage transformers connected to it. If set to Yes, this setting has no effect.
If set to No it causes the VTS logic to set the VTS Slow Block and VTS Fast Block DDBs, but not raise any alarms. It
also disables the VTS function. This prevents the pole dead logic working incorrectly if there is no voltage or
current. It also blocks the distance, under voltage and other voltage-dependant functions. However, it does not
affect the CB open part of the logic.
A VTS condition can be raised by a mini circuit breaker (MCB) status input, by internal logic using IED
measurement, or both. The setting VTS Mode is used to select the method of indicating VT failure.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 449
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

2.5 VTS LOGIC


All Poles Dead

IA

240ms
VTS I> Inhibit

IB &
1
VTS I> Inhibit

IC

VTS I> Inhibit

VA

VTS Time Delay


Hardcoded threshold
VB
1
Hardcoded threshold 1 & S
Q
VC R 1
& VTS Slow Block

Hardcoded threshold

Delta IA

& S 1 & VTS Fast Block


Hardcoded threshold Q
R
Delta IB
1
Hardcoded threshold 1
Delta IC

Hardcoded threshold
&
V2

Hardcoded threshold & & S


Q
I2
R

I2>1 Current Set &


Any Voltage dependent
function
VTS Reset Mode
Manual &
1
Auto

MCB/VTS

VTS Status
Indication
Blocking
1 S 1 VT Fail Alarm
Any Pole Dead & Q
240ms R
& 20ms
VTS Acc Ind

5
Cycle

½ Cycle
Cycle
VT Fast Block 1 Block Distance

&
All Poles Dead ½
Cycle
V01261

Figure 246: VTS logic

450 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

The IED may respond as follows, on operation of any VTS element:


● VTS set to provide alarm indication only
● Optional blocking of voltage-dependent protection elements
● Optional conversion of directional overcurrent elements to non-directional protection (by setting the
relevant current protection status cells to Enabled VTS. In this case, the directional setting cells are
automatically set to non-directional.)
The VTS I> Inhibit or VTS I2> Inhibit elements are used to override a VTS block if a fault occurs that could trigger
the VTS logic. However, once the VTS block is set, subsequent system faults must not override the block. Therefore
the VTS block is latched after a settable time delay (VTS Time Delay). Once the signal has latched, there are two
methods of resetting. The first is manually using the front panel HMI, or remote communications (if the VTS
condition has been removed). The second is in Auto mode, by restoring the 3 phase voltages above the phase level
detector settings mentioned previously.
VTS Status can be set to Disabled, Blocking or Indication. If VTS Status is set to Blocking, a VTS
condition will block operation of the relevant protection elements. In this case, a VTS indication is given after the
VTS Time Delay has expired. If it is set to Indication, their is a risk of maloperation because protection
elements are not blocked. In this case the VTS indication is given before the VTS Time Delay expires, if a trip signal
is given (in this case a signal from the VTS acceleration logic is used as an input).
This scheme also operates correctly under very low load or even no load conditions. To achieve this, it uses a
combination of time delayed signals derived from the DDB signals VTS Fast Block and All Poles Dead, to generate
the distance blocking DDB signal called VTS Blk Distance.

Note:
All non-distance voltage-dependent elements are blocked by the VTS Fast Block DDB.

If a miniature circuit breaker (MCB) is used to protect the voltage transformer output circuits, MCB auxiliary
contacts can be used to indicate a three-phase output disconnection. It is possible for the VTS logic to operate
correctly without this input, but this facility has been provided to maintain compatibility with some practises.
Energising an opto-isolated input assigned to the MCB/VTS provides the necessary block.
The VTS function is inhibited if:
● An All Poles Dead DDB signal is present
● Any phase overcurrent condition exists
● A Negative Phase Sequence current exists
● If the phase current changes over the period of 1 cycle

P446SV-TM-EN-1 451
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

3 CURRENT TRANSFORMER SUPERVISION


The Current Transformer Supervision function (CTS) is used to detect failure of the AC current inputs to the
protection. This may be caused by internal current transformer faults, overloading, or faults on the wiring. If there
is a failure of the AC current input, the protection could misinterpret this as a failure of the actual phase currents
on the power system, which could result in maloperation. Also, interruption in the AC current circuits can cause
dangerous CT secondary voltages to be generated.

3.1 CTS IMPLEMENTATION


If the power system currents are healthy, no zero sequence voltage are derived. However, if one or more of the AC
current inputs are missing, a zero sequence current would be derived, even if the actual power system phase
currents are healthy. Standard CTS works by detecting a derived zero sequence current where there is no
corresponding derived zero sequence voltage.
The voltage transformer connection used must be able to refer zero sequence voltages from the primary to the
secondary side. Therefore, this element should only be enabled where the VT is of a five-limb construction, or
comprises three single-phase units with the primary star point earthed.
The CTS function is implemented in the SUPERVISION column of the relevant settings group, under the sub-heading
CT SUPERVISION.
The following settings are relevant for CT Supervision:
● CTS Status: to disable or enable CTS
● CTS VN< Inhibit: inhibits CTS if the zero sequence voltage exceeds this setting
● CTS IN> Set: determines the level of zero sequence current
● CTS Time Delay: determines the operating time delay

452 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

3.2 STANDARD CTS LOGIC


CTS Time Delay
IN2

& Pickup S
CTS IN> Set
Q CT1 Fail Alarm
VN & R

CTS VN< Inhibit 1


& CTS Block
Inhibit CTS
1
Disable CTS

CTS Status 1
In indication mode , timer is set to 20 ms
Indication
Restrain

CTS Reset Mode


Manual
Auto
CTS Time Delay
IN2

& Pickup S
CTS IN> Set
Q CT2 Fail Alarm
VN & R

CTS VN< Inhibit

Inhibit CTS
1
Disable CTS

CTS Status 1
In indication mode , timer is set to 20 ms
Indication

CTS Reset Mode


Manual
Auto V01270

Figure 247: Standard CTS

3.3 CTS BLOCKING


Both the standard and differential CTS methods block protection elements operating from derived quantities, such
as Broken conductor, derived earth fault and negative sequence overcurrent. Measured quantities such as DEF
can be selectively blocked by designing an appropriate PSL scheme.
Differential CTS can be used to restrain the differential protection if required.

3.4 APPLICATION NOTES

3.4.1 SETTING GUIDELINES


The residual voltage setting, CTS VN< Inhibit and the residual current setting, CTS IN> Set, should be set to avoid
unwanted operation during healthy system conditions. For example:
● CTS VN< Inhibit should be set to 120% of the maximum steady state residual voltage.
● CTS IN> Set will typically be set below minimum load current.
● CTS Time Delay is generally set to 5 seconds.

Where the magnitude of residual voltage during an earth fault is unpredictable, the element can be disabled to
prevent protection elements being blocked during fault conditions.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 453
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

4 TRIP CIRCUIT SUPERVISION


In most protection schemes, the trip circuit extends beyond the IED enclosure and passes through components
such as links, relay contacts, auxiliary switches and other terminal boards. Such complex arrangements may
require dedicated schemes for their supervision.
There are two distinctly separate parts to the trip circuit; the trip path, and the trip coil. The trip path is the path
between the IED enclosure and the CB cubicle. This path contains ancillary components such as cables, fuses and
connectors. A break in this path is possible, so it is desirable to supervise this trip path and to raise an alarm if a
break should appear in this path.
The trip coil itself is also part of the overall trip circuit, and it is also possible for the trip coil to develop an open-
circuit fault.
This product supports a number of trip circuit supervision (TCS) schemes.

4.1 TRIP CIRCUIT SUPERVISION SCHEME 1


This scheme provides supervision of the trip coil with the CB open or closed, however, it does not provide
supervision of the trip path whilst the breaker is open. The CB status can be monitored when a self-reset trip
contact is used. However, this scheme is incompatible with latched trip contacts, as a latched contact will short out
the opto-input for a time exceeding the recommended Delayed Drop-off (DDO) timer setting of 400 ms, and
therefore does not support CB status monitoring. If you require CB status monitoring, further opto-inputs must be
used.

Note:
A 52a CB auxiliary contact follows the CB position. A 52b auxiliary contact is the opposite.

+ve

Trip Output Relay 52A Trip coil


Trip path

Blocking diode

52B

R1 Opto-input Circuit Breaker


V01214 -ve

Figure 248: TCS Scheme 1

When the CB is closed, supervision current passes through the opto-input, blocking diode and trip coil. When the
CB is open, supervision current flows through the opto-input and into the trip coil via the 52b auxiliary contact.
This means that Trip Coil supervision is provided when the CB is either closed or open, however Trip Path
supervision is only provided when the CB is closed. No supervision of the trip path is provided whilst the CB is open
(pre-closing supervision). Any fault in the trip path will only be detected on CB closing, after a 400 ms delay.

4.1.1 RESISTOR VALUES


The supervision current is a lot less than the current required by the trip coil to trip a CB. The opto-input limits this
supervision current to less than 10 mA. If the opto-input were to be short-circuited however, it could be possible for
the supervision current to reach a level that could trip the CB. For this reason, a resistor R1 is often used to limit the
current in the event of a short-circuited opto-input. This limits the current to less than 60mA. The table below
shows the appropriate resistor value and voltage setting for this scheme.
Trip Circuit Voltage Opto Voltage Setting with R1 Fitted Resistor R1 (ohms)
48/54 24/27 1.2k

454 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

Trip Circuit Voltage Opto Voltage Setting with R1 Fitted Resistor R1 (ohms)
110/125 48/54 2.7k
220/250 110/125 5.2k

Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.

4.1.2 PSL FOR TCS SCHEME 1

0 0
Opto Input dropoff Straight *Output Relay
400 0

50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm

*NC stands for Normally Closed. V01217

Figure 249: PSL for TCS Scheme 1

The opto-input can be used to drive a Normally Closed Output Relay, which in turn can be used to drive alarm
equipment. The signal can also be inverted to drive a latching programmable LED and a user alarm DDB signal.
The DDO timer operates as soon as the opto-input is energised, but will take 400 ms to drop off/reset in the event
of a trip circuit failure. The 400 ms delay prevents a false alarm due to voltage dips caused by faults in other
circuits or during normal tripping operation when the opto-input is shorted by a self-reset trip contact. When the
timer is operated the NC (normally closed) output relay opens and the LED and user alarms are reset.
The 50 ms delay on pick-up timer prevents false LED and user alarm indications during the power up time,
following a voltage supply interruption.

4.2 TRIP CIRCUIT SUPERVISION SCHEME 2


This scheme provides supervision of the trip coil with the breaker open or closed but does not provide pre-closing
supervision of the trip path. However, using two opto-inputs allows the IED to correctly monitor the circuit breaker
status since they are connected in series with the CB auxiliary contacts. This is achieved by assigning one opto-
input to the 52a contact and another opto-input to the 52b contact. Provided the CB Status setting in the CB
CONTROL column is set to Both 52A and 52B, the IED will correctly monitor the status of the breaker. This
scheme is also fully compatible with latched contacts as the supervision current will be maintained through the
52b contact when the trip contact is closed.

+ve

Trip Output Relay Trip coil


Trip path 52A

52B

R1 Opto-input 1
Circuit Breaker
-ve

R2 Opto-input 2
V01215

Figure 250: TCS Scheme 2

P446SV-TM-EN-1 455
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

When the breaker is closed, supervision current passes through opto input 1 and the trip coil. When the breaker is
open current flows through opto input 2 and the trip coil. No supervision of the trip path is provided whilst the
breaker is open. Any fault in the trip path will only be detected on CB closing, after a 400 ms delay.

4.2.1 RESISTOR VALUES


Optional resistors R1 and R2 can be added to prevent tripping of the CB if either opto-input is shorted. The table
below shows the appropriate resistor value and voltage setting for this scheme.
Trip Circuit Voltage Opto Voltage Setting with R1 Fitted Resistor R1 and R2 (ohms)
48/54 24/27 1.2k
110/125 48/54 2.7k
220/250 110/125 5.2k

Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.

4.2.2 PSL FOR TCS SCHEME 2

Opto Input 1 CB Aux 3ph(52 -A)

0 0
1 dropoff straight *Output Relay
400 0

Opto Input 2 CB Aux 3ph(52 -B)

50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm

*NC stands for Normally Closed. V01218

Figure 251: PSL for TCS Scheme 2

In TCS scheme 2, both opto-inputs must be low before a trip circuit fail alarm is given.

4.3 TRIP CIRCUIT SUPERVISION SCHEME 3


TCS Scheme 3 is designed to provide supervision of the trip coil with the breaker open or closed. It provides pre-
closing supervision of the trip path. Since only one opto-input is used, this scheme is not compatible with latched
trip contacts. If you require CB status monitoring, further opto-inputs must be used.

+ve
R3
Output Relay Trip coil
Trip path 52A

R2
52B

Opto-input R1 Circuit Breaker


-ve
V01216

Figure 252: TCS Scheme 3

When the CB is closed, supervision current passes through the opto-input, resistor R2 and the trip coil. When the
CB is open, current flows through the opto-input, resistors R1 and R2 (in parallel), resistor R3 and the trip coil. The

456 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision

supervision current is maintained through the trip path with the breaker in either state, therefore providing pre-
closing supervision.

4.3.1 RESISTOR VALUES


Resistors R1 and R2 are used to prevent false tripping, if the opto-input is accidentally shorted. However, unlike the
other two schemes. This scheme is dependent upon the position and value of these resistors. Removing them
would result in incomplete trip circuit monitoring. The table below shows the resistor values and voltage settings
required for satisfactory operation.
Opto Voltage Setting with R1
Trip Circuit Voltage Resistor R1 & R2 (ohms) Resistor R3 (ohms)
Fitted
48/54 24/27 1.2k 600
110/250 48/54 2.7k 1.2k
220/250 110/125 5.0k 2.5k

Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.

4.3.2 PSL FOR TCS SCHEME 3

0 0
Opto Input dropoff Straight *Output Relay
400 0

50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm

*NC stands for Normally Closed. V01217

Figure 253: PSL for TCS Scheme 3

P446SV-TM-EN-1 457
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV

458 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 18

DIGITAL I/O AND PSL CONFIGURATION


Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

460 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter introduces the PSL (Programmable Scheme Logic) Editor, and describes the configuration of the digital
inputs and outputs. It provides an outline of scheme logic concepts and the PSL Editor. This is followed by details
about allocation of the digital inputs and outputs, which require the use of the PSL Editor. A separate "Settings
Application Software" document is available that gives a comprehensive description of the PSL, but enough
information is provided in this chapter to allow you to allocate the principal digital inputs and outputs.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 461
Configuring Digital Inputs and Outputs 462
Scheme Logic 463
Configuring the Opto-Inputs 465
Assigning the Output Relays 466
Fixed Function LEDs 467
Configuring Programmable LEDs 468
Function Keys 470
Control Inputs 471

P446SV-TM-EN-1 461
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

2 CONFIGURING DIGITAL INPUTS AND OUTPUTS


Configuration of the digital inputs and outputs in this product is very flexible. You can use a combination of
settings and programmable logic to customise them to your application. You can access some of the settings
using the keypad on the front panel, but you will need a computer running the settings application software to fully
interrogate and configure the properties of the digital inputs and outputs.
The settings application software includes an application called the PSL Editor (Programmable Scheme Logic
Editor). The PSL Editor lets you allocate inputs and outputs according to your specific application. It also allows you
to apply attributes to some of the signals such as a drop-off delay for an output contact.
In this product, digital inputs and outputs that are configurable are:
● Optically isolated digital inputs (opto-inputs). These can be used to monitor the status of associated plant.
● Output relays. These can be used for purposes such as initiating the tripping of circuit breakers, providing
alarm signals, etc..
● Programmable LEDs. The number and colour of the programmable LEDs varies according to the particular
product being applied.
● Function keys and associated LED indications. These are not provided on all products, but where they are,
each function key has an associated tri-colour LED.
● IEC 61850 GOOSE inputs and outputs. These are only provided on products that have been specified for
connection to an IEC61850 system, and the details of the GOOSE are presented in the documentation on
IEC61850.
● InterMiCOM inputs and outputs. These are not used by all products. If your product is equipped with an
InterMiCOM feature, you will find details of allocation and configuration in the chapter dedicated to the
InterMiCOM function.

462 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

3 SCHEME LOGIC
The product is supplied with pre-loaded Fixed Scheme Logic (FSL) and Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL).
The Scheme Logic is a functional module within the IED, through which all mapping of inputs to outputs is handled.
The scheme logic can be split into two parts; the Fixed Scheme Logic (FSL) and the Programmable Scheme Logic
(PSL). It is built around a concept called the digital data bus (DDB). The DDB encompasses all of the digital signals
(DDBs) which are used in the FSL and PSL. The DDBs included digital inputs, outputs, and internal signals.
The FSL is logic that has been hard-coded in the product. It is fundamental to correct interaction between various
protection and/or control elements. It is fixed and cannot be changed.
The PSL gives you a facility to develop custom schemes to suit your application if the factory-programmed default
PSL schemes do not meet your needs. Default PSL schemes are programmed before the product leaves the
factory. These default PSL schemes have been designed to suit typical applications and if these schemes suit your
requirements, you do not need to take any action. However, if you want to change the input-output mappings, or
to implement custom scheme logic, you can change these, or create new PSL schemes using the PSL editor.
The PSL consists of components such as logic gates and timers, which combine and condition DDB signals.
The logic gates can be programmed to perform a range of different logic functions. The number of inputs to a logic
gate are not limited. The timers can be used either to create a programmable delay or to condition the logic
outputs. Output contacts and programmable LEDs have dedicated conditioners.
The PSL logic is event driven. Only the part of the PSL logic that is affected by the particular input change that has
occurred is processed. This minimises the amount of processing time used by the PSL ensuring industry leading
performance.
The following diagram shows how the scheme logic interacts with the rest of the IED.

Energising quantities Protection functions Fixed LEDs


SL outputs
SL inputs

Opto-inputs Programmable LEDs


PSL and FSL

Function keys Output relays


Goose outputs
Control inputs

Goose inputs

Control input Ethernet


module processing module

V02011

Figure 254: Scheme Logic Interfaces

P446SV-TM-EN-1 463
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

3.1 PSL EDITOR


The Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL) is a module of programmable logic gates and timers in the IED, which can
be used to create customised logic to qualify how the product manages its response to system conditions. The
IED's digital inputs are combined with internally generated digital signals using logic gates, timers, and
conditioners. The resultant signals are then mapped to digital outputs signals including output relays and LEDs.
The PSL Editor is a tool in the settings application software that allows you to create and edit scheme logic
diagrams. You can use the default scheme logic which has been designed to suit most applications, but if it does
not suit your application you can change it. If you create a different scheme logic with the software, you need to
upload it to the device to apply it.

3.2 PSL SCHEMES


Your product is shipped with default scheme files. These can be used without modification for most applications, or
you can choose to use them as a starting point to design your own scheme. You can also create a new scheme
from scratch. To create a new scheme, or to modify an existing scheme, you will need to launch the settings
application software. You then need to open an existing PSL file, or create a new one, for the particular product
that you are using, and then open a PSL file. If you want to create a new PSL file, you should select File then New
then Blank scheme... This action opens a default file appropriate for the device in question, but deletes the
diagram components from the default file to leave an empty diagram with configuration information loaded. To
open an existing file, or a default file, simply double-click on it.

3.3 PSL SCHEME VERSION CONTROL


To help you keep track of the PSL loaded into products, a version control feature is included. The user interface
contains a PSL DATA column, which can be used to track PSL modifications. A total of 12 cells are contained in the
PSL DATA column; 3 for each setting group.
Grp(n) PSL Ref: When downloading a PSL scheme to an IED, you will be prompted to enter the relevant group
number and a reference identifier. The first 32 characters of the reference identifier are displayed in this cell. The
horizontal cursor keys can scroll through the 32 characters as the LCD display only displays 16 characters.

Example:

Grp(n) PSL Ref

Date/time: This cell displays the date and time when the PSL scheme was downloaded to the IED.

Example:

18 Nov 2002
08:59:32.047

Grp(n) PSL ID: This cell displays a unique ID number for the downloaded PSL scheme.

Example:

Grp(n) PSL ID
ID - 2062813232

464 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

4 CONFIGURING THE OPTO-INPUTS


The number of optically isolated status inputs (opto-inputs) depends on the specific model supplied. The use of the
inputs will depend on the application, and their allocation is defined in the programmable scheme logic (PSL). In
addition to the PSL assignment, you also need to specify the expected input voltage. Generally, all opto-inputs will
share the same input voltage range, but if different voltage ranges are being used, this device can accommodate
them.
In the OPTO CONFIG column there is a global nominal voltage setting. If all opto-inputs are going to be energised
from the same voltage range, you select the appropriate value in the setting. If you select Custom in the setting,
then the cells Opto Input 1, Opto Input 2, etc. become visible. You use these cells to set the voltage ranges for
each individual opto-input.
Within the OPTO CONFIG column there are also settings to control the filtering applied to the inputs, as well as the
pick-up/drop-off characteristic.
The filter control setting provides a bit string with a bit associated with all opto-inputs. Setting the bit to ‘1’ means
that a half-cycle filter is applied to the inputs. This helps to prevent incorrect operation in the event of power
system frequency interference on the wiring. Setting the field to ‘0’ removes the filter and provides for faster
operation.
The Characteristic setting is a single setting that applies to all the opto-inputs. It is used to set the pick-up/drop-
off ratios of the input signals. As standard it is set to 80% pick-up and 60% drop-off, but you can change it to other
available thresholds if that suits your operational requirements.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 465
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

5 ASSIGNING THE OUTPUT RELAYS


Relay contact action is controlled using the PSL. DDB signals are mapped in the PSL and drive the output relays.
The driving of an output relay is controlled by means of a relay output conditioner. Several choices are available for
how output relay contacts are conditioned. For example, you can choose whether operation of an output relay
contact is latched, has delay on pick-up, or has a delay on drop-off. You make this choice in the Contact
Properties window associated with the output relay conditioner.
To map an output relay in the PSL you should use the Contact Conditioner button in the toolbar to import it. You
then condition it according to your needs. The output of the conditioner respects the attributes you have assigned.
The toolbar button for a Contact Conditioner looks like this:

The PSL contribution that it delivers looks like this:

Note:
Contact Conditioners are only available if they have not all been used. In some default PSL schemes, all Contact Conditioners
might have been used. If that is the case, and you want to use them for something else, you will need to re-assign them.

On the toolbar there is another button associated with the relay outputs. The button looks like this:

This is the "Contact Signal" button. It allows you to put replica instances of a conditioned output relay into the PSL,
preventing you having to make cross-page connections which might detract from the clarity of the scheme.

466 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

6 FIXED FUNCTION LEDS


Four fixed-function LEDs on the left-hand side of the front panel indicate the following conditions.
● Trip (Red) switches ON when the IED issues a trip signal. It is reset when the associated fault record is
cleared from the front display. Also the trip LED can be configured as self-resetting.
● Alarm (Yellow) flashes when the IED registers an alarm. This may be triggered by a fault, event or
maintenance record. The LED flashes until the alarms have been accepted (read), then changes to
constantly ON. When the alarms are cleared, the LED switches OFF.
● Out of service (Yellow) is ON when the IED's functions are unavailable.
● Healthy (Green) is ON when the IED is in correct working order, and should be ON at all times. It goes OFF if
the unit’s self-tests show there is an error in the hardware or software. The state of the healthy LED is
reflected by the watchdog contacts at the back of the unit.

6.1 TRIP LED LOGIC


When a trip occurs, the trip LED is illuminated. It is possible to reset this with a number of ways:
● Directly with a reset command (by pressing the Clear Key)
● With a reset logic input
● With self-resetting logic

You enable the automatic self-resetting with the Sys Fn Links cell in the SYSTEM DATA column. A '0' disables self
resetting and a '1' enables self resetting.
The reset occurs when the circuit is reclosed and the Any Pole Dead signal has been reset for three seconds
providing the Any Start signal is inactive. The reset is prevented if the Any Start signal is active after the breaker
closes.
The Trip LED logic is as follows:

Any Trip S
Q Trip LED Trigger
Reset R
1
Reset Relays/LED

Sys Fn Links
Trip LED S/Reset
3s
&

Any Pole Dead

Any Start

V01211

Figure 255: Trip LED logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 467
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

7 CONFIGURING PROGRAMMABLE LEDS


There are three types of programmable LED signals which vary according to the model being used. These are:
● Single-colour programmable LED. These are red when illuminated.
● Tri-colour programmable LED. These can be illuminated red, green, or amber.
● Tri-colour programmable LED associated with a Function Key. These can be illuminated red, green, or
amber.

DDB signals are mapped in the PSL and used to illuminate the LEDs. For single-coloured programmable LEDs there
is one DDB signal per LED. For tri-coloured LEDs there are two DDB signals associated with the LED. Asserting LED
# Grn will illuminate the LED green. Asserting LED # Red will illuminate the LED red. Asserting both DDB signals will
illuminate the LED amber.
The illumination of an LED is controlled by means of a conditioner. Using the conditioner, you can decide whether
the LEDs reflect the real-time state of the DDB signals, or whether illumination is latched pending user intervention.
To map an LED in the PSL you should use the LED Conditioner button in the toolbar to import it. You then condition
it according to your needs. The output(s) of the conditioner respect the attribute you have assigned.
The toolbar button for a tri-colour LED looks like this:

The PSL contribution that it delivers looks like this:

The toolbar button for a single-colour LED looks like this:

The PSL contribution that it delivers looks like this.

Note:
LED Conditioners are only available if they have not all been used up, and in some default PSL schemes they might be. If that
is the case and you want to use them for something else, you will need to re-assign them.

On the toolbar there is another button associated with the LEDs. For a tri-coloured LED the button looks like this:

For a single-colour LED it looks like this:

It is the "LED Signal" button. It allows you to put replica instances of a conditioned LED into the PSL, preventing you
having to make cross-page connections which might detract from the clarity of the scheme.

468 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

Note:
All LED DDB signals are always shown in the PSL Editor. However, the actual number of LEDs depends on the device
hardware. For example, if a small 20TE device has only 4 programmable LEDs, LEDs 5-8 will not take effect even if they are
mapped in the PSL.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 469
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

8 FUNCTION KEYS
For most models, a number of programmable function keys are available. This allows you to assign function keys
to control functionality via the programmable scheme logic (PSL). Each function key is associated with a
programmable tri-colour LED, which you can program to give the desired indication on activation of the function
key.
These function keys can be used to trigger any function that they are connected to as part of the PSL. The function
key commands are found in the FUNCTION KEYS column.
Each function key is associated with a DDB signal as shown in the DDB table. You can map these DDB signals to
any function available in the PSL.
The Fn Key Status cell displays the status (energised or de-energised) of the function keys by means of a binary
string, where each bit represents a function key starting with bit 0 for function key 1.
Each function key has three settings associated with it, as shown:
● Fn Key (n), which enables or disables the function key
● Fn Key (n) Mode, which allows you to configure the key as toggled or normal
● Fn Key (n) label, which allows you to define the function key text that is displayed

The Fn Key (n) cell is used to enable (unlock) or disable (unlock) the function key signals in PSL. The Lock setting has
been provided to prevent further activation on subsequent key presses. This allows function keys that are set to
Toggled mode and their DDB signal active ‘high’, to be locked in their active state therefore preventing any
further key presses from deactivating the associated function. Locking a function key that is set to the “Normal”
mode causes the associated DDB signals to be permanently off. This safety feature prevents any inadvertent
function key presses from activating or deactivating critical functions.
When the Fn Key (n) Mode cell is set to Toggle, the function key DDB signal output will remain in the set state
until a reset command is given. In the Normal mode, the function key DDB signal will remain energised for as long
as the function key is pressed and will then reset automatically. In this mode, a minimum pulse duration can be
programmed by adding a minimum pulse timer to the function key DDB output signal.
The Fn Key Label cell makes it possible to change the text associated with each individual function key. This text
will be displayed when a function key is accessed in the function key menu, or it can be displayed in the PSL.
The status of all function keys are recorded in non-volatile memory. In case of auxiliary supply interruption their
status will be maintained.

Note:
All function key DDB signals are always shown in the PSL Editor. However, the actual number of function keys depends on the
device hardware. For example, if a small 20TE device has no function keys, the function key DDBs mapped in the PSL will not
take effect.

470 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration

9 CONTROL INPUTS
The control inputs are software switches, which can be set or reset locally or remotely. These inputs can be used to
trigger any PSL function to which they are connected. There are three setting columns associated with the control
inputs: CONTROL INPUTS, CTRL I/P CONFIG and CTRL I/P LABELS. These are listed in the Settings and Records
appendix at the end of this manual.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 471
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV

472 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 19

FIBRE TELEPROTECTION
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

474 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the fibre-optic communication mechanism,which is used to provide unit
schemes and general-purpose teleprotection signalling for protection of transmission lines and distribution
feeders. The feature is called Fibre Teleprotection.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 475
Protection Signalling Introduction 476
Fibre Teleprotection Implementation 478
IM64 Logic 485
Application Notes 487

P446SV-TM-EN-1 475
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

2 PROTECTION SIGNALLING INTRODUCTION


Unit protection schemes can be formed by several IEDs located remotely from each other and some distance
protection schemes. Such unit protection schemes need communication between each location to achieve a unit
protection function. This communication is known as protection signalling or teleprotection. Communications
facilities are also needed when remote circuit breakers need to be operated due to a local event. This
communication is known as intertripping.
The communication messages involved may be quite simple, involving instructions for the receiving device to take
some defined action (trip, block, etc.), or it may be the passing of measured data in some form from one device to
another (as in a unit protection scheme).
Various types of communication links are available for protection signalling, for example:
● Private pilot wires installed by the utility
● Pilot wires or channels rented from a communications company
● Carrier channels at high frequencies over the power lines
● Radio channels at very high or ultra high frequencies
● Optical fibres
Whether or not a particular link is used depends on factors such as the availability of an appropriate
communication network, the distance between protection relaying points, the terrain over which the power
network is constructed, as well as cost.
Protection signalling is used to implement unit protection schemes, provide teleprotection commands, or
implement intertripping between circuit breakers.

2.1 UNIT PROTECTION SCHEMES


Phase comparison and current differential schemes use signalling to convey information concerning the relaying
quantity - phase angle of current and phase and magnitude of current respectively - between local and remote
relaying points. Comparison of local and remote signals provides the basis for both fault detection and
discrimination of the schemes.

2.2 TELEPROTECTION COMMANDS


Some Protection schemes use signalling to convey commands between local and remote relaying points. Receipt
of the information is used to aid or speed up clearance of faults within a protected zone or to prevent tripping from
faults outside a protected zone.
Teleprotection systems are often referred to by their mode of operation, or the role of the teleprotection command
in the system.
Three types of teleprotection command are commonly encountered, direct tripping, permissive tripping and
blocking schemes.

Direct Tripping
In direct tripping applications (also known as intertripping), signals are sent directly to the master trip relay. Receipt
of the command causes circuit breaker operation. The method of communication must be reliable and secure
because any signal detected at the receiving end causes a trip of the circuit at that end. The communications
system must be designed so that interference on the communication circuit does not cause spurious trips. If a
spurious trip occurs, the primary system might be unnecessarily isolated.

Permissive Tripping
Permissive trip commands are always monitored by a protection relay. The circuit breaker is tripped when receipt
of the command coincides with a ‘start’ condition being detected by the protection relay at the receiving end
responding to a system fault. Requirements for the communications channel are less onerous than for direct

476 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

tripping schemes, since receipt of an incorrect signal must coincide with a ‘start’ of the receiving end protection for
a trip operation to take place. The intention of these schemes is to speed up tripping for faults occurring within the
protected zone.

Blocking Scheme
Blocking commands are initiated by a protection element that detects faults external to the protected zone.
Detection of an external fault at the local end of a protected circuit results in a blocking signal being transmitted to
the remote end. At the remote end, receipt of the blocking signal prevents the remote end protection operating if it
had detected the external fault. Loss of the communications channel is less serious for this scheme than in others
as loss of the channel does not result in a failure to trip when required. However, the risk of a spurious trip is higher.

2.3 TRANSMISSION MEDIA AND INTERFERENCE


The transmission media that provide the communication links involved in protection signalling can be:
● Private pilots
● Rented pilots or channels
● Power line carrier
● Radio
● Optical fibres

Historically, pilot wires and channels (discontinuous pilot wires with isolation transformers or repeaters along the
route between signalling points) have been the most widely used due to their availability, followed by Power Line
Carrier Communications (PLCC) techniques and radio. In recent years, fibre-optic systems have become the usual
choice for new installations, primarily due to their complete immunity from electrical interference. The use of fibre-
optic cables also greatly increases the number of communication channels available for each physical fibre
connection and thus enables more comprehensive monitoring of the power system to be achieved by the
provision of a large number of communication channels.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 477
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

3 FIBRE TELEPROTECTION IMPLEMENTATION


The Fibre Teleprotection interface is an optional feature in this product. It provides fibre-optic communications to
implement intertripping command signalling which can be freely allocated to realise protection schemes such as
Permissive and Blocking schemes. To use the feature you must enable the InterMiCOM 64 setting in the
CONFIGURATION column.
Each product can have up to 2 fibre-optic communications channels for teleprotection signalling. A range of
different fibre-optic interfaces are available to provide:
● Direct fibre connections between devices with a number of options available to suit different requirements
● Indirect connections using the industry standard IEEE C37.94. Fibre-optic connections are made between
the product and telecommunications equipment that supports industry standard fibre-optic interfaces (IEEE
C37.94). The telecommunications equipment provides the end-to-end service.
● Fibre-optic connection in conjunction with proprietary auxiliary interface units to provide connection to
standard electrical telecommunications interfaces (G.703, V.35, X.21). With this indirect connection method,
the telecommunications equipment provides the end-to-end service.
Signals to be communicated between devices are constructed into packets (sometimes called telegrams). These
packets include addressing, timing, and error checking information as well as teleprotection commands and data,
and are transmitted between terminals at frequent regular intervals. Upon reception, they are checked for integrity
before the contents are used.
Allocation of teleprotection commands is realised with mappings between InterMiCOM 64 signals and internal DDB
logic signals using the product’s the Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL).

3.1 SETTING UP THE IM64 SCHEME


To use the fibre teleprotection features in this product, you will need to configure the protection signalling scheme.
The protection signalling scheme is defined by the number of connected terminals, together with the
communications links between them.
Products can have either 1 physical fibre teleprotection channel, or two. Products with 1 physical fibre
teleprotection channel can be used to connect two products together into a scheme. Products with 2 physical fibre
teleprotection channels can be used to connect three products together into a scheme, or they can be used to
connect two products together into a scheme with dual communications channels to provide communications
redundancy (hot standby) in the event of a single communications channel failure.
For products with 2 physical fibre teleprotection channels use the Scheme Setup setting in the PROT COMMS/IM64
column. The choices are 3 Terminal, 2 Terminal (only physical Ch1 is used), and Dual Redundant (two
terminals with two interconnecting channels).
The physical connections are labelled as Ch1 and Ch2.
In a two-terminal scheme, channel 1 of one device should always connect to channel 1 of the other device. For a
two-terminal scheme with dual redundant communications, it follows that channel 2 of one device should connect
to channel 2 of the other.
In a three terminal scheme, channel 1 of one device should always connect to channel 2 of another device as
shown in the figure below.

478 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

Rx IED B Tx
Ch1 Ch2
Tx Rx

Remote 1

Tx Rx Tx Rx
Ch2 Ch1
Local Remote 2
IED A IED C
Ch1 Ch2
Rx Tx Rx Tx

V02500

Figure 256: Fibre Teleprotection connections for a three-terminal Scheme

3.1.1 FIBRE TELEPROTECTION SCHEME TERMINAL ADDRESSING


In Fibre Teleprotection schemes, commands are packaged together with other important data for transmission
over communications channels to the other devices. The packages of information are generally called ‘messages’.
These messages are created for a specific destination where they will be acted upon to realise the overall scheme
protection. It is critical that they are only used by the intended device. Making the correct channel connections
may not always ensure that the messages get to the correct destination; there may be a possibility that
communication paths may become cross-connected or looped back during telecommunications network
switching operations. To avoid incorrect scheme operation, extra security is needed to ensure that messages are
acted upon only by their intended recipient. This is achieved by means of an address field in the messages. The
address field is used to individually match connected devices. A transmitting device includes the address of the
intended recipient in the message. If the receiving device matches the address, the message will be used. If it does
not match, it is discarded.
The address field is an 8-bit field in the message. It can carry any 8-bit value, but certain values have been chosen
for maximum security. For convenience they have been arranged into 32 groups. All devices in a scheme must
share the same group. For addressing, the different devices are referenced as ‘A’, ‘B’, and ‘C’ for three-terminal
schemes. Their addresses should recognise the referencing.
So for a two-terminal scheme, if one device has the address set to ‘5-A’ the other should have the address to ‘5-B’.
Similarly, in a three-terminal scheme if one device has address ‘1-A’, the other devices would have addresses ‘1-B’
and ‘1-C’. The address is set using the address setting in the PROT COMMS/IM64 column.

Note:
A universal address (0-0) is used as default. If this is used all products use the same address ‘0-0’. This is primarily intended to
help test the product before it goes into service. We strongly recommend not to use 0-0 in service since any communications
switching or loopback condition will not be detected and may cause false tripping.

Note:
For a three-terminal scheme, the A, B, and C parts of the address group should match the figure shown earlier for a
triangulated scheme where device A has address A, device B has address B, and device C has address C.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 479
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

3.1.2 SETTING UP IM64


In this product, the feature that manages the fibre teleprotection command signals is called InterMiCOM 64 (or
IM64). IM64 is suitable for the exchange of all teleprotection command types.
Up to 2 banks of teleprotection command signals (IM64 signals) are provided. Each bank provides 8 duplex
command signals. That means that each bank assigns 8 bits for IM64 input signals and 8 bits for IM64 output
signals. Each bank is associated with a logical channel (referred to as Ch1 or Ch2 in the internal logic). Each logical
channel associates with a physical communications channel (labelled Ch1 or Ch2 at the physical connection point).
The association of logical channels to physical channels varies according to specific scheme configurations.
Action of each IM64 input signal is managed by attributes defined by three settings associated with it. These are
set in the PROT COMMS/IM64 column and are of the form:
● IM 1 Cmd Type (command type)
● IM 1 FallBackMode (fallback modes)
● IM 1 DefaultValue (default values)

The settings shown above are for bit 1 only


The IM64 command type settings set the teleprotection type. Permissive satisfies the security requirements of
a permissive application, as well as the speed needed for a blocking scheme. For direct tripping applications, set it
to Direct.
The IM64fallback settings determine the behaviour of an input under communications failure conditions. You can
choose either to latch the state of the last good command received, or to revert to a default state. If you set the
fallback mode to Default you will need to set the default state to your requirement (either 1 or 0).
The attributes assigned to bit n of an IM64 input apply to that bit in both logical channels. For example, if IM4
DefaultValue is chosen as 1 then the default value for bit 4 in logical channel 1 (IM64 Ch1 Input 4) will be the same
for bit 4 in logical channel 2 (IM64 Ch2 Input 4), and will take the value 1.

3.1.3 TWO-TERMINAL IM64 OPERATION


The protection signalling connection requirement for products operating as a Two Terminal scheme is that the
Physical Channels labelled as Ch1 should be connected together. That means that the local Ch1 Tx connects to the
remote Ch1 Rx, and the local Ch1 Rx connects to the remote Ch1 Tx. Physical Channel 2 (Ch2) connectors may be
fitted, but they are not used.
The 8 bits of both Logical Channels (Ch1 and Ch2) are used. The bits of both Logical Channels are all assigned to
Physical Channel 1, so 16 duplex commands (IM64 Ch1 bits 1-8 and IM64 Ch2 bits 1-8) can be communicated
between terminals in IM64 messages using Ch1 Physical Channels.

3.1.4 DUAL REDUNDANT TWO-TERMINAL IM64 OPERATION


The protection signalling connection requirement for products operating as a Dual Redundant (Hot Standby)
scheme is that the Physical Channels labelled as Ch1 should be connected together and the Physical Channels
labelled as Ch2 should be connected together. That means that the local Ch1 Tx connects to the remote Ch1 Rx,
the local Ch1 Rx connects to the remote Ch1 Tx, the local Ch2 Tx connects to the remote Ch2 Rx, and the local Ch2
Rx connects to the remote Ch2 Tx.
The 8 bits of both Logical Channels (Ch1 and Ch2) are used. The bits of both Logical Channels are all assigned both
to Physical Channel 1 and to Physical Channel 2, so that 16 duplex commands (IM64 Ch1 bits 1-8 and IM64 Ch2
bits 1-8) can be communicated between terminals in IM64 messages with full redundancy of both Logical
Channels in the event of failure of either Physical Channel.

3.1.5 THREE-TERMINAL IM64 OPERATION


The protection signalling connection requirement for products operating as a Three Terminal scheme is that
Physical Channels labelled as Ch1 should be connected to Physical Channels labelled as Ch2. That means that a

480 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

local Ch1 Tx connects to a remote Ch2 Rx, and the corresponding Ch1 Rx and Ch2 Tx are connected together as
shown in the earlier figure (Fibre Teleprotection Connections for a Three Terminal Scheme).
This Three Terminal scheme uses a triangulation approach and is designed to function if a communications link
between two terminals is not present or is degraded. 8 duplex teleprotection commands are available between
any pair of terminals even if one communication channel fails.
Logical Channel 1 is associated with Physical Channel 1, and Logical Channel 2 is associated with Physical Channel
2.
Consider a Three terminal scheme where the terminals are referenced as Local, Remote1, and Remote2. Remote 1
correlates to Ch1, and Remote 2 correlates to Ch2. The Local terminal will send the commands that it wants
Remote 1 to act on to both Remote 1 and Remote 2. Upon receipt, Remote 1 acts upon the commands that the
Local terminal wants it to use. Remote 1 also packages the commands that it wants Remote 2 to use, together
with a copy of the commands that Local wants Remote 2 to use, and also the commands it wants Local to use.
Remote 1 sends the message to Remote2. Remote 2 acts similarly. The same process occurs in the opposite
direction around the ring, so in the event of a single channel failure, and if all terminals have the same mappings
for the 8 IM64 bits integrity will be maintained for all 8 duplex commands between connected terminals.
In a triangulated scheme, at each terminal, Logical Channel 1 commands are assigned to Physical Channel 1, and
Logical Channel 2 commands are assigned to Physical Channel 2. At each terminal, the eight IM64 commands
transmitted on Physical Channel 1 are intended for the device connected as its Remote 1, and the eight IM64
commands transmitted on Channel 2 are intended for the device connected as its Remote 2. So, eight full-duplex
commands are available between any two terminals. Each device transmits both channels of eight IM64
commands to the connected devices. At the Remote 1 device, the eight Channel 1 IM64 commands are used
directly by the receiving device which passes through the eight Channel 2 IM64 commands to the remote 2 device.
All three devices in the scheme perform similarly, ensuring that, so long as one device is able to communicate with
the other two, scheme integrity is maintained.
This Chain topology (normally invoked when a communication link fails) can be used to save cost in a three-
terminal scheme. This is because two legs are cheaper to install than full triangulation implementation. Also if a
suitable communication link is not available between two of the line ends, it may be the only option. If a Chain
topology is used, or one link in a fully triangulated scheme is lost, the operating delay of the teleprotection
commands increases by approximately 7 ms, plus the communications channel signalling delay, due to the
extended path length and additional processing.

3.1.6 PHYSICAL CONNECTION


The protection communications into and out of the products are fibre-optic. Connections are made using BFOC/2.5
connectors (BFOC/2.5 connectors are commonly referred to as “ST” connectors where “ST” is a registered
trademark of AT&T).
According to application, different fibre-optic interfaces are available described in the following table:
Wavelength of light (nm) Fibre type Maximum transmission distance (km)
850 Multi-mode 1
1300 Multi-mode 50
1300 Single-mode 100
1550 Single-mode 150

Connections are made using appropriate fibre-optic cables terminated with BFOC/2.5 connectors. The transmitter
of one device (for example Tx1) is connected to the receiver of another (Rx1 or Rx2 according to the scheme set-
up)
Products can be supplied with the following fibre-optic channel arrangements:
Ch 1 Ch2
850 nm 850 nm

P446SV-TM-EN-1 481
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

Ch 1 Ch2
1300 nm multi-mode Not fitted
1300 nm multi-mode 1300 nm multi-mode
1300 nm single-mode Not fitted
1300 nm single-mode 1300 nm single-mode
1550 nm single-mode Not fitted
1550 nm single-mode 1550 nm single-mode
850 nm 1300 nm multi-mode
850 nm 1300 nm single-mode
850 nm 1550 nm single-mode
1300 nm multi-mode 850 nm
1300 nm single-mode 850 nm
1550 nm single-mode 850 nm

3.1.6.1 DIRECT CONNECTION


If you are using direct fibre connections you need to set the Scheme Setup settings and you are advised to change
the Address setting from the default. You find these settings in the PROT COMMS/IM64 columns. You should not
need to use any of the other settings that would be applicable if using shared links and/or interfacing units.

3.1.6.2 INDIRECT CONNECTION


For 850nm communications links where the connection is not direct fibre, a number of options are available to
interface with standard telecommunications equipment. These are:
● Fibre connection to telecommunications equipment supporting the IEEE C37.94 interface
● Connection to G.703, V.35 or X.21 electrical circuits using auxiliary P59x interface units
P59x interface unit options are:
● P591 - Fiber optic to electrical signal G.703 (co-directional) 64 Kbit/s or 2Mbit/s, depending on ordering
option
● P592 - Fiber optic to electrical signal V.35
● P593 - Fiber optic to electrical signal X.21

P59x interface units are housed in 10TE wide, 4U high cases. They provide optical-electrical conversion. The optical
characteristics match those of the 850nm interface on the protection device. When used, you need one unit for
each transmitter/receiver pair. That means one unit at each end of each communications channel as
demonstrated in the figure below.

482 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

850 nm 850 nm 850 nm


multimode multimode multimode
optical fiber optical fiber optical fiber
P591 P592 P593
interface unit interface unit interface unit

G.703 V.35 X.21

Multiplexer or Multiplexer or
Multiplexer
xDSL modem xDSL modem

Multiplexer or Multiplexer or
Multiplexer
xDSL modem xDSL modem

G.703 V.35 X.21

P591 P592 P593


interface unit interface unit interface unit

850 nm 850 nm 850 nm


multimode multimode multimode
optical fiber optical fiber optical fiber

V02501

Figure 257: Interfacing to PCM multiplexers

Note:
P59x interface units should be mounted as close as possible to the telecommunications equipment to minimise interference
on the electrical connections.

3.1.6.2.1 INDIRECT CONNECTION - FIBRE (IEEE C37.94)


An 850 nm fibre-optic interface can connect directly to a multiplexer supporting the IEEE C37.94 standard. 850 nm
multi-mode optical fibres, either 50/125 mm or 62.5/125 mm are suitable. BFOC/2.5 type fibre optic connectors are
used.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 483
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

Note:
To use this configuration, you need to set Comms Mode to ‘IEEE C37.94’. You then need to remove the power supply from the
product and then re-apply the power. The setting is now effective. If ‘IEEE C37.94’ is used, it applies to both communication
channels.

The IEEE C37.94 standard defines an N*64 kbits/s selection, where N is a number between 1 and 12 and selects
the channel used in the multiplexer. The value of N is set on a per channel basis by setting Ch1 N*64kbits/s (and
Ch2 N*64kbits/s where applicable) to N (1 to 12). For convenience an auto-detect setting is provided. Setting to
Auto means that the device will automatically determine which multiplexer channel to use.

3.1.6.2.2 INDIRECT CONNECTION - ELECTRICAL CIRCUITS


P591, P592, P593 interface units are housed in 10TE wide, 4U high cases. They provide optical-electrical conversion
allowing the protection to be used with telecommunications equipment providing interfaces to the ITU-T
recommendations G,703, V.35 and X.21 respectively. The optical characteristics of the P59x devices match those of
the 850 nm interface on the protection device. When used, you need one unit for each transmitter/receiver pair.
That means one unit at each end of each communications channel. The P59x devices should be mounted as close
as possible to the telecommunications equipment to minimise interference on the electrical connections.
A detailed description of the devices can be found in the P59x Technical Manual.
The P59x range supports the following electrical connections:
● X.21: Connection at 64 kbps is supported.

● V.35: Connection at 64 kbps or 56 kbps is supported.


● G.703: The data rate (baud rate) is 64 kbps but connection can be made at either 64 kbps or 2 Mbps.

When P59x units are used in the communications channel of the protection scheme, the following must be set:
● Comms Mode
● Baud Rate Chn (n = 1 or 2)
● Clock Source Chn (n = 1 or 2)

You should set the Comms Mode setting to Standard, and you should match the Baud Rate to the channel data
rate.
For V.35, you should set the Clock Source to External for a multiplexer network which is supplying a master
clock signal, or to Internal for a multiplexer network recovering signal timing from the equipment (clock
recovery). For G.703 and X.21, you always set the clock source to External.

484 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

4 IM64 LOGIC

Channel Timeout
t
No Received Messages Ch 1 Ch1 Timeout
0 t
1
Poor Channel Quality Ch 1 0 1 Signalling Fail

Ch1 Degraded
Channel Timeout

No Received Messages Ch 2 t Ch2 Timeout


0
t
1
Poor Channel Quality Ch 2 0
Ch2 Degraded

1
Scheme Setup &
3 terminal

& 1 IM64 SchemeFail

&
V02502

Figure 258: IM64 channel fail and scheme fail logic

Channel Timeout
3 terminal
1 Ch1 Timeout
3 terminal

Channel Timeout
3 terminal Signalling Fail

Channel 1 IM64 Bits


received from channel 2 & Ch1 Degraded

Channel Timeout
3 terminal
& Ch2 Timeout
Channel 2 IM64 Bits
received from channel 1

V02503

Figure 259: IM64 general alarm signals logic

P446SV-TM-EN-1 485
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

Channel 1 Communication Error in Receive

Message Evaluation
message (IEEE C37 .94) Ch1 Signal Lost
Message Info

Channel 1
Error in Transit
Ch1 Path Yellow
Message Info
Comms Mode
IEEE C37.94 Channel Mismatch Ch1 Mismatch RxN

1 IEEE C37 .94

Error in Receive

Message Evaluation
Ch2 Signal Lost
Message Info

Channel 1
Error in Transit
Ch2 Path Yellow
Message Info
Channel 2 Communication Channel Mismatch Ch2 Mismatch RxN
message (IEEE C37 .94)

Comms Mode
Standard S
Q
IEEE C37.94 RD
& Comms Changed
S
Q
RD
Relay Power Up

Fixed Pulse
V02504

Figure 260: IM64 communications mode and IEEE C37.94 alarm signals

486 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

5 APPLICATION NOTES
Effective communications are essential for the performance of teleprotection schemes. Disturbances on the
communications links need to be detected and reported so that appropriate actions can be taken to ensure that
the power system does not go unprotected.

5.1 ALARM MANAGEMENT


Due to the criticality of IM64 communications for correct scheme performance, there is an extensive regime to
monitor signal quality and integrity, generate and report alarms. For most applications, the alarm management
provided as standard will satisfy the needs of the scheme.
For some applications, it may be necessary customise the alarm management. You can do this with the
programmable scheme logic. This section provides a detailed explanation the communications alarm signals
integrated in this product.

5.2 ALARM LOGIC


The figures in the logic diagram section show the main alarm DDB signals associated with IM64. Some of the
signals are setting or hardware dependent. For example, Channel 2 alarms are not available on a simple two-
terminal single communications link application. This section explains the logic, allowing you to understand how
you might customise the alarm logic for your application.
The messages received on each channel are individually assessed for quality to ensure the IM64 signalling scheme
is available for use. If no messages are received for a period equal to the Channel Timeout setting or the signal
quality falls below a defined value, DDB signals are activated as shown in the IM64 channel fail and scheme fail
logic diagram.
Poor quality is indicated if the percentage of incomplete messages exceeds the IM Msg Alarm Lvl setting in a
100 ms period (rolling window), or if the communications propagation time of the IM64 message exceeds the Max
Ch PropDelay (assuming the Prop Delay Stats setting is Enabled), or if (in IEEE C37.94 configuration only, and not
shown on the diagram) the Ch Mux Clk flag has been raised to indicate an incorrect baud rate.
If either the Ch Timeout or the Ch Degraded signal persists in the alarmed state for more than the duration of the
Comm Fail Timer setting, according to the conditions set in the Comm Fail Mode setting, the Signalling Fail signal
is raised.
For two-ended schemes (including dual redundant schemes), the IM64 SchemeFail signal is generated at the same
time as the Signalling Fail signal. However, for three-terminal applications, the IM64 SchemeFail signal indicates
that the full set of signalling bits cannot be processed by the scheme. Due to the self-healing nature of the three-
terminal application, this occurs when both channels at any one terminal are not receiving valid signals. This
condition generates a flag in the IM64 message structure which is passed to both remote ends, as well as
generating the local IM64 SchemeFail signal. Using this method, in three-terminal applications the scheme fail
indication is raised at all three ends.
The scheme fail signalling is generated by the inability of a device to receive messages through communication
failure. The transmitting device only knows that communication to a remote device has failed if it receives
notification from the remote device. If a device in the scheme is put into test mode, the communication failure
information is not passed on to the remote ends. If the communications failure is bidirectional, there will be no
indication at the remote device. If this causes operational issues, it may be necessary to include other signals to
enable more precise indication of scheme failure.
In addition to the main IM64 channel fail and scheme fail conceptual logic, there are number of additional alarm
DDB signals associated with test modes, reconfiguration for 3-terminal schemes, and the communication mode
(‘Standard’ or ‘IEEE C37.94’) shown in the logic diagrams.
The majority of signals are associated with the ‘IEEE C37.94’ communications mode and are not activated if the
Standard communication mode is selected. The Comms Changed DDB logic is to show that switching between
the different communication modes requires a power cycle to be performed before the change is activated.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 487
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

5.3 TWO-ENDED SCHEME EXTENDED SUPERVISION


For two-terminal applications, the Signalling Fail and IM64 SchemeFail signals operate together. As such, the
basic indications available on each device should be considered as local-terminal indications only. If remote
indication is needed to assure scheme functionality, it is necessary to use additional signals to communicate the
status to the remote end. One method of performing this is shown below:

These inputs are user controls that indicate


when the signalling is locally switched out of
service

Opto 1

Control Input 1

1 IM64 Ch1 output 8


Test Loopback

Test IM64 IM64 Ch2 output 8

Non-
Signalling Fail & Latching
LED 8

IM64 Ch1 Input 8 Aided 1 COS/LGS


1
IM64 Ch2 Input 8

V02505

Figure 261: IM64 two-terminal scheme extended supervision

In this example scheme, several signals are used to permanently pass an IM64 signal to the remote terminal.
These signals take account of the local ability to receive IM64 messages, local test/loopback modes and any other
external methods of switching the signalling scheme out of service. If any of these driving signals are energised,
the IM64 message is reset (a “0” sent on IM64 bit 8). This causes both ends to raise an alarm (LED 8 in the example)
or switch the aided scheme out of service due to loss of channel.
This is intended only as an example. You may need to customise it for your application requirements.

5.4 THREE-ENDED SCHEME EXTENDED SUPERVISION


The example for an IM64 two-terminal scheme above can be used for three-terminal applications. However for
three-terminal applications, the IM64 SchemeFail signal that is automatically communicated to all ends of the
scheme is used rather than the Signalling Fail signal.

These inputs are user controls


that indicate when the signalling
is locally switched out of service

Opto 1

Control Input 1

1 IM64 Ch1 output 8


Test Loopback

Test IM64 IM64 Ch2 output 8

Non-
Signalling Fail & Latching
LED 8

IM64 Ch1 Input 8 Aided 1 COS/LGS


1
IM64 Ch2 Input 8

V02506

Figure 262: IM64 three-terminal scheme extended supervision

In this example if both channels at any one terminal fail to receive information, this is communicated to the other
terminals. An alarm is raised and the aided scheme is switched out of service. The example given above, also takes
into account the test modes and local switching, so the scheme is signalled out of service at all terminals if one
terminal is locally disabled.

488 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection

The logic presented above is intended only as an example. You may need to customise it for your application
requirements.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 489
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV

490 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 20

ELECTRICAL TELEPROTECTION
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

492 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 493
Introduction 494
Teleprotection Scheme Principles 495
Implementation 496
Configuration 497
Connecting to Electrical InterMiCOM 499
Application Notes 500

P446SV-TM-EN-1 493
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

2 INTRODUCTION
Electrical Teleprotection is an optional feature that uses communications links to create protection schemes. It can
be used to replace hard wiring between dedicated relay output contacts and digital input circuits. Two products
equipped with electrical teleprotection can connect and exchange commands using a communication link. It is
typically used to implement teleprotection schemes.
Using full duplex communications, eight binary command signals can be sent in each direction between
connected products. The communication connection complies with the EIA(RS)232 standard. Ports may be
connected directly, or using modems. Alternatively EIA(RS)232 converters can be used for connecting to other
media such as optical fibres.
Communications statistics and diagnostics enable you to monitor the integrity of the communications link, and a
loopback feature is available to help with testing.

494 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection

3 TELEPROTECTION SCHEME PRINCIPLES


Teleprotection schemes use signalling to convey a trip command to remote circuit breakers to isolate circuits.
Three types of teleprotection commands are commonly encountered:
● Direct Tripping
● Permissive Tripping
● Blocking Scheme

3.1 DIRECT TRIPPING


In direct tripping applications (often described by the generic term: “intertripping”), teleprotection signals are sent
directly to a master trip device. Receipt of a command causes circuit breaker operation without any further
qualification. Communication must be reliable and secure because any signal detected at the receiving end
causes a trip of the circuit at that end. The communications system must be designed so that interference on the
communication circuit does not cause spurious trips. If a spurious trip occurs, the primary system might be
unnecessarily isolated.

3.2 PERMISSIVE TRIPPING


Permissive trip commands are monitored by a protection device. The circuit breaker is tripped when receipt of the
command coincides with a ‘start’ condition being detected by the protection at the receiving. Requirements for the
communications channel are less onerous than for direct tripping schemes, since receipt of an incorrect signal
must coincide with a ‘start’ of the receiving end protection for a trip operation to take place. Permissive tripping is
used to speed up tripping for faults occurring within a protected zone.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 495
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

4 IMPLEMENTATION
Electrical InterMiCOM is configured using a combination of settings in the INTERMICOM COMMS column, settings in
the INTERMICOM CONF column, and the programmable scheme logic (PSL).
The eight command signals are mapped to DDB signals within the product using the PSL.
Signals being sent to a remote terminal are referenced in the PSL as IM Output 1 - IM Output 8. Signals received
from the remote terminal are referenced as IM Input 1 - IM Input 8.

Note:
As well as the optional Modem InterMiCOM, some products are available with a feature called InterMiCOM64 (IM64). The
functionality and assignment of commands in InterMiCOM and InterMiCOM64 are similar, but they act independently and are
configured independently.

496 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection

5 CONFIGURATION
Electrical Teleprotection is compliant with IEC 60834-1:1999. For your application, you can customise individual
command signals to the differing requirements of security, speed, and dependability as defined in this standard.
You customise the command signals using the IM# Cmd Type cell in the INTERMICOM CONF column.
Any command signal can be configured for:
● Direct intertripping by selecting ‘Direct’. (this is the most secure signalling but incurs a time delay to deliver
the security).
● Blocking applications by selecting ‘Blocking’. (this is the fastest signalling)
● Permissive intertripping applications by selecting ‘Permissive. (this is dependable signalling that balances
speed and security)

You can also select to ‘Disable’ the command.

Note:
When used in the context of a setting, ‘#’ specifies which command signal (1-8) bit is being configured.

To ensure that command signals are processed only by their intended recipient, the command signals are
packaged into a message (sometimes referred to as a telegram) which contains an address field. A sending device
sets a pattern in this field. A receiving device must be set to match this pattern in the address field before the
commands will be acted upon. 10 patterns have been carefully chosen for maximum security. You need to choose
which ones to use, and set them using the Source Address and Receive Address cells in the INTERMICOM COMMS
column.
The value set in the Source Address of the transmitting device should match that set in the Receive Address of the
receiving device. For example set Source Address to 1 at a local terminal and set Receive Address to 1 at the
remote terminal.
The Source Address and Receive Address settings in the device should be set to different values to avoid false
operation under inadvertent loopback conditions.
Where more than one pair of devices is likely to share a communication link, you should set each pair to use a
different pair of address values.
Electrical InterMiCOM has been designed to be resilient to noise on communications links, but during severe noise
conditions, the communication may fail. If this is the case, an alarm is raised and you can choose how the input
signals are managed using the IM# FallBackMode cell in the INTERMICOM CONF column:
• If you choose Latched, the last valid command to be received can be maintained until a new valid message is
received.
• If you choose Default, the signal will revert to a default value after the period defined in the IM#
FrameSyncTim setting has expired. You choose the default value using the IM# DefaultValue setting.
Subsequent receipt of a full valid message will reset the alarm, and the new command signals will be used.
As well as the settings described above, you will need to assign input and output signals in the Programmable
Scheme Logic (PSL). Use the ‘Integral Tripping’ buttons to create the logic you want to apply. A typical example is
shown below.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 497
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

E002521

Figure 263: Example assignment of InterMiCOM signals within the PSL

Note:
When an Electrical InterMiCOM signal is sent from a local terminal, only the remote terminal will react to the command. The
local terminal will only react to commands initiated at the remote terminal.

498 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection

6 CONNECTING TO ELECTRICAL INTERMICOM


Electrical InterMiCOM uses EIA(RS)232 communication presented on a 9-pin ‘D’ type connector. The connector is
labelled SK5 and is located at the bottom of the 2nd Rear communication board. The port is configured as
standard DTE (Data Terminating Equipment).

6.1 SHORT DISTANCE


EIA(RS)232 is suitable for short distance connections only - less than 15m. Where this limitation is not a problem,
direct connection between devices is possible. For this case, inter-device connections should be made as shown
below the figure below.

IED IED

DCD 1 1 DCD
RxD 2 2 RxD

TxD 3 3 TxD

DTR 4 4 DTR

GND 5 5 GND

6 6
RTS 7 7 RTS
8 8
9 9

E02522

Figure 264: Direct connection

For direct connection, the maximum baud rate can generally be used.

6.2 LONG DISTANCE


EIA(RS)232 is suitable for short distance connections only - less than 15m. Where this limitation is a problem, direct
connection between devices is not possible. For this case, inter-device connections should be made as shown
below the figure below.

IED Modem Modem IED


DCD 1 DCD DCD 1 DCD
RxD 2 RxD RxD 2 RxD
Communication
TxD 3 TxD TxD 3 TxD
Network
DTR 4 4 DTR
GND 5 GND GND 5 GND
6 6
RTS 7 7 RTS
8 8
9 9

E02523

Figure 265: Indirect connection using modems

This type of connection should be used when connecting to devices that have the ability to control the DCD line.
The baud rate should be chosen to be suitable for the communications network. If the Modem does not support
the DCD function, the DCD terminal on the IED should be connected to the DTR terminal.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 499
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

7 APPLICATION NOTES
Electrical InterMiCOM settings are contained within two columns; INTERMICOM COMMS and INTERMICOM CONF.
The INTERMICOM COMMS column contains all the settings needed to configure the communications, as well as the
channel statistics and diagnostic facilities. The INTERMICOM CONF column sets the mode of each command signal
and defines how they operate in case of signalling failure.
Short metallic direct connections and connections using fire-optic converters will generally be set to have the
highest signalling speed of 19200b/s. Due to this high signalling rate, the difference in operating time between the
direct, permissive, and blocking type signals is small. This means you can select the most secure signalling
command type (‘Direct’ intertrip) for all commands. You do this with the IM# Cmd Type settings. For these
applications you should set the IM# Fallback Mode to Default. You should also set a minimal intentional delay
by setting IM# FrameSyncTim to 10 msecs. This ensures that whenever two consecutive corrupt messages are
received, the command will immediately revert to the default value until a new valid message is received.
For applications that use Modem and/or multiplexed connections, the trade-off between speed, security, and
dependability is more critical. Choosing the fastest baud rate (data rate) to achieve maximum speed may appear
attractive, but this is likely to increase the cost of the telecommunications equipment. Also, telecommunication
services operating at high data rates are more prone to interference and suffer from longer re-synchronisation
times following periods of disruption. Taking into account these factors we recommend a maximum baud rate
setting of 9600 bps. As baud rates decrease, communications become more robust with fewer interruptions, but
overall signalling times increase.
At slower baud rates, the choice of signalling mode becomes significant. You should also consider what happens
during periods of noise when message structure and content can be lost.
● In ‘Blocking’ mode, the likelihood of receiving a command in a noisy environment is high. In this case, we
recommend you set IM# Fallback Mode to Default, with a reasonably long IM# FrameSyncTim setting.
Set IM# DefaultValue to ‘1’. This provides a substitute for a received blocking signal, applying a failsafe for
blocking schemes.
● In ‘Direct’ mode, the likelihood of receiving commands in a noisy environment is small. In this case, we
recommend you set IM# Fallback Mode to Default with a short IM# FrameSyncTim setting. Set IM#
DefaultValue to ‘0’. This means that if a corrupt message is received, InterMiCOM will use the default value.
This provides a substitute for the intertrip signal not being received, applying a failsafe for direct
intertripping schemes.
● In ‘Permissive’ mode, the likelihood of receiving a valid command under noisy communications conditions is
somwhere between that of the ‘Blocking’ mode and the ‘Direct’ intertrip mode. In this case, we
recommended you set IM# Fallback Mode to Latched.
The table below presents recommended IM# FrameSyncTim settings for the different signalling modes and baud
rates:
Minimum Recommended "IM# FrameSyncTim" Setting
Minimum Setting Maximum Setting
Baud Rate Direct Intertrip Mode Blocking Mode
(ms) (ms)
600 100 250 100 1500
1200 50 130 50 1500
2400 30 70 30 1500
4800 20 40 20 1500
9600 10 20 10 1500
19200 10 10 10 1500

500 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection

Note:
As we have recommended Latched operation, the table does not contain recommendations for ‘Permissive’ mode. However, if
you do select ‘Default’ mode, you should set IM# FrameSyncTim greater than those listed above. If you set IM#
FrameSyncTim lower than the minimum setting listed above, the device could interpret a valid change in a message as a
corrupted message.

We recommend a setting of 25% for the communications failure alarm.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 501
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV

502 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 21

COMMUNICATIONS
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

504 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This product supports Substation Automation System (SAS), and Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition (SCADA)
communication. The support embraces the evolution of communications technologies that have taken place since
microprocessor technologies were introduced into protection, control, and monitoring devices which are now
ubiquitously known as Intelligent Electronic Devices for the substation (IEDs).
As standard, all products support rugged serial communications for SCADA and SAS applications. By option, any
product can support Ethernet communications for more advanced SCADA and SAS applications.

This chapter contains the following sections:


Chapter Overview 505
Communication Interfaces 506
Serial Communication 507
Standard Ethernet Communication 510
Redundant Ethernet Communication 511
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) 533
Data Protocols 540
Read Only Mode 569
Time Synchronisation 571

P446SV-TM-EN-1 505
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

2 COMMUNICATION INTERFACES
The products have a number of standard and optional communication interfaces. The standard and optional
hardware and protocols are summarised below:
Port Availability Physical layer Use Data Protocols
Front Standard RS232 Local settings Courier
Rear Port 1 RS232 / RS485 / K- SCADA Courier, MODBUS, IEC60870-5-103, DNP3.0
Standard
(RP1 copper) Bus Remote settings (order option)
Rear Port 1 SCADA Courier, MODBUS, IEC60870-5-103, DNP3.0
Optional Fibre
(RP1 fibre) Remote settings (order option)
Rear Port 2 RS232 / RS485 / K- SCADA SK4: Courier only
Optional
(RP2) Bus Remote settings SK5: InterMicom only
IEC 61850 or DNP3 IEC 61850, Courier (tunnelled) or DNP3.0
Ethernet Optional Ethernet
Remote settings (order option)

Note:
Optional communications boards are always fitted into slot A.

Note:
It is only possible to fit one optional communications board, therefore RP2 and Ethernet communications are mutually
exclusive.

506 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

3 SERIAL COMMUNICATION
The physical layer standards that are used for serial communications for SCADA purposes are:
● EIA(RS)485 (often abbreviated to RS485)
● K-Bus (a proprietary customization of RS485)

EIA(RS)232 is used for local communication with the IED (for transferring settings and downloading firmware
updates).
RS485 is similar to RS232 but for longer distances and it allows daisy-chaining and multi-dropping of IEDs.
K-Bus is a proprietary protocol quite similar to RS485, but it cannot be mixed on the same link as RS485. Unlike
RS485, K-Bus signals applied across two terminals are not polarised.
It is important to note that these are not data protocols. They only describe the physical characteristics required
for two devices to communicate with each other.
For a description of the K-Bus standard see K-Bus (on page508) and General Electric's K-Bus interface guide
reference R6509.
A full description of the RS485 is available in the published standard.

3.1 EIA(RS)232 BUS


The EIA(RS)232 interface uses the IEC 60870-5 FT1.2 frame format.
The device supports an IEC 60870-5 FT1.2 connection on the front-port. This is intended for temporary local
connection and is not suitable for permanent connection. This interface uses a fixed baud rate of 19200 bps, 11-bit
frame (8 data bits, 1 start bit, 1 stop bit, even parity bit), and a fixed device address of '1'.
EIA(RS)232 interfaces are polarised.

3.2 EIA(RS)485 BUS


The RS485 two-wire connection provides a half-duplex, fully isolated serial connection to the IED. The connection is
polarized but there is no agreed definition of which terminal is which. If the master is unable to communicate with
the product, and the communication parameters match, then it is possible that the two-wire connection is
reversed.
The RS485 bus must be terminated at each end with 120 Ω 0.5 W terminating resistors between the signal wires.
The RS485 standard requires that each device be directly connected to the actual bus. Stubs and tees are
forbidden. Loop bus and Star topologies are not part of the RS485 standard and are also forbidden.
Two-core screened twisted pair cable should be used. The final cable specification is dependent on the application,
although a multi-strand 0.5 mm2 per core is normally adequate. The total cable length must not exceed 1000 m. It
is important to avoid circulating currents, which can cause noise and interference, especially when the cable runs
between buildings. For this reason, the screen should be continuous and connected to ground at one end only,
normally at the master connection point.
The RS485 signal is a differential signal and there is no signal ground connection. If a signal ground connection is
present in the bus cable then it must be ignored. At no stage should this be connected to the cable's screen or to
the product’s chassis. This is for both safety and noise reasons.
It may be necessary to bias the signal wires to prevent jabber. Jabber occurs when the signal level has an
indeterminate state because the bus is not being actively driven. This can occur when all the slaves are in receive
mode and the master is slow to turn from receive mode to transmit mode. This may be because the master is
waiting in receive mode, in a high impedance state, until it has something to transmit. Jabber causes the receiving
device(s) to miss the first bits of the first character in the packet, which results in the slave rejecting the message
and consequently not responding. Symptoms of this are; poor response times (due to retries), increasing message
error counts, erratic communications, and in the worst case, complete failure to communicate.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 507
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

3.2.1 EIA(RS)485 BIASING REQUIREMENTS


Biasing requires that the signal lines be weakly pulled to a defined voltage level of about 1 V. There should only be
one bias point on the bus, which is best situated at the master connection point. The DC source used for the bias
must be clean to prevent noise being injected.

Note:
Some devices may be able to provide the bus bias, in which case external components would not be required.

6 – 9 V DC
180 Ω bias

Master 120 Ω

180 Ω bias
0V 120 Ω

Slave Slave Slave

V01000

Figure 266: RS485 biasing circuit

Warning:
It is extremely important that the 120 Ω termination resistors are fitted. Otherwise
the bias voltage may be excessive and may damage the devices connected to the
bus.

3.3 K-BUS
K-Bus is a robust signalling method based on RS485 voltage levels. K-Bus incorporates message framing, based on
a 64 kbps synchronous HDLC protocol with FM0 modulation to increase speed and security.
The rear interface is used to provide a permanent connection for K-Bus, which allows multi-drop connection.
A K-Bus spur consists of up to 32 IEDs connected together in a multi-drop arrangement using twisted pair wiring.
The K-Bus twisted pair connection is non-polarised.
It is not possible to use a standard EIA(RS)232 to EIA(RS)485 converter to convert IEC 60870-5 FT1.2 frames to K-
Bus. A protocol converter, namely the KITZ101, KITZ102 or KITZ201, must be used for this purpose. Please consult
General Electric for information regarding the specification and supply of KITZ devices. The following figure
demonstrates a typical K-Bus connection.

508 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

IED IED IED

RS232 K-Bus

Computer RS232-USB converter KITZ protocol converter

V01001

Figure 267: Remote communication using K-Bus

Note:
An RS232-USB converter is only needed if the local computer does not provide an RS232 port.

Further information about K-Bus is available in the publication R6509: K-Bus Interface Guide, which is available on
request.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 509
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

4 STANDARD ETHERNET COMMUNICATION


The type of Ethernet board depends on the chosen model. The available boards and their features are described in
the Hardware Design chapter of this manual.
The Ethernet interface is required for either IEC 61850 or DNP3 over Ethernet (protocol must be selected at time of
order). With either of these protocols, the Ethernet interface also offers communication with the settings
application software for remote configuration and record extraction.
Fibre optic connection is recommended for use in permanent connections in a substation environment, as it offers
advantages in terms of noise rejection. The fibre optic port provides 100 Mbps communication and uses type
BFOC 2.5 (ST) connectors. Fibres should be suitable for 1300 nm transmission and be multimode 50/125 µm or
62.5/125 µm.
Connection can also be made to a 10Base-T or a 100Base-TX Ethernet switch using the RJ45 port.

4.1 HOT-STANDBY ETHERNET FAILOVER


This is used for products which are fitted with a standard Ethernet board. The standard Ethernet board has one
fibre and one copper interface. If there is a fault on the fibre channel it can switch to the copper channel, or vice
versa.
When this function detects a link failure, it generates the NIC Fail Alarm. The failover timer then starts, which has a
settable timeout. During this time, the Hot Standby Failover function continues to check the status of the other
channel. If the link failure recovers before the failover timer times out, the channels are not swapped over. If there
is still a fail when the failover timer times out and the other channel status is ok, the channels are swapped over.
The Ethernet controller is then reconfigured and the link is renegotiated.
To set the function, use the IEC 61850 Configurator tool in the Settings Application Software.

510 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

5 REDUNDANT ETHERNET COMMUNICATION


Redundancy is required where a single point of failure cannot be tolerated. It is required in critical applications
such as substation automation. Redundancy acts as an insurance policy, providing an alternative route if one
route fails.
Ethernet communication redundancy is available for most General Electric products, using a Redundant Ethernet
Board (REB). The REB is a Network Interface Card (NIC), which incorporates an integrated Ethernet switch. The
board provides two Ethernet transmitter/receiver pairs.
By ordering option, a number of different protocols are available to provide the redundancy according to particular
system requirements.
In addition to the two Ethernet transmitter/receiver pairs, the REB provides link activity indication in the form of
LEDs, link fail indication in the form of watchdog contacts, and a dedicated time synchronisation input.
The dedicated time synchronisation input is designed to connect to an IRIG-B signal. Both modulated and un-
modulated IRIG-B formats are supported according to the selected option. Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) is
supported over the Ethernet communications.

5.1 SUPPORTED PROTOCOLS


A range of Redundant Ethernet Boards are available to support different protocols for different requirements. One
of the key requirements of substation redundant communications is "bumpless" redundancy. This means the
ability to transfer from one communication path to another without noticeable consequences. Standard protocols
of the time could not meet the demanding requirements of network availability for substation automation
solutions. Switch-over times were unacceptably long. For this reason, companies developed proprietary protocols.
More recently, however, standard protocols, which support bumpless redundancy (namely PRP and HSR) have
been developed and ratified.
As well as supporting standard non-bumpless protocols such as RSTP, the REB was originally designed to support
bumpless redundancy, using proprietary protocols (SHP, DHP) before the standard protocols became available.
Since then, variants have been produced for the newer standard protocols.
REB variants for each of the following protocols are available:
● PRP (Parallel Redundancy Protocol)
● HSR (High-availability Seamless Redundancy)
● RSTP (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol)
● SHP (Self-Healing Protocol)
● DHP (Dual Homing Protocol)

PRP and HSR are open standards, so their implementation is compatible with any standard PRP or HSR device
respectively. PRP provides "bumpless" redundancy. RSTP is also an open standard, so its implementation is
compatible with any standard RSTP devices. RSTP provides redundancy, however, it is not "bumpless".
SHP and DHP are proprietary protocols intended for use with specific General Electric products:
● SHP is compatible with the C264-SWR212 as well as H35x multimode switches.
● DHP is compatible with the C264-SWD212 as well as H36x multimode switches.

Both SHP and DHP provide "bumpless" redundancy.

Note:
The protocol you require must be selected at the time of ordering.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 511
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

5.2 PARALLEL REDUNDANCY PROTOCOL


PRP (Parallel Reundancy Protocol) is defined in IEC 62439-3. PRP provides bumpless redundancy and meets the
most demanding needs of substation automation. The PRP implementation of the REB is compatible with any
standard PRP device.
PRP uses two independent Ethernet networks operating in parallel. PRP systems are designed so that there should
be no common point of failure between the two networks, so the networks have independent power sources and
are not connected together directly.
Devices designed for PRP applications have two ports attached to two separate networks and are called Doubly
Attached Nodes (DAN). A DAN has two ports, one MAC address and one IP address.
The sending node replicates each frame and transmits them over both networks. The receiving node processes the
frame that arrives first and discards the duplicate. Therefore there is no distinction between the working and
backup path. The receiving node checks that all frames arrive in sequence and that frames are correctly received
on both ports.
Devices such as printers that have a single Ethernet port can be connected to either of the networks but will not
directly benefit from the PRP principles. Such devices are called Singly Attached Nodes (SAN). For devices with a
single Ethernet port that need to connect to both LANs, this can be achieved by employing Ethernet Redundancy
Boxes (sometimes abbreviated to RedBox). Devices with a single Ethernet port that connect to both LANs by
means of a RedBox are known as Virtual DAN (VDAN).
The figure below summarises DAN, SAN, VDAN, LAN, and RedBox connectivity.

DAN DAN

SAN DAN

LAN B

LAN A

REDUNDANCY
BOX

VDAN

VDAN SAN SAN

VDAN

E01028

Figure 268: IED attached to separate LANs

In a DAN, both ports share the same MAC address so it does not affect the way devices talk to each other in an
Ethernet network (Address Resolution Protocol at layer 2). Every data frame is seen by both ports.
When a DAN sends a frame of data, the frame is duplicated on both ports and therefore on both LAN segments.
This provides a redundant path for the data frame if one of the segments fails. Under normal conditions, both LAN
segments are working and each port receives identical frames.

512 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

5.3 HIGH-AVAILABILITY SEAMLESS REDUNDANCY (HSR)


HSR is standardized in IEC 62439-3 (clause 5) for use in ring topology networks. Similar to PRP, HSR provides
bumpless redundancy and meets the most demanding needs of substation automation. HSR has become the
reference standard for ring-topology networks in the substation environment. The HSR implementation of the
redundancy Ethernet board (REB) is compatible with any standard HSR device.
HSR works on the premise that each device connected in the ring is a doubly attached node running HSR (referred
to as DANH). Similar to PRP, singly attached nodes such as printers are connected via Ethernet Redundancy Boxes
(RedBox).

5.3.1 HSR MULTICAST TOPOLOGY


When a DANH is sending a multicast frame, the frame (C frame) is duplicated (A frame and B frame), and each
duplicate frame A/B is tagged with the destination MAC address and the sequence number. The frames A and B
differ only in their sequence number, which is used to identify one frame from the other. Each frame is sent to the
network via a separate port. The destination DANH receives two identical frames, removes the HSR tag of the first
frame received and passes this (frame D) on for processing. The other duplicate frame is discarded. The nodes
forward frames from one port to the other unless it was the node that injected it into the ring.

Source

DANH DANH Redbox Switch

D frame C frame D frame


A frame B frame

Singly Attached
Nodes

D frame D frame D frame

DANH DANH DANH


V01030

Figure 269: HSR multicast topology

Only about half of the network bandwidth is available in HSR for multicast or broadcast frames because both
duplicate frames A & B circulate the full ring.

5.3.2 HSR UNICAST TOPOLOGY


With unicast frames, there is just one destination and the frames are sent to that destination alone. All non-
recipient devices simply pass the frames on. They do not process them in any way. In other words, D frames are
produced only for the receiving DANH. This is illustrated below.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 513
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Source

DANH DANH Redbox Switch

C frame
A frame B frame

Singly Attached
Nodes

D frame

DANH DANH DANH

Destination V01031

Figure 270: HSR unicast topology

For unicast frames, the whole bandwidth is available as both frames A & B stop at the destination node.

5.3.3 HSR APPLICATION IN THE SUBSTATION

514 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

T1000 switch

PC SCADA

DS Agile gateways

Px4x H49 H49 H49 Px4x

Px4x Px4x Px4x Px4x Px4x Px4x

Bay 1 Bay 2 Bay 3


E01066

Figure 271: HSR application in the substation

5.4 RAPID SPANNING TREE PROTOCOL


RSTP is a standard used to quickly reconnect a network fault by finding an alternative path. It stops network loops
whilst enabling redundancy. It can be used in star or ring connections as shown in the following figure.

Switch 1 Switch 2 Switch 1 Switch 2

IED 1 IED 2 IED 1 IED 2

Star connection with redundant ports Ring connection managed by RST P


managed by RSTP blocking function . blocking function on upper switches
and IEDs interconnected directly .
V01010

Figure 272: IED attached to redundant Ethernet star or ring circuit

The RSTP implementation in this product is compatible with any devices that use RSTP.
RSTP can recover network faults quickly, but the fault recovery time depends on the number of devices on the
network and the network topology. A typical figure for the fault recovery time is 300ms. Therefore, RSTP cannot
achieve the “bumpless” redundancy that some other protocols can.
Refer to IEEE 802.1D 2004 standard for detailed information about the opration of the protocol.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 515
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

5.5 SELF HEALING PROTOCOL


The Self-Healing Protocol (SHP) implemented in the REB is a proprietary protocol that responds to the constraints
of critical time applications such as the GOOSE messaging of IEC 61850.
It is designed, primarily, to be used on PACiS Substation Automation Systems that employ the C264-SWR212
and/or H35x switches.
SHP is applied to double-ring network topologies. If adjacent devices detect a break in the ring, then they re-route
communication traffic to restore communication as outlined in the figure below.

MiCOM MiCOM
H35 H35

C264 Px4x C264 Px4x

DS Agile Ethernet DS Agile Ethernet


IEC 61850 ring network IEC 61850 ring network
under normal conditions self healed

Px4x Px4x

E01011

Figure 273: IED, bay computer and Ethernet switch with self healing ring facilities

A Self-Healing Management function (SHM) manages the ring.


Under healthy conditions, frames are sent on the main ring (primary fibre) in one direction, with short check frames
being sent every 5 μs in the opposite direction on the back-up ring (secondary fibre).
If the main ring breaks, the SHMs at either side of the break start the network self-healing. On one side of the
break, received messages are no longer sent to the main ring, but are sent to the back-up ring instead. On the
other side of the break, messages received on the back-up ring are sent to the main ring and communications are
re-established. This takes place in less than 1 ms and can be described as “bumpless”.
The principle of SHP is outlined in the figures below.

Primary Fibre

1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3

Switch Rx (Ep) Tx (Ep) Switch Switch

A B C D E

Tx (Es) Rx (Rs)
Hx5x IED C264 IED Hx5x

Secondary Fibre
V01013

Figure 274: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches

516 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Primary Fibre

1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3

Switch Rx (Ep) Tx (Ep) Switch Switch

A B C D E

Tx (Es) Rx (Rs)
Hx5x IED C264 IED Hx5x

Secondary Fibre
V01014

Figure 275: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches after failure

5.6 DUAL HOMING PROTOCOL


The Dual Homing Protocol (DHP) implemented in the REB is a proprietary protocol. It is designed, primarily to be
used on PACiS systems that employ the C264-SWD212 and/or H36x multimode switches.
DHP addresses the constraints of critical time applications such as the GOOSE messaging of IEC 61850.
DHP is applied to double-star network topologies. If a connection between two devices is broken, the network
continues to operate correctly.
The Dual Homing Manager (DHM) handles topologies where a device is connected to two independent networks,
one being the "main" path, the other being the "backup" path. Both are active at the same time.
Internet frames from a sending device are sent by the DHM to both networks. Receiving devices apply a “duplicate
discard” principle. This means that when both networks are operational, the REB receives two copies of the same
Ethernet frame. If both links are healthy, frames are received on both, and the DHM uses the first frame received.
The second frame is discarded. If one link fails, frames received on the healthy link are used.
DHP delivers a typical recovery time of less than 1 ms. The mechanism is outlined in the figures below.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 517
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Network 1 Network 2

Optical star Optical star


Alstom Alstom
H63x H63x

Dual homing Dual homing Dual homing


SWD21x SWD21x SWD21x

IED IED IED IED IED IED IED IED

Modified frames from network 1


Modified frames from network 2
No modified frames
V01015

Figure 276: Dual homing mechanism

The H36x is a repeater with a standard 802.3 Ethernet switch, plus the DHM.

518 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

MiCOM H382

SCADA or PACiS OI

DS Agile gateways

H600 switch H600 switch

Ethernet
Up to
6 links C264 *

C264 H368 Px4x **


Ethernet
Up to
4 links

RS485

Bay level Bay level Bay level


Type 1 Type 2 Type 3

TX copper link
FX optical fibre Ethernet
E01017 RS485, RS422
* For PRP this is SRP, for DHP this is SWD
** For PRP this is PRP REB, for DHP this is DHP REB

Figure 277: Application of Dual Homing Star at substation level

5.7 CONFIGURING IP ADDRESSES


An IP address is a logical address assigned to devices in a computer network that uses the Internet Protocol (IP) for
communication between nodes. IP addresses are stored as binary numbers but they are represented using
Decimal Dot Notation, where four sets of decimal numbers are separated by dots as follows:
XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
For example:
10.86.254.85
An IP address in a network is usually associated with a subnet mask. The subnet mask defines which network the
device belongs to. A subnet mask has the same form as an IP address.
For example:
255.255.255.0
Both the IED and the REB each have their own IP address. The following diagram shows the IED as IP1 and the REB
as IP2.

Note:
IP1 and IP2 are different but use the same subnet mask.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 519
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

The switch IP address must be configured through the Ethernet network.

Set by IED Configurator

IED (IP1) AAA.BBB.CCC.DDD

REB (IP2) WWW.XXX.YYY.ZZZ

Set by Hardware Dip Switch SW2 for SHP, DHP, or RSTP


Set by Switch Manager for SHP and DHP Set by PRP/HSR Configurator for PRP or HSR
Set by RSTP Configurator for RSTP
Set by PRP/HSR Configurator for PRP or HSR Fixed at 254 for SHP or DHP
Set by PRP/HSR/RSTP Configurator for PRP, HSR or RSTP
V01018

Figure 278: IED and REB IP address configuration

5.7.1 CONFIGURING THE IED IP ADDRESS


If you are using IEC 61850, set the IED IP address using the IEC 61850 Configurator software. In the IEC 61850
Configurator, set Media to Single Copper or Redundant Fibre.
If you are using DNP3 over Ethernet, set the IED IP address by editing the DNP3 file, using the DNP3 Configurator
software. In the DNP3 Configurator, set Ethernet Media to Copper, even though the redundant Ethernet network
uses fibre optic cables.

5.7.2 CONFIGURING THE REB IP ADDRESS


The board IP address must be configured before connecting the IED to the network to avoid an IP address conflict.
The way you configure the IP address depends on the redundancy protocol you have chosen.

PRP/HSR
If using PRP or HSR, you configure the REB IP address using the PRP/HSR Configurator software.

RSTP
If using RSTP, you configure the REB IP address using the PRP/HSR Configurator software.

SHP or DHP
If using SHP or DHP the first two octets are set by the Switch Manager software or an SNMP MIB browser. The third
octet is fixed at 254 (FE hex, 11111110 binary), and the fourth octet is set by the on-board dip switch.

Note:
An H35 (SHP) or H36 (DHP) network device is needed in the network to configure the REB IP address if you are using SNMP.

5.7.2.1 CONFIGURING THE LAST OCTET (SHP, DHP, RSTP)


If using SHP or DHP, the last octet is configured using board address switch SW2 on the board. Remove the IED
front cover to gain access to the board address switch.

Warning:
Configure the hardware settings before the device is installed.

1. Refer to the safety section of the IED.


2. Switch off the IED. Disconnect the power and all connections.

520 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

3. Before removing the front cover, take precautions to prevent electrostatic discharge damage according to
the ANSI/ESD-20.20 -2007 standard.
4. Wear a 1 MΩ earth strap and connect it to the earth (ground) point on the back of the IED.

E01019

5. Lift the upper and lower flaps. Remove the six screws securing the front panel and pull the front panel
outwards.

E01020

P446SV-TM-EN-1 521
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

6. Press the levers either side of the connector to disconnect the ribbon cable from the front panel.

E01021

7. Remove the redundant Ethernet board. Set the last octet of IP address using the DIP switches. The available
range is 1 to 127.

1 Example address 1 + 4 + 16 + 64 = 85
2 decimal 85
4
8
16
32
64
Unused
ON
V01022 SW2 Top view

8. Once you have set the IP address, reassemble the IED, following theses instructions in the reverse order.

Warning:
Take care not to damage the pins of the ribbon cable connector on the front panel when reinserting
the ribbon cable.

5.8 PRP/HSR CONFIGURATOR


The PRP/HSR Configurator tool is intended for MiCOM Px4x IEDs with redundant Ethernet using PRP (Parallel
Redundancy Protocol), or HSR (High-availability Seamless Redundancy). This tool is used to identify IEDs, switch

522 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

between PRP and HSR or configure their parameters, configure the redundancy IP address, or configure the SNTP
IP address.

5.8.1 CONNECTING THE IED TO A PC


Connect the IED to the PC on which the Configurator tool is used. This connection is done through an Ethernet
switch or through a media converter.

RJ45

Ethernet switch
Media
Converter
TXA RXA TXB RXB

TX RX

RXA TXA RXB TXB RXA TXA RXB TXB

IED IED

(a) (b)
V01806

Figure 279: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter

5.8.2 INSTALLING THE CONFIGURATOR


To install the configurator:
1. Double click the WinPcap installer.
2. Double click the Configurator installer.
3. Click Next and follow the on-screen instructions.

5.8.3 STARTING THE CONFIGURATOR


To start the configurator:
1. Select the Configurator from the Windows Programs menu.
2. The Login screen appears. For user mode login, enter the Login name as User and click OK with no
password.
3. If the login screen does not appear, check all network connections.
4. The main window appears. In the bottom right-hand corner of the main window, click the Language button
to select the language.
5. The Network Board drop-down list shows the Network Board, IP Address and MAC Address of the PC in
which the Configurator is running.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 523
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

5.8.4 PRP/HSR DEVICE IDENTIFICATION


To configure the redundant Ethernet board, go to the main window and click the Identify Device button. A list of
devices are shown with the following details:
● Device address
● MAC address
● Version number of the firmware
● SNTP IP address
● Date & time of the real-time clock, from the board.

Select the device you wish to configure. The MAC address of the selected device is highlighted.

5.8.5 SELECTING THE DEVICE MODE


You must now select the device mode that you wish to use. This will be either PRP or HSR. To do this, select the
appropriate radio button then click the Update button. You will be asked to confirm a device reboot. Click OK to
confirm.

5.8.6 PRP/HSR IP ADDRESS CONFIGURATION


To change the network address component of the IP address:
1. From the main window click the IP Config button. The Device setup screen appears.
2. Enter the required board IP address and click OK. This is the redundancy network address, not the IEC 61850
IP address.
3. The board network address is updated and displayed in the main window.

5.8.7 SNTP IP ADDRESS CONFIGURATION


To Configure the SNTP server IP address:
1. From the main window click the SNTP Config button. The Device setup screen appears.
2. Enter the required MAC SNTP address and server IP SNTP Address. Click OK.
3. The updated MAC and IP SNTP addresses appear in the main screen.

5.8.8 CHECK FOR CONNECTED EQUIPMENT


To check what devices are connected to the device being monitored:
1. From the main window, select the device.
2. Click the Equipment button.
3. At the bottom of the main window, a box shows the ports where devices are connected and their MAC
addresses.

5.8.9 PRP CONFIGURATION


To view or configure the PRP Parameters:
1. Ensure that you have set the device mode to PRP.
2. Click the PRP/HSR Config button. The PRP Config screen appears.
3. To view the available parameters, click the Get PRP Parameters button.
4. To change the parameters, click the Set Parameters button and modify their values.
If you need to restore the default values of the parameters, click the Restore Defaults button.

524 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

The configurable parameters are as follows:


● Multicast Address: Use this field to configure the multicast destination address. All DANPs in the network
must be configured to operate with the same multicast address for the purpose of network supervision.
● Node Forget Time: This is the time after which a node entry is cleared in the nodes table.
● Life Check Interval: This defines how often a node sends a PRP_Supervision frame. All DANPs shall be
configured with the same Life Check Interval.

5.8.10 HSR CONFIGURATION


To view or configure the HSR Parameters:
1. Click the PRP/HSR Config button. The HSR Config screen appears.
2. To view the available parameters in the board that is connected, click the Retrieve HSR Parameters from
IED button.
3. To change the parameters, click the Set Parameters button and modify their values.
If you need to restore the default values of the parameters, click the Restore Defaults button.
The configurable parameters are as follows:
● Multicast Address: Use this field to configure the multicast destination address. All DANPs in the network
must be configured to operate with the same multicast address for the purpose of network supervision.
● Node Forget Time: This is the time after which a node entry is cleared in the nodes table.
● Life Check Interval: This defines how often a node sends a PRP_Supervision frame. All DANPs must be
configured with the same Life Check Interval.
● Proxy Node Table Forget Time: This is the time after which a node entry is cleared in the ProxyTable
● Proxy Node Table Max Entries: This is the maximum number of entries in the ProxyTable
● Entry Forget Time: This is the time after which an entry is removed from the duplicates
● Node Reboot Interval: This is the minimum time during which a node that reboots remains silent

5.8.11 FILTERING DATABASE


The Filtering Database is used to determine how frames are forwarded or filtered across the on-board Ethernet
switch. Filtering information specifies the set of ports to which frames received from a specific port are forwarded.
The Ethernet switch examines each received frame to see if the frame's destination address matches a source
address listed in the Filtering Database. If there is a match, the device uses the filtering/forwarding information for
that source address to determine how to forward or filter the frame. Otherwise the frame is forwarded to all the
ports in the Ethernet switch (broadcast).

General tab
The Filtering Database contains two types of entry; static and dynamic. The Static Entries are the source addresses
entered by an administrator. The Dynamic Entries are the source addresses learnt by the switch process. The
Dynamic Entries are removed from the Filtering Database after the Ageing Time. The Database holds a maximum
of 1024 entries.
1. To access the forwarding database functions, if required, click the Filtering Database button in the main
window.
2. To view the Forwarding Database Size, Number of Static Entries and Number of Dynamic Entries, click Read
Database Info.
3. To set the Aging Time, enter the number of seconds in the text box and click the Set button.

Filtering Entries tab


The Filtering Database configuration pages are used to view, add or delete entries from the Filtering Database. This
feature is available only for the administrator. This Filtering Database is mainly used during the testing to verify the

P446SV-TM-EN-1 525
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

PRP/HSR functionality. To add an entry in the forwarding database, click the Filtering Entries tab. Configure as
follows:
1. Select the Port Number and MAC Address
2. Set the Entry type (Dynamic or Static)
3. Set the cast type (Unicast or Multicast)
4. Set theMGMT and Rate Limit
5. Click the Create button. The new entry appears in the forwarding database.
To delete an entry from the forwarding database, select the entry and click the Delete Entry button.

Goose Filtering tab


This page configures the source MACs from which GOOSE messages will be allowed or blocked. The filtering can be
configured by either the MAC address range boxes or by selecting or unselecting the individual MAC addresses in
the MAC table. After you have defined the addresses to be allowed or blocked you need to update the table and
apply the filter:
● Update Table: This updates the MAC table according to the filtering range entered in the MAC address
range boxes.
● Apply Filter: This applies the filtering configuration in the MAC table to the HSR/PRP board.

5.8.12 END OF SESSION


To finish the session:
1. In the main window, click the Quit button, a new screen appears.
2. If a database backup is required, click Yes, a new screen appears.
3. Click the ... button to browse the path. Enter the name in the text box.

5.9 RSTP CONFIGURATOR


The RSTP Configurator tool is intended for MiCOM Px4x IEDs with redundant Ethernet using RSTP (Rapid Spanning
Tree Protocol). This tool is used to identify IEDs, configure the redundancy IP address, configure the SNTP IP
address and configure the RSTP parameters.

5.9.1 CONNECTING THE IED TO A PC


Connect the IED to the PC on which the Configurator tool is used. This connection is done through an Ethernet
switch or through a media converter.

526 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

RJ45

Ethernet switch
Media
Converter
TX1 RX1 TX2 RX2

TX RX

RX1 TX1 RX2 TX2 RX1 TX1 RX2 TX2

IED IED

(a) (b)
V01803

Figure 280: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter

5.9.2 INSTALLING THE CONFIGURATOR


To install the configurator:
1. Double click the WinPcap installer.
2. Double click the Configurator installer.
3. Click Next and follow the on-screen instructions.

5.9.3 STARTING THE CONFIGURATOR


To start the configurator:
1. Select the Configurator from the Windows Programs menu.
2. The Login screen appears. For user mode login, enter the Login name as User and click OK with no
password.
3. If the login screen does not appear, check all network connections.
4. The main window appears. In the bottom right-hand corner of the main window, click the Language button
to select the language.
5. The Network Board drop-down list shows the Network Board, IP Address and MAC Address of the PC in
which the Configurator is running.

5.9.4 RSTP DEVICE IDENTIFICATION


To configure the redundant Ethernet board, go to the main window and click Identify Device.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 527
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Note:
Due to the time needed to establish the RSTP protocol, wait 25 seconds between connecting the PC to the IED and clicking the
Identify Device button.

The redundant Ethernet board connected to the PC is identified and its details are listed.
● Device address
● MAC address
● Version number of the firmware
● SNTP IP address
● Date & time of the real-time clock, from the board.

5.9.5 RSTP IP ADDRESS CONFIGURATION


To change the network address component of the IP address,
1. From the main window click the IP Config button.
2. The Device Setup screen appears showing the IP Base Address. This is the board redundancy network
address, not the IEC 61850 IP address.
3. Enter the required board IP address.
4. Click OK. The board network address is updated and displayed in the main window.

5.9.6 SNTP IP ADDRESS CONFIGURATION


To Configure the SNTP server IP address:
1. From the main window click the SNTP Config button. The Device setup screen appears.
2. Enter the required MAC SNTP address and server IP SNTP Address. Click OK.
3. The updated MAC and IP SNTP addresses appear in the main screen.

5.9.7 CHECK FOR CONNECTED EQUIPMENT


To check what devices are connected to the device being monitored:
1. From the main window, select the device.
2. Click the Equipment button.
3. At the bottom of the main window, a box shows the ports where devices are connected and their MAC
addresses.

5.9.8 RSTP CONFIGURATION


1. To view or configure the RSTP Bridge Parameters, from the main window, click the device address to select
the device. The selected device MAC address appears highlighted.
2. Click the RSTP Config button. The RSTP Config screen appears.
3. To view the available parameters in the board that is connected, click the Get RSTP Parameters button.
4. To set the configurable parameters such as Bridge Max Age, Bridge Hello Time, Bridge Forward Delay, and
Bridge Priority, modify the parameter values according to the following table and click Set RSTP
Parameters.

Maximum value
S.No Parameter Default value (second) Minimum value (second)
(second)
1 Bridge Max Age 20 6 40
2 Bridge Hello Time 2 1 10

528 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Maximum value
S.No Parameter Default value (second) Minimum value (second)
(second)
3 Bridge Forward Delay 15 4 30
4 Bridge Priority 32768 0 61440

5.9.8.1 BRIDGE PARAMETERS


To read the RSTP bridge parameters from the board,
1. From the main window click the device address to select the device. The RSTP Config window appears and
the default tab is Bridge Parameters.
2. Click the Get RSTP Parameters button. This displays all the RSTP bridge parameters from the Ethernet
board.
3. To modify the RSTP parameters, enter the values and click Set RSTP Parameters.
4. To restore the default values, click Restore Default and click Set RSTP Parameters.
The grayed parameters are read-only and cannot be modified.

Note:
When assigning the bridge priority, make sure the root of the network is the Ethernet switch, not the IEDs. This reduces the
number of hops to reach all devices in the network. Also make sure the priority values for all IEDs are higher than that of the
switch.

5.9.8.2 PORT PARAMETERS


This function is useful if you need to view the parameters of each port.
1. From the main window, click the device address to select the device. The RSTP Config window appears.
2. Select the Port Parameters tab, then click Get Parameters to read the port parameters. Alternatively, select
the port numbers to read the parameters.

5.9.8.3 PORT STATES


This is used to see which ports of the board are enabled or disabled.
1. From the main window, click the device address to select the device. The RSTP Config window appears.
2. Select the Port States tab then click the Get Port States button. This lists the ports of the Ethernet board. A
tick shows they are enabled.

5.9.9 END OF SESSION


To finish the session:
1. In the main window, click the Quit button, a new screen appears.
2. If a database backup is required, click Yes, a new screen appears.
3. Click the ... button to browse the path. Enter the name in the text box.

5.10 SWITCH MANAGER


Switch Manager is used to manage Ethernet ring networks and MiCOM H35x-V2 and H36x-V2 SNMP facilities. It is
a set of tools used to manage, optimize, diagnose and supervise your network. It also handles the version software
of the switch.
The Switch Manager tool is also intended for MiCOM Px4x IEDs with redundant Ethernet using Self Healing Protocol
(SHP) and Dual Homing Protocol (DHP). This tool is used to identify IEDs and Alstom Switches, and to configure the
redundancy IP address for the Alstom proprietary Self Healing Protocol and Dual Homing Protocol.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 529
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Switch hardware
Alstom switches are stand-alone devices (H3xx, H6x families) or embedded in a computer device rack, for example
MiCOM C264 (SWDxxx, SWRxxx, SWUxxx Ethernet boards) or PC board (MiCOM H14x, MiCOM H15x, MiCOM H16x).

Switch range
There are 3 types of Alstom switches:
● Standard switches: SWU (in C264), H14x (PCI), H34x, H6x
● Redundant Ring switches: SWR (in C264), H15x (PCI), H35x,
● Redundant Dual Homing switches: SWD (in C264), H16x (PCI), H36x

Switch Manager allows you to allocate an IP addresses for Alstom switches. Switches can then be synchronized
using the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) or they can be administrated using the Simple Network
Management Protocol (SNMP).
All switches have a single 6-byte MAC address.

Redundancy Management
Standard Ethernet does not support a loop at the OSI link layer (layer 2 of the 7 layer model). A mesh topology
cannot be created using a standard Hub and switch. Redundancy needs separate networks using hardware in
routers or software in dedicated switches using STP (Spanning Tree Protocol). However, this redundancy
mechanism is too slow for one link failure in electrical automation networks.
Alstom has developed its own Redundancy ring and star mechanisms using two specific Ethernet ports of the
redundant switches. This redundancy works between Alstom switches of the same type. The two redundant
Ethernet connections between Alstom switches create one private redundant Ethernet LAN.
The Ethernet ports dedicated to the redundancy are optical Ethernet ports. The Alstom redundancy mechanism
uses a single specific address for each Ethernet switch of the private LAN. This address is set using DIP switches or
jumpers.
Switch Manager monitors the redundant address of the switches and the link topology between switches.

5.10.1 INSTALLATION

Switch Manager requirements


● PC with Windows XP or later
● Ethernet port
● 200 MB hard disk space
● PC IP address configured in Windows in same IP range as switch

Network IP address
IP addressing is needed for time synchronization of Alstom switches and for SNMP management.
Switch Manager is used to define IP addresses of Alstom switches. These addresses must be in the range of the
system IP, depending on the IP mask of the engineering PC for substation maintenance.
Alstom switches have a default multicast so the 3rd word of the IP address is always 254.

Installation procedure
Run Setup.exe and follow the on-screen instructions.

530 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

5.10.2 SETUP
1. Make sure the PC has one Ethernet port connected to the Alstom switch.
2. Configure the PC's Ethernet port on the same subnet as the Alstom switch.
3. Select User or Admin mode. In User mode enter the user name as User, leave the password blank and click
OK. In Admin mode you can not upload the firmware on the Ethernet repeaters.
4. In Admin mode enter the user name as Admin, enter the password and click OK. All functions are available
including Expert Maintenance facilities.
5. Click the Language button in the bottom right of the screen and select your language.
6. If several Ethernet interfaces are used, in the Network board drop-down box, select the PC Network board
connected to the Alstom switch. The IP and MAC addresses are displayed below the drop-down box.
7. Periodically click the Ring Topology button (top left) to display or refresh the list of Alstom switches that are
connected.

5.10.3 NETWORK SETUP


To configure the network options:
1. From the main window click the Settings button. The Network Setup screen appears.
2. Enter the required board IP address. The first two octets can be configured. The third octet is always 254.
The last octet is set using the DIP switches (SW2) on the redundant Ethernet board, next to the ribbon
connector.
3. Click OK. The board network address is updated and displayed in the main window.
4. From the main window click the SNTP Config button. The Device setup screen appears.
5. Enter the required MAC SNTP Address and server IP SNTP Address. Click OK.
6. The updated MAC and IP SNTP addresses appear in the main screen.
7. Click the Saturation button. A new screen appears.
8. Set the saturation level and click OK. The default value is 300.

5.10.4 BANDWIDTH USED


To show how much bandwidth is used in the ring,
Click the Ring% button, at the bottom of the main window. The percentage of bandwidth used in the ring is
displayed.

5.10.5 RESET COUNTERS


To reset the switch counters,
1. Click Switch Counter Reset.
2. Click OK.

5.10.6 CHECK FOR CONNECTED EQUIPMENT


To check what devices are connected to the device being monitored:
1. From the main window, select the device.
2. Click the Equipment button.
3. At the bottom of the main window, a box shows the ports where devices are connected and their MAC
addresses.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 531
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

5.10.7 MIRRORING FUNCTION


Port mirroring is a method of monitoring network traffic that forwards a copy of each incoming and outgoing
packet from one port of the repeater to another port where the data can be studied. Port mirroring is managed
locally and a network administrator uses it as a diagnostic tool.
To set up port mirroring:
1. Select the address of the device in the main window.
2. Click the Mirroring button, a new screen appears.
3. Click the checkbox to assign a a mirror port. A mirror port copies the incoming and outgoing traffic of the
port.

5.10.8 PORTS ON/OFF


To enable or disable ports:
1. Select the address of the device in the main window.
2. Click Ports On/Off, a new screen appears.
3. Click the checkbox to enable or disable a port. A disabled port has an empty checkbox.

5.10.9 VLAN
The Virtual Local Area Network (VLAN) is a technique used to split an interconnected physical network into several
networks. This technique can be used at all ISO/OSI levels. The VLAN switch is mainly at OSI level 1 (physical VLAN)
which allows communication only between some Ethernet physical ports.
Ports on the switch can be grouped into Physical VLANs to limit traffic flooding. This is because it is limited to ports
belonging to that VLAN and not to other ports.
Port-based VLANs are VLANs where the packet forwarding decision is based on the destination MAC address and
its associated port. You must define outgoing ports allowed for each port when using port-based VLANs. The VLAN
only governs the outgoing traffic so is unidirectional. Therefore, if you wish to allow two subscriber ports to talk to
each other, you must define the egress port for both ports. An egress port is an outgoing port, through which a
data packet leaves.
To assign a physical VLAN to a set of ports:
1. Select the address of the device in the main window.
2. Click the VLAN button, a new screen appears.
3. Use the checkboxes to select which ports will be in the same VLAN. By default all the ports share the same
VLAN.

5.10.10 END OF SESSION


To finish the session:
1. In the main window, click the Quit button, a new screen appears.
2. If a database backup is required, click Yes, a new screen appears.
3. Click the ... button to browse the path. Enter the name in the text box.

532 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

6 SIMPLE NETWORK MANAGEMENT PROTOCOL (SNMP)


Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is a network protocol designed to manage devices in an IP network.
The MiCOM P40 Modular products can provide up to two SNMP interfaces on Ethernet models; one to the IED’s
Main Processor for device level status information, and another directly to the redundant Ethernet board (where
applicable) for specific Ethernet network level information.
Two versions of SNMP are supported: Version 2c, and a secure implementation of version 3 that includes cyber-
security. Only the Main Processor SNMP interface supports Version 3.

6.1 SNMP MANAGEMENT INFORMATION BASES


SNMP uses a Management Information Base (MIB), which contains information about parameters to supervise. The
MIB format is a tree structure, with each node in the tree identified by a numerical Object Identifier (OID). Each OID
identifies a variable that can be read using SNMP with the appropriate software. The information in the MIB is
standardized.
Each device in a network (workstation, server, router, bridge, etc.) maintains a MIB that reflects the status of the
managed resources on that system, such as the version of the software running on the device, the IP address
assigned to a port or interface, the amount of free hard drive space, or the number of open files. The MIB does not
contain static data, but is instead an object-oriented, dynamic database that provides a logical collection of
managed object definitions. The MIB defines the data type of each managed object and describes the object.

6.2 MAIN PROCESSOR MIBS STRUCTURE


The Main Processor MIB uses a private OID with a specific Alstom Grid number assigned by the IANA. Some items
in this MIB also support SNMP traps (where indicated). These are items that can automatically notify a host without
being read.
Address Name Trigger Trap?
0 ROOT NODE
1 ISO
3 Org
6 DOD
1 Internet
4 Private
1 Enterprise
43534 Alstom Grid (IANA No)
1 Px4x
1 System Data
1 Description YES
2 Plant Reference YES
3 Model Number NO
4 Serial Number NO
5 Frequency NO
6 Plant Status YES
7 Active Group YES
8 Software Ref.1 NO
9 Software Ref.2 NO
10 Access Level (UI) YES
2 Date and Time

P446SV-TM-EN-1 533
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Address Name Trigger Trap?


1 Date Time NO
2 IRIG-B Status YES
3 Battery Status YES
4 Active Sync source YES
5 SNTP Server 1 NO
6 SNTP Server 2 NO
7 SNTP Status YES
8 PTP Status YES
3 System Alarms
1 Invalid Message Format YES
2 Main Protection Fail YES
3 Comms Changed YES
4 Max Prop. Alarm YES
5 9-2 Sample Alarm YES
6 9-2LE Cfg Alarm YES
7 Battery Fail YES
8 Rear Communication Fail YES
9 GOOSE IED Missing YES
10 Intermicom loopback YES
11 Intermicom message fail YES
12 Intermicom data CD fail YES
13 Intermicom Channel fail YES
14 Backup setting fail YES
15 User Curve commit to flash failure YES
16 SNTP time Sync fail YES
17 PTP failure alarm YES
4 Device Mode
1 IED Mod/Beh YES
2 Simulation Mode of Subscription YES

6.3 REDUNDANT ETHERNET BOARD MIB STRUCTURE


The Redundant Ethernet board MIB uses three types of OID:
● sysDescr
● sysUpTime
● sysName

MIB structure for RSTP, DHP and SHP


Address Name
0 CCITT
1 ISO
3 Org
6 DOD
1 Internet

534 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Address Name
2 mgmt
1 Mib-2
1 sys
1 sysDescr
3 sysUpTime
4 sysName
Remote Monitoring
16 RMON
1 statistics
1 etherstat
1 etherStatsEntry
9 etherStatsUndersizePkts
10 etherStatsOversizePkts
12 etherStatsJabbers
13 etherStatsCollisions
14 etherStatsPkts64Octets
15 etherStatsPkts65to127Octets
16 etherStatsPkts128to255Octets
17 etherStatsPkts256to511Octets
18 etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

MIB structure for PRP/HSR


Address Name
0 ITU
1 ISO
0 Standard
62439 IECHighavailibility
3 PRP
1 linkRedundancyEntityObjects
0 lreConfiguration
0 lreConfigurationGeneralGroup
1 lreManufacturerName
2 lreInterfaceCount
1 lreConfigurationInterfaceGroup
0 lreConfigurationInterfaces
1 lreInterfaceConfigTable
1 lreInterfaceConfigEntry
1 lreInterfaceConfigIndex
2 lreRowStatus
3 lreNodeType
4 lreNodeName
5 lreVersionName
6 lreMacAddressA

P446SV-TM-EN-1 535
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Address Name
7 lreMacAddressB
8 lreAdapterAdminStateA
9 lreAdapterAdminStateB
10 lreLinkStatusA
11 lreLinkStatusB
12 lreDuplicateDiscard
13 lreTransparentReception
14 lreHsrLREMode
15 lreSwitchingEndNode
16 lreRedBoxIdentity
17 lreSanA
18 lreSanB
19 lreEvaluateSupervision
20 lreNodesTableClear
21 lreProxyNodeTableClear
1 lreStatistics
1 lreStatisticsInterfaceGroup
0 lreStatisticsInterfaces
1 lreInterfaceStatsTable
1 lreInterfaceStatsIndex
2 lreCntTotalSentA
3 lreCntTotalSentB
4 lreCntErrWrongLANA
5 lreCntErrWrongLANB
6 lreCntReceivedA
7 lreCntReceivedB
8 lreCntErrorsA
9 lreCntErrorsB
10 lreCntNodes
11 IreOwnRxCntA
12 IreOwnRxCntB
3 lreProxyNodeTable
1 lreProxyNodeEntry
1 reProxyNodeIndex
2 reProxyNodeMacAddress
3 Org
6 Dod
1 Internet
2 mgmt
1 mib-2
1 System
1 sysDescr
3 sysUpTime

536 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Address Name
5 sysName
7 sysServices
2 interfaces
2 ifTable
1 ifEntry
1 ifIndex
2 ifDescr
3 ifType
4 ifMtu
5 ifSpeed
6 ifPhysAddress
7 ifAdminStatus
8 ifOpenStatus
9 ifLastChange
10 ifInOctets
11 ifInUcastPkts
12 ifInNUcastPkts
13 ifInDiscards
14 ifInErrors
15 ifInUnknownProtos
16 ifOutOctets
17 ifOutUcastPkts
18 ifOutNUcastPkts
19 ifOutDiscards
20 ifOutErrors
21 ifOutQLen
22 ifSpecific
16 rmon
1 statistics
1 etherStatsTable
1 etherStatsEntry
1 etherStatsIndex
2 etherStatsDataSource
3 etherStatsDropEvents
4 etherStatsOctets
5 etherStatsPkts
6 etherStatsBroadcastPkts
7 etherStatsMulticastPkts
8 etherStatsCRCAlignErrors
9 etherStatsUndersizePkts
10 etherStatsOversizePkts
11 etherStatsFragments
12 etherStatsJabbers

P446SV-TM-EN-1 537
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Address Name
13 etherStatsCollisions
14 etherStatsPkts64Octets
15 etherStatsPkts65to127Octets
16 etherStatsPkts128to255Octets
17 etherStatsPkts256to511Octets
18 etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets
19 etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets
20 etherStatsOwner
21 etherStatsStatus

6.4 ACCESSING THE MIB


Various SNMP client software tools can be used. We recommend using an SNMP MIB browser, which can perform
the basic SNMP operations such as GET, GETNEXT and RESPONSE.

Note:
There are two IP addresses visible when communicating with the Redundant Ethernet Card via the fibre optic ports: Use the
one for the IED itself to the Main Processor SNMP interface, and use the one for the on-board Ethernet switch to access the
Redundant Ethernet Board SNMP interface. See the configuration chapter for more information.

6.5 MAIN PROCESSOR SNMP CONFIGURATION


You configure the main processor SNMP interface using the HMI panel. Two different versions are available;
SNMPv2c and SNMPv3:
To enable the main processor SNMP interface:
1. Select the COMMUNICATIONS column and scroll to the SNMP PARAMETERS heading
2. You can select either v2C, V3 or both. Selecting None will disable the main processor SNMP interface.

SNMP Trap Configuration


SNMP traps allow for unsolicited reporting between the IED and up to two SNMP managers with unique IP
addresses. The device MIB details what information can be reported using Traps. To configure the SNMP Traps:
1. Move down to the cell Trap Dest. IP 1 and enter the IP address of the first destination SNMP manager.
Setting this cell to 0.0.0.0 disables the first Trap interface.
2. Move down to the cell Trap Dest. IP 2 and enter the IP address of the second destination SNMP manager.
Setting this cell to 0.0.0.0 disables the Second Trap interface.

SNMP V3 Security Configuration


SNMPv3 provides a higher level of security via authentication and privacy protocols. The IED adopts a secure
SNMPv3 implementation with a user-based security model (USM).

538 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Authentication is used to check the identity of users, privacy allows for encryption of SNMP messages. Both are
optional, however you must enable authentication in order to enable privacy. To configure these security options:
1. If SNMPv3 has been enabled, set the Security Level setting. There are three levels; without authentication
and without privacy (noAuthNoPriv), with authentication but without privacy (authNoPriv), and with
authentication and with privacy (authPriv).
2. If Authentication is enabled, use the Auth Protocol setting to select the authentication type. There are two
options: HMAC-MD5-96 or HMAC-SHA-96.
3. Using the Auth Password setting, enter the 8-character password to be used by the IED for authentication.
4. If privacy is enabled, use the Encrypt Protocol setting to set the 8-character password that will be used by
the IED for encryption.

SNMP V2C Security Configuration


SNMPv2c implements authentication between the master and agent using a parameter called the Community
Name. This is effectively the password but it is not encrypted during transmission (this makes it inappropriate for
some scenarios in which case version 3 should be used instead). To configure the SNMP 2c security:
1. If SNMPv2c has been enabled, use the Community Name setting to set the password that will be used by
the IED and SNMP manager for authentication. This may be between one and 8 characters.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 539
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

7 DATA PROTOCOLS
The products supports a wide range of protocols to make them applicable to many industries and applications.
The exact data protocols supported by a particular product depend on its chosen application, but the following
table gives a list of the data protocols that are typically available.

SCADA data protocols


Data Protocol Layer 1 protocol Description
Courier K-Bus, RS232, RS485, Ethernet Standard for SCADA communications developed by General Electric.
MODBUS RS485 Standard for SCADA communications developed by Modicon.
IEC 60870-5-103 RS485 IEC standard for SCADA communications
Standard for SCADA communications developed by Harris. Used mainly in
DNP 3.0 RS485, Ethernet
North America.
IEC 61850 Ethernet IEC standard for substation automation. Facilitates interoperability.

The relationship of these protocols to the lower level physical layer protocols are as follows:
IEC 60870-5-103
MODBUS IEC 61850
Data Protocols
DNP3.0 DNP3.0
Courier Courier Courier Courier
Data Link Layer EIA(RS)485 Ethernet EIA(RS)232 K-Bus
Physical Layer Copper or Optical Fibre

7.1 COURIER
This section should provide sufficient detail to enable understanding of the Courier protocol at a level required by
most users. For situations where the level of information contained in this manual is insufficient, further
publications (R6511 and R6512) containing in-depth details about the protocol and its use, are available on
request.
Courier is an General Electric proprietary communication protocol. Courier uses a standard set of commands to
access a database of settings and data in the IED. This allows a master to communicate with a number of slave
devices. The application-specific elements are contained in the database rather than in the commands used to
interrogate it, meaning that the master station does not need to be preconfigured. Courier also provides a
sequence of event (SOE) and disturbance record extraction mechanism.

7.1.1 PHYSICAL CONNECTION AND LINK LAYER


Courier can be used with three physical layer protocols: K-Bus, EIA(RS)232 or EIA(RS)485.
Several connection options are available for Courier
● The front serial RS232 port (for connection to Settings application software on, for example, a laptop
● Rear Port 1 (RP1) - for permanent SCADA connection via RS485 or K-Bus
● Optional fibre port (RP1 in slot A) - for permanent SCADA connection via optical fibre
● Optional Rear Port 2 (RP2) - for permanent SCADA connection via RS485, K-Bus, or RS232

For either of the rear ports, both the IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by
the settings application software.

540 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

7.1.2 COURIER DATABASE


The Courier database is two-dimensional and resembles a table. Each cell in the database is referenced by a row
and column address. Both the column and the row can take a range from 0 to 255 (0000 to FFFF Hexadecimal.
Addresses in the database are specified as hexadecimal values, for example, 0A02 is column 0A row 02.
Associated settings or data are part of the same column. Row zero of the column has a text string to identify the
contents of the column and to act as a column heading.
The product-specific menu databases contain the complete database definition.

7.1.3 SETTINGS CATEGORIES


There are two main categories of settings in protection IEDs:
● Control and support settings
● Protection settings

With the exception of the Disturbance Recorder settings, changes made to the control and support settings are
implemented immediately and stored in non-volatile memory. Changes made to the Protection settings and the
Disturbance Recorder settings are stored in ‘scratchpad’ memory and are not immediately implemented. These
need to be committed by writing to the Save Changes cell in the CONFIGURATION column.

7.1.4 SETTING CHANGES


Courier provides two mechanisms for making setting changes. Either method can be used for editing any of the
settings in the database.

Method 1
This uses a combination of three commands to perform a settings change:
First, enter Setting mode: This checks that the cell is settable and returns the limits.
1. Preload Setting: This places a new value into the cell. This value is echoed to ensure that setting corruption
has not taken place. The validity of the setting is not checked by this action.
2. Execute Setting: This confirms the setting change. If the change is valid, a positive response is returned. If
the setting change fails, an error response is returned.
3. Abort Setting: This command can be used to abandon the setting change.
This is the most secure method. It is ideally suited to on-line editors because the setting limits are extracted before
the setting change is made. However, this method can be slow if many settings are being changed because three
commands are required for each change.

Method 2
The Set Value command can be used to change a setting directly. The response to this command is either a
positive confirm or an error code to indicate the nature of a failure. This command can be used to implement a
setting more rapidly than the previous method, however the limits are not extracted. This method is therefore most
suitable for off-line setting editors such as MiCOM S1 Agile, or for issuing preconfigured control commands.

7.1.5 EVENT EXTRACTION


You can extract events either automatically (rear serial port only) or manually (either serial port). For automatic
extraction, all events are extracted in sequential order using the Courier event mechanism. This includes fault and
maintenance data if appropriate. The manual approach allows you to select events, faults, or maintenance data
as desired.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 541
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

7.1.5.1 AUTOMATIC EVENT RECORD EXTRACTION


This method is intended for continuous extraction of event and fault information as it is produced. It is only
supported through the rear Courier port.
When new event information is created, the Event bit is set in the Status byte. This indicates to the Master device
that event information is available. The oldest, non-extracted event can be extracted from the IED using the Send
Event command. The IED responds with the event data.
Once an event has been extracted, the Accept Event command can be used to confirm that the event has been
successfully extracted. When all events have been extracted, the Event bit is reset. If there are more events still to
be extracted, the next event can be accessed using the Send Event command as before.

7.1.5.2 MANUAL EVENT RECORD EXTRACTION


The VIEW RECORDS column (location 01) is used for manual viewing of event, fault, and maintenance records. The
contents of this column depend on the nature of the record selected. You can select events by event number and
directly select a fault or maintenance record by number.

Event Record Selection ('Select Event' cell: 0101)


This cell can be set the number of stored events. For simple event records (Type 0), cells 0102 to 0105 contain the
event details. A single cell is used to represent each of the event fields. If the event selected is a fault or
maintenance record (Type 3), the remainder of the column contains the additional information.

Fault Record Selection ('Select Fault' cell: 0105)


This cell can be used to select a fault record directly, using a value between 0 and 4 to select one of up to five
stored fault records. (0 is the most recent fault and 4 is the oldest). The column then contains the details of the fault
record selected.

Maintenance Record Selection ('Select Maint' cell: 01F0)


This cell can be used to select a maintenance record using a value between 0 and 4. This cell operates in a similar
way to the fault record selection.
If this column is used to extract event information, the number associated with a particular record changes when
a new event or fault occurs.

Event Types
The IED generates events under certain circumstances such as:
● Change of state of output contact
● Change of state of opto-input
● Protection element operation
● Alarm condition
● Setting change
● Password entered/timed-out

Event Record Format


The IED returns the following fields when the Send Event command is invoked:
● Cell reference
● Time stamp
● Cell text
● Cell value

542 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

The Menu Database contains tables of possible events, and shows how the contents of the above fields are
interpreted. Fault and Maintenance records return a Courier Type 3 event, which contains the above fields plus two
additional fields:
● Event extraction column
● Event number

These events contain additional information, which is extracted from the IED using column B4. Row 01 contains a
Select Record setting that allows the fault or maintenance record to be selected. This setting should be set to the
event number value returned in the record. The extended data can be extracted from the IED by uploading the text
and data from the column.

7.1.6 DISTURBANCE RECORD EXTRACTION


The stored disturbance records are accessible through the Courier interface. The records are extracted using
column (B4).
The Select Record cell can be used to select the record to be extracted. Record 0 is the oldest non-extracted
record. Older records which have been already been extracted are assigned positive values, while younger records
are assigned negative values. To help automatic extraction through the rear port, the IED sets the Disturbance bit
of the Status byte, whenever there are non-extracted disturbance records.
Once a record has been selected, using the above cell, the time and date of the record can be read from the
Trigger Time cell (B402). The disturbance record can be extracted using the block transfer mechanism from cell
B40B and saved in the COMTRADE format. The settings application software software automatically does this.

7.1.7 PROGRAMMABLE SCHEME LOGIC SETTINGS


The programmable scheme logic (PSL) settings can be uploaded from and downloaded to the IED using the block
transfer mechanism.
The following cells are used to perform the extraction:
● Domain cell (B204): Used to select either PSL settings (upload or download) or PSL configuration data
(upload only)
● Sub-Domain cell (B208): Used to select the Protection Setting Group to be uploaded or downloaded.
● Version cell (B20C): Used on a download to check the compatibility of the file to be downloaded.
● Transfer Mode cell (B21C): Used to set up the transfer process.
● Data Transfer cell (B120): Used to perform upload or download.

The PSL settings can be uploaded and downloaded to and from the IED using this mechanism. The settings
application software must be used to edit the settings. It also performs checks on the validity of the settings before
they are transferred to the IED.

7.1.8 TIME SYNCHRONISATION


The time and date can be set using the time synchronization feature of the Courier protocol. The device will correct
for the transmission delay. The time synchronization message may be sent as either a global command or to any
individual IED address. If the time synchronization message is sent to an individual address, then the device will
respond with a confirm message. If sent as a global command, the (same) command must be sent twice. A time
synchronization Courier event will be generated/produced whether the time-synchronization message is sent as a
global command or to any individual IED address.
If the clock is being synchronized using the IRIG-B input then it will not be possible to set the device time using the
Courier interface. An attempt to set the time using the interface will cause the device to create an event with the
current date and time taken from the IRIG-B synchronized internal clock.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 543
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

7.1.9 COURIER CONFIGURATION


To configure the device:
1. Select the CONFIGURATION column and check that the Comms settings cell is set to Visible.
2. Select the COMMUNICATIONS column.
3. Move to the first cell down (RP1 protocol). This is a non-settable cell, which shows the chosen
communication protocol – in this case Courier.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
Courier
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the address of the RP1 port on thje device. Up to
32 IEDs can be connected to one spur. It is therefore necessary for each IED to have a unique address so
that messages from the master control station are accepted by one IED only. Courier uses an integer
number between 1 and 254 for the Relay Address. It is set to 255 by default, which has to be changed. It is
important that no two IEDs share the same address.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Address
100
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 InactivTimer). This cell controls the inactivity timer. The inactivity timer
controls how long the IED waits without receiving any messages on the rear port before revoking any
password access that was enabled and discarding any changes. For the rear port this can be set between 1
and 30 minutes.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Inactivtimer
10.00 mins.
6. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
7. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Card Status). This cell is not settable. It displays the status of the chosen
physical layer protocol for RP1.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Card Status
K-Bus OK

544 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

8. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Port Config). This cell controls the type of serial connection. Select between
K-Bus or RS485.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Port Config
K-Bus
9. If using EIA(RS)485, the next cell (RP1 Comms Mode) selects the communication mode. The choice is either
IEC 60870 FT1.2 for normal operation with 11-bit modems, or 10-bit no parity. If using K-Bus this cell will not
appear.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Comms Mode
IEC 60870 FT1.2
10. If using EIA(RS)485, the next cell down controls the baud rate. Three baud rates are supported; 9600, 19200
and 38400. If using K-Bus this cell will not appear as the baud rate is fixed at 64 kbps.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
19200

7.2 IEC 60870-5-103


The specification IEC 60870-5-103 (Telecontrol Equipment and Systems Part 5 Section 103: Transmission
Protocols), defines the use of standards IEC 60870-5-1 to IEC 60870-5-5, which were designed for communication
with protection equipment
This section describes how the IEC 60870-5-103 standard is applied to the Px40 platform. It is not a description of
the standard itself. The level at which this section is written assumes that the reader is already familiar with the
IEC 60870-5-103 standard.
This section should provide sufficient detail to enable understanding of the standard at a level required by most
users.
The IEC 60870-5-103 interface is a master/slave interface with the device as the slave device. The device conforms
to compatibility level 2, as defined in the IEC 60870-5-103.standard.
The following IEC 60870-5-103 facilities are supported by this interface:
● Initialization (reset)
● Time synchronization
● Event record extraction
● General interrogation
● Cyclic measurements
● General commands
● Disturbance record extraction
● Private codes

7.2.1 PHYSICAL CONNECTION AND LINK LAYER


Two connection options are available for IEC 60870-5-103:
● Rear Port 1 (RP1) - for permanent SCADA connection via RS485
● Optional fibre port (RP1 in slot A) - for permanent SCADA connection via optical fibre

If the optional fibre optic port is fitted, a menu item appears in which the active port can be selected. However the
selection is only effective following the next power up.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 545
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

The IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by the settings application software.

7.2.2 INITIALISATION
Whenever the device has been powered up, or if the communication parameters have been changed a reset
command is required to initialize the communications. The device will respond to either of the two reset
commands; Reset CU or Reset FCB (Communication Unit or Frame Count Bit). The difference between the two
commands is that the Reset CU command will clear any unsent messages in the transmit buffer, whereas the
Reset FCB command does not delete any messages.
The device will respond to the reset command with an identification message ASDU 5. The Cause of Transmission
(COT) of this response will be either Reset CU or Reset FCB depending on the nature of the reset command. The
content of ASDU 5 is described in the IEC 60870-5-103 section of the Menu Database, available from General
Electric separately if required.
In addition to the above identification message, it will also produce a power up event.

7.2.3 TIME SYNCHRONISATION


The time and date can be set using the time synchronization feature of the IEC 60870-5-103 protocol. The device
will correct for the transmission delay as specified in IEC 60870-5-103. If the time synchronization message is sent
as a send/confirm message then the device will respond with a confirm message. A time synchronization Class 1
event will be generated/produced whether the time-synchronization message is sent as a send confirm or a
broadcast (send/no reply) message.
If the clock is being synchronized using the IRIG-B input then it will not be possible to set the device time using the
IEC 60870-5-103 interface. An attempt to set the time via the interface will cause the device to create an event
with the current date and time taken from the IRIG-B synchronized internal clock.

7.2.4 SPONTANEOUS EVENTS


Events are categorized using the following information:
● Function type
● Information Number

The IEC 60870-5-103 profile in the Menu Database contains a complete listing of all events produced by the
device.

7.2.5 GENERAL INTERROGATION (GI)


The GI request can be used to read the status of the device, the function numbers, and information numbers that
will be returned during the GI cycle. These are shown in the IEC 60870-5-103 profile in the Menu Database.

7.2.6 CYCLIC MEASUREMENTS


The device will produce measured values using ASDU 9 on a cyclical basis, this can be read from the device using a
Class 2 poll (note ADSU 3 is not used). The rate at which the device produces new measured values can be
controlled using the measurement period setting. This setting can be edited from the front panel menu or using
MiCOM S1 Agile. It is active immediately following a change.
The device transmits its measurands at 2.4 times the rated value of the analogue value.

7.2.7 COMMANDS
A list of the supported commands is contained in the Menu Database. The device will respond to other commands
with an ASDU 1, with a cause of transmission (COT) indicating ‘negative acknowledgement’.

546 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

7.2.8 TEST MODE


It is possible to disable the device output contacts to allow secondary injection testing to be performed using
either the front panel menu or the front serial port. The IEC 60870-5-103 standard interprets this as ‘test mode’. An
event will be produced to indicate both entry to and exit from test mode. Spontaneous events and cyclic measured
data transmitted whilst the device is in test mode will have a COT of ‘test mode’.

7.2.9 DISTURBANCE RECORDS


The disturbance records are stored in uncompressed format and can be extracted using the standard
mechanisms described in IEC 60870-5-103.

Note:
IEC 60870-5-103 only supports up to 8 records.

7.2.10 COMMAND/MONITOR BLOCKING


The device supports a facility to block messages in the monitor direction (data from the device) and also in the
command direction (data to the device). Messages can be blocked in the monitor and command directions using
one of the two following methods
● The menu command RP1 CS103Blcking in the COMMUNICATIONS column
● The DDB signals Monitor Blocked and Command Blocked

7.2.11 IEC 60870-5-103 CONFIGURATION


To configure the device:
1. Select the CONFIGURATION column and check that the Comms settings cell is set to Visible.
2. Select the COMMUNICATIONS column.
3. Move to the first cell down (RP1 protocol). This is a non-settable cell, which shows the chosen
communication protocol – in this case IEC 60870-5-103.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
IEC 60870-5-103
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the IEC 60870-5-103 address of the IED. Up to 32
IEDs can be connected to one spur. It is therefore necessary for each IED to have a unique address so that
messages from the master control station are accepted by one IED only. IEC 60870-5-103 uses an integer
number between 0 and 254 for the address. It is important that no two IEDs have the same IEC 60870 5 103
address. The IEC 60870-5-103 address is then used by the master station to communicate with the IED.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 address
162
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Baud Rate). This cell controls the baud rate to be used. Two baud rates are
supported by the IED, 9600 bits/s and 19200 bits/s. Make sure that the baud rate selected on the
IED is the same as that set on the master station.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
9600 bits/s

P446SV-TM-EN-1 547
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

6. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Meas Period). The next cell down controls the period between
IEC 60870-5-103 measurements. The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol allows the IED to supply measurements at
regular intervals. The interval between measurements is controlled by this cell, and can be set between 1
and 60 seconds.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Meas Period
30.00 s
7. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
8. The next cell down (RP1 CS103Blcking) can be used for monitor or command blocking.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 CS103Blcking
Disabled
9. There are three settings associated with this cell; these are:

Setting: Description:
Disabled No blocking selected.
When the monitor blocking DDB Signal is active high, either by energising an opto input or control input,
Monitor Blocking reading of the status information and disturbance records is not permitted. When in this mode the device
returns a "Termination of general interrogation" message to the master station.
When the command blocking DDB signal is active high, either by energising an opto input or control input,
Command Blocking all remote commands will be ignored (i.e. CB Trip/Close, change setting group etc.). When in this mode the
device returns a "negative acknowledgement of command" message to the master station.

7.3 DNP 3.0


This section describes how the DNP 3.0 standard is applied in the product. It is not a description of the standard
itself. The level at which this section is written assumes that the reader is already familiar with the DNP 3.0
standard.
The descriptions given here are intended to accompany the device profile document that is included in the Menu
Database document. The DNP 3.0 protocol is not described here, please refer to the documentation available from
the user group. The device profile document specifies the full details of the DNP 3.0 implementation. This is the
standard format DNP 3.0 document that specifies which objects; variations and qualifiers are supported. The
device profile document also specifies what data is available from the device using DNP 3.0. The IED operates as a
DNP 3.0 slave and supports subset level 2, as described in the DNP 3.0 standard, plus some of the features from
level 3.
The DNP 3.0 protocol is defined and administered by the DNP Users Group. For further information on DNP 3.0 and
the protocol specifications, please see the DNP website (www.dnp.org).

7.3.1 PHYSICAL CONNECTION AND LINK LAYER


DNP 3.0 can be used with two physical layer protocols: EIA(RS)485, or Ethernet.

548 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Several connection options are available for DNP 3.0


● Rear Port 1 (RP1) - for permanent SCADA connection via RS485
● Optional fibre port (RP1 in slot A) - for permanent SCADA connection via optical fibre
● An RJ45 connection on an optional Ethernet board - for permanent SCADA Ethernet connection
● A fibre connection on an optional Ethernet board - for permanent SCADA Ethernet connection

The IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by the settings application software.
When using a serial interface, the data format is: 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit and optional configurable parity
bit.

7.3.2 OBJECT 1 BINARY INPUTS


Object 1, binary inputs, contains information describing the state of signals in the IED, which mostly form part of
the digital data bus (DDB). In general these include the state of the output contacts and opto-inputs, alarm signals,
and protection start and trip signals. The ‘DDB number’ column in the device profile document provides the DDB
numbers for the DNP 3.0 point data. These can be used to cross-reference to the DDB definition list. See the
relevant Menu Database document. The binary input points can also be read as change events using Object 2 and
Object 60 for class 1-3 event data.

7.3.3 OBJECT 10 BINARY OUTPUTS


Object 10, binary outputs, contains commands that can be operated using DNP 3.0. Therefore the points accept
commands of type pulse on (null, trip, close) and latch on/off as detailed in the device profile in the relevant Menu
Database document, and execute the command once for either command. The other fields are ignored (queue,
clear, trip/close, in time and off time).
There is an additional image of the Control Inputs. Described as Alias Control Inputs, they reflect the state of the
Control Input, but with a dynamic nature.
● If the Control Input DDB signal is already SET and a new DNP SET command is sent to the Control Input, the
Control Input DDB signal goes momentarily to RESET and then back to SET.
● If the Control Input DDB signal is already RESET and a new DNP RESET command is sent to the Control
Input, the Control Input DDB signal goes momentarily to SET and then back to RESET.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 549
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

DNP Latch DNP Latch DNP Latch DNP Latch


ON ON OFF OFF

Control Input
(Latched)

Aliased Control
Input
(Latched)

Control Input
(Pulsed )

Aliased Control
Input
(Pulsed )
The pulse width is equal to the duration of one protection iteration
V01002

Figure 281: Control input behaviour

Many of the IED’s functions are configurable so some of the Object 10 commands described in the following
sections may not be available. A read from Object 10 reports the point as off-line and an operate command to
Object 12 generates an error response.
Examples of Object 10 points that maybe reported as off-line are:
● Activate setting groups: Ensure setting groups are enabled
● CB trip/close: Ensure remote CB control is enabled
● Reset NPS thermal: Ensure NPS thermal protection is enabled
● Reset thermal O/L: Ensure thermal overload protection is enabled
● Reset RTD flags: Ensure RTD Inputs is enabled
● Control inputs: Ensure control inputs are enabled

7.3.4 OBJECT 20 BINARY COUNTERS


Object 20, binary counters, contains cumulative counters and measurements. The binary counters can be read as
their present ‘running’ value from Object 20, or as a ‘frozen’ value from Object 21. The running counters of object
20 accept the read, freeze and clear functions. The freeze function takes the current value of the object 20 running
counter and stores it in the corresponding Object 21 frozen counter. The freeze and clear function resets the Object
20 running counter to zero after freezing its value.
Binary counter and frozen counter change event values are available for reporting from Object 22 and Object 23
respectively. Counter change events (Object 22) only report the most recent change, so the maximum number of
events supported is the same as the total number of counters. Frozen counter change events (Object 23) are
generated whenever a freeze operation is performed and a change has occurred since the previous freeze
command. The frozen counter event queues store the points for up to two freeze operations.

7.3.5 OBJECT 30 ANALOGUE INPUT


Object 30, analogue inputs, contains information from the IED’s measurements columns in the menu. All object 30
points can be reported as 16 or 32-bit integer values with flag, 16 or 32-bit integer values without flag, as well as
short floating point values.

550 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Analogue values can be reported to the master station as primary, secondary or normalized values (which takes
into account the IED’s CT and VT ratios), and this is settable in the COMMUNICATIONS column in the IED.
Corresponding deadband settings can be displayed in terms of a primary, secondary or normalized value.
Deadband point values can be reported and written using Object 34 variations.
The deadband is the setting used to determine whether a change event should be generated for each point. The
change events can be read using Object 32 or Object 60. These events are generated for any point which has a
value changed by more than the deadband setting since the last time the data value was reported.
Any analogue measurement that is unavailable when it is read is reported as offline. For example, the frequency
would be offline if the current and voltage frequency is outside the tracking range of the IED. All Object 30 points
are reported as secondary values in DNP 3.0 (with respect to CT and VT ratios).

7.3.6 OBJECT 40 ANALOGUE OUTPUT


The conversion to fixed-point format requires the use of a scaling factor, which is configurable for the various
types of data within the IED such as current, voltage, and phase angle. All Object 40 points report the integer
scaling values and Object 41 is available to configure integer scaling quantities.

7.3.7 OBJECT 50 TIME SYNCHRONISATION


Function codes 1 (read) and 2 (write) are supported for Object 50 (time and date) variation 1. The DNP Need Time
function (the duration of time waited before requesting another time sync from the master) is supported, and is
configurable in the range 1 - 30 minutes.
If the clock is being synchronized using the IRIG-B input then it will not be possible to set the device time using the
Courier interface. An attempt to set the time using the interface will cause the device to create an event with the
current date and time taken from the IRIG-B synchronized internal clock.

7.3.8 DNP3 DEVICE PROFILE


This section describes the specific implementation of DNP version 3.0 within General Electric MiCOM P40 Agile IEDs
for both compact and modular ranges.
The devices use the DNP 3.0 Slave Source Code Library version 3 from Triangle MicroWorks Inc.
This document, in conjunction with the DNP 3.0 Basic 4 Document Set, and the DNP Subset Definitions Document,
provides complete information on how to communicate with the devices using the DNP 3.0 protocol.
This implementation of DNP 3.0 is fully compliant with DNP 3.0 Subset Definition Level 2. It also contains many
Subset Level 3 and above features.

7.3.8.1 DNP3 DEVICE PROFILE TABLE


The following table provides the device profile in a similar format to that defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document. While it is referred to in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions as a “Document”, it is just one component of a
total interoperability guide. This table, in combination with the subsequent Implementation and Points List tables
should provide a complete interoperability/configuration guide for the device.
The following table provides the device profile in a similar format to that defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document. While it is referred to in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions as a "Document", it is just one component of a
total interoperability guide. This table, in combination with the subsequent Implementation and Points List tables
should provide a complete interoperability/configuration guide for the device.

DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Vendor Name: ALSTOM GRID
Device Name: MiCOM P40Agile Protection Relays – compact and modular range

P446SV-TM-EN-1 551
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Models Covered: All models
Highest DNP Level Supported*: For Requests: Level 2
*This is the highest DNP level FULLY supported. Parts of level 3 are For Responses: Level 2
also supported
Device Function: Slave
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the highest DNP levels supported (the complete list is described in the
DNP 3.0 Implementation Table):
For static (non-change event) object requests, request qualifier codes 00 and 01 (start-stop), 07 and 08 (limited quantity), and 17 and 28 (index)
are supported in addition to the request qualifier code 06 (no range (all points))
Static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08 will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01
Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or 28
For change-event object requests, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded
16-bit and 32-bit analogue change events with time may be requested
The read function code for Object 50 (time and date) variation 1 is supported
Analogue Input Deadbands, Object 34, variations 1 through 3, are supported
Floating Point Analogue Output Status and Output Block Objects 40 and 41 are supported
Sequential file transfer, Object 70, variations 2 through 7, are supported
Device Attribute Object 0 is supported
Maximum Data Link Frame Size (octets): Transmitted: 292
Received: 292
Maximum Application Fragment Size (octets) Transmitted: Configurable (100 to 2048). Default 2048
Received: 249
Maximum Data Link Retries: Fixed at 2
Maximum Application Layer Retries: None
Requires Data Link Layer Confirmation: Configurable to Never or Always
Requires Application Layer Confirmation: When reporting event data (Slave devices only)
When sending multi-fragment responses (Slave devices only)
Timeouts while waiting for:
Data Link Confirm: Configurable
Complete Application Fragment: None
Application Confirm: Configurable
Complete Application Response: None
Others:
Data Link Confirm Timeout: Configurable from 0 (Disabled) to 120s, default 10s.
Application Confirm Timeout: Configurable from 1 to 120s, default 2s.
Select/Operate Arm Timeout: Configurable from 1 to 10s, default 10s.
Need Time Interval (Set IIN1-4): Configurable from 1 to 30, default 10min.
Application File Timeout 60 s
Analog Change Event Scan Period: Fixed at 0.5s
Counter Change Event Scan Period Fixed at 0.5s
Frozen Counter Change Event Scan Period Fixed at 1s
Maximum Delay Measurement Error: 2.5 ms
Time Base Drift Over a 10-minute Interval: 7 ms
Sends/Executes Control Operations:
Write Binary Outputs: Never
Select/Operate: Always

552 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Direct Operate: Always
Direct Operate - No Ack: Always
Count > 1 Never
Pulse On Always
Pulse Off Sometimes
Latch On Always
Latch Off Always
Queue Never
Clear Queue Never
Note: Paired Control points will accept Pulse On/Trip and Pulse On/Close, but only single point will accept the Pulse Off control command.
Reports Binary Input Change Events when no specific variation Configurable to send one or the other
requested:
Reports time-tagged Binary Input Change Events when no specific Binary input change with time
variation requested:
Sends Unsolicited Responses: Never
Sends Static Data in Unsolicited Responses: Never
No other options are permitted
Default Counter Object/Variation: Configurable, Point-by-point list attached
Default object: 20
Default variation: 1
Counters Roll Over at: 32 bits
Sends multi-fragment responses: Yes
Sequential File Transfer Support:
Append File Mode No
Custom Status Code Strings No
Permissions Field Yes
File Events Assigned to Class No
File Events Send Immediately Yes
Multiple Blocks in a Fragment No
Max Number of Files Open 1

7.3.8.2 DNP3 IMPLEMENTATION TABLE


The implementation table provides a list of objects, variations and control codes supported by the device:
Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
1 0 Binary Input (Variation 0 is used to 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
request default variation) 22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
1 1 Binary Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
1 2 Binary Input with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 553
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
2 0 Binary Input Change - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
2 1 Binary Input Change without Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
2 2 Binary Input Change with Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
10 0 Binary Output Status - Any 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
Variation 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
10 2 Binary Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)
12 1 Control Relay Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
20 0 Binary Counter - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
7 (freeze) 00, 01 (start-stop)
8 (freeze noack) 06 (no range, or all)
9 (freeze clear) 07, 08 (limited qty)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 1 32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 2 16-Bit Binary Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 5 32-Bit Binary Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 6 16-Bit Binary Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 0 Frozen Counter - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 1 32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 2 16-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 5 32-Bit Frozen Counter with Time of 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Freeze 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 1)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 6 16-Bit Frozen Counter with Time of 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Freeze 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 17, 28 (index - see note 1)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 9 32-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)

554 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
21 10 16-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
`22 0 Counter Change Event - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 1 32-Bit Counter Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
22 2 16-Bit Counter Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 5 32-Bit Counter Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 6 16-Bit Counter Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
23 0 Frozen Counter Event (Variation 0 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
is used to request default 07, 08 (limited qty)
variation)
23 1 32-Bit Frozen Counter Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
23 2 16-Bit Frozen Counter Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
23 5 32-Bit Frozen Counter Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
23 6 16-Bit Frozen Counter Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
30 0 Analog Input - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 1 32-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 2 16-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 3 32-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 4 16-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 5 Short floating point 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
32 0 Analog Change Event - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 1 32-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
32 2 16-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 3 32-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 4 16-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 5 Short floating point Analog 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Change Event without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 7 Short floating point Analog 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Change Event with Time 07, 08 (limited qty)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 555
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
34 0 Analog Input Deadband (Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
0 is used to request default 06 (no range, or all)
variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 1 16 Bit Analog Input Deadband 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 2 32 Bit Analog Input Deadband 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 3 Short Floating Point Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Deadband 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 0 Analog Output Status (Variation 0 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
is used to request default 06 (no range, or all)
variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 1 32-Bit Analog Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 2 16-Bit Analog Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 3 Short Floating Point Analog 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Output Status 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
41 1 32-Bit Analog Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate) 27 (index)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
41 2 16-Bit Analog Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate) 27 (index)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
41 3 Short Floating Point Analog 3 (select) 17, 27, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
Output Block 4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
1 1 (read) 07 (limited qty = 1) 129 response 07 (limited qty = 1)
50 (default - see Time and Date
note 1)
2 (write) 07 (limited qty = 1)
60 0 Not defined
60 1 Class 0 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
60 2 Class 1 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
60 3 Class 2 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
60 4 Class 3 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)

556 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
70 0 File Event - Any Variation 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
70 2 File Authentication 29 (authenticate) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 3 File Command 25 (open) 5b (free-format)
27 (delete)
70 4 File Command Status 26 (close) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
30 (abort)
70 5 File Transfer 1 (read) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 6 File Transfer Status 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 7 File Descriptor 28 (get file info) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)

80 1 Internal Indications 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)

No Object (function code only) 13 (cold restart)

No Object (function code only) 14 (warm restart)

No Object (function code only) 23 (delay meas.)

Note:
A Default variation refers to the variation responded to when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans.

Note:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded to when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or
28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded to with qualifiers
00 or 01. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded to.

7.3.8.3 DNP3 INTERNAL INDICATIONS


The following table lists the DNP3.0 Internal Indications (IIN) and identifies those that are supported by the device.
The IIN form an information element used to convey the internal states and diagnostic results of a device. This
information can be used by a receiving station to perform error recovery or other suitable functions. The IIN is a
two-octet field that follows the function code in all responses from the device. When a request cannot be
processed due to formatting errors or the requested data is not available, the IIN is always returned with the
appropriate bits set.
Bit Indication Description Supported
Octet 1
Set when a request is received with the destination address of the all stations
address (6553510). It is cleared after the next response (even if a response to a
0 All stations message received global request is required). Yes
This IIN is used to let the master station know that a "broadcast" message was
received by the relay.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 557
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Bit Indication Description Supported


Set when data that has been configured as Class 1 data is ready to be sent to
the master.
1 Class 1 data available Yes
The master station should request this class data from the relay when this bit
is set in a response.
Set when data that has been configured as Class 2 data is ready to be sent to
the master.
2 Class 2 data available Yes
The master station should request this class data from the relay when this bit
is set in a response.
Set when data that has been configured as Class 3 data is ready to be sent to
the master.
3 Class 3 data available Yes
The master station should request this class data from the relay when this bit
is set in a response.
The relay requires time synchronization from the master station (using the
Time and Date object).
4 Time-synchronization required Yes
This IIN is cleared once the time has been synchronized. It can also be cleared
by explicitly writing a 0 into this bit of the Internal Indication object.
Set when some or all of the relays digital output points (Object 10/12) are in the
Local state. That is, the relays control outputs are NOT accessible through the
5 Local DNP protocol. No
This IIN is clear when the relay is in the Remote state. That is, the relays control
outputs are fully accessible through the DNP protocol.
Set when an abnormal condition exists in the relay. This IIN is only used when
6 Device in trouble the state cannot be described by a combination of one or more of the other IIN No
bits.
Set when the device software application restarts. This IIN is cleared when the
7 Device restart master station explicitly writes a 0 into this bit of the Internal Indications Yes
object.
Octet 2
0 Function code not implemented The received function code is not implemented within the relay. Yes
The relay does not have the specified objects or there are no objects assigned
to the requested class.
1 Requested object(s) unknown Yes
This IIN should be used for debugging purposes and usually indicates a
mismatch in device profiles or configuration problems.
Parameters in the qualifier, range or data fields are not valid or out of range.
This is a 'catch-all' for application request formatting errors. It should only be
2 Out of range Yes
used for debugging purposes. This IIN usually indicates configuration
problems.
Event buffer(s), or other application buffers, have overflowed. The master
station should attempt to recover as much data as possible and indicate to the
3 Buffer overflow Yes
user that there may be lost data. The appropriate error recovery procedures
should be initiated by the user.
The received request was understood but the requested operation is already
4 Already executing
executing.
Set to indicate that the current configuration in the relay is corrupt. The
5 Bad configuration Yes
master station may download another configuration to the relay.
6 Reserved Always returned as zero.
7 Reserved Always returned as zero.

7.3.8.4 DNP3 RESPONSE STATUS CODES


When the device processes Control Relay Output Block (Object 12) requests, it returns a set of status codes; one for
each point contained within the original request. The complete list of codes appears in the following table:

558 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Code Number Identifier Name Description


0 Success The received request has been accepted, initiated, or queued.
The request has not been accepted because the ‘operate’ message was received after the
1 Timeout arm timer (Select Before Operate) timed out.
The arm timer was started when the select operation for the same point was received.
The request has not been accepted because no previous matching ‘select’ request exists. (An
2 No select ‘operate’ message was sent to activate an output that was not previously armed with a
matching ‘select’ message).
The request has not been accepted because there were formatting errors in the control
3 Format error
request (‘select’, ‘operate’, or ‘direct operate’).
The request has not been accepted because a control operation is not supported for this
4 Not supported
point.
The request has not been accepted because the control queue is full or the point is already
5 Already active
active.
6 Hardware error The request has not been accepted because of control hardware problems.
7 Local The request has not been accepted because local access is in progress.
8 Too many operations The request has not been accepted because too many operations have been requested.
9 Not authorized The request has not been accepted because of insufficient authorization.
127 Undefined The request not been accepted because of some other undefined reason.

Note:
Code numbers 10 through to 126 are reserved for future use.

7.3.9 DNP3 CONFIGURATION


To configure the device:
1. Select the CONFIGURATION column and check that the Comms settings cell is set to Visible.
2. Select the COMMUNICATIONS column.
3. Move to the first cell down (RP1 protocol). This is a non-settable cell, which shows the chosen
communication protocol – in this case DNP3.0.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
DNP3.0
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the DNP3.0 address of the IED. Up to 32 IEDs can
be connected to one spur, therefore it is necessary for each IED to have a unique address so that messages
from the master control station are accepted by only one IED. DNP3.0 uses a decimal number between 1
and 65519 for the Relay Address. It is important that no two IEDs have the same address.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Address
1
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Baud Rate). This cell controls the baud rate to be used. Six baud rates are
supported by the IED 1200 bps, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 9600 bps, 19200 bps and 38400 bps. Make sure that
the baud rate selected on the IED is the same as that set on the master station.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
9600 bits/s

P446SV-TM-EN-1 559
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

6. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Parity). This cell controls the parity format used in the data frames. The
parity can be set to be one of None, Odd or Even. Make sure that the parity format selected on the IED is
the same as that set on the master station.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Parity
None
7. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
8. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Time Sync). This cell affects the time synchronisation request from the
master by the IED. It can be set to enabled or disabled. If enabled it allows the DNP3.0 master to
synchronise the time on the IED.

COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Time Sync
Enabled

7.3.9.1 DNP3 CONFIGURATOR


A PC support package for DNP3.0 is available as part of the supplied settings application software (MiCOM S1 Agile)
to allow configuration of the device's DNP3.0 response. The configuration data is uploaded from the device to the
PC in a block of compressed format data and downloaded in a similar manner after modification. The new DNP3.0
configuration takes effect after the download is complete. To restore the default configuration at any time, from
the CONFIGURATION column, select the Restore Defaults cell then select All Settings.
In MiCOM S1 Agile, the DNP3.0 data is shown in three main folders, one folder each for the point configuration,
integer scaling and default variation (data format). The point configuration also includes screens for binary inputs,
binary outputs, counters and analogue input configuration.
If the device supports DNP Over Ethernet, the configuration related settings are done in the folder DNP Over
Ethernet.

7.4 IEC 61850


This section describes how the IEC 61850 standard is applied to General Electric products. It is not a description of
the standard itself. The level at which this section is written assumes that the reader is already familiar with the
IEC 61850 standard.
IEC 61850 is the international standard for Ethernet-based communication in substations. It enables integration of
all protection, control, measurement and monitoring functions within a substation, and additionally provides the
means for interlocking and inter-tripping. It combines the convenience of Ethernet with the security that is so
essential in substations today.
There are two editions of IEC 61850; IEC 61850 edition 1 and IEC 61850 edition 2. The edition which this product
supports depends on your exact model.

560 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

7.4.1 BENEFITS OF IEC 61850


The standard provides:
● Standardised models for IEDs and other equipment within the substation
● Standardised communication services (the methods used to access and exchange data)
● Standardised formats for configuration files
● Peer-to-peer communication

The standard adheres to the requirements laid out by the ISO OSI model and therefore provides complete vendor
interoperability and flexibility on the transmission types and protocols used. This includes mapping of data onto
Ethernet, which is becoming more and more widely used in substations, in favour of RS485. Using Ethernet in the
substation offers many advantages, most significantly including:
● Ethernet allows high-speed data rates (currently 100 Mbps, rather than tens of kbps or less used by most
serial protocols)
● Ethernet provides the possibility to have multiple clients
● Ethernet is an open standard in every-day use
● There is a wide range of Ethernet-compatible products that may be used to supplement the LAN installation
(hubs, bridges, switches)

7.4.2 IEC 61850 INTEROPERABILITY


A major benefit of IEC 61850 is interoperability. IEC 61850 standardizes the data model of substation IEDs, which
allows interoperability between products from multiple vendors.
An IEC 61850-compliant device may be interoperable, but this does not mean it is interchangeable. You cannot
simply replace a product from one vendor with that of another without reconfiguration. However the terminology
is pre-defined and anyone with prior knowledge of IEC 61850 should be able to integrate a new device very quickly
without having to map all of the new data. IEC 61850 brings improved substation communications and
interoperability to the end user, at a lower cost.

7.4.3 THE IEC 61850 DATA MODEL


The data model of any IEC 61850 IED can be viewed as a hierarchy of information, whose nomenclature and
categorization is defined and standardized in the IEC 61850 specification.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 561
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

Data Attributes
stVal q t PhA PhB PhC

Data Objects
Pos A

Logical Nodes : 1 to n
LN1: XCBR LN2: MMXU

Logical Device : IEDs 1 to n

Physical Device (network address)

V01008

Figure 282: Data model layers in IEC 61850

The levels of this hierarchy can be described as follows:

Data Frame format


Layer Description
Identifies the actual IED within a system. Typically the device’s name or IP address can be used (for
Physical Device
example Feeder_1 or 10.0.0.2.
Identifies groups of related Logical Nodes within the Physical Device. For the MiCOM IEDs, 5 Logical
Logical Device
Devices exist: Control, Measurements, Protection, Records, System.
Identifies the major functional areas within the IEC 61850 data model. Either 3 or 6 characters are
used as a prefix to define the functional group (wrapper) while the actual functionality is identified by
Wrapper/Logical Node Instance a 4 character Logical Node name suffixed by an instance number.
For example, XCBR1 (circuit breaker), MMXU1 (measurements), FrqPTOF2 (overfrequency protection,
stage 2).
This next layer is used to identify the type of data you will be presented with. For example, Pos
Data Object
(position) of Logical Node type XCBR.
This is the actual data (measurement value, status, description, etc.). For example, stVal (status value)
Data Attribute
indicating actual position of circuit breaker for Data Object type Pos of Logical Node type XCBR.

7.4.4 IEC 61850 IN MICOM IEDS


IEC 61850 is implemented by use of a separate Ethernet card. This Ethernet card manages the majority of the
IEC 61850 implementation and data transfer to avoid any impact on the performance of the protection functions.
To communicate with an IEC 61850 IED on Ethernet, it is necessary only to know its IP address. This can then be
configured into either:
● An IEC 61850 client (or master), for example a bay computer (MiCOM C264)
● An HMI
● An MMS browser, with which the full data model can be retrieved from the IED, without any prior knowledge
of the IED

562 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

The IEC 61850 compatible interface standard provides capability for the following:
● Read access to measurements
● Refresh of all measurements at the rate of once per second.
● Generation of non-buffered reports on change of status or measurement
● SNTP time synchronization over an Ethernet link. (This is used to synchronize the IED's internal real time
clock.
● GOOSE peer-to-peer communication
● Disturbance record extraction by file transfer. The record is extracted as an ASCII format COMTRADE file

● Controls (Direct and Select Before Operate)

Note:
Setting changes are not supported in the current IEC 61850 implementation. Currently these setting changes are carried out
using the settings application software.

7.4.5 IEC 61850 DATA MODEL IMPLEMENTATION


The data model naming adopted in the IEDs has been standardised for consistency. Therefore the Logical Nodes
are allocated to one of the five Logical Devices, as appropriate.
The data model is described in the Model Implementation Conformance Statement (MICS) document, which is
available as a separate document.

7.4.6 IEC 61850 COMMUNICATION SERVICES IMPLEMENTATION


The IEC 61850 communication services which are implemented in the IEDs are described in the Protocol
Implementation Conformance Statement (PICS) document, which is available as a separate document.

7.4.7 IEC 61850 PEER-TO-PEER (GOOSE) COMMUNICATIONS


The implementation of IEC 61850 Generic Object Oriented Substation Event (GOOSE) enables faster
communication between IEDs offering the possibility for a fast and reliable system-wide distribution of input and
output data values. The GOOSE model uses multicast services to deliver event information. Multicast messaging
means that messages are sent to selected devices on the network. The receiving devices can specifically accept
frames from certain devices and discard frames from the other devices. It is also known as a publisher-subscriber
system. When a device detects a change in one of its monitored status points it publishes a new message. Any
device that is interested in the information subscribes to the data it contains.

7.4.8 MAPPING GOOSE MESSAGES TO VIRTUAL INPUTS


Each GOOSE signal contained in a subscribed GOOSE message can be mapped to any of the virtual inputs within
the PSL. The virtual inputs allow the mapping to internal logic functions for protection control, directly to output
contacts or LEDs for monitoring.
An IED can subscribe to all GOOSE messages but only the following data types can be decoded and mapped to a
virtual input:
● BOOLEAN
● BSTR2
● INT16
● INT32

P446SV-TM-EN-1 563
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

● INT8
● UINT16
● UINT32
● UINT8

7.4.8.1 IEC 61850 GOOSE CONFIGURATION


All GOOSE configuration is performed using the IEC 61850 Configurator tool available in the MiCOM S1 Agile
software application.
All GOOSE publishing configuration can be found under the GOOSE Publishing tab in the configuration editor
window. All GOOSE subscription configuration parameters are under the External Binding tab in the configuration
editor window.
Settings to enable GOOSE signalling and to apply Test Mode are available using the HMI.

7.4.9 ETHERNET FUNCTIONALITY


IEC 61850 Associations are unique and made between the client and server. If Ethernet connectivity is lost for any
reason, the associations are lost, and will need to be re-established by the client. The IED has a TCP_KEEPALIVE
function to monitor each association, and terminate any which are no longer active.
The IED allows the re-establishment of associations without disruption of its operation, even after its power has
been removed. As the IED acts as a server in this process, the client must request the association. Uncommitted
settings are cancelled when power is lost, and reports requested by connected clients are reset. The client must
re-enable these when it next creates the new association to the IED.

7.4.10 IEC 61850 CONFIGURATION


You cannot configure the device for IEC 61850 edition 1 using the HMI panel on the product. For this you must use
the IEC 61850 Configurator, which is part of the settings application software. If the device is compatible with
edition 2, however, you can configure it with the HMI. To configure IEC61850 edition 2 using the HMI, you must first
enable the IP From HMI setting, after which you can set the media (copper or fibre), IP address, subnet mask and
gateway address.
IEC 61850 allows IEDs to be directly configured from a configuration file. The IED’s system configuration
capabilities are determined from an IED Capability Description file (ICD), supplied with the product. By using ICD
files from the products to be installed, you can design, configure and test (using simulation tools), a substation’s
entire protection scheme before the products are installed into the substation.
To help with this process, the settings application software provides an IEC 61850 Configurator tool, which allows
the pre-configured IEC 61850 configuration file to be imported and transferred to the IED. As well as this, you can
manually create configuration files for all products, based on their original IED capability description (ICD file).
Other features include:
● The extraction of configuration data for viewing and editing.
● A sophisticated error checking sequence to validate the configuration data before sending to the IED.

Note:
Some configuration data is available in the IEC61850 CONFIG. column, allowing read-only access to basic configuration data.

7.4.10.1 IEC 61850 CONFIGURATION BANKS


There are two configuration banks:
● Active Configuration Bank
● Inactive Configuration Bank

564 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

Any new configuration sent to the IED is automatically stored in the inactive configuration bank, therefore not
immediately affecting the current configuration.
Following an upgrade, the IEC 61850 Configurator tool can be used to transmit a command, which authorises
activation of the new configuration contained in the inactive configuration bank. This is done by switching the
active and inactive configuration banks. The capability of switching the configuration banks is also available using
the IEC61850 CONFIG. column of the HMI.
The SCL Name and Revision attributes of both configuration banks are available in the IEC61850 CONFIG. column
of the HMI.

7.4.10.2 IEC 61850 NETWORK CONNECTIVITY


Configuration of the IP parameters and SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol) time synchronisation parameters is
performed by the IEC 61850 Configurator tool. If these parameters are not available using an SCL (Substation
Configuration Language) file, they must be configured manually.
Every IP address on the Local Area Network must be unique. Duplicate IP addresses result in conflict and must be
avoided. Most IEDs check for a conflict on every IP configuration change and at power up and they raise an alarm
if an IP conflict is detected.
The IED can be configured to accept data from other networks using the Gateway setting. If multiple networks are
used, the IP addresses must be unique across networks.

7.4.11 IEC 61850 EDITION 2


Many parts of the IEC 61850 standard have now been released as the second edition. This offers some significant
enhancements including:
● Improved interoperability
● Many new logical nodes
● Better defined testing; it is now possible to perform off-line testing and simulation of functions

Edition 2 implementation requires use of version 3.2 of the IEC 61850 configurator, which is installed with version
1.2 of MiCOM S1 Agile.

7.4.11.1 BACKWARD COMPATIBILITY

IEC61850 System - Backward compatibility


An Edition 1 IED can operate with an Edition 2 IEC 61850 system, provided that the Edition 1 IEDs do not subscribe
to GOOSE messages with data objects or data attributes which are only available in Edition 2.
The following figure explains this concept:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 565
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

V01056

Figure 283: Edition 2 system - backward compatibility

An Edition 2 IED cannot normally operate within an Edition 1 IEC 61850 system. An Edition 2 IED can work for
GOOSE messaging in a mixed system, providing the client is compatible with Edition 2.

V01057

Figure 284: Edition 1 system - forward compatibility issues

7.4.11.2 EDITION-2 COMMON DATA CLASSES


The following common data classes (CDCs) are new to Edition 2 and therefore should not be used in GOOSE control
blocks in mixed Edition 1 and Edition 2 systems
● Histogram (HST)
● Visible string status (VSS)
● Object reference setting (ORG)
● Controllable enumerated status (ENC)
● Controllable analogue process value (APC)
● Binary controlled analogue process value (BAC)
● Enumerated status setting (ENG)

566 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

● Time setting group (TSG)


● Currency setting group (CUG)
● Visible string setting (VSG)
● Curve shape setting (CSG)

Of these, only ENS and ENC types are available from a MiCOM P40 IED when publishing GOOSE messages, so Data
Objects using these Common Data Classes should not be published in mixed Edition 1 and Edition 2 systems.
For compatibility between Edition 1 and Edition 2 IEDs, SCL files using SCL schema version 2.1 must be used. For a
purely Edition 2 system, use the schema version 3.1.

7.4.11.3 STANDBY PROTECTION REDUNDANCY


With digital substation architectures, measurements can be shared freely on the process bus across the
substation and between different devices without any additional wiring. This is because there are no longer any
electrical connections to instruments transformers that restrict the location of IEDs.
The new IEC 61850 Edition 2 test modes enable the introduction of standby protection IEDs at any location within
the substation, which has access to both station and process buses. In the case of failure, these devices can
temporarily replace the protection functions inside other IEDs.

V01059

Figure 285: Example of Standby IED

See the example below. If a failure occurs in the Bay 1 protection IED (MP2), we could disable this device and
activate a standby protection IED to replace its functionality.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 567
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

V01060

Figure 286: Standby IED Activation Process

The following sequence would occur under this scenario:


1. During the installation phase, a spare standby IED is installed in the substation. This can remain inactive,
until it is needed to replace functions in one of several bays. The device is connected to the process bus, but
does not have any subscriptions enabled.
2. If a failure occurs (in this example, bay 1), first isolate the faulty device by disabling its process bus and
station bus interfaces. You do this by turning off the attached network interfaces.
3. Retrieve the configuration that the faulty device normally uses, and load this into the standby redundant
IED.
4. Place the IED into the "Test Blocked" mode, as defined in IEC 61850-7-4 Edition Two. This allows test signals
to be injected into the network, which will check that the configuration is correct. GOOSE signals issued by
the device will be flagged as "test" so that subscribing switchgear controllers know not to trip during this
testing. In this way the protection can be tested all the way up to the switchgear control merging units
without having to operate primary circuit breakers, or by carrying out any secondary injection.
5. Take the standby IED out of "Test-Blocked" mode and activate it so that it now replaces the protection
functions that were disabled from the initial device failure.
The standby IED reduces downtime in the case of device failure, as protection functions can be restored quickly
before the faulted device is replaced.

568 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

8 READ ONLY MODE


With IEC 61850 and Ethernet/Internet communication capabilities, security has become an important issue. For
this reason, all relevant General Electric IEDs have been adapted to comply with the latest cyber-security
standards.
In addition to this, a facility is provided which allows you to enable or disable the communication interfaces. This
feature is available for products using Courier, IEC 60870-5-103, or IEC 61850.

8.1 IEC 60870-5-103 PROTOCOL BLOCKING


If Read-Only Mode is enabled for RP1 or RP2 with IEC 60870-5-103, the following commands are blocked at the
interface:
● Write parameters (=change setting) (private ASDUs)
● General Commands (ASDU20), namely:
○ INF16 auto-recloser on/off
○ INF19 LED reset
○ Private INFs (for example: CB open/close, Control Inputs)
The following commands are still allowed:
● Poll Class 1 (Read spontaneous events)
● Poll Class 2 (Read measurands)
● GI sequence (ASDU7 'Start GI', Poll Class 1)
● Transmission of Disturbance Records sequence (ASDU24, ASDU25, Poll Class 1)
● Time Synchronisation (ASDU6)
● General Commands (ASDU20), namely:
○ INF23 activate characteristic 1
○ INF24 activate characteristic 2
○ INF25 activate characteristic 3
○ INF26 activate characteristic 4

Note:
For IEC 60870-5-103, Read Only Mode function is different from the existing Command block feature.

8.2 COURIER PROTOCOL BLOCKING


If Read-Only Mode is enabled for RP1 or RP2 with Courier, the following commands are blocked at the interface:
● Write settings
● All controls, including:Reset Indication (Trip LED)
○ Operate Control Inputs
○ CB operations
○ Auto-reclose operations
○ Reset demands
○ Clear event/fault/maintenance/disturbance records
○ Test LEDs & contacts

P446SV-TM-EN-1 569
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

The following commands are still allowed:


● Read settings, statuses, measurands
● Read records (event, fault, disturbance)
● Time Synchronisation
● Change active setting group

8.3 IEC 61850 PROTOCOL BLOCKING


If Read-Only Mode is enabled for the Ethernet interfacing with IEC 61850, the following commands are blocked at
the interface:
● All controls, including:
○ Enable/disable protection
○ Operate Control Inputs
○ CB operations (Close/Trip, Lock)
○ Reset LEDs
The following commands are still allowed:
● Read statuses, measurands
● Generate reports
● Extract disturbance records
● Time synchronisation
● Change active setting group

8.4 READ-ONLY SETTINGS


The following settings are available for enabling or disabling Read Only Mode.
● RP1 Read Only
● RP2 Read Only (only for products that have RP2)
● NIC Read Only (where Ethernet is available)

8.5 READ-ONLY DDB SIGNALS


The remote read only mode is also available in the PSL using three dedicated DDB signals:
● RP1 Read Only
● RP2 Read Only (only for products that have RP2)
● NIC Read Only (where Ethernet is available)

Using the PSL, these signals can be activated by opto-inputs, Control Inputs and function keys if required.

570 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

9 TIME SYNCHRONISATION
In modern protection schemes it is necessary to synchronise the IED's real time clock so that events from different
devices can be time stamped and placed in chronological order. This is achieved in various ways depending on the
chosen options and communication protocols.
● Using the IRIG-B input (if fitted)
● Using the SNTP time protocol (for Ethernet IEC 61850 versions + DNP3 OE)
● By using the time synchronisation functionality inherent in the data protocols

9.1 DEMODULATED IRIG-B


IRIG stands for Inter Range Instrumentation Group, which is a standards body responsible for standardising
different time code formats. There are several different formats starting with IRIG-A, followed by IRIG-B and so on.
The letter after the "IRIG" specifies the resolution of the time signal in pulses per second (PPS). IRIG-B, the one which
we use has a resolution of 100 PPS. IRIG-B is used when accurate time-stamping is required.
The following diagram shows a typical GPS time-synchronised substation application. The satellite RF signal is
picked up by a satellite dish and passed on to receiver. The receiver receives the signal and converts it into time
signal suitable for the substation network. IEDs in the substation use this signal to govern their internal clocks and
event recorders.

GPS time signal GPS satellite

IRIG-B

Satellite dish Receiver IED IED IED

V01040

Figure 287: GPS Satellite timing signal

The IRIG-B time code signal is a sequence of one second time frames. Each frame is split up into ten 100 mS slots
as follows:
● Time-slot 1: Seconds
● Time-slot 2: Minutes
● Time-slot 3: Hours
● Time-slot 4: Days
● Time-slot 5 and 6: Control functions
● Time-slots 7 to 10: Straight binary time of day

The first four time-slots define the time in BCD (Binary Coded Decimal). Time-slots 5 and 6 are used for control
functions, which control deletion commands and allow different data groupings within the synchronisation strings.
Time-slots 7-10 define the time in SBS (Straight Binary Second of day).

9.1.1 IRIG-B IMPLEMENTATION


Depending on the chosen hardware options, the product can be equipped with an IRIG-B input for time
synchronisation purposes. The IRIG-B interface is implemented either on a dedicated card, or together with other

P446SV-TM-EN-1 571
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

communication functionality such as Ethernet. The IRIG-B connection is presented by a connector is a BNC
connector. IRIG-B signals are usually presented as an RF-modulated signal. There are two types of input to our
IRIG-B boards: demodulated or modulated. A board that accepts a demodulated input is used where the IRIG-B
signal has already been demodulated by another device before being fed to the IED. A board that accepts a
modulated input has an on-board demodulator.
To set the device to use IRIG-B, use the setting IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND TIME column.
The IRIG-B status can be viewed in the IRIG-B Status cell in the DATE AND TIME column.

9.2 SNTP
SNTP is used to synchronise the clocks of computer systems over packet-switched, variable-latency data
networks, such as IP. SNTP can be used as the time synchronisation method for models using IEC 61850 over
Ethernet.
The device is synchronised by the main SNTP server. This is achieved by entering the IP address of the SNTP server
into the IED using the IEC 61850 Configurator software described in the settings application software manual. A
second server is also configured with a different IP address for backup purposes.
This function issues an alarm when there is a loss of time synchronisation on the SNTP server. This could be
because there is no response or no valid clock signal.
The HMI menu does not contain any configurable settings relating to SNTP, as the only way to configure it is using
the IEC 61850 Configurator. However it is possible to view some parameters in the COMMUNICATIONS column
under the sub-heading SNTP parameters. Here you can view the SNTP server addresses and the SNTP poll rate in
the cells SNTP Server 1, SNTP Server 2 and SNTP Poll rate respectively.
The SNTP time synchronisation status is displayed in the SNTP Status cell in the DATE AND TIME column.

9.2.1 LOSS OF SNTP SERVER SIGNAL ALARM


This function issues an alarm when there is a loss of time synchronization on the SNTP server. It is issued when the
SNTP sever has not detected a valid time synchronisation response within its 5 second window. This is because
there is no response or no valid clock. The alarm is mapped to IEC 61850.

9.3 IEEE 1588 PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL


The MiCOM P40 modular products support the IEEE C37.238 (Power Profile) of IEEE 1588 Precision Time Protocol
(PTP) as a slave-only clock. This can be used to replace or supplement IRIG-B and SNTP time synchronisation so
that the IED can be synchronised using Ethernet messages from the substation LAN without any additional
physical connections being required.
A dedicated DDB signal (PTP Failure) his provided to indicate failure of failure of PTP.

9.3.1 ACCURACY AND DELAY CALCULATION


A time synchronisation accuracy of within 5 ms is possible. Both peer-to-peer or end-to-end mode delay
measurement can be used.
In peer-to-peer mode, delays are measured between each link in the network and are compensated for. This
provides greater accuracy, but requires that every device between the Grand Master and Slaves supports the
peer-to-peer delay measurement.
In end-to-end mode, delays are only measured between each Grand Master and Slave. The advantage of this
mode is that the requirements for the switches on the network are lower; they do not need to independently
calculate delays. The main disadvantage is that more inaccuracy is introduced, because the method assumes that
forward and reverse delays are always the same, which may not always be correct.

572 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications

When using end-to-end mode, the IED can be connected in a ring or line topology using RSTP or Self Healing
Protocol without any additional Transparent Clocks. But because the IED is a slave-only device, additional
inaccuracy is introduced. The additional error will be less than 1ms for a network of eight devices.

V01061

Figure 288: Timing error using ring or line topology

9.3.2 PTP DOMAINS


PTP traffic can be segregated into different domains using Boundary Clocks. These allow different PTP clocks to
share the same network while maintaining independent synchronisation within each grouped set.

9.4 TIME SYNCHRONSIATION USING THE COMMUNICATION PROTOCOLS


All communication protocols have in-built time synchronisation mechanisms. If an external time synchronisation
mechanism such as IRIG-B, SNTP, or IEEE 1588 PTP is not used to synchronise the devices, the time synchronisation
mechanism within the relevant serial protocol is used. The real time is usually defined in the master station and
communicated to the relevant IEDs via one of the rear serial ports using the chosen protocol. It is also possible to
define the time locally using settings in the DATE AND TIME column.
The time synchronisation for each protocol is described in the relevant protocol description section.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 573
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV

574 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 22

CYBER-SECURITY
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

576 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

1 OVERVIEW
In the past, substation networks were traditionally isolated and the protocols and data formats used to transfer
information between devices were often proprietary.
For these reasons, the substation environment was very secure against cyber-attacks. The terms used for this
inherent type of security are:
● Security by isolation (if the substation network is not connected to the outside world, it cannot be accessed
from the outside world).
● Security by obscurity (if the formats and protocols are proprietary, it is very difficult to interpret them).

The increasing sophistication of protection schemes, coupled with the advancement of technology and the desire
for vendor interoperability, has resulted in standardisation of networks and data interchange within substations.
Today, devices within substations use standardised protocols for communication. Furthermore, substations can be
interconnected with open networks, such as the internet or corporate-wide networks, which use standardised
protocols for communication. This introduces a major security risk making the grid vulnerable to cyber-attacks,
which could in turn lead to major electrical outages.
Clearly, there is now a need to secure communication and equipment within substation environments. This
chapter describes the security measures that have been put in place for our range of Intelligent Electronic Devices
(IEDs).

Note:
Cyber-security compatible devices do not enforce NERC compliance, they merely facilitate it. It is the responsibility of the user
to ensure that compliance is adhered to as and when necessary.

This chapter contains the following sections:


Overview 577
The Need for Cyber-Security 578
Standards 579
Cyber-Security Implementation 583

P446SV-TM-EN-1 577
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

2 THE NEED FOR CYBER-SECURITY


Cyber-security provides protection against unauthorised disclosure, transfer, modification, or destruction of
information or information systems, whether accidental or intentional. To achieve this, there are several security
requirements:
● Confidentiality (preventing unauthorised access to information)
● Integrity (preventing unauthorised modification)
● Availability / Authentication (preventing the denial of service and assuring authorised access to information)
● Non-repudiation (preventing the denial of an action that took place)
● Traceability / Detection (monitoring and logging of activity to detect intrusion and analyse incidents)

The threats to cyber-security may be unintentional (e.g. natural disasters, human error), or intentional (e.g. cyber-
attacks by hackers).
Good cyber-security can be achieved with a range of measures, such as closing down vulnerability loopholes,
implementing adequate security processes and procedures and providing technology to help achieve this.
Examples of vulnerabilities are:
● Indiscretions by personnel (users keep passwords on their computer)
● Bad practice (users do not change default passwords, or everyone uses the same password to access all
substation equipment)
● Bypassing of controls (users turn off security measures)
● Inadequate technology (substation is not firewalled)

Examples of availability issues are:


● Equipment overload, resulting in reduced or no performance
● Expiry of a certificate preventing access to equipment

To help tackle these issues, standards organisations have produced various standards. Compliance with these
standards significantly reduces the threats associated with lack of cyber-security.

578 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

3 STANDARDS
There are several standards, which apply to substation cyber-security. The standards currently applicable to
General Electric IEDs are NERC and IEEE1686.
Standard Country Description
NERC CIP (North American Electric Reliability
USA Framework for the protection of the grid critical Cyber Assets
Corporation)
BDEW (German Association of Energy and Water Requirements for Secure Control and Telecommunication
Germany
Industries) Systems
ICS oriented then Relevant for EPU completing existing standard
ANSI ISA 99 USA
and identifying new topics such as patch management
International Standard for substation IED cyber-security
IEEE 1686 International
capabilities
IEC 62351 International Power system data and Comm. protocol
ISO/IEC 27002 International Framework for the protection of the grid critical Cyber Assets
NIST SP800-53 (National Institute of Standards and
USA Complete framework for SCADA SP800-82and ICS cyber-security
Technology)
CPNI Guidelines (Centre for the Protection of National Clear and valuable good practices for Process Control and SCADA
UK
Infrastructure) security

3.1 NERC COMPLIANCE


The North American Electric Reliability Corporation (NERC) created a set of standards for the protection of critical
infrastructure. These are known as the CIP standards (Critical Infrastructure Protection). These were introduced to
ensure the protection of 'Critical Cyber Assets', which control or have an influence on the reliability of North
America’s electricity generation and distribution systems.
These standards have been compulsory in the USA for several years now. Compliance auditing started in June
2007, and utilities face extremely heavy fines for non-compliance.

NERC CIP standards


CIP standard Description
CIP-002-1 Critical Cyber Assets Define and document the Critical Assets and the Critical Cyber Assets
Define and document the Security Management Controls required to protect the
CIP-003-1 Security Management Controls
Critical Cyber Assets
Define and Document Personnel handling and training required protecting Critical
CIP-004-1 Personnel and Training
Cyber Assets
Define and document logical security perimeters where Critical Cyber Assets reside.
CIP-005-1 Electronic Security Define and document measures to control access points and monitor electronic
access
Define and document Physical Security Perimeters within which Critical Cyber Assets
CIP-006-1 Physical Security
reside
Define and document system test procedures, account and password management,
CIP-007-1 Systems Security Management security patch management, system vulnerability, system logging, change control
and configuration required for all Critical Cyber Assets
Define and document procedures necessary when Cyber-security Incidents relating
CIP-008-1 Incident Reporting and Response Planning
to Critical Cyber Assets are identified
CIP-009-1 Recovery Plans Define and document Recovery plans for Critical Cyber Assets

P446SV-TM-EN-1 579
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

3.1.1 CIP 002


CIP 002 concerns itself with the identification of:
● Critical assets, such as overhead lines and transformers
● Critical cyber assets, such as IEDs that use routable protocols to communicate outside or inside the
Electronic Security Perimeter; or are accessible by dial-up

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


We can help the power utilities to create this asset register automatically.
Create the list of the assets
We can provide audits to list the Cyber assets

3.1.2 CIP 003


CIP 003 requires the implementation of a cyber-security policy, with associated documentation, which
demonstrates the management’s commitment and ability to secure its Critical Cyber Assets.
The standard also requires change control practices whereby all entity or vendor-related changes to hardware
and software components are documented and maintained.

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


We can help the power utilities to have access control to its critical assets by
providing centralized Access control.
To create a Cyber-security Policy
We can help the customer with its change control by providing a section in the
documentation where it describes changes affecting the hardware and software.

3.1.3 CIP 004


CIP 004 requires that personnel with authorized cyber access or authorized physical access to Critical Cyber
Assets, (including contractors and service vendors), have an appropriate level of training.

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


To provide appropriate training of its personnel We can provide cyber-security training

3.1.4 CIP 005


CIP 005 requires the establishment of an Electronic Security Perimeter (ESP), which provides:
● The disabling of ports and services that are not required
● Permanent monitoring and access to logs (24x7x365)
● Vulnerability Assessments (yearly at a minimum)
● Documentation of Network Changes

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


To monitor access to the ESP
To disable all ports not used in the IED
To perform the vulnerability assessments
To monitor and record all access to the IED
To document network changes

3.1.5 CIP 006


CIP 006 states that Physical Security controls, providing perimeter monitoring and logging along with robust
access controls, must be implemented and documented. All cyber assets used for Physical Security are considered
critical and should be treated as such:

580 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


Provide physical security controls and perimeter
monitoring.
General Electric cannot provide additional help with this aspect.
Ensure that people who have access to critical cyber
assets don’t have criminal records.

3.1.6 CIP 007


CIP 007 covers the following points:
● Test procedures
● Ports and services
● Security patch management
● Antivirus
● Account management
● Monitoring
● An annual vulnerability assessment should be performed

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


Test procedures, we can provide advice and help on testing.
Ports and services, our devices can disable unused ports and services
To provide an incident response team and have Security patch management, we can provide assistance
appropriate processes in place Antivirus, we can provide advise and assistance
Account management, we can provide advice and assistance
Monitoring, our equipment monitors and logs access

3.1.7 CIP 008


CIP 008 requires that an incident response plan be developed, including the definition of an incident response
team, their responsibilities and associated procedures.

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


To provide an incident response team and have
General Electric cannot provide additional help with this aspect.
appropriate processes in place.

3.1.8 CIP 009


CIP 009 states that a disaster recovery plan should be created and tested with annual drills.

Power utility responsibilities: General Electric's contribution:


To provide guidelines on recovery plans and backup/restore
To implement a recovery plan
documentation

3.2 IEEE 1686-2007


IEEE 1686-2007 is an IEEE Standard for substation IEDs' cyber-security capabilities. It proposes practical and
achievable mechanisms to achieve secure operations.
The following features described in this standard apply:
● Passwords are 8 characters long and can contain upper-case, lower-case, numeric and special characters.
● Passwords are never displayed or transmitted to a user.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 581
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

● IED functions and features are assigned to different password levels. The assignment is fixed.
● The audit trail is recorded, listing events in the order in which they occur, held in a circular buffer.
● Records contain all defined fields from the standard and record all defined function event types where the
function is supported.
● No password defeat mechanism exists. Instead a secure recovery password scheme is implemented.
● Unused ports (physical and logical) may be disabled.

582 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

4 CYBER-SECURITY IMPLEMENTATION
The General Electric IEDs have always been and will continue to be equipped with state-of-the-art security
measures. Due to the ever-evolving communication technology and new threats to security, this requirement is
not static. Hardware and software security measures are continuously being developed and implemented to
mitigate the associated threats and risks.
This section describes the current implementation of cyber-security. This is valid for the release of platform
software to which this manual pertains. This current cyber-security implementation is known as Cyber-security
Phase 1.
At the IED level, these cyber-security measures have been implemented:
● NERC-compliant default display
● Four-level access
● Enhanced password security
● Password recovery procedure
● Disabling of unused physical and logical ports
● Inactivity timer
● Security events management

External to the IEDs, the following cyber-security measures have been implemented:
● Antivirus
● Security patch management

4.1 NERC-COMPLIANT DISPLAY


For the device to be NERC-compliant, it must provide the option for a NERC-compliant default display. The default
display that is implemented in our cyber-security concept contains a warning that the IED can be accessed by
authorised users. You can change this if required with the User Banner setting in the SECURITY CONFIG column.

ACCESS ONLY FOR


AUTHORISED USERS
HOTKEY

If you try to change the default display from the NERC-compliant one, a further warning is displayed:

DISPLAY NOT NERC


COMPLIANT OK?

The default display navigation map shows how NERC-compliance is achieved with the product's default display
concept.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 583
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

NERC compliant
banner

NERC Compliance NERC Compliance


Warning Warning

System Current
Access Level
Measurements

System Voltage
System Frequency
Measurements

System Power
Plant Reference
Measurements

Description Date & Time

V00403

Figure 289: Default display navigation

4.2 FOUR-LEVEL ACCESS


The menu structure contains four levels of access, three of which are password protected.

Password levels
Level Meaning Read Operation Write Operation
SYSTEM DATA column:
Description
Plant Reference
Model Number
Serial Number
S/W Ref.
Access Level
Read Some Password Entry
0 Security Feature
Write Minimal LCD Contrast (UI only)
SECURITY CONFIG column:
User Banner
Attempts Remain
Blk Time Remain
Fallback PW level
Security Code (UI only)
All items writeable at level 0.
Level 1 Password setting
Read All All data and settings are readable.
1 Extract Disturbance Record
Write Few Poll Measurements
Select Event, Main and Fault (upload)
Extract Events (e.g. via MiCOM S1 Studio)

584 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

Level Meaning Read Operation Write Operation


All items writeable at level 1.
Setting Cells that change visibility (Visible/Invisible).
Setting Values (Primary/Secondary) selector
Commands:
Read All All data and settings are readable.
2 Reset Indication
Write Some Poll Measurements
Reset Demand
Reset Statistics
Reset CB Data / counters
Level 2 Password setting
All items writeable at level 2.
Change all Setting cells
Operations:
Extract and download Setting file.
Extract and download PSL
Extract and download MCL61850 (IEC61850 CONFIG)
Auto-extraction of Disturbance Recorder
Courier/Modbus Accept Event (auto event extraction, e.g. via
Read All All data and settings are readable.
3 A2R)
Write All Poll Measurements
Commands:
Change Active Group setting
Close / Open CB
Change Comms device address.
Set Date & Time
Switch MCL banks / Switch Conf. Bank in UI (IEC61850 CONFIG)
Enable / Disable Device ports (in SECURITY CONFIG column)
Level 3 password setting

4.2.1 BLANK PASSWORDS


A blank password is effectively a zero-length password. Through the front panel it is entered by confirming the
password entry without actually entering any password characters. Through a communications port the Courier
and Modbus protocols each have a means of writing a blank password to the IED. A blank password disables the
need for a password at the level that this password is applied.
Blank passwords have a slightly different validation procedure. If a blank password is entered through the front
panel, the following text is displayed, after which the procedure is the same as already described:

BLANK PASSWORD
ENTERED CONFIRM

Blank passwords cannot be configured if the lower level password is not blank.
Blank passwords affect the fall back level after inactivity timeout or logout.
The ‘fallback level’ is the password level adopted by the IED after an inactivity timeout, or after the user logs out.
This will be either the level of the highest-level password that is blank, or level 0 if no passwords are blank.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 585
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

4.2.2 PASSWORD RULES


● Default passwords are blank for Level 1 and are AAAA for Levels 2 and 3
● Passwords may be any length between 0 and 8 characters long
● Passwords may or may not be NERC compliant
● Passwords may contain any ASCII character in the range ASCII code 33 (21 Hex) to ASCII code 122 (7A Hex)
inclusive
● Only one password is required for all the IED interfaces

4.2.3 ACCESS LEVEL DDBS


The 'Access level' cell is in the 'System data' column (address 00D0). Also the current level of access for each
interface is available for use in the Programming Scheme Logic (PSL) by mapping to these Digital Data Bus (DDB)
signals:
● HMI Access Lvl 1
● HMI Access Lvl 2
● FPort AccessLvl1
● FPort AccessLvl2
● RPrt1 AccessLvl1
● RPrt1 AccessLvl2
● RPrt2 AccessLvl1
● RPrt2 AccessLvl2

Each pair of DDB signals indicates the access level as follows:


● Level 1 off, Level 2 off = 0
● Level 1 on, Level 2 off = 1
● Level 1 off, Level 2 on = 2
● Level 1 on, Level 2 on = 3

Key:
HMI = Human Machine Interface
FPort = Front Port
RPrt = Rear Port
Lvl = Level

4.3 ENHANCED PASSWORD SECURITY


Cyber-security requires strong passwords and validation for NERC compliance.

4.3.1 PASSWORD STRENGTHENING


NERC compliant passwords have the following requirements:
● At least one upper-case alpha character
● At least one lower-case alpha character
● At least one numeric character
● At least one special character (%,$...)
● At least six characters long

586 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

4.3.2 PASSWORD VALIDATION


The IED checks for NERC compliance. If the password is entered through the front panel, this is briefly displayed on
the LCD.
If the entered password is NERC compliant, the following text is displayed.

NERC COMPLIANT
P/WORD WAS SAVED

If the password entered is not NERC-compliant, the user is required to actively confirm this, in which case the non-
compliance is logged.
If the entered password is not NERC compliant, the following text is displayed:

NERC COMPLIANCE
NOT MET CONFIRM?

On confirmation, the non-compliant password is stored and the following acknowledgement message is displayed
for 2 seconds.

NON-NERC P/WORD
SAVED OK

If the action is cancelled, the password is rejected and the following message is displayed for 2 seconds.

NON-NERC P/WORD
NOT SAVE

If the password is entered through a communications port using Courier or Modbus protocols, the device will store
the password, irrespective of whether it is NERC-compliant or not. It then uses appropriate response codes to
inform the client of the NERC-compliancy status. You can then choose to enter a new NERC-compliant password
or accept the non-NERC compliant password just entered.

4.3.3 PASSWORD BLOCKING


You are locked out temporarily, after a defined number of failed password entry attempts. Each invalid password
entry attempt decrements the 'Attempts Remain' data cell by 1. When the maximum number of attempts has been
reached, access is blocked. If the attempts timer expires, or the correct password is entered before the 'attempt
count' reaches the maximum number, then the 'attempts count' is reset to 0.
An attempt is only counted if the attempted password uses only characters in the valid range, but the attempted
password is not correct (does not match the corresponding password in the IED). Any attempt where one or more
characters of the attempted password are not in the valid range will not be counted.
Once the password entry is blocked, a 'blocking timer' is started. Attempts to access the interface while the
'blocking timer' is running results in an error message, irrespective of whether the correct password is entered or
not. Once the 'blocking timer' has expired, access to the interface is unblocked and the attempts counter is reset to
zero.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 587
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

If you try to enter the password while the interface is blocked, the following message is displayed for 2 seconds.

NOT ACCEPTED
ENTRY IS BLOCKED

A similar response occurs if you try to enter the password through a communications port.
The parameters can then be configured using the Attempts Limit, Attempts Timer and Blocking Timer settings in
the SECURITY CONFIG column.

Password blocking configuration


Cell
Setting Units Default Setting Available Setting
col row
Attempts Limit 25 02 3 0 to 3 step 1
Attempts Timer 25 03 Minutes 2 1 to 3 step 1
Blocking Timer 25 04 Minutes 5 1 to 30 step 1

4.4 PASSWORD RECOVERY


If you mislay a device's password, they can be recovered. To obtain the recovery password you must contact the
Contact Centre and supply the Serial Number and its Security Code. The Contact Centre will use these items to
generate a Recovery Password.
The security code is a 16-character string of upper case characters. It is a read-only parameter. The device
generates its own security code randomly. A new code is generated under the following conditions:
● On power up
● Whenever settings are set back to default
● On expiry of validity timer (see below)
● When the recovery password is entered

As soon as the security code is displayed on the LCD, a validity timer is started. This validity timer is set to 72 hours
and is not configurable. This provides enough time for the contact centre to manually generate and send a
recovery password. The Service Level Agreement (SLA) for recovery password generation is one working day, so 72
hours is sufficient time, even allowing for closure of the contact centre over weekends and bank holidays.
To prevent accidental reading of the IED security code, the cell will initially display a warning message:

PRESS ENTER TO
READ SEC. CODE

The security code is displayed on confirmation. The validity timer is then started. The security code can only be
read from the front panel.

4.4.1 PASSWORD RECOVERY


The recovery password is intended for recovery only. It is not a replacement password that can be used
continually. It can only be used once – for password recovery.
Entry of the recovery password causes the IED to reset all passwords back to default. This is all it is designed to do.
After the passwords have been set back to default, it is up to the user to enter new passwords. Each password
should be appropriate for its intended function, ensuring NERC compliance, if required.

588 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

On this action, the following message is displayed:

PASSWORDS HAVE
BEEN SET TO
DEFAULT

The recovery password can be applied through any interface, local or remote. It will achieve the same result
irrespective of which interface it is applied through.

4.4.2 PASSWORD ENCRYPTION


The IED supports encryption for passwords entered remotely. The encryption key can be read from the IED through
a specific cell available only through communication interfaces, not the front panel. Each time the key is read the
IED generates a new key that is valid only for the next password encryption write. Once used, the key is invalidated
and a new key must be read for the next encrypted password write. The encryption mechanism is otherwise
transparent to the user.

4.5 DISABLING PHYSICAL PORTS


It is possible to disable unused physical ports. A level 3 password is needed to perform this action.
To prevent accidental disabling of a port, a warning message is displayed according to whichever port is required
to be disabled. For example if rear port 1 is to be disabled, the following message appears:

REAR PORT 1 TO BE
DISABLED.CONFIRM

The following ports can be disabled, depending on the model.


● Front port (Front Port setting)
● Rear port 1 (Rear Port 1 setting)
● Rear port 2 (Rear Port 2 setting)
● Ethernet port (Ethernet setting)

Note:
It is not possible to disable a port from which the disabling port command originates.

Note:
We do not generally advise disabling the physical Ethernet port.

4.6 DISABLING LOGICAL PORTS


It is possible to disable unused logical ports. A level 3 password is needed to perform this action.

Note:
The port disabling setting cells are not provided in the settings file. It is only possible to do this using the HMI front panel.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 589
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

The following protocols can be disabled:


● IEC 61850 (IEC61850 setting)
● DNP3 Over Ethernet (DNP3 OE setting)
● Courier Tunnelling (Courier Tunnel setting)

Note:
If any of these protocols are enabled or disabled, the Ethernet card will reboot.

4.7 SECURITY EVENTS MANAGEMENT


To implement NERC-compliant cyber-security, a range of Event records need to be generated. These log security
issues such as the entry of a non-NERC-compliant password, or the selection of a non-NERC-compliant default
display.

Security event values


Event Value Display
USER LOGGED IN
PASSWORD LEVEL UNLOCKED
ON {int} LEVEL {n}
USER LOGGED OUT
PASSWORD LEVEL RESET
ON {int} LEVEL {n}
P/WORD SET BLANK
PASSWORD SET BLANK
BY {int} LEVEL {p}
P/WORD NOT-NERC
PASSWORD SET NON-COMPLIANT
BY {int} LEVEL {p}
PASSWORD CHANGED
PASSWORD MODIFIED
BY {int} LEVEL {p}
PASSWORD BLOCKED
PASSWORD ENTRY BLOCKED
ON {int}
P/WORD UNBLOCKED
PASSWORD ENTRY UNBLOCKED
ON {int}
INV P/W ENTERED
INVALID PASSWORD ENTERED
ON <int}
P/WORD EXPIRED
PASSWORD EXPIRED
ON {int}
P/W ENT WHEN BLK
PASSWORD ENTERED WHILE BLOCKED
ON {int}
RCVY P/W ENTERED
RECOVERY PASSWORD ENTERED
ON {int}
IED SEC CODE RD
IED SECURITY CODE READ
ON {int}
IED SEC CODE EXP
IED SECURITY CODE TIMER EXPIRED
-
PORT DISABLED
PORT DISABLED
BY {int} PORT {prt}
PORT ENABLED
PORT ENABLED
BY {int} PORT {prt}
DEF. DISPLAY NOT NERC COMPLIANT DEF DSP NOT-NERC
PSL STNG D/LOAD
PSL SETTINGS DOWNLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}

590 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security

Event Value Display


DNP STNG D/LOAD
DNP SETTINGS DOWNLOADED
BY {int}
TRACE DAT D/LOAD
TRACE DATA DOWNLOADED
BY {int}
IED CONFG D/LOAD
IEC61850 CONFIG DOWNLOADED
BY {int}
USER CRV D/LOAD
USER CURVES DOWNLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {crv}
PSL CONFG D/LOAD
PSL CONFIG DOWNLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
SETTINGS D/LOAD
SETTINGS DOWNLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
PSL STNG UPLOAD
PSL SETTINGS UPLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
DNP STNG UPLOAD
DNP SETTINGS UPLOADED
BY {int}
TRACE DAT UPLOAD
TRACE DATA UPLOADED
BY {int}
IED CONFG UPLOAD
IEC61850 CONFIG UPLOADED
BY {int}
USER CRV UPLOAD
USER CURVES UPLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {crv}
PSL CONFG UPLOAD
PSL CONFIG UPLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
SETTINGS UPLOAD
SETTINGS UPLOADED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
EVENTS EXTRACTED
EVENTS HAVE BEEN EXTRACTED
BY {int} {nov} EVNTS
ACTIVE GRP CHNGE
ACTIVE GROUP CHANGED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
C & S CHANGED
CS SETTINGS CHANGED
BY {int}
DR CHANGED
DR SETTINGS CHANGED
BY {int}
SETTINGS CHANGED
SETTING GROUP CHANGED
BY {int} GROUP {grp}
POWER ON
POWER ON
-
S/W DOWNLOADED
SOFTWARE_DOWNLOADED
-

where:
● int is the interface definition (UI, FP, RP1, RP2, TNL, TCP)
● prt is the port ID (FP, RP1, RP2, TNL, DNP3, IEC, ETHR)
● grp is the group number (1, 2, 3, 4)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 591
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV

● crv is the Curve group number (1, 2, 3, 4)


● n is the new access level (0, 1, 2, 3)
● p is the password level (1, 2, 3)
● nov is the number of events (1 – nnn)

Each new event has an incremented unique number, therefore missing events appear as ‘gap’ in the sequence.
The unique identifier forms part of the event record that is read or uploaded from the IED.

Note:
It is no longer possible to clear Event, Fault, Maintenance, and Disturbance Records.

4.8 LOGGING OUT


If you have been configuring the IED, you should 'log out'. Do this by going up to the top of the menu tree. When
you are at the Column Heading level and you press the Up button, you may be prompted to log out with the
following display:

DO YOU WANT TO
LOG OUT?

You will only be asked this question if your password level is higher than the fallback level.
If you confirm, the following message is displayed for 2 seconds:

LOGGED OUT
Access Level #

Where # is the current fallback level.


If you decide not to log out, the following message is displayed for 2 seconds.

LOGOUT CANCELLED
Access Level #

where # is the current access level.

592 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 23

INSTALLATION
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

594 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about installing the product.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 595
Handling the Goods 596
Mounting the Device 597
Cables and Connectors 600
Case Dimensions 604

P446SV-TM-EN-1 595
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

2 HANDLING THE GOODS


Our products are of robust construction but require careful treatment before installation on site. This section
discusses the requirements for receiving and unpacking the goods, as well as associated considerations regarding
product care and personal safety.

Caution:
Before lifting or moving the equipment you should be familiar with the Safety
Information chapter of this manual.

2.1 RECEIPT OF THE GOODS


On receipt, ensure the correct product has been delivered. Unpack the product immediately to ensure there has
been no external damage in transit. If the product has been damaged, make a claim to the transport contractor
and notify us promptly.
For products not intended for immediate installation, repack them in their original delivery packaging.

2.2 UNPACKING THE GOODS


When unpacking and installing the product, take care not to damage any of the parts and make sure that
additional components are not accidentally left in the packing or lost. Do not discard any CDROMs or technical
documentation. These should accompany the unit to its destination substation and put in a dedicated place.
The site should be well lit to aid inspection, clean, dry and reasonably free from dust and excessive vibration. This
particularly applies where installation is being carried out at the same time as construction work.

2.3 STORING THE GOODS


If the unit is not installed immediately, store it in a place free from dust and moisture in its original packaging. Keep
any de-humidifier bags included in the packing. The de-humidifier crystals lose their efficiency if the bag is
exposed to ambient conditions. Restore the crystals before replacing it in the carton. Ideally regeneration should
be carried out in a ventilating, circulating oven at about 115°C. Bags should be placed on flat racks and spaced to
allow circulation around them. The time taken for regeneration will depend on the size of the bag. If a ventilating,
circulating oven is not available, when using an ordinary oven, open the door on a regular basis to let out the
steam given off by the regenerating silica gel.
On subsequent unpacking, make sure that any dust on the carton does not fall inside. Avoid storing in locations of
high humidity. In locations of high humidity the packaging may become impregnated with moisture and the de-
humidifier crystals will lose their efficiency.
The device can be stored between –25º to +70ºC for unlimited periods or between -40°C to + 85°C for up to 96
hours (see technical specifications).

2.4 DISMANTLING THE GOODS


If you need to dismantle the device, always observe standard ESD (Electrostatic Discharge) precautions. The
minimum precautions to be followed are as follows:
● Use an antistatic wrist band earthed to a suitable earthing point.
● Avoid touching the electronic components and PCBs.

596 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation

3 MOUNTING THE DEVICE


The products are dispatched either individually or as part of a panel or rack assembly.
Individual products are normally supplied with an outline diagram showing the dimensions for panel cut-outs and
hole centres.
The products are designed so the fixing holes in the mounting flanges are only accessible when the access covers
are open.
If you use a P991 or MMLG test block with the product, when viewed from the front, position the test block on the
right-hand side of the associated product. This minimises the wiring between the product and test block, and
allows the correct test block to be easily identified during commissioning and maintenance tests.
If you need to test the product for correct operation during installation, open the lower access cover, hold the
battery in place and pull the red tab to remove the battery isolation strip.

V01412

Figure 290: Location of battery isolation strip

3.1 FLUSH PANEL MOUNTING


Panel-mounted devices are flush mounted into panels using M4 SEMS Taptite self-tapping screws with captive
3 mm thick washers (also known as a SEMS unit).

Caution:
Do not use conventional self-tapping screws, because they have larger heads and could
damage the faceplate.

Alternatively, you can use tapped holes if the panel has a minimum thickness of 2.5 mm.
For applications where the product needs to be semi-projection or projection mounted, a range of collars are
available.
If several products are mounted in a single cut-out in the panel, mechanically group them horizontally or vertically
into rigid assemblies before mounting in the panel.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 597
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

Caution:
Do not fasten products with pop rivets because this makes them difficult to remove if
repair becomes necessary.

3.2 RACK MOUNTING


Panel-mounted variants can also be rack mounted using single-tier rack frames (our part number FX0021 101), as
shown in the figure below. These frames are designed with dimensions in accordance with IEC 60297 and are
supplied pre-assembled ready to use. On a standard 483 mm (19 inch) rack this enables combinations of case
widths up to a total equivalent of size 80TE to be mounted side by side.
The two horizontal rails of the rack frame have holes drilled at approximately 26 mm intervals. Attach the products
by their mounting flanges using M4 Taptite self-tapping screws with captive 3 mm thick washers (also known as a
SEMS unit).

Caution:
Risk of damage to the front cover molding. Do not use conventional self-tapping
screws, including those supplied for mounting MiDOS products because they have
slightly larger heads.

Once the tier is complete, the frames are fastened into the racks using mounting angles at each end of the tier.

Figure 291: Rack mounting of products

Products can be mechanically grouped into single tier (4U) or multi-tier arrangements using the rack frame. This
enables schemes using products from different product ranges to be pre-wired together before mounting.
Use blanking plates to fill any empty spaces. The spaces may be used for installing future products or because the
total size is less than 80TE on any tier. Blanking plates can also be used to mount ancillary components. The part
numbers are as follows:

Case size summation Blanking plate part number


5TE GJ2028 101
10TE GJ2028 102

598 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation

Case size summation Blanking plate part number


15TE GJ2028 103
20TE GJ2028 104
25TE GJ2028 105
30TE GJ2028 106
35TE GJ2028 107
40TE GJ2028 108

P446SV-TM-EN-1 599
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

4 CABLES AND CONNECTORS


This section describes the type of wiring and connections that should be used when installing the device. For pin-
out details please refer to the Hardware Design chapter or the wiring diagrams.

Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the Safety
Section and the ratings on the equipment’s rating label.

4.1 TERMINAL BLOCKS


The device may use one or more of the terminal block types shown in the following diagram. The terminal blocks
are fastened to the rear panel with screws.
● Heavy duty (HD) terminal blocks for CT and VT circuits
● Medium duty (MD) terminal blocks for the power supply, relay outputs and rear communications port
● MiDOS terminal blocks for CT and VT circuits
● RTD/CLIO terminal block for connection to analogue transducers

Figure 292: Terminal block types

MiCOM products are supplied with sufficient M4 screws for making connections to the rear mounted terminal
blocks using ring terminals, with a recommended maximum of two ring terminals per terminal.
If required, M4 90° crimp ring terminals can be supplied in three different sizes depending on wire size. Each type is
available in bags of 100.
Part number Wire size Insulation color
ZB9124 901 0.25 - 1.65 mm2 (22 – 16 AWG) Red
ZB9124 900 1.04 - 2.63 mm2 (16 – 14 AWG) Blue

600 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation

4.2 POWER SUPPLY CONNECTIONS


These should be wired with 1.5 mm PVC insulated multi-stranded copper wire terminated with M4 ring terminals.
The wire should have a minimum voltage rating of 300 V RMS.

Caution:
Protect the auxiliary power supply wiring with a maximum 16 A high rupture capacity
(HRC) type NIT or TIA fuse.

4.3 EARTH CONNNECTION


Every device must be connected to the cubicle earthing bar using the M4 earth terminal.

Use a wire size of at least 2.5 mm2 terminated with a ring terminal.

Due to the physical limitations of the ring terminal, the maximum wire size you can use is 6.0 mm2 using ring
terminals that are not pre-insulated. If using pre insulated ring terminals, the maximum wire size is reduced to 2.63
mm2 per ring terminal. If you need a greater cross-sectional area, use two wires in parallel, each terminated in a
separate ring terminal.
The wire should have a minimum voltage rating of 300 V RMS.

Note:
To prevent any possibility of electrolytic action between brass or copper ground conductors and the rear panel of the product,
precautions should be taken to isolate them from one another. This could be achieved in several ways, including placing a
nickel-plated or insulating washer between the conductor and the product case, or using tinned ring terminals.

4.4 WATCHDOG CONNECTIONS


These should be wired with 1 mm PVC insulated multi-stranded copper wire terminated with M4 ring terminals.
The wire should have a minimum voltage rating of 300 V RMS.

4.5 EIA(RS)485 AND K-BUS CONNECTIONS


For connecting the EIA(RS485) / K-Bus ports, use 2-core screened cable with a maximum total length of 1000 m or
200 nF total cable capacitance.
To guarantee the performance specifications, you must ensure continuity of the screen, when daisy chaining the
connections.
Two-core screened twisted pair cable should be used. It is important to avoid circulating currents, which can cause
noise and interference, especially when the cable runs between buildings. For this reason, the screen should be
continuous and connected to ground at one end only, normally at the master connection point.
The K-Bus signal is a differential signal and there is no signal ground connection. If a signal ground connection is
present in the bus cable then it must be ignored. At no stage should this be connected to the cable's screen or to
the product’s chassis. This is for both safety and noise reasons.
A typical cable specification would be:
● Each core: 16/0.2 mm2 copper conductors, PVC insulated
● Nominal conductor area: 0.5 mm2 per core
● Screen: Overall braid, PVC sheathed

P446SV-TM-EN-1 601
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

4.6 IRIG-B CONNECTION


The IRIG-B input and BNC connector have a characteristic impedance of 50 ohms. We recommend that
connections between the IRIG-B equipment and the product are made using coaxial cable of type RG59LSF with a
halogen free, fire retardant sheath.

4.7 OPTO-INPUT CONNECTIONS


These should be wired with 1 mm2 PVC insulated multi-stranded copper wire terminated with M4 ring terminals.
Each opto-input has a selectable preset ½ cycle filter. This makes the input immune to noise induced on the wiring.
This can, however slow down the response. If you need to switch off the ½ cycle filter, either use double pole
switching on the input, or screened twisted cable on the input circuit.

Caution:
Protect the opto-inputs and their wiring with a maximum 16 A high rupture capacity
(HRC) type NIT or TIA fuse.

4.8 OUTPUT RELAY CONNECTIONS


These should be wired with 1 mm PVC insulated multi-stranded copper wire terminated with M4 ring terminals.

4.9 ETHERNET METALLIC CONNECTIONS


If the device has a metallic Ethernet connection, it can be connected to either a 10Base-T or a 100Base-TX
Ethernet hub. Due to noise sensitivity, we recommend this type of connection only for short distance connections,
ideally where the products and hubs are in the same cubicle. For increased noise immunity, CAT 6 (category 6) STP
(shielded twisted pair) cable and connectors can be used.
The connector for the Ethernet port is a shielded RJ-45. The pin-out is as follows:
Pin Signal name Signal definition
1 TXP Transmit (positive)
2 TXN Transmit (negative)
3 RXP Receive (positive)
4 - Not used
5 - Not used
6 RXN Receive (negative)
7 - Not used
8 - Not used

4.10 ETHERNET FIBRE CONNECTIONS


We recommend the use of fibre-optic connections for permanent connections in a substation environment. The
100 Mbps fibre optic port uses type ST connectors (one for Tx and one for Rx), compatible with 50/125 µm or
62.5/125 µm multimode fibres at 1300 nm wavelength.

Note:
For models equipped with redundant Ethernet connections the product must be partially dismantled to set the fourth octet of
the second IP address. This ideally, should be done before installation.

602 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation

4.11 RS232 CONNECTION


Short term connections to the EIA(RS)232 port, located behind the bottom access cover, can be made using a
screened multi-core communication cable up to 15 m long, or a total capacitance of 2500 pF. The cable should be
terminated at the product end with a standard 9-pin D-type male connector.

4.12 DOWNLOAD/MONITOR PORT


Short term connections to the download/monitor port, located behind the bottom access cover, can be made
using a screened 25-core communication cable up to 4 m long. The cable should be terminated at the product end
with a 25-pin D-type male connector.

4.13 GPS FIBRE CONNECTION


Some products use a GPS 1 PPS timing signal. If applicable, this is connected to a fibre-optic port on the
coprocessor board in slot B. The fibre-optic port uses an ST type connector, compatible with fibre multimode
50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm – 850 nm.

4.14 FIBRE COMMUNICATION CONNECTIONS


The fibre optic port consists of one or two channels using ST type connectors (one for Tx and one for Rx). The type
of fibre used depends on the option selected.
850 nm and 1300 nm multimode systems use 50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm multimode fibres. 1300 nm and 1550 nm
single mode systems use 9/125 µm single mode fibres.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 603
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV

5 CASE DIMENSIONS
Not all products are available in all case sizes.

5.1 CASE DIMENSIONS 40TE


Sealing
155.40 8 off holes Dia. 3.4 strip
23.30

AB BA

168.00 177.0
159.00 (4U)

AB BA

10.35 181.30 483 (19” rack)


202.00

A = Clearance holes Flush mouting panel


Panel cut-out details
B = Mouting holes

200.00
Note: If mouting plate is required
use flush mounting cut out
dimentions

All dimensons in mm

Secondary cover (when fitted)


240.00
Front view Incl. wiring
177.00

157.5
max.

Side view
206.00 30.00

E01411

Figure 293: 40TE case dimensions

604 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 24

COMMISSIONING INSTRUCTIONS
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

606 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 607
General Guidelines 608
Commissioning Test Menu 609
Commissioning Equipment 613
Product Checks 615
Electrical Intermicom Communication Loopback 624
Intermicom 64 Communication 626
Setting Checks 628
IEC 61850 Edition 2 Testing 630
Distance Protection 635
Delta Directional Comparison 641
DEF Aided Schemes 644
Out of Step Protection 646
Protection Timing Checks 648
System Check and Check Synchronism 650
Check Trip and Autoreclose Cycle 651
End-to-End Communication Tests 652
End-to-End Scheme Tests 655
Onload Checks 657
Final Checks 659
Commmissioning the P59x 660

P446SV-TM-EN-1 607
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

2 GENERAL GUIDELINES
General Electric IEDs are self-checking devices and will raise an alarm in the unlikely event of a failure. This is why
the commissioning tests are less extensive than those for non-numeric electronic devices or electro-mechanical
relays.
To commission the devices, you (the commissioning engineer) do not need to test every function. You need only
verify that the hardware is functioning correctly and that the application-specific software settings have been
applied. You can check the settings by extracting them using the settings application software, or by means of the
front panel interface (HMI panel).
The menu language is user-selectable, so you can change it for commissioning purposes if required.

Note:
Remember to restore the language setting to the customer’s preferred language on completion.

Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or Safety Guide SFTY/4LM as well as the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.

Warning:
With the exception of the CT shorting contacts check, do not disassemble the device
during commissioning.

608 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

3 COMMISSIONING TEST MENU


The IED provides several test facilities under the COMMISSION TESTS menu heading. There are menu cells that
allow you to monitor the status of the opto-inputs, output relay contacts, internal Digital Data Bus (DDB) signals
and user-programmable LEDs. This section describes these commissioning test facilities.

3.1 OPTO I/P STATUS CELL (OPTO-INPUT STATUS)


This cell can be used to monitor the status of the opto-inputs while they are sequentially energised with a suitable
DC voltage. The cell is a binary string that displays the status of the opto-inputs where '1' means energised and '0'
means de-energised. If you move the cursor along the binary numbers, the corresponding label text is displayed
for each logic input.

3.2 RELAY O/P STATUS CELL (RELAY OUTPUT STATUS)


This cell can be used to monitor the status of the relay outputs. The cell is a binary string that displays the status of
the relay outputs where '1' means energised and '0' means de-energised. If you move the cursor along the binary
numbers, the corresponding label text is displayed for each relay output.
The cell indicates the status of the output relays when the IED is in service. You can check for relay damage by
comparing the status of the output contacts with their associated bits.

Note:
When the Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked, the relay output status indicates which contacts would operate if
the IED was in-service. It does not show the actual status of the output relays, as they are blocked.

3.3 TEST PORT STATUS CELL


This cell displays the status of the DDB signals that have been allocated in the Monitor Bit cells. If you move the
cursor along the binary numbers, the corresponding DDB signal text string is displayed for each monitor bit.
By using this cell with suitable monitor bit settings, the state of the DDB signals can be displayed as various
operating conditions or sequences are applied to the IED. This allows you to test the Programmable Scheme Logic
(PSL).

3.4 MONITOR BIT 1 TO 8 CELLS


The eight Monitor Bit cells allows you to select eight DDB signals that can be observed in the Test Port Status cell or
downloaded via the front port.
Each Monitor Bit cell can be assigned to a particular DDB signal. You set it by entering the required DDB signal
number from the list of available DDB signals.
The pins of the monitor/download port used for monitor bits are as follows:
Monitor Bit 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Monitor/Download Port Pin 11 12 15 13 20 21 23 24

The signal ground is available on pins 18, 19, 22 and 25.

Caution:
The monitor/download port is not electrically isolated against induced voltages on
the communications channel. It should therefore only be used for local
communications.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 609
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

3.5 TEST MODE CELL


This cell allows you to perform secondary injection testing. It also lets you test the output contacts directly by
applying menu-controlled test signals.
To go into test mode, select the Test Mode option in the Test Mode cell. This takes the IED out of service causing
an alarm condition to be recorded and the Out of Service LED to illuminate. This also freezes any information
stored in the CB CONDITION column. In IEC 60870-5-103 versions, it changes the Cause of Transmission (COT) to
Test Mode.
In Test Mode, the output contacts are still active. To disable the output contacts you must select the Contacts
Blocked option.
Once testing is complete, return the device back into service by setting the Test Mode Cell back to Disabled.

Caution:
When the cell is in Test Mode, the Scheme Logic still drives the output relays, which
could result in tripping of circuit breakers. To avoid this, set the Test Mode cell to
Contacts Blocked.

Note:
Test mode and Contacts Blocked mode can also be selected by energising an opto-input mapped to the Test Mode
signal, and the Contact Block signal respectively.

3.6 TEST PATTERN CELL


The Test Pattern cell is used to select the output relay contacts to be tested when the Contact Test cell is set to
Apply Test. The cell has a binary string with one bit for each user-configurable output contact, which can be
set to '1' to operate the output and '0' to not operate it.

3.7 CONTACT TEST CELL


When the Apply Test command in this cell is issued, the contacts set for operation change state. Once the test
has been applied, the command text on the LCD will change to No Operation and the contacts will remain in the
Test state until reset by issuing the Remove Test command. The command text on the LCD will show No
Operation after the Remove Test command has been issued.

Note:
When the Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked the Relay O/P Status cell does not show the current status of the
output relays and therefore cannot be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it will be necessary to monitor
the state of each contact in turn.

3.8 TEST LEDS CELL


When the Apply Test command in this cell is issued, the user-programmable LEDs illuminate for approximately
2 seconds before switching off, and the command text on the LCD reverts to No Operation.

3.9 TEST AUTORECLOSE CELL


Where the IED provides an auto-reclose function, this cell will be available for testing the sequence of circuit
breaker trip and auto-reclose cycles.
The Trip 3 Pole option in the Test Autoreclose cell causes the device to perform the first three phase trip/
reclose cycle so that associated output contacts can be checked for operation at the correct times during the

610 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

cycle. Once the trip output has operated the command text will revert to No Operation whilst the rest of the
auto-reclose cycle is performed. To test subsequent three-phase autoreclose cycles, you repeat the Trip 3
Pole command. You can also test the single phases with Trip Pole A , Trip Pole B and Trip Pole B.

Note:
The default settings for the programmable scheme logic has the AR Trip Test signals mapped to the Trip Input
signals. If the programmable scheme logic has been changed, it is essential that these signals retain this mapping for the
Test Autoreclose facility to work.

3.10 STATIC TEST MODE


Static Test Mode can be set to Enabled or Disabled. When the Static Test mode is enabled it allows injection
test that don't support dynamic switching to be used to commission and test the device.
Dynamic secondary injection test sets are able to accurately mimic real power system faults. The test sets mimic
an instantaneous fault “shot”, with the real rate of rise of current, and the decaying DC exponential component.
Dynamic injection test sets are available, which cater for all three phases, providing a six signal set of analogue
inputs: Va, Vb, Vc, Ia, Ib, Ic. Such injection test sets can be used with the device, with no special testing limitations.
Static test sets, also known as Static Simulators, may not properly provide or simulate:
● A healthy pre-fault voltage
● A real fault shot (instead a gradually varying current or voltage would be used)
● The rate of rise of current and DC components
● A complete set of three-phase analogue inputs
● Real dynamic step changes in current and voltage.
Some of the protection in this product is based on delta techniques which recognise step changes in actual power
system quantities. Because these may not be produced by static test sets,, certain functions are can be disabled or
bypassed to allow injection testing with static test sets. Enabling the Static Test Mode option does this..
For the tests, the delta directional line is replaced by a conventional distance directional line. Extra filtering of
distance comparators is used so the filtering slows to use a fixed one cycle window. Memory polarising is replaced
by cross-polarising from unfaulted phases.

Note:
Trip times may be up to ½ cycle longer when tested in the static mode, due to the nature of the test voltage and current, and
the slower filtering. This is normal, and perfectly acceptable.

3.11 LOOPBACK MODE


Loopback Mode can be used to test InterMiCOM64 signalling.

Note:
If the cell is set to Internal, only the IED software is checked. If the cell is set to External, both the software and hardware
are checked.

When the device is switched into Loopback Mode, it automatically uses generic addresses 0-0. It responds as if it is
connected to a remote device. The sent and received IM64 signals continue to be routed to and from the signals
defined in the programmable logic.

Note:
Loopback mode can also be selected by energising an opto-input mapped to the Loopback signal.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 611
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

3.12 IM64 TEST PATTERN


This cell is used with the IM64 Test Mode cell to set a 16-bit pattern (8 bits per channel), which is transmitted
whenever the IM64 Test Mode cell is set to Enabled. The IM64 TestPattern cell has a binary string with one bit for
each user-defined Inter-MiCOM command. These can be set to '1' to operate the IM64 output under test conditions
and '0' for no operation.

3.13 IM64 TEST MODE


When the Enable command in this cell is issued, the InterMiCOM64 commands change to reflect the state of the
values set in the IM64 TestPattern cell. If the cell is set to Disabled, the InterMiCOM64 commands reflect the state
of the signals generated by the protection and control functions.

3.14 RED AND GREEN LED STATUS CELLS


These cells contain binary strings that indicate which of the user-programmable red and green LEDs are
illuminated when accessing from a remote location. A '1' indicates that a particular LED is illuminated.

Note:
When the status in both Red LED Status and Green LED Status cells is ‘1’, this indicates the LEDs illumination is yellow.

3.15 USING A MONITOR PORT TEST BOX


A test box containing eight LEDs and a switchable audible indicator is available. It is housed in a small plastic box
with a 25-pin male D-connector that plugs directly into the monitor/download port. There is also a 25-pin female
D-connector which allows other connections to be made to the monitor/download port while the monitor/
download port test box is in place.
Each LED corresponds to one of the monitor bit pins on the monitor/download port. Monitor Bit 1 is on the left-
hand side when viewed from the front of the IED. The audible indicator can be selected to sound if a voltage
appears on any of the eight monitor pins. Alternatively it can be set to remain silent, using only the LEDs.

612 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

4 COMMISSIONING EQUIPMENT
Specialist test equipment is required to commission this product. We recognise three classes of equipment for
commissioning :
● Recommended
● Essential
● Advisory

Recommended equipment constitutes equipment that is both necessary, and sufficient, to verify correct
performance of the principal protection functions.
Essential equipment represents the minimum necessary to check that the product includes the basic expected
protection functions and that they operate within limits.
Advisory equipment represents equipment that is needed to verify satisfactory operation of features that may be
unused, or supplementary, or which may, for example, be integral to a distributed control/automation scheme.
Operation of such features may, perhaps, be more appropriately verified as part of a customer defined
commissioning requirement, or as part of a system-level commissioning regime.

4.1 RECOMMENDED COMMISSIONING EQUIPMENT


The minimum recommended equipment is a multifunctional three-phase AC current and voltage injection test set
featuring :
● Controlled three-phase AC current and voltage sources,
● Transient (dynamic) switching between pre-fault and post-fault conditions (to generate delta conditions),
● Dynamic impedance state sequencer (capable of sequencing through 4 impedance states),
● Integrated or separate variable DC supply (0 - 250 V)
● Integrated or separate AC and DC measurement capabilities (0-440V AC, 0-250V DC)
● Integrated and/or separate timer,
● Integrated and/or separate test switches.

In addition, you will need :


● A portable computer, installed with appropriate software to liaise with the equipment under test (EUT).
Typically this software will be proprietary to the product’s manufacturer (for example MiCOM S1 Agile).
● Suitable electrical test leads.
● Electronic or brushless insulation tester with a DC output not exceeding 500 V
● Continuity tester
● Verified application-specific settings files
For products that use fibre-optic communications to implement unit protection schemes :
● Fibre optic test leads (minimum 2). 10m minimum length, multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5µm, OR single mode
(according to the model variant) terminated with connectors as required by the product.
● Fibre-optic power meter
● P59x commissioning instructions

4.2 ESSENTIAL COMMISSIONING EQUIPMENT


As an absolute minimum, the following equipment is required:
● AC current source coupled with AC voltage source
● Variable DC supply (0 - 250V)
● Multimeter capable of measuring AC and DC current and voltage (0-440V AC, 0-250V DC)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 613
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

● Timer
● Test switches
● Suitable electrical test leads
● Continuity tester
For products that use fibre-optic communications to implement unit protection schemes :
● Fibre optic test leads (minimum 2). 10m minimum length, multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5µm, OR single mode
(according to the model variant) terminated with connectors as required by the product.
● Fibre-optic power meter
Note that if the AC test source that you are using is not capable of dynamic fault simulation (cannot dynamically
switch from load to fault conditions) you must use the product’s static test mode feature
To do this, in COMMISSIONING TESTS, set Static Test Mode to Enabled.

4.3 ADVISORY TEST EQUIPMENT


Advisory test equipment may be required for extended commissioning procedures:
● Current clamp meter
● Multi-finger test plug:
○ P992 for test block type P991
○ MMLB for test block type MMLG blocks
● Electronic or brushless insulation tester with a DC output not exceeding 500 V
● KITZ K-Bus - EIA(RS)232 protocol converter for testing EIA(RS)485 K-Bus port
● EIA(RS)485 to EIA(RS)232 converter for testing EIA(RS)485 Courier/MODBUS/IEC60870-5-103/DNP3 port
● A portable printer (for printing a setting record from the portable PC) and or writeable, detachable memory
device.
● Phase angle meter
● Phase rotation meter
● Fibre-optic power meter.
● Fibre optic test leads (minimum 2). 10m minimum length, multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5µm terminated with
BFOC (ST) 2.5 connectors for testing the fibre-optic RP1 port.

614 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

5 PRODUCT CHECKS
These product checks are designed to ensure that the device has not been physically damaged prior to
commissioning, is functioning correctly and that all input quantity measurements are within the stated tolerances.
If the application-specific settings have been applied to the IED prior to commissioning, you should make a copy of
the settings. This will allow you to restore them at a later date if necessary. This can be done by:
● Obtaining a setting file from the customer.
● Extracting the settings from the IED itself, using a portable PC with appropriate setting software.

If the customer has changed the password that prevents unauthorised changes to some of the settings, either the
revised password should be provided, or the original password restored before testing.

Note:
If the password has been lost, a recovery password can be obtained from General Electric.

5.1 PRODUCT CHECKS WITH THE IED DE-ENERGISED

Warning:
The following group of tests should be carried out without the auxiliary supply being
applied to the IED and, if applicable, with the trip circuit isolated.

The current and voltage transformer connections must be isolated from the IED for these checks. If a P991 test
block is provided, the required isolation can be achieved by inserting test plug type P992. This open circuits all
wiring routed through the test block.
Before inserting the test plug, you should check the scheme diagram to ensure that this will not cause damage or
a safety hazard (the test block may, for example, be associated with protection current transformer circuits). The
sockets in the test plug, which correspond to the current transformer secondary windings, must be linked before
the test plug is inserted into the test block.

Warning:
Never open-circuit the secondary circuit of a current transformer since the high
voltage produced may be lethal and could damage insulation.

If a test block is not provided, the voltage transformer supply to the IED should be isolated by means of the panel
links or connecting blocks. The line current transformers should be short-circuited and disconnected from the IED
terminals. Where means of isolating the auxiliary supply and trip circuit (for example isolation links, fuses and MCB)
are provided, these should be used. If this is not possible, the wiring to these circuits must be disconnected and the
exposed ends suitably terminated to prevent them from being a safety hazard.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 615
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

5.1.1 VISUAL INSPECTION

Warning:
Check the rating information under the top access cover on the front of the IED.

Warning:
Check that the IED being tested is correct for the line or circuit.

Warning:
Record the circuit reference and system details.

Warning:
Check the CT secondary current rating and record the CT tap which is in use.

Carefully examine the IED to see that no physical damage has occurred since installation.
Ensure that the case earthing connections (bottom left-hand corner at the rear of the IED case) are used to
connect the IED to a local earth bar using an adequate conductor.

5.1.2 CURRENT TRANSFORMER SHORTING CONTACTS


Check the current transformer shorting contacts to ensure that they close when the heavy-duty terminal block is
disconnected from the current input board.
The heavy-duty terminal blocks are fastened to the rear panel using four crosshead screws. These are located two
at the top and two at the bottom.

Note:
Use a magnetic bladed screwdriver to minimise the risk of the screws being left in the terminal block or lost.

Pull the terminal block away from the rear of the case and check with a continuity tester that all the shorting
switches being used are closed.

5.1.3 INSULATION
Insulation resistance tests are only necessary during commissioning if explicitly requested.
Isolate all wiring from the earth and test the insulation with an electronic or brushless insulation tester at a DC
voltage not exceeding 500 V. Terminals of the same circuits should be temporarily connected together.
The insulation resistance should be greater than 100 MW at 500 V.
On completion of the insulation resistance tests, ensure all external wiring is correctly reconnected to the IED.

5.1.4 EXTERNAL WIRING

Caution:
Check that the external wiring is correct according to the relevant IED and scheme
diagrams. Ensure that phasing/phase rotation appears to be as expected.

616 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

5.1.5 WATCHDOG CONTACTS


Using a continuity tester, check that the Watchdog contacts are in the following states:
Terminals Contact state with product de-energised
11 - 12 on power supply board Closed
13 - 14 on power supply board Open

5.1.6 POWER SUPPLY


Depending on its nominal supply rating, the IED can be operated from either a DC only or an AC/DC auxiliary
supply. The incoming voltage must be within the operating range specified below.
Without energising the IED measure the auxiliary supply to ensure it is within the operating range.
Nominal supply rating Nominal supply rating
DC operating range AC operating range
DC AC RMS
24 - 54 V N/A 19 to 65 V N/A
48 - 125 V 30 - 100 V 37 to 150 V 24 - 110 V
110 - 250 V 100 - 240 V 87 to 300 V 80 to 265 V

Note:
The IED can withstand an AC ripple of up to 12% of the upper rated voltage on the DC auxiliary supply.

Warning:
Do not energise the IED or interface unit using the battery charger with the battery
disconnected as this can irreparably damage the power supply circuitry.

Caution:
Energise the IED only if the auxiliary supply is within the specified operating ranges.
If a test block is provided, it may be necessary to link across the front of the test plug
to connect the auxiliary supply to the IED.

5.2 PRODUCT CHECKS WITH THE IED ENERGISED

Warning:
The current and voltage transformer connections must remain isolated from the IED
for these checks. The trip circuit should also remain isolated to prevent accidental
operation of the associated circuit breaker.

The following group of tests verifies that the IED hardware and software is functioning correctly and should be
carried out with the supply applied to the IED.

5.2.1 WATCHDOG CONTACTS


Using a continuity tester, check that the Watchdog contacts are in the following states when energised and
healthy.
Terminals Contact state with product energised
11 - 12 on power supply board Open

P446SV-TM-EN-1 617
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

Terminals Contact state with product energised


13 - 14 on power supply board Closed

5.2.2 TEST LCD


The Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) is designed to operate in a wide range of substation ambient temperatures. For
this purpose, the IEDs have an LCD Contrast setting. The contrast is factory pre-set, but it may be necessary to
adjust the contrast to give the best in-service display.
To change the contrast, you can increment or decrement the LCD Contrast cell in the CONFIGURATION column.

Caution:
Before applying a contrast setting, make sure that it will not make the display so
light or dark such that menu text becomes unreadable. It is possible to restore the
visibility of a display by downloading a setting file, with the LCD Contrast set within
the typical range of 7 - 11.

5.2.3 DATE AND TIME


The date and time is stored in memory, which is backed up by an auxiliary battery situated at the front of the
device behind the lower access cover. When delivered, this battery is isolated to prevent battery drain during
transportation and storage.
Before setting the date and time, ensure that the isolation strip has been removed. With the lower access cover
open, the battery isolation strip can be identified by a red tab protruding from the positive side of the battery
compartment. Pull the red tab to remove the isolation strip.
The method for setting the date and time depends on whether an IRIG-B signal is being used or not. The IRIG-B
signal will override the time, day and month settings, but not the initial year setting. For this reason, you must
ensure you set the correct year, even if the device is using IRIG-B to maintain the internal clock.
You set the Date and Time by one of the following methods:
● Using the front panel to set the Date and Time cells respectively
● By sending a courier command to the Date/Time cell (Courier reference 0801)

Note:
If the auxiliary supply fails, the time and date will be maintained by the auxiliary battery. Therefore, when the auxiliary supply
is restored, you should not have to set the time and date again. To test this, remove the IRIG-B signal, and then remove the
auxiliary supply. Leave the device de-energised for approximately 30 seconds. On re energisation, the time should be correct.

When using IRIG-B to maintain the clock, the IED must first be connected to the satellite clock equipment (usually a
P594), which should be energised and functioning.
1. Set the IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND TIME column to Enabled.
2. Ensure the IED is receiving the IRIG-B signal by checking that cell IRIG-B Status reads Active.
3. Once the IRIG-B signal is active, adjust the time offset of the universal co coordinated time (satellite clock
time) on the satellite clock equipment so that local time is displayed.
4. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell. The IRIG-B signal does not contain
the current year so it will need to be set manually in this cell.
5. Reconnect the IRIG-B signal.

If the time and date is not being maintained by an IRIG-B signal, ensure that the IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND
TIME column is set to Disabled.
1. Set the date and time to the correct local time and date using Date/Time cell or using the serial protocol.

618 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

5.2.4 TEST LEDS


On power-up, all LEDs should first flash yellow. Following this, the green "Healthy" LED should illuminate indicating
that the device is healthy.
The IED's non-volatile memory stores the states of the alarm, the trip, and the user-programmable LED indicators
(if configured to latch). These indicators may also illuminate when the auxiliary supply is applied.
If any of these LEDs are ON then they should be reset before proceeding with further testing. If the LEDs
successfully reset (the LED goes off), no testing is needed for that LED because it is obviously operational.

Note:
In most cases, alarms related to the communications channels will not reset at this stage.

5.2.5 TEST ALARM AND OUT-OF-SERVICE LEDS


The alarm and out of service LEDs can be tested using the COMMISSION TESTS menu column.
1. Set the Test Mode cell to Contacts Blocked.
2. Check that the out of service LED illuminates continuously and the alarm LED flashes.
It is not necessary to return the Test Mode cell to Disabled at this stage because the test mode will be required
for later tests.

5.2.6 TEST TRIP LED


The trip LED can be tested by initiating a manual circuit breaker trip. However, the trip LED will operate during the
setting checks performed later. Therefore no further testing of the trip LED is required at this stage.

5.2.7 TEST USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS


To test these LEDs, set the Test LEDs cell to Apply Test. Check that all user-programmable LEDs illuminate.

5.2.8 TEST OPTO-INPUTS


This test checks that all the opto-inputs on the IED are functioning correctly.
The opto-inputs should be energised one at a time. For terminal numbers, please see the external connection
diagrams in the "Wiring Diagrams" chapter. Ensuring correct polarity, connect the supply voltage to the
appropriate terminals for the input being tested.
The status of each opto-input can be viewed using either the Opto I/P Status cell in the SYSTEM DATA column, or
the Opto I/P Status cell in the COMMISSION TESTS column.
A '1' indicates an energised input and a '0' indicates a de-energised input. When each opto-input is energised, one
of the characters on the bottom line of the display changes to indicate the new state of the input.

5.2.9 TEST OUTPUT RELAYS


This test checks that all the output relays are functioning correctly.
1. Ensure that the IED is still in test mode by viewing the Test Mode cell in the COMMISSION TESTS column.
Ensure that it is set to Contacts Blocked.
2. The output relays should be energised one at a time. To select output relay 1 for testing, set the Test Pattern
cell as appropriate.
3. Connect a continuity tester across the terminals corresponding to output relay 1 as shown in the external
connection diagram.
4. To operate the output relay set the Contact Test cell to Apply Test.
5. Check the operation with the continuity tester.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 619
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

6. Measure the resistance of the contacts in the closed state.


7. Reset the output relay by setting the Contact Test cell to Remove Test.
8. Repeat the test for the remaining output relays.
9. Return the IED to service by setting the Test Mode cell in the COMMISSION TESTS menu to Disabled.

5.2.10 TEST SERIAL COMMUNICATION PORT RP1


You need only perform this test if the IED is to be accessed from a remote location with a permanent serial
connection to the communications port. The scope of this test does not extend to verifying operation with
connected equipment beyond any suppied protocol converter. It verifies operation of the rear communication port
(and if applicable the protocol converter) and varies according to the protocol fitted.

5.2.10.1 CHECK PHYSICAL CONNECTIVITY


The rear communication port RP1 is presented on terminals 16, 17 and 18 of the power supply terminal block.
Screened twisted pair cable is used to make a connection to the port. The cable screen should be connected to pin
16 and pins 17 and 18 are for the communication signal:

Figure 294: RP1 physical connection

For K-Bus applications, pins 17 and 18 are not polarity sensitive and it does not matter which way round the wires
are connected. EIA(RS)485 is polarity sensitive, so you must ensure the wires are connected the correct way round
(pin 18 is positive, pin 17 is negative).
If K-Bus is being used, a Kitz protocol converter (KITZ101, KITZ102 OR KITZ201) will have been installed to convert
the K-Bus signals into RS232. Likewise, if RS485 is being used, an RS485-RS232 converter will have been installed.
In the case where a protocol converter is being used, a laptop PC running appropriate software (such as MiCOM S1
Agile) can be connected to the incoming side of the protocol converter. An example for K-bus to RS232 conversion
is shown below. RS485 to RS232 would follow the same principle, only using a RS485-RS232 converter. Most
modern laptops have USB ports, so it is likely you will also require a RS232 to USB converter too.

620 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

IED IED IED

RS232 K-Bus

Computer RS232-USB converter KITZ protocol converter

V01001

Figure 295: Remote communication using K-bus

Fibre Connection
Some models have an optional fibre optic communications port fitted (on a separate communications board). The
communications port to be used is selected by setting the Physical Link cell in the COMMUNICATIONS column, the
values being Copper or K-Bus for the RS485/K-bus port and Fibre Optic for the fibre optic port.

5.2.10.2 CHECK LOGICAL CONNECTIVITY


The logical connectivity depends on the chosen data protocol, but the principles of testing remain the same for all
protocol variants:
1. Ensure that the communications baud rate and parity settings in the application software are set the same
as those on the protocol converter.
2. For Courier models, ensure that you have set the correct RP1 address
3. Check that communications can be established with this IED using the portable PC/Master Station.

5.2.11 TEST SERIAL COMMUNICATION PORT RP2


RP2 is an optional second serial port board providing additional serial connectivity. It provides two 9-pin D-type
serial port connectors SK4 and SK5. Both ports are configured as DTE (Date Terminal Equipment) ports. That means
they can be connected to communications equipment such as a modem with a straight-through cable.
SK4 can be configured as an EIA(RS232), EIA(RS485), or K-Bus connection for Courier protocol only, whilst SK5 is
fixed to EIA(RS)232 for InterMiCOM signalling only.
It is not the intention of this test to verify the operation of the complete communication link between the IED and
the remote location, just the IED's rear communication port and, if applicable, the protocol converter.
The only checks that need to be made are as follows:
1. Set the RP2 Port Config cell in the COMMUNICATIONS column to the required physical protocol; (K-Bus,
EIA(RS)485, or EIA(RS)232.
2. Set the IED's Courier address to the correct value (it must be between 1 and 254).

5.2.12 TEST ETHERNET COMMUNICATION


For products that employ Ethernet communications, we recommend that testing be limited to a visual check that
the correct ports are fitted and that there is no sign of physical damage.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 621
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

If there is no board fitted or the board is faulty, a NIC link alarm will be raised (providing this option has been set in
the NIC Link Report cell in the COMMUNICATIONS column).

5.3 SECONDARY INJECTION TESTS


Secondary injection testing is carried out to verify the integrity of the VT and CT readings. All devices leave the
factory set for operation at a system frequency of 50 Hz. If operation at 60 Hz is required, you must set this in the
Frequency cell in the SYSTEM DATA column.
The PMU must be installed and connected to a 1pps fibre optic synchronising signal and a demodulated IRIG-B
signal, provided by a device such as a P594 or a REASON RT430.
Connect the current and voltage outputs of the test set to the appropriate terminals of the first voltage and current
channel and apply nominal voltage and current with the current lagging the voltage by 90 degrees.

5.3.1 TEST CURRENT INPUTS


This test verifies that the current measurement inputs are configured correctly.
1. Using secondary injection test equipment such as an Omicron, apply and measure nominal rated current to
each CT in turn.
2. Check its magnitude using a multi-meter or test set readout. Check this value against the value displayed
on the HMI panel (usually in MEASUREMENTS 1 column).
3. Record the displayed value. The measured current values will either be in primary or secondary Amperes. If
the Local Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column is set to Primary, the values displayed should be
equal to the applied current multiplied by the corresponding current transformer ratio (set in the CT AND VT
RATIOS column). If the Local Values cell is set to Secondary, the value displayed should be equal to the
applied current.

Note:
If a PC connected to the IED using the rear communications port is being used to display the measured current, the process
will be similar. However, the setting of the Remote Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column will determine whether the
displayed values are in primary or secondary Amperes.

The measurement accuracy of the IED is +/- 1%. However, an additional allowance must be made for the accuracy
of the test equipment being used.

5.3.2 TEST VOLTAGE INPUTS


This test verifies that the voltage measurement inputs are configured correctly.
1. Using secondary injection test equipment, apply and measure the rated voltage to each voltage
transformer input in turn.
2. Check its magnitude using a multimeter or test set readout. Check this value against the value displayed on
the HMI panel (usually in MEASUREMENTS 1 column).
3. Record the value displayed. The measured voltage values will either be in primary or secondary Volts. If the
Local Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column is set to Primary, the values displayed should be equal
to the applied voltage multiplied by the corresponding voltage transformer ratio (set in the CT AND VT
RATIOS column). If the Local Values cell is set to Secondary, the value displayed should be equal to the
applied voltage.

Note:
If a PC connected to the IED using the rear communications port is being used to display the measured current, the process
will be similar. However, the setting of the Remote Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column will determine whether the
displayed values are in primary or secondary Amperes.

622 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

The measurement accuracy of the IED is +/- 1%. However, an additional allowance must be made for the accuracy
of the test equipment being used.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 623
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

6 ELECTRICAL INTERMICOM COMMUNICATION LOOPBACK


If the IED is used in a scheme with standard InterMiCOM communication (Electrical Teleprotection), you need to
configure a loopback for testing purposes.

6.1 SETTING UP THE LOOPBACK


The communication path may include various connectors and signal converters before leaving the substation. We
therefore advise making the loopback as close as possible to where the communication link leaves the substation.
This way, as much of the wiring as possible and all associated communication signal converters are included in
the test.
1. Set CONFIGURATION > InterMiCOM to Enabled.
2. Set INTERMICOM COMMS > Ch Statistics and Ch Diagnostics to Visible.
3. Check that INTERMICOM COMMS > IM H/W Status displays OK. This means the InterMiCOM hardware is
fitted and initialised.

6.2 LOOPBACK TEST


INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Mode allows you to test the InterMiCOM channel. In normal service it must be
disabled. INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Status shows the status of the InterMiCOM loopback mode.

Note:
If INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Mode is set to Internal, only the internal software of the device is checked. This is
useful for testing functionality if no communications connections are made. Use the 'External' setting during commissioning
because it checks both the software and hardware. When the IED is switched into either Internal or External Loopback Mode it
automatically inhibits InterMiCOM messages to the PSL by setting all eight InterMiCOM message command states to zero.

Set INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Mode to External and form a communications loopback by connecting
the transmit signal (pin 2) to the receive signal (pin 3).

Note:
The DCD signal must be held high (by connecting pin 1 to pin 4) if the connected equipment does not support DCD.

DCD 1
RxD 2
TxD 3
DTR 4
GND 5
6
RTS 7
8
9
E01450

Figure 296: InterMicom loopback testing

The loopback mode is shown on the front panel by an Alarm LED and the message IM Loopback on the LCD.
Check that all connections are correct and the software is working correctly.
Check that INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Status shows OK.

624 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

6.2.1 INTERMICOM COMMAND BITS


To test the InterMiCOM command bits, go to the INTERMICOM COMMS column and do the following:
1. Enter any test pattern in the Test Pattern cell in the by scrolling through and changing selected bits
between 1 and 0. The entered pattern is transmitted through the loopback.
2. Check that the IM Output Status cell matches the applied Test Pattern.
3. Check that all 8 bits in the IM Input Status cell are zero.

6.2.2 INTERMICOM CHANNEL DIAGNOSTICS


Check that the following cells in the INTERMICOM COMMS column all read OK.
● Data CD Status
● FrameSync Status
● Message Status
● Channel Status

6.2.3 SIMULATING A CHANNEL FAILURE


1. Simulate a failure of the communications link by breaking a connection and checking that some of these
cells show Fail.
2. Restore the communications loopback and ensure that the four diagnostic cells display OK.

Note:
Some or all of these cells show Fail depending on the communications configuration and the way the link has failed.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 625
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

7 INTERMICOM 64 COMMUNICATION

If the IED is used in a scheme with InterMiCOM64 communication, you need to configure a loopback for testing
purposes.
IM64 is fibre-based. Several different fibre-optic interfaces are available. In general, 1300 nm fibres are used for
direct connection (these may be single mode or multimode). 850 nm multimode fibres are generally used with
multiplexing telecommunications equipment.

Note:
It is important that fibres used for testing are correct for the specified interface(s).

Optical fibres should be terminated with BFOC2.5 (ST2.5) connectors. For multimode applications use 50/125 µm
core fibre. Make sure fibre test leads used for measurements are long enough for mode stripping (a method of
reducing loss within the core). We recommend a minimum length of 10 m (30ft) for this.
If IEDs communicate using IEEE C37.94 compliant multiplexed electrical communication channels, a P590 is used.
This is a bidirectional optical-to-electrical signal converter. It is situated near the multiplexer, between the fibre
from the IED and the electrical interface of the multiplexer. Apply the loopback either at the P590 or the multiplexer
to ensure as much of the circuit as possible is tested. If the IED is connected to a multiplexer, the loopback testing
is exactly the same whether connected directly or via a multiplexer. The P590 interface units require additional
tests (see P590 documentation).
To enable IM64, set the InterMiCOM64 cell in the CONFIGURATION column to Enable.

Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.

7.1 CHECKING THE INTERFACE


Before carrying out the loopback test, you need to check that the interface is transmitting a suitable signal. To
check this ...
1. Set COMMISSIONING TEST > Loopback Mode to External.
2. Using an appropriate fibre-optic cable, connect the Channel 1 transmitter (TX1) to an optical power meter.
Check that the average power transmitted is within the range given in the following table.
3. Record the transmit power level.
4. Repeat for Channel 2 if applicable.

850 nm 1300 nm 1300/1550 nm


Power
multi-mode multi-mode single-mode
Maximum transmitter power (average value) -19.8 dBm -3 dBm -3 dBm
Minimum transmitter power (average value) -22.8 dBm -9 dBm -9 dBm

Note:
If CONFIGURATION > InterMiCOM64 is set to Enable, the signals normally sent and received by and from the
communications interface are routed to and from the signals defined in the Programmable Scheme Logic. If, however,
COMMISSION TESTS > IM64 Test Mode is set to Enabled, an IM64 test pattern is transmitted instead.

626 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

7.2 SETTING UP THE LOOPBACK


Set up a communications loopback for each of the two channels.
Where direct fibre connections are used (or where multiplexer channels conforming to the IEEE C37.94 standard
are used), connect an appropriate fibre-optic cable from the channel transmitter to the channel receiver port on
the rear of the device.
If the communications use P59x interface devices, connect the appropriate optical fibre(s) between the channel
transmitter(s) on the IED used to make connection to the P59x optical receiver(s). Then commission the relevant
P59x devices.

7.3 LOOPBACK TEST


1. Set COMMISSION TESTS > IM64 Test Mode to Enabled, and use COMMISSION TESTS > Test Pattern to set a
bit pattern sent using the InterMiCOM64 loopback.
2. Check that MEASUREMENTS 4 > IM64 Rx Status matches the test pattern set. The communication statistics
show the number of valid and erroneous messages received.

Note:
The propagation delay measurement is not valid in this mode of operation. The IED responds as if it is connected to a remote
IED. It indicates a loopback alarm which can only be cleared by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Loopback Mode to Disabled.

Note:
In loopback mode the signals sent and received through the protection communications interface continue to be routed to
and from the signals defined in the programmable logic.

Note:
A test pattern can also be sent to the remote end to test the whole InterMiCOM communication path. To do this, set
COMMISSION TESTS >IM64 Test Mode to Enable and connect two ends. Take special care because the test pattern is
executed using PSL at the remote end.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 627
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

8 SETTING CHECKS
The setting checks ensure that all of the application-specific settings (both the IED’s function and programmable
scheme logic settings) have been correctly applied.

Note:
If applicable, the trip circuit should remain isolated during these checks to prevent accidental operation of the associated
circuit breaker.

8.1 APPLY APPLICATION-SPECIFIC SETTINGS


There are two different methods of applying the settings to the IED
● Transferring settings to the IED from a pre-prepared setting file using MiCOM S1 Agile
● Enter the settings manually using the IED’s front panel HMI

8.1.1 TRANSFERRING SETTINGS FROM A SETTINGS FILE


This is the preferred method for transferring function settings. It is much faster and there is a lower margin for
error.
1. Connect a PC running the Settings Application Software to the IED's front port, or a rear Ethernet port.
Alternatively connect to the rear Courier communications port, using a KITZ protocol converter if necessary.
2. Power on the IED
3. Enter the IP address of the device if it is Ethernet enabled
4. Right-click the appropriate device name in the System Explorer pane and select Send
5. In the Send to dialog select the setting files and click Send

Note:
The device name may not already exist in the system shown in System Explorer. In this case, perform a Quick Connect to the
IED, then manually add the settings file to the device name in the system. Refer to the Settings Application Software help for
details of how to do this.

8.1.2 ENTERING SETTINGS USING THE HMI


1. Starting at the default display, press the Down cursor key to show the first column heading.
2. Use the horizontal cursor keys to select the required column heading.
3. Use the vertical cursor keys to view the setting data in the column.
4. To return to the column header, either press the Up cursor key for a second or so, or press the Cancel key
once. It is only possible to move across columns at the column heading level.
5. To return to the default display, press the Up cursor key or the Cancel key from any of the column headings.
If you use the auto-repeat function of the Up cursor key, you cannot go straight to the default display from
one of the column cells because the auto-repeat stops at the column heading.
6. To change the value of a setting, go to the relevant cell in the menu, then press the Enter key to change the
cell value. A flashing cursor on the LCD shows that the value can be changed. You may be prompted for a
password first.
7. To change the setting value, press the vertical cursor keys. If the setting to be changed is a binary value or a
text string, select the required bit or character to be changed using the left and right cursor keys.

628 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

8. Press the Enter key to confirm the new setting value or the Clear key to discard it. The new setting is
automatically discarded if it is not confirmed within 15 seconds.
9. For protection group settings and disturbance recorder settings, the changes must be confirmed before
they are used. When all required changes have been entered, return to the column heading level and press
the down cursor key. Before returning to the default display, the following prompt appears.

Update settings?
ENTER or CLEAR

10. Press the Enter key to accept the new settings or press the Clear key to discard the new settings.

Note:
If the menu time-out occurs before the setting changes have been confirmed, the setting values are also discarded.
Control and support settings are updated immediately after they are entered, without the Update settings prompt.
It is not possible to change the PSL using the IED’s front panel HMI.

Caution:
Where the installation needs application-specific PSL, the relevant .psl files, must be
transferred to the IED, for each and every setting group that will be used. If you do
not do this, the factory default PSL will still be resident. This may have severe
operational and safety consequences.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 629
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

9 IEC 61850 EDITION 2 TESTING

9.1 USING IEC 61850 EDITION 2 TEST MODES


In a conventional substation, functionality typically resides in a single device. It is usually easy to physically isolate
these functions, as the hardwired connects can simply be removed. Within a digital substation architecture
however, functions may be distributed across many devices. This makes isolation of these functions difficult,
because there are no physical wires that can be disconnected on a Ethernet network. Logical isolation of the
various functions is therefore necessary.
With devices that support IEC 61850 Edition 2, it is possible to use a test mode to conduct online testing, which
helps with the situation. The advantages of this are as follows:
● The device can be placed into a test mode, which can disable the relay outputs when testing the device
with test input signals.
● Specific protection and control functions can be logically isolated.
● GOOSE messages can be tagged so that receiving devices can recognise they are test signals.
● An IED receiving simulated GOOSE or Sampled Value messages from test devices can differentiate these
from normal process messages, and be configured to respond appropriately.

9.1.1 IED TEST MODE BEHAVIOUR


Test modes define how the device responds to test messages, and whether the relay outputs are activated or not.
You can select the mode of operation by:
● Using the front panel HMI, with the setting IED Test Mode under the COMMISSION TESTS column.
● Using an IEC 61850 control service to System/LLN0.Mod
● Using an opto-input via PSL with the signal Block Contacts

The following table summarises the IED behaviour under the different modes:
IED Test Mode Setting Result
Disabled ● Normal IED behaviour
● Protection remains enabled
● Output from the device is still active
Test ● IEC 61850 message output has the 'quality' parameter set to 'test'
● The device only responds to IEC61850 MMS messages from the client with the
'test' flag set
● Protection remains enabled
● Output from the device is disabled
Contacts Blocked ● IEC 61850 message output has quality set to ‘test’
● The device only responds to IEC 61850 MMS messages from the client with the
'test' flag set

Setting the Test or Contacts Blocked mode puts the whole IED into test mode. The IEC 61850 data object Beh in all
Logical Nodes (except LPHD and any protection Logical Nodes that have Beh = 5 (off) due to the function being
disabled) will be set to 3 (test) or 4 (test/blocked) as applicable.

9.1.2 SAMPLED VALUE TEST MODE BEHAVIOUR


The SV Test Mode defines how the device responds to test sampled value messages. You can select the mode of
operation by using the front panel HMI, with the setting SV Test Mode under the IEC 61850-9.2LE column.
The following table summarises the behaviour for sampled values under the different modes:

630 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

SV Test Mode Setting Result


● Normal IED behaviour
● All sampled value data frames received with an IEC 61850 Test quality bit set
Disabled are treated as invalid
● The IED will display the measurement values for sampled values with the
Simulated flag set but the protection elements within the IED will be blocked
● All sampled value data frames received are treated as good, no matter if they
Enabled
have an IEC 61850-9-2 Simulated flag set or not

9.2 SIMULATED INPUT BEHAVIOUR


Simulated GOOSE messages and sampled value streams can be used during testing.
The Subscriber Sim setting in the COMMISSION TESTS column controls whether a device listens to simulated
signals or to real ones. An IEC 61850 control service to System/LPHD.Sim can also be used to change this value.
The device may be presented with both real signals and test signals. An internal state machine is used to control
how the device switches between signals:
● The IED will continue subscribing to the ‘real’ GOOSE1 (in green) until it receives the first simulated GOOSE 1
(in red). This will initiate subscription changeover.
● After changeover to this new state, the IED will continue to subscribe to the simulated GOOSE 1 message (in
red). Even if this simulated GOOSE 1 message disappears, the real GOOSE 1 message (in green) will still not
be processed. This means all Virtual Inputs derived from the GOOSE 1 message will go to their default state.
● The only way to bring the IED out of this state is to set the Subscriber Sim setting back to False. The IED will
then immediately stop processing the simulated messages and start processing real messages again.
● During above steps, IED1 will continuously process the real GOOSE 2 and GOOSE 3 messages as normal
because it has not received any simulated messages for these that would initiate a changeover.
The process is represented in the following figure:

LPHD1

Sim stVal=true Beh stVal=on


Simulated GOOSE 1 messages
Simulation bit goes TRUE

Real GOOSE 1 messages


Simulation bit was FALSE

Incoming data
processed
Real GOOSE 2 messages

Real GOOSE 3 messages

Reception buffer

V01058

Figure 297: Simulated input behaviour

9.3 TESTING EXAMPLES


These examples show how you test the IED with and without simulated values. Depending on the IED Test Mode, it
may respond by operating plant (for example by tripping the circuit breaker) or it may not operate plant.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 631
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

9.3.1 TEST PROCEDURE FOR REAL VALUES


This procedure is for testing with real values without operating plant.
1. Set device into 'Contacts Blocked' Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Test Mode ® Contacts Blocked
2. Confirm new behaviour has been enabled
View COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Mod/Beh, and check that it shows Test-blocked
3. Set device into Simulation Listening Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® Subscriber Sim = Disabled
4. If using sampled values set the sampled values test mode
Select IEC 61850-9.2LE ® SV Test Mode ® Disabled
5. Inject real signals using a test device connected to the merging units. The device will continue to listen to
‘real’ GOOSE messages and ignore simulated messages received.
6. Verify function based on test signal outputs
Binary outputs (e.g. CB trips) will not operate. All transmitted GOOSE and MMS data items will be tagged with
the 'quality' parameter set to 'test', so that the receiver understands that they have been issued by a device
under test and can respond accordingly. This is summarised in the following diagram

V01062

Figure 298: Test example 1

9.3.2 TEST PROCEDURE FOR SIMULATED VALUES - NO PLANT


This procedure is for testing with simulated values without operating plant.
1. Set device into 'Contacts Blocked' Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Test Mode ® Contacts Blocked
2. Confirm new behaviour has been enabled
View COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Mod/Beh, and check that it shows test-blocked
3. Set device into Simulation Listening Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® Subscriber Sim = Enabled

632 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

4. If using sampled values set the sampled values test mode


Select IEC 61850-9.2LE ® SV Test Mode ® Enabled
5. Inject simulated signals using a test device connected to the Ethernet network. The device will continue to
listen to ‘real’ GOOSE messages until a simulated message is received. Once the simulated messages are
received, the corresponding ‘real’ messages are ignored until the device is taken out of test mode. Each
message is treated separately, but sampled values are considered as a single message.
6. Verify function based on test signal outputs
Binary outputs (e.g. CB trips) will not operate. All transmitted GOOSE and MMS data items will be tagged with
the 'quality' parameter set to 'test', so that the receiver understands that they have been issued by a device
under test and can respond accordingly. This is summarised in the following diagram

V01063

Figure 299: Test example 2

9.3.3 TEST PROCEDURE FOR SIMULATED VALUES - WITH PLANT


This procedure is for testing with simulated values with operating plant.
1. Set device into 'Contacts Blocked' Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Test Mode ® Test
2. Confirm new behaviour has been enabled
View COMMISSION TESTS ® IED Mod/Beh, and check that it shows Test
3. Set device into Simulation Listening Mode
Select COMMISSION TESTS ® Subscriber Sim = Enabled
4. If using sampled values set the sampled values test mode
Select IEC 61850-9.2LE ® SV Test Mode ® Enabled
5. Inject simulated signals using a test device connected to the Ethernet network.
The device will continue to listen to ‘real’ GOOSE messages until a simulated message is received. Once the
simulated messages are received, the corresponding ‘real’ messages are ignored until the device is taken
out of IED test mode. Each message is treated separately, but sampled values are considered as a single
message.
6. Verify function based on test signal outputs.
Binary outputs (e.g. CB trips) will operate as normal. All transmitted GOOSE and MMS data items will be
tagged with the 'quality' parameter set to 'test', so that the receiver understands that they have been issued
by a device under test and can respond accordingly. This is summarised in the following diagram:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 633
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

V01064

Figure 300: Test example 3

9.3.4 CONTACT TEST


The Apply Test command in this cell is used to change the state of the contacts set for operation.
If the device has been put into 'Contact Blocked' mode using an input signal (via the Block Contacts DDB signal)
then the Apply Test command will not execute. This is to prevent a device that has been blocked by an external
process having its contacts operated by a local operator using the HMI.
If the Block Contacts DDB is not set and the Apply Test command in this cell is issued, contacts change state and
the command text on the LCD changes to No Operation. The contacts remain in the Test state until reset by
issuing the Remove Test command. The command text on the LCD shows No Operation after the Remove Test
command has been issued.

Note:
When the IED Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked, the Relay O/P Status cell does not show the current status of the
output relays so cannot be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it is necessary to monitor the state of
each contact in turn.

634 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

10 DISTANCE PROTECTION

10.1 SINGLE-ENDED TESTING


If the distance protection function is being used, test the reaches and time delays.
1. Check for any possible dependency conditions and simulate as appropriate
2. In the CONFIGURATION column, disable all protection elements other than the one being tested
3. Make a note of which elements need to be re-enabled after testing

10.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
You should now connect the IED to equipment able to supply phase-phase and phase-neutral volts with current in
the correct phase relation for a particular type of fault on the selected characteristic angle. The facility for altering
the loop impedance (phase-to-ground fault or phase-phase) presented to the IED is essential.
Use a three-phase digital/electronic injection test set to make the commissioning procedure easier.
1. If testing the distance elements using using test sets that do not provide a dynamic model to generate true
fault delta conditions, set COMMISSIONING TESTS > Static Test Mode to Enabled. When set, this disables
phase selector control and forces the device to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.
2. For lower specification test equipment that cannot apply a full three phase set of healthy simulated pre-
fault voltages, the VT supervision may need to be disabled to avoid spurious pickup. Set CONFIGURATION >
Supervision to Disabled.
3. Connect the test equipment to the device using the test block(s), taking care not to open-circuit any CT
secondary windings. If using MMLG type test blocks, the live side of the test plug must be provided with
shorting links before it is inserted into the test block.
4. When the test is complete, make sure COMMISSIONING TESTS > Static Test Mode is set back to Disabled.

10.1.2 ZONE 1 REACH CHECK


The zone 1 element is set to be directional forward.
1. Apply a dynamic A-phase-to-neutral fault, slightly in excess of the expected reach. The duration of the
injection should be in excess of the tZ1 timer setting, but less than tZ2. These settings are in the DISTANCE
column. No trip should occur, and the red Trip LED should remain OFF.
2. Reduce the impedance and reapply the simulated fault.
3. Repeat this procedure until a trip occurs. When this happens, the display shows Alarms/Faults present and
the Alarm and Trip LEDs switch ON.
4. To view the alarm message, keep pressing the read key until the yellow alarm LED changes from flashing to
being steadily on.
5. At the prompt Press clear to reset alarms, press the C key. This clears the fault record from the display.
6. Record the impedance at which the device trips. The measured impedance should be within +/- 10% of the
expected reach.
7. Read and reset the alarms
Modern injection test sets usually calculate the expected fault loop impedance from the device settings. For those
that do not, check the reach for phase-phase and confirm the operation of the contacts. The appropriate loop
impedance is given by the vector sum:
Z1 + Z1 residual = Z1 + (Z1.kZN Res Comp ÐkZN Angle) Ω

P446SV-TM-EN-1 635
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

10.1.3 ZONE 2 REACH CHECK


The zone 2 element is set to be directional forward.
1. Apply a dynamic B-C fault, slightly in excess of the expected reach. The duration of the injection should be
in excess of the tZ2 timer setting, but less than tZ3. These settings are in the DISTANCE column. No trip
should occur, and the red Trip LED should remain OFF.
2. Repeat the test described above to find the zone reach.
3. Record the impedance at which the device trips. The measured impedance should be within +/- 10% of the
expected reach.
4. Read and reset the alarms.
Modern injection test sets usually calculate the expected fault loop impedance from the device settings. For those
that do not, check the reach for phase-phase and confirm the operation of the appropriate contacts. The
appropriate loop impedance is now given by:
2 x Z2 Ω

10.1.4 ZONE 3 REACH CHECK


1. The zone 3 element is set to forward, reverse or offset. The current injected must be in the appropriate
direction to match the setting in the DISTANCE SETUP column.
2. Apply a dynamic C-A fault, slightly in excess of the expected reach. The duration of the injection should be
in excess of the tZ3 timer setting (typically tZ3 + 100 ms).
3. Repeat the test described above to find the zone reach.
4. Record the impedance at which the device trips. The measured impedance should be within +/- 10% of the
expected reach.
5. Read and reset the alarms.
6. Check that the correct reverse offset (Z3’) has been applied. The setting is in the Z3’ Ph Rev Reach and Z3’
Gnd Rev Reach cells.

10.1.5 ZONE 4 REACH CHECK


The zone 4 element is set to be directional reverse.
1. Apply a dynamic B-N fault, slightly in excess of the expected reach. The duration of the injection should be
in excess of the tZ4 timer setting (typically tZ4 + 100 ms).
2. Repeat the test described above to find the zone reach.
3. Record the impedance at which the device trips. The measured impedance should be within +/- 10% of the
expected reach.
4. Read and reset the alarms.

10.1.6 ZONE P REACH CHECK


The zone P element can be set to forward or reverse directional or offset. The current injected must be in the
correct direction to match the setting in the DISTANCE SETUP column.
1. Apply a dynamic C-N fault, slightly in excess of the expected reach. The duration of the injection should be
in excess of the tZP timer setting (typically tZP + 100 ms).
2. Repeat the test described above to find the zone reach.
3. Record the impedance at which the relay trips. The measured impedance should be within +/-10% of the
expected reach.
4. Read and reset the alarms.

636 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

10.1.7 RESISTIVE REACH


This is for quadrilateral characteristics only.
Check that the correct settings for phase and ground element resistive reaches have been applied. The relevant
settings are:
● R1Ph, R2Ph, R3Ph, R3Ph reverse, R4Ph and RP Ph for phase fault zones.
● R1Gnd, R2Gnd, R3Gnd, R3Gnd reverse, R4Gnd and RP Gnd for ground fault zones.

Note:
Zone 3 has an independent setting for the forward resistance reach (right-hand resistive reach line), and the reverse resistance
reach (left-hand resistive reach line).

10.1.8 LOAD BLINDER


1. Check that the correct settings for the load blinder have been applied. The settings are at the end of the
DISTANCE SETUP column.
2. Verify that the Load B/Angle cell is set at least 10 degrees less than the Line Angle setting in the LINE
PARAMETERS column.

10.2 OPERATION AND CONTACT ASSIGNMENT


You should inject a fault at half Z1 reach with the intention of causing a distance protection trip.

10.2.1 PHASE A
1. Prepare a dynamic A-phase-to-neutral fault, as detailed above.
2. Set a timer to start when the fault injection is applied and to stop when the trip occurs.
3. To verify correct output contact mapping use the trip contacts that would be expected to trip the circuit
breaker(s) (Any Trip for 3-pole tripping, Trip A for single pole tripping).
4. For two breaker applications, stop the timer when CB1 and CB2 trip contacts have both closed. Monitor by
connecting the contacts in series to stop the timer if necessary.
5. Record the phase A trip time.
6. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

10.2.2 PHASE B
1. Reconfigure to test a B phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to B phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase B trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

10.2.3 PHASE C
1. Reconfigure to test a C phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to C phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase C trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 637
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

The average of the recorded operating times for the three phases should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz,
and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.

Note:
Where a non-zero time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically within +/- 5% of
the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” delay.

10.2.4 TIME DELAY SETTINGS


Check that the correct time delay settings have been applied. The relevant settings are in the SCHEME LOGIC
column and are as follows:
● tZ1 Ph Time Delay and tZ1 Gnd Time Delay
● tZ2 Ph Time Delay and tZ2 Gnd Time Delay
● tZ3 Ph Time Delay and tZ3 Gnd Time Delay
● tZP Ph Time Delay and tZP Gnd Time Delay
● tZ4 Ph Time Delay and tZ4 Gnd Time Delay

Note:
The device allows separate time delay settings for phase (“Ph”) and ground (“Gnd”) fault elements. BOTH must be checked to
ensure that they have been set correctly.

10.3 SCHEME TESTING


The device is tested for its response to internal and external fault simulations but the response depends on the
aided channel (pilot) scheme selected. The response to the 'Reset Z1 Extension' opto-input is shown in the case of a
Zone 1 Extension scheme.
We assume a conventional signalling scheme implementation.

If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal DDB signals need to be set or reset to test the operation of the
protection scheme.
Use the IM64 Test Mode with the IM64 Test Pattern to assert or monitor the relevant signals.
Ensure that the injection test set timer is still connected to measure the time taken for the device to trip. A series of
fault injections are applied, with a Zone 1, end-of-line, or Zone 4 fault simulated. At this stage, note the method in
which each fault is applied, but do not inject yet:
● Zone 1 fault: A dynamic forward A-B fault at half the Zone 1 reach is simulated.
● End of line fault: A dynamic forward A-B fault at the remote end of the line is simulated. The fault
impedance simulated should match the LINE PARAMETERS > Line Impedance setting.
● Zone 4 fault: A dynamic reverse A-B fault at half the Zone 4 reach is simulated.

The following table indicates the expected response for various test situations for a conventional signalling
scheme.
IED RESPONSE
Forward fault in Forward fault at end of line
Fault type simulated Reverse fault in zone 4
zone 1 (within Z1X/Z2)
Signal receive opto ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Zone 1 extension Trip Trip No Trip Trip No Trip No Trip
Trip, Trip, No Trip, No Signal Trip, No Trip, Signal No Trip, Signal
Blocking scheme
No Signal Send No Signal Send Send No Signal Send Send Send

638 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

IED RESPONSE
Forward fault in Forward fault at end of line
Fault type simulated Reverse fault in zone 4
zone 1 (within Z1X/Z2)
Permissive Scheme Trip, No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal
Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send
(PUR/PUTT) No Signal Send Send Send Send
Permissive Scheme No Trip, Signal No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal
Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send
(POR/POTT) Send Send Send

10.3.1 SCHEME TRIP TEST FOR ZONE 1 EXTENSION


1. Energise the Reset Z1X (Reset Zone 1 Extension) opto-input. This is done by applying a continuous DC
voltage onto the required opto-input, either from the test set, or station battery.
2. Inject an end of line fault. The duration of injection should be set to 100 ms. No trip should occur.
3. De-energise the Reset Z1X opto-input
4. Repeat the test injection and record the operating time. This should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz,
and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.
5. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

Note:
Here a non-zero tZ1 Ph or tZ1 Gnd time delay is set in the DISTANCE column, the expected operating time is typically within
+/- 5% of the tZ1 setting plus the “instantaneous” delay quoted above.

10.3.2 SCHEME TRIP TESTS FOR PERMISSIVE SCHEMES


This test applies to both Permissive Underreach, and Permissive Overreach aided scheme applications.
1. Energise the Signal Receive opto-input. This is done by applying a continuous DC voltage onto the required
opto-input from the test set, or station battery.
2. Inject an end of line fault, and record the operating time. The measured operating time should typically be
less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.
3. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
4. De-energise the Signal Receive opto-input (remove the temporary energisation link, to turn it OFF).

Note:
Where a non-zero Aided Distance Dly time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically
within +/- 5% of the tZ1 setting plus the “instantaneous” delay quoted above.

10.3.3 SCHEME TRIP TESTS FOR BLOCKING SCHEME


1. Energise the Signal Receive opto-input. This is done by applying a continuous DC voltage onto the required
opto-input, either from the test set, or station battery.
2. Inject an end of line fault. The duration of injection should be set to 100 ms. No trip should occur.
3. De-energise the channel received opto-input.
4. Repeat the test injection, and record the operating time.
5. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

Note:
For blocking schemes, a non-zero Aided Distance Dly time delay is set, so the expected operating time is typically within +/-
5% of the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” operating delay. The trip time should thus be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and
less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz, plus 1.05 x Delay setting.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 639
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

10.3.4 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR PERMISSIVE SCHEMES


This test applies to both Permissive Underreach, and Permissive Overreach scheme applications.
1. Reconnect the test set so that the timer is no longer stopped by the Trip contact, but is now stopped by the
Signal Send contact. This is the contact that would normally be connected to the pilot/signalling channel.
2. Inject a Zone 1 fault, and record the Signal Send contact operating time. The measured operating time
should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz applications.
3. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

10.3.5 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR BLOCKING SCHEME


1. Reconnect the test set so that the timer is no longer stopped by the Trip contact, but is now stopped by the
Signal Send contact. This is the contact that would normally be connected to the pilot/signalling channel.
2. Inject a Zone 4 fault, and record the signal send contact operating time. The measured operating time
should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz applications.
3. Switch OFF the ACsupply and reset the alarms.

10.3.6 SCHEME TIMER SETTINGS


1. Check that the correct time delay settings have been applied. The relevant settings in the AIDED SCHEMES
column are:
a. tRev. Guard (if applicable/visible)
b. Unblocking Delay (if applicable/visible)
c. WI Trip Delay (if applicable/visible)
2. When the tests are completed, restore all settings that were disabled for testing purposes.
3. Set the Static Test Mode to Disabled.
4. Remove any wires or leads temporarily fitted to energise the channel receive opto-input

640 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

11 DELTA DIRECTIONAL COMPARISON

11.1 SINGLE-ENDED TESTING


If the delta directional comparison aided scheme is being used, test the operation
1. In the CONFIGURATION column, disable all protection elements other than the one being tested.
2. Make a note of which elements need to be re-enabled after testing

11.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
Use a three-phase digital/electronic injection test set to make the commissioning procedure easier.
Connect the test equipment to the device using the test block(s) taking care not to open-circuit any CT secondary.
If MMLG type test blocks are used, the live side of the test plug must be provided with shorting links before it is
inserted into the test block.

11.1.2 SINGLE-ENDED INJECTION TEST


This set of injection tests aims to determine correct operation of a single IED at one end of the scheme. The device
is tested in isolation, with the communications channel to the remote line terminal disconnected.
First verify that the device cannot send or receive channel scheme signals to or from the remote line end.
The device is tested for its response to forward and reverse fault injections, but the response depends on the aided
channel (pilot) scheme that is selected. The table below shows the expected response for various test situations for
a conventional signalling scheme.
We assume a conventional signalling scheme implementation.

If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal DDB signals need to be set or reset to test the operation of the
protection scheme.
Use the IM64 Test Mode with the IM64 Test Pattern to assert or monitor the relevant signals.
IED RESPONSE
Direction of fault test
Forward fault Reverse fault
injection
Signal receive opto ON OFF ON OFF
No Trip, Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
Blocking scheme
No Signal Send No Signal Send Signal Send Signal Send
Permissive scheme (POR/ Trip, No Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
POTT) Signal Send Signal Send No Signal Send No Signal Send

11.1.3 FORWARD FAULT PREPARATION


Configure the test set to inject a dynamic sequence of injection, as follows:
1. Simulate a healthy three-phase set of balanced voltages, each of magnitude Vn. No load current should be
simulated. The duration of injection should be set to 1 second. Step 1 therefore mimics a healthy unloaded
line before the onset of a fault.
2. Simulate a forward fault on the A-phase. The A-phase voltage must be simulated to drop by 3 times the Dir.
V Fwd setting,
Va = Vn – 3 (Dir. V Fwd)
The fault current on the A-phase should be set to 3 times the Dir. I Fwd setting, lagging Va by a phase angle equal
to the line angle,

P446SV-TM-EN-1 641
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

Ia = 3 (Dir. I Fwd)Ð-θ Line


Phases B and C should retain their healthy pre-fault voltage, and no current. The duration of injection should be
set to 100 ms longer than the Aid. 1 Delta Dly, Aid. 2 Delta Dly time setting.

11.2 OPERATION AND CONTACT ASSIGNMENT


You should inject a forward fault with the intention of causing a scheme trip. For a Permissive scheme, the Signal
Receive opto-input needs to be energized. This is done by applying a continuous DC voltage onto the required
opto-input, either from the test set, or station battery.
For a Blocking scheme, the opto-input should remain de-energised.

11.2.1 PHASE A
1. Prepare a dynamic A-phase-to-neutral fault, as detailed above.
2. Set a timer to start when the fault injection is applied and to stop when the trip occurs.
3. To verify correct output contact mapping use the trip contacts that would be expected to trip the circuit
breaker(s) (Any Trip for 3-pole tripping, Trip A for single pole tripping).
4. For two breaker applications, stop the timer when CB1 and CB2 trip contacts have both closed. Monitor by
connecting the contacts in series to stop the timer if necessary.
5. Record the phase A trip time.
6. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

11.2.2 PHASE B
1. Reconfigure to test a B phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to B phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase B trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

11.2.3 PHASE C
1. Reconfigure to test a C phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to C phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase C trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

The average of the recorded operating times for the three phases should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz,
and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.

Note:
Where a non-zero time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically within +/- 5% of
the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” delay.

642 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

11.3 DELTA PROTECTION SCHEME TESTING

11.3.1 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR PERMISSIVE SCHEMES


1. Reconnect the test set so that the timer is no longer stopped by the Trip contact, but is now stopped by the
Signal Send contact. This is the contact that would normally be connected to the pilot/signalling channel.
2. Repeat the forward fault injection, and record the Signal Send contact operating time. The measured
operating time should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz applications.
3. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

11.3.2 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR BLOCKING SCHEMES


Configure the test set to inject a dynamic sequence of injection, as follows:
1. Simulate a healthy three-phase set of balanced voltages, each of magnitude Vn. No load current should be
simulated. The duration of injection should be set to 1 second. Step 1 therefore mimics a healthy unloaded
line, prior to the onset of a fault.
2. Simulate a reverse fault on the A-phase. The A-phase voltage must be simulated to drop by 3 times the Dir.
V Rev setting; Va = Vn – 3(Dir. V Rev)
3. The fault current on the A-phase should be set to 3 times the DI Rev setting, and in antiphase to the forward
injections; Ia = 3 (Dir. I Rev) Ð180°-θ Line
4. Prepare the dynamic A phase reverse fault, as detailed above. Ensure that the test set is simulating Steps 1
and 2 as one continuous transition.
5. Set a timer to start when the fault injection is applied, and to stop when the Delta scheme Signal Send
contact closes.
6. Apply the test, and record the signal send contact response time. The recorded operating time should
typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz applications.
7. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

Caution:
When the tests are completed, restore all settings that were disabled for testing
purposes.

Caution:
Remove any wires or leads temporarily fitted to energise the channel receive opto-
input.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 643
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

12 DEF AIDED SCHEMES

12.1 EARTH CURRENT PILOT SCHEME


1. Check for any possible dependency conditions and simulate as appropriate.
2. In the CONFIGURATION column, disable all protection elements other than the one being tested.
3. Make a note of which elements need to be re-enabled after testing.
We assume a conventional signalling scheme implementation.

If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal logic signals (DDBs) need to be set or reset to test the
operation of the protection scheme.
The IM64 Test Mode in conjunction with the IM64 Test Pattern should be used to assert or monitor the relevant
signals.
This set of injection tests aims to determine that a single device, at one end of the scheme is performing correctly.

Note:
The device must be tested in isolation, with the communications channel to the remote line terminal disconnected.

12.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
1. Determine which output relays have been selected to operate when a DEF trip occurs, by viewing the
programmable scheme logic. If the trip outputs are phase segregated (a different output relay allocated for
each phase), the output relay assigned for tripping on ‘A’ phase faults should be used.
2. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the timer.
3. Connect the current output of the test set to the ‘A’ phase current transformer input
4. Connect, all three phase voltages Va, Vb, and Vc.
5. Depending on the test equipment used, make sure the timer is set to start when the current is applied.

12.1.2 PERFORM THE TEST


1. Ensure that the timer is reset and prepare the following test shot.
2. Simulate a forward fault on the A-phase. The A-phase voltage must be simulated to drop by 4 times the DEF
VNpol Set setting; Va = Vn - 4 (DEF Vpol)
3. Set the fault current on the A-phase should to 2 times the DEF Threshold setting, and in the forward
direction. For a forward fault, the current Ia should lag the voltage Va by the DEF Char Angle setting; Ia = 2
(IN DEF Threshold Ð q DEF)
4. Phases B and C should retain their healthy pref-ault voltage, and no current. The duration of the injection
should be in excess of the DEF Delay setting (typically Aid. 1 DEF Dly. and Aid. 2 DEF Dly. + 100 ms).
IED RESPONSE
Direction of fault
Forward fault Reverse fault
test injection
Signal Receive Opto ON OFF ON OFF
No Trip, Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
Blocking Scheme
No Signal Send No Signal Send Signal Send Signal Send
Permissive Scheme Trip, No Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
(POR/POTT) Signal Send Signal Send No Signal Send No Signal Send

644 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

12.1.3 FORWARD FAULT TRIP TEST


A forward fault is now injected as described, with the intention to cause a scheme trip.
For a permissive scheme, the Signal Receive opto-input should be energised. This is done by applying a
continuous DC voltage onto the required opto-input, either from the test set, station battery, or IED field voltage.
The commissioning engineer decides on the best method.
For a blocking scheme, the opto-input should remain de-energised (“OFF”).
1. Apply the fault and record the (phase A) trip time.
2. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
The aided earth fault (DEF) scheme trip time for POR schemes (permissive overreach) POR schemes should be less
than 40 ms.
For blocking schemes, where a non-zero DEF Dly time delay is set, the expected operating time is typically within
+/- 5% of the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” (40 ms) delay quoted above.
There is no need to repeat the test for phases B and C, as these trip assignments have already been proven by the
distance/delta trip tests.

12.2 SCHEME TESTING

12.2.1 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR PERMISSIVE SCHEMES


1. Reconnect the test set so that the timer is no longer stopped by the Trip contact, but is now stopped by the
Signal Send contact (the contact that would normally be connected to the pilot/signalling channel).
2. Repeat the forward fault injection, and record the Signal Send contact operating time. The measured
operating time should typically be less than 40 ms.
3. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

12.2.2 SIGNAL SEND TEST FOR BLOCKING SCHEMES


1. Reconnect the test set so that the timer is no longer stopped by the Trip contact, but is now stopped by the
Signal Send contact. This is the contact that would normally be connected to the pilot/signalling channel.
2. Reverse the current flow direction on the A phase to simulate a reverse fault.
3. Perform the reverse fault injection and record the signal send contact operating time. The measured
operating time should typically be less than 40 ms.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.

Caution:
When the tests are completed, restore all settings that were disabled for testing
purposes.

Caution:
Remove any wires or leads temporarily fitted to energise the channel receive opto-
input.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 645
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

13 OUT OF STEP PROTECTION


For this test, an injection set with a state sequencer function is required, as dynamic impedance conditions are
going to be tested. The four states impedances that applied during the Out of Step commissioning process are
shown below:

+jX

Z6
Z5

State 4

State 3

State 2

State 1
R

R6' R5' R5 R6

∆R

Z5'
Z6'

V01451

Figure 301: State impedances

Depending on the Out of Step (OST) settings, use one of the following setting options.
● OST setting
● Predictive OST setting
● Predictive and OST setting

13.1 OST SETTING


1. Clear all alarms.
2. Set the OST timer to zero.
3. To test OST, a 4-state test sequence is required. Based on healthy voltages (VA = VB = VC = 57.8 V) calculate
the currents to generate the impedances as below.
State 1 State 2 State 3 State 4
Applied current
57.8/(1.1R6) 57.8/(R5+0.5(R6-R5)) 57.8/(0.95R5) 57.8/(1.1R5')
(all 3 phases)
Angle 0° 0° 0° 180°
Duration 500 ms Longer than ‘Delta t’ set time 100 ms 500 ms

Now apply the 4-state sequence, check that all 3-phases have tripped and that an OST alarm is displayed on the
local LCD.

646 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

Note:
The angle in the table above is the angle between voltages and their respective currents. In state 4 the currents are displaced
180° from their respective voltages.

13.2 PREDICTIVE OST SETTING


1. Clear all alarms.
2. Set the OST timer to zero.
3. To test OST, a 3-state test sequence is required. Based on healthy voltages (VA = VB = VC = 57.8 V) calculate
the currents to generate the impedances as below
State 1 State 2 State 3
Applied current
57.8/(1.1R6) 57.8/(R5+0.5(R6-R5)) 57.8/(0.95R5)
(all 3 phases)
Angle 0° 0° 0°
Longer than 25 ms but shorter than
Duration 500 ms 500 ms
‘Delta t’ set time

Now apply the 3-state sequence, check that all 3-phases have tripped and that an OST alarm is displayed on the
local LCD.

13.3 PREDICTIVE AND OST SETTING


As per Predictive OST

13.4 OST TIMER TEST


1. Repeat the test as for ‘predictive OST’ and observe that the 3-phase tripping comes up after the ‘Tost’ set
delay.
2. Record the operating time in the commissioning record sheet.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 647
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

14 PROTECTION TIMING CHECKS


There is no need to check every protection function. Only one protection function needs to be checked as the
purpose is to verify the timing on the processor is functioning correctly.

14.1 OVERCURRENT CHECK


If the overcurrent protection function is being used, test the overcurrent protection for stage 1.
1. Check for any possible dependency conditions and simulate as appropriate.
2. In the CONFIGURATION column, disable all protection elements other than the one being tested.
3. Make a note of which elements need to be re-enabled after testing.
4. Connect the test circuit.
5. Perform the test.
6. Check the operating time.

14.2 CONNECTING THE TEST CIRCUIT


1. Use the PSL to determine which output relay will operate when an overcurrent trip occurs.
2. Use the output relay assigned to Trip Output A.
3. Use the PSL to map the protection stage under test directly to an output relay.

Note:
If using the default PSL, use output relay 3 as this is already mapped to the DDB signal Trip Command Out.

4. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the timer.
5. Connect the current output of the test set to the A-phase current transformer input.
If the I>1 Directional cell in the OVERCURRENT column is set to Directional Fwd, the current should
flow out of terminal 2. If set to Directional Rev, it should flow into terminal 2.
If the I>1 Directional cell in the OVERCURRENT column has been set to Directional Fwd or
Directional Rev, the rated voltage should be applied to terminals 20 and 21.
6. Ensure that the timer starts when the current is applied.

Note:
If the timer does not stop when the current is applied and stage 1 has been set for directional operation, the connections may
be incorrect for the direction of operation set. Try again with the current connections reversed.

14.3 PERFORMING THE TEST


1. Ensure that the timer is reset.
2. Apply a current of twice the setting shown in the I>1 Current Set cell in the OVERCURRENT column.
3. Note the time displayed when the timer stops.
4. Check that the red trip LED has illuminated.

14.4 CHECK THE OPERATING TIME


Check that the operating time recorded by the timer is within the range shown below.
For all characteristics, allowance must be made for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.

648 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

Operating time at twice current setting and time multiplier/


Characteristic
time dial setting of 1.0
Nominal (seconds) Range (seconds)
DT I>1 Time Delay setting Setting ±2%
IEC S Inverse 10.03 9.53 - 10.53
IEC V Inverse 13.50 12.83 - 14.18
IEC E Inverse 26.67 24.67 - 28.67
UK LT Inverse 120.00 114.00 - 126.00
IEEE M Inverse 3.8 3.61 - 4.0
IEEE V Inverse 7.03 6.68 - 7.38
IEEE E Inverse 9.50 9.02 - 9.97
US Inverse 2.16 2.05 - 2.27
US ST Inverse 12.12 11.51 - 12.73

Note:
With the exception of the definite time characteristic, the operating times given are for a Time Multiplier Setting (TMS) or Time
Dial Setting (TDS) of 1. For other values of TMS or TDS, the values need to be modified accordingly.

Note:
For definite time and inverse characteristics there is an additional delay of up to 0.02 second and 0.08 second respectively.
You may need to add this the IED's acceptable range of operating times.

Caution:
On completion of the tests, you must restore all settings to customer specifications.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 649
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

15 SYSTEM CHECK AND CHECK SYNCHRONISM


This function performs a comparison between the line voltage and the bus voltage.
For a single circuit breaker application, there are two voltage inputs to compare:
● one from the voltage transformer input from the line side of the circuit breaker (Main VT)
● one from the VT on the bus side of the circuit breaker (CS VT).

For a dual circuit breaker installation (breaker-and-a-half switch or mesh/ring bus), three VT inputs are required:
● one from the common point of the two circuit breakers, identified as the line (Main VT)
● one from the bus side of CB1 (CB1 CS VT)
● one from the bus side of CB2 (CB2 CS VT)

In most cases the line VT input is three phase, whereas the bus VTs are single phase.
The bus VT inputs are normally single phase so the system voltage checks are made on single phases and the VT
may be connected to either a phase-to-phase or phase to neutral voltage.
For these reasons, the IED has to be programmed with the appropriate connection. The CS Input setting in the CT
AND VT RATIOS column can be set to A-N, B-N, C-N, A-B, B-C or C-A according to the application.
The single-phase bus VT inputs each have associated phase shift and voltage magnitude compensation settings
to compensate for healthy voltage angle and magnitude differences between the check sync VT input and the
selected main VT reference phase. These are:
● CB1 CS VT PhShft, CB1 CS VT Mag, CB2 CS VT PhShft, CB2 CS VT Mag
Any voltage measurements or comparisons using bus VT inputs are made using the compensated values.
Each circuit breaker controlled can have two stages of check synchronism enabled according to the settings:
● Sys Checks CB1, CB1 CS1 Status, CB1 CS2 Status, Sys Checks CB2, CB2 CS1 Status, CB1 CS2 Status
When the system voltage check conditions are satisfied, the relevant DDB signals are asserted high as follows:
● DDB (883): CB1 CS1 OK
● DDB (884): CB1 CS2 OK
● DDB (1577): CB2 CS1 OK
● DDB (1463): CB2 CS2 OK

These DDB signals should be mapped to the monitor/download port and used to indicate that the system check
synchronism condition has been satisfied.

15.1 CHECK SYNCHRONISM PASS


1. Taking note of the check synchronism settings, identify the appropriate VT input terminals and inject voltage
signals that should satisfy the system voltage check synchronism criteria.
2. Check that the DDB signals are asserted high.

15.2 CHECK SYNCHRONISM FAIL


1. Change the voltage signals so that the criteria are not satisfied
2. Check that the appropriate DDB signals are driven low

650 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

16 CHECK TRIP AND AUTORECLOSE CYCLE


If the auto-reclose function is being used, the circuit breaker trip and auto reclose cycle can be tested
automatically by using the application-specific settings.
To test the trip and close operation without operating the breaker, the following conditions must be satisfied:
● The CB Healthy DDB signal should either not be mapped, or if it is mapped it must be asserted high.
● The CB status inputs (52A, etc.) should either not be mapped, or if they are mapped they should be activated
to mimic the circuit breaker operation.
● Some models can be configured for single-pole tripping. If configured for single pole tripping, either set
CT/VT RATIO > VT Connected to No, or apply appropriate voltage signals to prevent the pole dead logic from
converting to 3-pole tripping.

1. To test the first three-phase auto-reclose cycle, set COMMISSION TESTS > Test Autoreclose to Trip 3
Pole. The IED performs a trip/reclose cycle.
2. Repeat this operation to test the subsequent three-phase auto-reclose cycles.
3. Check all output relays (used for such as circuit breaker tripping and closing, or blocking other devices)
operate at the correct times during the trip/close cycle.
Check the auto-reclose cycles for single phase trip conditions one at a time by sequentially setting COMMISSION
TESTS > Test Autoreclose to Trip Pole A, Trip Pole B and Trip Pole C.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 651
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

17 END-TO-END COMMUNICATION TESTS

If the IED is being used in a scheme with InterMiCOM64 communications you must perform end-to-end testing of
the protection communications channels.
In this section all loopbacks are removed and satisfactory communications between line ends of the IEDs in the
scheme are confirmed.

Note:
End-to-end communication requires a working telecommunication channel between line ends (which may be a multiplexed
link or may be a direct connection). If the telecommunication channel is not available, it is not possible to establish end-to end
communication. Unless otherwise directed by local operational practise, follow the instructions in this section so the scheme
is ready for full operation when the telecommunications channels become available.

Note:
The trip circuit should remain isolated during these checks to prevent accidental operation of the associated circuit breaker.

17.1 REMOVE LOCAL LOOPBACKS


As well as removing the loopback, this section checks that all wiring and optical fibre are reconnected. If P592 or
P593 interface units are installed the application-specific settings are also applied.
1. Check the alarm records to ensure that no communications failure alarms have occurred while the
loopback test was in progress. If it was necessary to ‘fail’ the communications while testing the non-current
differential elements, observe the communications behaviour for a few minutes before removing the
loopbacks.
2. After you are satisfied with the communications behaviour in loopback, set COMMISSION TESTS > Test Mode
and Test Loopback to Disabled.

Note:
Most of the required optical signal power levels have already been measured and recorded. If all signalling uses P59x
interface units, no further measurements are required. If, however, direct fibre or C37.94 communications are used, further
measurements are needed.

17.1.1 RESTORING DIRECT FIBRE CONNECTIONS


When restoring direct fibre connections, check the optical power level received from the remote IED(s).
1. Remove the loopback test fibres and at both ends of each channel used, reconnect the fibre optic cables for
communications between IEDs.
2. For each channel fitted, remove the fibre connecting to the optical receiver (RX).
3. Using an optical power meter measure the strength of the signal received from the remote IED. The
measurements should be within -25.4 dBm and -16.8 dBm for 850 nm fibre connections and between
-37 dBm and -7 dBm for 1300 nm fibre connections
4. Record the received power level(s).
5. Reconnect the fibre(s) to the IED receiver(s).

Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.

652 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

17.1.2 RESTORING C37.94 FIBRE CONNECTIONS


When restoring C37.94 fibre connections, check the optical power level received from both the IED and the C37.94
multiplexer.
1. Remove the loopback test fibres and at both ends of each channel used.
2. Reconnect the fibre optic cables for communications between IEDs and the C37.94 compatible multiplexer.
3. Check that the value received from the IED at the C37.94 multiplexer, as well as that received by the IED
from the C37.94 multiplexer are between -25.4 dBm (min) and -16.8 dBm (max).
4. Record the received power level(s).
5. Reconnect the fibre(s) to the IED receiver(s).

Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.

17.1.3 COMMUNICATIONS USING P59X INTERFACE UNITS


If external wiring has been removed to facilitate testing, ensure that it is replaced in accordance with the relevant
connection diagram or scheme diagram.

For the P591:


1. Check that all the cabling is correct.
2. Verify that the Healthy LED is on.

For the P592:


1. Set the V.35 LOOPBACK switch to the 0 position.
2. Set the CLOCK SWITCH, DSR, CTS and DATA RATE switches on each unit to the positions required for the
specific application.
3. Ensure the OPTO LOOPBACK switch is in the 0 position.
4. If applicable, replace the secondary front cover.

For the P593:


1. Set the X.21 LOOPBACK switch to the OFF position.
2. Ensure the OPTO LOOPBACK switch is also in the OFF position.
3. If applicable, replace the secondary front cover.

17.2 REMOVE REMOTE LOOPBACKS


Remove loopbacks at remote terminal connected to channel 1 and channel 2 by repeating the instructions for
local loopback removal.

17.3 VERIFY COMMUNICATION BETWEEN IEDS


Reset any alarm indications and check that no further communications failure alarms are raised.
1. Check channel status and propagation delays in MEASUREMENTS 4 column for channel 1 (and channel 2
where fitted).
2. Check that the first two bits in ‘Channel Status’ (Rx and Tx) are displaying ‘1’ (11************ where *
indicates a ‘don’t care’ state).

P446SV-TM-EN-1 653
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

3. Clear the statistics and record the number of valid messages and the number of errored messages after a
minimum period of 1 hour.
4. Check that the ratio of errored/good messages is better than 10-4.
5. Record the measured message propagation delays for channel 1, and channel 2 (if fitted).

654 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

18 END-TO-END SCHEME TESTS


This section aims to check that the signalling channel is able to transmit the ON/OFF signals used in aided
schemes between the remote line ends.
Before testing, check that the channel is healthy. For example, if a power line carrier link is being used, it may not
be possible to perform the tests until the protected circuit is in service.

18.1 AIDED SCHEME 1


Aided Scheme 1 can be tested by operating output contacts to mimic the transmission of an aided channel signal.
For these tests, an engineer needs to be present at both ends of the line - at the local end to send aided signals,
and at the remote end to observe that the signals are received. A telephone link between the two commissioning
engineers is also necessary, to allow conversation.
1. Put the IED in test mode by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Test Mode to Blocked.
2. Record which contact is assigned as the Signal Send 1 output
3. Select this output contact as the one to test and advise the engineer at the remote end that the contact is
about to be tested.

18.1.1 PREPARATION AT REMOTE END


At the remote end, the engineer must confirm the assignment of the Monitor Bits in the COMMISSION TESTS
column in the menu, to be able to see the aided channel on arrival.
Scroll down and ensure that the Monitor Bit 1 cell is set to DDB493 and that the Monitor Bit 5 cell is set to
DDB507. The Test Port Status cell appropriately sets or resets the bits that now represent Aided 1 Scheme Receive
(DDB493), and Aided 2 Scheme Receive (DDB507), with the rightmost bit representing Aided Channel 1. From now
on the engineer at the remote end should monitor the indication of the Test Port Status cell.

18.1.2 PERFORMING THE TEST


1. At the local end, set the COMMISSION TESTS > Contact Test to Apply Test.
2. Reset the output relay by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Contact Test to Remove Test.
3. Check with the engineer at the remote end that the Aided Channel 1 signal did change state as expected.
The Test Port Status cell should have responded as in the table below
DDB No. 507 493
Monitor Bit 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Contact Test OFF X X X X X X X 0
Contact Test Applied (ON) X X X X X X X 1
Test OFF X X X X X X X 0
X = Don't Care
Now return the IED to service by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Test Mode to Disabled.

18.1.3 CHANNEL CHECK IN THE OPPOSITE DIRECTION


Repeat the aided scheme 1 test procedure, but this time to check that the channel responds correctly when keyed
from the remote end. The remote end commissioning engineer should perform the contact test, with the Monitor
Option observed at the local end.

18.2 AIDED SCHEME 2


1. If applicable, repeat the test for Aided Channel 2.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 655
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

2. Return the device to service by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Test Mode to Disabled.

656 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

19 ONLOAD CHECKS

Warning:
Onload checks are potentially very dangerous and may only be carried out by
qualified and authorised personnel.

Onload checks can only be carried out if there are no restrictions preventing the energisation of the plant, and the
other devices in the group have already been commissioned.
Remove all test leads and temporary shorting links, then replace any external wiring that has been removed to
allow testing.

Warning:
If any external wiring has been disconnected for the commissioning process, replace
it in accordance with the relevant external connection or scheme diagram.

19.1 CONFIRM CURRENT CONNECTIONS


1. Measure the current transformer secondary values for each input either by:
a. reading from the device's HMI panel (providing it has first been verified by a secondary injection test)
b. using a current clamp meter
2. Check that the current transformer polarities are correct by measuring the phase angle between the
current and voltage, either against a phase meter already installed on site and known to be correct or by
determining the direction of power flow by contacting the system control centre.
3. Ensure the current flowing in the neutral circuit of the current transformers is negligible.
If the Local Values cell is set to Secondary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary
voltage. The values should be within 1% of the applied secondary voltages. However, an additional allowance must
be made for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.
If the Local Values cell is set to Primary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary voltage
multiplied the corresponding voltage transformer ratio set in the CT & VT RATIOS column. The values should be
within 1% of the expected values, plus an additional allowance for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.

19.2 CONFIRM VOLTAGE CONNECTIONS


1. Using a multimeter, measure the voltage transformer secondary voltages to ensure they are correctly rated.
2. Check that the system phase rotation is correct using a phase rotation meter.
3. Compare the values of the secondary phase voltages with the measured voltage magnitude values, which
can be found in the MEASUREMENTS 1 menu column.

Cell in MEASUREMENTS 1 Column Corresponding VT ratio in CT/VT RATIOS column


VAB MAGNITUDE
VBC MAGNITUDE
VCA MAGNITUDE
Main VT Primary / Main VT Sec'y
VAN MAGNITUDE
VBN MAGNITUDE
VCN MAGNITUDE
C/S Voltage Mag CS VT Primary / CS VT Secondary

P446SV-TM-EN-1 657
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

If the Local Values cell is set to Secondary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary
voltage. The values should be within 1% of the applied secondary voltages. However, an additional allowance must
be made for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.
If the Local Values cell is set to Primary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary voltage
multiplied the corresponding voltage transformer ratio set in the CT & VT RATIOS column. The values should be
within 1% of the expected values, plus an additional allowance for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.

19.3 ON-LOAD DIRECTIONAL TEST


This test ensures that directional overcurrent and fault locator functions have the correct forward/reverse
response to fault and load conditions. For this test you must first know the actual direction of power flow on the
system. If you do not already know this you must determine it using adjacent instrumentation or protection
already in-service.
● For load current flowing in the Forward direction (power export to the remote line end), the A Phase Watts
cell in the MEASUREMENTS 2 column should show positive power signing.
● For load current flowing in the Reverse direction (power import from the remote line end), the A Phase
Watts cell in the MEASUREMENTS 2 column should show negative power signing.

Note:
This check applies only for Measurement Modes 0 (default), and 2. This should be checked in the MEASURE’T SETUP column
(Measurement Mode = 0 or 2). If measurement modes 1 or 3 are used, the expected power flow signing would be opposite to
that shown above.

In the event of any uncertainty, check the phase angle of the phase currents with respect to their phase voltage.

658 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

20 FINAL CHECKS
1. Remove all test leads and temporary shorting leads.
2. If you have had to disconnect any of the external wiring in order to perform the wiring verification tests,
replace all wiring, fuses and links in accordance with the relevant external connection or scheme diagram.
3. The settings applied should be carefully checked against the required application-specific settings to ensure
that they are correct, and have not been mistakenly altered during testing.
4. Ensure that all protection elements required have been set to Enabled in the CONFIGURATION column.
5. Ensure that the IED has been restored to service by checking that the Test Mode cell in the COMMISSION
TESTS column is set to Disabled.
6. If the IED is in a new installation or the circuit breaker has just been maintained, the circuit breaker
maintenance and current counters should be zero. These counters can be reset using the Reset All Values
cell. If the required access level is not active, the device will prompt for a password to be entered so that the
setting change can be made.
7. If the menu language has been changed to allow accurate testing it should be restored to the customer’s
preferred language.
8. If a P991/MMLG test block is installed, remove the P992/MMLB test plug and replace the cover so that the
protection is put into service.
9. Ensure that all event records, fault records, disturbance records, alarms and LEDs and communications
statistics have been reset.

Note:
Remember to restore the language setting to the customer’s preferred language on completion.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 659
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

21 COMMMISSIONING THE P59X


If you are setting up a scheme, which involves a P59x device, you will need to commission the P59x too. The
following instructions describe the commissioning procedure for a P59x.

21.1 VISUAL INSPECTION

Warning:
Check the rating information under the top access cover on the front of the IED.

Warning:
Check that the IED being tested is correct for the line or circuit.

Warning:
Record the circuit reference and system details.

Warning:
Check the CT secondary current rating and record the CT tap which is in use.

Carefully examine the IED to see that no physical damage has occurred since installation.
Ensure that the case earthing connections (bottom left-hand corner at the rear of the IED case) are used to
connect the IED to a local earth bar using an adequate conductor.

21.2 INSULATION
Insulation resistance tests are only necessary during commissioning if explicitly requested.
Isolate all wiring from the earth and test the insulation with an electronic or brushless insulation tester at a DC
voltage not exceeding 500 V. Terminals of the same circuits should be temporarily connected together.
The insulation resistance should be greater than 100 MW at 500 V.
On completion of the insulation resistance tests, ensure all external wiring is correctly reconnected to the IED.

Note:
The V.35 circuits and the X.21 circuits of the P592 and P593 respectively are isolated from all other circuits but are electrically
connected to the outer case. The circuits must therefore not be insulation or impulse tested to the case.

21.3 EXTERNAL WIRING

Caution:
Check that the external wiring is correct according to the relevant IED and scheme
diagrams. Ensure that phasing/phase rotation appears to be as expected.

21.4 P59X AUXILIARY SUPPLY


P591 devices operate from a DC auxiliary supply within the range of 19 V to 65 V for a 24 - 48 V version and 87.5 V
to 300 V for a 110 - 250 V version.

660 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions

P592 and P593 units operate from a DC auxiliary supply within the range of 19 V to 300 V.
Without energizing the device, measure the auxiliary supply to ensure it is within the operating range.
The devices are designed to withstand an AC ripple component of up to 12% of the normal DC auxiliary supply.
However, in all cases the peak value of the DC supply must not exceed the maximum specified operating limit.

Warning:
Do not energise the device or interface unit using the battery charger with the
battery disconnected as this can irreparably damage the power supply circuitry.

21.5 P59X LEDS


On power up the green ‘SUPPLY HEALTHY’ LED should be permanently illuminated, indicating that the device is
healthy.

P592 only
The four red LEDs can be tested by appropriate setting of the DIL switches on the front plate. Set the data rate
switch according to the communication channel bandwidth available. Set all other switches to 0. To illuminate the
‘DSR OFF’ and ‘CTS OFF’ LED’s, disconnect the V.35 connector from the rear of the P592 and set the ‘DSR’ and ‘CTS’
switches to ‘0’. The ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ and ‘V.35 LOOPBACK’ LEDs can be illuminated by setting their corresponding
switches to ‘1’.
Once operation of the LEDs has been established set all DIL switches, except for the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch, to ‘0’
and reconnect the V.35 connector.

P593 only
Set the ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’. The green ‘CLOCK’ and red ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ LED’s should illuminate. Reset
the ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to the ‘OFF’ position.
Set the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’. The red ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ LED should illuminate. Do not reset the “OPTO
LOOPBACK’ switch as it is required in this position for the next test.

21.6 RECEIVED OPTICAL SIGNAL LEVEL


1. With an optical cable connected to the P54x optical transmitter, disconnect the other end of the cable from
the P59x receiver (Rx) and use an optical power meter to measure the received signal strength. The value
should be in the range -16.8 dBm to -25.4 dBm.
2. Record the measured value and replace the connector to the P59x receiver.

Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.

21.7 OPTICAL TRANSMITTER LEVEL


1. Using an appropriate fibre-optic cable, connect the optical transmitter (Tx) to an optical power meter.
2. Check that the average power transmitted is within the range -16.8 dBm to -22.8 dBm.
3. Record the transmit power level.
4. Connect the appropriate optical fibre to connect the P591 transmitter to the IED's optical receiver
5. Return to the IED

P446SV-TM-EN-1 661
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV

21.8 LOOPBACK TEST

P591
It is necessary to loop the transmitted electrical G.703 signal presented on terminals 3 and 4 of the P591 to the
received signal presented on terminals 7 and 8.
If test links have been designed into the scheme to facilitate this they should be used. Alternatively, remove any
external wiring from terminals 3, 4, 7 and 8 at the rear of each P591 unit. Loopback the G.703 signals on each
device by connecting a wire link between terminals 3 and 7, and a second wire between terminals 4 and 8.

P592
With the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch in the ‘1’ position, the receive and transmit optical ports are connected together.
This allows the optical fibre communications between the IED and the P592 to be tested, but not the internal
circuitry of the P592 itself.

P593
Set the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘OFF’ and ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’ respectively. With the ‘X.21
LOOPBACK’ switch in this position the ‘Receive Data’ and ‘Transmit Data’ lines of the X.21 communication interface
are connected together. This allows the optical fibre communications between the IED and the P593, and the
internal circuitry of the P593 itself to be tested.

662 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 25

MAINTENANCE AND TROUBLESHOOTING


Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

664 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The Maintenance and Troubleshooting chapter provides details of how to maintain and troubleshoot products
based on the Px4x and P40Agile platforms. Always follow the warning signs in this chapter. Failure to do so may
result injury or defective equipment.

Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM and the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.

The troubleshooting part of the chapter allows an error condition on the IED to be identified so that appropriate
corrective action can be taken.
If the device develops a fault, it is usually possible to identify which module needs replacing. It is not possible to
perform an on-site repair to a faulty module.
If you return a faulty unit or module to the manufacturer or one of their approved service centres, you should
include a completed copy of the Repair or Modification Return Authorization (RMA) form.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 665
Maintenance 666
Troubleshooting 674

P446SV-TM-EN-1 665
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

2 MAINTENANCE

2.1 MAINTENANCE CHECKS


In view of the critical nature of the application, General Electric products should be checked at regular intervals to
confirm they are operating correctly. General Electric products are designed for a life in excess of 20 years.
The devices are self-supervising and so require less maintenance than earlier designs of protection devices. Most
problems will result in an alarm, indicating that remedial action should be taken. However, some periodic tests
should be carried out to ensure that they are functioning correctly and that the external wiring is intact. It is the
responsibility of the customer to define the interval between maintenance periods. If your organisation has a
Preventative Maintenance Policy, the recommended product checks should be included in the regular program.
Maintenance periods depend on many factors, such as:
● The operating environment
● The accessibility of the site
● The amount of available manpower
● The importance of the installation in the power system
● The consequences of failure

Although some functionality checks can be performed from a remote location, these are predominantly restricted
to checking that the unit is measuring the applied currents and voltages accurately, and checking the circuit
breaker maintenance counters. For this reason, maintenance checks should also be performed locally at the
substation.

Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM and the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.

2.1.1 ALARMS
First check the alarm status LED to see if any alarm conditions exist. If so, press the Read key repeatedly to step
through the alarms.
After dealing with any problems, clear the alarms. This will clear the relevant LEDs.

2.1.2 OPTO-ISOLATORS
Check the opto-inputs by repeating the commissioning test detailed in the Commissioning chapter.

2.1.3 OUTPUT RELAYS


Check the output relays by repeating the commissioning test detailed in the Commissioning chapter.

2.1.4 MEASUREMENT ACCURACY


If the power system is energised, the measured values can be compared with known system values to check that
they are in the expected range. If they are within a set range, this indicates that the A/D conversion and the
calculations are being performed correctly. Suitable test methods can be found in Commissioning chapter.
Alternatively, the measured values can be checked against known values injected into the device using the test
block, (if fitted) or injected directly into the device's terminals. Suitable test methods can be found in the
Commissioning chapter. These tests will prove the calibration accuracy is being maintained.

666 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

2.2 REPLACING THE DEVICE


If your product should develop a fault while in service, depending on the nature of the fault, the watchdog
contacts will change state and an alarm condition will be flagged. In the case of a fault, you can replace either the
complete device or just the faulty PCB, identified by the in-built diagnostic software.
If possible you should replace the complete device, as this reduces the chance of damage due to electrostatic
discharge and also eliminates the risk of fitting an incompatible replacement PCB. However, we understand it may
be difficult to remove an installed product and you may be forced to replace the faulty PCB on-site. The case and
rear terminal blocks are designed to allow removal of the complete device, without disconnecting the scheme
wiring.

Caution:
Replacing PCBs requires the correct on-site environment (clean and dry) as well as
suitably trained personnel.

Caution:
If the repair is not performed by an approved service centre, the warranty will be
invalidated.

Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment, you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM,
as well as the ratings on the equipment’s rating label. This should ensure that no
damage is caused by incorrect handling of the electronic components.

Warning:
Before working at the rear of the device, isolate all voltage and current supplying it.

Note:
The current transformer inputs are equipped with integral shorting switches which will close for safety reasons, when the
terminal block is removed.

To replace the complete device:


1. Carefully disconnect the cables not connected to the terminal blocks (e.g. IRIG-B, fibre optic cables, earth),
as appropriate, from the rear of the device.
2. Remove the terminal block screws using a magnetic screwdriver to minimise the risk of losing the screws or
leaving them in the terminal block.
3. Without exerting excessive force or damaging the scheme wiring, pull the terminal blocks away from their
internal connectors.
4. Remove the terminal block screws that fasten the device to the panel and rack. These are the screws with
the larger diameter heads that are accessible when the access covers are fitted and open.
5. Withdraw the device from the panel and rack. Take care, as the device will be heavy due to the internal
transformers.
6. To reinstall the device, follow the above instructions in reverse, ensuring that each terminal block is
relocated in the correct position and the chassis ground, IRIG-B and fibre optic connections are replaced.
The terminal blocks are labelled alphabetically with ‘A’ on the left hand side when viewed from the rear.
Once the device has been reinstalled, it should be re-commissioned as set out in the Commissioning chapter.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 667
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

Caution:
If the top and bottom access covers have been removed, some more screws with
smaller diameter heads are made accessible. Do NOT remove these screws, as they
secure the front panel to the device.

Note:
There are four possible types of terminal block: RTD/CLIO input, heavy duty, medium duty, and MiDOS. The terminal blocks are
fastened to the rear panel with slotted or cross-head screws depending on the type of terminal block. Not all terminal block
types are present on all products.

Figure 302: Possible terminal block types

2.3 REPAIRING THE DEVICE


If your product should develop a fault while in service, depending on the nature of the fault, the watchdog
contacts will change state and an alarm condition will be flagged. In the case of a fault, either the complete unit or
just the faulty PCB, identified by the in-built diagnostic software, should be replaced.
Replacement of printed circuit boards and other internal components must be undertaken by approved Service
Centres. Failure to obtain the authorization of after-sales engineers prior to commencing work may invalidate the
product warranty.
We recommend that you entrust any repairs to Automation Support teams, which are available world-wide.

2.4 REMOVING THE FRONT PANEL

Warning:
Before removing the front panel to replace a PCB, you must first remove the auxiliary
power supply and wait 5 seconds for the internal capacitors to discharge. You should
also isolate voltage and current transformer connections and trip circuit.

668 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

Caution:
Before removing the front panel, you should be familiar with the contents of the Safety
Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM, as well as the ratings
on the equipment’s rating label.

To remove the front panel:


1. Open the top and bottom access covers. You must open the hinged access covers by more than 90° before
they can be removed.
2. If fitted, remove the transparent secondary front cover.
3. Apply outward pressure to the middle of the access covers to bow them and disengage the hinge lug, so the
access cover can be removed. The screws that fasten the front panel to the case are now accessible.
4. Undo and remove the screws. The 40TE case has four cross-head screws fastening the front panel to the
case, one in each corner, in recessed holes. The 60TE/80TE cases have an additional two screws, one
midway along each of the top and bottom edges of the front plate.
5. When the screws have been removed, pull the complete front panel forward to separate it from the metal
case. The front panel is connected to the rest of the circuitry by a 64-way ribbon cable.
6. The ribbon cable is fastened to the front panel using an IDC connector; a socket on the cable and a plug
with locking latches on the front panel. Gently push the two locking latches outwards which eject the
connector socket slightly. Remove the socket from the plug to disconnect the front panel.

Caution:
Do not remove the screws with the larger diameter heads which are accessible when
the access covers are fitted and open. These screws hold the relay in its mounting
(panel or cubicle).

Caution:
The internal circuitry is now exposed and is not protected against electrostatic
discharge and dust ingress. Therefore ESD precautions and clean working conditions
must be maintained at all times.

2.5 REPLACING PCBS


1. To replace any of the PCBs, first remove the front panel.
2. Once the front panel has been removed, the PCBs are accessible. The numbers above the case outline
identify the guide slot reference for each printed circuit board. Each printed circuit board has a label stating
the corresponding guide slot number to ensure correct relocation after removal. To serve as a reminder of
the slot numbering there is a label on the rear of the front panel metallic screen.
3. Remove the 64-way ribbon cable from the PCB that needs replacing
4. Remove the PCB in accordance with the board-specific instructions detailed later in this section.

Note:
To ensure compatibility, always replace a faulty PCB with one of an identical part number.

2.5.1 REPLACING THE MAIN PROCESSOR BOARD


The main processor board is situated in the front panel. This board contains application-specific settings in its non-
volatile memory. You may wish to take a backup copy of these settings. This could save time in the re-
commissioning process.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 669
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

To replace the main processor board:


1. Remove front panel.
2. Place the front panel with the user interface face down and remove the six screws from the metallic screen,
as shown in the figure below. Remove the metal plate.
3. Remove the two screws either side of the rear of the battery compartment recess. These are the screws
that hold the main processor board in position.
4. Carefully disconnect the ribbon cable. Take care as this could easily be damaged by excessive twisting.
5. Replace the main processor board
6. Reassemble the front panel using the reverse procedure. Make sure the ribbon cable is reconnected to the
main processor board and that all eight screws are refitted.
7. Refit the front panel.
8. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
9. Once the unit has been reassembled, carry out the standard commissioning procedure as defined in the
Commissioning chapter.

Note:
After replacing the main processor board, all the settings required for the application need to be re-entered. This may be done
either manually or by downloading a settings file.

V01601

Figure 303: Front panel assembly

2.5.2 REPLACEMENT OF COMMUNICATIONS BOARDS


Most products will have at least one communications board of some sort fitted. There are several different boards
available offering various functionality, depending on the application. Some products may even be fitted two
boards of different types.
To replace a faulty communications board:
1. Remove front panel.
2. Disconnect all connections at the rear.
3. The board is secured in the relay case by two screws, one at the top and another at the bottom. Remove
these screws carefully as they are not captive in the rear panel.
4. Gently pull the communications board forward and out of the case.
5. Before fitting the replacement PCB check that the number on the round label next to the front edge of the
PCB matches the slot number into which it will be fitted. If the slot number is missing or incorrect, write the
correct slot number on the label.

670 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

6. Fit the replacement PCB carefully into the correct slot. Make sure it is pushed fully back and that the
securing screws are refitted.
7. Reconnect all connections at the rear.
8. Refit the front panel.
9. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
10. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.

2.5.3 REPLACEMENT OF THE INPUT MODULE


Depending on the product, the input module consists of two or three boards fastened together and is contained
within a metal housing. One board contains the transformers and one contains the analogue to digital conversion
and processing electronics. Some devices have an additional auxiliary transformer contained on a third board.
To replace an input module:
1. Remove front panel.
2. The module is secured in the case by two screws on its right-hand side, accessible from the front, as shown
below. Move these screws carefully as they are not captive in the front plate of the module.
3. On the right-hand side of the module there is a small metal tab which brings out a handle (on some
modules there is also a tab on the left). Grasp the handle(s) and pull the module firmly forward, away from
the rear terminal blocks. A reasonable amount of force is needed due to the friction between the contacts of
the terminal blocks.
4. Remove the module from the case. The module may be heavy, because it contains the input voltage and
current transformers.
5. Slot in the replacement module and push it fully back onto the rear terminal blocks. To check that the
module is fully inserted, make sure the v-shaped cut-out in the bottom plate of the case is fully visible.
6. Refit the securing screws.
7. Refit the front panel.
8. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
9. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.

Caution:
With non-mounted IEDs, the case needs to be held firmly while the module is
withdrawn. Withdraw the input module with care as it suddenly comes loose once the
friction of the terminal blocks is overcome.

Note:
If individual boards within the input module are replaced, recalibration will be necessary. We therefore recommend
replacement of the complete module to avoid on-site recalibration.

2.5.4 REPLACEMENT OF THE POWER SUPPLY BOARD

Caution:
Before removing the front panel, you should be familiar with the contents of the Safety
Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM, as well as the ratings
on the equipment’s rating label.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 671
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

The power supply board is fastened to an output relay board with push fit nylon pillars. This doubled-up board is
secured on the extreme left hand side, looking from the front of the unit.
1. Remove front panel.
2. Pull the power supply module forward, away from the rear terminal blocks and out of the case. A
reasonable amount of force is needed due to the friction between the contacts of the terminal blocks.
3. Separate the boards by pulling them apart carefully. The power supply board is the one with two large
electrolytic capacitors.
4. Before reassembling the module, check that the number on the round label next to the front edge of the
PCB matches the slot number into which it will be fitted. If the slot number is missing or incorrect, write the
correct slot number on the label
5. Reassemble the module with a replacement PCB. Push the inter-board connectors firmly together. Fit the
four push fit nylon pillars securely in their respective holes in each PCB.
6. Slot the power supply module back into the housing. Push it fully back onto the rear terminal blocks.
7. Refit the front panel.
8. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
9. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.

2.5.5 REPLACEMENT OF THE I/O BOARDS


There are several different types of I/O boards, which can be used, depending on the product and application.
Some boards have opto-inputs, some have relay outputs and others have a mixture of both.
1. Remove front panel.
2. Gently pull the board forward and out of the case
3. If replacing the I/O board, make sure the setting of the link above IDC connector on the replacement board
is the same as the one being replaced.
4. Before fitting the replacement board check the number on the round label next to the front edge of the
board matches the slot number into which it will be fitted. If the slot number is missing or incorrect, write
the correct slot number on the label.
5. Carefully slide the replacement board into the appropriate slot, ensuring that it is pushed fully back onto the
rear terminal blocks.
6. Refit the front panel.
7. Refit and close the access covers then press at the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the
front panel moulding.
8. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.

2.6 RECALIBRATION
Recalibration is not needed when a PCB is replaced, unless it is one of the boards in the input module. If any of the
boards in the input module is replaced, the unit must be recalibrated.
Although recalibration is needed when a board inside the input module is replaced, it is not needed if the input
module is replaced in its entirety.
Although it is possible to carry out recalibration on site, this requires special test equipment and software. We
therefore recommend that the work be carried out by the manufacturer, or entrusted to an approved service
centre.

2.7 CHANGING THE BATTERY


Each IED has a battery to maintain status data and the correct time when the auxiliary supply voltage fails. The
data maintained includes event, fault and disturbance records and the thermal state at the time of failure.

672 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

As part of the product's continuous self-monitoring, an alarm is given if the battery condition becomes poor.
Nevertheless, you should change the battery periodically to ensure reliability.
To replace the battery:
1. Open the bottom access cover on the front of the relay.
2. Gently remove the battery. If necessary, use a small insulated screwdriver.
3. Make sure the metal terminals in the battery socket are free from corrosion, grease and dust.
4. Remove the replacement battery from its packaging and insert it in the battery holder, ensuring correct
polarity.
5. Ensure that the battery is held securely in its socket and that the battery terminals make good contact with
the socket terminals.
6. Close the bottom access cover.

Caution:
Only use a type ½AA Lithium battery with a nominal voltage of 3.6 V and safety
approvals such as UL (Underwriters Laboratory), CSA (Canadian Standards Association)
or VDE (Vereinigung Deutscher Elektrizitätswerke).

Note:
Events, disturbance and maintenance records will be lost if the battery is replaced whilst the IED is de-energised.

2.7.1 POST MODIFICATION TESTS


To ensure that the replacement battery maintains the time and status data if the auxiliary supply fails, scroll across
to the DATE AND TIME cell, then scroll down to Battery Status which should read Healthy.

2.7.2 BATTERY DISPOSAL


Dispose of the removed battery according to the disposal procedure for Lithium batteries in the country in which
the relay is installed.

2.8 CLEANING

Warning:
Before cleaning the device, ensure that all AC and DC supplies and transformer
connections are isolated, to prevent any chance of an electric shock while cleaning.

Only clean the equipment with a lint-free cloth dampened with clean water. Do not use detergents, solvents or
abrasive cleaners as they may damage the product's surfaces and leave a conductive residue.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 673
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

3 TROUBLESHOOTING

3.1 SELF-DIAGNOSTIC SOFTWARE


The device includes several self-monitoring functions to check the operation of its hardware and software while in
service. If there is a problem with the hardware or software, it should be able to detect and report the problem, and
attempt to resolve the problem by performing a reboot. In this case, the device would be out of service for a short
time, during which the ‘Healthy’ LED on the front of the device is switched OFF and the watchdog contact at the
rear is ON. If the restart fails to resolve the problem, the unit takes itself permanently out of service; the ‘Healthy’
LED stays OFF and watchdog contact stays ON.
If a problem is detected by the self-monitoring functions, the device attempts to store a maintenance record to
allow the nature of the problem to be communicated to the user.
The self-monitoring is implemented in two stages: firstly a thorough diagnostic check which is performed on boot-
up, and secondly a continuous self-checking operation, which checks the operation of the critical functions whilst
it is in service.

3.2 POWER-UP ERRORS


If the IED does not appear to power up, use the following to determine whether the fault is in the external wiring,
auxiliary fuse, IED power supply module or IED front panel.
Test Check Action
Measure the auxiliary voltage on terminals 1 and 2.
Verify the voltage level and polarity against the rating If the auxiliary voltage is correct, go to test 2. Otherwise check the wiring
1
label on the front. and fuses in the auxiliary supply.
Terminal 1 is –dc, 2 is +dc
If the LEDs and LCD backlight switch on, or the contact closes and no error
Check the LEDs and LCD backlight switch on at code is displayed, the error is probably on the main processor board in the
2 power-up. Also check the N/O (normally open) front panel.
watchdog contact for closing. If the LEDs and LCD backlight do not switch on and the contact does not
close, go to test 3.
If there is no field voltage, the fault is probably in the IED power supply
3 Check the output (nominally 48 V DC)
module.

3.3 ERROR MESSAGE OR CODE ON POWER-UP


The IED performs a self-test during power-up. If it detects an error, a message appears on the LCD and the power-
up sequence stops. If the error occurs when the IED application software is running, a maintenance record is
created and the device reboots.
Test Check Action
If the IED locks up and displays an error code permanently, go to test 2.
Is an error message or code permanently displayed
1 If the IED prompts for user input, go to test 4.
during power up?
If the IED reboots automatically, go to test 5.
Record whether the same error code is displayed when the IED is
Record displayed error, and then remove and re-apply rebooted. If no error code is displayed, contact the local service centre
2
IED auxiliary supply. stating the error code and IED information. If the same code is
displayed, go to test 3.

674 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

Test Check Action


Error Code Identification
The following text messages (in English) are displayed if a
These messages indicate that a problem has been detected on the IED’s
fundamental problem is detected, preventing the system
main processor board in the front panel.
from booting:
Bus Fail – address lines
3 SRAM Fail – data lines
FLASH Fail format error
FLASH Fail checksum
Code Verify Fail
The following hex error codes relate to errors detected in
specific IED modules:
3.1 0c140005/0c0d0000 Input Module (including opto-isolated inputs)
3.2 0c140006/0c0e0000 Output IED Cards
Other error codes relate to hardware or software problems on the main
3.3 The last four digits provide details on the actual error.
processor board. Contact with details of the problem for a full analysis.
The IED displays a message for corrupt settings and The power-up tests have detected corrupted IED settings. Restore the
4 prompts for the default values to be restored for the default settings to allow the power-up to complete, and then reapply
affected settings. the application-specific settings.
Error 0x0E080000, programmable scheme logic error due to excessive
execution time. Restore the default settings by powering up with both
horizontal cursor keys pressed, then confirm restoration of defaults at
The IED resets when the power-up is complete. A record
5 the prompt using the Enter key. If the IED powers up successfully, check
error code is displayed
the programmable logic for feedback paths.
Other error codes relate to software errors on the main processor
board.

3.4 OUT OF SERVICE LED ON AT POWER-UP

Test Check Action


Using the IED menu, confirm the Commission Test or Test If the setting is Enabled, disable the test mode and make sure the Out of
1
Mode setting is Enabled. If it is not Enabled, go to test 2. Service LED is OFF.
Check for the H/W Verify Fail maintenance record. This indicates a
discrepancy between the IED model number and the hardware. Examine
Select the VIEW RECORDS column then view the last
2 the Maint Data; cell. This indicates the causes of the failure using bit
maintenance record from the menu.
fields:
Bit Meaning
The application type field in the model number does not
0
match the software ID
The application field in the model number does not match
1
the software ID
The variant 1 field in the model number does not match the
2
software ID
The variant 2 field in the model number does not match the
3
software ID
The protocol field in the model number does not match the
4
software ID
The language field in the model number does not match the
5
software ID
The VT type field in the model number is incorrect (110 V VTs
6
fitted)
The VT type field in the model number is incorrect (440 V VTs
7
fitted)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 675
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

Test Check Action


The VT type field in the model number is incorrect (no VTs
8
fitted)

3.5 ERROR CODE DURING OPERATION


The IED performs continuous self-checking. If the IED detects an error it displays an error message, logs a
maintenance record and after a short delay resets itself. A permanent problem (for example due to a hardware
fault) is usually detected in the power-up sequence. In this case the IED displays an error code and halts. If the
problem was transient, the IED reboots correctly and continues operation. By examining the maintenance record
logged, the nature of the detected fault can be determined.

3.5.1 BACKUP BATTERY


If the IED’s self-check detects a failure of the lithium battery, the IED displays an alarm message and logs a
maintenance record but the IED does not reset.
To prevent the IED from issuing an alarm when there is a battery failure, select DATE AND TIME then Battery Alarm
then Disabled. The IED can then be used without a battery and no battery alarm message appears.

3.6 MAL-OPERATION DURING TESTING

3.6.1 FAILURE OF OUTPUT CONTACTS


An apparent failure of the relay output contacts can be caused by the configuration. Perform the following tests to
identify the real cause of the failure. The self-tests verify that the coils of the output relay contacts have been
energized. An error is displayed if there is a fault in the output relay board.
Test Check Action
If this LED is ON, the relay may be in test mode or the protection has
1 Is the Out of Service LED ON?
been disabled due to a hardware verify error.
Examine the Contact status in the Commissioning If the relevant bits of the contact status are operated, go to test 4; if not,
2
section of the menu. go to test 3.
If the protection element does not operate, check the test is correctly
Examine the fault record or use the test port to check the applied.
3
protection element is operating correctly. If the protection element operates, check the programmable logic to
make sure the protection element is correctly mapped to the contacts.
Using the Commissioning or Test mode function, apply a If the output relay operates, the problem must be in the external wiring
test pattern to the relevant relay output contacts. to the relay. If the output relay does not operate the output relay
4 Consult the correct external connection diagram and use contacts may have failed (the self-tests verify that the relay coil is being
a continuity tester at the rear of the relay to check the energized). Ensure the closed resistance is not too high for the continuity
relay output contacts operate. tester to detect.

3.6.2 FAILURE OF OPTO-INPUTS


The opto-isolated inputs are mapped onto the IED's internal DDB signals using the programmable scheme logic. If
an input is not recognised by the scheme logic, use the Opto I/P Status cell in the COMMISSION TESTS column to
check whether the problem is in the opto-input itself, or the mapping of its signal to the scheme logic functions.
If the device does not correctly read the opto-input state, test the applied signal. Verify the connections to the
opto-input using the wiring diagram and the nominal voltage settings in the OPTO CONFIG column. To do this:
1. Select the nominal voltage for all opto-inputs by selecting one of the five standard ratings in the Global
Nominal V cell.
2. Select Custom to set each opto-input individually to a nominal voltage.
3. Using a voltmeter, check that the voltage on its input terminals is greater than the minimum pick-up level
(See the Technical Specifications chapter for opto pick-up levels).

676 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

If the signal is correctly applied, this indicates failure of an opto-input, which may be situated on standalone opto-
input board, or on an opto-input board that is part of the input module. Separate opto-input boards can simply be
replaced. If, however, the faulty opto-input board is part of the input module, the complete input module should be
replaced. This is because the analogue input module cannot be individually replaced without dismantling the
module and recalibration of the IED.

3.6.3 INCORRECT ANALOGUE SIGNALS


If the measured analogue quantities do not seem correct, use the measurement function to determine the type of
problem. The measurements can be configured in primary or secondary terms.
1. Compare the displayed measured values with the actual magnitudes at the terminals.
2. Check the correct terminals are used.
3. Check the CT and VT ratios set are correct.
4. Check the phase displacement to confirm the inputs are correctly connected.

3.7 COPROCESSOR BOARD FAILURES


If a coprocessor board is used, this may cause the IED to report one or more of the following alarms:
● Signalling failure alarm (on its own)
● C diff failure (on its own)
● Signalling failure and C diff failure together
● Incompatible IED
● Comms changed
● IEEE C37.94 fail

3.7.1 SIGNALLING FAILURE ALARM (ON ITS OWN)


This indicates that there is a problem with one of the fibre-optic signalling channels. This alarm can occur in dual
redundant or three terminal schemes. The fibre may have been disconnected, the device may have been
incorrectly configured at one of the ends, or there is a problem with the communications equipment. Further
information about the status of the signalling channels can be found in MEASUREMENTS 4 column.

3.7.2 C DIFF FAILURE ALARM (ON ITS OWN)


This indicates there is a problem with the Coprocessor board. As a result the current differential/distance
protection is not available and backup protection will operate, if configured to do so. Further information can be
found in the maintenance records.

3.7.3 SIGNALLING FAILURE AND C DIFF FAILURE ALARMS TOGETHER


This indicates that there is a problem with one or both fibre-optic signalling channels. The fibre may have been
disconnected, the device may have been incorrectly configured at one of the ends, or there is a problem with the
communications equipment. As a result the current differential protection is not available and backup protection
will operate, if configured to do so. Further information about the status of the signalling channels can be found in
MEASUREMENTS 4 column.

3.7.4 INCOMPATIBLE IED


This occurs if the IEDs trying to communicate with each other are of incompatible types.

3.7.5 COMMS CHANGED


This indicates that the Comms Mode setting has been changed without a subsequent power off and on.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 677
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

3.7.6 IEEE C37.94 FAIL


This indicates a Signal Lost, a Path Yellow (indicating a fault on the communications channel) or a mismatch in the
number of N*64 channels used on either channel 1 or channel 2. Further information can be found in the
MEASUREMENTS 4 column.

3.8 PSL EDITOR TROUBLESHOOTING


A failure to open a connection could be due to one or more of the following:
● The IED address is not valid (this address is always 1 for the front port)
● Password in not valid
● Communication set-up (COM port, Baud rate, or Framing) is not correct
● Transaction values are not suitable for the IED or the type of connection
● The connection cable is not wired correctly or broken
● The option switches on any protocol converter used may be incorrectly set

3.8.1 DIAGRAM RECONSTRUCTION


Although a scheme can be extracted from an IED, a facility is provided to recover a scheme if the original file is
unobtainable.
A recovered scheme is logically correct but much of the original graphical information is lost. Many signals are
drawn in a vertical line down the left side of the canvas. Links are drawn orthogonally using the shortest path from
A to B. Any annotation added to the original diagram such as titles and notes are lost.
Sometimes a gate type does not appear as expected. For example, a single-input AND gate in the original scheme
appears as an OR gate when uploaded. Programmable gates with an inputs-to-trigger value of 1 also appear as
OR gates

3.8.2 PSL VERSION CHECK


The PSL is saved with a version reference, time stamp and CRC check (Cyclic Redundancy Check). This gives a
visual check whether the default PSL is in place or whether a new application has been downloaded.

3.9 REPAIR AND MODIFICATION PROCEDURE


Please follow these steps to return an Automation product to us:
1. Get the Repair and Modification Return Authorization (RMA) form
An electronic version of the RMA form is available from the following web page:
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact
2. Fill in the RMA form
Fill in only the white part of the form.
Please ensure that all fields marked (M) are completed such as:
○ Equipment model
○ Model No. and Serial No.
○ Description of failure or modification required (please be specific)
○ Value for customs (in case the product requires export)
○ Delivery and invoice addresses
○ Contact details

678 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting

3. Send the RMA form to your local contact


For a list of local service contacts worldwide,visit the following web page:
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact
4. The local service contact provides the shipping information
Your local service contact provides you with all the information needed to ship the product:
○ Pricing details
○ RMA number
○ Repair centre address

If required, an acceptance of the quote must be delivered before going to the next stage.
5. Send the product to the repair centre
○ Address the shipment to the repair centre specified by your local contact
○ Make sure all items are packaged in an anti-static bag and foam protection
○ Make sure a copy of the import invoice is attached with the returned unit
○ Make sure a copy of the RMA form is attached with the returned unit
○ E-mail or fax a copy of the import invoice and airway bill document to your local contact.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 679
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV

680 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 26

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

682 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the technical specifications of the product.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 683
Interfaces 684
Protection Functions 688
Monitoring, Control and Supervision 693
Measurements and Recording 695
Ratings 696
Input / Output Connections 699
Mechanical Specifications 701
Type Tests 702
Environmental Conditions 703
Electromagnetic Compatibility 704
Regulatory Compliance 707

P446SV-TM-EN-1 683
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

2 INTERFACES

2.1 FRONT SERIAL PORT

Front serial port (SK1)


Use For local connection to laptop for configuration purposes
Standard EIA(RS)232
Designation SK1
Connector 9 pin D-type female connector
Isolation Isolation to ELV level
Protocol Courier
Constraints Maximum cable length 15 m

2.2 DOWNLOAD/MONITOR PORT

Front download port (SK2)


Use For firmware downloads or monitor connection
Standard Compatible with IEEE1284-A
Designation SK2
Connector 25 pin D-type female connector
Isolation Isolation to ELV level
Protocol Proprietary
Constraints Maximum cable length 3 m

2.3 REAR SERIAL PORT 1

Rear serial port 1 (RP1)


Use For SCADA communications (multi-drop)
Standard EIA(RS)485, K-bus
Connector General purpose block, M4 screws (2 wire)
Cable Screened twisted pair (STP)
Supported Protocols * Courier, IEC-60870-5-103, DNP3.0, MODBUS
Isolation Isolation to SELV level
Constraints Maximum cable length 1000 m
* Not all models support all protocols - see ordering options

2.4 FIBRE REAR SERIAL PORT 1

Optional fibre rear serial port (RP1)


Main Use Serial SCADA communications over fibre
Connector IEC 874-10 BFOC 2.5 –(ST®) (1 each for Tx and Rx)
Fibre type Multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm
Supported Protocols Courier, IEC870-5-103, DNP 3.0, MODBUS
Wavelength 850 nm

684 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

2.5 REAR SERIAL PORT 2

Optional rear serial port (RP2)


Use For SCADA communications (multi-drop)
Standard EIA(RS)485, K-bus, EIA(RS)232
Designation SK4
Connector 9 pin D-type female connector
Cable Screened twisted pair (STP)
Supported Protocols Courier
Isolation Isolation to SELV level
Constraints Maximum cable length 1000 m for RS485 and K-bus, 15 m for RS232

2.6 OPTIONAL REAR SERIAL PORT (SK5)

Optional rear serial port for teleprotection


Use For teleprotection in distance products
Standard EIA(RS)232
Designation SK5
Connector 9 pin D-type female connector
Cable Screened twisted pair (STP)
Supported Protocols InterMiCOM (IM)
Isolation Isolation to SELV level
Constraints Maximum cable length 15 m

2.7 IRIG-B (DEMODULATED)

IRIG-B Interface (Demodulated)


Use External clock synchronisation signal
Standard IRIG 200-98 format B00X
Connector BNC
Cable type 50 ohm coaxial
Isolation Isolation to SELV level
Constraints Maximum cable length 10 m
Input signal TTL level
Input impedance 10 k ohm at dc
Accuracy < +/- 1 s per day

2.8 IRIG-B (MODULATED)

IRIG-B Interface (Modulated)


Use External clock synchronisation signal
Standard IRIG 200-98 format B12X
Connector BNC
Cable type 50 ohm coaxial

P446SV-TM-EN-1 685
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

IRIG-B Interface (Modulated)


Isolation Isolation to SELV level
Constraints Maximum cable length 10 m
Input signal peak to peak, 200 mV to 20 mV
Input impedance 6 k ohm at 1000 Hz
Accuracy < +/- 1 s per day

2.9 REAR ETHERNET PORT COPPER

Rear Ethernet port using CAT 5/6/7 wiring


Main Use Substation Ethernet communications
Standard IEEE 802.3 10BaseT/100BaseTX
Connector RJ45
Cable type Screened twisted pair (STP)
Isolation 1.5 kV
Supported Protocols IEC 61850, DNP3.0 OE
Constraints Maximum cable length 100 m

2.10 REAR ETHERNET PORT FIBRE

Rear Ethernet port using fibre-optic cabling


Main Use Substation Ethernet communications
Connector IEC 874-10 BFOC 2.5 –(ST®) (1 each for Tx and Rx)
Standard IEEE 802.3 100 BaseFX
Fibre type Multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm
Supported Protocols IEC 61850, DNP3.0
Rapid spanning tree protocol (RSTP)
Self-healing protocol (SHP)
Optional Redundancy Protocols Supported
Dual homing protocol (DHP)
Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
Wavelength 1300 nm

2.10.1 100 BASE FX RECEIVER CHARACTERISTICS

Parameter Sym Min. Typ. Max. Unit


Input Optical Power Minimum at
PIN Min. (W) -33.5 –31 dBm avg.
Window Edge
Input Optical Power Minimum at
PIN Min. (C) -34.5 -31.8 Bm avg.
Eye Center
Input Optical Power Maximum PIN Max. -14 -11.8 dBm avg.
Conditions: TA = 0°C to 70°C

686 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

2.10.2 100 BASE FX TRANSMITTER CHARACTERISTICS

Parameter Sym Min. Typ. Max. Unit


Output Optical Power BOL 62.5/125 µm -19
PO -16.8 -14 dBm avg.
NA = 0.275 Fibre EOL -20
Output Optical Power BOL 50/125 µm -22.5
PO -20.3 -14 dBm avg.
NA = 0.20 Fibre EOL -23.5
10 %
Optical Extinction Ratio
-10 dB
Output Optical Power at Logic "0" State PO -45 dBm avg.
Conditions: TA = 0°C to 70°C

2.11 1 PPS PORT

1 PPS port (fibre)


Main Use GPS accuracy clock reference
Connector BFOC 2.5 –(ST®)
Standard IEC 874-10
Fibre type Multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm
Wavelength 850 nm
Minimum reception level -28 dBm
Better than +/- 50 ns for maximum absolute error between
Accuracy
actual GPS time and rising edge of 1 PPS signal.

2.12 FIBRE TELEPROTECTION INTERFACE

Fibre Teleprotection Interface


Main Use Teleprotection communications
Connectors (2) BFOC 2.5 –(ST®)
Standard IEC 874-10
Protocol InterMicom 64
Fibre type Multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5/125 µm or single-mode 9/125 µm
Wavelength 850 nm or 1300 nm (multimode), 1300 nm or 1500 nm (single mode)
Minimum reception level -28 dBm
Better than +/- 50 ns for maximum absolute error between actual GPS time and
Accuracy
rising edge of 1 PPS signal.

Optical budget
850nm MM 1300 nm MM 1300 nm SM 1550 nm SM
Minimum transmit output level (average power) -19.8 dBm -6 dBm -6 dBm -6 dBm
Receiver sensitivity (average power) -25.4 dBm -49 dBm -49 dBm -49 dBm
Optical budget 5.6 dB 43 dB 43 dB 43 dB
Less safety margin (3 dB) 2.6 dB 40 dB 40 dB 40 dB
Typical cable loss 2.6 dB/km 0.8 dB/km 0.4 dB/km 0.3 dB/km
Maximum transmission distance 1 km 50 km 100 km 130 km

P446SV-TM-EN-1 687
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

3 PROTECTION FUNCTIONS

3.1 DISTANCE PROTECTION

Tripping characteristics

Operating time versus reach percentage, for faults close to line


angle.

50 Hz, SIR = 5

All quoted operating times include closure of the trip output


contact

Operating time versus reach percentage, for faults close to line


angle.

60 Hz, SIR = 5

All quoted operating times include closure of the trip output


contact

Operating time for resistive faults > 20% inside the 50 Hz, up to SIR = 30 < 30 ms
characteristic 60 Hz, up to SIR = 30 < 25 ms

Accuracy
+/- 5% for on-angle fault (on the set line angle)
+/- 10% for off-angle fault
Characteristic shape, up to SIR = 30
Example: For a 70 degree set line angle, injection testing at 40 degrees
would be referred to as "off-angle".
Zone time delay deviations +/- 20 ms or 2%, whichever is greater

3.2 POWER SWING BLOCKING

Accuracy
Accuracy of zones and timers As per Distance

688 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

3.3 OUT OF STEP PROTECTION

Accuracy
Accuracy of zones and timers As per Distance
Operating range Up to 7 Hz

3.4 FIBRE TELEPROTECTION TRANSFER TIMES

The table below shows the minimum and maximum transfer time for InterMiCOM64 (IM64). The times are
measured from opto initialization (with no opto filtering) to relay standard output and include a small propagation
delay for back-back test (2.7 ms for 64 kbits/s and 3.2 ms for 56 kbits/s).
IDiff IM64 indicates InterMiCOM64 signals working in conjunction with the differential protection fibre optic
communications channel. IM64 indicates InterMiCOM64 signals working as a standalone feature.
Configuration Permissive op times (ms) Direct op times (ms)
IM64 at 64 k 13 - 18 17 - 20
IM64 at 56 k 15 - 20 19 - 22
IDiff IM64 at 64 k 22 - 24 23 - 25
IDiff IM64 at 56 k 24 - 26 25 - 27

3.5 AUTORECLOSE AND CHECK SYNYCHRONISM

Accuracy
Timers +/- 20 ms or 2%, whichever is greater

3.6 PHASE OVERCURRENT PROTECTION

Accuracy
IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%
DT pick-up Setting +/-5%
Drop-off (IDMT and DT) 0.98 x setting +/-5%
IDMT operate +/-5% of expected operating time or 40 ms, whichever is greater*
IEEE reset +/-5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
DT operate +/-2% of setting or 40 ms, whichever is greater
DT reset Setting +/-5%
Repeatability <5%
Characteristic UK IEC 60255-3 1998
Characteristic US IEEE C37.112 1996

Note:
*Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 7, I> = 1A, operating range = 2-20In

P446SV-TM-EN-1 689
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

3.6.1 TRANSIENT OVERREACH AND OVERSHOOT

Additional tolerance due to increasing X/R ratios +/-5% over the X/R ratio of 1 to 90
Overshoot of overcurrent elements < 30 ms

3.6.2 PHASE OVERCURRENT DIRECTIONAL PARAMETERS

Accuracy
Directional boundary pickup (RCA +/-90%) +/-2°
Directional boundary hysteresis < 2°
Directional boundary repeatability <2%

3.7 EARTH FAULT PROTECTION

Accuracy
IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%
DT pick-up Setting +/-5%, or 20 mA, whichever is greater
Drop-off (IDMT and DT) 0.95 x setting +/-5%
IDMT Operate +/-5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater*
IEEE reset +/-10% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
Repeatability < 5%
DT operate +/-2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
DT reset +/- 5% or 50 ms, whichever is greater

Note:
Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 1, IN> = 1A, operating range = 2-20In.

3.7.1 EARTH FAULT DIRECTIONAL PARAMETERS

Zero Sequence Polarising accuracy


Directional boundary pick-up (RCA +/- 90°) +/-2°
Hysteresis <3°
VN> pick-up Setting+/-10%
VN> drop-off 0.9 x Setting +/-10%

Negative Sequence Polarising accuracy


Directional boundary pick-up (RCA +/- 90°) +/-2°
Hysteresis <3°
VN2> pick-up Setting+/-10%
VN2> drop-off 0.9 x Setting +/-10%
IN2> pick-up Setting+/-10%
IN2> drop-off 0.9 x Setting +/-10%

690 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

3.8 SENSITIVE EARTH FAULT PROTECTION

IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%


DT Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
Drop-off (IDMT + DT) 0.95 x Setting +/-5%
IDMT operate +/- 5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater*
DT operate +/- 2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
DT reset Setting +/- 5% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
Repeatability < 5%

Note:
Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 1, IN> setting = 100 mA with operating range of 2-20Is.

3.8.1 SENSITIVE EARTH FAULT PROTECTION DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT

Wattmetric SEF
Pick-up P = 0 W ISEF > +/-5% or 5 mA
Pick-up P > 0 W P > +/-5%
Drop-off P = 0 W 0.95 x ISEF> +/- 5% or 5 mA
Drop-off P > 0 W 0.9 x P> +/- 5% or 5 mA
Boundary accuracy +/-5% with hysteresis < 1°
Repeatability < 1%

3.9 HIGH IMPEDANCE RESTRICTED EARTH FAULT PROTECTION

High Impedance and Low Impedance


Pick-up Setting formula +/- 5%
Drop-off 0.8 x Setting formula +/-5%
Operating time < 60 ms
High set pick-up Setting +/- 10%
High set operating time < 30 ms
Repeatability < 5%

3.10 NEGATIVE SEQUENCE OVERCURRENT PROTECTION

IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%


DT pick-up Setting +/- 5%
Drop-off (IDMT and DT) 0.95 x Setting +/-5%
IDMT operate +/- 5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
DT operate +/- 2% or 60 ms, whichever is greater
DT Reset Setting +/- 5%

P446SV-TM-EN-1 691
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

3.10.1 NPSOC DIRECTIONAL PARAMETERS

Directional boundary pick-up (RCA +/-90%) +/-2°


Directional boundary hysteresis < 1°
Directional boundary repeatability < 1%

3.11 CIRCUIT BREAKER FAIL AND UNDERCURRENT PROTECTION

I< Pick-up Setting +/- 10% or 0.025 In, whichever is greater


I< Drop-off Setting +/- 5% or 20 mA, whichever is greater
Operate time < 12 ms
Timers +/- 2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater
Reset time < 15 ms

3.12 BROKEN CONDUCTOR PROTECTION

Pick-up Setting +/- 2.5%


Drop-off 0.95 x Setting +/- 2.5%
DT operate +/- 2% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
Reset time <25 ms

3.13 THERMAL OVERLOAD PROTECTION

Thermal alarm pick-up Calculated trip time +/- 10%


Thermal overload pick-up Calculated trip time +/- 10%
Cooling time accuracy +/- 15% of theoretical
Repeatability <5%

Note:
Operating time measured with applied current of 20% above thermal setting.

692 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

4 MONITORING, CONTROL AND SUPERVISION

4.1 VOLTAGE TRANSFORMER SUPERVISION

Fast block operation < 1 cycle


Fast block reset < 1.5 cycles
Time delay +/- 2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater

4.2 STANDARD CURRENT TRANSFORMER SUPERVISION

IN> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%


VN< Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
IN> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/- 5%
VN< Drop-off 1.05 x setting +/-5% or 1 V, whichever is greater
Time delay operation Setting +/-2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater
CTS block operation < 1 cycle
CTS reset < 35 ms

4.3 DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT TRANSFORMER SUPERVISION

Accuracy
I1> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I1> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/- 5%
I2/I1> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I2/I1> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/-5%
I2/I1>> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I2/I1 >> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/-5%
Time delay operation Setting +/-2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater
CTS block diff operation < 1 cycle
CTS reset < 35 ms

4.4 CB STATE AND CONDITION MONITORING

Accuracy
Timers +/- 40 ms or 2%, whichever is greater
Broken current accuracy +/- 5%
Reset time < 30 ms

P446SV-TM-EN-1 693
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

4.5 PSL TIMERS

Output conditioner timer Setting +/- 2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater


Dwell conditioner timer Setting +/- 2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
Pulse conditioner timer Setting +/- 2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater

694 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

5 MEASUREMENTS AND RECORDING

5.1 GENERAL

General Measurement Accuracy


General measurement accuracy Typically +/- 1%, but +/- 0.5% between 0.2 - 2 In/Vn
Phase 0° to 360° +/- 0.5%
Current (0.05 to 3 In) +/- 1.0% of reading, or 4mA (1A input), or 20mA (5A input)
Voltage (0.05 to 2 Vn) +/- 1.0% of reading
Frequency (45 to 65 Hz) +/- 0.025 Hz
Power (W) (0.2 to 2 Vn and 0.05 to 3 In) +/- 5.0% of reading at unity power factor
Reactive power (Vars) (0.2 to 2 Vn and 0.05 to 3 In) +/- 5.0% of reading at zero power factor
Apparent power (VA) (0.2 to 2 Vn and 0.05 to 3 In) +/- 5.0% of reading
Energy (Wh) (0.2 to 2 Vn and 0.2 to 3 In) +/- 5.0% of reading at unity power factor
Energy (Varh) (0.2 to 2 Vn and 0.2 to 3In) +/- 5.0% of reading at zero power factor

5.2 DISTURBANCE RECORDS

Disturbance Records Measurement Accuracy


Minimum record duration 0.1 s
Maximum record duration 10.5 s
Minimum number of records at 10.5 seconds 8
Magnitude and relative phases accuracy +/- 5% of applied quantities
Duration accuracy +/- 2%
Trigger position accuracy +/- 2% (minimum Trigger 100 ms)

5.3 EVENT, FAULT AND MAINTENANCE RECORDS

Event, Fault & Maintenance Records


Record location Battery-backed memory
Viewing method Front panel display or Settings Application Software
Extraction method Extracted via the front serial port
Number of Event records Up to 1024 time tagged event records (newest overwrites oldest)
Number of Fault Records Up to 15
Number of Maintenance Records Up to 10
Event time stamp resolution 1 ms

5.4 FAULT LOCATOR

Accuracy
+/- 2% of line length
Fault Location
Reference conditions: solid fault applied on line

P446SV-TM-EN-1 695
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

6 RATINGS

6.1 AC MEASURING INPUTS

AC Measuring Inputs
Nominal frequency 50 Hz or 60 Hz (settable)
Operating range 45 to 65 Hz
Phase rotation ABC or CBA

6.2 CURRENT TRANSFORMER INPUTS


AC Current Inputs
Nominal current (In) 1A or 5A
Nominal burden per phase < 0.2 VA at In
20 A (continuous operation)
AC current thermal withstand (5A input) 150 A (for 10 s)
500 A (for 1 s)
4 A (continuous operation)
AC current thermal withstand (1A input) 30 A (for 10 s)
100 A (for 1 s)
Linearity Linear up to 64 × In (non-offset)

6.3 VOLTAGE TRANSFORMER INPUTS

AC Voltage Inputs
Nominal voltage 100 V to 120 V
Nominal burden per phase < 0.1 VA at Vn
2 x Vn (continuous operation)
Thermal withstand
2.6 x Vn (for 10 seconds)
Linear up to 200 V (100/120 V supply)
Linearity
Linear up to 800 V (380/400 V supply)

6.4 AUXILIARY SUPPLY VOLTAGE

Cortec option (DC only)


24 to 48 V DC
Cortec option (rated for AC or DC operation)
48 to 110 V DC
Nominal operating range
40 to 100 V AC rms
Cortec option (rated for AC or DC operation)
110 to 250 V DC
100 to 240 V AC rms

696 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

Cortec option (DC only)


19 to 65 V DC
Cortec option (rated for AC or DC operation)
37 to 150 V DC
Maximum operating range
32 to 110 V AC rms
Cortec option (rated for AC or DC operation)
87 to 300 V DC
80 to 265 V AC rms
Frequency range for AC supply 45 to 65 Hz
Ripple <15% for a DC supply (compliant with IEC 60255-11:2013)
Power up time < 11 seconds

6.5 NOMINAL BURDEN

Quiescent burden 11 W
2nd rear communications port 1.25 W
Each relay output burden 0.13 W per output relay
Each opto-input burden (24 – 27 V) 0.065 W max
Each opto-input burden (30 – 34 V) 0.065 W max
Each opto-input burden (48 – 54 V) 0.125 W max
Each opto-input burden (110 – 125 V) 0.36 W max
Each opto-input burden (220 – 250 V) 0.9 W max

6.6 POWER SUPPLY INTERRUPTION

Standard IEC 60255-26:2013 (DC and AC)


20 ms at 24 V (half and full load)
24-48V DC SUPPLY
50 ms at 36 V (half and full load)
100% interruption without de-energising
100 ms at 48 V (half and full load)
20 ms at 37V (half and full load)
50 ms at 60 V (half and full load)
48-110V DC SUPPLY
100 ms at 72 V (half load)
100% interruption without de-energising
100 ms at 85 V (full load)
200 ms at 110 V (half and full load)
20 ms at 87 V (half load)
50 ms at 110 V (half load)
50 ms at 98 V (full load)
110-250V DC SUPPLY
100 ms at 160 V (half load)
100% interruption without de-energising
100 ms at 135 V (full load)
200 ms at 210 V (half load)
200 ms at 174 V (full load)
40-100V AC SUPPLY 50 ms at 32 V (half load)
100% voltage dip without de-energising 10 ms at 32 V (full load)
100-240V AC SUPPLY
50 ms at 80 V (full and half load)
100% voltage dip without de-energising

P446SV-TM-EN-1 697
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

Note:
Maximum loading = all inputs/outputs energised.

Note:
Quiescent or 1/2 loading = 1/2 of all inputs/outputs energised.

6.7 BATTERY BACKUP

Location Front panel


Type 1/2 AA, 3.6V Lithium Thionyly Chloride
Battery reference LS14250
Lifetime > 10 years (IED energised for 90% of the time)

698 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

7 INPUT / OUTPUT CONNECTIONS

7.1 ISOLATED DIGITAL INPUTS

Opto-isolated digital inputs (opto-inputs)


Compliance ESI 48-4
Rated nominal voltage 24 to 250 V dc
Operating range 19 to 265 V dc
Withstand 300 V dc
Recognition time with half-cycle ac
< 2 ms
immunity filter removed
Recognition time with filter on < 12 ms

7.1.1 NOMINAL PICKUP AND RESET THRESHOLDS

Nominal battery
Logic levels: 60-80% DO/PU Logic Levels: 50-70% DO/PU
voltage
24/27 V Logic 0 < 16.2V, Logic 1 > 19.2V Logic 0 <12V, Logic 1 > 16.8V
30/34 Logic 0 < 20.4V, Logic 1 > 24V Logic 0 < 15V, Logic 1 > 21V
48/54 Logic 0 < 32.4V, Logic 1 > 38.4V Logic 0 < 24V, Logic 1 > 33.6V
110/125 Logic 0 < 75V, Logic 1 > 88V Logic 0 < 55.V, Logic 1 > 77V
220/250 Logic 0 < 150V, Logic 1 > 176V Logic 0 < 110V, Logic 1 > 154V

Note:
Filter is required to make the opto-inputs immune to induced AC voltages.

In addition to the above thresholds, some models of this product provide the following threshold levels for FSK
applications:
● For 220/250 voltage inputs: Logic 0 < 145V, Logic 1 > 165V

7.2 STANDARD OUTPUT CONTACTS

Compliance In accordance with IEC 60255-1:2009


Use General purpose relay outputs for signalling, tripping and alarming
Rated voltage 300 V
Maximum continuous current 10 A
30 A for 3 s
Short duration withstand carry
250 A for 30 ms
Make and break, dc resistive 50 W
Make and break, dc inductive 62.5 W (L/R = 50 ms)
Make and break, ac resistive 2500 VA resistive (cos phi = unity)
Make and break, ac inductive 2500 VA inductive (cos phi = 0.7)
Make and carry, dc resistive 30 A for 3 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break, dc resistive 4 A for 1.5 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 699
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

Make, carry and break, dc inductive 0.5 A for 1 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break ac resistive 30 A for 200 ms, 2000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break ac inductive 10 A for 1.5 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Loaded contact 1000 operations min.
Unloaded contact 10000 operations min.
Operate time < 5 ms
Reset time < 10 ms

7.3 HIGH BREAK OUTPUT CONTACTS

Compliance In accordance with IEC 60255-1:2009


Use For applciations requiring high rupture capacity
Rated voltage 300 V
Maximum continuous current 10 A DC
30 A DC for 3 s
Short duration withstand carry
250 A for 30 ms
Make and break, dc resistive 7500 W
Make and break, dc inductive 2500 W (L/R = 50 ms)
Make and carry, dc resistive 30 A for 3 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
30 A for 3 s, 5000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break, dc resistive
30 A for 200 ms, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
10 A for 40 ms, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break, dc inductive
10 a for 20 ms (250V, 4 shots per second)
Loaded contact 10,000 operations minimum.
Unloaded contact 100,000 operations minimum.
Operate time < 0.2 ms
Reset time < 8 ms
MOV Protection Maximum voltage 330 V DC

7.4 WATCHDOG CONTACTS

Use Non-programmable contacts for relay healthy/relay fail indication


Breaking capacity, dc resistive 30 W
Breaking capacity, dc inductive 15 W (L/R = 40 ms)
Breaking capacity, ac inductive 375 VA inductive (cos phi = 0.7)

700 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

8 MECHANICAL SPECIFICATIONS

8.1 PHYSICAL PARAMETERS

40TE
Case Types* 60TE
80TE
Weight (40TE case) 7 kg – 8 kg (depending on chosen options)
Weight (60TE case) 9 kg – 12 kg (depending on chosen options)
Weight (80TE case) 13 kg - 16 kg (depending on chosen options)
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (40TE case) W: 206.0 mm H: 177.0 mm D: 243.1 mm
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (60TE case) W: 309.6 mm H: 177.0 mm D: 243.1 mm
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (80TE case) W 413.2 mm H 177.0 mm D 243.1 mm
Mounting Panel, rack, or retrofit

Note:
*Case size is product dependent.

8.2 ENCLOSURE PROTECTION

Against dust and dripping water (front face) IP52 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection against dust (whole case) IP50 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection for sides of the case (safety) IP30 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection for rear of the case (safety) IP10 as per IEC 60529:2002

8.3 MECHANICAL ROBUSTNESS

Vibration test per EN 60255-21-1:1996 Response: class 2, Endurance: class 2


Shock response: class 2, Shock withstand: class 1, Bump withstand:
Shock and bump immunity per EN 60255-21-2:1995
class 1
Seismic test per EN 60255-21-3: 1995 Class 2

8.4 TRANSIT PACKAGING PERFORMANCE

Primary packaging carton protection ISTA 1C


Vibration tests 3 orientations, 7 Hz, amplitude 5.3 mm, acceleration 1.05g
10 drops from 610 mm height on multiple carton faces, edges and
Drop tests
corners

P446SV-TM-EN-1 701
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

9 TYPE TESTS

9.1 INSULATION

Compliance IEC 60255-27: 2005


Insulation resistance > 100 M ohm at 500 V DC (Using only electronic/brushless insulation tester)

9.2 CREEPAGE DISTANCES AND CLEARANCES

Compliance IEC 60255-27: 2005


Pollution degree 3
Overvoltage category lll
Impulse test voltage (not RJ45) 5 kV
Impulse test voltage (RJ45) 1 kV

9.3 HIGH VOLTAGE (DIELECTRIC) WITHSTAND

IEC Compliance IEC 60255-27: 2005


Between all independent circuits 2 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Between independent circuits and protective earth conductor terminal 2 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Between all case terminals and the case earth 2 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Across open watchdog contacts 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Across open contacts of changeover output relays 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Between all RJ45 contacts and protective earth 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Between all screw-type EIA(RS)485 contacts and protective earth 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute
ANSI/IEEE Compliance ANSI/IEEE C37.90-2005
Across open contacts of normally open output relays 1.5 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Across open contacts of normally open changeover output relays 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute
Across open watchdog contacts 1 kV ac rms for 1 minute

9.4 IMPULSE VOLTAGE WITHSTAND TEST

Compliance IEC 60255-27: 2005


Between all independent circuits Front time: 1.2 µs, Time to half-value: 50 µs, Peak value: 5 kV, 0.5 J
Between terminals of all independent circuits Front time: 1.2 µs, Time to half-value: 50 µs, Peak value: 5 kV, 0.5 J
Between all independent circuits and protective
Front time: 1.2 µs, Time to half-value: 50 µs, Peak value: 5 kV, 0.5 J
earth conductor terminal

Note:
Exceptions are communications ports and normally-open output contacts, where applicable.

702 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

10 ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS

10.1 AMBIENT TEMPERATURE RANGE

Compliance IEC 60255-27: 2005


Test Method IEC 60068-2-1:2007 and IEC 60068-2-2 2007
Operating temperature range -25°C to +55°C (continuous)
Storage and transit temperature range -25°C to +70°C (continuous)

10.2 TEMPERATURE ENDURANCE TEST

Temperature Endurance Test


Test Method IEC 60068-2-1: 1993 and 60068-2-2: 2007
-40°C (96 hours)
Operating temperature range
+70°C (96 hours)
-40°C (96 hours)
Storage and transit temperature range
+70°C (96 hours)

10.3 AMBIENT HUMIDITY RANGE

Compliance IEC 60068-2-78: 2001 and IEC 60068-2-30: 2005


Durability 56 days at 93% relative humidity and +40°C
Damp heat cyclic six (12 + 12) hour cycles, 93% RH, +25 to +55°C

10.4 CORROSIVE ENVIRONMENTS

Compliance IEC 60068-2-42: 2003, IEC 60068-2-43: 2003


Industrial corrosive environment/poor environmental 21 days exposure to elevated concentrations (25ppm) of SO2 at
control, Sulphur Dioxide 75% relative humidity and +25°C
Industrial corrosive environment/poor environmental 21 days exposure to elevated concentrations (10ppm) of H2S at
control, Hydrogen Sulphide 75% relative humidity and +25°C
Salt mist IEC 60068-2-52: 1996 KB severity 3

P446SV-TM-EN-1 703
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

11 ELECTROMAGNETIC COMPATIBILITY

11.1 1 MHZ BURST HIGH FREQUENCY DISTURBANCE TEST

Compliance IEC 60255-22-1: 2008, Class III, IEC 60255-26:2013


Common-mode test voltage (level 3) 2.5 kV
Differential test voltage (level 3) 1.0 kV

11.2 DAMPED OSCILLATORY TEST

EN61000-4-18: 2011: Level 3, 100 kHz and 1 MHz. Level 4: 3 MHz,


Compliance
10 MHz and 30 MHz, IEC 60255-26:2013
Common-mode test voltage (level 3) 2.5 kV
Common-mode test voltage (level 4) 4.0 kV
Differential mode test voltage 1.0 kV

11.3 IMMUNITY TO ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE

Compliance IEC 60255-22-2: 2009 Class 3 and Class 4, IEC 60255-26:2013


Class 4 Condition 15 kV discharge in air to user interface, display, and exposed metalwork
Class 3 Condition 8 kV discharge in air to all communication ports

11.4 ELECTRICAL FAST TRANSIENT OR BURST REQUIREMENTS

IEC 60255-22-4: 2008 and EN61000-4-4:2004. Test severity level lll and lV, IEC
Compliance
60255-26:2013
Applied to communication inputs Amplitude: 2 kV, burst frequency 5 kHz and 100 KHz (level 4)
Applied to power supply and all other inputs
Amplitude: 4 kV, burst frequency 5 kHz and 100 KHz (level 4)
except for communication inputs

11.5 SURGE WITHSTAND CAPABILITY

Compliance IEEE/ANSI C37.90.1: 2002


4 kV fast transient and 2.5 kV oscillatory applied common mode and differential
Condition 1
mode to opto inputs, output relays, CTs, VTs, power supply
4 kV fast transient and 2.5 kV oscillatory applied common mode to communications,
Condition 2
IRIG-B

704 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

11.6 SURGE IMMUNITY TEST

Compliance IEC 61000-4-5: 2005 Level 4, IEC 60255-26:2013


Pulse duration Time to half-value: 1.2/50 µs
Between all groups and protective earth conductor terminal Amplitude 4 kV
Between terminals of each group (excluding communications ports,
Amplitude 2 kV
where applicable)

11.7 IMMUNITY TO RADIATED ELECTROMAGNETIC ENERGY

Compliance IEC 60255-22-3: 2007, Class III, IEC 60255-26:2013


Frequency band 80 MHz to 3.0 GHz
Spot tests at 80, 160, 380, 450, 900, 1850, 2150 MHz
Test field strength 10 V/m
Test using AM 1 kHz @ 80%
Compliance IEEE/ANSI C37.90.2: 2004
Frequency band 80 MHz to 1 GHz
Spot tests at 80, 160, 380, 450 MHz
Waveform 1 kHz @ 80% am and pulse modulated
Field strength 35 V/m

11.8 RADIATED IMMUNITY FROM DIGITAL COMMUNICATIONS

Compliance IEC 61000-4-3: 2006, Level 4, IEC 60255-26:2013


Frequency bands 800 to 960 MHz, 1.4 to 2.0 GHz
Test field strength 30 V/m
Test using AM 1 kHz / 80%

11.9 RADIATED IMMUNITY FROM DIGITAL RADIO TELEPHONES

Compliance IEC 61000-4-3: 2006, IEC 60255-26:2013


Frequency bands 900 MHz and 1.89 GHz
Test field strength 10 V/m

11.10 IMMUNITY TO CONDUCTED DISTURBANCES INDUCED BY RADIO FREQUENCY


FIELDS

Compliance IEC 61000-4-6: 2008, Level 3, IEC 60255-26:2013


Frequency bands 150 kHz to 80 MHz

P446SV-TM-EN-1 705
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

Test disturbance voltage 10 V rms


Test using AM 1 kHz @ 80%
Spot tests 27 MHz and 68 MHz

11.11 MAGNETIC FIELD IMMUNITY

IEC 61000-4-8: 2009 Level 5


Compliance
IEC 61000-4-9/10: 2001 Level 5
IEC 61000-4-8 test 100 A/m applied continuously, 1000 A/m applied for 3 s
IEC 61000-4-9 test 1000 A/m applied in all planes
100 A/m applied in all planes at 100 kHz/1 MHz with a burst duration of 2
IEC 61000-4-10 test
seconds

11.12 CONDUCTED EMISSIONS

Compliance EN 55022: 2010, IEC 60255-26:2013


Power supply test 1 0.15 - 0.5 MHz, 79 dBµV (quasi peak) 66 dBµV (average)
Power supply test 2 0.5 – 30 MHz, 73 dBµV (quasi peak) 60 dBµV (average)
RJ45 test 1 (where applicable) 0.15 - 0.5 MHz, 97 dBµV (quasi peak) 84 dBµV (average)
RJ45 test 2 (where applicable) 0.5 – 30 MHz, 87 dBµV (quasi peak) 74 dBµV (average)

11.13 RADIATED EMISSIONS

Compliance EN 55022: 2010, IEC 60255-26:2013


Test 1 30 – 230 MHz, 40 dBµV/m at 10 m measurement distance
Test 2 230 – 1 GHz, 47 dBµV/m at 10 m measurement distance
Test 3 1 – 2 GHz, 76 dBµV/m at 10 m measurement distance

11.14 POWER FREQUENCY

Compliance IEC 60255-22-7:2003, IEC 60255-26:2013


Opto-inputs (Compliance is achieved using the opto-input 300 V common-mode (Class A)
filter) 150 V differential mode (Class A)

Note:
Compliance is achieved using the opto-input filter.

706 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications

12 REGULATORY COMPLIANCE
Compliance with the European Commission Directive on EMC and LVD is demonstrated using a technical file.

12.1 EMC COMPLIANCE: 2014/30/EU


The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the relevant harmonised standard(s) or conformit
assessment used to demonstrate compliance with the EMC directive.

12.2 LVD COMPLIANCE: 2014/35/EU


The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the relevant harmonized standard(s) or conformity
assessment used to demonstrate compliance with the LVD directive.
Safety related information, such as the installation I overvoltage category, pollution degree and operating
temperature ranges are specified in the Technical Data section of the relevant product documentation and/or on
the product labelling .
Unless otherwise stated in the Technical Data section of the relevant product documentation, the equipment is
intended for indoor use only. Where the equipment is required for use in an outdoor location, it must be mounted
in a specific cabinet or housing to provide the equipment with the appropriate level of protection from the
expected outdoor environment.

12.3 R&TTE COMPLIANCE: 2014/53/EU


Radio and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) directive 2014/53/EU.
Conformity is demonstrated by compliance to both the EMC directive and the Low Voltage directive, to zero volts.

12.4 UL/CUL COMPLIANCE


If marked with this logo, the product is compliant with the requirements of the Canadian and USA Underwriters
Laboratories.
The relevant UL file number and ID is shown on the equipment.

12.5 ATEX COMPLIANCE: 2014/34/EU


Products marked with the 'explosion protection' Ex symbol (shown in the example, below) are compliant with the
ATEX directive. The product specific Declaration of Conformity (DoC) lists the Notified Body, Type Examination
Certificate, and relevant harmonized standard or conformity assessment used to demonstrate compliance with
the ATEX directive.
The ATEX Equipment Protection level, Equipment group, and Zone definition will be marked on the
product.
For example:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 707
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV

Where:

'II' Equipment Group: Industrial.

'(2)G' High protection equipment category, for control of equipment in gas atmospheres in Zone 1 and 2.
This equipment (with parentheses marking around the zone number) is not itself suitable for operation
within a potentially explosive atmosphere.

708 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX A

ORDERING OPTIONS
Appendix A - Ordering Options P446SV

P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix A - Ordering Options

Variants Order No.


Distance Protection P446 P446 **
Distance & Autoreclose for 2 Circuit Breakers

Nominal auxiliary voltage


24-54 Vdc 7
48-125 Vdc (40-100 Vac) 8
110-250 Vdc (100-240 Vac) 9

In/Vn rating
In = 1A/5A ; Vn = 100-120Vac 1
IEC 61850-9-2LE Sampled Analogue Values Ethernet board * C

* Only available with '74'/'80' Software

Hardware options Protocol Compatibilty


Nothing 1, 3 & 4 1
IRIG-B Only (Modulated) 1, 3 & 4 2
Fibre Optic Converter Only 1, 3 & 4 3
IRIG-B (Modulated) & Fibre Optic Converter 1, 3 & 4 4
Ethernet (100Mbit/s) 6, 7 & 8 6
Second Rear Comms + InterMiCOM 1, 3 & 4 7
IRIG-B (Modulated) + Second Rear Comms + InterMiCOM 1, 3 & 4 8
Ethernet (100Mbit/s) plus IRIG-B (Modulated) 6, 7 & 8 A
Ethernet (100Mbit/s) plus IRIG-B (Un-modulated) 6, 7 & 8 B
IRIG-B (Un-modulated) 1, 3 & 4 C
InterMiCOM + Courier Rear Port 1, 3 & 4 E
InterMiCOM + Courier Rear Port + IRIG-B modulated 1, 3 & 4 F
Redundant Ethernet Self-Healing Ring, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 G
Redundant Ethernet Self-Healing Ring, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Un-modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 H
Redundant Ethernet RSTP, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 J
Redundant Ethernet RSTP, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Un-modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 K
Redundant Ethernet Dual-Homing Star, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 L
Redundant Ethernet Dual-Homing Star, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Un-modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 M
Redundant Ethernet PRP, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 N
Redundant Ethernet PRP, 2 multi-mode fibre ports + Un-modulated IRIG-B 6, 7 & 8 P

Product Options
24 inputs and 32 outputs (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) B
24 inputs and 8 standard plus 12 high break outputs C
24 inputs and 16 standard plus 8 high break outputs D
As B + 850nm dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) F
As C + 850nm dual channel G
As D + 850nm dual channel H
As B + 1300nm SM single channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) J
As C + 1300nm SM single channel K
As D + 1300nm SM single channel L
As B + 1300nm SM dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) N
As C + 1300nm SM dual channel O
As D + 1300nm SM dual channel P
As B + 1300nm MM single channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) R
As C + 1300nm MM single channel S
As D + 1300nm MM single channel T
As B + 1300nm MM dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) V
As C + 1300nm MM dual channel W
As D + 1300nm MM dual channel X
As B + 850nm MM + 1300mn SM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) Z
As D + 850nm MM + 1300mn SM 1
As B + 1300mn SM + 850nm MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 2
As D + 1300mn SM + 850nm MM 3
As B + 850nm MM + 1300mn MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 4
As D + 850nm MM + 1300mn MM 5
As B + 1300mn MM + 850nm MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 6
As D + 1300mn MM + 850nm MM 7

Protocol options Hardware Compatibilty


K-Bus 1, 2, 3, 4, C, E & F 1
IEC60870-5-103 1, 2, 3, 4, C, E & F 3
DNP3.0 1, 2, 3, 4, C, E & F 4
IEC61850 + Courier via rear RS485 port 6, A, B, G, H, J, K, L, M, N, P 6
IEC61850+IEC60870-5-103 via rear RS485 port 6, A, B, G, H, J, K, L, M, N, P 7
DNP3.0 Over Ethernet with Courier rear port K-Bus/RS485 protocol 6, A, B, G, H, J, K, L, M, N, P 8

Mounting
Flush/Panel Mounting with Harsh Environment Coating M
Rack Mounting with Harsh Environmental Coating N
Flush/panel mounting with harsh environment coating P
19" Rack mounting with harsh environmental coating Q
40TE Case (9-2LE models only) Flush/Panel Mounting with Harsh Environmetal Coating R

Language
English, French, German, Spanish 0
English, French, German, Russian 5
English, Italian, Polish and Portuguese * 7
Chinese, English or French via HMI, with English or French only via Communications port C

* Available with '75'/'76'/'82' software

Software version
Date and application dependant **

Customer specific options


Standard version 0
Customer version A

Hardware version
Extended main processor (XCPU2) With Function Keys & Tri-colour LEDs K
Main processor (CPU3) 40TE P
As K plus increased main processor memory (XCPU3), Cyber Security M

P446SV-TM-EN-1 A1
Appendix A - Ordering Options P446SV

A2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX B

SETTINGS AND SIGNALS


Appendix B - Settings and Signals P446SV

P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
SYSTEM DATA 00 00
This column contains general system settings
English
Francais
Language 00 01 English Deutsch
Espanol
[Indexed String]
The default language used by the device. Selectable as English, French, German, Spanish.
4 registers for writing 8 character password
Each register contains a pair of characters
Each register is formatted as follows:-
Password 00 02 first character of a pair
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[ASCII Password (8)]
Plain text password entry cell
Trip led self reset
Sys Fn Links 00 03 0
[Binary Flag (1) Indexed String]
Setting to allow the fixed function trip LED to be self resetting (set to 1 to extinguish the LED after a period of healthy restoration of load
current).
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Description 00 04 MiCOM P54x
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
16 character relay description. Can be edited.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Plant Reference 00 05 MiCOM
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Associated plant description and can be edited.
Model Number
Model Number 00 06 Model Number
[ASCII Text (32)]
Relay model number. This display cannot be altered.
Serial Number
Serial Number 00 08 Serial Number
[ASCII Text (7)]
Relay model number. This display cannot be altered.
50 or 60
Frequency 00 09 50
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Relay set frequency. Settable either 50 or 60 Hz
Comms Level
Comms Level 00 0A 1
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Displays the conformance of the relay to the Courier Level 2 comms.
From 0 to 255 in steps of 1
Relay Address 00 0B 255
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets the first rear port relay address.
Plant Status
Plant Status 00 0C
[Binary Flag (16)]
Displays the circuit breaker plant status.
Control Status
Control Status 00 0D
[Binary Flag (16)]
Not used
Active Group
Active Group 00 0E
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Displays the active settings group
No Operation
Trip
Close
No Operation
No Operation
CB Trip/Close 00 10 No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
Trip CB2

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B1
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Close CB2
[Indexed String]
Supports trip and close commands if enabled in the Circuit Breaker Control menu.
No Operation
Trip
Close
No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
CB Trip/Close 00 10 No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
No Operation
Trip CB2
Close CB2
[Indexed String]
Supports trip and close commands if enabled in the Circuit Breaker Control menu.
Software Ref. 1
Software Ref. 1 00 11
[ASCII Text (16)]
Displays the relay software version including protocol and relay model.
Opto I/P Status
Opto I/P Status 00 20 [Binary Flag (32)
Indexed String]
Display the status of the available opto inputs fitted.
Relay O/P Status
Relay O/P Status 00 21 [Binary Flag (32)
Indexed String]
Displays the status of all available output relays fitted.
Setting Group via opto invalid
Test Mode Enabled
Static Test Mode
Loop Back Test Enabled
IM64 Test Enabled
VTS Indication
CTS Alarm
CT2S Alarm
Remote CTS Alarm
Power Swing
BF Block AR
CB Monitor Alarm
CB Lockout Alarm
CB Status Alarm
CB Failed to Trip
CB Failed to Close
Control CB Unhealthy
Alarm Status 1 00 22
Control No Checksync
Autoclose Lockout/RLY BAR
No Healthy (AR)
No Check Sync / AR Fail
System Split Alarm
GPS Alarm
Signaling failure alarm
Signaling Propagation Delay Alarm
Differential protection failure alarm
IM64 Scheme Fail alarm
IEEE C37.94 Communications Alarms
Diff Protection inhibited
Aid1 Channel Out
Aid2 Channel Out
Frequency out of range
[Binary Flag (32)
Indexed String]
Displays the status of the first 32 alarms as a binary string. Includes fixed and user settable alarms. Data type G96

B2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting Group via opto invalid
Test Mode Enabled
Static Test Mode
Loop Back Test Enabled
IM64 Test Enabled
VTS Indication
CTS Alarm
CT2S Alarm
Remote CTS Alarm
Power Swing
BF Block AR
CB Monitor Alarm
CB Lockout Alarm
CB Status Alarm
CB Failed to Trip
CB Failed to Close
Control CB Unhealthy
Alarm Status 1 00 50
Control No Checksync
Autoclose Lockout/RLY BAR
No Healthy (AR)
No Check Sync / AR Fail
System Split Alarm
GPS Alarm
Signaling failure alarm
Signaling Propagation Delay Alarm
Differential protection failure alarm
IM64 Scheme Fail alarm
IEEE C37.94 Communications Alarms
Diff Protection inhibited
Aid1 Channel Out
Aid2 Channel Out
Frequency out of range
[Binary Flag (32)
Indexed String]
32 bit field gives status of first 32 alarms. Includes fixed and user settable alarms.
BF Block AR 2
CB2 Monitor Alarm
CB2 Lockout Alarm
CB2 Status Alarm
CB2 Failed to Trip
CB2 Failed to Close
Control CB2 Unhealthy
Control No Checksync
Autoclose Lockout/RLY BAR
No Healthy (AR)
No Check Sync / AR Fail
Invalid AR Mode
Incompatible relays
In Valid Message Format
Alarm Status 2 00 51
Copro Main Prot. Fail
Configuration Error
Re-Configuration Error
C Diff Protection Comms Mode
Max Prop Delay Alarm
SR User Alarm 1
SR User Alarm 2
SR User Alarm 3
SR User Alarm 4
MR User Alarm 5
MR User Alarm 6
MR User Alarm 7
MR User Alarm 8
[Binary Flag (32)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B3
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Indexed String]
Displays the status of the next 32 alarms as a binary string. Data type G128
Battery Fail
Field Volt Fail
Rear Comm 2 Fail
GOOSE IED Absent
NIC Not Fitted
NIC No Response
NIC Fatal Error
NIC Soft. Reload
Bad TCP/IP Cfg.
Bad OSI Config.
Alarm Status 3 00 52
NIC Link Fail
NIC SW Mis-Match
IP Addr Conflict
IM Loopback
IM Message Fail
IM Data CD Fail
IM Channel Fail
Backup Setting
[Binary Flag (32)
Indexed String]
Displays the status of the next 32 alarms as a binary string. Data type G228
Access Level
Access Level 00 D0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Displays the current access level.
Level 0 - No password required - Read access to Security features, Model Number, Serial Number, S/W version, DescriptionPlant reference,
Security code (UI Only), Encryption key (UI Only), User Banner and security related cells (BF12 - BF14).
Level 1 - Password 1, 2 or 3 required - Read access to all data and settings. Write access to Primary/Secondary selector, Level 1 password
setting, Password reset cell and log extraction cells (record selector)
Level 2 - Password 2 or 3 required - Read access to all data and settings. Write access to Reset demands and counters and Level 2 password
setting.
Level 3 - Password 3 required - Read access to all data and settings. Write access to All settings including Level 3 password setting, PSL, IED
Config, Security settings (port disabling etc)
4 registers for writing 8 character password
Each register contains a pair of characters
Each register is formatted as follows:-
Password Level 1 00 D2 first character of a pair
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change password level 1.
4 registers for writing 8 character password
Each register contains a pair of characters
Each register is formatted as follows:-
Password Level 2 00 D3 AAAA first character of a pair
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change password level 2.
4 registers for writing 8 character password
Each register contains a pair of characters
Each register is formatted as follows:-
Password Level 3 00 D4 AAAA first character of a pair
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change password level 3.
4 registers for writing 8 character password
Each register contains a pair of characters
Security Feature 00 DF 1
Each register is formatted as follows:-
first character of a pair

B4 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[Integer]
Displays the level of cyber security implemented, 1 = phase 1.
4 registers for writing encrypted password
Password 00 E1 Registers can contain any bit pattern.
[ASCII Password (8)]
Encrypted password entry cell. Not visbile via UI
4 registers for writing encrypted password
Password Level 1 00 E2 Registers can contain any bit pattern.
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change Encryped password level 1. Not visbile via UI
4 registers for writing encrypted password
Password Level 2 00 E3 Registers can contain any bit pattern.
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change Encryped password level 2. Not visbile via UI
4 registers for writing encrypted password
Password Level 3 00 E4 Registers can contain any bit pattern.
[ASCII Password (8)]
Allows user to change Encryped password level 3. Not visbile via UI
VIEW RECORDS 01 00
This column contains record configuration
From 0 to 499 in steps of 1
Select Event 01 01 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Setting range from 0 to 511. This selects the required event record from the possible 512 that may be stored. A value of 0 corresponds to the
latest event and so on.
Menu Cell Ref
Menu Cell Ref 01 02 (From Record)
[Cell Reference]
Indicates the type of event. See Event sheet for more details
Time & Date
Time & Date 01 03 (From Record)
[IEC870 Time & Date]
Time & Date Stamp for the event given by the internal Real Time Clock.
Event Text
Event Text 01 04
[ASCII Text (32)]
Up to 32 Character description of the Event (refer to following sections).
Event Value
Event Value 01 05
[Binary Flag (32)/UINT32]
Up to 32 Bit Binary Flag or integer representative of the Event (refer to following sections).
From 0 to 4 in steps of 1
Select Fault 01 06 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Setting range from 0 to 14. This selects the required fault record from the possible 15 that may be stored. A value of 0 corresponds to the
latest fault and so on.
Start A
Start B
Start C
Start N
Faulted Phase 01 07 Trip A
Trip B
Trip C
Trip N
[Binary Flag (8)]
Displays the faulted phase. Started phases + tripped phases
General Start
Start I Diff
Start Z1
Start Z2
Start Elements 1 01 08 Start Z3
Start ZP
Start Z4
Start I>1
Start I>2

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B5
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Start I>3
Start I>4
Start IN1>1
Start IN1>2
Start IN1>3
Start IN1>4
Start ISEF>1
Start ISEF>2
Start ISEF>3
Start ISEF>4
Thermal Alarm
Start NVD 1
Start NVD 2
Start I2>1
Start I2>2
Start I2>3
Start I2>4
Start F<1
Start F<2
Start F<3
Start F<4
Start F>1
Start F>2
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the first 32 start signals.
Start V<1
Start V<2
Start V<A
Start V<B
Start V<C
Start V>1
Start V>2
Start V>A
Start V>B
Start V>C
Start df/dt>1
Start df/dt>2
Start df/dt>3
Start df/dt>4
Delta I2 Low
Delta I2 High
Start Elements 2 01 09 Delta I1 Low
Delta I1 High
I2 Low
I2 High
I1 Low
I1 High
V2 Low
V2 High
Z2 Low
Z2 High
Z3 Low
Z3 High
Z4 Low
Z4 High
Zp Low
Zp High
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the second 32 start signals.
Any Trip
Trip I Diff
Trip Elements(1) 01 0A
InterTrip I Diff
PIT

B6 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Trip Z1
Trip Z2
Trip Z3
Trip ZP
Trip Z4
Aid 1 Dist Trip
Aid 1 Delta Trip
Aid 1 DEF Trip
Aided 1 WI
Aid 2 Dist Trip
Aid 2 Delta Trip
Aid 2 DEF Trip
Aided 2 WI
TOR
SOTF
LOL
Stub Bus Trip
Trip F<1
Trip F<2
Trip F<3
Trip F<4
Trip F>1
Trip F>2
Trip df/dt>1
Trip df/dt>2
Trip df/dt>3
Trip df/dt>4
Phase Comparison
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the first 32 trip signals.
Trip I>1
Trip I>2
Trip I>3
Trip I>4
Trip Broken Line
Trip IN1>1
Trip IN1>2
Trip IN1>3
Trip IN1>4
Trip ISEF>1
Trip ISEF>2
Trip ISEF>3
Trip ISEF>4
Trip Thermal
Trip NVD 1
Trip NVD 2
Trip Elements(2) 01 0B Trip I2>1
Trip V< 1
Trip V< 2
Trip V< A
Trip V< B
Trip V< C
Trip V> 1
Trip V> 2
Trip V> A
Trip V> B
Trip V> C
Pred. OST
OST
Trip I2>2
Trip I2>3
Trip I2>4
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B7
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Displays the status of the second 32 trip signals.
CB Fail 1
CB Fail 2
A/R Trip 1
A/R Trip 2
A/R Trip 3
A/R Trip 4
A/R Trip 5
Fault Alarms 01 0C VTS
PSB
CB2 Fail 1
CB2 Fail 2
CTS1
CTS2
Remote CTS
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the fault alarm signals.
Fault Time
Fault Time 01 0D
[IEC870 Time & Date]
Displays fault time and date.
Active Group
Active Group 01 0E
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Displays active setting group
System Frequency
System Frequency 01 0F
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Displays the system frequency
Fault Duration
Fault Duration 01 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Displays time from the start or trip until the undercurrent elements indicate the CB is open
CB Operate Time
CB Operate Time 01 11
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Displays time from protection trip to undercurrent elements indicating the CB is open
Relay Trip Time
Relay Trip Time 01 12
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Displays time from protection start to protection trip
Fault Location
Fault Location 01 13
[Courier Number (metres)]
Displays fault location in metres.
Fault Location
Fault Location 01 14
[Courier Number (miles)]
Displays fault location in miles.
Fault Location
Fault Location 01 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Displays fault location in ohms.
Fault Location
Fault Location 01 16
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Displays fault location in percentage.
CB2 Operate Time
CB2 Operate Time 01 17
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Displays time from protection trip to undercurrent elements indicating the CB2 is open
V1>1 Cmp Start
V1>2 Cmp Start
Start Elements 3 01 1A
Start I>>Diff
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the third 32 start signals.
V1>1 Cmp Trip
V1>2 Cmp Trip
Trip Elements(3) 01 1C
Trip I>>Diff
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
Displays the status of the third 32 trip signals.

B8 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IA Angle Pre Flt
IA Angle Pre Flt 01 20
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IA Angle Pre Flt
IA Angle Pre Flt 01 21
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IB Angle Pre Flt
IB Angle Pre Flt 01 22
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Angle Pre Flt
IB Angle Pre Flt 01 23
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IC Angle Pre Flt
IC Angle Pre Flt 01 24
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Angle Pre Flt
IC Angle Pre Flt 01 25
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IN Angle Pre Flt
IN Angle Pre Flt 01 26
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IN Angle Pre Flt
IN Angle Pre Flt 01 27
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IM Angle Pre Flt
IM Angle Pre Flt 01 28
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IM Angle Pre Flt
IM Angle Pre Flt 01 29
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VA Pre Flt
VA Pre Flt 01 30
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VA Angle Pre Flt
VA Angle Pre Flt 01 31
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VB Pre Flt
VB Pre Flt 01 32
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VB Angle Pre Flt
VB Angle Pre Flt 01 33
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VC Pre Flt
VC Pre Flt 01 34
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VC Angle Pre Flt
VC Angle Pre Flt 01 35
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VN Pre Flt
VN Pre Flt 01 36
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VN Angle Pre Flt
VN Angle Pre Flt 01 37
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IA Fault
IA Fault 01 40
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IA Angle Fault
IA Angle Fault 01 41
[Courier Number (degrees)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B9
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
IB Fault
IB Fault 01 42
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Angle Fault
IB Angle Fault 01 43
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IC Fault
IC Fault 01 44
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Angle Fault
IC Angle Fault 01 45
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IN Fault
IN Fault 01 46
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IN Angle Fault
IN Angle Fault 01 47
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
IM Fault
IM Fault 01 48
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IM Angle Fault
IM Angle Fault 01 49
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VA Fault
VA Fault 01 50
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VA Angle Fault
VA Angle Fault 01 51
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VB Fault
VB Fault 01 52
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VB Angle Fault
VB Angle Fault 01 53
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VC Fault
VC Fault 01 54
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VC Angle Fault
VC Angle Fault 01 55
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
VN Fault
VN Fault 01 56
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VN Angle Fault
VN Angle Fault 01 57
[Courier Number (degrees)]
Measured parameter
Ch 1 Prop Delay
Ch 1 Prop Delay 01 73
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
Ch 2 Prop Delay
Ch 2 Prop Delay 01 74
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
V1 Rem Magnitude
V1 Rem Magnitude 01 98
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V1 Rem Phase Ang 01 99 V1 Rem Phase Ang

B10 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
From 0 to 9 in steps of 1
Select Maint 01 F0 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Range from 0 to 4. This selects the required maintenance report from the possible 5 that may be stored. A value of 0 corresponds to the
latest report and so on.
Maint Text
Maint Text 01 F1
[ASCII Text (32)]
Up to 16 Character description of the occurrence (refer to following sections).
Maint Type
Maint Type 01 F2
[UINT32]
These cells are numbers representative of the occurrence. They form a specific error code which should be quoted in any related
correspondence to Report Data.
Maint Data
Maint Data 01 F3
[UINT32]
These cells are numbers representative of the occurrence. They form a specific error code which should be quoted in any related
correspondence to Report Data.
Evt Iface Source
Evt Iface Source 01 FA
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

Evt Access Level


Evt Access Level 01 FB
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Any security event that indicates that it came from an interface action, such as disabling a port, will also record the access level of the
interface that initiated the event. This will be recorded in the ‘Event State’ field of the event.
Evt Extra Info
Evt Extra Info 01 FC
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

High order word of long stored in 1st register


Evt Unique Id 01 FE Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[UINT32]
Each event will have a unique event id. The event id is a 32 bit unsigned integer that is incremented for each new event record and is stored
in the record in battery-backed memory (BBRAM). The current event id must be non-volatile so as to preserve it during power cycles, thus it
too will be stored in BBRAM. The event id will wrap back to zero when it reaches its maximum (4,294,967,295). The event id will be used by PC
based utilities when organising extracted logs from relays.
No
Reset Indication 01 FF No Yes
[Indexed String]
This serves to reset the trip LED indications provided that the relevant protection element has reset.
MEASUREMENTS 1 02 00
This column contains measurement parameters
IA Magnitude
IA Magnitude 02 01
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IA Phase Angle
IA Phase Angle 02 02
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IB Magnitude
IB Magnitude 02 03
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Phase Angle
IB Phase Angle 02 04
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IC Magnitude
IC Magnitude 02 05
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Phase Angle
IC Phase Angle 02 06
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IN Derived Mag
IN Derived Mag 02 09
[Courier Number (current)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B11
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
IN Derived Angle
IN Derived Angle 02 0A
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
ISEF Magnitude
ISEF Magnitude 02 0B
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
ISEF Angle
ISEF Angle 02 0C
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
I1 Magnitude
I1 Magnitude 02 0D
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
I2 Magnitude
I2 Magnitude 02 0E
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
I0 Magnitude
I0 Magnitude 02 0F
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IA RMS
IA RMS 02 10
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB RMS
IB RMS 02 11
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC RMS
IC RMS 02 12
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
VAB Magnitude
VAB Magnitude 02 14
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VAB Phase Angle
VAB Phase Angle 02 15
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
VBC Magnitude
VBC Magnitude 02 16
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VBC Phase Angle
VBC Phase Angle 02 17
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
VCA Magnitude
VCA Magnitude 02 18
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VCA Phase Angle
VCA Phase Angle 02 19
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
VAN Magnitude
VAN Magnitude 02 1A
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VAN Phase Angle
VAN Phase Angle 02 1B
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
VBN Magnitude
VBN Magnitude 02 1C
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VBN Phase Angle
VBN Phase Angle 02 1D
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
VCN Magnitude 02 1E VCN Magnitude

B12 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VCN Phase Angle
VCN Phase Angle 02 1F
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
V1 Magnitude
V1 Magnitude 02 24
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V2 Magnitude
V2 Magnitude 02 25
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V0 Magnitude
V0 Magnitude 02 26
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VAN RMS
VAN RMS 02 27
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VBN RMS
VBN RMS 02 28
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
VCN RMS
VCN RMS 02 29
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
Frequency
Frequency 02 2D
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Measured parameter
C/S Voltage Mag
C/S Voltage Mag 02 2E
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
C/S Voltage Ang
C/S Voltage Ang 02 2F
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IM Magnitude
IM Magnitude 02 32
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IM Phase Angle
IM Phase Angle 02 33
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
CB1 Bus-Line Mag
CB1 Bus-Line Mag 02 3A
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
CB2 Bus-Line Mag
CB2 Bus-Line Mag 02 3B
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
I1 Magnitude
I1 Magnitude 02 40
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
I1 Phase Angle
I1 Phase Angle 02 41
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
I2 Magnitude
I2 Magnitude 02 42
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
I2 Phase Angle
I2 Phase Angle 02 43
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
I0 Magnitude
I0 Magnitude 02 44
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B13
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
I0 Phase Angle
I0 Phase Angle 02 45
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
V1 Magnitude
V1 Magnitude 02 46
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V1 Phase Angle
V1 Phase Angle 02 47
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
V2 Magnitude
V2 Magnitude 02 48
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V2 Phase Angle
V2 Phase Angle 02 49
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
V0 Magnitude
V0 Magnitude 02 4A
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V0 Phase Angle
V0 Phase Angle 02 4B
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
CB2 CS Volt Mag
CB2 CS Volt Mag 02 4C
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
CB2 CS Volt Ang
CB2 CS Volt Ang 02 4D
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
CB2 Bus-Line Ang
CB2 Bus-Line Ang 02 4E
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
CB2 CS Slip Freq
CB2 CS Slip Freq 02 4F
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Measured parameter
V1 Rem Magnitude
V1 Rem Magnitude 02 50
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Measured parameter
V1 Rem Phase Ang
V1 Rem Phase Ang 02 51
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IA CT1 Magnitude
IA CT1 Magnitude 02 52
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IA CT1 Phase Ang
IA CT1 Phase Ang 02 53
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IB CT1 Magnitude
IB CT1 Magnitude 02 54
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB CT1 Phase Ang
IB CT1 Phase Ang 02 55
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IC CT1 Magnitude
IC CT1 Magnitude 02 56
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC CT1 Phase Ang
IC CT1 Phase Ang 02 57
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IA CT2 Magnitude
IA CT2 Magnitude 02 58
[Courier Number (current)]

B14 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
IA CT2 Phase Ang
IA CT2 Phase Ang 02 59
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IB CT2 Magnitude
IB CT2 Magnitude 02 5A
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB CT2 Phase Ang
IB CT2 Phase Ang 02 5B
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
IC CT2 Magnitude
IC CT2 Magnitude 02 5C
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC CT2 Phase Ang
IC CT2 Phase Ang 02 5D
[Courier Number (angle)]
Measured parameter
MEASUREMENTS 2 03 00
This column contains measurement parameters
A Phase Watts
A Phase Watts 03 01
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
B Phase Watts
B Phase Watts 03 02
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
C Phase Watts
C Phase Watts 03 03
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
A Phase VArs
A Phase VArs 03 04
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
B Phase VArs
B Phase VArs 03 05
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
C Phase VArs
C Phase VArs 03 06
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
A Phase VA
A Phase VA 03 07
[Courier Number (VA)]
Measured parameter
B Phase VA
B Phase VA 03 08
[Courier Number (VA)]
Measured parameter
C Phase VA
C Phase VA 03 09
[Courier Number (VA)]
Measured parameter
3 Phase Watts
3 Phase Watts 03 0A
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
3 Phase VArs
3 Phase VArs 03 0B
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
3 Phase VA
3 Phase VA 03 0C
[Courier Number (VA)]
Measured parameter
3Ph Power Factor
3Ph Power Factor 03 0E
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Measured parameter
APh Power Factor
APh Power Factor 03 0F
[Courier Number (decimal)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B15
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
BPh Power Factor
BPh Power Factor 03 10
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Measured parameter
CPh Power Factor
CPh Power Factor 03 11
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Measured parameter
3Ph WHours Fwd
3Ph WHours Fwd 03 12
[Courier Number (Wh)]
Measured parameter
3Ph WHours Rev
3Ph WHours Rev 03 13
[Courier Number (Wh)]
Measured parameter
3Ph VArHours Fwd
3Ph VArHours Fwd 03 14
[Courier Number (VArh)]
Measured parameter
3Ph VArHours Rev
3Ph VArHours Rev 03 15
[Courier Number (VArh)]
Measured parameter
3Ph W Fix Demand
3Ph W Fix Demand 03 16
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
3Ph VArs Fix Dem
3Ph VArs Fix Dem 03 17
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
IA Fixed Demand
IA Fixed Demand 03 18
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Fixed Demand
IB Fixed Demand 03 19
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Fixed Demand
IC Fixed Demand 03 1A
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
3Ph W Roll Dem
3Ph W Roll Dem 03 1B
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
3Ph VArs RollDem
3Ph VArs RollDem 03 1C
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
IA Roll Demand
IA Roll Demand 03 1D
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Roll Demand
IB Roll Demand 03 1E
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Roll Demand
IC Roll Demand 03 1F
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
3Ph W Peak Dem
3Ph W Peak Dem 03 20
[Courier Number (power)]
Measured parameter
3Ph VAr Peak Dem
3Ph VAr Peak Dem 03 21
[Courier Number (VAr)]
Measured parameter
IA Peak Demand
IA Peak Demand 03 22
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IB Peak Demand 03 23 IB Peak Demand

B16 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
IC Peak Demand
IC Peak Demand 03 24
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
No
Reset Demand 03 25 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Measured parameter
Thermal State
Thermal State 03 26
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Measured parameter
No
Reset Thermal 03 27 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Measured parameter
Bit 31 = sign
Bits 30-23 = e7 - e0
df/dt 03 29 Implicit 1.
Bits 22-0 = f22 - f0
[Courier Number (Hz/sec)]
Measured parameter
MEASUREMENTS 4 05 00
This column contains measurement parameters
Ch 1 Prop Delay
Ch 1 Prop Delay 05 01
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
Ch 2 Prop Delay
Ch 2 Prop Delay 05 02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
Rx
Tx
Local GPS
Remote GPS
Mux Clk F Error
Signal Lost
Path Yellow
Channel 1 Status 05 07 Mismatch RxN
Timeout
Message Level
Passthrough
H/W B to J mode
Max PropDelay
Max Tx-RxTime
[Binary Flag (11) & Indexed String]
Measured parameter
Rx
Tx
Local GPS
Remote GPS
Mux Clk F Error
Signal Lost
Path Yellow
Channel 2 Status 05 08 Mismatch RxN
Timeout
Message Level
Passthrough
H/W B to J mode
Max PropDelay
Max Tx-RxTime
[Binary Flag (11) & Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B17
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
IM64 Rx Status
IM64 Rx Status 05 09
[Binary Flag (16) & Indexed String]
Measured parameter
STATISTICS 05 10
Measured parameter
Stats Reset on
Stats Reset on 05 11
[(Sub Heading)]
Measured parameter
Date/Time
Date/Time 05 12
[IEC870 Time & Date]
Measured parameter
Ch1 No.Vald Mess
Ch1 No.Vald Mess 05 13
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch1 No.Err Mess
Ch1 No.Err Mess 05 14
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch1 No.Errored s
Ch1 No.Errored s 05 15
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch1 No.Sev Err s
Ch1 No.Sev Err s 05 16
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch1 No.Dgraded m
Ch1 No.Dgraded m 05 17
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch2 No.Vald Mess
Ch2 No.Vald Mess 05 18
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch2 No.Err Mess
Ch2 No.Err Mess 05 19
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch2 No.Errored s
Ch2 No.Errored s 05 1A
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch2 No.Sev Err s
Ch2 No.Sev Err s 05 1B
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
Ch2 No.Dgraded m
Ch2 No.Dgraded m 05 1C
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Measured parameter
MaxCh1 PropDelay
MaxCh1 PropDelay 05 26
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
MaxCh2 PropDelay
MaxCh2 PropDelay 05 27
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
No
Clear Statistics 05 30 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Reset All Values
CB CONDITION 06 00
This column contains CB Condition Monitoring Measured Parameters
CB A Operations
CB A Operations 06 02
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Measured parameter
CB B Operations
CB B Operations 06 03
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

B18 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Measured parameter
CB C Operations
CB C Operations 06 04
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Measured parameter
Total IA Broken
Total IA Broken 06 05
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
Total IB Broken
Total IB Broken 06 06
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
Total IC Broken
Total IC Broken 06 07
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
CB Operate Time
CB Operate Time 06 08
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
No
Reset CB Data 06 09 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Reset All Values
I^ Maint Alarm
I^ Lockout Alarm
CB OPs Maint
CB OPs Lock
CB Time Maint
CB Time Lockout
Fault Freq Lock
CB Monitoring 06 10 I^ Maint Alarm
I^ Lockout Alarm
CB2 OPs Maint
CB2 OPs Lock
CB2 Time Maint
CB2 Time Lockout
Fault Freq Lock
[Binary Flag (14) & Indexed String]
Measured parameter
CB2 A Operations
CB2 A Operations 06 12
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Measured parameter
CB2 B Operations
CB2 B Operations 06 13
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Measured parameter
CB2 C Operations
CB2 C Operations 06 14
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Measured parameter
CB2 IA Broken
CB2 IA Broken 06 15
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
CB2 IB Broken
CB2 IB Broken 06 16
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
CB2 IC Broken
CB2 IC Broken 06 17
[Courier Number (current)]
Measured parameter
CB2 OperateTime
CB2 OperateTime 06 18
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Measured parameter
No
Reset CB2 Data 06 19 No Yes
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B19
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Reset All Values
CB CONTROL 07 00
This column controls the circuit Breaker Control configuration
Disabled
Local
Remote
Local+Remote
CB Control by 07 01 Disabled Opto
Opto+local
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+local
[Indexed String]
Selects the type of circuit breaker control to be used
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.01
Close Pulse Time 07 02 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Set period during which the CB should close when a CB close command is issued.
From 0.1 to 5 in steps of 0.01
Trip Pulse Time 07 03 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Set period during which the CB should trip when a CB trip command is issued.
From 0.01 to 600 in steps of 0.01
Man Close Delay 07 05 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Set delay after operator controlled CB close sequence is initiated, before a CB close output can be issued. (Allows operator to retire to a place
of safety before the CB close command is issued).
From 0.01 to 9999 in steps of 0.01
CB Healthy Time 07 06 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Maximum waiting time for input DDB: CB1 Healthy (= gas pressure OK, spring charged etc) to enable CB1 Close by manual control. Same
setting applies to DDB: CB2 Healthy to enable CB2 Close by manual control. If set time runs out with input DDB: CBx Healthy low (= 0), alarm
Control CBx Unhealthy is set and CB close sequence is cancelled.
From 0.01 to 9999 in steps of 0.01
Check Sync Time 07 07 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Maximum waiting time for input signal CB1MSCOK from system check logic, to enable CB1 Close by manual control. Same setting applies to
input signal CB2MSCOK to enable CB2 Close by manual control. If set time runs out with input signal CBxMSCOK low (= 0), alarm Control CBx
NoChSync is set and CB close sequence is cancelled.
No
CB mon LO reset 07 08 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Command to reset the CB monitoring Lockout Alarm
User Interface
Rst CB mon LO by 07 09 CB Close CB Close
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines if a lockout condition caused by CB monitoring conditions will be reset by a manual circuit breaker close command
or via the user interface.
From 0.1 to 600 in steps of 0.01
CB mon LO RstDly 07 0A 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
If Rst CB mon LO by is set to CB close then CB mon LO RstDly timer allows reset of CB lockout state after set time delay
No Operation
In Service
Autoreclose Mode 07 0B No Operation
Out of Service
[Indexed String]
Command to changes state of Auto-Reclose
Out of Service
AR Status 07 0E In Service
[Indexed String]
Auto Reclose - Inservice / Out of service
None
52A 3 pole
52B 3 pole
CB Status Input 07 11 52B 1 pole 52A & 52B 3 pole
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole

B20 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the type of circuit breaker contacts that will be used for the circuit breaker control logic. Form A contacts match the status
of the circuit breaker primary contacts, form B are opposite to the breaker status.
When 1 pole is selected, individual contacts must be assigned in the Programmable Scheme Logic for phase A, phase B, and phase C. Setting
3 pole means that only a single contact is used, common to all 3 poles.
From 0.1 to 5 in steps of 0.01
CB Status Time 07 7F 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Under healthy conditions the circuit breaker auxiliary contacts will be in opposite states. Should both sets of contacts be open or closed, it
indicates that either the contacts, or the wiring, or the circuit breaker are defective and an alarm will be issued after CB Status Time delay.
The time delay is set to avoid unwanted operation during normal switching duties.
None
52A 3 pole
52B 3 pole
52A & 52B 3 pole
CB2 Status Input 07 80 52B 1 pole
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the type of circuit breaker contacts that will be used for the circuit breaker control logic. Form A contacts match the status
of the circuit breaker primary contacts, form B are opposite to the breaker status.
When 1 pole is selected, individual contacts must be assigned in the Programmable Scheme Logic for phase A, phase B, and phase C. Setting
3 pole means that only a single contact is used, common to all 3 poles.
No Operation
Set
CTRL CB2 Lead 07 81 Reset
Reset
[Indexed String]
If Leader Select By is set to Control, this user control determines the preferred leader: Set / Reset (Reset = CB1 lead; Set = CB2 lead). This
command is NON VOLATILE
No
Reset AROK Ind 07 82 No Yes
[Indexed String]
If Res AROK by UI is set to Enabled, this command provides a pulse to reset the successful AR indication for both CB's
No
Reset CB1 LO 07 83 No Yes
[Indexed String]
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, this command provides a pulse to reset the lockout for CB1.
Note: This requires the condition that caused the lockout to have been cleared.
No
Reset CB2 LO 07 84 No Yes
[Indexed String]
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, this command provides a pulse to reset the lockout for CB2.
Note: This requires the condition that caused the lockout to have been cleared.
CB1 Total Shots
CB1 Total Shots 07 85
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 reclosures
CB1 SUCC SPAR
CB1 SUCC SPAR 07 86
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 successful 1 pole reclosures
CB1SUCC3PARShot1
CB1SUCC3PARShot1 07 87
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 successful 3 pole reclosures at 1st shot
CB1SUCC3PARShot2
CB1SUCC3PARShot2 07 88
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 successful 3 pole reclosures at 2nd shot
CB1SUCC3PARShot3
CB1SUCC3PARShot3 07 89
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 successful 3 pole reclosures at 3rd shot
CB1SUCC3PARShot4
CB1SUCC3PARShot4 07 8A
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 successful 3 pole reclosures at 4th shot
CB1 Failed Shots 07 8B CB1 Failed Shots

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B21
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB1 failed reclose cycles
No
Reset CB1 Shots 07 8C No Yes
[Indexed String]
This command resets all CB1 shots counters to zero
CB2 Total Shots
CB2 Total Shots 07 8D
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 reclosures
CB2 SUCC SPAR
CB2 SUCC SPAR 07 8E
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 successful 1 pole reclosures
CB2SUCC3PARShot1
CB2SUCC3PARShot1 07 8F
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 successful 3 pole reclosures at 1st shot
CB2SUCC3PARShot2
CB2SUCC3PARShot2 07 90
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 successful 3 pole reclosures at 2nd shot
CB2SUCC3PARShot3
CB2SUCC3PARShot3 07 91
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 successful 3 pole reclosures at 3rd shot
CB2SUCC3PARShot4
CB2SUCC3PARShot4 07 92
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 successful 3 pole reclosures at 4th shot
CB2 Failed Shots
CB2 Failed Shots 07 93
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Indicates the total number of CB2 failed reclose cycles
No
Reset CB2 Shots 07 94 No Yes
[Indexed String]
This command resets all CB2 shots counters to zero
Disabled
Res AROK by UI 07 96 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If Enabled, this allows the successful auto-reclose signal to be reset by user interface command Reset AROK Ind.
Disabled
Res AROK by NoAR 07 97 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows "successful autoreclose" signal reset by selecting CB autoreclosing disabled
Disabled
Res AROK by Ext 07 98 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If Enabled, allows "successful autoreclose" signal reset by external DDB input
Disabled
Res AROK by TDly 07 99 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows "successful autoreclose" signal to reset after time AROK Reset Time
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
Res AROK by TDly 07 9A 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Reset time for "successful autoreclose" signal if Res AROK by TDly is set to Enabled
Disabled
Res LO by CB IS 07 9B Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows reset of CB lockout state when CB is "In Service" (= closed for t > CBIS Time)
Disabled
Res LO by UI 07 9C Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows reset of CB lockout state by UI command
Disabled
Res LO by NoAR 07 9D Disabled
Enabled

B22 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows reset of CB lockout state by selecting CB autoreclosing disabled
Disabled
Res LO by ExtDDB 07 9E Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows reset of CB lockout state by external DDB input
Disabled
Res LO by TDelay 07 9F Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
if Enabled, allows reset of CB lockout state after time LO Reset Time
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
LO Reset Time 07 A0 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
CB lockout reset time if Res LO by TDelay is set to Enabled
DATE and TIME 08 00
This column contains Date and Time stamp settings
Date/Time 08 01
Displays the relay’s current date and time.
Date/Time 08 N/A
Modbus only
Date 08 N/A
Displays the date. Front Panel Menu only
Time 08 N/A
Displays the time. Front Panel Menu only
Dead
Battery Status 08 06 Healthy
[Indexed String]
Displays whether the battery is healthy or not
Disabled
Battery Alarm 08 07 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines whether an unhealthy relay battery condition is alarmed or not
IRIG-B
None
Primary Source 08 08 PTP PTP
SNTP
[Indexed String]
Sets the primary time synchronisation source
IRIG-B
None
Secondary Source 08 09 None PTP
SNTP
[Indexed String]
Sets the secondary time synchronisation source
From 0 to 127 in steps of 1
Domain Number 08 0F 0
[Integers]
Assigns the PTP domain number. A domain is grouping of PTP clocks that synchronise to each other on a network.
This provides a way of implementing independent synchronisation of PTP clocks on a shared network
IRIG-B
None
Act. Time Source 08 10 PTP
SNTP
[Indexed String]
Displays the active time synchronisation source being used.

‘Free Running’ means the IED is not synchronised with any normal time-server, including IRIG-B, PTP or SNTP. The IED relies solely on its
internal clock.
Card Not Fitted
Card Failed
IRIG-B Status 08 11
Signal Healthy
No Signal

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B23
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Displays the status of IRIG-B
Not Master Found
Illegal Master
PTP Status 08 12
Valid master
[Indexed String]
IEC61850 or DNP3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Displays the status of PTP time synchronisation

No Master Found = No PTP master can be found, the IED has not received a valid ‘Announce’ message.
Illegal Master = Master clock is not valid, typically this will occur when the clock is not using the correct epoch
Valid Master = At least valid one master clock is available
Disabled
Trying server 1
Trying server 2
Server 1 OK
SNTP Status 08 13
Server 2 OK
No response
No valid clock
[Indexed String]
IEC61850 or DNP3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Displays information about the SNTP time synchronisation status.
Disabled
Fixed
LocalTime Enable 08 20 Flexible
Flexible
[Indexed String]
Setting to turn on/off local time adjustments.
Disabled - No local time zone will be maintained. Time synchronization from any interface will be used to directly set the master clock and all
displayed (or read) times on all interfaces will be based on the master clock with no adjustment.
Fixed - A local time zone adjustment can be defined using the LocalTime offset setting and all interfaces will use local time except SNTP time
synchronization and IEC 61850 timestamps.
Flexible - A local time zone adjustment can be defined using the LocalTime offset setting and each interface can be assigned to the UTC zone
or local time zone with the exception of the local interfaces which will always be in the local time zone and IEC 61850/SNTP which will always
be in the UTC zone.
From -720 to 720 in steps of 15
LocalTime Offset 08 21 0
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify an offset of -12 to +12 hrs in 15 minute intervals for local time zone. This adjustment is applied to the time based on the
master clock which is UTC/GMT
Disabled
DST Enable 08 22 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to turn on/off daylight saving time adjustment to local time.
30 or 60
DST Offset 08 23 60
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify daylight saving offset which will be used for the time adjustment to local time.
First
Second
Third
DST Start 08 24 Last
Fourth
Last
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the week of the month in which daylight saving time adjustment starts
Sunday
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
DST Start Day 08 25 Sunday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the day of the week in which daylight saving time adjustment starts
January
DST Start Month 08 26 March
February

B24 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
March
April
May
June
July
August
September
October
November
December
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the month in which daylight saving time adjustment starts
From 0 to 1425 in steps of 15
DST Start Mins 08 27 60
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify the time of day in which daylight saving time adjustment starts. This is set relative to 00:00 hrs on the selected day when
time adjustment is to start
First
Second
Third
DST End 08 28 Last
Fourth
Last
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the week of the month in which daylight saving time adjustment ends
Sunday
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
DST End Day 08 29 Sunday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the day of the week in which daylight saving time adjustment ends
January
February
March
April
May
June
DST End Month 08 2A October July
August
September
October
November
December
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the month in which daylight saving time adjustment ends
From 0 to 1425 in steps of 15
DST End Mins 08 2B 60
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify the time of day in which daylight saving time adjustment ends. This is set relative to 00:00 hrs on the selected day when
time adjustment is to end
UTC
RP1 Time Zone 08 30 UTC Local
[Indexed String]
Setting for the rear port 1 interface to specify if time synchronization received will be local or universal time co-ordinated
UTC
RP2 Time Zone 08 31 UTC Local
[Indexed String]
Setting for the rear port 2 interface to specify if time synchronization received will be local or universal time co-ordinated
UTC
DNPOE Time Zone 08 32 UTC Local
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B25
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
DNP3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Setting to specify if time synchronisation received will be local or universal time
co-ordinate.
UTC
Tunnel Time Zone 08 33 UTC Local
[Indexed String]
Ethernet versions only for tunnelled courier. Setting to specify if time synchronization received will be local or universal time co-ordinate
CONFIGURATION 09 00
This column contains all the general configuration options
No Operation
All Settings
Setting Group 1
Restore Defaults 09 01 No Operation Setting Group 2
Setting Group 3
Setting Group 4
[Indexed String]
Setting to restore a setting group to factory default settings.
To restore the default values to the settings in any Group settings, set the ‘restore defaults’ cell to the relevant Group number. Alternatively it
is possible to set the ‘restore defaults’ cell to ‘all settings’ to restore the default values to all of the IED’s settings, not just the Group settings.
The default settings will initially be placed in the scratchpad and will only be used by the relay after they have been confirmed by the user.
Note: Restoring defaults to all settings includes the rear communication port settings, which may result in communication via the rear port
being disrupted if the new (default) settings do not match those of the master station.
Select via Menu
Setting Group 09 02 Select via Menu Select via PSL
[Indexed String]
Allows setting group changes to be initiated via Opto Input or via Menu
Group 1
Group 2
Active Settings 09 03 Group 1 Group 3
Group 4
[Indexed String]
Selects the active setting group.
No Operation
Save
Save Changes 09 04 No Operation
Abort
[Indexed String]
Saves all relay settings.
Group 1
Group 2
Copy From 09 05 Group 1 Group 3
Group 4
[Indexed String]
Allows displayed settings to be copied from a selected setting group
No Operation
Group 1
Group 2
Copy To 09 06 No Operation
Group 3
Group 4
[Indexed String]
Allows displayed settings to be copied to a selected setting group (ready to paste).
Disabled
Setting Group 1 09 07 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Settings Group 1. If the setting group is disabled from the configuration, then all associated settings and signals are hidden, with the
exception of this setting (paste).
Disabled
Setting Group 2 09 08 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Settings Group 2. If the setting group is disabled from the configuration, then all associated settings and signals are hidden, with the
exception of this setting (paste).
Disabled
Setting Group 3 09 09 Disabled
Enabled

B26 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Settings Group 3. If the setting group is disabled from the configuration, then all associated settings and signals are hidden, with the
exception of this setting (paste).
Disabled
Setting Group 4 09 0A Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Settings Group 4. If the setting group is disabled from the configuration, then all associated settings and signals are hidden, with the
exception of this setting (paste).
Disabled
Distance 09 0B Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Only in models with Distance option. To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Distance Protection: ANSI 21P/21G.
Disabled
Directional E/F 09 0C Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Only in models with Distance option. To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Directional Earth Fault (DEF) Protection used in a pilot aided
scheme: ANSI 67N.
This protection is independent from back up Earth fault protection described below.
Disabled
Overcurrent 09 10 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Phase Overcurrent Protection function. I> stages: ANSI 50/51/67P
Disabled
Neg Sequence O/C 09 11 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection function. I2> stages: ANSI 46/67
Disabled
Broken Conductor 09 12 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Broken Conductor function. I2/I1> stage: ANSI 46BC
Disabled
Earth Fault 09 13 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the back up Earth Fault Protection function. IN >stages: ANSI 50/51/67N
Disabled
SEF/REF Prot'n 09 15 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Sensitive Earth Fault/Restricted Earth fault Protection function.
ISEF >stages: ANSI 50/51/67N. IREF>stage: ANSI 64.
Disabled
Residual O/V NVD 09 16 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Residual Overvoltage Protection function. VN>stages: ANSI 59N
Disabled
Thermal Overload 09 17 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Thermal Overload Protection function. ANSI 49.
Disabled
PowerSwing Block 09 18 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Only in models with Distance option. To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the power swing blocking/out of step: ANSI 68/78.
Disabled
Volt Protection 09 1D Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Voltage Protection (under/overvoltage) function. V<, V> stages: ANSI 27/59.
Disabled
Freq Protection 09 1E Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Frequency Protection (under/over frequency) function. F<, F> stages: ANSI 81O/U.
df/dt Protection 09 1F Disabled Disabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B27
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Rate of change of Frequency Protection function. df/dt> stages: ANSI 81R.
Disabled
CB Fail 09 20 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Circuit Breaker Fail Protection function. ANSI 50BF.
Disabled
Supervision 09 21 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Supervision (VTS & CTS) functions. ANSI VTS/CTS.
Disabled
System Checks 09 23 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the System Checks (Check Sync. and Voltage Monitor) function: ANSI 25.
Disabled
Auto-Reclose 09 24 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Auto-reclose function. ANSI 79.
Invisible
Input Labels 09 25 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Input Labels menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
Output Labels 09 26 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Output Labels menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
CT & VT Ratios 09 28 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Current & Voltage Transformer Ratios menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
Record Control 09 29 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Record Control menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
Disturb Recorder 09 2A Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Disturbance Recorder menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
Measure't Setup 09 2B Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Measurement Setup menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Invisible
Comms Settings 09 2C Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Communications Settings menu visible further on in the relay settings menu. These are the settings associated with the 2nd rear
communications ports.
Invisible
Commission Tests 09 2D Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Commissioning Tests menu visible further on in the relay settings menu.
Primary
Setting Values 09 2E Primary Secondary
[Indexed String]
This affects all protection settings that are dependent upon CT and VT ratios. All subsequent settings input must be based in terms of this
reference.
Invisible
Control Inputs 09 2F Visible Visible
[Indexed String]

B28 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Activates the Control Input status and operation menu further on in the relay setting menu.
Invisible
Ctrl I/P Config 09 35 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Control Input Configuration menu visible further on in the relay setting menu.
Invisible
Ctrl I/P Labels 09 36 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Control Input Labels menu visible further on in the relay setting menu.
Disabled
Enabled
Direct Access 09 39 Enabled Hotkey Only
CB Ctrl Only
[Indexed String]
Defines what CB control direct access is allowed. The front direct access keys that are used as a short cut function of the menu may be:
Disabled – No function visible on the LCD.
Enabled – All control functions mapped to the Hotkeys and Control Trip/Close are available.
Hotkey Only – Only control functions mapped to the Hotkeys are available on the LCD.
CB Ctrl Only – Only Control Trip/Control Close command will appear on the relay’s LCD.
Disabled
InterMiCOM 09 40 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) EIA (RS) 232 InterMiCOM (integrated teleprotection).
Disabled
InterMiCOM 64 09 41 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) InterMiCOM64 (integrated 56/64kbit/s teleprotection). Note that Phase Diff setting and InterMiCOM64
Fiber setting are mutually exclusive as with Phase Diff enabled, the digital message exchanged has the structure of the differential message
(i.e. currents are sent to the remote end, etc) and with InterMiCOM64 Fiber the digital message exchanged has the structure and properties
of the InterMiCOM64 Fiber.
Invisible
Function Key 09 50 Visible Visible
[Indexed String]
Sets the Function Key menu visible further on in the relay setting menu.
Disabled
RP1 Read Only 09 FB Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) Read Only Mode of Rear Port 1.
Disabled
RP2 Read Only 09 FC Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) Read Only Mode of Rear Port 2.
Disabled
NIC Read Only 09 FD Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Ethernet versions only. To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) Read Only Mode of Network Interface Card.
From 0 to 31 in steps of 1
LCD Contrast 09 FF 11
[Indexed String]
Sets the LCD contrast.
CT AND VT RATIOS 0A 00
This column contains settings for Current and Voltage Transformer ratios
From 100 to 1000000 in steps of 1
Main VT Primary 0A 01 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the main voltage transformer input primary voltage.
From 80*V1 to 140*V1 in steps of 1*V1
Main VT Sec'y 0A 02 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the main voltage transformer input secondary voltage.
From 100 to 1000000 in steps of 1
CB1 CS VT Prim'y 0A 03 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the CB1 check sync. voltage transformer input primary voltage.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B29
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 80*V2 to 140*V2 in steps of 1*V2
CB1 CS VT Sec'y 0A 04 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the CB1 check sync. voltage transformer input secondary voltage.
From 100 to 1000000 in steps of 1
CB2 CS VT Prim'y 0A 05 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the CB2 check sync. voltage transformer input primary voltage.
From 80*V2 to 140*V2 in steps of 1*V2
CB2 CS VT Sec'y 0A 06 110
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the CB2 check sync. voltage transformer input secondary voltage.
From 1 to 30000 in steps of 1
Phase CT Primary 0A 07 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the phase current transformer input primary current rating.
1 or 5
Phase CT Sec'y 0A 08 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the phase current transformer input secondary current rating.
From 1 to 30000 in steps of 1
SEF CT Primary 0A 0B 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the sensitive earth fault current transformer input primary current rating.
1 or 5
SEF CT Secondary 0A 0C 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the sensitive earth fault current transformer input secondary current rating.
From 1 to 30000 in steps of 1
MComp CT Primary 0A 0D 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the mutual compensation current transformer input primary current rating.
1 or 5
MComp CT Sec'y 0A 0E 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the mutual compensation current transformer input secondary current rating.
AN
BN
CN
AB
BC
CS Input 0A 0F AN
CA
AN/1.732
BN/1.732
CN/1.732
[Indexed String]
Selects the System Check Synchronism Input voltage measurement.
Standard
CT2 Polarity 0A 12 Standard Inverted
[Indexed String]
To invert polarity (180 °) of the CT2
Standard
SEF CT Polarity 0A 13 Standard Inverted
[Indexed String]
To invert polarity (180 °) of the SEF CT
Standard
M CT Polarity 0A 14 Standard Inverted
[Indexed String]
To invert polarity (180 °) of the Mutual CT
From -180 to 180 in steps of 5
CB1 CS VT PhShft 0A 21 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Phase angle difference between selected phase ("C/S Input" 0A 0F) of Line VT input and applied "CB1 CS" VT input voltage under healthy
system conditions
From 0.2 to 3 in steps of 0.01
CB1 CS VT Mag 0A 22 1
[Courier Number]
Ratio of voltage magnitudes of selected phase ("C/S Input" 0A 0F) of Line VT input and applied "CB CS" VT input voltage under healthy system
conditions
From -180 to 180 in steps of 5
CB2 CS VT PhShft 0A 23 0
[Courier Number (angle)]

B30 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Phase angle difference between selected phase ("C/S Input" 0A 0F) of Line VT input and applied "CB2 CS" VT input voltage under healthy
system conditions
From 0.2 to 3 in steps of 0.01
CB2 CS VT Mag 0A 24 1
[Courier Number]
Ratio of voltage magnitudes of selected phase ("C/S Input" 0A 0F) of Line VT input and applied "CB2 CS" VT input voltage under healthy
system conditions
RECORD CONTROL 0B 00
This column contains settings for Record Controls
Disabled
Alarm Event 0B 04 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that all the occurrences that produce an alarm will result in no event being generated.
Disabled
Relay O/P Event 0B 05 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that no event will be generated for any change in logic state.
Disabled
Opto Input Event 0B 06 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that no event will be generated for any change in logic input state.
Disabled
General Event 0B 07 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that no General Events will be generated
Disabled
Fault Rec Event 0B 08 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that no event will be generated for any fault that produces a fault record
Disabled
Maint Rec Event 0B 09 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that no event will be generated for any occurrence that produces a maintenance record.
Disabled
Protection Event 0B 0A Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabling this setting means that any operation of protection elements will not be logged as an event
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 31 - 0 0B 40 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 63 - 32 0B 41 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 95 - 64 0B 42 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 127 - 96 0B 43 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 159 - 128 0B 44 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B31
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 191 - 160 0B 45 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 223 - 192 0B 46 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 255 - 224 0B 47 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 287 - 256 0B 48 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 319 - 288 0B 49 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 351 - 320 0B 4A 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 383 - 352 0B 4B 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 415 - 384 0B 4C 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 447 - 416 0B 4D 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 479 - 448 0B 4E 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 511 - 480 0B 4F 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 543 - 512 0B 50 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.

B32 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 575 - 544 0B 51 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 607 - 576 0B 52 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 639 - 608 0B 53 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 671 - 640 0B 54 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 703 - 672 0B 55 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 735 - 704 0B 56 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 767 - 736 0B 57 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 799 - 768 0B 58 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 831 - 800 0B 59 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 863 - 832 0B 5A 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 895 - 864 0B 5B 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 927 - 896 0B 5C 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
DDB 959 - 928 0B 5D 0xFFFFFFFF High order word of long stored in 1st register

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B33
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 991 - 960 0B 5E 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1023 - 992 0B 5F 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1055 - 1024 0B 60 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1087 - 1056 0B 61 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1119 - 1088 0B 62 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1151 - 1120 0B 63 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1183 - 1152 0B 64 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1215 - 1184 0B 65 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1247 - 1216 0B 66 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1279 - 1248 0B 67 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1311 - 1280 0B 68 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1343 - 1312 0B 69 0xFFFFFFFF
Low order word of long stored in 2nd register

B34 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1375 - 1344 0B 6A 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1407 - 1376 0B 6B 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1439 - 1408 0B 6C 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1471 - 1440 0B 6D 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1503 - 1472 0B 6E 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1535 - 1504 0B 6F 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1567 - 1536 0B 70 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1599 - 1568 0B 71 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1631 - 1600 0B 72 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1663 - 1632 0B 73 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1695 - 1664 0B 74 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1727 - 1696 0B 75 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B35
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1759 - 1728 0B 76 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1791 - 1760 0B 77 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1823 - 1792 0B 78 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1855 - 1824 0B 79 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1887 - 1856 0B 7A 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1919 - 1888 0B 7B 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1951 - 1920 0B 7C 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 1983 - 1952 0B 7D 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 2015 - 1984 0B 7E 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
High order word of long stored in 1st register
DDB 2047 - 2016 0B 7F 0xFFFFFFFF Low order word of long stored in 2nd register
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Chooses whether any individual DDBs should be deselected as a stored event, by setting the relevant bit to 0 (zero). Typically used for
repetitive recurrent changes such as an Opto input assigned for Minute Pulse clock synchronizing.
DISTURB RECORDER 0C 00
This column contains settings for the Disturbance Recorder
From 0.1 to 10.5 in steps of 0.01
Duration 0C 01 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
This sets the overall recording time.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.1
Trigger Position 0C 02 33.3
[Courier Number (percentage)]
This sets the trigger point as a percentage of the duration. For example, the default settings show that the overall recording time is set to
1.5 s with the trigger point being at 33.3% of this, giving 0.5 s pre-fault and 1s post fault recording times.

B36 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Single
Trigger Mode 0C 03 Single Extended
[Indexed String]
If set to single mode, if a further trigger occurs whilst a recording is taking place, the recorder will ignore the trigger. However, if this has
been set to Extended, the post trigger timer will be reset to zero, thereby extending the recording time.
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 1 0C 04 VA
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 2 0C 05 VB
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 3 0C 06 VC
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
Analog Channel 4 0C 07 IA
IN
IN Sensitive
VA

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B37
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
VB
VC
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 5 0C 08 IB
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 6 0C 09 IC
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 7 0C 0A IN
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).

B38 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel 8 0C 0B IN Sensitive
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 1 0C 0C Relay 1
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 1 Trigger 0C 0D No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 2 0C 0E Relay 2
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 2 Trigger 0C 0F No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 3 0C 10 Relay 3
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 3 Trigger 0C 11 Trigger L/H
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 4 0C 12 Relay 4
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 4 Trigger 0C 13 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 5 0C 14 Relay 5
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 5 Trigger 0C 15 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B39
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 6 0C 16 Relay 6
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 6 Trigger 0C 17 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 7 0C 18 Relay 7
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 7 Trigger 0C 19 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 8 0C 1A Relay 8
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 8 Trigger 0C 1B No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 9 0C 1C Relay 9
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 9 Trigger 0C 1D No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 10 0C 1E Relay 10
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 10 Trigger 0C 1F No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 11 0C 20 Relay 11
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 11 Trigger 0C 21 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 12 0C 22 Relay 12
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
Input 12 Trigger 0C 23 No Trigger No Trigger

B40 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Trigger L/H
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 13 0C 24 Relay 13
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 13 Trigger 0C 25 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 14 0C 26 Relay 14
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 14 Trigger 0C 27 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 15 0C 28 Opto Input 1
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 15 Trigger 0C 29 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 16 0C 2A Opto Input 2
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 16 Trigger 0C 2B No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 17 0C 2C Opto Input 3
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 17 Trigger 0C 2D No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 18 0C 2E Opto Input 4
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 18 Trigger 0C 2F No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 19 0C 30 Opto Input 5
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B41
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 19 Trigger 0C 31 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 20 0C 32 Opto Input 6
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 20 Trigger 0C 33 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 21 0C 34 Opto Input 7
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 21 Trigger 0C 35 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 22 0C 36 Opto Input 8
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 22 Trigger 0C 37 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 23 0C 38 Opto Input 9
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 23 Trigger 0C 39 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 24 0C 3A Opto Input 10
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 24 Trigger 0C 3B No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 25 0C 3C Opto Input 11
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 25 Trigger 0C 3D No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.

B42 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 26 0C 3E Opto Input 12
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 26 Trigger 0C 3F No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 27 0C 40 Opto Input 13
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 27 Trigger 0C 41 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 28 0C 42 Opto Input 14
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 28 Trigger 0C 43 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 29 0C 44 Opto Input 15
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 29 Trigger 0C 45 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
See Data Type G32 in Menus Database
Digital Input 30 0C 46 Opto Input 16
[Indexed String]
The digital channels may monitor any of the opto isolated inputs or output contacts, in addition to a number of internal relay digital signals,
such as protection starts, LEDs etc.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 30 Trigger 0C 47 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 31 Trigger 0C 49 No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
No Trigger
Trigger L/H
Input 32 Trigger 0C 4B No Trigger
Trigger H/L
[Indexed String]
Any of the digital channels may be selected to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to low transition.
IA
IB
IC
Analog Channel 9 0C 50 V Checksync
IN
IN Sensitive
VA

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B43
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
VB
VC
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel10 0C 51 IA2
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel11 0C 52 IB2
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).
IA
IB
IC
IN
IN Sensitive
VA
VB
VC
Analog Channel12 0C 53 IC2
IM
V Checksync
IA2
IB2
IC2
IN2
V Checksync2
[Indexed String]
Selects any available analogue input to be assigned to this channel (including derived IN residual current).

B44 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
MEASURE'T SETUP 0D 00
This column contains settings for the measurement setup
3Ph + N Current
3Ph Voltage
Power
Date and Time
Default Display 0D 01 Description Description
Plant Reference
Frequency
Access Level
[Indexed String]
This setting can be used to select the default display from a range of options, note that it is also possible to view the other default displays
whilst at the default level using the 4 and 6 keys. However once the 15 minute timeout elapses the default display will revert to that
selected by this setting.
Primary
Local Values 0D 02 Primary Secondary
[Indexed String]
This setting controls whether measured values via the front panel user interface and the front courier port are displayed as primary or
secondary quantities.
Primary
Remote Values 0D 03 Primary Secondary
[Indexed String]
This setting controls whether measured values via the rear communication port are displayed as primary or secondary quantities.
VA
VB
VC
Measurement Ref 0D 04 VA IA
IB
IC
[Indexed String]
Using this setting the phase reference for all angular measurements by the relay can be selected. This reference is for Measurements 1.
Measurements 3 uses always IA local as a reference
From 0 to 3 in steps of 1
Measurement Mode 0D 05 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
This setting is used to control the signing of the real and reactive power quantities; the signing convention used is defined in the
Measurements and Recording chapter (P54x/EN MR).
From 1 to 99 in steps of 1
Fix Dem Period 0D 06 30
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
This setting defines the length of the fixed demand window
From 1 to 99 in steps of 1
Roll Sub Period 0D 07 30
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
These two settings are used to set the length of the window used for the calculation of rolling demand quantities
From 1 to 15 in steps of 1
Num Sub Periods 0D 08 1
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
This setting is used to set the resolution of the rolling sub window
Kilometres
Distance Unit 0D 09 Miles Miles
[Indexed String]
This setting is used to select the unit of distance for fault location purposes, note that the length of the line is preserved when converting
from km to miles and vice versa
Distance
Ohms
Fault Location 0D 0A Distance
% of Line
[Indexed String]
The calculated fault location can be displayed using one of several options selected using this setting
Primary
Remote2 Values 0D 0B Primary Secondary
[Indexed String]
The setting defines whether the values measured via the 2nd Rear Communication port are displayed in primary or secondary terms.
COMMUNICATIONS 0E 00
This column contains general communications settings

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B45
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Courier
IEC870-5-103
RP1 Protocol 0E 01 Modbus
DNP 3.0
[Indexed String]
Indicates the communications protocol that will be used on the rear communications port.
From 0 to 255 in steps of 1
RP1 Address 0E 02 255
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Courier or IEC60870-5-103 versions only. This cell sets the unique address for the relay such that only one relay is accessed by master
station software.
From 0 to 65519 in steps of 1
RP1 Address 0E 02 1
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
DNP3.0 versions only. This cell sets the unique address for the relay such that only one relay is accessed by master station software.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
RP1 InactivTimer 0E 03 15
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
This cell controls how long the relay will wait without receiving any messages on the rear port before it reverts to its default state, including
resetting any password access that was enabled.
9600 bits/s
RP1 Baud Rate 0E 04 19200 bits/s 19200 bits/s
[Indexed String]
IEC60870-5-103 versions only. This cell controls the communication speed between relay and master station. It is important that both relay
and master station are set at the same speed setting.
1200 bits/s
2400 bits/s
4800 bits/s
RP1 Baud Rate 0E 04 19200 bits/s 9600 bits/s
19200 bits/s
38400 bits/s
[Indexed String]
DNP3.0 versions only. This cell controls the communication speed between relay and master station. It is important that both relay and
master station are set at the same speed setting.
Odd
Even
RP1 Parity 0E 05 None
None
[Indexed String]
DNP3.0 versions only. This cell controls the parity format used in the data frames. It is important that both relay and master station are set
with the same parity setting.
From 1 to 60 in steps of 1
RP1 Meas Period 0E 06 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
IEC60870-5-103 versions only. This cell controls the time interval that the relay will use between sending measurement data to the master
station.
Copper
RP1 PhysicalLink 0E 07 Copper Fibre Optic
[Indexed String]
This cell defines whether an electrical EIA(RS) 485 or fiber optic connection is being used for communication between the master station and
relay. If ‘Fiber Optic’ is selected, the optional fiber optic communications board will be required.
Disabled
RP1 Time Sync 0E 08 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
DNP3.0 versions only. If set to Enabled the master station can be used to synchronize the time on the relay. If set to Disabled either the
internal free running clock or IRIG-B input are used.
Disabled
Monitor Blocking
RP1 CS103Blcking 0E 0A Disabled
Command Blocking
[Indexed String]
IEC60870-5-103 versions only. There are three settings associated with this cell:
Disabled - No blocking selected.
Monitor Blocking - When the monitor blocking DDB Signal is active high, either by energizing an opto input or control input, reading of the
status information and disturbance records is not permitted. When in this mode the relay returns a “termination of general interrogation”
message to the master station.
Command Blocking - When the command blocking DDB signal is active high, either by energizing an opto input or control input, all remote

B46 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
commands will be ignored (i.e. CB Trip/Close, change setting group etc.). When in this mode the relay returns a “negative acknowledgement
of command” message to the master station.
K Bus OK
EIA485 OK
RP1 Card Status 0E 0B
Fibre Optic OK
[Indexed String]
Displays the status of the card in RP1
K Bus
RP1 Port Config 0E 0C K Bus EIA485 (RS485)
[Indexed String]
Courier versions only. This cell defines whether an electrical KBus or EIA(RS)485 is being used for communication between the master station
and relay.
IEC60870 FT1.2 Frame
RP1 Comms Mode 0E 0D IEC60870 FT1.2 10-bit no parity
[Indexed String]
Courier versions only. The choice is either IEC 60870 FT1.2 for normal operation with 11-bit modems, or 10-bit no parity.
9600 bits/s
19200 bits/s
RP1 Baud Rate 0E 0E 19200 bits/s
38400 bits/s
[Indexed String]
Courier versions only. This cell controls the communication speed between relay and master station. It is important that both relay and
master station are set at the same speed setting.
Normalised
Primary
Meas Scaling 0E 0F Normalised
Secondary
[Indexed String]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Setting to report analogue values in terms of primary, secondary or normalized (with respect to the CT/VT ratio
setting) values.
Message Gap (ms)
Message Gap (ms) 0E 10 0
[Courier Number (time-milliseconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. This setting allows the master station to have an interframe gap.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
DNP Need Time 0E 11 10
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. The duration of time waited before requesting another time sync from the master.
From 100 to 2048 in steps of 1
DNP App Fragment 0E 12 2048
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. The maximum message length (application fragment size) transmitted by the relay.
From 1 to 120 in steps of 1
DNP App Timeout 0E 13 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Duration of time waited, after sending a message fragment and awaiting a confirmation from the master.
From 1 to 10 in steps of 1
DNP SBO Timeout 0E 14 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Duration of time waited, after receiving a select command and awaiting an operate confirmation from the master.
From 0 to 120 in steps of 1
DNP Link Timeout 0E 15 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Duration of time that the relay will wait for a Data Link Confirm from the master. A value of 0 means data link support
disabled and 1 to 120 seconds is the timeout setting.
0 or 1
Class 0 Poll 0E 16 Running Counters
[Indexed String]
Used for DNP3 serial only.
When set the cell to “Running Counters”, the IED will only report the static counters (object 20) in class 0 responses. Otherwise if set to
“Frozen Counters”, the IED will only report the frozen counters (object 21) in class 0 responses.
UCA 2.0
UCA 2.0 GOOSE
NIC Protocol 0E 1F IEC61850 IEC61850
DNP3.0
[Indexed String]
IEC61850 versions only. Indicates that IEC 61850 will be used on the rear Ethernet port.
NIC Mac Address
NIC Mac Address 0E 22
[ASCII Text (17 Chars)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B47
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IEC61850 versions only. Indicates the MAC address of the rear Ethernet port.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
NIC Tunl Timeout 0E 64 5
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
IEC61850 versions only. Duration of time waited before an inactive tunnel to MiCOM S1 Studio is reset.
Alarm
Event
NIC Link Report 0E 6A Alarm
None
[Indexed String]
IEC61850 versions only.
Configures how a failed/unfitted network link (copper or fiber) is reported:
Alarm - an alarm is raised for a failed link
Event - an event is logged for a failed link
None - nothing reported for a failed link
REAR PORT2 (RP2) 0E 80
RP2 versions only.
Courier
IEC870-5-103
RP2 Protocol 0E 81 Courier Modbus
DNP 3.0
[Indexed String]
RP2 versions only. Indicates the communications protocol that will be used on the rear communications port.
Unsupported
Card Not Fitted
EIA232 OK
RP2 Card Status 0E 84
EIA485 OK
K Bus OK
[Indexed String]
RP2 versions only. Displays the status of the card in RP2
EIA232 (RS232)
EIA485 (RS485)
RP2 Port Config 0E 88 EIA232 (RS232)
K-Bus
[Indexed String]
RP2 versions only. This cell defines whether an electrical EIA(RS)232, EIA(RS)485 or KBus is being used for communication.
IEC60870 FT1.2 Frame
RP2 Comms Mode 0E 8A IEC60870 FT1.2 10-bit no parity
[Indexed String]
RP2 versions only. The choice is either IEC 60870 FT1.2 for normal operation with 11-bit modems, or 10-bit no parity.
From 0 to 255 in steps of 1
RP2 Address 0E 90 255
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
RP2 versions only. This cell sets the unique address for the relay such that only one relay is accessed by master station software.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
RP2 InactivTimer 0E 92 15
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
RP2 versions only. This cell controls how long the relay will wait without receiving any messages on the rear port before it reverts to its
default state, including resetting any password access that was enabled.
9600 bits/s
19200 bits/s
RP2 Baud Rate 0E 94 19200 bits/s
38400 bits/s
[Indexed String]
RP2 versions only. This cell controls the communication speed between relay and master station. It is important that both relay and master
station are set at the same speed setting.
UCA 2.0
UCA 2.0 GOOSE
NIC Protocol 0E A0 DNP 3.0 IEC61850
DNP3.0
[Indexed String]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates that DNP 3.0 will be used on the rear Ethernet port.
IP Address
IP Address 0E A1 0.0.0.0
[ASCII Text]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the IP address of the relay
Subnet Mask
Subnet Mask 0E A2 0.0.0.0
[ASCII Text]

B48 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the Subnet address
NIC MAC Address
NIC MAC Address 0E A3 Ethernet MAC Address
[ASCII Text (17 chars)]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the MAC address of the rear Ethernet port.
Gateway
Gateway 0E A4 0.0.0.0
[ASCII Text]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the Gateway address
Disabled
DNP Time Sync 0E A5 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. If set to ‘Enabled’ the DNP3.0 master station can be used to synchronize the time on the relay. If set to
‘Disabled’ either the internal free running clock, or IRIG-B input are used.
Normalised
Primary
Meas Scaling 0E A6 Normalised
Secondary
[Indexed String]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Setting to report analogue values in terms of primary, secondary or normalized (with respect to the
CT/VT ratio setting) values.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
NIC Tunl Timeout 0E A7 5
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Duration of time waited before an inactive tunnel to MiCOM S1 Studio is reset.
Alarm
Event
NIC Link Report 0E A8 Alarm
None
[Indexed String]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only.
Configures how a failed/unfitted network link (copper or fiber) is reported:
Alarm - an alarm is raised for a failed link
Event - an event is logged for a failed link
None - nothing reported for a failed link
SNTP PARAMETERS 0E AA
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only
SNTP Server 1
SNTP Server 1 0E AB 0.0.0.0
[ASCII Text]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the SNTP Server 1 address.
SNTP Server 2
SNTP Server 2 0E AC 0.0.0.0
[ASCII Text]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Indicates the SNTP Server 2 address.
SNTP Poll Rate
SNTP Poll Rate 0E AD 64
[ASCII Text]
DNP 3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Duration of SNTP poll rate in seconds.
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
DNP Need Time 0E B1 10
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. The duration of time waited before requesting another time sync from the master.
From 100 to 2048 in steps of 1
DNP App Fragment 0E B2 2048
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. The maximum message length (application fragment size) transmitted by the relay.
From 1 to 120 in steps of 1
DNP App Timeout 0E B3 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Duration of time waited, after sending a message fragment and awaiting a confirmation from the master.
From 1 to 10 in steps of 1
DNP SBO Timeout 0E B4 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
DNP 3.0 versions only. Duration of time waited, after receiving a select command and awaiting an operate confirmation from the master.
0 or 1
Class 0 Poll 0E B5 Running Counters
[Indexed String]
Used for DNP3 over Ethernet only.
When set the cell to “Running Counters”, the IED will only report the static counters (object 20) in class 0 responses. Otherwise if set to
“Frozen Counters”, the IED will only report the frozen counters (object 21) in class 0 responses.
COMMISSION TESTS 0F 00
This column contains commissioning test settings

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B49
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Opto I/P Status
Opto I/P Status 0F 01
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
This menu cell displays the status of the available relay’s opto-isolated inputs as a binary string, a ‘1’ indicating an energized opto-isolated
input and a ‘0’ a de-energized one.
Relay O/P Status
Relay O/P Status 0F 02
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
This menu cell displays the status of the digital data bus (DDB) signals that result in energization of the available output relays as a binary
string, a ‘1’ indicating an operated state and ‘0’ a non-operated state.
When the ‘Test Mode’ cell is set to ‘Enabled’ the ‘Relay O/P Status’ cell does not show the current status of the output relays and hence can
not be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it will be necessary to monitor the state of each contact in turn.
Test Port Status
Test Port Status 0F 03
[Binary Flag (8) Indexed String]
This menu cell displays the status of the eight digital data bus (DDB) signals that have been allocated in the ‘Monitor Bit’ cells.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 1 0F 05 1060
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 2 0F 06 1062
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 3 0F 07 1064
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 4 0F 08 1066
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 5 0F 09 1068
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 6 0F 0A 1070
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 7 0F 0B 1072
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
From 0 to 2047 in steps of 1
Monitor Bit 8 0F 0C 1074
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
The eight ‘Monitor Bit’ cells allow the user to select the status of which digital data bus signals can be observed in the ‘Test Port Status’ cell or
via the monitor/download port.
Disabled
Test Mode
IED Test Mode 0F 0D Disabled
Contacts Blocked
[Indexed String]
The IED Test Mode menu cell is used to allow online testing to be performed on the IED without operation of the trip contacts. It also enables
a facility to directly test the output contacts by applying menu controlled test signals.

This setting influences the processing of GOOSE and control service frames with an IEC61850 Test mode flag.

To select test mode the IED Test Mode menu cell should be set to ‘Test’, which takes the IED out of service. It also causes an alarm condition
to be recorded and the yellow ‘Out of Service’ LED to illuminate. In IEC 60870-5-103 builds changes the Cause of Transmission, COT, to Test
Mode. In IED Test Mode, only GOOSE messages and control service commands with a quality flat set to "test" will be processed as valid .

To enable testing of output contacts the IED Test Mode cell should be set to Contacts Blocked. This blocks the protection from operating the
contacts and enables the test pattern and contact test functions which can be used to manually operate the output contacts. This mode
also blocks maintenance, counters and freezes any information stored in the Circuit Breaker Condition column. Also in IEC 60870-5-103

B50 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
builds changes the Cause of Transmission, COT, to Test Mode. In Contacts Blocked Mode, only GOOSE messages and control service
commands with a quality flat set to "test" will be processed as valid.

Once testing is complete the cell must be set back to ‘Disabled’ to restore the IED back to service

The following IEC 61850 Mode definitions apply for the different settings:
0 = Disabled Mod = 1 (On)
1 = Test Mod = 3 (Test)
2 = Contacts Blocked Mod = 4 (Test/blocked)

Note: The cell ‘Test Mode’ used in software prior to IEC 61850 edition 2 has been renamed as ‘IED Test Mode’
Relay 1
Relay 2
Relay 3
Relay 4
Relay 5
Relay 6
Relay 7
Relay 8
Relay 9
Relay 10
Relay 11
Relay 12
Relay 13
Relay 14
Relay 15
Relay 16
Test Pattern 0F 0E 0x0 Relay 17
Relay 18
Relay 19
Relay 20
Relay 21
Relay 22
Relay 23
Relay 24
Relay 25
Relay 26
Relay 27
Relay 28
Relay 29
Relay 30
Relay 31
Relay 32
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
This cell is used to select the output relay contacts that will be tested when the ‘Contact Test’ cell is set to ‘Apply Test’.
No Operation
Apply Test
Contact Test 0F 0F No Operation
Remove Test
[Indexed String]
When the ‘Apply Test’ command in this cell is issued the contacts set for operation (set to ‘1’) in the ‘Test Pattern’ cell change state. After the
test has been applied the command text on the LCD will change to ‘No Operation’ and the contacts will remain in the Test State until reset
issuing the ‘Remove Test’ command. The command text on the LCD will again revert to ‘No Operation’ after the ‘Remove Test’ command has
been issued.
Note: When the ‘Test Mode’ cell is set to ‘Enabled’ the ‘Relay O/P Status’ cell does not show the current status of the output relays and hence
can not be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it will be necessary to monitor the state of each contact in turn.
No Operation
Test LEDs 0F 10 No Operation Apply Test
[Indexed String]
When the ‘Apply Test’ command in this cell is issued the eighteen user-programmable LEDs will illuminate for approximately 2 seconds
before they extinguish and the command text on the LCD reverts to ‘No Operation’.
No Operation
Test Autoreclose 0F 11 No Operation
Trip 3 Pole

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B51
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Trip Pole A
Trip Pole B
Trip Pole C
[Indexed String]
This is a command used to simulate a single pole or three phase tripping in order to test Auto-reclose cycle.
Disabled
Static Test Mode 0F 12 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
When Static test is Enabled, delta phase selectors and the delta directional line are bypassed to allow the user to test the relay with older
injection test sets that are incapable of simulating real dynamic step changes in current and voltage. Resulting trip times will be slower, as
extra filtering of distance comparators is also switched-in.
Disabled
External
Loopback Mode 0F 13 Disabled
Internal
[Indexed String]
Setting that allows communication loopback testing.
From 0 to 16 in steps of 1
IM64 TestPattern 0F 14 0
[Binary Flag (16)]
This cell is used to set the DDB signals included in the User Defined Inter-Relay Commands IM64 when the ‘IM64 Test Mode’ cell is set to
‘Enable’.
Disabled
IM64 Test Mode 0F 15 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
When the Enable command in this cell is issued the DDB set for operation (set to ‘1’) in the ‘Test Pattern’ cell change state.
Red LED Status
Red LED Status 0F 1A
[Binary Flag (18)]
This cell is an eighteen bit binary string that indicates which of the user-programmable LEDs on the relay are illuminated with the Red LED
input active when accessing the relay from a remote location, a ‘1’ indicating a particular LED is lit and a ‘0’ not lit.
Green LED Status
Green LED Status 0F 1B
[Binary Flag (18)]
This cell is an eighteen bit binary string that indicates which of the user-programmable LEDs on the relay are illuminated with the Green LED
input active when accessing the relay from a remote location, a ‘1’ indicating a particular LED is lit and a ‘0’ not lit.
On
On-blocked
Test
IED Mod/Beh 0F 1E
Test-blocked
Off
[Indexed String]
Indicates the current Mod/Beh status of whole IED
Disabled
Subscriber Sim 0F 1F Disabled Enabled
[indexed String]
Used to enable/disable the 'subscriber simulation' feature, for Sampled Values and GOOSE subscriptions
DDB 31 - 0
DDB 31 - 0 0F 20
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 63 - 32
DDB 63 - 32 0F 21
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 95 - 64
DDB 95 - 64 0F 22
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 127 - 96
DDB 127 - 96 0F 23
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 159 - 128
DDB 159 - 128 0F 24
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 191 - 160
DDB 191 - 160 0F 25
[Binary Flag (32)]

B52 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 223 - 192
DDB 223 - 192 0F 26
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 255 - 224
DDB 255 - 224 0F 27
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 287 - 256
DDB 287 - 256 0F 28
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 319 - 288
DDB 319 - 288 0F 29
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 351 - 320
DDB 351 - 320 0F 2A
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 383 - 352
DDB 383 - 352 0F 2B
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 415 - 384
DDB 415 - 384 0F 2C
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 447 - 416
DDB 447 - 416 0F 2D
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 479 - 448
DDB 479 - 448 0F 2E
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 511 - 480
DDB 511 - 480 0F 2F
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 543 - 512
DDB 543 - 512 0F 30
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 575 - 544
DDB 575 - 544 0F 31
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 607 - 576
DDB 607 - 576 0F 32
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 639 - 608
DDB 639 - 608 0F 33
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 671 - 640
DDB 671 - 640 0F 34
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 703 - 672
DDB 703 - 672 0F 35
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 735 - 704
DDB 735 - 704 0F 36
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 767 - 736
DDB 767 - 736 0F 37
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 799 - 768
DDB 799 - 768 0F 38
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 831 - 800 0F 39 DDB 831 - 800

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B53
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 863 - 832
DDB 863 - 832 0F 3A
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 895 - 864
DDB 895 - 864 0F 3B
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 927 - 896
DDB 927 - 896 0F 3C
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 959 - 928
DDB 959 - 928 0F 3D
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 991 - 960
DDB 991 - 960 0F 3E
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1023 - 992
DDB 1023 - 992 0F 3F
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1055 - 1024
DDB 1055 - 1024 0F 40
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1087 - 1056
DDB 1087 - 1056 0F 41
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1119 - 1088
DDB 1119 - 1088 0F 42
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1151 - 1120
DDB 1151 - 1120 0F 43
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1183 - 1152
DDB 1183 - 1152 0F 44
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1215 - 1184
DDB 1215 - 1184 0F 45
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1247 - 1216
DDB 1247 - 1216 0F 46
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1279 - 1248
DDB 1279 - 1248 0F 47
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1311 - 1280
DDB 1311 - 1280 0F 48
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1343 - 1312
DDB 1343 - 1312 0F 49
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1375 - 1344
DDB 1375 - 1344 0F 4A
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1407 - 1376
DDB 1407 - 1376 0F 4B
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1439 - 1408
DDB 1439 - 1408 0F 4C
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals

B54 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
DDB 1471 - 1440
DDB 1471 - 1440 0F 4D
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1503 - 1472
DDB 1503 - 1472 0F 4E
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1535 - 1504
DDB 1535 - 1504 0F 4F
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1567 - 1536
DDB 1567 - 1536 0F 50
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1599 - 1568
DDB 1599 - 1568 0F 51
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1631 - 1600
DDB 1631 - 1600 0F 52
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1663 - 1632
DDB 1663 - 1632 0F 53
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1695 - 1664
DDB 1695 - 1664 0F 54
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1727 - 1696
DDB 1727 - 1696 0F 55
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1759 - 1728
DDB 1759 - 1728 0F 56
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1791 - 1760
DDB 1791 - 1760 0F 57
[Binary Flag (32)]
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1823 - 1792 0F 58
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1855 - 1824 0F 59
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1887 - 1856 0F 5A
Displays the status of DDB signals
DDB 1919 - 1888 0F 5B
Displays the status of DDB signals
CB MONITOR SETUP 10 00
This column contains Circuit Breaker monitoring parameters
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.1
CB1 Broken I^ 10 01 2
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This sets the factor to be used for the cumulative I^ counter calculation that monitors the cumulative severity of the duty placed on the
interrupter. This factor is set according to the type of Circuit Breaker used
Alarm Disabled
CB1 I^ Maint 10 02 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines if an alarm will be raised or not when the cumulative I^ maintenance counter threshold is exceeded.
From 1 to 25000 in steps of 1
CB1 I^ Maint 10 03 1000
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the threshold for the cumulative I^ maintenance counter monitors.
Alarm Disabled
CB1 I^ Lockout 10 04 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines if an alarm will be raised or not when the cumulative I^lockout counter threshold is exceeded.
CB1 I^ Lockout 10 05 2000 From 1 to 25000 in steps of 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B55
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the threshold for the cumulative I^ lockout counter monitor. Set that should maintenance not be carried out, the
relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
No.CB1 Ops Maint 10 06 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the number of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm.
From 1 to 10000 in steps of 1
No.CB1 Ops Maint 10 07 10
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets the threshold for number of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm, indicating when preventative maintenance is due.
Alarm Disabled
No.CB1 Ops Lock 10 08 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the number of circuit breaker operations lockout alarm.
From 1 to 10000 in steps of 1
No.CB1 Ops Lock 10 09 20
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets the threshold for number of circuit breaker operations lockout. The relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a
second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
CB1 Time Maint 10 0A Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the circuit breaker operating time maintenance alarm.
From 0.005 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB1 Time Maint 10 0B 0.1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit operating time threshold which is set in relation to the specified interrupting time of the circuit breaker.
Alarm Disabled
CB1 Time Lockout 10 0C Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the circuit breaker operating time lockout alarm.
From 0.005 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB1 Time Lockout 10 0D 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker operating time threshold which is set in relation to the specified interrupting time of the circuit breaker. The
relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
CB1FltFreqLock 10 0E Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Enables the excessive fault frequency alarm.
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
CB1FltFreqCount 10 0F 10
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets a circuit breaker frequent operations counter that monitors the number of operations over a set time period
From 0 to 9999 in steps of 1
CB1FltFreqTime 10 10 3600
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Sets the time period over which the circuit breaker operations are to be monitored. Should the set number of trip operations be
accumulated within this time period, an alarm can be raised. Excessive fault frequency/trips can be used to indicate that the circuit may
need maintenance attention (e.g. Tree-felling or insulator cleaning).
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.1
CB2 Broken I^ 10 21 2
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This sets the factor to be used for the cumulative I^ counter calculation that monitors the cumulative severity of the duty placed on the
interrupter. This factor is set according to the type of Circuit Breaker used
Alarm Disabled
CB2 I^ Maint 10 22 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines if an alarm will be raised or not when the cumulative I^ maintenance counter threshold is exceeded.
From 1 to 25000 in steps of 1
CB2 I^ Maint 10 23 1000
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the threshold for the cumulative I^ maintenance counter monitors.
Alarm Disabled
CB2 I^ Lockout 10 24 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines if an alarm will be raised or not when the cumulative I^lockout counter threshold is exceeded.

B56 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 1 to 25000 in steps of 1
CB2 I^ Lockout 10 25 2000
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the threshold for the cumulative I^ lockout counter monitor. Set that should maintenance not be carried out, the
relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
No.CB2 OPs Maint 10 26 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the number of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm.
From 1 to 10000 in steps of 1
No.CB2 OPs Maint 10 27 10
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets the threshold for number of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm, indicating when preventative maintenance is due.
Alarm Disabled
No.CB2 OPs Lock 10 28 Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the number of circuit breaker operations lockout alarm.
From 1 to 10000 in steps of 1
No.CB2 OPs Lock 10 29 20
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets the threshold for number of circuit breaker operations lockout. The relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a
second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
CB2 Time Maint 10 2A Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the circuit breaker operating time maintenance alarm.
From 0.005 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB2 Time Maint 10 2B 0.1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit operating time threshold which is set in relation to the specified interrupting time of the circuit breaker.
Alarm Disabled
CB2 Time Lockout 10 2C Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate the circuit breaker operating time lockout alarm.
From 0.005 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB2 Time Lockout 10 2D 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker operating time threshold which is set in relation to the specified interrupting time of the circuit breaker. The
relay can be set to lockout the auto-reclose function on reaching a second operations threshold.
Alarm Disabled
CB2FltFreqLock 10 2E Alarm Disabled Alarm Enabled
[Indexed String]
Enables the excessive fault frequency alarm.
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
CB2FltFreqCount 10 2F 10
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Sets a circuit breaker frequent operations counter that monitors the number of operations over a set time period
From 0 to 9999 in steps of 1
CB2FltFreqTime 10 30 3600
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Sets the time period over which the circuit breaker operations are to be monitored. Should the set number of trip operations be
accumulated within this time period, an alarm can be raised. Excessive fault frequency/trips can be used to indicate that the circuit may
need maintenance attention (e.g. Tree-felling or insulator cleaning).
OPTO CONFIG 11 00
This column contains opto-input configuration settings
24/27V
30/34V
48/54V
Global Nominal V 11 01 24/27V 110/125V
220/250V
Custom
[Indexed String]
Sets the nominal battery voltage for all opto inputs by selecting one of the five standard ratings in the Global Nominal V settings. If Custom
is selected then each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value.
24-27V
Opto Input 1 11 02 24/27V 30-34V
48-54V

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B57
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 2 11 03 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 3 11 04 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 4 11 05 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 5 11 06 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 6 11 07 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 7 11 08 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 8 11 09 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
Opto Input 9 11 0A 24/27V 24-27V

B58 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
30-34V
48-54V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 10 11 0B 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 11 11 0C 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 12 11 0D 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 13 11 0E 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 14 11 0F 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 15 11 10 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
24-27V
30-34V
48-54V
Opto Input 16 11 11 24/27V
110-125V
220-250V
[Indexed String]
Each opto input can individually be set to a nominal voltage value if custom is selected for the global setting. The number of inputs may be

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B59
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
up to 32, depending on MiCOM P54x model and I/O configuration.
Opto 1 Input State
Opto 2 Input State
Opto 3 Input State
Opto 4 Input State
Opto 5 Input State
Opto 6 Input State
Opto 7 Input State
Opto 8 Input State
Opto 9 Input State
Opto 10 Input State
Opto 11 Input State
Opto 12 Input State
Opto 13 Input State
Opto 14 Input State
Opto 15 Input State
Opto 16 Input State
Opto Filter Cntl 11 60 0xFEB7FB Opto 17 Input State
Opto 18 Input State
Opto 19 Input State
Opto 20 Input State
Opto 21 Input State
Opto 22 Input State
Opto 23 Input State
Opto 24 Input State
Opto 25 Input State
Opto 26 Input State
Opto 27 Input State
Opto 28 Input State
Opto 29 Input State
Opto 30 Input State
Opto 31 Input State
Opto 32 Input State
[Binary Flag (32-Bit)]
Selects each input with a pre-set filter of ½ cycle that renders the input immune to induced noise on the wiring. The number of available bits
may be 16, 24 or 32, depending on the I/O configuration.
Standard 60%-80%
Characteristic 11 80 Standard 60%-80% 50% - 70%
[Indexed String]
Selects the pick-up and drop-off characteristics of the optos. Selecting the standard setting means they nominally provide a Logic 1 or On
value for Voltages 80% of the set lower nominal voltage and a Logic 0 or Off value for the voltages 60% of the set higher nominal
voltage.
CONTROL INPUTS 12 00
This column contains settings for the type of control input (32 in all)
Control Input 1
Control Input 2
Control Input 3
Control Input 4
Control Input 5
Control Input 6
Control Input 7
Control Input 8
Control Input 9
Ctrl I/P Status 12 01
Control Input 10
Control Input 11
Control Input 12
Control Input 13
Control Input 14
Control Input 15
Control Input 16
Control Input 17
Control Input 18

B60 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Control Input 19
Control Input 20
Control Input 21
Control Input 22
Control Input 23
Control Input 24
Control Input 25
Control Input 26
Control Input 27
Control Input 28
Control Input 29
Control Input 30
Control Input 31
Control Input 32
[Binary Flag (32 bits) Indexed String]
Cell that is used to set (1) and reset (0) the selected Control Input by simply scrolling and changing the status of selected bits. This command
will be then recognized and executed in the PSL. Alternatively, each of the 32 Control input can also be set and reset using the individual
menu setting cells as follows:
No Operation
Set
Control Input 1 12 02 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 1 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 2 12 03 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 2 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 3 12 04 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 3 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 4 12 05 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 4 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 5 12 06 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 5 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 6 12 07 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 6 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 7 12 08 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 7 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 8 12 09 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 8 set/ reset.
No Operation
Control Input 9 12 0A No Operation Set
Reset

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B61
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 9 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 10 12 0B No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 10 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 11 12 0C No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 11 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 12 12 0D No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 12 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 13 12 0E No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 13 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 14 12 0F No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 14 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 15 12 10 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 15 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 16 12 11 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 16 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 17 12 12 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 17 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 18 12 13 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 18 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 19 12 14 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 19 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 20 12 15 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 20 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 21 12 16 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]

B62 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting to allow Control Inputs 21 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 22 12 17 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 22 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 23 12 18 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 23 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 24 12 19 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 24 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 25 12 1A No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 25 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 26 12 1B No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 26 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 27 12 1C No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 27 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 28 12 1D No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 28 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 29 12 1E No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 29 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 30 12 1F No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 30 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 31 12 20 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 31 set/ reset.
No Operation
Set
Control Input 32 12 21 No Operation
Reset
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 32 set/ reset.
CTRL I/P CONFIG 13 00
This column contains settings for the type of control input (32 in all)
From 0xFFFFFFFF to 32 in steps of 1
Hotkey Enabled 13 01 0xFFFFFFFF
[Binary Flag (32 bits) Indexed String]
Setting to allow the control inputs to be individually assigned to the Hotkey menu by setting ‘1’ in the appropriate bit in the Hotkey Enabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B63
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
cell. The hotkey menu allows the control inputs to be set, reset or pulsed without the need to enter the CONTROL INPUTS column.
Latched
Control Input 1 13 10 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’. A latched control input will remain in the set state until a reset command is
given, either by the menu or the serial communications. A pulsed control input, however, will remain energized for 10 ms after the set
command is given and will then reset automatically (i.e. no reset command required).
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 1 13 11 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 2 13 14 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 2 13 15 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 3 13 18 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 3 13 19 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 4 13 1C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 4 13 1D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 5 13 20 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 5 13 21 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 6 13 24 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]

B64 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 6 13 25 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 7 13 28 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 7 13 29 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 8 13 2C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 8 13 2D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 9 13 30 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 9 13 31 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 10 13 34 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 10 13 35 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 11 13 38 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 11 13 39 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B65
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 12 13 3C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 12 13 3D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 13 13 40 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 13 13 41 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 14 13 44 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 14 13 45 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 15 13 48 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 15 13 49 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 16 13 4C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 16 13 4D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 17 13 50 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.

B66 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 17 13 51 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 18 13 54 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 18 13 55 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 19 13 58 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 19 13 59 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 20 13 5C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 20 13 5D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 21 13 60 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 21 13 61 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 22 13 64 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 22 13 65 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B67
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 23 13 68 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 23 13 69 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 24 13 6C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 24 13 6D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 25 13 70 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 25 13 71 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 26 13 74 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 26 13 75 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 27 13 78 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 27 13 79 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 28 13 7C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
Ctrl Command 28 13 7D Set/Reset ON/OFF

B68 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
SET/RESET
IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 29 13 80 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 29 13 81 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 30 13 84 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 30 13 85 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 31 13 88 Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 31 13 89 Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
Latched
Control Input 32 13 8C Latched Pulsed
[Indexed String]
Configures the control inputs as either ‘latched’ or ‘pulsed’.
ON/OFF
SET/RESET
Ctrl Command 32 13 8D Set/Reset IN/OUT
ENABLED/DISABLED
[Indexed String]
Allows the SET / RESET text, displayed in the hotkey menu, to be changed to something more suitable for the application of an individual
control input, such as ON / OFF, IN / OUT etc.
INTERMICOM COMMS 15 00
This column is only visible if the model number supports InterMiCOM and second rear comms board is fitted.
IM Output Status
IM Output Status 15 01 Data
[Binary Flags (8 bits)]
Displays the status of each InterMiCOM output signal.
IM Input Status
IM Input Status 15 02 Data
[Binary Flags (8 bits)]
Displays the status of each InterMiCOM input signal, with IM1 signal starting from the right. When loop back mode is set, all bits will display
zero.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Source Address 15 10 1
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B69
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting for the unique relay address that is encoded in the InterMiCOM sent message.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Receive Address 15 11 2
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
The aim of setting addresses is to establish pairs of relays which will only communicate with each other. Should an inadvertent channel
misrouting or spurious loopback occur, an error will be logged, and the erroneous received data will be rejected.
As an example, in a 2 ended scheme the following address setting would be correct:
Local relay: Source Address = 1, Receive Address = 2
Remote relay: Source Address = 2, Receive Address = 1
600
1200
2400
Baud Rate 15 12 9600 4800
9600
19200
[Indexed String]
Setting of the signalling speed in terms of number of bits per second. The speed will match the capability of the MODEM or other
characteristics of the channel provided.
Invisible
Ch Statistics 15 20 Invisible Visible
[Indexed String]
Settings that makes visible or invisible Channel Statistics on the LCD. The statistic is reset by either relay’s powering down or using the ‘Reset
Statistics’ cell.
Rx Direct Count
Rx Direct Count 15 21
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the number of valid Direct Tripping messages since last counter reset.
Rx Perm Count
Rx Perm Count 15 22
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the number of valid Permissive Tripping messages since last counter reset.
Rx Block Count
Rx Block Count 15 23
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the number of valid Blocking messages since last counter reset.
Rx NewData Count
Rx NewData Count 15 24
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the number of different messages (change events) since last counter reset.
Rx Errored Count
Rx Errored Count 15 25
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the number of invalid received messages since last counter reset.
Lost Messages
Lost Messages 15 26
[Float]
Displays the difference between the number of messages that were supposed to be received (based on set Baud Rate) and actual valid
received messages since last reset.
Elapsed Time
Elapsed Time 15 30
[Unsigned Integer(32 bit)]
Displays the time in seconds since last counter reset.
No
Reset Statistics 15 31 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Command that allows all Statistics and Channel Diagnostics to be reset.
Invisible
Ch Diagnostics 15 40 Invisible Visible
[Indexed String]
Setting that makes visible or invisible Channel Diagnostics on the LCD. The diagnostic is reset by either relay’s powering down or using the
‘Reset Statistics’ cell.
OK
Fail
Data CD Status 15 41
SCC Absent
[Indexed String]
Indicates when the DCD line (pin 1 on EIA232 Connector) is energized.
OK = DCD is energized
FAIL = DCD is de-energized
Absent = 2nd Rear port board is not fitted

B70 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
OK
Fail
FrameSync Status 15 42
SCC Absent
[Indexed String]
Indicates when the message structure and synchronization is valid.
OK = Valid message structure and synchronization
FAIL = Synchronization has been lost
Absent = 2nd Rear port board is not fitted
Unavailable = Hardware error present
OK
Fail
Message Status 15 43
SCC Absent
[Indexed String]
Indicates when the percentage of received valid messages has fallen below the ‘IM Msg Alarm Lvl’ setting within the alarm time period.
OK = Acceptable ratio of lost messages
FAIL = Unacceptable ratio of lost messages
Absent = 2nd Rear port board is not fitted
Unavailable = Hardware error present
OK
Fail
Channel Status 15 44
SCC Absent
[Indexed String]
Indicates the state of the InterMiCOM communication channel.
OK = Channel healthy
FAIL = Channel failure
Absent = 2nd Rear port board is not fitted
Unavailable = Hardware error present
OK
Fail
SCC Absent
IM H/W Status 15 45
SCC Read Error
SCC Write Error
[Indexed String]
Indicates the state of InterMiCOM hardware
OK = InterMiCOM hardware healthy
Read or Write Error = InterMiCOM failure
Absent = 2nd Rear port is not fitted or failed to initialize.
Disabled
Internal
Loopback Mode 15 50 Disabled
External
[Indexed String]
Setting to allow testing of the InterMiCOM channel. When ‘Internal’ is selected, only the local InterMiCOM software functionality is tested,
whereby the relay will receive its own sent data. ‘External’ setting allows a hardware and software check, with an external link required to
jumper the sent data onto the receive channel.
During normal service condition Loopback mode must be disabled.
From 0x00 to 0xFF in steps of 1
Test Pattern 15 51 0xFF
[Binary Flags (8 bits)]
Allows specific bit statuses to be inserted directly into the InterMiCOM message, to substitute real data. This is used for testing purposes.
OK
Fail
Loopback Status 15 52
SCC Absent
[Indexed String]
Indicates the status of the InterMiCOM loopback mode
OK = Loopback software (and hardware) is working correctly
FAIL = Loopback mode failure
Unavailable = Hardware error present.
INTERMICOM CONF 16 00
This column is only visible if the model number supports InterMiCOM and second rear comms board is fitted.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.1
IM Msg Alarm Lvl 16 01 25
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting that is used to alarm for poor channel quality. If during the fixed 1.6s window the ratio of invalid messages to the total number of

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B71
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
messages that should be received (based upon the ‘Baud Rate’ setting) exceeds the above threshold, a ‘Message Fail’ alarm will be issued.
Disabled
Direct
IM1 Cmd Type 16 10 Blocking
Blocking
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_1 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM1 FallBackMode 16 11 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM1 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM1 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM1 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM1 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM1
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM1 DefaultValue 16 12 1
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM1 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM1 FrameSyncTim 16 13 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ’IM1 DefaultValue’ is applied, providing that no valid message is received in the meantime.
Disabled
Direct
IM2 Cmd Type 16 18 Blocking
Blocking
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_2 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM2 FallBackMode 16 19 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM2 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM2 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM2 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM2 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM2
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM2 DefaultValue 16 1A 1
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM2 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM2 FrameSyncTim 16 1B 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ’IM2 DefaultValue’ is applied, providing that no valid message is received in the meantime.
Disabled
Direct
IM3 Cmd Type 16 20 Blocking
Blocking
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_3 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM3 FallBackMode 16 21 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM3 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM3 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM3 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM3 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM3
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM3 DefaultValue 16 22 1
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM3 fallback status.

B72 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM3 FrameSyncTim 16 23 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ’IM3 DefaultValue’ is applied, providing that no valid message is received in the meantime.
Disabled
Direct
IM4 Cmd Type 16 28 Blocking
Blocking
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_4 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM4 FallBackMode 16 29 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM4 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM4 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM4 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM4 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM4
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM4 DefaultValue 16 2A 1
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM4 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM4 FrameSyncTim 16 2B 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ’IM4 DefaultValue’ is applied, providing that no valid message is received in the meantime.
Disabled
Permissive
IM5 Cmd Type 16 30 Direct
Direct
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_5 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM5 FallBackMode 16 31 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM5 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM5 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM5 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM5 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM5
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM5 DefaultValue 16 32 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM5 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM5 FrameSyncTim 16 33 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ‘IM5 DefaultValue’ is applied.
Disabled
Permissive
IM6 Cmd Type 16 38 Direct
Direct
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_6 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM6 FallBackMode 16 39 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM6 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM6 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM6 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM6 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM6
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
IM6 DefaultValue 16 3A 0 0 or 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B73
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM6 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM6 FrameSyncTim 16 3B 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ‘IM6 DefaultValue’ is applied.
Disabled
Permissive
IM7 Cmd Type 16 40 Direct
Direct
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_7 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM7 FallBackMode 16 41 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM7 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM7 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM7 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM7 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM7
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM7 DefaultValue 16 42 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM7 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM7 FrameSyncTim 16 43 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ‘IM7 DefaultValue’ is applied.
Disabled
Permissive
IM8 Cmd Type 16 48 Direct
Direct
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the InterMiCOM_8 signal.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Blocking allows fastest signalling, whereas setting to Direct offers higher security at the
expense of speed.
Selecting the channel response for this bit to Permissive offers higher dependability
Default
IM8 FallBackMode 16 49 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM8 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to ‘Latching’ the last valid IM8 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to ‘Default’, the IM8 status, pre-defined by the user in ‘IM8 DefaultValue’ cell will be set. A new valid message will replace ‘IM8
DefaultValue’, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM8 DefaultValue 16 4A 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM8 fallback status.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
IM8 FrameSyncTim 16 4B 1.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which ‘IM8 DefaultValue’ is applied.
FUNCTION KEYS 17 00
This column contains the function key definitions
Fn Key Status
Fn Key Status 17 01
[Binary Flag (10 bits) Indexed String]
Displays the status of each function key.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 1 17 02 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
state.
Normal
Fn Key 1 Mode 17 03 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]

B74 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 1 Label 17 04 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 2 17 05 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 2 Mode 17 06 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 2 Label 17 07 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 3 17 08 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 3 Mode 17 09 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 3 Label 17 0A Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 4 17 0B Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 4 Mode 17 0C Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 4 Label 17 0D Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 5 17 0E Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 5 Mode 17 0F Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B75
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 5 Label 17 10 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 6 17 11 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 6 Mode 17 12 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 6 Label 17 13 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 7 17 14 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 7 Mode 17 15 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 7 Label 17 16 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 8 17 17 Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 8 Mode 17 18 Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 8 Label 17 19 Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 9 17 1A Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 9 Mode 17 1B Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will

B76 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 9 Label 17 1C Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
Disabled
Unlocked (Enabled)
Fn Key 10 17 1D Unlocked
Locked
[Indexed String]
Setting to activate function key. The ‘Lock’ setting allows a function key output that is set to toggle mode to be locked in its current active
position.
Normal
Fn Key 10 Mode 17 1E Normal Toggled
[Indexed String]
Sets the function key in toggle or normal mode. In ‘Toggle’ mode, a single key press will set/latch the function key output as ‘high’ or ‘low’ in
programmable scheme logic. This feature can be used to enable/disable relay functions. In the ‘Normal’ mode the function key output will
remain ‘high’ as long as key is pressed.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Fn Key 10 Label 17 1F Function Key 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Allows the text of the function key to be changed to something more suitable for the application.
IEC 61850-9.2LE 18 00
This column contains all the configure/setting measurement parameters relative to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
0 or 1
Physical Link 18 01 Fibre Optic
[Indexed String]

Disabled
AntiAlias Filter 18 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

From 0 to 2 in steps of 1
Synchro Alarm 18 03 Local 1PPS
[Indexed String]

0 or 1
SV Test Mode 18 04 Disabled
[Indexed String]
This setting is used for processing Sampled Value frames with an IEC 61850 Test mode flag. This setting is common to all SV Logical Nodes
configured in the IED.
Disabled: all channel data frames received with an IEC 61850 Test flag are treated as invalid. The IED blocks relevant protection functions
Enabled: all channel data frames received with an IEC 61850 Test flag are treated as good so all protection functions remain active.

Note: The cell ‘9.2 Mode’ used in software prior to IEC 61850 edition 2 has been renamed as ‘SV Test Mode’
From 0 to 3 in steps of 0.25
Merge Unit Delay 18 05 1
[Numeric(time-ms)]

0 or 1
VT Switch Mode 18 06 Disabled
[Indexed String]

From 1 to 8 in steps of 1
LN Count 18 11 1
[Integers]

LN1 Name 18 12 MiCOM Logical Node 1

LN2 Name 18 13 MiCOM Logical Node 2

LN3 Name 18 14 MiCOM Logical Node 3

LN4 Name 18 15 MiCOM Logical Node 4

LN5 Name 18 16 MiCOM Logical Node 5

LN6 Name 18 17 MiCOM Logical Node 6

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B77
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
LN7 Name 18 18 MiCOM Logical Node 7

LN8 Name 18 19 MiCOM Logical Node 8

LN9 Name 18 1A MiCOM Logical Node 9

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IA1 IB1 IC1 18 31 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IA2 IB2 IC2 18 32 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
INsen 18 33 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IM 18 34 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA VB VC 18 35 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
Vsc1 18 36 Unused LN3
LN4
LN5

B78 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vsc2 18 37 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA1 VB1 VC1 18 38 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA2 VB2 VC2 18 39 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vcs1 18 3A Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vcs2 18 3B Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]

LN1
LN2
LN3
Vcs3 18 3C Unused LN4
LN5
LN6
LN7

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B79
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
LN8
[Indexed String]

No
MUs Delay Search 18 41 No Yes
[Indexed String]

MUs Delay Max 18 42 0

Trust Ques Data 18 43 0

From 1.25% to 0.15 in steps of 1.25%


Loss Rate Level 18 44 0.1
[Numeric (percentage)]

SAV Absence
SAV Absence 18 51 0
[Binary Flag]

SAV No SmpSynch
SAV No SmpSynch 18 52 0
[Binary Flag]

00000000 00000000 SAV Test


SAV Test 18 53
00000000 [Binary Flag]

00000000 00000000 SAV Questionable


SAV Questionable 18 54
00000000 [Binary Flag]

00000000 00000000 SAV Invalid


SAV Invalid 18 55
00000000 [Binary Flag]

LN1 FramesRcvd
LN1 FramesRcvd 18 61 1
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN2 FramesRcvd
LN2 FramesRcvd 18 62 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN3 FramesRcvd
LN3 FramesRcvd 18 63 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN4 FramesRcvd
LN4 FramesRcvd 18 64 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN5 FramesRcvd
LN5 FramesRcvd 18 65 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN6 FramesRcvd
LN6 FramesRcvd 18 66 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN7 FramesRcvd
LN7 FramesRcvd 18 67 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN8 FramesRcvd
LN8 FramesRcvd 18 68 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN9 FramesRcvd
LN9 FramesRcvd 18 69 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
Frame Loss Data
Frame Loss Data 18 70 0
[Indexed String]

B80 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Disabled
Frame Loss Rate 18 71 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

2nd character
LN1 LossRate Sec 18 72 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN2 LossRate Sec 18 73 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN3 LossRate Sec 18 74 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN4 LossRate Sec 18 75 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN5 LossRate Sec 18 76 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN6 LossRate Sec 18 77 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN7 LossRate Sec 18 78 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN8 LossRate Sec 18 79 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

2nd character
LN9 LossRate Sec 18 7A 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]

No
Loss Rate Reset 18 90 No Yes
[Indexed String]

Reset Time
Reset Time 18 91 0
[Integer]

LN1 FrmLoss Cuml


LN1 FrmLoss Cuml 18 92 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN2 FrmLoss Cuml


LN2 FrmLoss Cuml 18 93 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN3 FrmLoss Cuml


LN3 FrmLoss Cuml 18 94 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN4 FrmLoss Cuml


LN4 FrmLoss Cuml 18 95 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN5 FrmLoss Cuml 18 96 0 LN5 FrmLoss Cuml

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B81
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN6 FrmLoss Cuml


LN6 FrmLoss Cuml 18 97 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN7 FrmLoss Cuml


LN7 FrmLoss Cuml 18 98 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN8 FrmLoss Cuml


LN8 FrmLoss Cuml 18 99 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN9 FrmLoss Cuml


LN9 FrmLoss Cuml 18 9A 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN1 Error Second


LN1 Error Second 18 B1 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN2 Error Second


LN2 Error Second 18 B2 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN3 Error Second


LN3 Error Second 18 B3 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN4 Error Second


LN4 Error Second 18 B4 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN5 Error Second


LN5 Error Second 18 B5 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN6 Error Second


LN6 Error Second 18 B6 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN7 Error Second


LN7 Error Second 18 B7 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN8 Error Second


LN8 Error Second 18 B8 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

LN9 Error Second


LN9 Error Second 18 B9 0
[Numeric(Percentage)]

VA VB VC
VA VB VC 18 D1 0
[Indexed String]

Vsc1
Vsc1 18 D2 0
[Indexed String]

Vsc2
Vsc2 18 D3 0
[Indexed String]

IEC 61850 CONFIG 19 00


This column contains IED Configurator settings
No Action
Switch Conf.Bank 19 05 No Action Switch banks
[Indexed String]
Setting which allows the user to switch between the current configuration, held in the Active Memory Bank (and partly displayed below), to
the configuration sent to and held in the Inactive Memory Bank.
No Action
Restore MCL 19 0A No Action
Restore MCL

B82 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Setting which allows the user to restore MCL or no action.
Active Conf.Name
Active Conf.Name 19 10
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. The name of the configuration in the Active Memory Bank, usually taken from the SCL file.
Active Conf.Rev
Active Conf.Rev 19 11
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Configuration Revision number of the configuration in the Active Memory Bank, usually taken from the SCL file.
Inact.Conf.Name
Inact.Conf.Name 19 20
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. The name of the configuration in the Inactive Memory Bank, usually taken from the SCL file.
Inact.Conf.Rev
Inact.Conf.Rev 19 21
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Configuration Revision number of the configuration in the Inactive Memory Bank, usually taken from the SCL file.
Disabled
IP From HMI 19 2F Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
When set to Enabled the IP Address, Subnet Mask & Gateway may be configured via the HMI. When set to Disabled these parameters may
only be set using the .MCL file.

This setting allows for an Ethernet connection to be established with the relay without needing to first send a .MCL file via the serial port.
Once a connection has been established the correct .MCL can be sent via Ethernet and this setting can be changed back to “Disabled”.
Note: You can enable this feature when you use the IED for the first time. However, the IED will at this point not have an active MCL file and
any data model extracted from IEC 61850 may not be correct. Therefore, to prevent any issues you should send a correct MCL file to the IED
after a connection is first established.
IP PARAMETERS
IP PARAMETERS 19 30
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only.
IP address
IP address 19 31
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the unique network IP address that identifies the relay.
Subnet mask
Subnet mask 19 32
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the sub-network the relay is connected to.
Gateway
Gateway 19 33
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the IP address of the gateway (proxy) that the relay is connected to, if any.
0 or 1
Media 19 34 1xFibre
[Indexed String]
IEC 61850 versions only. Displays the communication media of the Ethernet port that is currently in use.
IP address
IP address 19 38 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. When IP From HMI is enabled this is used to set the unique network IP address that identifies the unit.
Subnet mask
Subnet mask 19 39 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. When IP From HMI is enabled this is used to set the sub-network mask.
Gateway
Gateway 19 3A 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Set the IP address of the gateway (proxy) the relay is connected to via HMI if any.
0 or 1
Media 19 3B 1xFibre
[Indexed String]
IEC 61850 versions only. Sets the communication media of the Ethernet port. For products with dual redundant fibre select the
1xCopper/2xFibre setting
SNTP PARAMETERS 19 40
IEC61850 versions only.
SNTP Server 1
SNTP Server 1 19 41
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the IP address of the primary SNTP server.
SNTP Server 2
SNTP Server 2 19 42
[ASCII text]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B83
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the IP address of the secondary SNTP server.
IEC 61850 SCL 19 50
IEC61850 versions only.
IED Name
IED Name 19 51
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. 8 character IED name, which is the unique name on the IEC 61850 network for the IED, usually taken from the SCL
file.
IEC 61850 GOOSE 19 60
IEC61850 versions only.
Disabled
GoEna 19 70 0x00000000 Enabled
[Binary Flag (32)]
IEC61850 versions only. Setting to enable GOOSE publisher settings.
Disabled
Pass Through
Publisher Sim 19 71 0x00000000
Forced
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
IEC 61850 versions only. The Publisher Sim cell allows the simulation bit to be sent in the GOOSE message, for example for testing or
commissioning.

When ‘Disabled’ is selected, the simulation bit for the goose control block is not set.

When ‘Enabled’ is selected, the simulation bit for the goose control block is set.

Once testing is complete the cell must be set back to ‘Disabled’ to restore the GOOSE scheme back to normal service.

Note: The cell ‘Test Mode’ under IED Configurator used in software prior to IEC 61850 Edition 2 has been renamed as ‘Publisher Sim’
No
Ignore Test Flag 19 73 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Be removed after Cat2,This setting is determines whether GOOSE messages with an IEC 61850 Test mode flag are ignored or processed as
valid by the IED.
PROT COMMS/ IM64 20 00
This column contains settings for Current Differtial/IM64 Configuration
3 Terminal
2 Terminal
Scheme Setup 20 01 2 Terminal
Dual Redundant
[Indexed String]
Settings to determine how many relay ends are connected in the differential zone or how many relays are connected to the teleprotection
scheme for the protected line, with two or three ends possible.
For a plain two terminal line, there is an additional option to use dual communication channels, to implement redundancy (i.e. employ a
parallel “hot-standby” path).
0-0
1-A
2-A
3-A
4-A
5-A
6-A
7-A
8-A
Address 20 02 0-0 9-A
10-A
11-A
12-A
13-A
14-A
15-A
16-A
17-A
18-A

B84 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
19-A
20-A
1-B
2-B
3-B
4-B
5-B
6-B
7-B
8-B
9-B
10-B
11-B
12-B
13-B
14-B
15-B
16-B
17-B
18-B
19-B
20-B
1-C
2-C
3-C
4-C
5-C
6-C
7-C
8-C
9-C
10-C
11-C
12-C
13-C
14-C
15-C
16-C
17-C
18-C
19-C
20-C
[Indexed String]
In 3 terminal schemes, communicating groups of three relays may be configured. See below.
0-0
1-A
2-A
3-A
4-A
5-A
6-A
7-A
8-A
Address 20 03 0-0 9-A
10-A
11-A
12-A
13-A
14-A
15-A
16-A
17-A
18-A

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B85
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
19-A
20-A
1-B
2-B
3-B
4-B
5-B
6-B
7-B
8-B
9-B
10-B
11-B
12-B
13-B
14-B
15-B
16-B
17-B
18-B
19-B
20-B
1-C
2-C
3-C
4-C
5-C
6-C
7-C
8-C
9-C
10-C
11-C
12-C
13-C
14-C
15-C
16-C
17-C
18-C
19-C
20-C
[Indexed String]
Setting for the unique relay address that is encoded in the Differential message and in the InterMiCOM64 sent message. The aim of setting
the address is to establish pairs of relays which will only communicate with each other. Should an inadvertent fiber/MUX misrouting or
spurious loopback occur, an error will be logged, and the erroneous received data will be rejected.
As an example, in a 2 ended scheme the following address setting would be correct:
Local relay: 1-A
Remote relay: 1-B
Address 0-0 is a universal address, whereby any relay will be free to communicate with any other (equivalent to disabling of the unique
addressing). When PROT COMMS/IM64 is set to loop back mode, the address 0-0 will replace any existing address in the relay.
Standard
Comms Mode 20 10 Standard IEEE C37.94
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the data format that will be transmitted on the fiber outputs from the relay.
If the Multiplexer accepts direct fiber inputs according to IEEE C37.94, the ‘IEEE C37.94’ setting is selected.
For a direct fiber link between relays, and where the MUX connection is in electrical format (G.703 or V.35 or X.21), the ‘Standard’ message
format needs to be set.
For a setting change to take effect, rebooting of the relay will be required. The Comm Mode setting applies to both channels.
64kbits/s
Baud Rate Ch1 20 11 64kbits/s 56kbits/s
[Indexed String]
Channel 1 data rate setting for signalling between ends. The setting will depend on the MUX electrical interface, set 64kbit/s for G.703 and

B86 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
X.21, or generally 56kbit/s for V.35.
For direct fiber connection between relays, 64kbit/s will offer slightly faster data transmission.
The setting is invisible when IEEE C37.94 Comm Mode is selected.
64kbits/s
Baud Rate Ch2 20 12 64kbits/s 56kbits/s
[Indexed String]
Channel 2 data rate setting for signalling between ends. The setting will depend on the MUX electrical interface, set 64kbit/s for G.703 and
X.21, or generally 56kbit/s for V.35.
For direct fiber connection between relays, 64kbit/s will offer slightly faster data transmission.
The setting is invisible when IEEE C37.94 Comm Mode is selected.
Internal
Clock Source Ch1 20 13 Internal External
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines which clock source is used to synchronize data transmissions over channel 1. The setting will depend on
communications configuration and external clock source availability. If relays are connected direct fiber over channel 1, ‘Internal’ setting
should be selected. If channel 1 is routed via a multiplexer, either setting may be required (see Application Notes).
Internal
Clock Source Ch2 20 14 Internal External
[Indexed String]
Setting that matches the clock source being used for data synchronization over channel 2.
Auto
1
2
3
4
5
6
Ch1 N*64kbits/s 20 15 1
7
8
9
10
11
12
[Indexed String]
Setting for channel 1 when connected to MUX. When set to ‘Auto’ P54x will configure itself to match the multiplexer.
The setting is visible only when IEEE C37.94 Comm Mode is selected.
Auto
1
2
3
4
5
6
Ch2 N*64kbits/s 20 16 1
7
8
9
10
11
12
[Indexed String]
Setting for channel 2 when connected to Mux.
The setting is visible only when IEEE C37.94 Comm Mode is selected.
From 0.1 to 600 in steps of 0.1
Comm Fail Timer 20 18 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after which the ‘Channel Fail Alarm’ will be issued providing that no messages were received during the ‘Channel Timeout’ period
or the ‘Alarm Level’ is exceeded.
Ch 1 Failure
Ch 2 Failure
Comm Fail Mode 20 19 Ch 1 or 2 Fail Ch 1 or 2 Fail
Ch 1 and 2 Fail
[Indexed String]
Fail mode setting that triggers the ‘Channel Fail Alarm’, providing that the Dual Redundancy or 3 ended scheme is set.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B87
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Normally the alarm would be raised for any loss of an operational channel (logical OR combination). However, when relays in a 3 ended
scheme are deliberately operated in Chain topology AND logic may be used, for indication when the scheme becomes finally inoperative,
with no self-healing (signal rerouting) mode possible.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
Channel Timeout 20 1E 0.1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
A rolling time window beyond which any of the 8 IM signals that are set to ‘Default’ will be replaced by the corresponding ‘IM_X Default
Value’ setting, providing that no valid message is received on that channel in the meantime. The ‘Chnl Fail Alarm’ timer will be also initiated.
If only one channel is used, each out of 16 IM signals available that is set to ‘Default’ will convert to corresponding ‘IM_X Default Value’
If a Dual redundant or 3 ended scheme is selected, each out of 8 IM signals available that is set to ‘Default’ will convert to corresponding
‘IM_X Default Value’, but only for the affected channel.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.1
IM Msg Alarm Lvl 20 1F 25
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting that is used to alarm for poor channel quality. If during a fixed 100 ms rolling window the number of invalid messages divided by the
total number of messages that should be received (based upon the ‘Baud Rate’ setting) increase above the threshold, a ‘Channel Fail Alarm’
timer will be initiated.
Disabled
Prop Delay Stats 20 20 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the alarms of Maximum propagation delay time
From 0.001 to 0.05 in steps of 0.001
MaxCh1 PropDelay 20 21 0.015
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
When the protection communications are enabled, the overall propagation delay divided by 2 is calculated and the maximum value is
determined and displayed in Measurements 4 column. This value is displayed and compared against this setting. If the setting is exceeded,
an alarm MaxCh1 PropDelay (DDB 1386) is raised.
From 0.001 to 0.05 in steps of 0.001
MaxCh2 PropDelay 20 22 0.015
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
When the protection communications are enabled, the overall propagation delay divided by 2 is calculated and the maximum value is
determined and displayed in Measurements 4 column. This value is displayed and compared against this setting. If the setting is exceeded,
an alarm MaxCh2 PropDelay (DDB 1387) is raised.
Direct
IM1 Cmd Type 20 30 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_1 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM1 FallBackMode 20 31 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM1 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM1 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM1 status, pre-defined by the user in IM1 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM1 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM1 DefaultValue 20 32 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM1 fallback status.
Direct
IM2 Cmd Type 20 34 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_2 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM2 FallBackMode 20 35 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM2 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM2 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM2 status, pre-defined by the user in IM2 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM2 Default

B88 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM2 DefaultValue 20 36 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM2 fallback status.
Direct
IM3 Cmd Type 20 38 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_3 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM3 FallBackMode 20 39 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM3 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM3 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM3 status, pre-defined by the user in IM3 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM3 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM3 DefaultValue 20 3A 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM3 fallback status.
Direct
IM4 Cmd Type 20 3C Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_4 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM4 FallBackMode 20 3D Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM4 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM4 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM4 status, pre-defined by the user in IM4 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM4 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM4 DefaultValue 20 3E 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM4 fallback status.
Direct
IM5 Cmd Type 20 40 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_5 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM5 FallBackMode 20 41 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM5 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM5 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM5 status, pre-defined by the user in IM5 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM5 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM5 DefaultValue 20 42 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM5 fallback status.
Direct
IM6 Cmd Type 20 44 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B89
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_6 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM6 FallBackMode 20 45 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM6 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM6 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM6 status, pre-defined by the user in IM6 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM6 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM6 DefaultValue 20 46 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM6 fallback status.
Direct
IM7 Cmd Type 20 48 Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_7 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM7 FallBackMode 20 49 Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM7 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM7 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM7 status, pre-defined by the user in IM7 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM7 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM7 DefaultValue 20 4A 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM7 fallback status.
Direct
IM8 Cmd Type 20 4C Permissive Permissive
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the operative mode of the received InterMiCOM_8 signal.
When ‘Direct’ tripping is chosen, for security reasons 2 consecutive valid messages have to be received before a change in the signal status
will be acknowledged. That will impose an additional 1-2 ms delay comparing to ‘Permissive’ mode.
Set ‘Direct’ in Direct Transfer Tripping (Intertripping) applications.
Set ‘Permissive’ to accommodate any Permissive or Blocking scheme.
Default
IM8 FallBackMode 20 4D Default Latched
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the status of IM8 signal in case of heavy noise and message synchronization being lost.
If set to Latching the last valid IM8 status will be maintained until the new valid message is received.
If set to Default, the IM8 status, pre-defined by the user in IM8 Default Value cell will be set. A new valid message will replace IM8 Default
Value, once the channel recovers.
0 or 1
IM8 DefaultValue 20 4E 0
[Unsigned Integer(16 bit)]
Setting that defines the IM8 fallback status.
SECURITY CONFIG 25 00

ACCESS ONLY FOR From 32 to 234 in steps of 1


User Banner 25 01
AUTHORISED USERS [ASCII Text]

From 0 to 2 in steps of 1
Attempts Limit 25 02 2
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

From 1 to 3 in steps of 1
Attempts Timer 25 03 2
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

B90 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION

From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
Blocking Timer 25 04 5
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

Disabled
Front Port 25 05 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
Rear Port 1 25 06 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
Rear Port 2 25 07 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
Ethernet Port 25 08 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
Courier Tunnel 25 09 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
IEC61850 25 0A Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Disabled
DNP3 OE 25 0B Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

Attempts Remain
Attempts Remain 25 11
[Integer]

Blk Time Remain


Blk Time Remain 25 12
[Integer]

Fallbck PW Level
Fallbck PW Level 25 20 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

Security Code
Security Code 25 FF
[ASCII Text]

CTRL I/P LABELS 29 00


This column contains settings for Control Input Labels
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 1 29 01 Control Input 1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 1 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 2 29 02 Control Input 2
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 2 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 3 29 03 Control Input 3
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 3 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 4 29 04 Control Input 4
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 4 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 5 29 05 Control Input 5
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B91
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting to allow Control Inputs 5 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 6 29 06 Control Input 6
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 6 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 7 29 07 Control Input 7
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 7 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 8 29 08 Control Input 8
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 8 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 9 29 09 Control Input 9
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 9 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 10 29 0A Control Input 10
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 10 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 11 29 0B Control Input 11
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 11 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 12 29 0C Control Input 12
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 12 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 13 29 0D Control Input 13
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 13 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 14 29 0E Control Input 14
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 14 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 15 29 0F Control Input 15
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 15 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 16 29 10 Control Input 16
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 16 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 17 29 11 Control Input 17
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 17 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 18 29 12 Control Input 18
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 18 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 19 29 13 Control Input 19
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 19 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 20 29 14 Control Input 20
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 20 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 21 29 15 Control Input 21
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 21 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 22 29 16 Control Input 22
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 22 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 23 29 17 Control Input 23
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 23 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 24 29 18 Control Input 24
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 24 set/ reset.
Control Input 25 29 19 Control Input 25 From 32 to 163 in steps of 1

B92 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 25 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 26 29 1A Control Input 26
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 26 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 27 29 1B Control Input 27
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 27 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 28 29 1C Control Input 28
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 28 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 29 29 1D Control Input 29
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 29 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 30 29 1E Control Input 30
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 30 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 31 29 1F Control Input 31
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 31 set/ reset.
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Control Input 32 29 20 Control Input 32
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Setting to allow Control Inputs 32 set/ reset.
GROUP 1: LINE
30 00
PARAMETERS
This column contains settings for Line Parameters
From 300 to 1000000 in steps of 10
Line Length 30 01 100000
[Courier Number (metres)]
Setting of the protected line/cable length in km. This setting is available if MEASURE’T SETUP column is selected as ‘Visible’ in the
CONFIGURATION column and if ‘Distance unit’ in the MEASURE’T SETUP column is selected as ‘kilometers’.
From 0.05 to 621 in steps of 0.005
Line Length 30 02 62.1
[Courier Number (miles)]
Setting of the protected line/cable length in miles. This setting is available if MEASURE’T SETUP column is selected as ‘Visible’ in the
CONFIGURATION column and if ‘Distance unit’ in the MEASURE’T SETUP column is selected as ‘miles’. Dual step size is provided, for
cables/short lines up to 10 miles the step size is 0.005 miles, 0.01 miles otherwise.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Line Impedance 30 03 10
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for protected line/cable positive sequence impedance in either primary or secondary terms, depending on the Setting Values
reference chosen in the CONFIGURATION column. The set value is used for Fault locator, and for all distance zone reaches calculation if
‘Simple’ setting mode under GROUP x DISTANCE SETUP is selected.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Line Angle 30 04 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the line angle (line positive sequence impedance angle).
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZN Res Comp 30 05 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of the residual compensation factor magnitude, used to extend the ground loop reach by a multiplication factor of (1+ kZN), is
calculated as ratio:
│kZN│ = (Z0 – Z1)/3Z1 where,
Z1 = positive sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
Z0 = zero sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
Setting of the residual compensation factor magnitude, used to extend the ground loop reach by a multiplication factor of (1+ kZN), is
calculated as ratio:
│kZN│ = (Z0 – Z1)/3Z1 where,
Z1 = positive sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
Z0 = zero sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
This setting is a used for Distance protection (when set to simple mode) . If Distance protection is set to Advanced mode, there are individual
settings per Zone in the GROUP x DISTANCE ELEMENTS settings.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 1
kZN Res Angle 30 06 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the residual compensation factor angle (in degrees) is calculated as:

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B93
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
ÐkZN = Ð (Z0 – Z1)/3Z1 where,
Z1 = positive sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
Z0 = zero sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
This setting is a used for Distance protection (when set to simple mode) . If Distance protection is set to Advanced mode, there are individual
settings per Zone in the GROUP x DISTANCE ELEMENTS settings.
Disabled
Mutual Comp 30 07 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Mutual compensation replica used in both, Distance and Fault locator ground fault loops.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
KZm Mutual Set. 30 08 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of the mutual compensation factor kZm magnitude is calculated as a ratio:
|kZm| = ZM0/3Z1 where,
ZM0 = zero sequence mutual impedance for the protected line or cable.
Z1 = positive sequence impedance for the protected line or cable.
Setting kZm is visible if ‘Mutual Comp’ is enabled. This setting is a used for fault locator and Distance protection (when set to simple mode) .
If Distance protection is set to Advanced mode, there are individual settings per Zone in the GROUP x DISTANCE ELEMENTS settings.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 1
KZm Mutual Angle 30 09 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the mutual compensation angle (in degrees) is calculated as:
kZm = ZM0/3Z1
Angle setting kZm is visible if ‘Mutual Comp’ is enabled. This setting is a used for fault locator and Distance protection (when set to simple
mode) . If Distance protection is set to Advanced mode, there are individual settings per Zone in the GROUP x DISTANCE ELEMENTS settings.
From 0 to 2 in steps of 0.1
Mutual Cut Off 30 0A 0
[Courier Number]
Only in models with Distance option. Setting used to eliminate the mutual compensation replica in case when the ratio of neutral current of
the parallel line to the neutral current of the protective line (IMUTUAL/IN) exceeds the setting. This setting is visible only if ‘Mutual Comp’ is
enabled.
Standard ABC
Phase Sequence 30 0B Standard ABC Reverse ACB
[Indexed String]
This setting is used to select whether the 3 phase quantities (V and I) are rotating in the standard ABC sequence, or whether the rotation is in
reverse ACB order. The appropriate selection is required to ensure that all derived sequence components and faulted phase
flagging/targeting are correct.
3 Pole
CB1Tripping Mode 30 0C 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
This setting is used to select the tripping mode. The selection 1 and 3 pole allows single pole tripping for single phase to ground faults, whilst
selection 3 pole converts any trip command(s) to three pole tripping.
3 Pole
CB2Tripping Mode 30 0E 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
This setting is used to select the tripping mode. The selection 1 and 3 pole allows single pole tripping for single phase to ground faults, whilst
selection 3 pole converts any trip command(s) to three pole tripping.
From 0*I2 to 0.01*I2 in steps of 0.0001
Line Charging Y 30 10 0.002
[Courier Number (inverse ohms)]
Setting for protected lines’ total susceptance in either primary or secondary terms, depending on the Setting Values reference chosen in the
CONFIGURATION column. The set value is used to calculate the compensated overvoltage if ‘V1>1 Cmp Funct’ setting is enabled under
GROUP x VOLT PROTECTION.
GROUP 1: DISTANCE
31 00
SETUP
This column contains settings for Distance Setup
Simple
Setting Mode 31 0C Simple Advanced
[Indexed String]
Setting to select setting mode for Distance protection, depending on type of application and user preferences.
‘Simple’ mode:
‘Simple’ setting mode is the default setting mode, suitable for the majority of applications. Instead of entering distance zone impedance
reaches in ohms, zone settings are simply entered in terms of percentage of the protected line data specified in the ‘GROUP x LINE
PARAMETERS/Line Impedance’ setting. The setting assumes that the residual compensation factor is equal for all zones. The relay auto
calculates the required reaches from the percentages. The calculated zone reaches are available for viewing but a user can not alter/change

B94 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
the value as long as ‘Simple’ mode setting remains active.
Advanced setting mode:
‘Advanced’ setting mode allows individual distance ohmic reaches and residual compensation factors to be entered for each zone. When
‘Advanced’ mode is selected, all ‘percentage’ settings that are associated to ‘Simple’ setting mode in the column GROUP x DISTANCE SETUP
will be hidden and the Distance zone settings need to be entered for each zone in the ‘GROUP x DIST. ELEMENTS’ column.
PHASE DISTANCE 31 10

Disabled
Mho
Quadrilateral
Phase Chars. 31 11 Mho
Disabled
Mho
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable (turn off) phase distance protection or to set Mho or Quad operating characteristic: ANSI 21P.
The chosen setting is applicable to all phase distance zones.
Common
Quad Resistance 31 12 Proportional Proportional
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the mode of resistive reach coverage. If ‘Common’ mode is selected, all phase distance zones will have the equal resistive
coverage. If ‘Proportional’ mode is selected, the zones will have resistive coverage according to the % reach set for the zone, multiplied by
the ‘Fault Resistance’ RPH setting.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
From 0.1*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Fault Resistance 31 13 10
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting used to specify the fault arc resistance that can be detected for faults between phases. The set value determines the right hand side
of the quadrilaterals.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 1 Ph Status 31 20 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z1 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 1 Ph Reach 31 21 80
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 1 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 2 Ph Status 31 30 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z2 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 2 Ph Reach 31 31 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 2 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 3 Ph Status 31 40 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z3 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 3 Ph Reach 31 41 250
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 3 forward reach in ohms.
Disabled
Zone 3 Ph Offset 31 42 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B95
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 3 offset
reach for phase faults.
By default, Z3 Mho phase characteristic is offset (partly reverse directional), thus not memory/cross polarized. ‘If Z3 Gnd Offset’ is disabled, Z3
Mho characteristic becomes memory/cross polarized like all other zones.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Z3Ph Rev Reach 31 43 10
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 3 reverse reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone P Ph Status 31 50 Disabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) ZP for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
Forward
Zone P Ph Dir. 31 51 Forward Reverse
[Indexed String]
To directionalize Zone P forward or reverse.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone P Ph Reach 31 52 200
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone P forward or reverse reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 4 Ph Status 31 60 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z4 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 4 Ph Reach 31 61 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets reverse Zone 4 reach in ohms.
GROUND DISTANCE 31 70

Disabled
Mho
Quadrilateral
Ground Chars. 31 71 Mho
Disabled
Mho
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable (turn off) ground distance protection or to set Mho or Quad operating characteristic: ANSI 21G.
The chosen setting is applicable to all ground distance zones.
Common
Quad Resistance 31 72 Proportional Proportional
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the mode of resistive reach coverage. If ‘Common’ mode is selected, all ground distance zones will have the equal resistive
coverage. If ‘Proportional’ mode is selected, the zones will have resistive coverage according to the % reach set for the zone, multiplied by
the ‘Fault Resistance’ RG setting.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
From 0.1*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Fault Resistance 31 73 10
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting used to specify the fault arc resistance that can be detected for faults phase - ground. The set value determines the right hand side
of the quadrilaterals.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 1 Gnd Stat. 31 80 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 1 for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.

B96 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 1 Gnd Reach 31 81 80
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 1 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 2 Gnd Stat. 31 90 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 2 for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 2 Gnd Reach 31 91 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 2 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 3 Gnd Stat. 31 A0 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 3 for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 3 Gnd Reach 31 A1 250
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 3 forward reach in ohms.
Disabled
Zone3 Gnd Offset 31 A2 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 3 offset
reach for ground faults.
By default, Z3 Mho ground characteristic is offset (partly reverse directional), thus not memory/cross polarized. ‘If Z3 Gnd Offset’ is disabled,
Z3 Mho characteristic becomes memory/cross polarized like all other zones.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Z3Gnd Rev Reach 31 A3 10
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 3 reverse reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone P Gnd Stat. 31 B0 Disabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone P for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.
Forward
Zone P Gnd Dir. 31 B1 Forward Reverse
[Indexed String]
To directionalize ZP forward or reverse.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone P Gnd Reach 31 B2 200
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone P forward or reverse reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 4 Gnd Stat. 31 C0 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 4 for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 4 Gnd Reach 31 C1 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets reverse Zone 4 reach in ohms.
Standard
Digital Filter 31 D0 Standard Special Applics.
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable (activate) ‘Standard’ or ‘Special Application’ filters. ‘Standard’ filters are the default setting and should be applied in the

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B97
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
majority of applications. It is only the case when the fault currents and voltages may become very distorted by non-fundamental harmonics
that extra filtering is necessary to avoid transient over-reach. In such system conditions the ‘Special Applications’ setting should be applied.
Disabled
Passive
CVT Filters 31 D1 Disabled
Active
[Indexed String]
Setting that accommodates the type of voltage transformer being used to prevent transient over-reach and preserve sub-cycle operating
time whenever possible.
In case of conventional wound VTs, the transients due to voltage collapse during faults are very small and no extra filtering is required,
therefore the setting should be ‘Disabled’ as per default.
For a CVT with active Ferro resonance damping, the voltage distortions may be severe and risk transient over-reach. For that reason, the
‘CVT Filters’ should be set to ‘Active’. Trip times increase proportionally (subcycle up to SIR = 2, gradually lengthening for SIR up to 30).
For a CVT with passive Ferro resonance damping, the voltage distortions are generally small up to SIR of 30. For such applications, ‘CVT
Filters’ should be set ‘Passive’. The relay calculates the SIR and will take marginally longer to trip if the infeed is weak (exceeds the relay’s SIR
setting).
From 5 to 60 in steps of 1
SIR Setting 31 D2 30
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Setting that determines when extra filtering will be applied. If on fault inception the calculated SIR exceeds the ‘SIR Setting’ the relay will
marginally slow down, as otherwise there would be a risk of over-reach.
This setting is visible only when ‘CVT Filters’ is set to ‘Passive’.
Disabled
Load Blinders 31 D3 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting used to activate (enable) or turn off (disable) load blinders.
Load blinders, when enabled, have two main purposes: to prevent tripping due to load encroachment under heavy load condition and detect
very slow moving power swings.
From 0.1*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z< Blinder Imp 31 D4 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting of radius of under-impedance circle.
From 15 to 65 in steps of 1
Load/B Angle 31 D5 45
[Courier Number (angle)]
Angle setting for the two blinder lines boundary with the gradient of the rise or fall with respect to the resistive axis.
From 1*V1 to 70*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
Load Blinder V< 31 D6 15
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Load blinder phase to ground under-voltage setting that overrides the blinder if the measured voltage in the affected phase falls below
setting. Also overrides blinding of phase-phase loops where the phase-phase voltage falls below √3 x (V< setting).
From 0.2 to 5 in steps of 0.1
Dist. Polarizing 31 D7 1
[Courier Number]
The setting defines the composition of polarizing voltage as a mixture of ‘Self’ and ‘Memory’ polarizing voltage. ‘Self’ polarized voltage is
fixed to 1pu and could be mixed with ‘Memory’ polarizing voltage ranging from 0.2pu up to 5pu. The default setting of 1 means that half of
the polarizing voltage is made up from ‘Self’ and the other half from clean ‘Memory’ voltage. Adding more ‘Memory’ voltage will enhance the
resistive coverage of Mho characteristics, whose expansion is defined as:
Mho expansion = [(Dist. Polarizing)/ (Dist. Polarizing + 1)] x Zs
Where Zs is the source impedance.
DELTADIRECTIONAL 31 E0

Disabled
Dir. Status 31 E1 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting used to enable or disable Delta Direction (∆I/∆V).
To enable or disable the delta direction decision used by distance elements. If disabled, the relay uses conventional (non delta) directional
lines.
Disabled
Phase only
AidedDeltaStatus 31 E2 Phase and Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
This setting is only used for channel aided schemes, and is used to select which types of fault Delta Directional Comparison protection to
apply.
When this setting is disabled, Delta V Fwd, Delta V Rev, Delta I Fwd and Delta I Rev are invisible.
This setting is invisible if the Delta Status setting is disabled.

B98 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 0 to 90 in steps of 1
Dir. Char Angle 31 E3 60
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the delta directional decision.
From 1.0*V1 to 30*V1 in steps of 0.1*V1
Dir. V Fwd 31 E4 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting for the minimum delta voltage change to permit the directional forward decision.
From 0.5*V1 to 30*V1 in steps of 0.1*V1
Dir. V Rev 31 E5 4
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting for the minimum delta voltage change to permit the directional reverse decision.
From 0.1*I1 to 10*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
Dir. I Fwd 31 E6 0.1
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting for the minimum delta current change to permit the directional forward decision.
From 0.05*I1 to 10*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
Dir. I Rev 31 E7 0.08
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting for the minimum delta current change to permit the directional reverse decision.
GROUP 1: DIST.
32 00
ELEMENTS
This column contains settings for Distance Elements
PHASE DISTANCE 32 01

From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1


Z1 Ph. Reach 32 02 8
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z1 reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z1 Ph. Angle 32 03 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle for zone 1.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R1 Ph. Resistive 32 07 8
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z1 resistive reach. This setting is only visible if Quad is selected.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z1 Tilt Top Line 32 08 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z1 top reactance line gradient to avoid over-reach for resistive phase faults under heavy load. Minus angle tilts the reactance line
downwards.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z1 Sensit. Iph>1 32 09 0.075
[Courier Number (current)]
Current sensitivity setting for Z1 that must be exceeded in faulted phases if Z1 is to operate.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z2 Ph. Reach 32 10 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z2 reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z2 Ph. Angle 32 11 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle for zone 2.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R2 Ph. Resistive 32 15 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z2 resistive reach.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z2 Tilt Top Line 32 16 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z2 top reactance line gradient.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z2 Sensit. Iph>2 32 17 0.075
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone 2 current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z3 Ph. Reach 32 20 25
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z3 Ph. Angle 32 21 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle for zone 3.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z3' Ph Rev Reach 32 22 1
[Courier Number (impedance)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B99
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting for Z3 offset (reverse) reach. This setting is only visible if ‘Z3 Offset’ is enabled in ‘GROUP x DISTANCE SETUP’.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R3 Ph. Res. Fwd. 32 25 25
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 resistive reach that defines Quad’s right hand line.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R3' Ph. Res. Rev 32 26 1
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 resistive reach that defines Quad’s left hand line. This is settable only if Phase Chars. is Quad and Z3 offset is enabled
otherwise is fixed to 25% of the right hand blinder.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z3 Tilt Top Line 32 27 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z3 top reactance line gradient.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z3 Sensit. Iph>3 32 28 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone 3 current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
ZP Ph. Reach 32 30 20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for ZP reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
ZP Ph. Angle 32 31 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle for zone P.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
RP Ph Resistive 32 35 20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for ZP resistive reach.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
ZP Tilt Top Line 32 36 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of ZP top reactance line gradient.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
ZP Sensit. Iph>P 32 37 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone P current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z4 Ph. Reach 32 40 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z4 reach. This is a common setting for Z4 time delayed and Z4 high speed elements used in blocking schemes and for current
reversal guard.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z4 Ph. Angle 32 41 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle for zone 4.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R4 Ph. Resistive 32 42 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for ZP resistive reach.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z4 Tilt Top Line 32 45 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z4 top reactance line gradient.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z4 Sensit. Iph>4 32 46 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone P current sensitivity.
GROUND DISTANCE 32 50

From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1


Z1 Gnd. Reach 32 51 8
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z1 reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z1 Gnd. Angle 32 52 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle (positive sequence) for zone 1.
Disabled
Z1 Dynamic Tilt 32 53 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables or disables zone 1 top reactance line dynamic tilting. If set enabled, the top line angle will be automatically shifted by
the angle difference between the fault current and negative sequence current, starting from the ‘Z1 Tilt top line’ angle setting – see the next
cell. The zone 1 is allowed only to tilt down. If Dynamic tilting is disabled, the top line will be shifted by the ‘Z1 Tilt top line’ setting
(Predetermined tilting by fixed angle).

B100 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
This setting is visible only when ground characteristic is set to ‘Quad’.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z1 Tilt Top Line 32 54 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the zone 1 tilt angle. Minus angle tilts the reactance line downwards This setting is visible only when the above setting is visible.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZN1 Res. Comp. 32 55 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z1 residual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZN1 Res. Angle 32 56 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z1 residual compensation angle.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZm1 Mut. Comp. 32 57 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z1 mutual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZm1 Mut. Angle 32 58 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z1 mutual compensation angle.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R1 Gnd Resistive 32 59 8
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z1 ground resistive reach. This setting is only visible if Quad is selected.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z1 Sensit Ignd>1 32 5B 0.075
[Courier Number (current)]
Current sensitivity setting for Z1 that must be exceeded in faulted phase and the neutral if Z1 is to operate.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z2 Gnd. Reach 32 60 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z2 reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z2 Gnd. Angle 32 61 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle (positive sequence) for zone 2.
Disabled
Z2 Dynamic Tilt 32 63 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables or disables zone 2 top reactance line dynamic tilting. If set enabled, the top line angle will be automatically shifted by
the angle difference between the fault current and negative sequence current, starting from the ‘Z2 Tilt top line’ angle setting – see the next
cell. The zone 2, as over-reaching zone, is allowed only to tilt up. If Dynamic tilting is disabled, the top line will be shifted by the ‘Z2 Tilt top
line’ setting (Predetermined tilting by fixed angle).
This setting is visible only when ground characteristic is set to ‘Quad’.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z2 Tilt Top Line 32 64 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the zone 2 tilt angle. Minus angle tilts the reactance line downwards This setting is visible only when the above setting is visible.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZN2 Res. Comp. 32 65 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z2 residual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZN2 Res. Angle 32 66 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z2 residual compensation angle.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZm2 Mut. Comp. 32 67 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z2 mutual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZm2 Mut. Angle 32 68 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z2 mutual compensation angle.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R2 Gnd Resistive 32 69 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z2 ground resistive reach.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z2 Sensit Ignd>2 32 6B 0.075
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone 2 current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z3 Gnd. Reach 32 70 25
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 reach.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B101
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z3 Gnd. Angle 32 71 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle (positive sequence) for zone 3.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z3' Gnd Rev Rch 32 72 1
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 offset (reverse) reach. This setting is only visible if ‘Z3 Offset’ is enabled in ‘GROUP x DISTANCE SETUP’.
Disabled
Z3 Dynamic Tilt 32 73 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables or disables Z3 top reactance line dynamic tilting. If set enabled, the top line angle will be automatically shifted by the
angle difference between the fault current and negative sequence current, starting from the ‘Z3 Tilt top line’ angle setting – see the next cell.
The ZP, as over-reaching zone, is allowed only to tilt up. If Dynamic tilting is disabled, the top line will be shifted by the ‘ZP Tilt top line’ setting
(Predetermined tilting by fixed angle).
This setting is visible only when ground characteristic is set to ‘Quad’ and Z3 offset disabled.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z3 Tilt Top Line 32 74 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the Z3 tilt angle. Minus angle tilts the reactance line downwards This setting is visible only when the above setting is visible.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZN3 Res. Comp. 32 75 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z3 residual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZN3 Res. Angle 32 76 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z3 residual compensation angle.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZm3 Mut. Comp. 32 77 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z3 mutual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZm3 Mut. Angle 32 78 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z3 mutual compensation angle.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R3 Gnd. Res. Fwd 32 79 25
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 resistive reach that defines Quad’s right hand line.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R3' Gnd Res. Rev 32 7A 1
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z3 resistive reach that defines Quad’s left hand line. This is settable only if Ground Chars. is Quad and Z3 offset is enabled
otherwise is fixed to 25% of the right hand blinder.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z3 Sensit Ignd>3 32 7C 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone 3 current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
ZP Gnd. Reach 32 80 20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for ZP reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
ZP Gnd. Angle 32 81 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle (positive sequence) for zone P.
Disabled
ZP Dynamic Tilt 32 83 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables or disables ZP top reactance line dynamic tilting. If set enabled, the top line angle will be automatically shifted by the
angle difference between the fault current and negative sequence current, starting from the ‘ZP Tilt top line’ angle setting – see the next cell.
The ZP, as over-reaching zone, is allowed only to tilt up. If Dynamic tilting is disabled, the top line will be shifted by the ‘ZP Tilt top line’ setting
(Predetermined tilting by fixed angle).
This setting is visible only when ground characteristic is set to ‘Quad’.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
ZP Tilt Top Line 32 84 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the ZP tilt angle. Minus angle tilts the reactance line downwards This setting is visible only when the above setting is visible.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZNP Res. Comp. 32 85 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of ZP residual compensation magnitude.
kZNP Res. Angle 32 86 0 From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1

B102 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of ZP residual compensation angle.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZmP Mut. Comp. 32 87 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of ZP mutual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZmP Mut. Angle 32 88 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of ZP mutual compensation angle.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
RP Gnd Resistive 32 89 20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for ZP ground resistive reach.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
ZP Sensit Ignd>P 32 8B 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone P current sensitivity.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Z4 Gnd. Reach 32 90 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z4 reach. This is a common setting for Z4 time delayed and Z4 high speed elements used in blocking schemes and for current
reversal guard.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Z4 Gnd. Angle 32 91 70
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of line angle (positive sequence) for zone 4.
Disabled
Z4 Dynamic Tilt 32 93 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables or disables Z4 top reactance line dynamic tilting. If set enabled, the top line angle will be automatically shifted by the
angle difference between the fault current and negative sequence current, starting from the ‘Z4 Tilt top line’ angle setting – see the next cell.
The Z4, as over-reaching zone, is allowed only to tilt up. If Dynamic tilting is disabled, the top line will be shifted by the ‘Z4 Tilt top line’ setting
(Predetermined tilting by fixed angle).
This setting is visible only when ground characteristic is set to ‘Quad’.
From -30 to 30 in steps of 1
Z4 Tilt Top Line 32 94 -3
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of the Z4 tilt angle. Minus angle tilts the reactance line downwards This setting is visible only when the above setting is visible.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZN4 Res. Comp. 32 95 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z4 residual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZN4 Res. Angle 32 96 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z4 residual compensation angle.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
kZm4 Mut. Comp. 32 97 1
[Courier Number]
Setting of Z4 mutual compensation magnitude.
From -180 to 90 in steps of 0.1
kZm4 Mut. Angle 32 98 0
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of Z4 mutual compensation angle.
From 0.05*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
R4 Gnd Resistive 32 99 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z4 ground resistive reach.
From 0.05*I1 to 2*I1 in steps of 0.005*I1
Z4 Sensit Ignd>4 32 9B 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Zone 4 current sensitivity.
GROUP 1: SCHEME
34 00
LOGIC
This column contains settings for Distance Scheme Logic
Disabled
Phase only
Zone1 Tripping 34 08 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select for which types of fault Zone 1 elements will be applied.
tZ1 Ph. Delay 34 09 0 From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B103
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z1 phase element.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ1 Gnd. Delay 34 0A 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z1 ground element.
Disabled
Phase only
Zone2 Tripping 34 10 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select for which types of fault Zone 2 elements will be applied.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ2 Ph. Delay 34 11 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z2 phase element.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ2 Gnd. Delay 34 12 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z2 ground element.
Disabled
Phase only
Zone3 Tripping 34 18 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select for which types of fault Zone 3 elements will be applied.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ3 Ph. Delay 34 19 0.6
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z3 phase element.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ3 Gnd. Delay 34 1A 0.6
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z3 ground element.
Disabled
Phase only
ZoneP Tripping 34 20 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select for which types of fault Zone P elements will be applied.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZP Ph. Delay 34 21 0.4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for ZP phase element.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZP Gnd. Delay 34 22 0.4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for ZP ground element.
Disabled
Phase only
Zone4 Tripping 34 28 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select for which types of fault Zone 4 elements will be applied.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ4 Ph. Delay 34 29 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z4 phase element.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
tZ4 Gnd. Delay 34 2A 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Z4 ground element.
Disabled
PUR
PUR Unblocking
Aid. 1 Selection 34 41 Disabled POR
POR Unblocking
Blocking 1
Blocking 2

B104 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Prog. Unblocking
Programmable
[Indexed String]
Selection of the generic scheme type for aided channel 1.
Note: POR is equivalent to POTT (permissive overreach transfer trip), PUR is
equivalent to PUTT (permissive underreach transfer trip).
Disabled
Phase only
Aid 1 Distance 34 42 Phase And Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
Setting to select whether distance elements should key the scheme selected as per the previous setting. If set to Disabled, no distance zones
interact with this aided scheme, and basic scheme tripping only applies.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid.1 Dist. Dly 34 43 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Trip time delay for Aided 1 Distance schemes.
Disabled
Aid. 1 DEF 34 44 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to select whether a DEF scheme should be mapped to Aided scheme 1.
(Not applicable where a Permissive Underreaching scheme selection has been made).
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid. 1 DEF Dly. 34 45 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Aided 1 DEF tripping.
3 Pole
Aid. 1 DEF Trip 34 46 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the tripping mode for Aided 1 DEF.
This setting is visible only if tripping mode under GROUP x LINE PARAMETERS/Trip Mode is set to 1 and 3 pole.
Disabled
Aid. 1 Delta 34 47 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to select whether a Delta directional comparison scheme should be mapped to Aided scheme 1.
(Not applicable where a Permissive Underreaching scheme selection has been made).
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid. 1 Delta Dly 34 48 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Aided 1 Delta tripping.
3 Pole
Aid. 1 DeltaTrip 34 49 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines tripping mode for Aided 1 Delta.
This setting is visible only if tripping mode under GROUP x LINE PARAMETERS/ Trip Mode is set to 1 and 3 pole.
From 0 to 0.15 in steps of 0.002
tReversal Guard 34 4A 0.02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the current reversal guard timer. Intended to keep stability on a healthy line, whilst breakers open on a faulted parallel line to
clear the fault.
This setting is visible only when over-reaching or Blocking schemes are selected.
From 0 to 0.1 in steps of 0.002
Unblocking Delay 34 4B 0.05
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after Loss of Guard until unblocking occurs. After the set delay, the relay will respond as though an aided signal has been
received from the remote end.
This setting is visible only when PUR Unblocking, POR Unblocking or Programmable Unblocking schemes are chosen.
Aided / Z1
Any Trip
Send on Trip 34 4C Aided / Z1
None
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the reinforced trip signal for POR Aided 1 scheme.
If selected to: None: No reinforced signal is issued
Aided/Z1: The reinforced signal is issued with aided trip or with Z1 if aided distance scheme is enabled
Any Trip: Signal is reinforced with Any trip (DDB 522)
Weak Infeed 34 50 Disabled Disabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B105
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Echo
Echo and Trip
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines Aided 1 scheme operation in case of weak infeed conditions, where no protection elements detect the fault at the local
end, but an aided channel has been received from the remote end. Setting “Echo” will allow the received signal to be returned to the remote
relay, “Trip” will allow local end tripping after a set delay.
Disabled
WI Sngl Pole Trp 34 51 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Weak Infeed tripping mode. When disabled, any WI trip will be converted to a 3 phase trip.
From 10*V1 to 70*V1 in steps of 5*V1
WI V<Thresh. 34 52 45
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting of Weak Infeed level detector. If phase - ground voltage in any phase drops below the threshold and with insufficient phase current
for the protection to operate, the end is declared as a weak infeed terminal.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
WI Trip Delay 34 53 0.06
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the weak infeed trip time delay.
Z1 Gnd.
Z2 Gnd.
Z4 Gnd.
Z1 Ph.
Z2 Ph.
Custom Send Mask 34 58 1 Z4 Ph.
DEF Fwd.
DEF Rev.
Dir Comp Fwd.
Dir Comp Rev.
[Binary Flag (indexed string)]
Logic Settings that determine the element or group of elements that are sending a permissive signal to the other line end. For the signal to
be sent, the element must operate and a corresponding bit in the matrix must be set to 1 (High).
The above mapping is part of a custom made Aided 1 scheme, and unlike all other schemes that are factory tested, the customer must take
the responsibility for testing and the operation of the scheme.
This setting is visible only if a Programmable or Prog. Unblocking scheme is selected.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Custom Time PU 34 59 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Pick up time delay of DDB signal ‘Aid1 CustomT in’, available in the PSL logic. Once the time delay elapses, the DDB signal ‘Aid1 CustomT out’
will become high.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Custom Time DO 34 5A 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Drop off time delay of DDB signal ‘Aid1 CustomT in’. Once the time delay elapses, the DDB signal ‘Aid1 CustomT out’ will become low.
Note: The timer is a combined hard coded PU/DO timer for Custom Aided scheme 1.
AIDED SCHEME 2 34 60

Disabled
PUR
PUR Unblocking
POR
POR Unblocking
Aid. 2 Selection 34 61 Disabled
Blocking 1
Blocking 2
Prog. Unblocking
Programmable
[Indexed String]
Selection of the generic scheme type for aided channel 2.
Note: POR is equivalent to POTT (permissive overreach transfer trip), PUR is
equivalent to PUTT (permissive underreach transfer trip).
Disabled
Phase only
Aid 2 Distance 34 62 Disabled Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]

B106 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting to select whether distance elements should key the scheme selected as per the previous setting. If set to Disabled, no distance zones
interact with this aided scheme, and basic scheme tripping only applies.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid.2 Dist. Dly 34 63 0.02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Trip time delay for Aided 2 Distance schemes.
Disabled
Aid. 2 DEF 34 64 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to select whether a DEF scheme should be mapped to Aided scheme 2.
(Not applicable where a Permissive Underreaching scheme selection has been made).
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid. 2 DEF Dly. 34 65 0.02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Aided 2 DEF tripping.
3 Pole
Aid. 2 DEF Trip 34 66 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the tripping mode for Aided 2 DEF.
This setting is visible only if tripping mode under GROUP x LINE PARAMETERS/Trip Mode is set to 1 and 3 pole.
Disabled
Aid. 2 Delta 34 67 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to select whether a Delta directional comparison scheme should be mapped to Aided scheme 2.
(Not applicable where a Permissive Underreaching scheme selection has been made).
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Aid. 2 Delta Dly 34 68 0.02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay for Aided 2 Delta tripping.
3 Pole
Aid. 2 DeltaTrip 34 69 3 Pole 1 and 3 Pole
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines tripping mode for Aided 2 Delta.
This setting is visible only if tripping mode under GROUP x LINE PARAMETERS/ Trip Mode is set to 1 and 3 pole.
From 0 to 0.15 in steps of 0.002
tReversal Guard 34 6A 0.02
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the current reversal guard timer. Intended to keep stability on a healthy line, whilst breakers open on a faulted parallel line to
clear the fault.
This setting is visible only when over-reaching or Blocking schemes are selected.
From 0 to 0.1 in steps of 0.002
Unblocking Delay 34 6B 0.05
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay after Loss of Guard until unblocking occurs. After the set delay, the relay will respond as though an aided signal has been
received from the remote end.
This setting is visible only when PUR Unblocking, POR Unblocking or Programmable Unblocking schemes are chosen.
Aided / Z1
Any Trip
Send on Trip 34 6C Aided / Z1
None
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the reinforced trip signal for POR Aided 2 scheme.
If selected to: None: No reinforced signal is issued
Aided/Z1: The reinforced signal is issued with aided trip or with Z1 if aided distance scheme is enabled
Any Trip: Signal is reinforced with Any trip (DDB 522)
Disabled
Echo
Weak Infeed 34 70 Disabled
Echo and Trip
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines Aided 2 scheme operation in case of weak infeed conditions, where no protection elements detect the fault at the local
end, but an aided channel has been received from the remote end. Setting “Echo” will allow the received signal to be returned to the remote
relay, “Trip” will allow local end tripping after a set delay.
Disabled
WI Sngl Pole Trp 34 71 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Weak Infeed tripping mode. When disabled, any WI trip will be converted to a 3 phase trip.
WI V<Thresh. 34 72 45 From 10*V1 to 70*V1 in steps of 5*V1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B107
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting of Weak Infeed level detector. If phase - ground voltage in any phase drops below the threshold and with insufficient phase current
for the protection to operate, the end is declared as a weak infeed terminal.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
WI Trip Delay 34 73 0.06
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the weak infeed trip time delay.
Z1 Gnd.
Z2 Gnd.
Z4 Gnd.
Z1 Ph.
Z2 Ph.
Custom Send Mask 34 78 1 Z4 Ph.
DEF Fwd.
DEF Rev.
Dir Comp Fwd.
Dir Comp Rev.
[Binary Flag (indexed string)]
Logic Settings that determine the element or group of elements that are sending a permissive signal to the other line end. For the signal to
be sent, the element must operate and a corresponding bit in the matrix must be set to 1 (High).
The above mapping is part of a custom made Aided 2 scheme, and unlike all other schemes that are factory tested, the customer must take
the responsibility for testing and the operation of the scheme.
This setting is visible only if a Programmable or Prog. Unblocking scheme is selected.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Custom Time PU 34 79 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Pick up time delay of DDB signal ‘Aid2 CustomT in’, available in the PSL logic. Once the time delay elapses, the DDB signal ‘Aid2 CustomT out’
will become high.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.002
Custom Time DO 34 7A 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Drop off time delay of DDB signal ‘Aid2 CustomT in’. Once the time delay elapses, the DDB signal ‘Aid2 CustomT out’ will become low.
Note: The timer is a combined hard coded PU/DO timer for Custom Aided scheme 2.
Trip on Close 34 80

Disabled
Enabled PoleDead
SOTF Status 34 81 Enabled PoleDead Enabled ExtPulse
En Pdead + Pulse
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables note (turns on) or disables (turns off) a special protection logic which can apply upon line energization. SOTF = Switch
on to Fault.
Note: SOTF can be enabled in three different manners:
1. Enabled Pole Dead. By using pole dead logic detection logic
2. Enabled ExtPulse. By using an external pulse
3. En Pdead + Pulse. By using both
From 0.2 to 1000 in steps of 0.2
SOTF Delay 34 82 110
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
The SOTF Delay is a pick up time delay that starts after opening all 3 poles of a CB. If the CB is then closed after the set time delay has
expired, SOTF protection will be active. SOTF provides enhanced protection for manual closure of the breaker (not for auto-reclosure).
This setting is visible only if Pole Dead or Pdead + Pulse are selected to enable SOTF.
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
SOTF Tripping 34 83 1 Zone P
Zone 4
Current No Volts
[Binary Flag (indexed string)]
Logic Settings that determine the Distance zones that are allowed to operate instantaneously upon line energization. If, for example, Bit 1 is
set to 1 (High), Z2 will operate without waiting for the usual tZ2 time delay should a fault lie within Z2 upon CB closure. It also allows a user
to map ‘Currents No Volt’ option for fast fault clearance upon line energization. SOTF tripping is 3 phase and auto-reclose will be blocked.
Disabled
TOR Status 34 84 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

B108 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting that enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) special protection following
auto-reclosure. When set Enabled, TOR will be activated after the ‘TOC Delay’ has expired, ready for application when an auto-reclose shot
occurs. TOR = Trip on (auto)Reclose.
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
TOR Tripping 34 85 1 Zone P
Zone 4
Current No Volts
[Binary Flag (indexed string)]
Logic Settings that determine the Distance zones that are allowed to operate instantaneously upon line energization. If, for example, Bit 1 is
set to 1 (High), Z2 will operate without waiting for the usual tZ2 time delay should a fault lie within Z2 upon CB closure. It also allows a user
to map ‘Currents No Volt’ option for fast fault clearance upon line reclosure on a permanent fault. TOR tripping is 3 phase and auto-reclose
will be blocked.
From 0.1 to 2s in steps of 0.1
TOC Reset Delay 34 86 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
The TOC Reset Delay is a user settable time window during which TOC protection is available. The time window starts timing upon CB closure
and it is common for SOTF and TOR protection. Once this timer expires after a successful (re)closure, all protection reverts to normal.
From 0.1 to 10s in steps of 0.01
SOTF Pulse 34 87 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
The SOTF Pulse is a user settable time window during which the SOTF protection is available. This setting is visible only if ExtPulse or Pdead +
Pulse are selected to enable SOTF
From 0.05 to 0.2 in steps of 0.01
TOC Delay 34 88 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
The TOC Delay is a user settable time delay following the CB opening after which the TOR becomes active (enabled). The time must be set in
conjunction with the Dead Time setting of the Auto-reclose so that the setting must not exceed the minimum Dead Time setting since both
timers start instantaneously.
Z1 EXTENSION 34 B0

Disabled
Enabled
En. on Ch1 Fail
Z1 Ext Scheme 34 B1 Disabled En. on Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) the Zone 1 Extension scheme. When Enabled, extended Zone 1 will apply unless the
Reset Zone 1 Extension DDB signal is energized. Otherwise, it is possible to enable Z1X when aided scheme channel(s) fail.
From 100 to 200 in steps of 1
Z1 Ext Ph 34 B2 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Extended Z1X phase reach as a percentage of the Z1 phase reach. (Phase resistive reach for Z1X is the same as for Zone 1.)
From 100 to 200 in steps of 1
Z1 Ext Gnd 34 B3 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Extended Z1X ground reach as a percentage of Z1 ground reach. (Ground resistive reach and residual compensation for Z1X is the same as
for Zone 1.)
Loss of Load 34 C0

Disabled
Enabled
En. on Ch1 Fail
LOL Scheme 34 C1 Disabled En. on Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) the Loss of Load scheme. When Enabled, accelerated tripping can apply as the remote
end opens (3-pole trip applications only). Otherwise, it is possible to enable Z1X when aided scheme channel(s) fail.
From 0.05*I1 to 1*I1 in steps of 0.05*I1
LOL <I 34 C3 0.5
[Courier Number (current)]
LOL undercurrent detector that indicates a loss of load condition on the unfaulted phases, indicating that the remote end has just opened.
From 0.01 to 0.1 in steps of 0.01
LoL Window 34 C4 0.04
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B109
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Length of LOL window - the time window in which Zone 2 accelerated tripping can occur following LOL undercurrent detector operation.
GROUP 1:
35 00
OVERCURRENT
This column contains settings for Overcurrent
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
I>1 Status 35 01 Enabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines first stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, I>1 will be enabled permanently or in case of Voltage
Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
I>1 Function 35 02 IEC S Inverse IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the first stage overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I>1 Direction 35 03 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for first stage element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I>1 Current Set 35 04 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for first stage overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>1 Time Delay 35 05 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time-delay for the definite time setting if selected for first stage element. The setting is visible only when DT function is
selected.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
I>1 TMS 35 06 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>1 Time Dial 35 07 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves. The Time Dial (TD) is a multiplier on the
standard curve equation, in order to achieve the required tripping time. The reference curve is based on TD = 1.
Care: Certain manufacturer's use a mid-range value of TD = 5 or 7, so it may be necessary to divide by 5 or 7 to achieve parity.
DT
I>1 Reset Char 35 08 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>1 tRESET 35 09 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
I>2 Status 35 0A Disabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines second stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, I>2 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.

B110 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
I>2 Function 35 0B IEC S Inverse IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the second stage overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I>2 Direction 35 0C Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for second stage element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I>2 Current Set 35 0D 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for second stage overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>2 Time Delay 35 0E 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time-delay for the definite time setting if selected for second stage element. The setting is visible only when DT function is
selected.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
I>2 TMS 35 0F 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>2 Time Dial 35 10 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves. The Time Dial (TD) is a multiplier on the
standard curve equation, in order to achieve the required tripping time. The reference curve is based on TD = 1.
Care: Certain manufacturer's use a mid-range value of TD = 5 or 7, so it may be necessary to divide by 5 or 7 to achieve parity.
DT
I>2 Reset Char 35 11 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>2 tRESET 35 12 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
I>3 Status 35 13 Disabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines third stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, I>3 will be enabled permanently or in case of Voltage
Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I>3 Current Set 35 15 10
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for third stage overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>3 Time Delay 35 16 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for third stage overcurrent element.
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
I>4 Status 35 18 Disabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B111
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting that defines fourth stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, I>4 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I>4 Direction 35 19 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the fourth stage overcurrent element.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I>4 Current Set 35 1A 10
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for fourth stage overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I>4 Time Delay 35 1B 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for fourth stage overcurrent element.
From -95 to 95 in steps of 1
I> Char Angle 35 1C 30
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the directional decision. The setting is visible only when ‘Directional Fwd’ or ‘Directional
Rev’ is set.
VTS Blocks I>1
VTS Blocks I>2
I> Blocking 35 1D 0xF VTS Blocks I>3
VTS Blocks I>4
[Binary Flag (16 bits)]
Logic Settings that determine whether blocking signals from VT supervision affect certain overcurrent stages.
VTS Block – only affects directional overcurrent protection. With the relevant bit set to 1, operation of the Voltage Transformer Supervision
(VTS), will block the stage. When set to 0, the stage will revert to Non-directional upon operation of the VTS.
If I> Status is set ‘Enabled VTS’, no blocking should be selected in order to provide fault clearance by overcurrent protection during the VTS
condition.
GROUP 1: NEG SEQ O/C 36 00
This column contains settings for Negative Sequence overcurrent
Disabled
I2>1 Status 36 10 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage negative sequence element.
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
I2>1 Function 36 11 DT IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the first stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I2>1 Direction 36 12 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for this element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I2>1 Current Set 36 15 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the first stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>1 Time Delay 36 17 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the first stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
I2>1 TMS 36 18 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>1 Time Dial 36 19 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]

B112 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves.
DT
I2>1 Reset Char 36 1C DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>1 tRESET 36 1D 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
I2>2 Status 36 20 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage negative sequence element.
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
I2>2 Function 36 21 DT IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the second stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I2>2 Direction 36 22 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for this element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I2>2 Current Set 36 25 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the second stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>2 Time Delay 36 27 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the second stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
I2>2 TMS 36 28 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>2 Time Dial 36 29 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves.
DT
I2>2 Reset Char 36 2C DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>2 tRESET 36 2D 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
I2>3 Status 36 30 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the third stage negative sequence element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I2>3 Direction 36 32 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for this element.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I2>3 Current Set 36 35 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the third stage negative sequence overcurrent element.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B113
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>3 Time Delay 36 37 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the third stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
Disabled
I2>4 Status 36 40 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the fourth stage negative sequence element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
I2>4 Direction 36 42 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for this element.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
I2>4 Current Set 36 45 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the fourth stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
I2>4 Time Delay 36 47 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the fourth stage negative sequence overcurrent element.
VTS Blocks I2>1
VTS Blocks I2>2
I2> VTS Blocking 36 50 0x0F VTS Blocks I2>3
VTS Blocks I2>4
[Binary Flag (8bits)]
Logic settings that determine whether VT supervision blocks selected negative sequence overcurrent stages. Setting ‘0’ will permit
continued non-directional operation.
From -95 to 95 in steps of 1
I2> Char Angle 36 51 -60
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the directional decision.
From 0.5*V1 to 25*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
I2> V2pol Set 36 52 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting determines the minimum negative sequence voltage threshold that must be present to determine directionality.
GROUP 1: BROKEN
37 00
CONDUCTOR
This column contains settings for Broken Conductor
Disabled
Broken Conductor 37 01 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Enables or disables the broken conductor function.
From 0.2 to 1 in steps of 0.01
I2/I1 Setting 37 02 0.2
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting to determine the pick- up level of the negative to positive sequence current ratio.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.1
I2/I1 Time Delay 37 03 60
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the function operating time delay.
GROUP 1: EARTH FAULT 38 00
This column contains settings for Earth Fault
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
IN>1 Status 38 01 Enabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines first stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, IN>1 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
DT
IEC S Inverse
IN>1 Function 38 25 IEC S Inverse IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse

B114 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
IDG
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the first stage earth fault overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
IN>1 Direction 38 26 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for first stage element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
IN>1 Current Set 38 29 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for first stage overcurrent element
From 1 to 4 in steps of 0.1
IN1>1 IDG Is 38 2A 1.5
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This setting is set as a multiple of “IN>” setting for the IDG curve (Scandinavian) and determines the actual relay current threshold at which
the element starts.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
IN>1 Time Delay 38 2C 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time-delay for the definite time setting if selected for first stage element. The setting is available only when DT function is
selected.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
IN>1 TMS 38 2D 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
IN>1 Time Dial 38 2E 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves. The Time Dial (TD) is a multiplier on the
standard curve equation, in order to achieve the required tripping time. The reference curve is based on TD = 1.
Care: Certain manufacturer's use a mid-range value of TD = 5 or 7, so it may be necessary to divide by 5 or 7 to achieve parity.
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.01
IN1>1 IDG Time 38 30 1.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the IDG curve used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.
DT
IN>1 Reset Char 38 32 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
IN>1 tRESET 38 33 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
IN>2 Status 38 35 Disabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines secondstage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, IN>2 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
IN>2 Function 38 36 IEC S Inverse
IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B115
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
IDG
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the second stage earth fault overcurrent element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
IN>2 Direction 38 37 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for first stage element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
IN>2 Current Set 38 3A 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for second stage overcurrent element
From 1 to 4 in steps of 0.1
IN2>1 IDG Is 38 3B 1.5
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This setting is set as a multiple of “IN>” setting for the IDG curve (Scandinavian) and determines the actual relay current threshold at which
the element starts.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
IN>2 Time Delay 38 3D 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time-delay for the definite time setting if selected for second stage element. The setting is available only when DT function is
selected.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
IN>2 TMS 38 3E 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
IN>2 Time Dial 38 3F 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves. The Time Dial (TD) is a multiplier on the
standard curve equation, in order to achieve the required tripping time. The reference curve is based on TD = 1.
Care: Certain manufacturer's use a mid-range value of TD = 5 or 7, so it may be necessary to divide by 5 or 7 to achieve parity.
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.01
IN2>1 IDG Time 38 41 1.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the IDG curve used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.
DT
IN>2 Reset Char 38 43 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
IN>2 tRESET 38 44 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled VTS
IN>3 Status 38 46 Disabled Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines third stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, IN>3 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
IN>3 Direction 38 47 Directional Fwd
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the earth fault overcurrent element.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
IN>3 Current Set 38 4A 10
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for third stage earth fault overcurrent element.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
IN>3 Time Delay 38 4B 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for third stage earth fault overcurrent element.
Disabled
IN>4 Status 38 4D Disabled Enabled
Enabled VTS

B116 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Enabled Ch Fail
En VTSorCh Fail
En VTSandCh Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines fourth stage overcurrent operating status. Depending of this setting, IN>4 will be enabled permanently or in case of
Voltage Transformer Supervision (fuse fail) operation, or in case of communication channel fail, or a combination (and /or) of both.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
IN>4 Direction 38 4E Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the earth fault overcurrent element.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
IN>4 Current Set 38 51 10
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for fourth stage earth fault overcurrent element.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
IN>4 Time Delay 38 52 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for fourth stage earth fault overcurrent element.
VTS Blocks IN>1
VTS Blocks IN>2
IN> Blocking 38 54 0x00F VTS Blocks IN>3
VTS Blocks IN>4
[Binary Flag (8 bits)]
Logic Settings that determine whether blocking signals from VT supervision affect certain earth fault overcurrent stages.
VTS Block - only affects directional earth fault overcurrent protection. With the relevant bit set to 1, operation of the Voltage Transformer
Supervision (VTS), will block the stage. When set to 0, the stage will revert to Non-directional upon operation of the VTS.
If IN> Status is set ‘Enabled VTS’, no blocking should be selected in order to provide earth fault clearance by earth fault overcurrent
protection during VTS condition.
IN> DIRECTIONAL 38 55

From -95 to 95 in steps of 1


IN> Char Angle 38 56 -60
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the directional decision. The setting is visible only when ‘Directional Fwd’ or ‘Directional
Rev’ is set.
Zero Sequence
IN> Polarisation 38 57 Zero Sequence Neg Sequence
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines whether the directional function uses zero sequence or negative sequence voltage polarizing.
From 0.5*V1 to 40*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
IN> VNpol Set 38 59 1
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting for the minimum zero sequence voltage polarizing quantity for directional decision. Setting is visible only when ‘Zero Sequence’
polarization is set.
From 0.5*V1 to 25*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
IN> V2pol Set 38 5A 1
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting for the minimum negative sequence voltage polarizing quantity for directional decision. Setting is visible only when ‘Negative
Sequence’ polarization is set.
From 0.08*I1 to 1.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
IN> I2pol Set 38 5B 0.08
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting for the minimum negative sequence current polarizing quantity for directional decision. Setting is visible only when ‘Negative
Sequence’ polarization is set.
GROUP 1: AIDED DEF 39 00
This column contains settings for Aided DEF
Disabled
DEF Status 39 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the Directional Earth Fault element that is used in an aided scheme (= ground overcurrent pilot
scheme). This setting is invisible if disabled in ‘CONFIGURATION’ column.
Zero Sequence
DEF Polarizing 39 03 Zero Sequence Neg Sequence
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the method of DEF polarization. Either zero, or negative sequence voltage can be taken as the directional reference.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B117
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
When Zero Sequence is selected, this arms the Virtual Current Polarizing.
From -95 to 95 in steps of 1
DEF Char. Angle 39 04 -60
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the directional decision.
From 0.5*V1 to 40*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
DEF VNpol Set 39 05 1
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting that must be exceeded by generated neutral displacement voltage VN (= 3.Vo) in order for the DEF function to be operational.
As Virtual Current Polarizing will be in force when Zero sequence polarizing is used, this setting will normally have no relevance. If the relay
phase selector (delta sensitivity typically 4% In) detects the faulted phase, this will artificially generate a large VNpol, typically equal to Vn
(phase-ground). Only if the phase selector cannot phase select will this setting be relevant, as VNpol will then measure true VN.
The setting is invisible if ‘Neg. Sequence’ polarization is set.
From 0.5*V1 to 25*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
DEF V2pol Set 39 06 1
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting that must be exceeded by generated negative sequence voltage V2 in order for the DEF function to be operational.
The setting is invisible if ‘Zero Sequence’ polarization is set.
From 0.05*I1 to 1.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
DEF FWD Set 39 07 0.08
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting the forward pickup current sensitivity for residual current (= 3.Io).
From 0.03*I1 to 1.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
DEF REV Set 39 08 0.04
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting the reverse pickup current sensitivity for residual current (= 3.Io).
GROUP 1: SEF/REF
3A 00
PROT'N
This column contains settings for SEF/REF
SEF Enabled
Wattmetric SEF
SEF/REF Options 3A 01 SEF Enabled
Hi Z REF
[Indexed String]
Setting to select the type of sensitive earth fault protection function and the type of high-impedance function to be used.
Disabled
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
ISEF>1 Function 3A 2A DT IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
IDG
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the first stage sensitive earth fault element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
ISEF>1 Direction 3A 2B Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the first stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 0.005*I3 to 0.1*I3 in steps of 0.00025*I3
ISEF>1 Current 3A 2E 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the first stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 1 to 4 in steps of 0.1
ISEF>1 IDG Is 3A 2F 1.5
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This setting is set as a multiple of ISEF> setting for the IDG curve (Scandinavian) and determines the actual relay current threshold at which
the element starts.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>1 Delay 3A 31 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time delay for the first stage definite time element.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
ISEF>1 TMS 3A 32 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.

B118 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>1 Time Dial 3A 33 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves.
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>1 IDG Time 3A 34 1.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the IDG curve used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.
DT
ISEF>1 Reset Chr 3A 36 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>1 tRESET 3A 37 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting to determine the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
DT
IEC S Inverse
IEC V Inverse
IEC E Inverse
UK LT Inverse
ISEF>2 Function 3A 3A Disabled IEEE M Inverse
IEEE V Inverse
IEEE E Inverse
US Inverse
US ST Inverse
IDG
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic for the second stage sensitive earth fault element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
ISEF>2 Direction 3A 3B Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the second stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 0.005*I3 to 0.1*I3 in steps of 0.00025*I3
ISEF>2 Current 3A 3E 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the second stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 1 to 4 in steps of 0.1
ISEF>2 IDG Is 3A 3F 1.5
[Courier Number (decimal)]
This setting is set as a multiple of ISEF> setting for the IDG curve (Scandinavian) and determines the actual relay current threshold at which
the element starts.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>2 Delay 3A 41 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the time delay for the second stage definite time element.
From 0.025 to 1.2 in steps of 0.005
ISEF>2 TMS 3A 42 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier to adjust the operating time of the IEC IDMT characteristic.
From 0.01 to 100 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>2 Time Dial 3A 43 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier to adjust the operating time of the IEEE/US IDMT curves.
From 1 to 2 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>2 IDG Time 3A 44 1.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the IDG curve used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.
DT
ISEF>2 Reset Chr 3A 46 DT Inverse
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine the type of reset/release characteristic of the IEEE/US curves.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>2 tRESET 3A 47 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting to determine the reset/release time for definite time reset characteristic.
Disabled
ISEF>3 Status 3A 49 Disabled
Enabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B119
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the third stage definite time sensitive earth fault element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
ISEF>3 Direction 3A 4A Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the third stage element.
From 0.005*I3 to 0.8*I3 in steps of 0.001*I3
ISEF>3 Current 3A 4D 0.4
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the third stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>3 Delay 3A 4E 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time delay for third stage sensitive earth fault element.
Disabled
ISEF>4 Status 3A 50 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the fourth stage definite time sensitive earth fault element.
Non-Directional
Directional Fwd
ISEF>4 Direction 3A 51 Non-Directional
Directional Rev
[Indexed String]
This setting determines the direction of measurement for the fourth stage element.
From 0.005*I3 to 0.8*I3 in steps of 0.001*I3
ISEF>4 Current 3A 54 0.6
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the fourth stage sensitive earth fault element.
From 0 to 200 in steps of 0.01
ISEF>4 Delay 3A 55 0.25
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time delay for fourth stage sensitive earth fault element.
VTS Blks ISEF>1
VTS Blks ISEF>2
VTS Blks ISEF>3
ISEF> Blocking 3A 57 0x00F VTS Blks ISEF>4
A/R Blks ISEF>3
A/R Blks ISEF>4
[Binary Flag (8 bits)]
Logic Settings that determine whether blocking signals from VT supervision affect certain earth fault overcurrent stages.
VTS Block - only affects sensitive earth fault protection. With the relevant bit set to 1, operation of the Voltage Transformer Supervision (VTS),
will block the stage. When set to 0, the stage will revert to Non-directional upon operation of the VTS.
ISEF DIRECTIONAL 3A 58

From -95 to 95 in steps of 1


ISEF> Char Angle 3A 59 90
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting for the relay characteristic angle used for the directional decision.
From 0.5*V1 to 88*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
ISEF> VNpol Set 3A 5B 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Setting for the minimum zero sequence voltage polarizing quantity required for directional decision.
Wattmetric SEF 3A 5D

From 0.0*V1*I3 to 20*V1*I3 in steps of 0.05*V1*I3


PN> Setting 3A 5E 9
[Courier Number (power Watts)]
Setting for the threshold for the wattmetric component of zero sequence power. The power calculation is as follows:
The PN> setting corresponds to:
Vres x Ires x Cos (φ – φc) = 9 x Vo x Io x Cos (φ– φc)
Where; φ = Angle between the Polarizing Voltage (-Vres) and the Residual Current
φc = Relay Characteristic Angle (RCA) Setting (ISEF> Char Angle)
Vres = Residual Voltage
Ires = Residual Current
Vo = Zero Sequence Voltage
Io = Zero Sequence Current
RESTRICTED E/F 3A 60

B120 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION

From 0.05*I3 to 1.0*I3 in steps of 0.01*I3


IREF> Is 3A 65 0.2
[Courier Number (current)]
Pick-up setting for the High Impedance restricted earth fault element.
Measured
VN Input 3B 01 Derived Derived
[Indexed String]
Data cell indicating the VN Input is always derived from the 3 phase voltages
Disabled
DT
VN>1 Function 3B 02 DT
IDMT
[Indexed String]
Setting for the tripping characteristic of the first stage residual overvoltage element.
From 1*V1 to 50*V1 in steps of 1*V1
VN>1 Voltage Set 3B 03 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Pick-up setting for the first stage residual overvoltage characteristic.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
VN>1 Time Delay 3B 04 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Operating time delay setting for the first stage definite time residual overvoltage element.
From 0.5 to 100 in steps of 0.5
VN>1 TMS 3B 05 1
[Courier Number (Decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IDMT characteristic.
The characteristic is defined as follows:
t = K / ( M – 1)
Where:
K = Time multiplier setting
t = Operating time in seconds
M = Derived residual voltage/relay setting voltage (VN> Voltage Set)
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
VN>1 tReset 3B 06 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting to determine the reset/release definite time for the first stage characteristic
Disabled
VN>2 Status 3B 07 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage definite time residual overvoltage element.
From 1*V1 to 50*V1 in steps of 1*V1
VN>2 Voltage Set 3B 08 10
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Pick-up setting for the second stage residual overvoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
VN>2 Time Delay 3B 09 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Operating time delay for the second stage residual overvoltage element.
GROUP 1: THERMAL
3C 00
OVERLOAD
This column contains settings for Thermal Overload
Disabled
Single
Characteristic 3C 01 Single
Dual
[Indexed String]
Setting for the operating characteristic of the thermal overload element.
From 0.08*I1 to 4.0*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
Thermal Trip 3C 02 1
[Courier Number (current)]
Sets the maximum full load current allowed and the pick-up threshold of the thermal characteristic.
From 50 to 100 in steps of 1
Thermal Alarm 3C 03 70
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting for the thermal state threshold corresponding to a percentage of the trip threshold at which an alarm will be generated.
From 1 to 200 in steps of 1
Time Constant 1 3C 04 10
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting for the thermal time constant for a single time constant characteristic or the first time constant for the dual time constant
characteristic.
Time Constant 2 3C 05 5 From 1 to 200 in steps of 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B121
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting for the second thermal time constant for the dual time constant characteristic.
GROUP 1: POWER
3D 00
SWING
This column contains settings for Power Swing Blocking/Out of Step Tripping
Blocking
Power Swing 3D 01 Blocking Indication
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) Indication or Blocking mode. This setting is invisible if disabled in ‘CONFIGURATION’ column.
If Indication status is selected, the alarm will be issued but tripping by distance protection will be unaffected. When Blocking status is
selected, the user is presented with further options as to which zones do/do not require blocking.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 1 Ph. PSB 3D 03 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z1 phase element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z1 phase characteristic for
more then ‘tZ1 Ph. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z1 phase element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z1 phase element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing is
still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z1 phase element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 2 Ph. PSB 3D 05 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z2 phase element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z2 phase characteristic for
more then ‘tZ2 Ph. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z2 phase element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z2 phase element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing is
still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z2 phase element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 3 Ph. PSB 3D 07 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z3 phase element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z3 phase characteristic for
more then ‘tZ3 Ph. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z3 phase element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z3 phase element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing is
still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z3 phase element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone P Ph. PSB 3D 09 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the ZP phase element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the ZP phase characteristic for
more then ‘tZP Ph. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the ZP phase element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the ZP phase element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing is
still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the ZP phase element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 4 Ph. PSB 3D 0B Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z4 phase element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z4 phase characteristic for
more then ‘tZ4 Ph. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z4 phase element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z4 phase element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing is
still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z4 phase element is unaffected by PSB detection.

B122 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 1 Gnd. PSB 3D 0D Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z1 ground element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z1 ground characteristic for
more then ‘tZ1 Gnd. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z1 ground element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z1 ground element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing
is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z1 ground element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 2 Gnd. PSB 3D 0F Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z2 ground element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z2 ground characteristic for
more then ‘tZ2 Gnd. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z2 ground element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z2 ground element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing
is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z2 ground element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 3 Gnd. PSB 3D 11 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z3 ground element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z3 ground characteristic for
more then ‘tZ3 Gnd. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z3 ground element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z3 ground element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing
is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z3 ground element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone P Gnd. PSB 3D 13 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the ZP ground element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the ZP ground characteristic for
more then ‘tZP Gnd. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the ZP ground element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the ZP ground element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing
is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the ZP ground element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Allow Trip
Blocking
Zone 4 Gnd. PSB 3D 15 Blocking
Delayed Unblock
[Indexed String]
Setting that defines the Z4 ground element operation should any swing impedance enter and remains inside the Z4 ground characteristic for
more then ‘tZ4 Gnd. Delay’.
If Blocking is selected, the Z4 ground element operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing.
If Unblocking is chosen, the Z4 ground element block will be removed after drop off timer ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’ has expired, even if the swing
is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilize.
In ‘Allow trip’ mode, the Z4 ground element is unaffected by PSB detection.
Disabled
PSB Unblocking 3D 20 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) the PSB Unblocking delay timer.
This setting is common to all zones and it is visible if any distance zone is set to ‘PSB Unblocking Dly’. For swing durations longer than this
setting, blocking can be selectively removed.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
PSB Unblock dly 3D 21 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Unblock timer setting - on expiry, power swing blocking can optionally be removed.
From 0.05 to 2 in steps of 0.05
PSB Reset Delay 3D 22 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting to maintain the power swing detection for a period after the delta current detection has reset. ΔI will naturally reset momentarily

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B123
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
twice in each swing cycle, and a short setting ensures continued PSB pick-up, to ride through the gaps.
OST Disabled
OST Predictive Trip
OST Mode 3D 23 OST Disabled
OST Trip
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) Out of Step protection. This setting (and all related settings below) is invisible if PowerSwing Block is
disabled in ‘CONFIGURATION’ column.
If ‘OST Trip’ is selected, relay will operate after Tost time delay if the measured positive sequence impedance has passed the Z6-Z5 region
slower than 25 ms (@ 50 or 60 Hz) and if the polarity of the resistive component has changed between entering and exiting zone 5.
If ‘Predictive OST Trip’ is selected, relay will operate after Tost time delay if the positive sequence impedance has passed the Z6-Z5 region
faster than 25ms but slower than ‘Delta t’ set time.
If ‘Predictive & OST Trip’ is selected, it will operate if any of two above criteria is satisfied.
From 0.1 to 500 in steps of 0.01
Z5 3D 24 30
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z5 forward reactance reach.
From 0.1 to 500 in steps of 0.01
Z6 3D 25 32
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z6 forward reactance reach.
From -500 to -0.1 in steps of 0.01
Z5' 3D 26 -30
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z5 reverse reactance reach.
From -500 to -0.1 in steps of 0.01
Z6' 3D 27 -32
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z6 reverse reactance reach.
From 0.1 to 200 in steps of 0.01
R5 3D 28 20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z5 positive resistive reach.
From 0.1 to 200 in steps of 0.01
R6 3D 29 22
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z6 positive resistive reach.
From -0.1 to -200 in steps of 0.01
R5' 3D 2A -20
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z5 negative resistive reach.
From -0.1 to -200 in steps of 0.01
R6' 3D 2B -22
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting for Z6 negative resistive reach.
From 20 to 90 in steps of 1
Blinder Angle 3D 2C 80
[Courier Number (angle)]
Setting of blinder angle, common for both Z5 and Z6.
From 0.04 to 1 in steps of 0.001
delta T 3D 2D 0.04
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time setting that is compared with the measured time between positive sequence impedance entering Z6 and entering Z5.
From 0 to 1 in steps of 0.01
Tost 3D 2E 0
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Tripping time delay common for any OST setting option.
GROUP 1: VOLT
42 00
PROTECTION
This column contains settings for Voltage protection
UNDER VOLTAGE 42 01

V<1 & V<2 Ph-Ph


V<1 & V<2 Ph-N
V< Measur't Mode 42 02 V<1 & V<2 Ph-Ph V<1Ph-Ph V<2Ph-N
V<1Ph-N V<2Ph-Ph
[Indexed String]
Sets the combination of measured input voltage that will be used for the undervoltage elements.
Note: If any stage is disabled, the associated text in the setting menu cell setting will remain visible but will not affect the operation of the
stage that is enabled.
V<1 & V<2 Any Ph
V< Operate Mode 42 03 V<1 & V<2 Any Ph
V<1 & V<2 3 Phase

B124 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
V<1AnyPh V<2 3Ph
V<1 3Ph V<2AnyPh
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines whether any phase or all three phases has to satisfy the undervoltage criteria before a decision is made.
Note: If any stage is disabled, the associated text in the setting menu cell setting will remain visible but will not affect the operation of the
stage that is enabled.
Disabled
DT
V<1 Function 42 04 DT
IDMT
[Indexed String]
Tripping characteristic for the first stage undervoltage function.
The IDMT characteristic available on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K / (1 - M)
Where:
K = Time multiplier setting
t = Operating time in seconds
M = Measured voltage/relay setting voltage (V< Voltage Set)
From 10*V1 to 120*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V<1 Voltage Set 42 05 80
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the pick-up setting for first stage undervoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V<1 Time Delay 42 06 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the first stage definite time undervoltage element.
From 0.5 to 100 in steps of 0.5
V<1 TMS 42 07 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IDMT characteristic.
Disabled
V<1 Poledead Inh 42 08 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If the cell is enabled, the relevant stage will become inhibited by the pole dead logic. This logic produces an output when it detects either an
open circuit breaker via auxiliary contacts feeding the relay opto inputs or it detects a combination of both undercurrent and undervoltage
on any one phase. It allows the undervoltage protection to reset when the circuit breaker opens to cater for line or bus side VT applications.
Disabled
V<2 Status 42 09 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage undervoltage element.
From 10*V1 to 120*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V<2 Voltage Set 42 0A 60
[Courier Number (voltage)]
This setting determines the pick-up setting for second stage undervoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V<2 Time Delay 42 0B 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the second stage definite time undervoltage element.
Disabled
V<2 Poledead Inh 42 0C Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Similar function to V<1 Poledead Inhibit.
OVERVOLTAGE 42 0D

V>1 & V>2 Ph-Ph


V>1 & V>2 Ph-N
V> Measur't Mode 42 0E V>1 & V>2 Ph-Ph V>1Ph-Ph V>2Ph-N
V>1Ph-N V>2Ph-Ph
[Indexed String]
Sets the combination of measured input voltage that will be used for the overvoltage elements.
Note: If any stage is disabled, the associated text in the setting menu cell setting will remain visible but will not affect the operation of the
stage that is enabled.
V>1 & V>2 Any Ph
V>1 & V>2 3 Phase
V> Operate Mode 42 0F V>1 & V>2 Any Ph V>1AnyPh V>2 3Ph
V>1 3Ph V>2AnyPh
[Indexed String]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B125
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting that determines whether any phase or all three phases has to satisfy the overvoltage criteria before a decision is made.
Note: If any stage is disabled, the associated text in the setting menu cell setting will remain visible but will not affect the operation of the
stage that is enabled.
Disabled
DT
V>1 Function 42 10 DT
IDMT
[Indexed String]
Tripping characteristic setting for the first stage overvoltage element.
The IDMT characteristic available on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K/(M - 1)
Where:
K = Time multiplier setting
t = Operating time in seconds
M = Measured voltage/relay setting voltage (V<>Voltage Set)
From 60*V1 to 185*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V>1 Voltage Set 42 11 130
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the pick-up setting for first stage overvoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V>1 Time Delay 42 12 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the first stage definite time overvoltage element.
From 0.5 to 100 in steps of 0.5
V>1 TMS 42 13 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IDMT characteristic.
Disabled
V>2 Status 42 14 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage overvoltage element.
From 60*V1 to 185*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V>2 Voltage Set 42 15 150
[Courier Number (voltage)]
This setting determines the pick-up setting for the second stage overvoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V>2 Time Delay 42 16 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the second stage definite time overvoltage element.
COMP OVERVOLTAGE 42 20

Disabled
DT
V1>1 Cmp Funct 42 23 Disabled
IDMT
[Indexed String]
Tripping characteristic setting for the first stage compensated overvoltage element.
The IDMT characteristic available on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K/(M - 1)
Where:
K = Time multiplier setting
t = Operating time in seconds
M = Remote calculated voltage/relay setting voltage (V<>Voltage Set)
From 60*V1 to 110*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V1>1 Cmp Vlt Set 42 24 75
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the pick-up setting for first stage overvoltage element. This is set in terms of the phase to neutral voltage.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V1>1 Cmp Tim Dly 42 25 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the first stage definite time compensated overvoltage element.
From 0.5 to 100 in steps of 0.5
V1>1 Cmp TMS 42 26 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IDMT characteristic.
Disabled
V1>2 Cmp Status 42 27 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage compensated overvoltage element.
V1>2 Cmp Vlt Set 42 28 85 From 60*V1 to 110*V1 in steps of 1*V1

B126 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (voltage)]
This setting determines the pick-up setting for the second stage overvoltage element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V1>2 Cmp Tim Dly 42 29 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the second stage definite time compensated overvoltage element.
GROUP 1: FREQ
43 00
PROTECTION
This column contains settings for Frequency
UNDER FREQUENCY 43 01

Disabled
F<1 Status 43 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<1 Setting 43 03 49.5
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the first stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<1 Time Delay 43 04 4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the first stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<2 Status 43 05 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<2 Setting 43 06 49
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the second stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<2 Time Delay 43 07 3
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the second stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<3 Status 43 08 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the third stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<3 Setting 43 09 48.5
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the third stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<3 Time Delay 43 0A 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the third stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<4 Status 43 0B Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the fourth stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<4 Setting 43 0C 48
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the fourth stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<4 Time Delay 43 0D 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the fourth stage underfrequency element.
F<1 U/V Block
F<2 U/V Block
F< Function Link 43 0E 0x0 F<3 U/V Block
F<4 U/V Block
[Binary Flag (4 bits)]
Settings that determines whether undervoltage level (setting CB FAIL & P.DEAD/POLEDEAD VOLTAGE/V< ) signal block the underfrequency
elements.
OVER FREQUENCY 43 0F

F>1 Status 43 10 Enabled Disabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B127
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage overfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F>1 Setting 43 11 50.5
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the first stage overfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F>1 Time Delay 43 12 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the first stage overfrequency element.
Disabled
F>2 Status 43 13 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage overfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F>2 Setting 43 14 51
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the second stage overfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F>2 Time Delay 43 15 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the second stage overfrequency element.
GROUP 1: DF/DT
44 00
PROTECTION
This column contains settings for rate of change of Frequency
6 or 12
df/dt Avg.Cycles 44 01 6
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
This setting is available for calculating the rate of change of frequency measurement over a fixed period of either 6 or 12 cycles.
Disabled
df/dt>1 Status 44 04 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage df/dt element.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
df/dt>1 Setting 44 05 2
[Courier Number (Hz/sec)]
Pick-up setting for the first stage df/dt element.
Negative
Positive
df/dt>1 Dir'n 44 06 Negative
Both
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the element will react to rising or falling frequency conditions respectively, with an incorrect setting being
indicated if the threshold is set to zero.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
df/dt>1 Time 44 07 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Minimum operating time-delay setting for the first stage df/dt element.
Disabled
df/dt>2 Status 44 0B Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage df/dt element.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
df/dt>2 Setting 44 0C 2
[Courier Number (Hz/sec)]
Pick-up setting for the second stage df/dt element.
Negative
Positive
df/dt>2 Dir'n 44 0D Negative
Both
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the element will react to rising or falling frequency conditions respectively, with an incorrect setting being
indicated if the threshold is set to zero.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
df/dt>2 Time 44 0E 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Minimum operating time-delay setting for the second stage df/dt element.
Disabled
df/dt>3 Status 44 12 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]

B128 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Setting to enable or disable the third stage df/dt element.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
df/dt>3 Setting 44 13 2
[Courier Number (Hz/sec)]
Pick-up setting for the third stage df/dt element.
Negative
Positive
df/dt>3 Dir'n 44 14 Negative
Both
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the element will react to rising or falling frequency conditions respectively, with an incorrect setting being
indicated if the threshold is set to zero.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
df/dt>3 Time 44 15 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Minimum operating time-delay setting for the third stage df/dt element.
Disabled
df/dt>4 Status 44 19 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the fourth stage df/dt element.
From 0.1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
df/dt>4 Setting 44 1A 2
[Courier Number (Hz/sec)]
Pick-up setting for the fourth stage df/dt element.
Negative
Positive
df/dt>4 Dir'n 44 1B Negative
Both
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the element will react to rising or falling frequency conditions respectively, with an incorrect setting being
indicated if the threshold is set to zero.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
df/dt>4 Time 44 1C 3
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Minimum operating time-delay setting for the fourth stage df/dt element.
BREAKER FAIL 45 01

Disabled
CB Fail 1 Status 45 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage of the circuit breaker function.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CB Fail 1 Timer 45 03 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker fail timer stage 1, during which breaker opening must be detected. There are timers per phase to cope with
evolving faults, but the timer setting is common.
Disabled
CB Fail 2 Status 45 04 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage of the circuit breaker function.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CB Fail 2 Timer 45 05 0.4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker fail timer stage 2, during which breaker opening must be detected.
I< Only
CB Open & I<
Volt Prot Reset 45 06 Prot Reset & I<
Prot Reset & I<
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines the elements that will reset the circuit breaker fail time for voltage protection function initiated circuit breaker fail
conditions.
I< Only
CB Open & I<
Ext Prot Reset 45 07 Prot Reset & I<
Prot Reset & I<
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines the elements that will reset the circuit breaker fail time for external protection function initiated circuit breaker fail
conditions.
Disabled
WI Prot Reset 45 08 Disabled
Enabled

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B129
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
When Enabled, CB Fail timers will be reset by drop off of a weak infeed trip condition, providing that WI trip logic is activated.
UNDER CURRENT 45 0A

From 0.02*I1 to 3.2*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1


I< Current Set 45 0B 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the circuit breaker fail timer reset current for overcurrent based protection circuit breaker fail initiation. This setting
is also used in the pole dead logic to determine the status of the pole (dead or live).
From 0.001*I3 to 0.8*I3 in steps of 0.0005*I3
ISEF< Current 45 0D 0.02
[Courier Number (current)]
Setting that determines the circuit breaker fail timer reset current for Sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection circuit breaker fail initiation.
PoleDead Voltage 45 0E

From 10*V1 to 40*V1 in steps of 0.1*V1


V< 45 10 38.1
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Under voltage level detector for pole dead detection
GROUP 1: SUPERVISION 46 00
This column contains settings for Voltage and Current Supervision
Measured + MCB
Measured Only
VTS Mode 46 01 Measured + MCB
MCB Only
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines the method to be used to declare VT failure.
Disabled
Blocking
VTS Status 46 02 Blocking
Indication
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the following operations will occur upon detection of VTS.
• VTS set to provide alarm indication only.
• Optional blocking of voltage dependent protection elements.
• Optional conversion of directional overcurrent elements to non-directional protection
(available when set to blocking mode only). These settings are found in the function links cell of the relevant protection element columns in
the menu.
Manual
VTS Reset Mode 46 03 Auto Auto
[Indexed String]
The VTS block will be latched after a user settable time delay ‘VTS Time Delay’. Once the signal has latched then two methods of resetting
are available. The first is manually via the front panel interface (or remote communications) and secondly, when in ‘Auto’ mode, provided the
VTS condition has been removed and the 3 phase voltages have been restored above the phase level detector settings for more than 240 ms.
From 1 to 10 in steps of 0.1
VTS Time Delay 46 04 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the operating time-delay of the element upon detection of a voltage supervision condition.
From 0.08*I1 to 32*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
VTS I> Inhibit 46 05 10
[Courier Number (current)]
The setting is used to override a voltage supervision block in the event of a phase fault occurring on the system that could trigger the
voltage supervision logic.
From 0.05*I1 to 0.5*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
VTS I2> Inhibit 46 06 0.05
[Courier Number (current)]
The setting is used to override a voltage supervision block in the event of a fault occurring on the system with negative sequence current
above this setting which could trigger the voltage supervision logic.
Disabled
Inrush Detection 46 0E Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting is to enable/disable the Inrush Detection used for the Distance protection.
From 10 to 100 in steps of 5
I>2nd Harmonic 46 0F 20
[Courier Number (percentage)]
If the level of second harmonic in any phase current or neutral current exceeds the setting, inrush conditions will be recognized by changing
the status of four DDB signals from low to high in the Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL). The user then has a choice to use them further in
the PSL in accordance with the application.
WI Inhibit 46 11 Enabled Disabled

B130 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) a special feature to cover scenarios when there is a very weak positive or negative
sequence source behind the relay, but the zero sequence infeed is large. Special to stub-end transformer feeding, where the stub end has no
generation, but has solid earthing at a Yd transformer neutral.
From 2 to 3 in steps of 0.2
I0/I2 Setting 46 12 3
[Courier Number (decimal)]
If the ratio of zero sequence current to negative sequence current exceeds the setting, all protection elements such as Distance, DEF and
Delta that could potentially operate during a genuine weak infeed condition will be inhibited. This setting will be visible only if ‘WI Inhibit’ is
enabled.
CT SUPERVISION 46 30

Disabled
Standard / Enabled
CTS Mode 46 31 Disabled I Diff
IDiff + Std
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable, enable the standard (voltage dependant) CTS element
Restrain
CTS Status 46 32 Restrain Indication
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the following operations will occur upon detection of CTS.
• CTS set to provide alarm indication only.
• CTS set to restrain local protection
The settings are visible if CTS Mode is not disabled.
Manual
CTS Reset Mode 46 33 Manual Auto
[Indexed String]
The CTS block will be latched after a user settable time delay ‘CTS Time Delay’. Once the signal has latched then two methods of resetting
are available. The first is manually via the front panel interface (or remote communications) and secondly, when in ‘Auto’ mode, provided the
CTS condition has been removed. The setting is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CTS Time Delay 46 34 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the operating time-delay of the element upon detection of a current transformer supervision condition. The setting
is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
From 0.5*V1 to 22*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
CTS VN< Inhibit 46 35 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
This setting is used to inhibit the current transformer supervision element should the zero sequence voltage exceed this setting. The setting
is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
From 0.08*I1 to 4*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
CTS IN> Set 46 36 0.1
[Courier Number (current)]
This setting determines the level of zero sequence current that must be present for a valid current transformer supervision condition. The
setting is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
GROUP 1: SYSTEM
48 00
CHECKS
This column contains settings for System Checks
VOLTAGE MONITORS 48 14

From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5


Live Line 48 85 32
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Line is considered Live with voltage above this setting.
From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5
Dead Line 48 86 13
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Line is considered Dead with voltage below this setting.
From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5
Live Bus 1 48 87 32
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Bus 1 is considered Live with voltage above this setting.
From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5
Dead Bus 1 48 88 13
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Bus 1 is considered Dead with voltage below this setting.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B131
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5
Live Bus 2 48 89 32
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Bus 2 is considered Live with voltage above this setting.
From 5 to 132 in steps of 0.5
Dead Bus 2 48 8A 13
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Bus 2 is considered Dead with voltage below this setting.
From 5 to 120 in steps of 0.5
CS UV 48 8B 54
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Undervoltage setting decides that System Check Synchronism logic for CB1 will be blocked if V< is one of the selected options in
setting CB1 CS Volt.Blk (48 8 E), and either line or bus voltage is below this setting.
System Check Synchronism for CB2 will be blocked if V< is one of the selected options in setting CB2 CS Volt. Blk (48 9 C), and either line or bus
voltage is below this setting.
From 60 to 200 in steps of 0.5
CS OV 48 8C 130
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Overvoltage setting decides that System Check Synchronism logic for CB1 is blocked if V> is one of the selected options in
setting CB1 CS Volt.Blk (48 8 E), and either line or bus voltage is above this setting.
System Check Synchronism for CB2 is blocked if V> is one of the selected options in setting CB2 CS Volt. Blk (48 9 C), and either line or bus
voltage is above this setting.
Disabled
Sys Checks CB1 48 8D Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable both stages of system checks for reclosing CB1
If Sys Checks CB1 is set to Disabled, all other menu settings associated with synchronism checks for CB1 become invisible, and a DDB (880)
signal SChksInactiveCB1 is set.
None
V<
V>
Vdiff>
CB1 CS Volt. Blk 48 8E V< V< and V>
V< and Vdiff>
V> and Vdiff>
V< V> and Vdiff>
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine which, if any, conditions should block synchronism check for CB1 (undervoltage V<, overvoltage V>, and/or voltage
differential Vdiff etc) for the line and bus voltages.
Disabled
CB1 CS1 Status 48 8F Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the stage 1 synchronism check elements for auto-reclosing and manual closing CB1.
From 0 to 90 in steps of 1
CB1 CS1 Angle 48 90 20
[Courier Number (angle)]
Maximum permitted phase angle between Line and Bus 1 voltages for first stage synchronism check element to reclose CB1.
From 1 to 120 in steps of 0.5
CB1 CS1 VDiff 48 91 6.5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Voltage differential setting decides that stage 1 System Check Synchronism logic for CB1 is blocked if Vdiff> is one of the
selected options in setting CB1 CS Volt. Blk (48 8 E), and voltage magnitude difference between line and bus 1 voltage is above this setting.
Disabled
CB1 CS1 SlipCtrl 48 92 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable blocking of synchronism check stage 1 for reclosing CB1 by excessive frequency difference (slip) between line
and bus voltages
(refer to setting CB1 CS1 SlipFreq).
From 0.005 to 2 in steps of 0.005
CB1 CS1 SlipFreq 48 93 0.05
[Courier Number (frequency)]
If CB1 CS1 SlipCtrl is enabled, synchronism check stage 1 is blocked for reclosing CB1 if measured frequency difference between line and bus
voltages is greater than this setting.
Disabled
CB1 CS2 Status 48 94 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the stage 2 synchronism check elements for auto-reclosing and manual closing CB1.
CB1 CS2 Angle 48 95 20 From 0 to 90 in steps of 1

B132 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (angle)]
Maximum permitted phase angle between Line and Bus 1 voltages for second stage synchronism check element to reclose CB1
From 1 to 120 in steps of 0.5
CB1 CS2 VDiff 48 96 6.5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Voltage differential setting decides that stage 2 System Check Synchronism logic for CB1 is blocked if Vdiff> is one of the
selected options in setting CB1 CS Volt.Blk (48 8 E), and voltage magnitude difference between line and bus 1 voltage is above this setting.
Disabled
CB1 CS2 SlipCtrl 48 97 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable blocking of synchronism check stage 2 for reclosing CB1 by excessive frequency difference (slip) between line
and bus voltages (refer to setting CB1 CS2 SlipFreq)
From 0.005 to 2 in steps of 0.005
CB1 CS2 SlipFreq 48 98 0.05
[Courier Number (frequency)]
If CB1 CS2 SlipCtrl is enabled, synchronism check stage 2 is blocked for reclosing CB1 if measured frequency difference between line and bus
voltages is greater than this setting.
Disabled
CB1 CS2 Adaptive 48 99 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable Adaptive CB closing with System Check Synchronism stage 2 closing for CB1: logic uses set CB1 CI Time to issue
CB1 close command at such a time that the predicted phase angle difference when CB1 main contacts touch is as close as possible to 0
degrees. If Adaptive closing is disabled, the logic issues CB1 close command as soon as phase angle comes within set limit at CB1 CS2 Angle
.
From 0.01 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB1 Cl Time 48 9A 0.05
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
This sets CB1 closing time, from receipt of CB1 close command until main contacts touch.
Disabled
Sys Checks CB2 48 9B Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable both stages of system checks for reclosing CB2.
If Sys Checks CB2 is set to Disabled, all other menu settings associated with synchronism checks for CB2 become invisible, and a DDB (1484)
signal SChksInactiveCB2 is set.
None
V<
V>
Vdiff>
CB2 CS Volt. Blk 48 9C V< V< and V>
V< and Vdiff>
V> and Vdiff>
V< V> and Vdiff>
[Indexed String]
Setting to determine which, if any, conditions should block synchronism check for CB2 (undervoltage V<, overvoltage V>, and/or voltage
differential Vdiff etc) for the line and bus voltages.
Disabled
CB2 CS1 Status 48 9D Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the stage 1 synchronism check elements for auto-reclosing and manual closing CB2.
From 0 to 90 in steps of 1
CB2 CS1 Angle 48 9E 20
[Courier Number (angle)]
Maximum permitted phase angle between Line and Bus 2 voltages for first stage synchronism check element to reclose CB2.
From 1 to 120 in steps of 0.5
CB2 CS1 VDiff 48 9F 6.5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Voltage differential setting decides that stage 1 System Check Synchronism logic for CB2 is blocked if Vdiff> is one of the
selected options in setting CB2 CS Volt. Blk (48 9C), and voltage magnitude difference between line and bus 2 voltage is above this setting.
Disabled
CB2 CS1 SlipCtrl 48 A0 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable blocking of synchronism check stage 1 for reclosing CB2 by excessive frequency difference (slip) between line
and bus voltages (refer to setting CB2 CS1 SlipFreq).
From 0.005 to 2 in steps of 0.005
CB2 CS1 SlipFreq 48 A1 0.05
[Courier Number (frequency)]
If CB2 CS1 SlipCtrl is enabled, synchronism check stage 1 is blocked for reclosing CB2 if measured frequency difference between line and bus

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B133
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
voltages is greater than this setting.
Disabled
CB2 CS2 Status 48 A2 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the stage 2 synchronism check elements for auto-reclosing and manual closing CB2.
From 0 to 90 in steps of 1
CB2 CS2 Angle 48 A3 20
[Courier Number (angle)]
Maximum permitted phase angle between Line and Bus 2 voltages for second stage synchronism check element to reclose CB2.
From 1 to 120 in steps of 0.5
CB2 CS2 VDiff 48 A4 6.5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Check Synch Voltage differential setting decides that stage 2 System Check Synchronism logic for CB2 is blocked if Vdiff> is one of the
selected options in setting CB2 CS Volt. Blk (48 9C), and voltage magnitude difference between line and bus 2 voltage is above this setting.
Disabled
CB2 CS2 SlipCtrl 48 A5 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable blocking of synchronism check stage 2 for reclosing CB2 by excessive frequency difference (slip) between line
and bus voltages (refer to setting CB2 CS2 SlipFreq)
From 0.005 to 2 in steps of 0.005
CB2 CS2 SlipFreq 48 A6 0.05
[Courier Number (frequency)]
If CB2 CS2 SlipCtrl is enabled, synchronism check stage 2 is blocked for reclosing CB2 if measured frequency difference between line and bus
voltages is greater than this setting.
Disabled
CB2 CS2 Adaptive 48 A7 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable Adaptive CB closing with System Check Synchronism stage 2 closing for CB2: logic uses set CB2 CI Time to issue
CB2 close command at such a time that the predicted phase angle difference when CB2 main contacts touch is as close as possible to 0
degrees. If adaptive closing is disabled, the logic issues CB2 close command as soon as phase angle comes within set limit at CB2 CS2 Angle.
From 0.01 to 0.5 in steps of 0.001
CB2 Cl Time 48 A8 0.05
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
This sets CB2 closing time, from receipt of CB2 close command until main contacts touch
MAN SYS CHECKS 48 B0

CB1 Only
CB2 Only
Num CBs 48 B1 CB1 Only
CB1&CB2
[Indexed String]
This setting is only visible if the CB Control by cell (Cell 0701 under CB CONTROL column) is ‘Enabled’.
If visible, the setting dictates which of the circuit breakers (CB1 only, CB2 only, or both CB1 & CB2) can be manually closed.
Disabled
CB1M SC required 48 B2 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any manual (operator-controlled) closure of CB1.
If Enabled, system check is required for closure. If Disabled, system check is not required.
Disabled
CB1M SC CS1 48 B3 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 conditions as listed
under the setting CB1 CS1 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1M SC CS2 48 B4 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 conditions as listed
under the setting CB1 CS2 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1M SC DLLB 48 B5 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the dead line & live bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1M SC LLDB 48 B6 Disabled
Enabled

B134 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the live line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1M SC DLDB 48 B7 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the dead line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2M SC required 48 B8 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any manual (operator-controlled) closure of CB2.
If Enabled, system check is required for closure. If Disabled, system check is not required.
Disabled
CB2M SC CS1 48 B9 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to close by manual control when system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 conditions as listed
under the setting CB2 CS1 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2M SC CS2 48 BA Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to close by manual control when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 conditions as listed
under setting CB2 CS2 status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2M SC DLLB 48 BB Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to close by manual control when the dead line & live bus2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2M SC LLDB 48 BC Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to close by manual control when the live line & dead bus2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2M SC DLDB 48 BD Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to close by manual control when the dead line & dead bus2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
GROUP 1:
49 00
AUTORECLOSE
This column contains settings for Autoreclose
CB1 Only
CB2 Only
Num CBs 49 50 CB1 Only
CB1&CB2
[Courier Number]
Setting defines which CB(s) are active for the specific installation: CB1 only, CB2 only or both CB1 & CB2.
1P
1/3P
AR Mode 49 51 AR 3P 3P
AR Opto
[Indexed String]
If the Num CBs setting (cell 4950 {above} in the AUTORECLOSE column) is set to CB1 Only, or CB2 Only, then this setting determines which
auto-reclose modes are permitted for the circuit breaker : single phase (AR 1P) only, both single phase and three phase (AR 1/3P), three phase
only (AR 3P), or the auto-reclosing mode is controlled by opto input signals (AR Opto) mapped via DDBs (1497) AR Mode 1P and (1498) AR
Mode 3P.
L 1P, F 1P
L 1P, F 3P
L 3P, F 3P
Lead/Foll ARMode 49 53 L 3P, F 3P
L 1/3P, F 1/3P
L 1/3P, F 3P
AR Opto

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B135
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Indexed String]
Setting determines which auto-reclose modes are permitted for leader /follower circuit breakers.
The auto-reclose scheme provides single phase or three phase auto-reclosing of a feeder switched by two circuit breakers. The two circuit
breakers are normally arranged to reclose sequentially with one, designated the ‘Leader’ circuit breaker, reclosing after a set dead time
followed, if the leader CB remains closed, by the second circuit breaker, designated the ‘Follower’ circuit breaker after a further delay
(follower time).
L1P F1P : both leader and follower are configured for single phase auto-reclosing.
L1P F3P : the leader is configured for single phase auto-reclosing, whilst the follower is configured for three phase auto-reclosing.
L3P F3P : both leader and follower are configured for three phase auto-reclosing.
L1/3P F1/3P : both leader and follower are configured for either single phase or three phase auto-reclosing.
L1/3P F3P : the leader is configured for single phase or three phase auto-reclosing, while the follower is configured for three phase auto-
reclosing only.
AR Opto : the auto-reclosing mode of the leader and follower are controlled by opto input signals (Opto) mapped via DDBs (1497) Lead AR 1P,
(1498) Lead AR 3P, (1409) Follower AR 1P, and (1410) Follower AR 3P.
Menu
Opto
Leader Select By 49 55 Menu
Control
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines how the preferred leader CB is selected - can be by menu setting, HMI command or by designated opto input.
If Leader Select By: is set to Leader by Opto, then preferred leader CB is :-
• CB1 if input DDB(1408) CB2 Lead is low, or
• CB2 if input DDB (1408) CB2 Lead is high.
If Leader Select By: is set to Leader by Control, then user control setting CTRL CB2 Lead under CB CONTROL in the IED menu determines the
preferred leader by applying set/reset commands (If Set then CB2 is leader ,If Reset then CB1 is leader).
CB1
Select Leader 49 56 CB1 CB2
[Indexed String]
If Leader Select By is set to Leader by Menu in the previous cell, then setting Select Leader becomes visible, and determines which CB is the
preferred leader.
Disabled
BF if LFail Cls 49 57 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
BF if L Fail Cls = Block Follower reclose if Leader CB Fails to close. This setting determines whether a follower CB should lock out without
reclosing, or continue to reclose, if the leader CB fails to reclose when the leader CB close command is given.
If BF if L Fail Cls is set to Enable, follower CB reclosing is locked out if the leader fails to close.
If BF if L Fail Cls is set to Disable, the follower CB can continue its reclose cycle if the leader CB fails to close. (See also setting Dynamic F/L).
Disabled
Dynamic F/L 49 58 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Dynamic F/L = Dynamic change from follower to leader status during an auto-reclose cycle if the leader CB fails to close.
If setting BF if Lfail Cls is set to Disabled, then setting Dynamic F/L becomes visible and determines whether the follower CB should assume
leader status and reclose immediately if the leader CB should fail to close, or whether it should continue as follower and reclose after the
Follower Time delay.
Dynamic F/L set to Enabled selects immediate follower reclose if the leader CB fails to close;
Dynamic F/L set to Disabled selects the follower to reclose after the Follower Time if leader CB fails to close.
From 1 to 4 in steps of 1
AR Shots 49 59 1
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
This setting determines how many reclose attempts (shots) are permitted for any single fault incident before it is treated as persistent and
auto-reclosing is locked out. For example if AR Shots = 2, a second reclose attempt is initiated if the protection retrips during the reclaim
time following one reclose attempt, but locks out if the protection retrips during the reclaim time after a second reclose attempt.
Allow Autoclose
BAR 2 and 3Ph
Multi Phase AR 49 5C Allow AR
BAR 3 Phase
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether auto-reclosing is permitted or blocked for two phase or three phase faults.
From 0.005 to 5 in steps of 0.005
Discrim Time 49 5D 0.1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Discrim Time = Discriminating Time. This is a setting which determines whether a fault on another phase (evolving or developing fault) after
single phase trip and
auto-reclose has been initiated by a single phase fault stops the single phase cycle and starts a three phase auto-reclose cycle provided this
second fault (evolving fault) occurs BEFORE the Discrimination Time elapsed. It forces a lockout if second fault (evolving fault) occurs AFTER
Discrimination Time has elapsed but before Single Phase Dead Time elapses.

B136 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 0.1 to 200 in steps of 0.1
CB IS Time 49 60 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
CB IS Time = CB In Service Time. This is a timer setting for which a CB must remain closed (and optionally the line be live) before it is
considered to be In Service.
From 0.01 to 1 in steps of 0.01
CB IS MemoryTime 49 61 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
CB IS Memory Time is a timer setting which allows a CB In Service state to be remembered for a short period following changeover of the CB
auxiliary switch contacts to a CB Open state. This may occasionally be necessary for a few types of CB with exceptionally fast acting auxiliary
switch contacts which allow the auto-reclose scheme logic to detect the CB opening before it detects an associated protection operation.
Prot Res
Prot Op
DT Start by Prot 49 62 Prot Res
Disabled
[Indexed String]
DT Start by Prot = Dead Time Start By Protection action. If DT Start by Prot is set to Disable, a dead time start is not directly affected by
protection operation or reset, but is enabled by other conditions or events (see settings: 3PDTStart WhenLD and
DTStart by CB Op).
If DT Start by Prot is set to Protection Op, the dead time starting is enabled when the auto-reclose initiation signal is received from the
protection. If DT Start by Prot is set to Protection Reset, the dead time starting is inhibited until the auto-reclose initiation signal from the
protection resets.
Disabled
3PDTStart WhenLD 49 63 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
3PDTStart When LD = three phase auto-reclose dead time starts when the line has gone dead. If Enabled, the line is required to go dead
before a 3 phase auto-reclose dead time can start. If Disabled, dead time can start when other selected conditions are satisfied, irrespective
of line volts.
Disabled
DTStart by CB Op 49 64 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If Enabled, a dead time start is permitted only when the CB has tripped. If Disabled, a dead time start is permitted when other selected
conditions are satisfied, irrespective of the CB position.
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
Dead Line Time 49 66 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
When 3PDTStart When LD is Enabled, and the line does not go dead within the set Dead Line Time period, then the logic will force the auto-
reclose sequence to lockout after expiry of this time.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
SP AR Dead Time 49 67 0.5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Dead time setting for single phase auto-reclose.
From 0.01 to 300 in steps of 0.01
3P AR DT Shot 1 49 68 0.3
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Dead time setting for three phase auto-reclose (first shot).
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
3P AR DT Shot 2 49 69 60
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Dead time setting for three phase auto-reclose (2nd shot).
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
3P AR DT Shot 3 49 6A 60
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Dead time setting for three phase auto-reclose (3rd shot).
From 1 to 9999 in steps of 1
3P AR DT Shot 4 49 6B 60
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Dead time setting for three phase auto-reclose (4th shot).
From 0.1 to 300 in steps of 0.01
Follower Time 49 6C 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Time delay setting for follower CB reclosing after leader CB has reclosed.
From 1 to 600 in steps of 1
SPAR ReclaimTime 49 6D 60
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Reclaim time setting following single phase auto-reclosure.
From 1 to 600 in steps of 1
3PAR ReclaimTime 49 6E 180
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Reclaim time setting following three phase auto-reclosure.
From 0.01 to 9999 in steps of 0.01
AR CBHealthyTime 49 6F 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B137
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Maximum waiting time to enable CB Closing by auto-reclose.
Input DDBs (436/437) are used for CB1 Healthy & CB2 Healthy respectively to enable CB1 and CB2 Close by auto-reclose.
If the set time runs out with the input DDB: CBx Healthy low (= 0), alarm AR CBx Unhealthy (DDB307 or 329 for CB1 & CB2 respectively) is set
and the CBx auto-reclose sequence is cancelled.
From 0.01 to 9999 in steps of 0.01
AR CheckSyncTime 49 70 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Maximum waiting time for relevant signals CB1L SCOK or CB1F SCOK from system check logic, to enable CB1 Close by auto-reclose.
Same waiting time setting applies to input signals CB2L SCOK or CB2F SCOK to enable CB2 Close by auto-reclose.
If the set time runs out with the input signal CBx SCOK low (= 0), System Check Synchronization fail alarm AR CBx NO C/S (DDB 308 or 330 for
CB1 & CB2 respectively) is set and the CBx auto-reclose sequence is cancelled.
Initiate AR
Z1 AR 49 72 Initiate AR Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of instantaneous zone 1 on AR operation.
(Only in models with distance option)
Initiate AR
Dist Aided AR 49 74 Initiate AR Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the aided distance schemes tripping on AR operation.
(Only in models with distance option)
No Action
Initiate AR
Z2T AR 49 75 Block AR
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of time delayed zone 2 on AR operation. Set Initiate AR if the trip should initiate a cycle, and Block AR if a
time delayed trip should cause lockout. Set No action if Zone 2 tripping should exert no specific logic control on the recloser.
(Only in models with distance option)
No Action
Initiate AR
Z3T AR 49 76 Block AR
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Similar application to Z3T AR. Selection for Zone 3 trips.
(Only in models with distance option)
No Action
Initiate AR
ZPT AR 49 77 Block AR
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Similar application to ZPT AR. Selection for Zone 3 trips.
(Only in models with distance option)
No Action
Initiate AR
Z4T AR 49 78 Block AR
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Similar application to Z4T AR. Selection for Zone 4 trips.
(Only in models with distance option)
Initiate AR
DEF Aided AR 49 79 Block AR Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of aided Directional Earth Fault protection (DEF) on AR operation.
(Only in models with distance option)
Initiate AR
Dir Aided AR 49 7A Block AR Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of aided Directional Comparison protection (DEF) on AR operation.
(Only in models with distance option)
Initiate AR
TOR AR 49 7B Block AR Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of Trip On Reclose (TOR) on AR operation.
(Only in models with distance option)
I>1 AR 49 7C No Action No Action

B138 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Initiate AR
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the first stage overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
I>2 AR 49 7D No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the second stage overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
I>3 AR 49 7E No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the third stage overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
I>4 AR 49 7F No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the fourth stage overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
IN>1 AR 49 80 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the first stage earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
IN>2 AR 49 81 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the second stage earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
IN>3 AR 49 82 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the third stage earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
IN>4 AR 49 83 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the fourth stage earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
ISEF>1 AR 49 84 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the first stage sensitive earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
ISEF>2 AR 49 85 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the second stage sensitive earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
ISEF>3 AR 49 86 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the third stage sensitive earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
No Action
Initiate AR
ISEF>4 AR 49 87 No Action
Block AR
[Indexed String]
Setting that determines impact of the fourth stage sensitive earth fault overcurrent protection on AR operation.
AR SYS CHECKS 49 A5

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B139
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Disabled
CB1L SC all 49 A6 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any auto-reclose of CB1 as leader. If Enabled,
system check is required for some or all reclosures. If Disabled, system check is not required for any reclosures.
Disabled
CB1L SC Shot 1 49 A7 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for the first shot reclosure of CB1 as leader. If
Enabled, system check is required for the first shot reclosure. If Disabled, system check is not required for the first shot reclosure.
Disabled
CB1L SC ClsNoDly 49 A8 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If CB1L SC ClsNoDly is Enabled, CB1 can reclose as leader as soon as the synchro check conditions are satisfied, without waiting for the dead
time to elapse.
This option is sometimes required for the second line end to reclose onto a line with delayed auto-reclosing (typical cycle: first line end
recloses after the dead time with
live bus & dead line, then the second line end recloses immediately with live bus & live line in synchronism).
Disabled
CB1L SC CS1 49 A9 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 criteria as defined
under CB1 CS1 Status settings in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1L SC CS2 49 AA Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 criteria as defined
under the setting CB1 CS2 status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1L SC DLLB 49 AB Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the dead line & live bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1L SC LLDB 49 AC Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the live line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1L SC DLDB 49 AD Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the dead line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2L SC all 49 AE Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as leader when the dead line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2L SC Shot 1 49 AF Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for the first shot reclosure of CB2 as leader. If
Enabled, system check is required for the first shot reclosure. If Disabled, system check is not required for the first shot reclosure.
Disabled
CB2L SC ClsNoDly 49 B0 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
If CB2L SC ClsNoDly is Enabled, CB2 can reclose as leader as soon as the synchro check conditions are satisfied, without waiting for the dead
time to elapse.
This option is sometimes required for the second line end to reclose on a line with delayed auto-reclosing (typical cycle: the first line end
recloses after the dead time with live bus & dead line, then the second line end recloses immediately with live bus & live line in synchronism).
CB2L SC CS1 49 B1 Disabled Disabled

B140 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as leader when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 criteria as defined
under CB2 CS1 Status settings in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2L SC CS2 49 B2 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as leader when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 criteria as defined
under CB2 CS2 Status settings in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2L SC DLLB 49 B3 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as leader when the dead line & live bus 2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2L SC LLDB 49 B4 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as leader when the live line & dead bus 2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB2L SC DLDB 49 B5 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as leader when the dead line & dead bus 2 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1F SC all 49 B6 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any auto-reclose of CB1 as follower. If Enabled,
system check is required for some or all reclosures. If Disabled, system check is not required for any reclosures.
Disabled
CB1F SC Shot 1 49 B7 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for the first shot reclosure of CB1 as follower. If
Enabled, system check is required for the first shot reclosure. If Disabled, system check is not required for the first shot reclosure.
Disabled
CB1F SC CS1 49 B8 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as follower when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 conditions as listed
under setting CB1 CS1 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1F SC CS2 49 B9 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as follower when system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 conditions as listed
under setting CB1 CS2 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS settings.
Disabled
CB1F SC DLLB 49 BA Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as follower when the dead line & live bus1 conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1F SC LLDB 49 BB Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as follower when the live line & dead bus1 conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1F SC DLDB 49 BC Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to auto-reclose as follower when the “dead line” & “dead bus1” conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS
settings.
Disabled
CB2F SC all 49 BD Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any auto-reclose of CB2 as follower. If Enabled,

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B141
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
system check is required for some or all reclosures. If Disabled, system check is not required for any reclosures.
Disabled
CB2F SC Shot 1 49 BE Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for the first shot reclosure of CB2 as follower. If
Enabled, system check is required for the first shot reclosure. If Disabled, system check is not required for the first shot reclosure.
Disabled
CB2F SC CS1 49 BF Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as follower when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 conditions as listed
under setting CB2 CS1 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2F SC CS2 49 C0 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as follower when system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 conditions as listed
under setting CB2 CS2 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS settings.
Disabled
CB2F SC DLLB 49 C1 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as follower when the dead line & live bus 2 conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2F SC LLDB 49 C2 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as follower when the live line & dead bus 2 conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB2F SC DLDB 49 C3 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB2 to auto-reclose as follower when the dead line & dead bus 2 conditions are satisfied in the SYSTEM CHECKS settings.
GROUP 1: INPUT
4A 00
LABELS
This column contains settings for Input Labels
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 1 4A 01 Input L1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 1
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 2 4A 02 Input L2
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 2
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 3 4A 03 Input L3
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 3
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 4 4A 04 Input L4
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 4
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 5 4A 05 Input L5
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 5
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 6 4A 06 Input L6
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 6
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 7 4A 07 Input L7
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 7
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 8 4A 08 Input L8
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 8
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 9 4A 09 Input L9
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 9
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 10 4A 0A Input L0A
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]

B142 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Label for Opto Input 10
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 11 4A 0B Input L0B
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 11
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 12 4A 0C Input L0C
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 12
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 13 4A 0D Input L0D
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 13
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 14 4A 0E Input L0E
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 14
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 15 4A 0F Input L0F
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 15
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 16 4A 10 Input L10
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 16
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 17 4A 11 Input L11
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 17
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 18 4A 12 Input L12
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 18
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 19 4A 13 Input L13
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 19
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 20 4A 14 Input L14
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 20
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 21 4A 15 Input L15
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 21
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 22 4A 16 Input L16
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 22
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 23 4A 17 Input L17
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 23
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Opto Input 24 4A 18 Input L18
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for Opto Input 24
GROUP 1: OUTPUT
4B 00
LABELS
This column contains settings for Output Relay Labels
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 1 4B 01 Output R1
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 1
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 2 4B 02 Output R2
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 2
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 3 4B 03 Output R3
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 3
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 4 4B 04 Output R4
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 4
Relay 5 4B 05 Output R5 From 32 to 163 in steps of 1

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B143
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 5
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 6 4B 06 Output R6
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 6
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 7 4B 07 Output R7
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 7
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 8 4B 08 Output R8
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 8
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 9 4B 09 Output R9
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 9
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 10 4B 0A Output R0A
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 10
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 11 4B 0B Output R0B
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 11
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 12 4B 0C Output R0C
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 12
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 13 4B 0D Output R0D
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 13
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 14 4B 0E Output R0E
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 14
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 15 4B 0F Output R0F
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 15
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 16 4B 10 Output R10
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 16
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 17 4B 11 Output R11
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 17
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 18 4B 12 Output R12
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 18
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 19 4B 13 Output R13
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 19
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 20 4B 14 Output R14
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 20
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 21 4B 15 Output R15
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 21
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 22 4B 16 Output R16
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 22
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 23 4B 17 Output R17
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 23
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 24 4B 18 Output R18
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 24

B144 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 25 4B 19 Output R19
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 25
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 26 4B 1A Output R1A
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 26
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 27 4B 1B Output R1B
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 27
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 28 4B 1C Output R1C
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 28
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 29 4B 1D Output R1D
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 29
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 30 4B 1E Output R1E
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 30
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 31 4B 1F Output R1F
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 31
From 32 to 163 in steps of 1
Relay 32 4B 20 Output R20
[ASCII Text (16 chars)]
Label for output relay 32
Repeat of Group 1
50 00
columns/rows
Protection Settings of Group 2
Repeat of Group 1
70 00
columns/rows
Protection Settings of Group 3
Repeat of Group 1
90 00
columns/rows
Protection Settings of Group 4
From 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Select Record B0 01
[Unsigned Integer(2)]

Faulted Phase
Faulted Phase B0 07
[Binary Flag (8) Indexed String]

1 bit per elementLSB Start Elements 1


Start Elements 1 B0 08
String..MSB String [Binary Flag (32)Indexed String]

1 bit per elementLSB Trip Elements(1)


Trip Elements(1) B0 0A
String..MSB String [Binary Flag (32)Indexed String]

1 bit per elementLSB Fault Alarms


Fault Alarms B0 0C
String..MSB String [Binary Flag (32)Indexed String]

Fault Time
Fault Time B0 0D
[IEC870 Time & Date]

Active Group
Active Group B0 0E
[Unsigned Integer]

System Frequency
System Frequency B0 0F
[Courier Number (frequency)]

Fault Duration
Fault Duration B0 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B145
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION

CB Operate Time
CB Operate Time B0 11
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

Relay Trip Time


Relay Trip Time B0 12
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

Fault Location
Fault Location B0 13
[Courier Number (metres)]

Fault Location
Fault Location B0 14
[Courier Number (miles)]

Fault Location
Fault Location B0 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]

Fault Location
Fault Location B0 16
[Courier Number (percentage)]

CB2 Operate Time


CB2 Operate Time B0 17
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

IA Pre Flt
IA Pre Flt B0 20
[Courier Number (current)]

IA Angle Pre Flt


IA Angle Pre Flt B0 21
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IB Pre Flt
IB Pre Flt B0 22
[Courier Number (current)]

IB Angle Pre Flt


IB Angle Pre Flt B0 23
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IC Pre Flt
IC Pre Flt B0 24
[Courier Number (current)]

IC Angle Pre Flt


IC Angle Pre Flt B0 25
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IN Pre Flt
IN Pre Flt B0 26
[Courier Number (current)]

IN Angle Pre Flt


IN Angle Pre Flt B0 27
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IM Pre Flt
IM Pre Flt B0 28
[Courier Number (current)]

IM Angle Pre Flt


IM Angle Pre Flt B0 29
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VA Pre Flt
VA Pre Flt B0 30
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VA Angle Pre Flt


VA Angle Pre Flt B0 31
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VB Pre Flt B0 32 VB Pre Flt

B146 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VB Angle Pre Flt


VB Angle Pre Flt B0 33
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VC Pre Flt
VC Pre Flt B0 34
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VC Angle Pre Flt


VC Angle Pre Flt B0 35
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VN Pre Flt
VN Pre Flt B0 36
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VN Angle Pre Flt


VN Angle Pre Flt B0 37
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IA Fault
IA Fault B0 40
[Courier Number (current)]

IA Angle Fault
IA Angle Fault B0 41
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IB Fault
IB Fault B0 42
[Courier Number (current)]

IB Angle Fault
IB Angle Fault B0 43
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IC Fault
IC Fault B0 44
[Courier Number (current)]

IC Angle Fault
IC Angle Fault B0 45
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IN Fault
IN Fault B0 46
[Courier Number (current)]

IN Angle Fault
IN Angle Fault B0 47
[Courier Number (degrees)]

IM Fault
IM Fault B0 48
[Courier Number (current)]

IM Angle Fault
IM Angle Fault B0 49
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VA Fault
VA Fault B0 50
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VA Angle Fault
VA Angle Fault B0 51
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VB Fault
VB Fault B0 52
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VB Angle Fault
VB Angle Fault B0 53
[Courier Number (degrees)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B147
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
VC Fault
VC Fault B0 54
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VC Angle Fault
VC Angle Fault B0 55
[Courier Number (degrees)]

VN Fault
VN Fault B0 56
[Courier Number (voltage)]

VN Angle Fault
VN Angle Fault B0 57
[Courier Number (degrees)]

V1 Rem Magnitude
V1 Rem Magnitude B0 98
[Courier Number (current)]

V1 Rem Phase Ang


V1 Rem Phase Ang B0 99
[Courier Number (current)]

From 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


Select Record B1 01
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]

Time & Date


Time & Date B1 02
[IEC Date and Time]

Event Text
Event Text B1 03
[ASCII Text]

Maint Type
Maint Type B1 04
[UINT32]

Maint Data
Maint Data B1 05
[UINT32]

0 or 1
Domain B2 04 PSL Settings
[Indexed String]

From 0 to 3 in steps of 1
Sub-Domain B2 08 Group 1
[Indexed String]

From 0 to 65535 in steps of 1


Version B2 0C 256
[Unsigned Integer (2 Bytes)]

Prepare Rx
Complete Rx
Prepare Tx
Complete Tx
Transfer Mode B2 1C 6 Rx Prepared
Tx Prepared
OK
Error
[Unsigned Integer Indexed String]

Data Transfer B2 20

Recorder Source
Recorder Source B3 02 Samples
[Indexed String]

From -199 to 199 in steps of 1


Select Record B4 01 0
[Unsigned Integer]

B148 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Trigger Time
Trigger Time B4 02
[IEC870 Time & Date]

Active Channels
Active Channels B4 03
[Binary Flag]

Channel Types
Channel Types B4 04
[Binary Flag]

Channel Offsets
Channel Offsets B4 05
[Courier Number (decimal)]

Channel Scaling
Channel Scaling B4 06
[Courier Number (decimal)]

Channel SkewVal
Channel SkewVal B4 07
[Integer]

Channel MinVal
Channel MinVal B4 08
[Integer]

Channel MaxVal
Channel MaxVal B4 09
[Integer]

Format
Format B4 0A
[Unsigned Integer]

Upload
Upload B4 0B
[Unsigned Integer]

No. Of Samples
No. Of Samples B4 10
[Unsigned Integer]

Trig Position
Trig Position B4 11
[Unsigned Integer]

Time Base
Time Base B4 12
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]

Sample Times
Sample Times B4 14
[Unsigned Integer]

Dist. Channel 1
Dist. Channel 1 B4 20
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 2
Dist. Channel 2 B4 21
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 3
Dist. Channel 3 B4 22
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 4
Dist. Channel 4 B4 23
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 5
Dist. Channel 5 B4 24
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 6
Dist. Channel 6 B4 25
[Integer]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B149
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION

Dist. Channel 7
Dist. Channel 7 B4 26
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 8
Dist. Channel 8 B4 27
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 9
Dist. Channel 9 B4 28
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 10
Dist. Channel 10 B4 29
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 11
Dist. Channel 11 B4 2A
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 12
Dist. Channel 12 B4 2B
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 13
Dist. Channel 13 B4 2C
[Integer]

Dist. Channel 31
Dist. Channel 31 B4 3D
[Binary Flag]

Dist. Channel 32
Dist. Channel 32 B4 3E
[Binary Flag]

Cal Soft Version B5 01

Cal Date & Time B5 02

Channel Types B5 03

Cal Coeffs B5 04

Err Count F B6 01

Msg Count F B6 02

Prot Count F B6 03

Slave Count F B6 04

Reset Count F B6 05

Err Count R B6 06

Prot Count R B6 07

Slave Count R B6 08

Busy Count R B6 09

Reset Count R B6 0A

PSL DATA B7 00

B150 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION
Default PSL "model Grp1 PSL Ref
Grp1 PSL Ref B7 01
number" [ASCII Text (32 chars)]

Date/Time
Date/Time B7 02
[IEC870 Date & Time]

Grp1 PSL ID
Grp1 PSL ID B7 03 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]

Default PSL "model Grp2 PSL Ref


Grp2 PSL Ref B7 11
number" [ASCII Text (32 chars)]

Date/Time
Date/Time B7 12
[IEC870 Date & Time]

Grp2 PSL ID
Grp2 PSL ID B7 13 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]

Default PSL "model Grp3 PSL Ref


Grp3 PSL Ref B7 21
number" [ASCII Text (32 chars)]

Date/Time
Date/Time B7 22
[IEC870 Date & Time]

Grp3 PSL ID
Grp3 PSL ID B7 23 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]

Default PSL "model Grp4 PSL Ref


Grp4 PSL Ref B7 31
number" [ASCII Text (32 chars)]

Date/Time
Date/Time B7 32
[IEC870 Date & Time]

Grp4 PSL ID
Grp4 PSL ID B7 33 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]

Record Cntl Ref


Record Cntl Ref BF 01 B300
[Menu Cell(2)]

Record Ext Ref


Record Ext Ref BF 02 B400
[Menu Cell(2)]

Setting Transfer BF 03

Reset Demand BF 04

Block Xfer Ref


Block Xfer Ref BF 06 B200
[Menu Cell(2)]

Read Only Mode


Read Only Mode BF 07
[Unsigned Integer (16)]

8 registers for reading 16 character encryption key


Each register contains a pair of characters
Each register is formatted as follows:-
Encryption Key BF 10 first character of a pair
second character of a pair
Each character is in the Courier range 33 - 122
[ASCII Text (16)]

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B151
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

MENU TEXT COL ROW DEFAULT SETTING AVAILABLE OPTIONS


DESCRIPTION

Connected i/face
Connected i/face BF 11
[Integer]

Security Column
Security Column BF 12 2500
[Menu Cell(2)]

Port Disable
Port Disable BF 13 2505
[Menu Cell(2)]

Port Disable end


Port Disable end BF 14 250B
[Menu Cell(2)]

PW Entry Needed
PW Entry Needed BF 15
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]

B152 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
0 Relay 1 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_1
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 1
1 Relay 2 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_2
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 2
2 Relay 3 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_3
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 3
3 Relay 4 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_4
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 4
4 Relay 5 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_5
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 5
5 Relay 6 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_6
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 6
6 Relay 7 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_7
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 7
7 Relay 8 DDB_OUTPUT_RELAY_8
Assignment of signal to drive output Relay 8
32 Opto 1 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_1
From opto input 1 - when opto energized
33 Opto 2 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_2
From opto input 2 - when opto energized
34 Opto 3 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_3
From opto input 3 - when opto energized
35 Opto 4 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_4
From opto input 4 - when opto energized
36 Opto 5 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_5
From opto input 5 - when opto energized
37 Opto 6 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_6
From opto input 6 - when opto energized
38 Opto 7 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_7
From opto input 7 - when opto energized
39 Opto 8 DDB_OPTO_ISOLATOR_8
From opto input 8 - when opto energized
80 IM Input 1 DDB_INTERIN_1
InterMiCOM Input 1 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
81 IM Input 2 DDB_INTERIN_2
InterMiCOM Input 2 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
82 IM Input 3 DDB_INTERIN_3
InterMiCOM Input 3 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
83 IM Input 4 DDB_INTERIN_4
InterMiCOM Input 4 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
84 IM Input 5 DDB_INTERIN_5
InterMiCOM Input 5 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
85 IM Input 6 DDB_INTERIN_6
InterMiCOM Input 6 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
86 IM Input 7 DDB_INTERIN_7
InterMiCOM Input 7 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
87 IM Input 8 DDB_INTERIN_8
InterMiCOM Input 8 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
88 IM Output 1 DDB_INTEROUT_1
InterMiCOM Output 1 - is an output to the remote line end
89 IM Output 2 DDB_INTEROUT_2
InterMiCOM Output 2 - is an output to the remote line end
90 IM Output 3 DDB_INTEROUT_3
InterMiCOM Output 3 - is an output to the remote line end
91 IM Output 4 DDB_INTEROUT_4
InterMiCOM Output 4 - is an output to the remote line end
92 IM Output 5 DDB_INTEROUT_5
InterMiCOM Output 5 - is an output to the remote line end

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B153
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
93 IM Output 6 DDB_INTEROUT_6
InterMiCOM Output 6 - is an output to the remote line end
94 IM Output 7 DDB_INTEROUT_7
InterMiCOM Output 7 - is an output to the remote line end
95 IM Output 8 DDB_INTEROUT_8
InterMiCOM Output 8 - is an output to the remote line end
96 IM64 Ch1 Input 1 DDB_IM64_CH1_1_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 1 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
97 IM64 Ch1 Input 2 DDB_IM64_CH1_2_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 2 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
98 IM64 Ch1 Input 3 DDB_IM64_CH1_3_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 3 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
99 IM64 Ch1 Input 4 DDB_IM64_CH1_4_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 4 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
100 IM64 Ch1 Input 5 DDB_IM64_CH1_5_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 5 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
101 IM64 Ch1 Input 6 DDB_IM64_CH1_6_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 6 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
102 IM64 Ch1 Input 7 DDB_IM64_CH1_7_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 7 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
103 IM64 Ch1 Input 8 DDB_IM64_CH1_8_IN
IM64 Ch1 input 8 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
104 IM64 Ch2 Input 1 DDB_IM64_CH2_1_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 1 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
105 IM64 Ch2 Input 2 DDB_IM64_CH2_2_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 2 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
106 IM64 Ch2 Input 3 DDB_IM64_CH2_3_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 3 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
107 IM64 Ch2 Input 4 DDB_IM64_CH2_4_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 4 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
108 IM64 Ch2 Input 5 DDB_IM64_CH2_5_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 5 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
109 IM64 Ch2 Input 6 DDB_IM64_CH2_6_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 6 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
110 IM64 Ch2 Input 7 DDB_IM64_CH2_7_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 7 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
111 IM64 Ch2 Input 8 DDB_IM64_CH2_8_IN
IM64 Ch2 input 8 - is driven by a message from the remote line end
112 IM64 Ch1 Output1 DDB_IM64_CH1_1_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 1 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
113 IM64 Ch1 Output2 DDB_IM64_CH1_2_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 2 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
114 IM64 Ch1 Output3 DDB_IM64_CH1_3_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 3 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
115 IM64 Ch1 Output4 DDB_IM64_CH1_4_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 4 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
116 IM64 Ch1 Output5 DDB_IM64_CH1_5_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 5 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
117 IM64 Ch1 Output6 DDB_IM64_CH1_6_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 6 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
118 IM64 Ch1 Output7 DDB_IM64_CH1_7_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 7 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
119 IM64 Ch1 Output8 DDB_IM64_CH1_8_OUT
IM64 Ch1 output 8 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
120 IM64 Ch2 Output1 DDB_IM64_CH2_1_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 1 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
121 IM64 Ch2 Output2 DDB_IM64_CH2_2_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 2 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end

B154 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
122 IM64 Ch2 Output3 DDB_IM64_CH2_3_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 3 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
123 IM64 Ch2 Output4 DDB_IM64_CH2_4_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 4 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
124 IM64 Ch2 Output5 DDB_IM64_CH2_5_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 5 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
125 IM64 Ch2 Output6 DDB_IM64_CH2_6_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 6 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
126 IM64 Ch2 Output7 DDB_IM64_CH2_7_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 7 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
127 IM64 Ch2 Output8 DDB_IM64_CH2_8_OUT
IM64 Ch2 output 8 - mapping what will be sent to the remote line end
128 Relay Cond 1 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_1
Input to relay 1 output conditioner
129 Relay Cond 2 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_2
Input to relay 2 output conditioner
130 Relay Cond 3 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_3
Input to relay 3 output conditioner
131 Relay Cond 4 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_4
Input to relay 4 output conditioner
132 Relay Cond 5 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_5
Input to relay 5 output conditioner
133 Relay Cond 6 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_6
Input to relay 6 output conditioner
134 Relay Cond 7 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_7
Input to relay 7 output conditioner
135 Relay Cond 8 DDB_OUTPUT_CON_8
Input to relay 8 output conditioner
160 Timer in 1 DDB_TIMERIN_1
Input to auxiliary timer 1
161 Timer in 2 DDB_TIMERIN_2
Input to auxiliary timer 2
162 Timer in 3 DDB_TIMERIN_3
Input to auxiliary timer 3
163 Timer in 4 DDB_TIMERIN_4
Input to auxiliary timer 4
164 Timer in 5 DDB_TIMERIN_5
Input to auxiliary timer 5
165 Timer in 6 DDB_TIMERIN_6
Input to auxiliary timer 6
166 Timer in 7 DDB_TIMERIN_7
Input to auxiliary timer 7
167 Timer in 8 DDB_TIMERIN_8
Input to auxiliary timer 8
168 Timer in 9 DDB_TIMERIN_9
Input to auxiliary timer 9
169 Timer in 10 DDB_TIMERIN_10
Input to auxiliary timer 10
170 Timer in 11 DDB_TIMERIN_11
Input to auxiliary timer 11
171 Timer in 12 DDB_TIMERIN_12
Input to auxiliary timer 12
172 Timer in 13 DDB_TIMERIN_13
Input to auxiliary timer 13
173 Timer in 14 DDB_TIMERIN_14
Input to auxiliary timer 14
174 Timer in 15 DDB_TIMERIN_15
Input to auxiliary timer 15

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B155
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
175 Timer in 16 DDB_TIMERIN_16
Input to auxiliary timer 16
176 Timer out 1 DDB_TIMEROUT_1
Output from auxiliary timer 1
177 Timer out 2 DDB_TIMEROUT_2
Output from auxiliary timer 2
178 Timer out 3 DDB_TIMEROUT_3
Output from auxiliary timer 3
179 Timer out 4 DDB_TIMEROUT_4
Output from auxiliary timer 4
180 Timer out 5 DDB_TIMEROUT_5
Output from auxiliary timer 5
181 Timer out 6 DDB_TIMEROUT_6
Output from auxiliary timer 6
182 Timer out 7 DDB_TIMEROUT_7
Output from auxiliary timer 7
183 Timer out 8 DDB_TIMEROUT_8
Output from auxiliary timer 8
184 Timer out 9 DDB_TIMEROUT_9
Output from auxiliary timer 9
185 Timer out 10 DDB_TIMEROUT_10
Output from auxiliary timer 10
186 Timer out 11 DDB_TIMEROUT_11
Output from auxiliary timer 11
187 Timer out 12 DDB_TIMEROUT_12
Output from auxiliary timer 12
188 Timer out 13 DDB_TIMEROUT_13
Output from auxiliary timer 13
189 Timer out 14 DDB_TIMEROUT_14
Output from auxiliary timer 14
190 Timer out 15 DDB_TIMEROUT_15
Output from auxiliary timer 15
191 Timer out 16 DDB_TIMEROUT_16
Output from auxiliary timer 16
192 Control Input 1 DDB_CONTROL_1
Control input 1 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
193 Control Input 2 DDB_CONTROL_2
Control input 2 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
194 Control Input 3 DDB_CONTROL_3
Control input 3 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
195 Control Input 4 DDB_CONTROL_4
Control input 4 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
196 Control Input 5 DDB_CONTROL_5
Control input 5 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
197 Control Input 6 DDB_CONTROL_6
Control input 6 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
198 Control Input 7 DDB_CONTROL_7
Control input 7 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
199 Control Input 8 DDB_CONTROL_8
Control input 8 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
200 Control Input 9 DDB_CONTROL_9
Control input 9 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
201 Control Input 10 DDB_CONTROL_10
Control input 10 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
202 Control Input 11 DDB_CONTROL_11
Control input 11 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
203 Control Input 12 DDB_CONTROL_12
Control input 12 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL

B156 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
204 Control Input 13 DDB_CONTROL_13
Control input 13 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
205 Control Input 14 DDB_CONTROL_14
Control input 14 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
206 Control Input 15 DDB_CONTROL_15
Control input 15 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
207 Control Input 16 DDB_CONTROL_16
Control input 16 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
208 Control Input 17 DDB_CONTROL_17
Control input 17 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
209 Control Input 18 DDB_CONTROL_18
Control input 18 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
210 Control Input 19 DDB_CONTROL_19
Control input 19 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
211 Control Input 20 DDB_CONTROL_20
Control input 20 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
212 Control Input 21 DDB_CONTROL_21
Control input 21 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
213 Control Input 22 DDB_CONTROL_22
Control input 22 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
214 Control Input 23 DDB_CONTROL_23
Control input 23 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
215 Control Input 24 DDB_CONTROL_24
Control input 24 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
216 Control Input 25 DDB_CONTROL_25
Control input 25 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
217 Control Input 26 DDB_CONTROL_26
Control input 26 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
218 Control Input 27 DDB_CONTROL_27
Control input 27 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
219 Control Input 28 DDB_CONTROL_28
Control input 28 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
220 Control Input 29 DDB_CONTROL_29
Control input 29- for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
221 Control Input 30 DDB_CONTROL_30
Control input 30 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
222 Control Input 31 DDB_CONTROL_31
Control input 31 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
223 Control Input 32 DDB_CONTROL_32
Control input 32 - for SCADA and menu commands into PSL
224 Virtual Input 1 DDB_GOOSEIN_1
Virtual Input 1 - received from GOOSE message
225 Virtual Input 2 DDB_GOOSEIN_2
Virtual Input 2 - received from GOOSE message
226 Virtual Input 3 DDB_GOOSEIN_3
Virtual Input 3 - received from GOOSE message
227 Virtual Input 4 DDB_GOOSEIN_4
Virtual Input 4 - received from GOOSE message
228 Virtual Input 5 DDB_GOOSEIN_5
Virtual Input 5 - received from GOOSE message
229 Virtual Input 6 DDB_GOOSEIN_6
Virtual Input 6 - received from GOOSE message
230 Virtual Input 7 DDB_GOOSEIN_7
Virtual Input 7 - received from GOOSE message
231 Virtual Input 8 DDB_GOOSEIN_8
Virtual Input 8 - received from GOOSE message
232 Virtual Input 9 DDB_GOOSEIN_9
Virtual Input 9 - received from GOOSE message

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B157
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
233 Virtual Input 10 DDB_GOOSEIN_10
Virtual Input 10 - received from GOOSE message
234 Virtual Input 11 DDB_GOOSEIN_11
Virtual Input 11 - received from GOOSE message
235 Virtual Input 12 DDB_GOOSEIN_12
Virtual Input 12 - received from GOOSE message
236 Virtual Input 13 DDB_GOOSEIN_13
Virtual Input 13 - received from GOOSE message
237 Virtual Input 14 DDB_GOOSEIN_14
Virtual Input 14 - received from GOOSE message
238 Virtual Input 15 DDB_GOOSEIN_15
Virtual Input 15 - received from GOOSE message
239 Virtual Input 16 DDB_GOOSEIN_16
Virtual Input 16 - received from GOOSE message
240 Virtual Input 17 DDB_GOOSEIN_17
Virtual Input 17 - received from GOOSE message
241 Virtual Input 18 DDB_GOOSEIN_18
Virtual Input 18 - received from GOOSE message
242 Virtual Input 19 DDB_GOOSEIN_19
Virtual Input 19 - received from GOOSE message
243 Virtual Input 20 DDB_GOOSEIN_20
Virtual Input 20 - received from GOOSE message
244 Virtual Input 21 DDB_GOOSEIN_21
Virtual Input 21 - received from GOOSE message
245 Virtual Input 22 DDB_GOOSEIN_22
Virtual Input 22 - received from GOOSE message
246 Virtual Input 23 DDB_GOOSEIN_23
Virtual Input 23 - received from GOOSE message
247 Virtual Input 24 DDB_GOOSEIN_24
Virtual Input 24 - received from GOOSE message
248 Virtual Input 25 DDB_GOOSEIN_25
Virtual Input 25 - received from GOOSE message
249 Virtual Input 26 DDB_GOOSEIN_26
Virtual Input 26 - received from GOOSE message
250 Virtual Input 27 DDB_GOOSEIN_27
Virtual Input 27 - received from GOOSE message
251 Virtual Input 28 DDB_GOOSEIN_28
Virtual Input 28 - received from GOOSE message
252 Virtual Input 29 DDB_GOOSEIN_29
Virtual Input 29 - received from GOOSE message
253 Virtual Input 30 DDB_GOOSEIN_30
Virtual Input 30 - received from GOOSE message
254 Virtual Input 31 DDB_GOOSEIN_31
Virtual Input 31 - received from GOOSE message
255 Virtual Input 32 DDB_GOOSEIN_32
Virtual Input 32 - received from GOOSE message
256 Virtual Output 1 DDB_GOOSEOUT_1
Virtual output 1 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
257 Virtual Output 2 DDB_GOOSEOUT_2
Virtual output 2 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
258 Virtual Output 3 DDB_GOOSEOUT_3
Virtual output 3 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
259 Virtual Output 4 DDB_GOOSEOUT_4
Virtual output 4 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
260 Virtual Output 5 DDB_GOOSEOUT_5
Virtual output 5 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
261 Virtual Output 6 DDB_GOOSEOUT_6
Virtual output 6 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices

B158 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
262 Virtual Output 7 DDB_GOOSEOUT_7
Virtual output 7 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
263 Virtual Output 8 DDB_GOOSEOUT_8
Virtual output 8 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
264 Virtual Output 9 DDB_GOOSEOUT_9
Virtual output 9 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
265 Virtual Output10 DDB_GOOSEOUT_10
Virtual output 10 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
266 Virtual Output11 DDB_GOOSEOUT_11
Virtual output 11 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
267 Virtual Output12 DDB_GOOSEOUT_12
Virtual output 12 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
268 Virtual Output13 DDB_GOOSEOUT_13
Virtual output 13 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
269 Virtual Output14 DDB_GOOSEOUT_14
Virtual output 14 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
270 Virtual Output15 DDB_GOOSEOUT_15
Virtual output 15 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
271 Virtual Output16 DDB_GOOSEOUT_16
Virtual output 16 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
272 Virtual Output17 DDB_GOOSEOUT_17
Virtual output 17 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
273 Virtual Output18 DDB_GOOSEOUT_18
Virtual output 18 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
274 Virtual Output19 DDB_GOOSEOUT_19
Virtual output 19 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
275 Virtual Output20 DDB_GOOSEOUT_20
Virtual output 20 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
276 Virtual Output21 DDB_GOOSEOUT_21
Virtual output 21 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
277 Virtual Output22 DDB_GOOSEOUT_22
Virtual output 22 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
278 Virtual Output23 DDB_GOOSEOUT_23
Virtual output 23 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
279 Virtual Output24 DDB_GOOSEOUT_24
Virtual output 24 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
280 Virtual Output25 DDB_GOOSEOUT_25
Virtual output 25 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
281 Virtual Output26 DDB_GOOSEOUT_26
Virtual output 26 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
282 Virtual Output27 DDB_GOOSEOUT_27
Virtual output 27 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
283 Virtual Output28 DDB_GOOSEOUT_28
Virtual output 28 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
284 Virtual Output29 DDB_GOOSEOUT_29
Virtual output 29 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
285 Virtual Output30 DDB_GOOSEOUT_30
Virtual output 30 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
286 Virtual Output31 DDB_GOOSEOUT_31
Virtual output 31 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
287 Virtual Output32 DDB_GOOSEOUT_32
Virtual output 32 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
288 SG-opto Invalid DDB_ILLEGAL_OPTO_SETTINGS_GROUP
Setting group selection opto inputs have detected an invalid (disabled) settings group
289 Prot'n In Test DDB_OOS_ALARM
Protection in test mode
290 Static Test Mode DDB_STATIC_TEST_MODE
Static test mode option bypasses the delta phase selectors, power swing detection and reverts to conventional directional line and

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B159
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
cross polarization to allow testing with test sets that can not simulate a real fault
291 Test Loopback DDB_LOOPBACK_TEST
Loopback test in service (external or internal)
292 Test IM64 DDB_IM64_TEST_MODE
Indication that relay is in test mode
293 VT Fail Alarm DDB_VTS_INDICATION
VTS indication alarm- failed VT (fuse blow) detected by VT supervision
294 CT1 Fail Alarm DDB_CTS_INDICATION
CT1S indication alarm (CT supervision alarm)
In the cases of two CTs:
- If standard CTS is used, this indication is ON in case of failure on any of the CTs
- If Diff CTS is used this indication is ON in case of failure on CT1
295 CT2 Fail Alarm DDB_CT2S_INDICATION
CT2S indication alarm (CT supervision alarm).
This indication is ON If Diff CTS is used and there is a failure on CT2
297 Power Swing DDB_PSB_ALARM
Powerswing blocking will block any distance zone selected in the setting file
298 CB1 Fail Alarm DDB_BREAKER_FAIL_ALARM
Circuit breaker (CB1) fail alarm
299 CB1 Monitor Alm DDB_CB_MONITOR_ALARM
CB1 Monitor Alarm
300 CB1 Mon LO Alarm DDB_CB_MONITOR_LOCKOUT
CB1 Monitor Lockout Alarm
301 CB1 Status Alm DDB_CB_STATUS_ALARM
CB1 Status Alarm - set when CB1 status is determined by inputs from BOTH 52A and 52B type auxiliary contacts (setting "CB1 Status
Input = 52A&52B-xPole), and both inputs are in the same state (both = 0 or both = 1) for time period => 5sec, indicating a problem with
the auxiliary switch mechanism).
302 CB1 Trip Fail DDB_CB_FAILED_TO_TRIP
CB1 Failed to Trip - alarm set if CB1 does not trip within set Trip Pulse Time when CB1 trip command is issued.
303 CB1 Close Fail DDB_CB_FAILED_TO_CLOSE
CB1 Failed to Close - alarm set if CB1 fails to close within set Close Pulse Time when CB1 close command is issued
304 ManCB1 Unhealthy DDB_CONTROL_CB_UNHEALTHY
Control CB1 Unhealthy - alarm set if CB1 remains "unhealthy" for CB Control set time "CB Healthy Time" when operator controlled CB1
close sequence is initiated. (Please see description for CB Control setting "CB Healthy Time").
305 NoCS CB1ManClose DDB_CONTROL_NO_CHECK_SYNC
Control No Checksync - alarm set if selected system check conditions for manual closing CB1 remain unsatisfied for CB Control set
time "Check Sync Time" when operator controlled CB1 close sequence is initiated. (Please see description for CB Control setting
"Check Sync Time").
306 CB1 AR Lockout DDB_AR_LOCKOUT
Autoclose Lockout/RLY BAR - alarm set when CB1 autoreclose is locked out.
307 AR CB1 Unhealthy DDB_AR_CB_UNHEALTHY
No Healthy (AR) - alarm set if CB1 remains "unhealthy" for Autoreclose set time "CB Healthy Time" when CB1 close sequence is
initiated by autoreclose function. (Please see description for Autoreclose setting "CB Healthy Time").
308 AR CB1 No C/S DDB_AR_NO_CHECK_SYNC
No Check Sync / AR Fail - alarm set if selected system check conditions for autoreclosing CB1 remain unsatisfied for Autoreclose set
time "Check Sync Time" when CB1 close sequence is initiated by autoreclose function. (Please see description for Autoreclose setting
"Check Sync Time").
311 Signalling Fail DDB_SIGNALLING_FAILURE
If a differential protection communication path has remained failed for a period which is longer than the “Comms Fail Timer”, this
alarm is ON
314 IM64 SchemeFail DDB_FIB_IM_SCHEME_FAIL
It indicates that communications between relays are completely lost and therefore IM64 does not work
315 IEEE C37.94 Fail DDB_IEEE_37_94
t will appear in case of at least one of the following: CH1 (or CH2) loss of signal, CH1 (or CH2) PATH_YELLOW or CH1 (or CH2) BAD_RX_N
317 Aid 1 Chan Fail DDB_AIDED1_LGS_ALARM
Aided channel scheme 1 - channel out of service indication, indicating channel failure
318 Aid 2 Chan Fail DDB_AIDED2_LGS_ALARM
Aided channel scheme 2 - channel out of service indication, indicating channel failure
319 F out of Range DDB_FREQ_ALARM

B160 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
Frequency out of range alarm
320 CB2 Fail Alarm DDB_BREAKER_FAIL_ALARM_2
Circuit breaker 2 fail alarm
321 CB2 Monitor Alm DDB_CB2_MONITOR_ALARM
This alarm indicates that DDB CB2 I ^ Maint. Alarm (1113) or DDB CB2 OPs Maint. (1115) or DDB CB2 Time Maint. (1117)
322 CB2 Mon LO Alarm DDB_CB2_MONITOR_LOCKOUT
This alarm indicates that DDB CB2 I ^ Lockout Alarm (1114) or DDB CB Ops Lock (1116) or DDB CB Time lockout (1118)
323 CB2 Status Alm DDB_CB2_STATUS_ALARM
Indication of problems by circuit breaker 2 state monitoring - example defective auxiliary contacts
324 CB2 Trip Fail DDB_CB2_FAILED_TO_TRIP
Circuit breaker 2 failed to trip (after a manual/operator) trip command
325 CB2 Close Fail DDB_CB2_FAILED_TO_CLOSE
Circuit breaker 2 failed to close (after a manual/operator or auto-reclose close command)
326 ManCB2 Unhealthy DDB_CONTROL_CB2_UNHEALTHY
Manual circuit breaker unhealthy output signal indicating that the circuit breaker 2 has not closed successfully after a manual close
command. (A successful close also requires The circuit breaker healthy signal to reappear within the "healthy window" timeout)
327 NoCS CB2ManClose DDB_CONTROL_NO_CHECK_SYNC_2
Indicates that the check synchronism signal has failed to appear for a manual close
328 CB2 AR Lockout DDB_AR_LOCKOUT_2
Indicates an auto-reclose lockout condition - no further auto-reclosures possible until resetting
329 AR CB2 Unhealthy DDB_AR_CB2_UNHEALTHY
Auto-reclose circuit breaker unhealthy signal, output from auto-reclose logic. Indicates during auto-reclose in progress, if the circuit
breaker has to become healthy within the circuit breaker healthy time window
330 AR CB2 No C/S DDB_AR_NO_CHECK_SYNC_2
Indicates during auto-reclose in progress, if system checks have not been satisfied within the check synchronizing time window
331 Invalid AR Mode DDB_INVALID_AR_MODE
AR Mode selected via optos is not supported
333 InValid Mesg Fmt DDB_MESSAGE_FORMAT_FAIL
Invalid Message Format
334 Main Prot. Fail DDB_MAIN_PROTECTION_FAIL
Indicates a failure in differential or distance or DEF
337 Comms Changed DDB_PROT_COMMS_MODE
This is an alarm which indicates that C3794 comms have been changed to standard or vice versa and relay must be rebooted
338 Max Prop. Alarm DDB_MAX_PROP_DELAY_ALARM
Maximum Propagation Delay Alarm
339 Prot'n Disabled DDB_PROTECTION_DISABLED
Protection disabled
340 9-2 Sample Alarm DDB_ALARM_9_2_SAV
Means the abnormal state of IEC 61850-9-2LE sample
342 9-2LE Cfg Alarm DDB_9_2_SAV_CFG_ALARM
This DDB means the IEC 61850-9-2LE configure is wrong
344 SR User Alarm 1 DDB_ALARM_56
Triggers user alarm 1 message to be alarmed on LCD display (self-resetting)
345 SR User Alarm 2 DDB_ALARM_57
Triggers user alarm 2 message to be alarmed on LCD display (self-resetting)
346 SR User Alarm 3 DDB_ALARM_58
Triggers user alarm 3 message to be alarmed on LCD display (self-resetting)
347 SR User Alarm 4 DDB_ALARM_59
Triggers user alarm 4 message to be alarmed on LCD display (self-resetting)
348 MR User Alarm 5 DDB_ALARM_60
Triggers user alarm 5 message to be alarmed on LCD display (manual-resetting)
349 MR User Alarm 6 DDB_ALARM_61
Triggers user alarm 6 message to be alarmed on LCD display (manual-resetting)
350 MR User Alarm 7 DDB_ALARM_62
Triggers user alarm 7 message to be alarmed on LCD display (manual-resetting)
351 MR User Alarm 8 DDB_ALARM_63
Triggers user alarm 8 message to be alarmed on LCD display (manual-resetting)
352 Battery Fail DDB_BATTERY_FAIL

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B161
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
Front panel miniature battery failure - either battery removed from slot, or low voltage
353 Field Volts Fail DDB_FIELD_VOLTS_FAIL
48V field voltage failure
354 Rear Comm 2 Fail DDB_REAR_COMMS_FAIL
Comm2 hardware failure - second rear communications board
355 GOOSE IED Absent DDB_GOOSE_MISSING_IED
The IED is not subscribed to a publishing IED in the current scheme
356 NIC Not Fitted DDB_ECARD_NOT_FITTED
Ethernet board not fitted
357 NIC No Response DDB_NIC_NOT_RESPONDING
Ethernet board not responding
358 NIC Fatal Error DDB_NIC_FATAL_ERROR
Ethernet board unrecoverable error
359 NIC Soft. Reload DDB_NIC_SOFTWARE_RELOAD
Ethernet problem
360 Bad TCP/IP Cfg. DDB_INVALID_NIC_TCPIP_CONFIG
Ethernet problem
361 Bad OSI Config. DDB_INVALID_NIC_OSI_CONFIG
Ethernet problem
362 NIC Link Fail DDB_NIC_LINK_FAIL
Ethernet link lost
363 NIC SW Mis-Match DDB_SW_MISMATCH_ALARM
Ethernet board software not compatible with main CPU
364 IP Addr Conflict DDB_NIC_IP_ADDRESS_CONFLICT
The IP address of the IED is already used by another IED
365 IM Loopback DDB_INTERMICOM_LOOPBACK
EIA(RS)232 InterMiCOM indication that Loopback testing is in progress
366 IM Message Fail DDB_INTERMICOM_MESSAGE
EIA(RS)232 InterMiCOM Message Failure alarm. Setting that is used to alarm for poor channel quality. If during the fixed 1.6 s rolling
window the ratio of invalid messages to the total number of messages that should be received (based upon the ‘Baud Rate’ setting)
exceeds the above threshold, a ‘Message Fail’ alarm will be issued
367 IM Data CD Fail DDB_INTERMICOM_DCD
EIA(RS)232 InterMiCOM Data Channel Detect Fail i.e. modem failure
368 IM Channel Fail DDB_INTERMICOM_CHANNEL
EIA(RS)232 InterMiCOM Channel Failure alarm. No messages were received during the alarm time setting
369 Backup Setting DDB_BACKUP_DATA_IN_USE
This is an alarm that is ON if any setting fail during the setting changing process. If this happens, the relay will use the last known
good setting
370 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_19
Platform Alarm 19
371 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_20
Platform Alarm 20
372 SNTP Failure DDB_SNTP_FAIL_ALARM
SNTP synchronisation fail alarm
373 NIC MemAllocFail DDB_NIC_MEM_ALLOC_FAIL_ALARM
MMS library memory allocation failure
374 PTP Failure DDB_PTP_FAIL_ALARM
IEEE 1588 PTP time synchronisation failure alarm
375 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_24
Platform Alarm 24
376 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_25
Platform Alarm 25
377 BBRAM Failure DDB_BBRAM_VERIFY_FAIL
BBRAM Verify Fail
378 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_27
Platform Alarm 27
379 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_28
Platform Alarm 28

B162 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
380 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_29
Platform Alarm 29
381 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_30
Platform Alarm 30
382 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_31
Platform Alarm 31
383 Reserved DDB_PLATFORM_ALARM_32
Platform Alarm 32
384 Block Zone 1 Gnd DDB_ZONE_1_GND_BLOCK
Zone 1 ground basic scheme blocking
385 Block Zone 1 Phs DDB_ZONE_1_PHS_BLOCK
Zone 1 phase basic scheme blocking
386 Block Zone 2 Gnd DDB_ZONE_2_GND_BLOCK
Zone 2 ground basic scheme blocking
387 Block Zone 2 Phs DDB_ZONE_2_PHS_BLOCK
Zone 2 phase basic scheme blocking
388 Block Zone 3 Gnd DDB_ZONE_3_GND_BLOCK
Zone 3 ground basic scheme blocking
389 Block Zone 3 Phs DDB_ZONE_3_PHS_BLOCK
Zone 3 phase basic scheme blocking
390 Block Zone P Gnd DDB_ZONE_P_GND_BLOCK
Zone P ground basic scheme blocking
391 Block Zone P Phs DDB_ZONE_P_PHS_BLOCK
Zone P phase basic scheme blocking
392 Block Zone 4 Gnd DDB_ZONE_4_GND_BLOCK
Zone 4 ground basic scheme blocking
393 Block Zone 4 Phs DDB_ZONE_4_PHS_BLOCK
Zone 4 phase basic scheme blocking
394 Aid1 InhibitDist DDB_AIDED1_DIST_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block distance aided scheme 1 tripping
395 Aid1 Inhibit DEF DDB_AIDED1_DEF_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block DEF aided scheme 1 tripping
396 Aid1 Inhib Delta DDB_AIDED1_DIR_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block Delta directional aided scheme 1 tripping
397 Aid2 InhibitDist DDB_AIDED2_DIST_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block distance aided scheme 2 tripping
398 Aid2 Inhibit DEF DDB_AIDED2_DEF_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block DEF aided scheme 2 tripping
399 Aid2 Inhibit DIR DDB_AIDED2_DIR_TRIP_INHIBIT
Block Delta directional aided scheme 2 tripping
400 Time Synch DDB_TIMESYNC
Time synchronism by opto pulse
401 I>1 Timer Block DDB_POC_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overcurrent stage 1 time delayed tripped trip
402 I>2 Timer Block DDB_POC_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overcurrent stage 2 time delayed tripped trip
403 I>3 Timer Block DDB_POC_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overcurrent stage 3 time delayed trip
404 I>4 Timer Block DDB_POC_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overcurrent stage 4 time delayed trip
405 IN>1 Timer Block DDB_EF1_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block standby earth fault stage 1 time delayed trip
406 IN>2 Timer Block DDB_EF1_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block standby earth fault stage 2 time delayed trip
407 IN>3 Timer Block DDB_EF1_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block standby earth fault stage 3 time delayed trip
408 IN>4 Timer Block DDB_EF1_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block standby earth fault stage 4 time delayed trip

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B163
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
409 ISEF>1 Timer Blk DDB_SEF_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block sensitive earth fault stage 1 time delayed trip
410 ISEF>2 Timer Blk DDB_SEF_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block sensitive earth fault stage 2 time delayed trip
411 ISEF>3 Timer Blk DDB_SEF_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block sensitive earth fault stage 3 time delayed trip
412 ISEF>4 Timer Blk DDB_SEF_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block sensitive earth fault stage 4 time delayed trip
414 V<1 Timer Block DDB_PUV_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase undervoltage stage 1 time delayed trip
415 V<2 Timer Block DDB_PUV_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase undervoltage stage 2 time delayed trip
416 V>1 Timer Block DDB_POV_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overvoltage stage 1 time delayed trip
417 V>2 Timer Block DDB_POV_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block phase overvoltage stage 2 time delayed trip
418 VN>1 Timer Blk DDB_RESOV_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block residual overvoltage stage 1 time delayed trip
419 VN>2 Timer Blk DDB_RESOV_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block residual overvoltage stage 2 time delayed trip
420 CB1Aux 3ph(52-A) DDB_CB_THREE_PHASE_52A
52-A (CB1 closed) CB auxiliary input (3 phase)
421 CB1Aux A (52-A) DDB_CB_PHASE_A_52A
52-A (CB1 A phase closed) CB auxiliary
422 CB1Aux B (52-A) DDB_CB_PHASE_B_52A
52-A (CB1 B phase closed) CB auxiliary
423 CB1Aux C (52-A) DDB_CB_PHASE_C_52A
52-A (CB1 C phase closed) CB auxiliary
424 CB1Aux 3ph(52-B) DDB_CB_THREE_PHASE_52B
52-B CB Contact Input
425 CB1Aux A (52-B) DDB_CB_PHASE_A_52B
52-B CB Contact Input A Phase
426 CB1Aux B (52-B) DDB_CB_PHASE_B_52B
52-B CB Contact Input B Phase
427 CB1Aux C (52-B) DDB_CB_PHASE_C_52B
52-B CB Contact Input C Phase
428 CB2 Aux3ph(52-A) DDB_CB2_THREE_PHASE_52A
52-A (CB2 closed) CB2 auxiliary input (3 phase)
429 CB2 Aux A(52-A) DDB_CB2_PHASE_A_52A
52-A (CB2 A phase closed) CB auxiliary
430 CB2 Aux B(52-A) DDB_CB2_PHASE_B_52A
52-A (CB2 B phase closed) CB2 auxiliary
431 CB2 Aux C(52-A) DDB_CB2_PHASE_C_52A
52-A (CB2 C phase closed)CB2 auxiliary
432 CB2 Aux3ph(52-B) DDB_CB2_THREE_PHASE_52B
52-B (CB2 open) CB2 auxiliary input (3 phase)
433 CB2 Aux A(52-B) DDB_CB2_PHASE_A_52B
52-B (CB2 A phase open) CB2 auxiliary input
434 CB2 Aux B(52-B) DDB_CB2_PHASE_B_52B
52-B (CB2 B phase open) CB2 auxiliary input
435 CB2 Aux C(52-B) DDB_CB2_PHASE_C_52B
52-B (CB2 C phase open) CB2 auxiliary input
436 CB1 Healthy DDB_CB_HEALTHY
Circuit breaker healthy (input to auto-recloser - that the CB1 has enough energy to allow re-closing)
437 CB2 Healthy DDB_CB2_HEALTHY
Circuit breaker healthy (input to auto-recloser - that the CB2 has enough energy to allow re-closing)
438 MCB/VTS DDB_VTS_MCB_OPTO
VT supervision input - signal from external miniature circuit breaker showing MCB tripped

B164 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
439 Init Trip CB1 DDB_LOGIC_INPUT_TRIP
Initiate tripping of circuit breaker 1 from a manual command
440 Init Close CB1 DDB_LOGIC_INPUT_CLOSE
Initiate closing of circuit breaker 1 from a manual command
441 Init Trip CB2 DDB_LOGIC_INPUT_TRIP_2
Initiate tripping of circuit breaker 2 from a manual command
442 Init Close CB2 DDB_LOGIC_INPUT_CLOSE_2
Initiate closing of circuit breaker 2 from a manual command
443 Rst CB1 CloseDly DDB_RESET_CB_CLOSE_DELAY
Reset Manual CB Close Timer Delay (stop & reset Manual Close Delay time for closing CB1).
444 Reset Relays/LED DDB_RESET_RELAYS_LEDS
Reset latched relays & LEDs (manual reset of any lockout trip contacts, auto-reclose lockout, and LEDs)
445 Reset Thermal DDB_RESET_THERMAL
Reset thermal state to 0%
446 Rst CB1 Lockout DDB_RESET_LOCKOUT
Reset Lockout Opto Input to reset CB1 Lockout state
447 Rst CB1 Data DDB_RESET_ALL_VALUES
Reset CB1 Maintenance values
448 Block CB1 AR DDB_BLOCK_AR
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. External signal to force CB1 autoreclose to lockout.
451 Pole Discrep.CB1 DDB_INP_TR2P
Pole discrepancy (from external detector) - input used to force a 2nd single pole trip to move to a 3 pole auto-reclose cycle
452 Loopback Mode DDB_INTERNAL_LOOPBACK
To enable loopback mode via opto input
458 Inhibit WI DDB_INHIBIT_WI
Inhibit weak infeed aided scheme logic
459 Test Mode DDB_TEST_MODE
Commissioning tests - automatically places relay in test mode
460 103 CommandBlock DDB_COMMAND_BLOCKING
For IEC-870-5-103 protocol only, used for "Command Blocking" (relay ignores SCADA commands)
461 103 MonitorBlock DDB_MONITOR_BLOCKING
For IEC-870-5-103 protocol only, used for "Monitor Blocking" (relay is quiet - issues no messages via SCADA port)
463 Inhibit I>1 DDB_INHIBIT_POC1
Inhibit stage 1 overcurrent protection
464 Inhibit I>2 DDB_INHIBIT_POC2
Inhibit stage 2 overcurrent protection
465 Inhibit I>3 DDB_INHIBIT_POC3
Inhibit stage 3 overcurrent protection
466 Inhibit I>4 DDB_INHIBIT_POC4
Inhibit stage 4 overcurrent protection
467 Inhibit IN>1 DDB_INHIBIT_EF1
Inhibit stage 1 earth fault protection
468 Inhibit IN>2 DDB_INHIBIT_EF2
Inhibit stage 2 earth fault protection
469 Inhibit IN>3 DDB_INHIBIT_EF3
Inhibit stage 3 earth fault protection
470 Inhibit IN>4 DDB_INHIBIT_EF4
Inhibit stage 4 earth fault protection
471 Inhibit V<1 DDB_INHIBIT_UV1
Inhibit stage 1 undervoltage protection
472 Inhibit V<2 DDB_INHIBIT_UV2
Inhibit stage 2 undervoltage protection
473 Inhibit V>1 DDB_INHIBIT_OV1
Inhibit stage 1 overvoltage protection
474 Inhibit V>2 DDB_INHIBIT_OV2
Inhibit stage 2 overvoltage protection
475 Inhibit VN>1 DDB_INHIBIT_RESOV1
Inhibit stage 2 overvoltage protection

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B165
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
476 Inhibit VN>2 DDB_INHIBIT_RESOV2
Inhibit stage 2 residual overvoltage protection
478 Inhibit Thermal DDB_INHIBIT_THERMAL
Inhibit thermal overload protection
479 InhibitCB Status DDB_INHIBIT_CBS
Inhibit circuit breaker state monitoring (no alarm for defective/stuck auxiliary contact)
480 Inhibit CB Fail DDB_INHIBIT_CBF
Inhibit circuit breaker fail protection
481 Inhibit OpenLine DDB_INHIBIT_BCL
Broken conductor protection
482 Inhibit VTS DDB_INHIBIT_VTS
Inhibit VT supervision (including turn OF MCB’s) via PSL
483 Inhibit CTS DDB_INHIBIT_CTS
Inhibit CT supervision (both differential and standard CTS) via PSL
484 InhibitChecksync DDB_INHIBIT_CHKSYN
Inhibit checksync. (Both stages and for each CB)
485 Inhibit TOR DDB_INHIBIT_TOR
Inhibit trip on reclose (TOR)
486 Inhibit SOTF DDB_INHIBIT_SOTF
Inhibit switch onto fault (SOTF)
488 Set SOTF DDB_SET_SOTF
To enable SOTF logic by an external pulse. When this input is energized by en external pulse, SOTF becomes enabled during “SOTF
Pulse” time setting
489 AR Reset Z1 EXT DDB_RESET_Z1_EXT
AR reset Z1X reach back to Z1 reach in Z1 extension scheme
490 Reset Zone 1 Ext DDB_RESET_ZONE1_EXT
Reset zone Z1X back to Z1 reach using logic input (i.e. case when external AR and Z1 extension scheme are used)
491 Inhibit LoL DDB_INHIBIT_LOL
Inhibit Loss of Load scheme function
492 Aided 1 COS/LGS DDB_AIDED1_COS_LGS
Aided 1 channel out of service signal (COS) or loss of guard signal (LGS) in distance unblocking schemes. This signal is normally driven
from an opto input on conventional channels or from InterMiCOM
493 Aided1 Scheme Rx DDB_AIDED1_CRX_EXT
Aided channel 1 - external signal received, for input to distance fixed scheme logic
494 Aided 1 Receive DDB_AIDED1_CRX_INT
Aided channel 1 - internal signal received generated in the signal receive logic
496 Aid1 Block Send DDB_AIDED1_BLOCK_SEND
Prevent sending by customized logic - aided scheme 1
497 Aid1 Custom Send DDB_AIDED1_PROGRAM_SEND
Programmable send logic for special customized scheme (aided channel 1)
498 Aided 1 Send DDB_AIDED1_SEND
Aided channel 1 send - internal send signal generated in signal send logic
499 Aid1 Custom T In DDB_AIDED1_CUSTOM_TIMER_IN
When using a custom programmable aided scheme 1, the user is able to include a current reversal guard timer. Energizing this DDB
will additionally start this timer, from PSL
500 Aid1 CustomT Out DDB_AIDED1_CUSTOM_TIMER_OUT
When using customized aided scheme 1, this signal is used to indicate any additional condition that should be treated as permission
for an aided trip (for example a permissive signal received could be connected, or a blocking signal could be inverted and then
connected)
501 Aid1 Trip Enable DDB_AIDED1_TRIP_ENABLE
Aided scheme 1 trip enable - this is a permissive signal used to accelerate zone 2, or a blocking signal which has been inverted. It is a
signal output, part-way through the internal fixed logic of aided schemes
502 Aid1 Custom Trip DDB_AIDED1_CUSTOM_TRIP_ENABLE
Aid1 custom trip enable
503 Aid 1 Dist Trip DDB_AIDED1_DIST_TRIP
Aided scheme 1 distance trip command (output from aided tripping logic)
504 Aid 1 Delta Trip DDB_AIDED1_DIR_TRIP
Aided Scheme 1 Delta Directional Trip command (output from Aided tripping logic)

B166 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
505 Aid 1 DEF Trip DDB_AIDED1_DEF_TRIP
Aided scheme 1 DEF trip command (output from aided tripping logic)
506 Aided 2 COS/LGS DDB_AIDED2_COS_LGS
Aided 2 channel out of service signal (COS) or loss of guard signal (LGS) in distance unblocking schemes. This signal is normally driven
from an opto input on conventional channels or from InterMiCOM
507 Aided2 Scheme Rx DDB_AIDED2_CRX_EXT
Aided channel 2 - external signal received, for input to distance fixed scheme logic
508 Aided 2 Receive DDB_AIDED2_CRX_INT
Aided channel 2 - internal signal received generated in the signal receive logic
509 RP1 Read Only DDB_REMOTEREADONLY_RP1
RP1 Read Only DDB
510 RP2 Read Only DDB_REMOTEREADONLY_RP2
RP2 Read Only DDB
511 NIC Read Only DDB_REMOTEREADONLY_NIC
NIC Read Only DDB
512 Aid2 Block Send DDB_AIDED2_BLOCK_SEND
Prevent sending by customized logic - aided scheme 2
513 Aid2 Custom Send DDB_AIDED2_PROGRAM_SEND
Programmable send logic for special customized scheme (aided channel 2)
514 Aided 2 Send DDB_AIDED2_SEND
Aided channel 2 send - internal send signal generated in signal send logic
515 Aid2 Custom T In DDB_AIDED2_CUSTOM_TIMER_IN
When using a custom programmable aided scheme 2, the user is able to include a current reversal guard timer. Energizing this DDB
will additionally start this timer, from PSL
516 Aid2 CustomT Out DDB_AIDED2_CUSTOM_TIMER_OUT
When using customized aided scheme 2, this signal is used to indicate any additional condition that should be treated as permission
for an aided trip (for example a permissive signal received could be connected, or a blocking signal could be inverted and then
connected)
517 Aid2 Trip Enable DDB_AIDED2_TRIP_ENABLE
Aided scheme 2 trip enable - this is a permissive signal used to accelerate zone 2, or a blocking signal which has been inverted. It is a
signal output, part-way through the internal fixed logic of aided schemes
518 Aid2 Custom Trip DDB_AIDED2_CUSTOM_TRIP_ENABLE
Aid2 custom trip enable
519 Aid 2 Dist Trip DDB_AIDED2_DIST_TRIP
Aided scheme 2 distance trip command (output from aided tripping logic)
520 Aid 2 Delta Trip DDB_AIDED2_DIR_TRIP
Aided Scheme 2 Delta Directional Trip command (output from Aided tripping logic)
521 Aid 2 DEF Trip DDB_AIDED2_DEF_TRIP
Aided scheme 2 DEF trip command (output from aided tripping logic)
522 Any Trip DDB_ANY_TRIP
Any trip signal - can be used as the trip command in three-pole tripping applications
523 CB1 Trip OutputA DDB_TRIP_A_PHASE
Trip signal for CB1 phase A - used as a command to drive CB1 trip A output contact(s). Takes the output from the internal trip
conversion logic
524 CB1 Trip OutputB DDB_TRIP_B_PHASE
Trip signal for CB1 phase B - used as a command to drive CB1 trip B output contact(s). Takes the output from the internal trip
conversion logic
525 CB1 Trip OutputC DDB_TRIP_C_PHASE
Trip signal for CB1 phase C - used as a command to drive CB1 trip C output contact(s). Takes the output from the internal trip
conversion logic
526 CB1 Trip 3ph DDB_TRIP_3PH
Trip signal for CB1 3ph - used as a command to drive CB1 trip 3ph output contact(s). Takes the output from the internal trip
conversion logic
527 2/3 Ph Fault DDB_TR_23_PHASE_FAULT
2 or 3 phase fault indication - used to flag whether the fault is polyphase. Typically used to control auto-reclose logic, where auto-
reclosing is allowed only for single phase faults
528 3 Ph Fault DDB_TR_3_PHASE_FAULT
3 phase fault indication. Typically used to control auto-reclose logic, where auto-reclosing is blocked for faults affecting all three
phases together

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B167
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
529 CB1 Trip I/P 3Ph DDB_TR_3_PHASE
CB1 Trip 3 Phase - Input to Trip Latching Logic
530 Trip Inputs A DDB_TR_A_PHASE
A phase trip - input to trip conversion logic. Essential to ensure correct single or three pole trip command results (e.g. converts a 2
pole trip to 3 phase)
531 Trip Inputs B DDB_TR_B_PHASE
B phase trip - input to trip conversion logic. Essential to ensure correct single or three pole trip command results (e.g. converts a 2
pole trip to 3 phase)
532 Trip Inputs C DDB_TR_C_PHASE
C phase trip - input to trip conversion logic. Essential to ensure correct single or three pole trip command results (e.g. converts a 2
pole trip to 3 phase)
533 Force 3PTrip CB1 DDB_FORCE_3_POLE_TRIP
External DDB input to host protection trip conversion logic to force 3 Pole tripping of CB1 for all faults
534 CB1 Ext Trip3ph DDB_EXTERNAL_TRIP_3PH
CB1 Ext Trip3ph - signal from external protection to initiate three phase autoreclosing of CB1
535 CB1 Ext Trip A DDB_EXTERNAL_TRIP_A
CB1 Ext Trip A - signal from external protection to initiate single phase autoreclosing (A Ph) of CB1
536 CB1 Ext Trip B DDB_EXTERNAL_TRIP_B
CB1 Ext Trip B - signal from external protection to initiate single phase autoreclosing (B Ph) of CB1
537 CB1 Ext Trip C DDB_EXTERNAL_TRIP_C
CB1 Ext Trip C - signal from external protection to initiate single phase autoreclosing (C Ph) of CB1
538 CB2 Ext Trip3ph DDB_CB2_EXTERNAL_TRIP_3PH
External trip 3 phase - allows external protection to initiate breaker 2 fail
539 CB2 Ext Trip A DDB_CB2_EXTERNAL_TRIP_A
External trip A phase - allows external protection to initiate breaker 2 fail
540 CB2 Ext Trip B DDB_CB2_EXTERNAL_TRIP_B
External trip B phase - allows external protection to initiate breaker 2 fail
541 CB2 Ext Trip C DDB_CB2_EXTERNAL_TRIP_C
External trip C phase - allows external protection to initiate breaker 2 fail
542 SG Select x1 DDB_SG_SELECTOR_X1
Setting group selector X1 (low bit)-selects SG2 if only DDB 542 signal is active.
SG1 is active if both DDB 542 & DDB 543=0
SG4 is active if both DDB 542 & DDB 543=1
543 SG Select 1x DDB_SG_SELECTOR_1X
Setting group selector 1X (high bit)-selects SG3 if only DDB 543 is active.
SG1 is active if both DDB 542 & DDB 543=0
SG4 is active if both DDB 542 & DDB 543=1
544 Clear Statistics DDB_CLEAR_STATISTICS
To reset all statistics values cumulated on the relay. If mapped, the input for this signal could come from a command of the remote
end (DDB 1020 - clear stats cmd -) via IM64
550 Inh Pred. OST DDB_INHIBIT_PREDICTIVE_OST_TRIP
Block predictive out of step tripping command
551 Pred. OST DDB_PREDICTIVE_OST_TRIP
Predictive out of step trip
552 Inhibit OST DDB_INHIBIT_OST_TRIP
Block out of step tripping command
553 OST DDB_OST_TRIP
Out of step trip
554 Start Z5 DDB_START_Z5
Positive sequence impedance is detected in Z5
555 Start Z6 DDB_START_Z6
Positive sequence impedance is detected in Z6
556 CNV ACTIVE DDB_CNV_ACTIVE
Level detector Current No Volts (CNV) exceeded
557 TOR Trip CNV DDB_CNV_TOR_TRIP
Trip on Reclose trip due to Current No Volts (CNV) level detectors
558 SOTF Trip CNV DDB_CNV_SOTF_TRIP
Switch on to Fault trip due to Current No Volts (CNV) level detectors

B168 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
559 Fast OV PHA DDB_QUARTER_CYCLE_OV_PHA
Phase A Fast Overvoltage level detector used by Current No Volts (CNV)
560 Fast OV PHB DDB_QUARTER_CYCLE_OV_PHB
Phase B Fast Overvoltage level detector used by Current No Volts (CNV)
561 Fast OV PHC DDB_QUARTER_CYCLE_OV_PHC
Phase C Fast Overvoltage level detector used by Current No Volts (CNV)
562 I2> Inhibit DDB_NPSOC_INHIBIT
Inhibit Neg Sequence overcurrent protection
563 I2>1 Tmr Blk DDB_NPSOC_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Neg Sequence overcurrent stage 1 time delayed trip
564 I2>2 Tmr Blk DDB_NPSOC_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Neg Sequence overcurrent stage 2 time delayed trip
565 I2>3 Tmr Blk DDB_NPSOC_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Neg Sequence overcurrent stage 3 time delayed trip
566 I2>4 Tmr Blk DDB_NPSOC_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Neg Sequence overcurrent stage 4 time delayed trip
567 I2>1 Start DDB_NPSOC_1_START
1st stage Neg Sequence overcurrent start
568 I2>2 Start DDB_NPSOC_2_START
2nd stage Neg Sequence overcurrent start
569 I2>3 Start DDB_NPSOC_3_START
3rd stage Neg Sequence overcurrent start
570 I2>4 Start DDB_NPSOC_4_START
4th stage Neg Sequence overcurrent start
571 I2>1 Trip DDB_NPSOC_1_TRIP
1st stage Neg Sequence overcurrent trip
572 I2>2 Trip DDB_NPSOC_2_TRIP
2nd stage Neg Sequence overcurrent trip
573 I2>3 Trip DDB_NPSOC_3_TRIP
3rd stage Neg Sequence overcurrent trip
574 I2>4 Trip DDB_NPSOC_4_TRIP
4th stage Neg Sequence overcurrent trip
576 AR Trip Test DDB_AR_TRIP_TEST
Autoreclose trip test
577 AR Trip Test A DDB_AR_TRIP_TEST_A
Auto-reclose trip test A phase. Indication that a manually-initiated test cycle is in progress
578 AR Trip Test B DDB_AR_TRIP_TEST_B
Auto-reclose trip test B phase. Indication that a manually-initiated test cycle is in progress
579 AR Trip Test C DDB_AR_TRIP_TEST_C
Auto-reclose trip test C phase. Indication that a manually-initiated test cycle is in progress
592 df/dt> Inhibit DDB_DFDT_INHIBIT
Inhibit df/dt protection
593 df/dt>1 Tmr Blk DDB_DFDT_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block df/dt Stage 1 Timer
594 df/dt>2 Tmr Blk DDB_DFDT_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block df/dt Stage 2 Timer
595 df/dt>3 Tmr Blk DDB_DFDT_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block df/dt Stage 3 Timer
596 df/dt>4 Tmr Blk DDB_DFDT_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block df/dt Stage 4 Timer
597 df/dt>1 Start DDB_DFDT_1_START
df/dt Stage 1 Start
598 df/dt>2 Start DDB_DFDT_2_START
df/dt Stage 2 Start
599 df/dt>3 Start DDB_DFDT_3_START
df/dt Stage 3 Start
600 df/dt>4 Start DDB_DFDT_4_START
df/dt Stage 4 Start

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B169
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
601 df/dt>1 Trip DDB_DFDT_1_TRIP
df/dt Stage 1 Trip
602 df/dt>2 Trip DDB_DFDT_2_TRIP
df/dt Stage 2 Trip
603 df/dt>3 Trip DDB_DFDT_3_TRIP
df/dt Stage 3 Trip
604 df/dt>4 Trip DDB_DFDT_4_TRIP
df/dt Stage 4 Trip
608 Zone 1 Trip DDB_ZONE_1_TRIP
Zone 1 Trip
609 Zone 1 A Trip DDB_ZONE_1_TRIP_A
Zone 1 A Phase Trip
610 Zone 1 B Trip DDB_ZONE_1_TRIP_B
Zone 1 B Phase Trip
611 Zone 1 C Trip DDB_ZONE_1_TRIP_C
Zone 1 C Phase Trip
612 Zone 1 N Trip DDB_ZONE_1_TRIP_N
Zone 1 N Trip
613 Zone 2 Trip DDB_ZONE_2_TRIP
Zone 2 Trip
614 Zone 2 A Trip DDB_ZONE_2_TRIP_A
Zone 2 A Phase Trip
615 Zone 2 B Trip DDB_ZONE_2_TRIP_B
Zone 2 B Phase Trip
616 Zone 2 C Trip DDB_ZONE_2_TRIP_C
Zone 2 C Phase Trip
617 Zone 2 N Trip DDB_ZONE_2_TRIP_N
Zone 2 N Trip
618 Zone 3 Trip DDB_ZONE_3_TRIP
Zone 3 Trip
619 Zone 3 A Trip DDB_ZONE_3_TRIP_A
Zone 3 A Phase Trip
620 Zone 3 B Trip DDB_ZONE_3_TRIP_B
Zone 3 B Phase Trip
621 Zone 3 C Trip DDB_ZONE_3_TRIP_C
Zone 3 C Phase Trip
622 Zone 3 N Trip DDB_ZONE_3_TRIP_N
Zone 3 N Trip
623 Zone P Trip DDB_ZONE_P_TRIP
Zone P Trip
624 Zone P A Trip DDB_ZONE_P_TRIP_A
Zone P A Phase Trip
625 Zone P B Trip DDB_ZONE_P_TRIP_B
Zone P B Phase Trip
626 Zone P C Trip DDB_ZONE_P_TRIP_C
Zone P C Phase Trip
627 Zone P N Trip DDB_ZONE_P_TRIP_N
Zone P N Trip
628 Zone 4 Trip DDB_ZONE_4_TRIP
Zone 4 Trip
629 Zone 4 A Trip DDB_ZONE_4_TRIP_A
Zone 4 A Phase Trip
630 Zone 4 B Trip DDB_ZONE_4_TRIP_B
Zone 4 B Phase Trip
631 Zone 4 C Trip DDB_ZONE_4_TRIP_C
Zone 4 C Phase Trip
632 Zone 4 N Trip DDB_ZONE_4_TRIP_N
Zone 4 N Phase Trip

B170 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
633 Aided 1 Trip A DDB_AIDED1_TRIP_A
Aided channel scheme 1 trip A phase
634 Aided 1 Trip B DDB_AIDED1_TRIP_B
Aided channel scheme 1 trip B phase
635 Aided 1 Trip C DDB_AIDED1_TRIP_C
Aided channel scheme 1 trip C phase
636 Aided 1 Trip N DDB_AIDED1_TRIP_N
Aided channel scheme 1 trip involving ground (N)
637 Aid 1 WI Trip A DDB_AIDED1_WI_TRIP_A
Aided scheme 1 weak infeed trip phase A
638 Aid 1 WI Trip B DDB_AIDED1_WI_TRIP_B
Aided scheme 1 weak infeed trip phase B
639 Aid 1 WI Trip C DDB_AIDED1_WI_TRIP_C
Aided scheme 1 weak infeed trip phase C
640 Aid1 Delta Tr3Ph DDB_AIDED1_DIR_3P_TRIP
Aided scheme 1 Delta directional Trip 3 Phase
641 Aid1 DEF Trip3Ph DDB_AIDED1_DEF_3P_TRIP
Aided 1 directional earth fault scheme trip 3 phase
642 Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph DDB_AIDED1_WI_3P_TRIP
Aided channel scheme 1 - weak infeed logic trip 3 phase
643 Aided 2 Trip A DDB_AIDED2_TRIP_A
Aided channel scheme 2 trip A phase
644 Aided 2 Trip B DDB_AIDED2_TRIP_B
Aided channel scheme 2 trip B phase
645 Aided 2 Trip C DDB_AIDED2_TRIP_C
Aided channel scheme 2 trip C phase
646 Aided 2 Trip N DDB_AIDED2_TRIP_N
Aided channel scheme 2 trip involving ground (N)
647 Aid 2 WI Trip A DDB_AIDED2_WI_TRIP_A
Aided scheme 2 weak infeed trip phase A
648 Aid 2 WI Trip B DDB_AIDED2_WI_TRIP_B
Aided scheme 2 weak infeed trip phase B
649 Aid 2 WI Trip C DDB_AIDED2_WI_TRIP_C
Aided scheme 2 weak infeed trip phase C
650 Aid2 Delta Tr3Ph DDB_AIDED2_DIR_3P_TRIP
Aided scheme 2 Delta directional Trip 3 Phase
651 Aid2 DEF Trip3Ph DDB_AIDED2_DEF_3P_TRIP
Aided 2 directional earth fault scheme trip 3 phase
652 Aid2 WI Trip 3Ph DDB_AIDED2_WI_3P_TRIP
Aided channel scheme 2 - weak infeed logic trip 3 phase
654 Loss ofLoad Trip DDB_LOL_TRIP
Loss of Load Trip
655 I>1 Trip DDB_POC_1_3PH_TRIP
1st stage phase overcurrent trip 3 phase
656 I>1 Trip A DDB_POC_1_PH_A_TRIP
1st stage phase overcurrent trip phase A
657 I>1 Trip B DDB_POC_1_PH_B_TRIP
1st stage phase overcurrent trip phase B
658 I>1 Trip C DDB_POC_1_PH_C_TRIP
1st stage phase overcurrent trip phase C
659 I>2 Trip DDB_POC_2_3PH_TRIP
2nd stage phase overcurrent trip 3 phase
660 I>2 Trip A DDB_POC_2_PH_A_TRIP
2nd stage phase overcurrent trip phase A
661 I>2 Trip B DDB_POC_2_PH_B_TRIP
2nd stage phase overcurrent trip phase B
662 I>2 Trip C DDB_POC_2_PH_C_TRIP
2nd stage phase overcurrent trip phase C

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B171
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
663 I>3 Trip DDB_POC_3_3PH_TRIP
3rd stage phase overcurrent trip 3 phase
664 I>3 Trip A DDB_POC_3_PH_A_TRIP
3rd stage phase overcurrent trip phase A
665 I>3 Trip B DDB_POC_3_PH_B_TRIP
3rd stage phase overcurrent trip phase B
666 I>3 Trip C DDB_POC_3_PH_C_TRIP
3rd stage phase overcurrent trip phase C
667 I>4 Trip DDB_POC_4_3PH_TRIP
4th stage phase overcurrent trip 3 phase
668 I>4 Trip A DDB_POC_4_PH_A_TRIP
4th stage phase overcurrent trip phase A
669 I>4 Trip B DDB_POC_4_PH_B_TRIP
4th stage phase overcurrent trip phase B
670 I>4 Trip C DDB_POC_4_PH_C_TRIP
4th stage phase overcurrent trip phase C
671 IN>1 Trip DDB_EF1_1_TRIP
1st stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) protection trip
672 IN>2 Trip DDB_EF1_2_TRIP
2nd stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) protection trip
673 IN>3 Trip DDB_EF1_3_TRIP
3rd stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) protection trip
674 IN>4 Trip DDB_EF1_4_TRIP
4th stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) protection trip
675 ISEF>1 Trip DDB_SEF_1_TRIP
1st stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection trip
676 ISEF>2 Trip DDB_SEF_2_TRIP
2nd stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection trip
677 ISEF>3 Trip DDB_SEF_3_TRIP
3rd stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection trip
678 ISEF>4 Trip DDB_SEF_4_TRIP
4th stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection trip
679 Broken Wire Trip DDB_BROKEN_CONDUCTOR_TRIP
Broken Conductor Trip
680 Thermal Trip DDB_THERMAL_TRIP
Thermal Overload Trip
682 IREF> Trip DDB_REF_TRIP
Restricted earth fault (REF) protection trip
683 V<1 Trip DDB_PUV_1_3PH_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 1, three phase trip
684 V<1 Trip A/AB DDB_PUV_1_PH_A_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 1 A/AB phase trip
685 V<1 Trip B/BC DDB_PUV_1_PH_B_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 1 B/BC phase trip
686 V<1 Trip C/CA DDB_PUV_1_PH_C_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 1 C/CA phase trip
687 V<2 Trip DDB_PUV_2_3PH_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 2, three phase trip
688 V<2 Trip A/AB DDB_PUV_2_PH_A_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 2 A/AB phase trip
689 V<2 Trip B/BC DDB_PUV_2_PH_B_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 2 B/BC phase trip
690 V<2 Trip C/CA DDB_PUV_2_PH_C_TRIP
Undervoltage stage 2 C/CA phase trip
691 V>1 Trip DDB_POV_1_3PH_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 1, three phase trip
692 V>1 Trip A/AB DDB_POV_1_PH_A_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 1 A/AB phase trip

B172 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
693 V>1 Trip B/BC DDB_POV_1_PH_B_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 1 B/BC phase trip
694 V>1 Trip C/CA DDB_POV_1_PH_C_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 1 C/CA phase trip
695 V>2 Trip DDB_POV_2_3PH_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 2, three phase trip
696 V>2 Trip A/AB DDB_POV_2_PH_A_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 2 A/AB phase trip
697 V>2 Trip B/BC DDB_POV_2_PH_B_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 2 B/BC phase trip
698 V>2 Trip C/CA DDB_POV_2_PH_C_TRIP
Overvoltage stage 2 C/CA phase trip
699 Pole Discrep.CB1 DDB_POLE_DISCREPENCE_TRIP
Pole Discrepancy (signal raised when a pole discrepancy state is detected on CB1)
700 VN>1 Trip DDB_RESOV_1_TRIP
Residual overvoltage stage 1 trip
701 VN>2 Trip DDB_RESOV_2_TRIP
Residual overvoltage stage 2 trip
702 Fault REC TRIG DDB_FAULT_RECORDER_START
Trigger for Fault Recorder
704 TOR Trip Zone 1 DDB_ZONE_1_TOR_TRIP
TOR trip zone 1 (trip on reclose)
705 TOR Trip Zone 2 DDB_ZONE_2_TOR_TRIP
TOR Trip Zone 2
706 TOR Trip Zone 3 DDB_ZONE_3_TOR_TRIP
TOR Trip Zone 3
707 TOR Trip Zone 4 DDB_ZONE_4_TOR_TRIP
TOR Trip Zone 4
708 TOR Trip Zone P DDB_ZONE_P_TOR_TRIP
TOR Trip Zone P
709 SOTF Trip Zone 1 DDB_ZONE_1_SOTF_TRIP
SOTF trip zone 1 (switch on to fault)
710 SOTF Trip Zone 2 DDB_ZONE_2_SOTF_TRIP
SOTF Trip Zone 2
711 SOTF Trip Zone 3 DDB_ZONE_3_SOTF_TRIP
SOTF Trip Zone 3
712 SOTF Trip Zone 4 DDB_ZONE_4_SOTF_TRIP
SOTF Trip Zone 4
713 SOTF Trip Zone P DDB_ZONE_P_SOTF_TRIP
SOTF Trip Zone P
736 Any Start DDB_ANY_START
Any Start
741 Zone 1 A Start DDB_ZONE_1_START_A
Zone 1 A Phase Start
742 Zone 1 B Start DDB_ZONE_1_START_B
Zone 1 B Phase Start
743 Zone 1 C Start DDB_ZONE_1_START_C
Zone 1 C Phase Start
744 Zone 1 N Start DDB_ZONE_1_START_N
Zone 1 ground element start
745 Zone 2 A Start DDB_ZONE_2_START_A
Zone 2 A Phase Start
746 Zone 2 B Start DDB_ZONE_2_START_B
Zone 2 B Phase Start
747 Zone 2 C Start DDB_ZONE_2_START_C
Zone 2 C Phase Start
748 Zone 2 N Start DDB_ZONE_2_START_N
Zone 2 ground element start

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B173
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
749 Zone 3 A Start DDB_ZONE_3_START_A
Zone 3 A Phase Start
750 Zone 3 B Start DDB_ZONE_3_START_B
Zone 3 B Phase Start
751 Zone 3 C Start DDB_ZONE_3_START_C
Zone 3 C Phase Start
752 Zone 3 N Start DDB_ZONE_3_START_N
Zone 3 N Start
753 Zone P A Start DDB_ZONE_P_START_A
Zone P A Phase Start
754 Zone P B Start DDB_ZONE_P_START_B
Zone P B Phase Start
755 Zone P C Start DDB_ZONE_P_START_C
Zone P C Phase Start
756 Zone P N Start DDB_ZONE_P_START_N
Zone P N Start
757 Zone 4 A Start DDB_ZONE_4_START_A
Zone 4 A Phase Start
758 Zone 4 B Start DDB_ZONE_4_START_B
Zone 4 B Phase Start
759 Zone 4 C Start DDB_ZONE_4_START_C
Zone 4 C Phase Start
760 Zone 4 N Start DDB_ZONE_4_START_N
Zone 4 N Start
761 I>1 Start DDB_POC_1_3PH_START
1st stage overcurrent start 3 phase
762 I>1 Start A DDB_POC_1_PH_A_START
1st stage overcurrent start phase A
763 I>1 Start B DDB_POC_1_PH_B_START
1st stage overcurrent start phase B
764 I>1 Start C DDB_POC_1_PH_C_START
1st stage overcurrent start phase C
765 I>2 Start DDB_POC_2_3PH_START
2nd stage overcurrent start 3 phase
766 I>2 Start A DDB_POC_2_PH_A_START
2nd stage overcurrent start phase A
767 I>2 Start B DDB_POC_2_PH_B_START
2nd stage overcurrent start phase B
768 I>2 Start C DDB_POC_2_PH_C_START
2nd stage overcurrent start phase C
769 I>3 Start DDB_POC_3_3PH_START
3rd stage overcurrent start 3 phase
770 I>3 Start A DDB_POC_3_PH_A_START
3rd stage overcurrent start phase A
771 I>3 Start B DDB_POC_3_PH_B_START
3rd stage overcurrent start phase B
772 I>3 Start C DDB_POC_3_PH_C_START
3rd stage overcurrent start phase C
773 I>4 Start DDB_POC_4_3PH_START
4th stage overcurrent start 3 phase
774 I>4 Start A DDB_POC_4_PH_A_START
4th stage overcurrent start phase A
775 I>4 Start B DDB_POC_4_PH_B_START
4th stage overcurrent start phase B
776 I>4 Start C DDB_POC_4_PH_C_START
4th Stage overcurrent start phase C
777 IN>1 Start DDB_EF1_1_START
1st stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) overcurrent start

B174 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
778 IN>2 Start DDB_EF1_2_START
2nd stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) overcurrent start
779 IN>3 Start DDB_EF1_3_START
3rd stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) overcurrent start
780 IN>4 Start DDB_EF1_4_START
4th stage stand by earth fault (SBEF) overcurrent start
781 ISEF>1 Start DDB_SEF_1_START
1st stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) overcurrent start
782 ISEF>2 Start DDB_SEF_2_START
2nd stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) overcurrent start
783 ISEF>3 Start DDB_SEF_3_START
3rd stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) overcurrent start
784 ISEF>4 Start DDB_SEF_4_START
4th stage sensitive earth fault (SEF) overcurrent start
785 Thermal Alarm DDB_THERMAL_ALARM
Thermal Overload Alarm
788 V<1 Start DDB_PUV_1_3PH_START
Undervoltage stage 1, three phase start
789 V<1 Start A/AB DDB_PUV_1_PH_A_START
Undervoltage stage 1, A phase start
790 V<1 Start B/BC DDB_PUV_1_PH_B_START
Undervoltage stage 1, B phase start
791 V<1 Start C/CA DDB_PUV_1_PH_C_START
Undervoltage stage 1, C phase start
792 V<2 Start DDB_PUV_2_3PH_START
Undervoltage stage 2, three phase start
793 V<2 Start A/AB DDB_PUV_2_PH_A_START
Undervoltage stage 2, A phase start
794 V<2 Start B/BC DDB_PUV_2_PH_B_START
Undervoltage stage 2, B phase start
795 V<2 Start C/CA DDB_PUV_2_PH_C_START
Undervoltage stage 2, C phase start
796 V>1 Start DDB_POV_1_3PH_START
Overvoltage stage 1, three phase start
797 V>1 Start A/AB DDB_POV_1_PH_A_START
Overvoltage stage 1, A phase start
798 V>1 Start B/BC DDB_POV_1_PH_B_START
Overvoltage stage 1, B phase start
799 V>1 Start C/CA DDB_POV_1_PH_C_START
Overvoltage stage 1, C phase start
800 V>2 Start DDB_POV_2_3PH_START
Overvoltage stage 1, C phase start
801 V>2 Start A/AB DDB_POV_2_PH_A_START
Overvoltage stage 2, A phase start
802 V>2 Start B/BC DDB_POV_2_PH_B_START
Overvoltage stage 2, B phase start
803 V>2 Start C/CA DDB_POV_2_PH_C_START
Overvoltage stage 2, C phase start
804 VN>1 Start DDB_RESOV_1_START
Residual overvoltage stage 1 start
805 VN>2 Start DDB_RESOV_2_START
Residual overvoltage stage 2 start
829 VA< start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERVOLTAGE
Phase A undervoltage level detector used in the pole dead logic. Detectors have a fixed threshold: undervoltage pickup 38.1 V-drop
off 43.8 V
830 VB< start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERVOLTAGE
Phase B undervoltage level detector used in the pole dead logic. Detectors have a fixed threshold: undervoltage pickup 38.1 V-drop
off 43.8 V

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B175
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
831 VC< start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERVOLTAGE
Phase C undervoltage level detector used in the pole dead logic. Detectors have a fixed threshold: undervoltage pickup 38.1 V-drop
off 43.8 V
832 VTS Fast Block DDB_VTS_FAST_BLOCK
VT supervision fast block - blocks elements which would otherwise maloperate immediately a fuse failure event occurs
833 VTS Slow Block DDB_VTS_SLOW_BLOCK
VT supervision slow block - blocks elements which would otherwise maloperate some time after a fuse failure event occurs
834 CB1 Fail1 Trip DDB_CBF1_TRIP_3PH
Bfail1 Trip 3ph
835 CB1 Fail2 Trip DDB_CBF2_TRIP_3PH
Bfail2 Trip 3ph
836 CB2 Fail1 Trip DDB_CB2F1_TRIP_3PH
tBF1 trip 3Ph - three phase output from circuit breaker failure 2 logic, stage 1
837 CB2 Fail2 Trip DDB_CB2F2_TRIP_3PH
tBF2 trip 3Ph - three phase output from circuit breaker failure 2 logic, stage 2
838 Control TripCB1 DDB_CONTROL_TRIP
Control trip - operator trip instruction to circuit breaker 1, via menu, or SCADA. (Does not operate for protection element trips)
839 Control CloseCB1 DDB_CONTROL_CLOSE
Control close command to circuit breaker 1. Operates for a manual close command (menu, SCADA), and additionally is driven by the
auto-reclose close command
840 Control TripCB2 DDB_CONTROL_TRIP_2
Control trip - operator trip instruction to circuit breaker 2, via menu, or SCADA. (Does not operate for protection element trips)
841 Control CloseCB2 DDB_CONTROL_CLOSE_2
Control close command to circuit breaker 2. Operates for a manual close command (menu, SCADA), and additionally is driven by the
auto-reclose close command
842 CB1 Close inProg DDB_CONTROL_CLOSE_IN_PROGRESS
Control Close in Progress
843 Block Main Prot DDB_AR_BLOCK_MAIN_PROTECTION
AR Block Main Protection. In P841 etc, there is no specific output DDB to block selected protection functions. If such a feature is
required for a particular application, appropriate mapping should be created in PSL, using output DDBs from sequence counter,
single phase dead time and three phase dead time logic as required.
844 CB1 AR 3p InProg DDB_AR_3_POLE_IN_PROGRESS
CB1 Auto Reclose/(AR 3 pole) in Progress
845 CB1 AR 1p InProg DDB_AR_1_POLE_IN_PROGRESS
CB1 AR 1pole in progress
846 Seq Counter = 0 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_0
Auto-reclose sequence counter is at zero - no previous faults have been cleared within recent history. The sequence count is at zero
because no reclaim times are timing out, and the auto-recloser is not locked out. The recloser is awaiting the first protection trip, and
all programmed cycles are free to follow
847 Seq Counter = 1 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_1
The first fault trip has happened in a new auto-reclose sequence. Dead time 1, or reclaim time 1 are in the process of timing out
848 Seq Counter = 2 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_2
Auto-reclose sequence counter is at 2. This means that the initial fault trip happened, and then another trip followed, moving the
counter on to 2
849 Seq Counter = 3 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_3
Auto-reclose sequence counter is at 3. This means that the initial fault trip happened, and then 2 trips followed, moving the counter
on to 3
850 Seq Counter = 4 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_4
Auto-reclose sequence counter is at 4. This means that the initial fault trip happened, and then 3 trips followed, moving the counter
on to 4
851 Seq Counter = 5 DDB_SEQ_COUNT_5
Seq Counter = 5 (In 2CB AR, there is no output specifically for seq counter = 5. However there is a DDB output for Seq Counter > 4.
may need a different allocation for DDB#851 in 2CB AR scheme.
852 CB1 Succ 3P AR DDB_AR_SUCCESSFUL_RECLOSE
This signal is set when CB1 has successfully completed a three phase autoreclose cycle.
853 3P Dead Time IP DDB_DEAD_TIME_IN_PROGRESS
2CB logic provides separate output DDBs indicating (i) single phase dead time in progress, (ii) three phase dead time in progress (all
shots), (iii) 3 ph 1st shot dead time in progress, (iv) 3 ph 2nd shot dead time in progress, (v) 3 ph 3rd shot dead time in progress, (vi) 3 ph
4th shot dead time in progress.

B176 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
854 Auto Close CB1 DDB_AUTO_CLOSE
This is a signal issued by the autoreclose logic to the general CB1 Control logic when the conditions to autoreclose CB1 are satisfied
(dead time complete, CB healthy etc).
855 CB2 AR 1p InProg DDB_AR_1_POLE_IN_PROGRESS_2
Single pole auto-reclose in progress (dead time is running) CB2
858 AR Force CB1 3P DDB_AR_FORCE_3_POLE_TRIPS
This DDB is set when the autoreclose logic has determined that single pole tripping/autoreclosing is not permitted for CB1. It can be
applied in PSL when required to force trip conversion logic for internal and/or external protection to three phase trip mode for CB1.
859 AR Blocked DDB_AR_BLOCKED
It indicates that AR has been blocked (ex. from external input BAR)
860 CB1 LO Alarm DDB_CB_LOCKOUT_ALARM
Composite Lockout Alarm - circuit breaker locked out due to auto-recloser, or condition monitioring
862 Block Contacts DDB_CONTACTS_BLOCKED_IP
Input DDB signal used to drive IED to be contacts blocked

If the device has been put into 'Contact Blocked' mode using this input signal then the Apply Test command will not execute. This is to
prevent a device that has been blocked by an external process having its contacts operated by a local operator using the HMI.

If the Block Contacts DDB is not set and the Apply Test command in is issued, the contacts will change state.
863 Contacts Blocked DDB_CONTACTS_BLOCKED_OP
Indicates contacts blocked mode enabled. Can be mapped in PSL and sent via InterMiCOM/IM64 to block contacts at the remote end.
864 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
865 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
866 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
867 CB1 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
868 CB1 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
869 CB1 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
870 CB2 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
871 CB2 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
872 CB2 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
873 ISEF< Start DDB_SEF_UNDERCURRENT
SEF undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT SEF)
876 Z1X Active DDB_ZONE1_EXT_ACTIVE
Zone 1 extension active - zone 1 is operating in its reach extended mode
877 TOC Active DDB_TOC_ACTIVE
Trip on close functions (either SOTF or TOR) active. These elements are in-service for a period of time following circuit breaker closure
878 TOR Active DDB_TOR_ACTIVE
Trip on re-close protection is active - indicated TOC delay timer has elapsed after circuit breaker opening, and remains in-service on
auto-reclosure for the duration of the trip on close window
879 SOTF Active DDB_SOTF_ACTIVE
Switch on to fault protection is active - in service on manual breaker closure, and then remains in-service for the duration of the trip
on close window
880 SChksInactiveCB1 DDB_SYSCHECKS_INACTIVE
Output from CB1 system check logic: indicates system checks for CB1 are disabled (setting "System Checks CB1" = Disabled or global
setting "System Checks" = Disabled)+D2269
881 CB1 CS1 Enabled DDB_CHECKSYNC_1_ENABLED
DDB input must be high to enable CB1check sync 1 logic to operate. Defaults to high if not mapped in PSL; if mapped in PSL must be

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B177
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
driven high.
882 CB1 CS2 Enabled DDB_CHECKSYNC_2_ENABLED
DDB input must be high to enable CB1check sync 2 logic to operate. Defaults to high if not mapped in PSL; if mapped in PSL must be
driven high.
883 CB1 CS1 OK DDB_CHECKSYNC_1_OK
Output from CB1 Check Sync logic, when enabled: indicates set conditions for CB1 sync check type 1 are satisfied.
884 CB1 CS2 OK DDB_CHECKSYNC_2_OK
Output from CB1 Check Sync logic, when enabled: indicates set conditions for CB1 sync check type 2 are satisfied.
886 Live Bus 1 DDB_SYSCHECKS_BUS_LIVE
Indicates Bus 1 input is live, i.e. voltage >= setting "Live Bus 1"
887 Dead Bus 1 DDB_SYSCHECKS_BUS_DEAD
Indicates Bus 1 input is dead, i.e. voltage < setting "Dead Bus 1"
888 Live Line DDB_SYSCHECKS_LINE_LIVE
Indicates live line condition is detected
889 Dead Line DDB_SYSCHECKS_LINE_DEAD
Indicates dead line condition is detected
890 All Poles Dead DDB_ALL_POLEDEAD
Pole dead logic detects 3 phase breaker open
891 Any Pole Dead DDB_ANY_POLEDEAD
Pole dead logic detects at least one breaker pole open
892 Pole Dead A DDB_PHASE_A_POLEDEAD
Phase A Pole Dead
893 Pole Dead B DDB_PHASE_B_POLEDEAD
Phase B Pole Dead
894 Pole Dead C DDB_PHASE_C_POLEDEAD
Phase C Pole Dead
895 VTS Acc Ind DDB_VTS_ACCELERATE_INPUT
Accelerate Ind
896 VTS Volt Dep DDB_VTS_ANY_VOLTAGE_DEP_FN
Any Voltage Dependent
897 AR Check Sync OK DDB_SYNC_AR_CS_CHECK_OK
Input to the auto-reclose logic to indicate system in synchronism
898 Ctl Check Sync DDB_SYNC_CTRL_SYS_CHECK_OK
Input to the circuit breaker control logic to indicate manual check synchronization conditions are satisfied
899 AR Sys Checks OK DDB_SYNC_AR_SYS_CHECK_OK
Input to the auto-reclose logic to indicate system checks conditions are satisfied
900 CB1 Ext CS OK DDB_CB1_EXT_CS_OK
External check-sync is OK for CB1
901 CB2 Ext CS OK DDB_CB2_EXT_CS_OK
External check-sync is OK for CB2
903 CB1 Open 3 ph DDB_CB_OPEN
CB1 Open 3 ph
904 CB1 Open A ph DDB_CB_PHASE_A_OPEN
CB1 Open A ph
905 CB1 Open B ph DDB_CB_PHASE_B_OPEN
CB1 Open B ph
906 CB1 Open C ph DDB_CB_PHASE_C_OPEN
CB1 Open C ph
907 CB1 Closed 3 ph DDB_CB_CLOSED
CB1 Closed 3 ph
908 CB1 Closed A ph DDB_CB_PHASE_A_CLOSED
CB1 Closed A ph
909 CB1 Closed B ph DDB_CB_PHASE_B_CLOSED
CB1 Closed B ph
910 CB1 Closed C ph DDB_CB_PHASE_C_CLOSED
CB1 Closed C ph
911 CB2 Open 3 ph DDB_CB2_OPEN
Circuit breaker 2 is open, all three phases

B178 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
912 CB2 Open A ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_A_OPEN
Circuit breaker 2 A phase is open
913 CB2 Open B ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_B_OPEN
Circuit breaker 2 A phase is open
914 CB2 Open C ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_C_OPEN
Circuit breaker 2 A phase is open
915 CB2 Closed 3 ph DDB_CB2_CLOSED
Circuit breaker 2 is closed, all three phases
916 CB2 Closed A ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_A_CLOSED
Circuit breaker 2 A phase is closed
917 CB2 Closed B ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_B_CLOSED
Circuit breaker 2 B phase is closed
918 CB2 Closed C ph DDB_CB2_PHASE_C_CLOSED
Circuit breaker 2 C phase is closed
919 Inhibit Cmp V1>1 DDB_INHIBIT_COMP_OV1
Inhibit the first stage compensated overvoltage element
920 Inhibit Cmp V1>2 DDB_INHIBIT_COMP_OV2
Inhibit the second stage compensated overvoltage element
921 Cmp V1>1 Tim Blk DDB_PCOV_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block the first stage compensated overvoltage element
922 Cmp V1>2 Tim Blk DDB_PCOV_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block the second stage compensated overvoltage element
923 V1>1 Cmp Start DDB_PCOV_1_3PH_START
1st stage compensated overvoltage start signal
924 V1>2 Cmp Start DDB_PCOV_2_3PH_START
2nd stage compensated overvoltage start signal
925 V1>1 Cmp Trip DDB_PCOV_1_3PH_TRIP
1st stage compensated overvoltage trip signal
926 V1>2 Cmp Trip DDB_PCOV_2_3PH_TRIP
2nd stage compensated overvoltage trip signal
928 CTS Block DDB_CTS_BLOCK
Standard or differential CT supervision block (current transformer supervision)
952 Faulted Phase A DDB_FLTREC_FLT_A
Faulted phase A - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
953 Faulted Phase B DDB_FLTREC_FLT_B
Faulted phase B - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
954 Faulted Phase C DDB_FLTREC_FLT_C
Faulted phase C - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
955 Faulted Phase N DDB_FLTREC_FLT_N
Faulted phase N (fault involves ground) - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
956 Started Phase A DDB_FLTREC_STRT_A
Started phase A - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
957 Started Phase B DDB_FLTREC_STRT_B
Started phase B - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
958 Started Phase C DDB_FLTREC_STRT_C
Started phase C - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
959 Started Phase N DDB_FLTREC_STRT_N
Started phase N (fault involves ground) - must be assigned, as this sets the start flag used in records, and on the LCD display
960 Zone1 AN Element DDB_ZONE_1_AN
Zone 1 AN ground fault element
961 Zone1 BN Element DDB_ZONE_1_BN
Zone 1 BN ground fault element
962 Zone1 CN Element DDB_ZONE_1_CN
Zone 1 CN ground fault element
963 Zone1 AB Element DDB_ZONE_1_AB
Zone 1 AB phase fault element
964 Zone1 BC Element DDB_ZONE_1_BC
Zone 1 BC phase fault element

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B179
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
965 Zone1 CA Element DDB_ZONE_1_CA
Zone 1 CA phase fault element
966 Zone2 AN Element DDB_ZONE_2_AN
Zone 2 AN ground fault element
967 Zone2 BN Element DDB_ZONE_2_BN
Zone 2 BN ground fault element
968 Zone2 CN Element DDB_ZONE_2_CN
Zone 2 CN ground fault element
969 Zone2 AB Element DDB_ZONE_2_AB
Zone 2 AB phase fault element
970 Zone2 BC Element DDB_ZONE_2_BC
Zone 2 BC phase fault element
971 Zone2 CA Element DDB_ZONE_2_CA
Zone 2 CA phase fault element
972 Zone3 AN Element DDB_ZONE_3_AN
Zone 3 AN ground fault element
973 Zone3 BN Element DDB_ZONE_3_BN
Zone 3 BN ground fault element
974 Zone3 CN Element DDB_ZONE_3_CN
Zone 3 CN ground fault element
975 Zone3 AB Element DDB_ZONE_3_AB
Zone 3 AB phase fault element
976 Zone3 BC Element DDB_ZONE_3_BC
Zone 3 BC phase fault element
977 Zone3 CA Element DDB_ZONE_3_CA
Zone 3 CA phase fault element
978 ZoneP AN Element DDB_ZONE_P_AN
Zone P AN ground fault element
979 ZoneP BN Element DDB_ZONE_P_BN
Zone P BN ground fault element
980 ZoneP CN Element DDB_ZONE_P_CN
Zone P CN ground fault element
981 ZoneP AB Element DDB_ZONE_P_AB
Zone P AB phase fault element
982 ZoneP BC Element DDB_ZONE_P_BC
Zone P BC phase fault element
983 ZoneP CA Element DDB_ZONE_P_CA
Zone P CA phase fault element
984 Zone4 AN Element DDB_ZONE_4_AN
Zone 4 AN ground fault element
985 Zone4 BN Element DDB_ZONE_4_BN
Zone 4 BN ground fault element
986 Zone4 CN Element DDB_ZONE_4_CN
Zone 4 CN ground fault element
987 Zone4 AB Element DDB_ZONE_4_AB
Zone 4 AB phase fault element
988 Zone4 BC Element DDB_ZONE_4_BC
Zone 4 BC phase fault element
989 Zone4 CA Element DDB_ZONE_4_CA
Zone 4 CA phase fault element
991 VABC Select x DDB_9_2_VABC_SELECT_X
Switch Main VT input between two designated Logical Node on Ethernet for IEC 61850-9-2LE.
992 Vsc1 Select x1 DDB_9_2_VSC1_SELECT_X1
Switch Vsc1 input signal 1 among three designated Logical Node on Ethernet for IEC 61850-9-2LE.
993 Vsc1 Select 1x DDB_9_2_VSC1_SELECT_1X
Switch Vsc1 input signal 2 among three designated Logical Node on Ethernet for IEC 61850-9-2LE.
994 Vsc2 Select x1 DDB_9_2_VSC2_SELECT_X1
Switch Vsc2 input signal 1 among three designated Logical Node on Ethernet for IEC 61850-9-2LE.

B180 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
995 Vsc2 Select 1x DDB_9_2_VSC2_SELECT_1X
Switch Vsc2 input signal 1 among three designated Logical Node on Ethernet for IEC 61850-9-2LE.
996 DEF Forward DDB_DEF_FWD
DEF forward (directional earth fault aided scheme detector)
997 DEF Reverse DDB_DEF_REV
DEF reverse (directional earth fault aided scheme detector)
998 Delta Dir FWD AN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_AN
Delta directional scheme forward AN detection
999 Delta Dir FWD BN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_BN
Delta directional scheme forward BN detection
1000 Delta Dir FWD CN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_CN
Delta directional scheme forward CN detection
1001 Delta Dir FWD AB DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_AB
Delta directional scheme forward AB detection
1002 Delta Dir FWD BC DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_BC
Delta directional scheme forward BC detection
1003 Delta Dir FWD CA DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_CA
Delta directional scheme forward CA detection
1004 Delta Dir Rev AN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_AN
Delta directional scheme reverse AN detection
1005 Delta Dir Rev BN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_BN
Delta directional scheme reverse BN detection
1006 Delta Dir Rev CN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_CN
Delta directional scheme reverse CN detection
1007 Delta Dir Rev AB DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_AB
Delta directional scheme reverse AB detection
1008 Delta Dir Rev BC DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_BC
Delta directional scheme reverse BC detection
1009 Delta Dir Rev CA DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_CA
Delta directional scheme reverse CA detection
1010 Phase Select A DDB_PHS_SEL_A
Phase selector - phase A pickup
1011 Phase Select B DDB_PHS_SEL_B
Phase selector - phase B pickup
1012 Phase Select C DDB_PHS_SEL_C
Phase selector - phase C pickup
1013 Phase Select N DDB_PHS_SEL_N
Phase selector - neutral indication
1014 P Swing Detector DDB_PSB_DETECTED
Power swing detected
1015 PSB Fault DDB_PSB_FAULT
Power swing block fault
1016 Ih(2) Loc Blk A DDB_HARMONIC_2_A
2nd harmonic current ratio exceeds threshold on phase A (may be used to block any instantaneous distance elements that reach
through the reactance of a power transformer)
1017 Ih(2) Loc Blk B DDB_HARMONIC_2_B
2nd harmonic current ratio exceeds threshold on phase B (may be used to block any instantaneous distance elements that reach
through the reactance of a power transformer)
1018 Ih(2) Loc Blk C DDB_HARMONIC_2_C
2nd harmonic current ratio exceeds threshold on phase C (may be used to block any instantaneous distance elements that reach
through the reactance of a power transformer)
1019 Ih(2) Loc Blk N DDB_HARMONIC_2_N
2nd harmonic current ratio exceeds threshold on neutral current measurement (may be used to block any instantaneous distance
elements that reach through the reactance of a power transformer)
1024 LED 1 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_1
Programmable LED 1
1025 LED 2 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_2
Programmable LED 2

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B181
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1026 LED 3 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_3
Programmable LED 3
1027 LED 4 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_4
Programmable LED 4
1028 LED 5 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_5
Programmable LED 5
1029 LED 6 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_6
Programmable LED 6
1030 LED 7 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_7
Programmable LED 7
1031 LED 8 DDB_OUTPUT_LED_8
Programmable LED 8
1070 LED Cond IN 1 DDB_LED_CON_1
Input to LED Output Condition
1071 LED Cond IN 2 DDB_LED_CON_2
Input to LED Output Condition
1072 LED Cond IN 3 DDB_LED_CON_3
Input to LED Output Condition
1073 LED Cond IN 4 DDB_LED_CON_4
Input to LED Output Condition
1074 LED Cond IN 5 DDB_LED_CON_5
Input to LED Output Condition
1075 LED Cond IN 6 DDB_LED_CON_6
Input to LED Output Condition
1076 LED Cond IN 7 DDB_LED_CON_7
Input to LED Output Condition
1077 LED Cond IN 8 DDB_LED_CON_8
Input to LED Output Condition
1106 CB1 I^ Maint DDB_BROKEN_CURRENT_ALARM
Broken current maintenance alarm - circuit breaker cumulative duty alarm set-point CB1
1107 CB1 I^ Lockout DDB_BROKEN_CURRENT_LOCKOUT
Broken current lockout alarm - circuit breaker cumulative duty has been exceeded CB1
1108 No.CB1 OPs Maint DDB_MAINTENANCE_ALARM
No of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm - indicated due to circuit breaker trip operations threshold CB1
1109 No.CB1 OPs Lock DDB_MAINTENANCE_LOCKOUT
No of circuit breaker operations maintenance lockout - excessive number of circuit breaker trip operations, safety lockout CB1
1110 CB1 Time Maint DDB_EXCESSIVE_OP_TIME_ALARM
Excessive circuit breaker operating time maintenance alarm - excessive operation time alarm for the circuit breaker (slow
interruption time) CB1
1111 CB1 Time Lockout DDB_EXCESSIVE_OP_TIME_LOCKOUT
Excessive circuit breaker operating time lockout alarm - excessive operation time alarm for the circuit breaker (too slow interruption)
CB1
1112 CB1FaultFreqLock DDB_EFF_LOCKOUT
Excessive fault frequency lockout alarm CB1
1113 CB2 I^ Maint DDB_BROKEN_CURRENT_ALARM_2
Broken current maintenance alarm - circuit breaker cumulative duty alarm set-point CB2
1114 CB2 I^ Lockout DDB_BROKEN_CURRENT_LOCKOUT_2
Broken current lockout alarm - circuit breaker cumulative duty has been exceeded CB2
1115 No.CB2 OPs Maint DDB_MAINTENANCE_ALARM_2
No of circuit breaker operations maintenance alarm - indicated due to circuit breaker trip operations threshold CB2
1116 No.CB2 OPs Lock DDB_MAINTENANCE_LOCKOUT_2
No of circuit breaker operations maintenance lockout - excessive number of circuit breaker trip operations, safety lockout CB2
1117 CB2 Time Maint DDB_EXCESSIVE_OP_TIME_ALARM_2
Excessive circuit breaker operating time maintenance alarm - excessive operation time alarm for the circuit breaker (slow
interruption time) CB2
1118 CB2 Time Lockout DDB_EXCESSIVE_OP_TIME_LOCKOUT_2
Excessive circuit breaker operating time lockout alarm - excessive operation time alarm for the circuit breaker (too slow interruption)
CB2

B182 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1119 CB2FaultFreqLock DDB_EFF_LOCKOUT_2
Excessive fault frequency lockout alarm CB2
1123 Ch1 Mux Clk DDB_MUX_CLK_ERROR_CH1
This is an alarm that appears if the channel 1 baud rate is outside the limits 52 kbits/s or 70 Kbits/s
1124 Ch1 Signal Lost DDB_IEEE37_94_CH1_LOSS_OF_SIG
Mux indicates signal lost over channel 1
1125 Ch1 Path Yellow DDB_IEEE37_94_CH1_PATH_YELLOW
One way communication. Local relay that is sending over Ch1 indicates that remote end is not receiving
1126 Ch1 Mismatch RxN DDB_IEEE37_94_CH1_BAD_RX_N
Indication of mismatch between Ch1 N*64kbits/s setting and Mux
1127 Ch1 Timeout DDB_CH1_TIMEOUT
Indication that no valid message is received over channel 1 during ‘Channel Timeout’ window
1128 Ch1 Degraded DDB_CH1_MESS_LEVEL
Indicates poor channel 1 quality
1129 Ch1 Passthrough DDB_CH1_PASSTHROUGH
Ch1 data received via Ch 2 in 3 ended configuration - self healing indication -
1133 Ch2 Mux Clk DDB_MUX_CLK_ERROR_CH2
This is an alarm that appears if the channel 2 baud rate is outside the limits 52kbits/s or 70 kbits/s
1134 Ch2 Signal Lost DDB_IEEE37_94_CH2_LOSS_OF_SIG
Mux indicates signal lost over channel 2
1135 Ch2 Path Yellow DDB_IEEE37_94_CH2_PATH_YELLOW
One way communication. Local relay that is sending over Ch2 indicates that remote end is not receiving
1136 Ch2 Mismatch RxN DDB_IEEE37_94_CH2_BAD_RX_N
Indication of mismatch between InterMiCOM64 Ch 2 setting and Mux
1137 Ch2 Timeout DDB_CH2_TIMEOUT
Indication that no valid message is received over channel 2 during ‘Channel Timeout’ window
1138 Ch2 Degraded DDB_CH2_MESS_LEVEL
Indicates poor channel 2 quality
1139 Ch2 Passthrough DDB_CH2_PASSTHROUGH
Ch2 data received via Ch 1 in 3 ended configuration - self healing indication -
1147 SEF Trip DDB_FL_CURRENT_PROT_SEF_TRIP
SEF Trip
1148 B Fail SEF Trip DDB_CURRENT_PROT_SEF_TRIP
Current Prot SEF Trip
1149 F<1 Timer Block DDB_UFREQ_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Underfrequency Stage 1 Timer
1150 F<2 Timer Block DDB_UFREQ_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Underfrequency Stage 2 Timer
1151 F<3 Timer Block DDB_UFREQ_3_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Underfrequency Stage 3 Timer
1152 F<4 Timer Block DDB_UFREQ_4_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Underfrequency Stage 4 Timer
1153 F>1 Timer Block DDB_OFREQ_1_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Overfrequency Stage 1 Timer
1154 F>2 Timer Block DDB_OFREQ_2_TIMER_BLOCK
Block Overfrequency Stage 2 Timer
1155 F<1 Start DDB_UFREQ_1_START
Under frequency Stage 1 start
1156 F<2 Start DDB_UFREQ_2_START
Under frequency Stage 2 start
1157 F<3 Start DDB_UFREQ_3_START
Under frequency Stage 3 start
1158 F<4 Start DDB_UFREQ_4_START
Under frequency Stage 4 start
1159 F>1 Start DDB_OFREQ_1_START
Over frequency Stage 1 start
1160 F>2 Start DDB_OFREQ_2_START
Over frequency Stage 2 start

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B183
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1161 F<1 Trip DDB_UFREQ_1_TRIP
Under frequency Stage 1 trip
1162 F<2 Trip DDB_UFREQ_2_TRIP
Under frequency Stage 2 trip
1163 F<3 Trip DDB_UFREQ_3_TRIP
Under frequency Stage 3 trip
1164 F<4 Trip DDB_UFREQ_4_TRIP
Under frequency Stage 4 trip
1165 F>1 Trip DDB_OFREQ_1_TRIP
Over frequency Stage 1 Trip
1166 F>2 Trip DDB_OFREQ_2_TRIP
Over frequency Stage 2 Trip
1167 Inhibit F<1 DDB_INHIBIT_UF1
Inhibit Stage 1 Underfrequency protection
1168 Inhibit F<2 DDB_INHIBIT_UF2
Inhibit Stage 2 Underfrequency protection
1169 Inhibit F<3 DDB_INHIBIT_UF3
Inhibit Stage 3 Underfrequency protection
1170 Inhibit F<4 DDB_INHIBIT_UF4
Inhibit Stage 4 Underfrequency protection
1171 Inhibit F>1 DDB_INHIBIT_OF1
Inhibit Stage 1 Overfrequency protection
1172 Inhibit F>2 DDB_INHIBIT_OF2
Inhibit Stage 2 Overfrequency protection
1176 HMI Access Lvl 1 DDB_UIPASSWORD_ONE
It indicates that level access 1 for HMI interface is enabled
1177 HMI Access Lvl 2 DDB_UIPASSWORD_TWO
It indicates that level access 2 for HMI interface is enabled
1178 FPort AccessLvl1 DDB_FCURPASSWORD_ONE
It indicates that level access 1 for the front port interface is enabled
1179 FPort AccessLvl2 DDB_FCURPASSWORD_TWO
It indicates that level access 2 for the front port interface is enabled
1180 RPrt1 AccessLvl1 DDB_REMOTEPASSWORD_ONE
It indicates that level access 1 for the rear port 1 interface is enabled
1181 RPrt1 AccessLvl2 DDB_REMOTEPASSWORD_TWO
It indicates that level access 2 for the rear port 1 interface is enabled
1182 RPrt2 AccessLvl1 DDB_REMOTE2PASSWORD_ONE
It indicates that level access 1 for the rear port 2 interface is enabled
1183 RPrt2 AccessLvl2 DDB_REMOTE2PASSWORD_TWO
It indicates that level access 2 for the rear port 2 interface is enabled
1184 Monitor Bit 1 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_1
Monitor port signal 1 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1185 Monitor Bit 2 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_2
Monitor port signal 2 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1186 Monitor Bit 3 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_3
Monitor port signal 3 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1187 Monitor Bit 4 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_4
Monitor port signal 4 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1188 Monitor Bit 5 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_5
Monitor port signal 5 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1189 Monitor Bit 6 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_6
Monitor port signal 6 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1190 Monitor Bit 7 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_7
Monitor port signal 7 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1191 Monitor Bit 8 DDB_MONITOR_PORT_8
Monitor port signal 8 - allows mapped monitor signals to be mapped to disturbance recorder or contacts
1192 New Fault Record DDB_NEW_FAULT_REC
New Fault Record

B184 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1194 PSL Int 1 DDB_PSLINT_1
PSL Internal Node
1195 PSL Int 2 DDB_PSLINT_2
PSL Internal Node
1196 PSL Int 3 DDB_PSLINT_3
PSL Internal Node
1197 PSL Int 4 DDB_PSLINT_4
PSL Internal Node
1198 PSL Int 5 DDB_PSLINT_5
PSL Internal Node
1199 PSL Int 6 DDB_PSLINT_6
PSL Internal Node
1200 PSL Int 7 DDB_PSLINT_7
PSL Internal Node
1201 PSL Int 8 DDB_PSLINT_8
PSL Internal Node
1202 PSL Int 9 DDB_PSLINT_9
PSL Internal Node
1203 PSL Int 10 DDB_PSLINT_10
PSL Internal Node
1204 PSL Int 11 DDB_PSLINT_11
PSL Internal Node
1205 PSL Int 12 DDB_PSLINT_12
PSL Internal Node
1206 PSL Int 13 DDB_PSLINT_13
PSL Internal Node
1207 PSL Int 14 DDB_PSLINT_14
PSL Internal Node
1208 PSL Int 15 DDB_PSLINT_15
PSL Internal Node
1209 PSL Int 16 DDB_PSLINT_16
PSL Internal Node
1210 PSL Int 17 DDB_PSLINT_17
PSL Internal Node
1211 PSL Int 18 DDB_PSLINT_18
PSL Internal Node
1212 PSL Int 19 DDB_PSLINT_19
PSL Internal Node
1213 PSL Int 20 DDB_PSLINT_20
PSL Internal Node
1214 PSL Int 21 DDB_PSLINT_21
PSL Internal Node
1215 PSL Int 22 DDB_PSLINT_22
PSL Internal Node
1216 PSL Int 23 DDB_PSLINT_23
PSL Internal Node
1217 PSL Int 24 DDB_PSLINT_24
PSL Internal Node
1218 PSL Int 25 DDB_PSLINT_25
PSL Internal Node
1219 PSL Int 26 DDB_PSLINT_26
PSL Internal Node
1220 PSL Int 27 DDB_PSLINT_27
PSL Internal Node
1221 PSL Int 28 DDB_PSLINT_28
PSL Internal Node
1222 PSL Int 29 DDB_PSLINT_29
PSL Internal Node

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B185
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1223 PSL Int 30 DDB_PSLINT_30
PSL Internal Node
1224 PSL Int 31 DDB_PSLINT_31
PSL Internal Node
1225 PSL Int 32 DDB_PSLINT_32
PSL Internal Node
1226 PSL Int 33 DDB_PSLINT_33
PSL Internal Node
1227 PSL Int 34 DDB_PSLINT_34
PSL Internal Node
1228 PSL Int 35 DDB_PSLINT_35
PSL Internal Node
1229 PSL Int 36 DDB_PSLINT_36
PSL Internal Node
1230 PSL Int 37 DDB_PSLINT_37
PSL Internal Node
1231 PSL Int 38 DDB_PSLINT_38
PSL Internal Node
1232 PSL Int 39 DDB_PSLINT_39
PSL Internal Node
1233 PSL Int 40 DDB_PSLINT_40
PSL Internal Node
1234 PSL Int 41 DDB_PSLINT_41
PSL Internal Node
1235 PSL Int 42 DDB_PSLINT_42
PSL Internal Node
1236 PSL Int 43 DDB_PSLINT_43
PSL Internal Node
1237 PSL Int 44 DDB_PSLINT_44
PSL Internal Node
1238 PSL Int 45 DDB_PSLINT_45
PSL Internal Node
1239 PSL Int 46 DDB_PSLINT_46
PSL Internal Node
1240 PSL Int 47 DDB_PSLINT_47
PSL Internal Node
1241 PSL Int 48 DDB_PSLINT_48
PSL Internal Node
1242 PSL Int 49 DDB_PSLINT_49
PSL Internal Node
1243 PSL Int 50 DDB_PSLINT_50
PSL Internal Node
1244 PSL Int 51 DDB_PSLINT_51
PSL Internal Node
1245 PSL Int 52 DDB_PSLINT_52
PSL Internal Node
1246 PSL Int 53 DDB_PSLINT_53
PSL Internal Node
1247 PSL Int 54 DDB_PSLINT_54
PSL Internal Node
1248 PSL Int 55 DDB_PSLINT_55
PSL Internal Node
1249 PSL Int 56 DDB_PSLINT_56
PSL Internal Node
1250 PSL Int 57 DDB_PSLINT_57
PSL Internal Node
1251 PSL Int 58 DDB_PSLINT_58
PSL Internal Node

B186 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1252 PSL Int 59 DDB_PSLINT_59
PSL Internal Node
1253 PSL Int 60 DDB_PSLINT_60
PSL Internal Node
1254 PSL Int 61 DDB_PSLINT_61
PSL Internal Node
1255 PSL Int 62 DDB_PSLINT_62
PSL Internal Node
1256 PSL Int 63 DDB_PSLINT_63
PSL Internal Node
1257 PSL Int 64 DDB_PSLINT_64
PSL Internal Node
1258 PSL Int 65 DDB_PSLINT_65
PSL Internal Node
1259 PSL Int 66 DDB_PSLINT_66
PSL Internal Node
1260 PSL Int 67 DDB_PSLINT_67
PSL Internal Node
1261 PSL Int 68 DDB_PSLINT_68
PSL Internal Node
1262 PSL Int 69 DDB_PSLINT_69
PSL Internal Node
1263 PSL Int 70 DDB_PSLINT_70
PSL Internal Node
1264 PSL Int 71 DDB_PSLINT_71
PSL Internal Node
1265 PSL Int 72 DDB_PSLINT_72
PSL Internal Node
1266 PSL Int 73 DDB_PSLINT_73
PSL Internal Node
1267 PSL Int 74 DDB_PSLINT_74
PSL Internal Node
1268 PSL Int 75 DDB_PSLINT_75
PSL Internal Node
1269 PSL Int 76 DDB_PSLINT_76
PSL Internal Node
1270 PSL Int 77 DDB_PSLINT_77
PSL Internal Node
1271 PSL Int 78 DDB_PSLINT_78
PSL Internal Node
1272 PSL Int 79 DDB_PSLINT_79
PSL Internal Node
1273 PSL Int 80 DDB_PSLINT_80
PSL Internal Node
1274 PSL Int 81 DDB_PSLINT_81
PSL Internal Node
1275 PSL Int 82 DDB_PSLINT_82
PSL Internal Node
1276 PSL Int 83 DDB_PSLINT_83
PSL Internal Node
1277 PSL Int 84 DDB_PSLINT_84
PSL Internal Node
1278 PSL Int 85 DDB_PSLINT_85
PSL Internal Node
1279 PSL Int 86 DDB_PSLINT_86
PSL Internal Node
1280 PSL Int 87 DDB_PSLINT_87
PSL Internal Node

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B187
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1281 PSL Int 88 DDB_PSLINT_88
PSL Internal Node
1282 PSL Int 89 DDB_PSLINT_89
PSL Internal Node
1283 PSL Int 90 DDB_PSLINT_90
PSL Internal Node
1284 PSL Int 91 DDB_PSLINT_91
PSL Internal Node
1285 PSL Int 92 DDB_PSLINT_92
PSL Internal Node
1286 PSL Int 93 DDB_PSLINT_93
PSL Internal Node
1287 PSL Int 94 DDB_PSLINT_94
PSL Internal Node
1288 PSL Int 95 DDB_PSLINT_95
PSL Internal Node
1289 PSL Int 96 DDB_PSLINT_96
PSL Internal Node
1290 PSL Int 97 DDB_PSLINT_97
PSL Internal Node
1291 PSL Int 98 DDB_PSLINT_98
PSL Internal Node
1292 PSL Int 99 DDB_PSLINT_99
PSL Internal Node
1293 PSL Int 100 DDB_PSLINT_100
PSL Internal Node
1294 VTS Ia> DDB_VTS_IA_OPERATED
“VTS I> Inhibit “ setting has been exceeded in phase a
1295 VTS Ib> DDB_VTS_IB_OPERATED
“VTS I> Inhibit “ setting has been exceeded in phase b
1296 VTS Ic> DDB_VTS_IC_OPERATED
“VTS I> Inhibit “ setting has been exceeded in phase c
1297 VTS Va> DDB_VTS_VA_OPERATED
Va has exceed 30 volts (drop off at 10 volts)
1298 VTS Vb> DDB_VTS_VB_OPERATED
Vb has exceed 30 volts (drop off at 10 volts)
1299 VTS Vc> DDB_VTS_VC_OPERATED
Vc has exceed 30 volts (drop off at 10 volts)
1300 VTS I2> DDB_VTS_I2_OPERATED
“VTS I2> Inhibit “ setting has been exceeded
1301 VTS V2> DDB_VTS_V2_OPERATED
V2 has exceed 10 volts
1302 VTS Ia delta> DDB_VTS_DELTA_IA_OPERATED
Superimposed phase a current has exceed 0.1In
1303 VTS Ib delta> DDB_VTS_DELTA_IB_OPERATED
Superimposed phase b current has exceed 0.1In
1304 VTS Ic delta> DDB_VTS_DELTA_IC_OPERATED
Superimposed phase c current has exceed 0.1In
1305 Z1 AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_AN_RAW
Z1 AN Comparator
1306 Z1 BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_BN_RAW
Z1 BN Comparator
1307 Z1 CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_CN_RAW
Z1 CN Comparator
1308 Z1 AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_AB_RAW
Z1 AB Comparator
1309 Z1 BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_BC_RAW
Z1 BC Comparator

B188 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1310 Z1 CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_1_CA_RAW
Z1 CA Comparator
1311 Z2 AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_AN_RAW
Z2 AN Comparator
1312 Z2 BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_BN_RAW
Z2 BN Comparator
1313 Z2 CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_CN_RAW
Z2 CN Comparator
1314 Z2 AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_AB_RAW
Z2 AB Comparator
1315 Z2 BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_BC_RAW
Z2 BC Comparator
1316 Z2 CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_2_CA_RAW
Z2 CA Comparator
1317 Z3 AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_AN_RAW
Z3 AN Comparator
1318 Z3 BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_BN_RAW
Z3 BN Comparator
1319 Z3 CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_CN_RAW
Z3 CN Comparator
1320 Z3 AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_AB_RAW
Z3 AB Comparator
1321 Z3 BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_BC_RAW
Z3 BC Comparator
1322 Z3 CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_3_CA_RAW
Z3 CA Comparator
1323 ZP AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_AN_RAW
ZP AN Comparator
1324 ZP BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_BN_RAW
ZP BN Comparator
1325 ZP CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_CN_RAW
ZP CN Comparator
1326 ZP AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_AB_RAW
ZP AB Comparator
1327 ZP BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_BC_RAW
ZP BC Comparator
1328 ZP CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_P_CA_RAW
ZP CA Comparator
1329 Z4 AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_AN_RAW
Z4 AN Comparator
1330 Z4 BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_BN_RAW
Z4 BN Comparator
1331 Z4 CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_CN_RAW
Z4 CN Comparator
1332 Z4 AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_AB_RAW
Z4 AB Comparator
1333 Z4 BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_BC_RAW
Z4 BC Comparator
1334 Z4 CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_4_CA_RAW
Z4 CA Comparator
1335 IN> Bias DDB_LDBN
IN> Bias
1336 WI Detect I0/I2 DDB_WI_I0_I2
WI Detect I0/I2
1337 Delta Dir FWD AN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_AN_RAW
Delta Directional Forward AN
1338 Delta Dir FWD BN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_BN_RAW
Delta Directional Forward BN

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B189
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1339 Delta Dir FWD CN DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_CN_RAW
Delta Directional Forward CN
1340 Delta Dir FWD AB DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_AB_RAW
Delta Directional Forward AB
1341 Delta Dir FWD BC DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_BC_RAW
Delta Directional Forward BC
1342 Delta Dir FWD CA DDB_DELTA_DIR_FWD_CA_RAW
Delta Directional Forward CA
1343 Delta Dir Rev AN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_AN_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse AN
1344 Delta Dir Rev BN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_BN_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse BN
1345 Delta Dir Rev CN DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_CN_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse CN
1346 Delta Dir Rev AB DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_AB_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse AB
1347 Delta Dir Rev BC DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_BC_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse BC
1348 Delta Dir Rev CA DDB_DELTA_DIR_REV_CA_RAW
Delta Directional Reverse CA
1349 Zone 1 Blocked DDB_ZONE_1_BLOCKED
Zone 1 Blocked by PSB
1350 Zone 2 Blocked DDB_ZONE_2_BLOCKED
Zone 2 Blocked by PSB
1351 Zone 3 Blocked DDB_ZONE_3_BLOCKED
Zone 3 Blocked by PSB
1352 Zone P Blocked DDB_ZONE_P_BLOCKED
Zone P Blocked by PSB
1353 Zone 4 Blocked DDB_ZONE_4_BLOCKED
Zone 4 Blocked by PSB
1354 Mem. Valid DDB_MEM_VALID
Memory Valid
1355 Ph Two Cycle DDB_PH_TWO_CYCLE
Phase Sel Two Cycle
1356 Ph Five Cycle DDB_PH_FIVE_CYCLE
Phase Sel Five Cycle
1357 Ph Frozen DDB_FROZEN
Buffer Frozen
1358 Aided 1 WI V< A DDB_AIDED1_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_A
Aided 1 WI V< A
1359 Aided 1 WI V< B DDB_AIDED1_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_B
Aided 1 WI V< B
1360 Aided 1 WI V< C DDB_AIDED1_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_C
Aided 1 WI V< C
1361 Aided 2 WI V< A DDB_AIDED2_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_A
Aided 2 WI V< A
1362 Aided 2 WI V< B DDB_AIDED2_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_B
Aided 2 WI V< B
1363 Aided 2 WI V< C DDB_AIDED2_WI_LEVEL_DETECT_C
Aided 2 WI V< C
1364 CB1 Pre-Lockout DDB_CB_PRE_LOCKOUT
Output from CB1 monitoring logic
1365 I> LoL A DDB_LOL_LEVEL_DETECT_A
Loss of Load level detector A
1366 I> LoL B DDB_LOL_LEVEL_DETECT_B
Loss of Load level detector B
1367 I> LoL C DDB_LOL_LEVEL_DETECT_C
Loss of Load level detector C

B190 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1368 Freq High DDB_FREQ_ABOVE_RANGE_LIMIT
Freq High
1369 Freq Low DDB_FREQ_BELOW_RANGE_LIMIT
Freq Low
1370 Freq Not found DDB_FREQ_NOT_FOUND
Freq Not found
1371 Stop Freq Track DDB_FREQ_STOP_TRACK
Stop Freq Track
1372 3d/4th HarmonicA DDB_FOURTH_HARM_A
3rd/4th Harmonic Restraint A Phase
1373 3d/4th HarmonicB DDB_FOURTH_HARM_B
3rd/4th Harmonic Restraint B Phase
1374 3d/4th HarmonicC DDB_FOURTH_HARM_C
3rd/4th Harmonic Restraint C Phase
1375 Teleprot Disturb DDB_TELEPROTECTION_DISTURBED
This is an output signal available in the PSL, that could be mapped to “C Diff Failure” for IEC870-5-103
1376 I>> Backup Super DDB_BACK_UP_SUPERVISION
This applies only if distance primary FUN is selected (in IEC870-5-103)
This signal is ON if an overcurrent stage is selected to be enabled on VTS and distance is blocked by VTS
1377 I> Trip by VTS DDB_POC_TRIP_BY_VTS
This applies only if distance primary FUN is selected (in IEC870-5-103)
This signal is ON if DDB 1376 is ON and one of the overcurrent stages set to be enabled on VTS condition trips
1378 Teleprot Tx DDB_TELEPROTECTION_SENT
This applies only if distance primary FUN is selected (in IEC870-5-103)
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which could be mapped to a signal send of one of the two teleprotection channels
1379 Teleprot Rx DDB_TELEPROTECTION_RECEIVED
This applies only if distance primary FUN is selected (in IEC870-5-103)
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which could be mapped to a signal receive of one of the two teleprotection channels
1380 Group Warning DDB_GROUP_WARNING
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which can be mapped in IEC870-5-103 to a minor defect which does not shut down the
main protection
1381 Group Alarm DDB_GROUP_ALARM
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which can be mapped in IEC870-5-103 to a major problem normally linked to the
watchdog
1382 AR On Pulse DDB_AR_ON_PULSE
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which can be mapped to enable AR via pulse
1383 AR Off Pulse DDB_AR_OFF_PULSE
This is an output signal available in the PSL, which can be mapped to disable AR via pulse
1384 AR Enable DDB_AR_ENABLE
External input via DDB mapped in PSL to enable AR if Enable AR CB1 or Enable AR CB2 is set and AR Configuration setting is enabled
1385 AR In Service DDB_AR_IN_SERVICE
Auto-reclose in service
1386 MaxCh1 PropDelay DDB_MAX_CH1_PROP_DELAY
Setting MaxCh 1 PropDelay has been exceeded
1387 MaxCh2 PropDelay DDB_MAX_CH2_PROP_DELAY
Setting MaxCh 2 PropDelay has been exceeded
1390 ZV AN Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_AN_RAW
ZV AN Comparator
1391 ZV BN Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_BN_RAW
ZV BN Comparator
1392 ZV CN Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_CN_RAW
ZV CN Comparator
1393 ZV AB Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_AB_RAW
ZV AB Comparator
1394 ZV BC Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_BC_RAW
ZV BC Comparator
1395 ZV CA Comparator DDB_ZONE_V_CA_RAW
ZV CA Comparator

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B191
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1404 VTS Blk Distance DDB_VTS_BLOCK_DIST
Signal from the VTS logic that can be used to block operation of the distance elements
1408 CB2 Lead DDB_CB2_LEAD
If setting "Leader Select By:" = Opto, then preferred leader CB is CB1 if input DDB "CB2 LEAD" is low, or CB2 if DDB "CB2 LEAD" is high.
1409 Foll AR Mode 1P DDB_FOLLOW_AR_SP
If setting "Foll AR Mode" = Opto, then if input DDB "FARSP" is high, the follower CB is enabled for single phase autoreclose, if "FARSP" is
low, the follower CB is NOT enabled for single phase autoreclose.D2215
1410 Foll AR Mode 3P DDB_FOLLOW_AR_3P
If setting "Foll AR Mode" = Opto, then if input DDB "FAR3P" is high, the follower CB is enabled for three phase autoreclose, if "FAR3P" is
low, the follower CB is NOT enabled for three phase autoreclose.
1411 CB2 AR 3p InProg DDB_AR_3_POLE_IN_PROGRESS_2
Autoreclose in progress CB2
1417 Ext Rst CB2 AROK DDB_EXTERNAL_RES_CB2_AROK
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. This input DDB is used when required to reset any CB2 Successful Autoreclose" signal.
1418 Ext Rst CB2Shots DDB_EXTERNAL_RES_CB2_SHOTS
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. This input DDB is used when required to reset the CB2 cumulative "Shots" counters.
1419 Rst CB2 CloseDly DDB_RESET_CB2_CLOSE_DELAY
DDB mapped in PSL. Reset Manual CB2 Close Timer Delay (stop & reset Manual Close Delay time for closing CB2).
1420 Inhibit AR DDB_INHIBIT_AR
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. External signal to inhibit autoreclose.
1421 Block CB2 AR DDB_BLOCK_CB2_AR
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. External signal to force CB2 autoreclose to lockout.
1422 Rst CB2 Lockout DDB_RESET_CB2_LOCKOUT
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. Reset Lockout Opto Input to reset CB2 Lockout state
1423 MCB/VTS CB2 CS DDB_MCB_VTS_CS2
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (Bus2 VT secondary MCB tripped or VT fail detected by external VTS scheme), or signal from host
relay VTS scheme
1424 Inhibit LB2 DDB_INHIBIT_LIVE_BUS2
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Live Bus 2 function)
1425 Inhibit DB2 DDB_INHIBIT_DEAD_BUS2
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Dead Bus 2 function)
1426 CB2 CS1 Enabled DDB_CHECKSYNC2_1_ENABLED
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input or logic DDBs (enable CB2 CS1 check synchronism function)
1427 CB2 CS2 Enabled DDB_CHECKSYNC2_2_ENABLED
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input or logic DDBs (enable CB2 CS2 check synchronism function)
1428 CB2 In Service DDB_CB2_IN_SERVICE
Signal from CB In Service logic, indicating that CB2 is "In Service", i.e. can be initiated to autoreclose,
1429 CB2 NoAR DDB_CB2_NO_AR
CB2 not available for autoreclose
1431 Leader CB2 DDB_LEAD_CB2
CB2 set as leader
1432 Follower CB1 DDB_FOLLOW_CB
CB1 set as follower
1433 Follower CB2 DDB_FOLLOW_CB2
CB2 set as follower
1434 CB2 AR Init DDB_CB2_AR_INIT
Indicates initiation of a CB2 autoreclose cycle
1435 CB2 ARIP DDB_CB2_AR_INPROGRESS
CB2 autoreclose cycle in progress
1441 CB2 Failed AR DDB_CB2_FAIL_AR
CB2 autoreclose failed due to persistent fault
1442 DTOK CB2L 1P DDB_DEAD_TIME_OK_CB2LSP
Output DDB indicates conditions to enable CB2 lead single phase autoreclose dead time to run are satisfied
1443 DTOK CB2L 3P DDB_DEAD_TIME_OK_CB2L3P
Output DDB indicates conditions to enable CB2 lead three phase autoreclose dead time to run are satisfied
1444 CB2 3P DTime DDB_CB2_3POLE_DEAD_TIME
Indicates CB2 three phase autoreclose dead time running
1445 En CB2 Follower DDB_ENABLE_CB2_FOLLOWER

B192 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
Indicates conditions are satisfied to enable CB2 follower sequence
1446 1P Follower Time DDB_SPOLE_FOLLOWER_TIME
Indicates a single pole autoreclose follower time is running (either CB)
1447 3P Follower Time DDB_3POLE_FOLLOWER_TIME
Indicates a three pole autoreclose follower time is running (either CB)
1448 Auto Close CB2 DDB_CB2_AUTO_CLOSE
Signal from autoreclose logic to initiate CB2 close via “CB2 CB Control”
1449 Set CB2 Close DDB_SET_CB2_CLOSE
Indicates a CB2 Auto Close signal has been issued
1450 CB2 Control DDB_CB2_CONTROL
Output DDB can be applied to inhibit CB2 reclose by adjacent scheme until local autoreclose scheme confirms it is OK to close CB2
1451 CB2 Succ 1P AR DDB_CB2_SUCCESSFUL_SPAR
CB2 successful single phase AR
1452 CB2 Succ 3P AR DDB_CB2_SUCCESSFUL_3PAR
CB2 successful three phase AR
1453 CB2 Close inProg DDB_CB2_CTRL_CLOSE_IN_PROGRESS
CB2 Manual Close initiated – awaiting Man Close Delay time
1454 CB2 Fast SCOK DDB_CB2_FAST_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
OK to reclose CB2 with sync check without waiting for dead time to complete
1455 CB2L SCOK DDB_CB2_LEADER_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to reclose CB2 as leader when dead time complete
1456 CB2F SCOK DDB_CB2_FOLLOWER_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to reclose CB2 when follower time complete
1458 CB2 Man SCOK DDB_CB2_MANUAL_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to manually close CB2
1459 CB2 Fail Pr Trip DDB_CB2_FAIL_PROTECTION_TRIP
signal to force CB2 AR lockout if CB2 fails to trip when protection operates
1461 Live Bus 2 DDB_SYSCHECKS_BUS2_LIVE
Indicates Bus 2 input is live, i.e. voltage >= setting [48 89]
1462 Dead Bus 2 DDB_SYSCHECKS_BUS2_DEAD
Indicates Bus 2 input is dead i.e. voltage < setting [48 8A]
1463 CB2 CS2 OK DDB_CHECKSYNC2_2_OK
CB2 close with synchronism check type 2 is permitted (setting [48 A2]= Enabled), and Line and Bus 2 voltages satisfy relay settings for
CB2 synchronism check type 2
1464 CB1 CS2 SlipF> DDB_CS2_SLIP_O
Line-Bus 1 slip freq > setting [48 98] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 1 voltage is greater than maximum slip
permitted for CB1 synchronism check type 2)
1465 CB1 CS2 SlipF< DDB_CS2_SLIP_U
Line-Bus 1 slip freq < setting [48 98] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 1 voltage is within the permitted range
for CB1 synchronism check type 2)
1466 CB2 CS1 SlipF> DDB_CS2_1_SLIP_O
Line-Bus 2 slip freq > setting [48 A1] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 2 voltage is greater than maximum slip
permitted for CB2 synchronism check type 1)
1467 CB2 CS1 SlipF< DDB_CS2_1_SLIP_U
Line-Bus 2 slip freq < setting [48 A1] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 2 voltage is within the permitted range
for CB2 synchronism check type 1)
1468 CB2 CS2 SlipF> DDB_CS2_2_SLIP_O
Line-Bus 2 slip freq > setting [48 A6] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 2 voltage is greater than maximum slip
permitted for CB2 synchronism check type 2)
1469 CB2 CS2 SlipF< DDB_CS2_2_SLIP_U
Line-Bus 2 slip freq < setting [48 A6] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 2 voltage is within the permitted range
for CB2 synchronism check type 2)
1470 CB2 CS1 VL>VB DDB_SYSCHECKS2_1_VLINE_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 9F] (line V > Bus V)
1471 CB2 CS2 VL>VB DDB_SYSCHECKS2_2_VLINE_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A4] (line V > Bus V)
1472 CB2 CS1 VL<VB DDB_SYSCHECKS2_1_VBUS_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 9F] (line V < Bus V)

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B193
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1473 CB2 CS2 VL<VB DDB_SYSCHECKS2_2_VBUS_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A4] (line V < Bus V)
1474 CB2 CS1 FL>FB DDB_CS2_1_LINE_FREQ_GT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A1] (line freq > Bus freq)
1475 CB2 CS2 FL>FB DDB_CS2_2_LINE_FREQ_GT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A6] (line freq > Bus freq)
1476 CB2 CS1 FL<FB DDB_CS2_1_LINE_FREQ_LT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A1] (line freq < Bus freq)
1477 CB2 CS2 FL<FB DDB_CS2_2_LINE_FREQ_LT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus2 V is greater than setting [48 A6] (line freq < Bus freq)
1478 CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ DDB_CS2_1_ANGLE_NOT_OK_POS
Line/Bus2 phase angle in range: setting [48 9E] to +180deg (anticlockwise from Vbus)
1479 CB2 CS1 AngHigh- DDB_CS2_1_ANGLE_NOT_OK_NEG
Line/Bus2 phase angle in range: setting [48 9E] to -180deg (clockwise from Vbus)
1480 CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ DDB_CS2_2_ANGLE_NOT_OK_POS
Line/Bus2 phase angle in range: setting [48 A3] to +180deg (anticlockwise from Vbus)
1481 CB2 CS2 AngHigh- DDB_CS2_2_ANGLE_NOT_OK_NEG
Line/Bus2 phase angle in range: setting [48 A3] to -180deg (clockwise from Vbus)
1482 CB2 CS AngRotACW DDB_SYSCHECKS2_ANGLE_ACW
Line freq > (Bus2 freq + 0.001Hz) (Line voltage vector rotating anticlockwise relative to VBus2)
1483 CB2 CS AngRotCW DDB_SYSCHECKS2_ANGLE_CW
Bus2 freq > (Line freq + 0.001Hz) (Line voltage vector rotating clockwise relative to VBus2)
1484 SChksInactiveCB2 DDB_SYSCHECKS_INACTIVE2
Output from CB2 system check logic: indicates system checks for CB2 are disabled (setting "System Checks CB2" = Disabled or global
setting "System Checks" = Disabled)
1485 AR Force CB2 3P DDB_AR_FORCE_3_POLE_TRIPS_CB2
This DDB is set when the autoreclose logic has determined that single pole tripping/autoreclosing is not permitted for CB2. It can be
applied in PSL when required to force trip conversion logic for internal and/or external protection to three phase trip mode for CB2.
1488 En CB1 Follower DDB_ENABLE_CB_FOLLOWER
Indicates conditions are satisfied to enable CB1 follower sequence
1491 CB1F SCOK DDB_CB_FOLLOWR_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to reclose CB1 when follower time complete
1493 CB1 CS2 FL>FB DDB_CS2_LINE_FREQ_GT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 98] (line freq > Bus freq)
1494 CB1 CS2 FL<FB DDB_CS2_LINE_FREQ_LT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 98] (line freq < Bus freq)
1495 CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ DDB_CS2_ANGLE_NOT_OK_POS
Line/Bus1 phase angle in range: setting [48 95] to +180deg (anticlockwise from Vbus)
1496 CB1 CS2 AngHigh- DDB_CS2_ANGLE_NOT_OK_NEG
Line/Bus1 phase angle in range: setting [48 95] to -180deg (clockwise from Vbus)
1497 AR Mode 1P DDB_LEAD_AR_SP
If setting "Lead AR Mode" = Opto, then if input DDB "AR Mode 1P" is high, the leader CB is enabled for single phase autoreclose, if "AR
Mode 1P" is low, the leader CB is NOT enabled for single phase autoreclose.
1498 AR Mode 3P DDB_LEAD_AR_3P
If setting "Lead AR Mode" = Opto, then if input DDB "AR Mode 3P" is high, the leader CB is enabled for three phase autoreclose, if "AR
Mode 3P" is low, the leader CB is NOT enabled for three phase autoreclose.
1499 CB2 Trip AR MemA DDB_CB2_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_A
CB2 A Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1500 CB2 Trip AR MemB DDB_CB2_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_B
CB2 B Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1501 CB2 Trip AR MemC DDB_CB2_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_C
CB2 C Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1504 Init APh AR Test DDB_INIT_APH_AR_TEST
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. Input high-low operation will initiate APh test trip & autoreclose cycle
1505 Init BPh AR Test DDB_INIT_BPH_AR_TEST
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. Input high-low operation will initiate BPh test trip & autoreclose cycle
1506 Init CPh AR Test DDB_INIT_CPH_AR_TEST
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. Input high-low operation will initiate CPh test trip & autoreclose cycle

B194 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1507 Init 3P AR Test DDB_INIT_3PH_AR_TEST
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. Input high-low operation will initiate 3Ph test trip & autoreclose cycle
1508 Ext Fault APh DDB_EXTERNAL_FAULT_A
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input: indicates external protection operated for fault involving A phase
1509 Ext Fault BPh DDB_EXTERNAL_FAULT_B
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input: indicates external protection operated for fault involving C phase
1510 Ext Fault CPh DDB_EXTERNAL_FAULT_C
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input: indicates external protection operated for fault involving C phase
1517 Ext Rst CB1 AROK DDB_EXTERNAL_RES_CB_AROK
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. This input DDB is used when required to reset any CB1 "Successful Autoreclose"
signal.
1518 Ext Rst CB1Shots DDB_EXTERNAL_RES_CB_SHOTS
DDB mapped in PSL from opto or comms input. This input DDB is used when required to reset the CB1 cumulative "Shots" counters.
1521 MCB/VTS CB1 CS DDB_MCB_VTS_CS1
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (Bus1 VT secondary MCB tripped or VT fail detected by external VTS scheme), or signal from host
relay VTS scheme
1522 Inhibit LL DDB_INHIBIT_LIVE_LINE
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Live Line function)
1523 Inhibit DL DDB_INHIBIT_DEAD_LINE
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Dead Line function)
1524 Inhibit LB1 DDB_INHIBIT_LIVE_BUS1
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Live Bus 1 function)
1525 Inhibit DB1 DDB_INHIBIT_DEAD_BUS1
DDB mapped in PSL from opto input (external signal to inhibit Dead Bus 1 function)
1526 CB1 In Service DDB_CB1_IN_SERVICE
CB1 In Service (can be initiated for autoreclose)
1528 CB1 NoAR DDB_CB_NO_AR
CB1 not available for autoreclose
1530 Leader CB1 DDB_LEAD_CB
CB1 set as leader
1535 CB1 Trip AR MemA DDB_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_A
A Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1536 CB1 Trip AR MemB DDB_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_B
B Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1537 CB1 Trip AR MemC DDB_TRIP_AR_MEMORY_C
C Ph trip & AR initiation memory
1541 AR Start DDB_AR_START
Any AR initiation signal present
1542 ARIP DDB_AR_IN_PROGRESS
Any AR cycle in progress
1543 CB1 AR Init DDB_CB_AR_INIT
CB1 AR cycle initiation
1544 CB1 ARIP DDB_CB_AR_INPROGRESS
CB1 AR cycle in progress
1546 Seq Counter>Set DDB_SEQ_COUNT_GREATER_THAN_SHOTS
Sequence counts greater than shots
1547 Evolve 3Ph DDB_EVOLVE_3PHASE
Convert SPAR to 3PAR. DDB mapped to give 100ms pulse to CB1 Trip 3Ph and CB2 Trip 3Ph outputs
1550 CB1 Failed AR DDB_CB_FAIL_AR
CB1 AR failed due to persistent fault
1551 DTOK All DDB_DEADTIME_OK_ALL
Enabling condition for any dead time
1552 DTOK CB1L 1P DDB_DEAD_TIME_OK_CB1LSP
required for CB1 lead SPAR D Time
1553 DTOK CB1L 3P DDB_DEAD_TIME_OK_CB1L3P
required for CB1 lead 3PAR D Time
1554 1P DTime DDB_SPDT_IN_PROGRESS
Single pole dead time in progress

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B195
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1555 OK Time 3P DDB_OK_TIME_3POLE
OK to start 3PAR dead time
1556 3P DTime1 DDB_3POLE_DEAD_TIME1
3Phase dead time 1 running
1557 3P DTime2 DDB_3POLE_DEAD_TIME2
3Phase dead time 2 running
1558 3P DTime3 DDB_3POLE_DEAD_TIME3
3Phase dead time 3 running
1559 3P DTime4 DDB_3POLE_DEAD_TIME4
3Phase dead time 4 running
1560 CB1 3P DTime DDB_CB_3POLE_DEAD_TIME
CB1 3PAR dead time running
1561 1PF TComp DDB_SPOLE_FT_COMPLETE
Either CB SP follower time complete
1562 3PF TComp DDB_3POLE_FT_COMPLETE
Either CB 3P follower time complete
1565 Set CB1 Close DDB_SET_CB_CLOSE
DDB (Optional PSL mapping to indication)
1566 CB1 Control DDB_CB_CONTROL
Inhibits CB1 reclose by adjacent scheme
1567 1P Reclaim Time DDB_SP_RECLAIM_TIME
Single Ph AR reclaim time running
1568 1P Reclaim TComp DDB_SP_RECLAIM_TIME_COMPLETE
Single Ph AR reclaim time complete
1569 3P Reclaim Time DDB_TP_RECLAIM_TIME
Three Ph AR reclaim time running
1570 3P Reclaim TComp DDB_TP_RECLAIM_TIME_COMPLETE
Three Ph AR reclaim time complete
1571 CB1 Succ 1P AR DDB_CB_SUCCESSFUL_SPAR
CB1 successful single phase AR
1572 CB1 Fast SCOK DDB_CB_FAST_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
OK to reclose CB1 with sync check without waiting for dead time to complete
1573 CB1L SCOK DDB_CB_LEADER_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to reclose CB1 when dead time complete
1574 CB1 Man SCOK DDB_CB_MANUAL_SYSTEM_CHECK_OK
System conditions OK to manually close CB1
1575 CB1 Fail Pr Trip DDB_CB_FAIL_PROTECTION_TRIP
signal to force CB1 AR lockout
1577 CB2 CS1 OK DDB_CHECKSYNC2_1_OK
CB2 CS1 is enabled and Line and Bus 2 voltages meet CB2 CS1 settings
1578 CB1 CS1 SlipF> DDB_CS1_SLIP_O
Line-Bus 1 slip freq > setting [48 93] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 1 voltage is greater than maximum slip
permitted for CB1 synchronism check type 1)
1579 CB1 CS1 SlipF< DDB_CS1_SLIP_U
Line-Bus 1 slip freq < setting [48 93] (frequency difference (slip) between line voltage and bus 1 voltage is greater than maximum slip
permitted for CB1 synchronism check type 1)
1580 CS VLine< DDB_SYSCHECKS_VLINE_U
Line Volts < setting [48 8B]
1581 CS VLine> DDB_SYSCHECKS_VLINE_O
Line Volts > setting [48 8C]
1582 CS VBus1< DDB_SYSCHECKS_VBUS_U
Bus1 Volts < setting [48 8B]
1583 CS VBus1> DDB_SYSCHECKS_VBUS_O
Bus1 Volts > setting [48 8C]
1584 CS VBus2< DDB_SYSCHECKS_VBUS2_U
Bus2 Volts < setting [48 8B]
1585 CS VBus2> DDB_SYSCHECKS_VBUS2_O
Bus2 Volts > setting [48 8C]

B196 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1586 CB1 CS1 VL>VB DDB_SYSCHECKS_VLINE_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 91] (line V > Bus V)
1587 CB1 CS2 VL>VB DDB_SYSCHECKS1_2_VLINE_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 96] (line V > Bus V)
1588 CB1 CS1 VL<VB DDB_SYSCHECKS_VBUS_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 91] (line V < Bus V)
1589 CB1 CS2 VL<VB DDB_SYSCHECKS1_2_VBUS_DIFF_HIGH
Voltage magnitude difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 96] (line V < Bus V)
1590 CB1 CS1 FL>FB DDB_CS1_LINE_FREQ_GT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 93] (line freq > Bus freq)
1591 CB1 CS1 FL<FB DDB_CS1_LINE_FREQ_LT_BUS_FREQ
Frequency difference between Line V and Bus1 V is greater than setting [48 93] (line freq < Bus freq)
1592 CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ DDB_CS1_ANGLE_NOT_OK_POS
Line/Bus1 phase angle in range: setting [48 90] to +180deg (anticlockwise from Vbus)
1593 CB1 CS1 AngHigh- DDB_CS1_ANGLE_NOT_OK_NEG
Line/Bus1 phase angle in range: setting [48 90] to -180deg (anticlockwise from Vbus)
1594 CB1 CS AngRotACW DDB_SYSCHECKS_ANGLE_ACW
Line freq > (Bus1 freq + 0.001Hz) (Line voltage vector rotating anticlockwise relative to VBus1)
1595 CB1 CS AngRotCW DDB_SYSCHECKS_ANGLE_CW
Bus1 freq > (Line freq + 0.001Hz) (Line voltage vector rotating clockwise relative to VBus1)
1597 Rst CB2 Data DDB_RESET_ALL_VALUES_2
Rst CB2 All Val
1598 CB2 Pre-Lockout DDB_CB2_PRE_LOCKOUT
Output from CB2 monitoring logic
1599 CB2 LO Alarm DDB_CB2_LOCKOUT_ALARM
CB2 LO Alarm
1600 CB2 Trip 3ph DDB_TRIP_3PH_2
3 Phase Trip 2
1601 CB2 Trip OutputA DDB_TRIP_A_PHASE_2
A Phase Trip 2
1602 CB2 Trip OutputB DDB_TRIP_B_PHASE_2
B Phase Trip 2
1603 CB2 Trip OutputC DDB_TRIP_C_PHASE_2
C Phase Trip 2
1604 Force 3PTrip CB2 DDB_FORCE_3_POLE_TRIP_2
External input via DDB to force host relay trip conversion logic to issue a three phase trip signal to CB2 for all faults
1605 AR Enable CB2 DDB_AR_ENABLE_CB2
External input via DDB to enable CB2, if "in service", to be initiated for autoreclosing by an AR initiation signal from protection. DDB
input defaults to high if not mapped in PSL, so CB2 AR initiation is permitted.
1606 Pole Discrep.CB2 DDB_INP_TR2P_2
Pole Discrepancy
1607 Pole Discrep.CB2 DDB_POLE_DISCREPENCE_TRIP_2
Pole Discrepancy
1608 CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph DDB_TR_3_PHASE_CB2
Trip 3 Phase - Input to Trip Latching Logic
1609 AR Enable CB1 DDB_AR_ENABLE_CB1
External input via DDB mapped in PSL to enable CB1, if "in service", to be initiated for autoreclosing by an AR initiation signal from
protection. DDB input defaults to high if not mapped in PSL, so CB1 AR initiation is permitted.
1616 PSL Int 101 DDB_PSLINT_101
PSL Internal Node
1617 PSL Int 102 DDB_PSLINT_102
PSL Internal Node
1618 PSL Int 103 DDB_PSLINT_103
PSL Internal Node
1619 PSL Int 104 DDB_PSLINT_104
PSL Internal Node
1620 PSL Int 105 DDB_PSLINT_105
PSL Internal Node

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B197
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1621 PSL Int 106 DDB_PSLINT_106
PSL Internal Node
1622 PSL Int 107 DDB_PSLINT_107
PSL Internal Node
1623 PSL Int 108 DDB_PSLINT_108
PSL Internal Node
1624 PSL Int 109 DDB_PSLINT_109
PSL Internal Node
1625 PSL Int 110 DDB_PSLINT_110
PSL Internal Node
1626 PSL Int 111 DDB_PSLINT_111
PSL Internal Node
1627 PSL Int 112 DDB_PSLINT_112
PSL Internal Node
1628 PSL Int 113 DDB_PSLINT_113
PSL Internal Node
1629 PSL Int 114 DDB_PSLINT_114
PSL Internal Node
1630 PSL Int 115 DDB_PSLINT_115
PSL Internal Node
1631 PSL Int 116 DDB_PSLINT_116
PSL Internal Node
1632 PSL Int 117 DDB_PSLINT_117
PSL Internal Node
1633 PSL Int 118 DDB_PSLINT_118
PSL Internal Node
1634 PSL Int 119 DDB_PSLINT_119
PSL Internal Node
1635 PSL Int 120 DDB_PSLINT_120
PSL Internal Node
1636 PSL Int 121 DDB_PSLINT_121
PSL Internal Node
1637 PSL Int 122 DDB_PSLINT_122
PSL Internal Node
1638 PSL Int 123 DDB_PSLINT_123
PSL Internal Node
1639 PSL Int 124 DDB_PSLINT_124
PSL Internal Node
1640 PSL Int 125 DDB_PSLINT_125
PSL Internal Node
1641 PSL Int 126 DDB_PSLINT_126
PSL Internal Node
1642 PSL Int 127 DDB_PSLINT_127
PSL Internal Node
1643 PSL Int 128 DDB_PSLINT_128
PSL Internal Node
1644 PSL Int 129 DDB_PSLINT_129
PSL Internal Node
1645 PSL Int 130 DDB_PSLINT_130
PSL Internal Node
1646 PSL Int 131 DDB_PSLINT_131
PSL Internal Node
1647 PSL Int 132 DDB_PSLINT_132
PSL Internal Node
1648 PSL Int 133 DDB_PSLINT_133
PSL Internal Node
1649 PSL Int 134 DDB_PSLINT_134
PSL Internal Node

B198 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1650 PSL Int 135 DDB_PSLINT_135
PSL Internal Node
1651 PSL Int 136 DDB_PSLINT_136
PSL Internal Node
1652 PSL Int 137 DDB_PSLINT_137
PSL Internal Node
1653 PSL Int 138 DDB_PSLINT_138
PSL Internal Node
1654 PSL Int 139 DDB_PSLINT_139
PSL Internal Node
1655 PSL Int 140 DDB_PSLINT_140
PSL Internal Node
1656 PSL Int 141 DDB_PSLINT_141
PSL Internal Node
1657 PSL Int 142 DDB_PSLINT_142
PSL Internal Node
1658 PSL Int 143 DDB_PSLINT_143
PSL Internal Node
1659 PSL Int 144 DDB_PSLINT_144
PSL Internal Node
1660 PSL Int 145 DDB_PSLINT_145
PSL Internal Node
1661 PSL Int 146 DDB_PSLINT_146
PSL Internal Node
1662 PSL Int 147 DDB_PSLINT_147
PSL Internal Node
1663 PSL Int 148 DDB_PSLINT_148
PSL Internal Node
1664 PSL Int 149 DDB_PSLINT_149
PSL Internal Node
1665 PSL Int 150 DDB_PSLINT_150
PSL Internal Node
1696 IEC Usr 01 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_1
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 1 Open
1697 IEC Usr 01 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_1
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 1 Closed
1698 IEC Usr 02 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_2
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 2 Open
1699 IEC Usr 02 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_2
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 2 Closed
1700 IEC Usr 03 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_3
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 3 Open
1701 IEC Usr 03 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_3
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 3 Closed
1702 IEC Usr 04 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_4
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 4 Open
1703 IEC Usr 04 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_4
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 4 Closed
1704 IEC Usr 05 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_5
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 5 Opened
1705 IEC Usr 05 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_5
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 5 Closed
1706 IEC Usr 06 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_6
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 6 Open
1707 IEC Usr 06 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_6
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 6 Closed
1708 IEC Usr 07 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_7
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 7 Open

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B199
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1709 IEC Usr 07 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_7
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 7 Closed
1710 IEC Usr 08 Open DDB_IEC_USR_OPN_8
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 8 Open
1711 IEC Usr 08 Close DDB_IEC_USR_CLS_8
IEC61850 User Dual Point Status 8 Closed
1717 Intlock CB1 CLS DDB_INTERLOCK_CB1_CLS_ENABLED
CB1 close enabled (interlock)
1718 Intlock CB1 OPN DDB_INTERLOCK_CB1_OPN_ENABLED
CB1 open enabled (interlock)
1719 Intlock CB2 CLS DDB_INTERLOCK_CB2_CLS_ENABLED
CB2 close enabled (interlock)
1720 Intlock CB2 OPN DDB_INTERLOCK_CB2_OPN_ENABLED
CB2 open enabled (interlock)
1721 Aided 1 Echo DDB_AIDED1_ECHO
Indicates Echo signal in Aided channel 1
1722 Aided 2 Echo DDB_AIDED2_ECHO
Indicates Echo signal in Aided channel 2
1723 Channel Fail DDB_CHANNEL_FAIL
Indicates that the communication channel has failed
1724 No signal Rec. DDB_NO_SIGNAL_RECEIVED
Indicates that the communication channel has not received a signal
1728 Quality VIP 1 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_1
GOOSE virtual input 1 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1729 Quality VIP 2 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_2
GOOSE virtual input 2 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1730 Quality VIP 3 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_3
GOOSE virtual input 3 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1731 Quality VIP 4 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_4
GOOSE virtual input 4 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1732 Quality VIP 5 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_5
GOOSE virtual input 5 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1733 Quality VIP 6 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_6
GOOSE virtual input 6 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1734 Quality VIP 7 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_7
GOOSE virtual input 7 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1735 Quality VIP 8 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_8
GOOSE virtual input 8 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1736 Quality VIP 9 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_9
GOOSE virtual input 9 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1737 Quality VIP 10 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_10
GOOSE virtual input 10 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1738 Quality VIP 11 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_11
GOOSE virtual input 11 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1739 Quality VIP 12 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_12
GOOSE virtual input 12 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1740 Quality VIP 13 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_13
GOOSE virtual input 13 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1741 Quality VIP 14 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_14
GOOSE virtual input 14 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1742 Quality VIP 15 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_15
GOOSE virtual input 15 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1743 Quality VIP 16 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_16
GOOSE virtual input 16 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1744 Quality VIP 17 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_17
GOOSE virtual input 17 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1745 Quality VIP 18 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_18
GOOSE virtual input 18 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message

B200 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1746 Quality VIP 19 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_19
GOOSE virtual input 19 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1747 Quality VIP 20 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_20
GOOSE virtual input 20 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1748 Quality VIP 21 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_21
GOOSE virtual input 21 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1749 Quality VIP 22 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_22
GOOSE virtual input 22 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1750 Quality VIP 23 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_23
GOOSE virtual input 23 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1751 Quality VIP 24 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_24
GOOSE virtual input 24 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1752 Quality VIP 25 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_25
GOOSE virtual input 25 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1753 Quality VIP 26 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_26
GOOSE virtual input 26 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1754 Quality VIP 27 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_27
GOOSE virtual input 27 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1755 Quality VIP 28 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_28
GOOSE virtual input 28 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1756 Quality VIP 29 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_29
GOOSE virtual input 29 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1757 Quality VIP 30 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_30
GOOSE virtual input 30 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1758 Quality VIP 31 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_31
GOOSE virtual input 31 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1759 Quality VIP 32 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_32
GOOSE virtual input 32 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1760 PubPres VIP 1 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_1
GOOSE virtual input 1- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1761 PubPres VIP 2 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_2
GOOSE virtual input 2- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1762 PubPres VIP 3 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_3
GOOSE virtual input 3- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1763 PubPres VIP 4 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_4
GOOSE virtual input 4- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1764 PubPres VIP 5 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_5
GOOSE virtual input 5- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1765 PubPres VIP 6 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_6
GOOSE virtual input 6- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1766 PubPres VIP 7 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_7
GOOSE virtual input 7- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1767 PubPres VIP 8 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_8
GOOSE virtual input 8- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1768 PubPres VIP 9 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_9
GOOSE virtual input 9- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1769 PubPres VIP 10 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_10
GOOSE virtual input 10- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1770 PubPres VIP 11 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_11
GOOSE virtual input 11- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1771 PubPres VIP 12 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_12
GOOSE virtual input 12- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1772 PubPres VIP 13 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_13
GOOSE virtual input 13- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1773 PubPres VIP 14 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_14
GOOSE virtual input 14- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1774 PubPres VIP 15 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_15
GOOSE virtual input 15- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B201
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1775 PubPres VIP 16 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_16
GOOSE virtual input 16- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1776 PubPres VIP 17 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_17
GOOSE virtual input 17- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1777 PubPres VIP 18 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_18
GOOSE virtual input 18- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1778 PubPres VIP 19 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_19
GOOSE virtual input 19- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1779 PubPres VIP 20 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_20
GOOSE virtual input 20- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1780 PubPres VIP 21 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_21
GOOSE virtual input 21- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1781 PubPres VIP 22 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_22
GOOSE virtual input 22- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1782 PubPres VIP 23 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_23
GOOSE virtual input 23- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1783 PubPres VIP 24 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_24
GOOSE virtual input 24- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1784 PubPres VIP 25 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_25
GOOSE virtual input 25- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1785 PubPres VIP 26 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_26
GOOSE virtual input 26- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1786 PubPres VIP 27 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_27
GOOSE virtual input 27- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1787 PubPres VIP 28 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_28
GOOSE virtual input 28- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1788 PubPres VIP 29 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_29
GOOSE virtual input 29- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1789 PubPres VIP 30 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_30
GOOSE virtual input 30- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1790 PubPres VIP 31 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_31
GOOSE virtual input 31- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1791 PubPres VIP 32 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_32
GOOSE virtual input 32- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1792 Virtual Input 33 DDB_GOOSEIN_33
Virtual Input 33 - received from GOOSE message
1793 Virtual Input 34 DDB_GOOSEIN_34
Virtual Input 34 - received from GOOSE message
1794 Virtual Input 35 DDB_GOOSEIN_35
Virtual Input 35 - received from GOOSE message
1795 Virtual Input 36 DDB_GOOSEIN_36
Virtual Input 36 - received from GOOSE message
1796 Virtual Input 37 DDB_GOOSEIN_37
Virtual Input 37 - received from GOOSE message
1797 Virtual Input 38 DDB_GOOSEIN_38
Virtual Input 38 - received from GOOSE message
1798 Virtual Input 39 DDB_GOOSEIN_39
Virtual Input 39 - received from GOOSE message
1799 Virtual Input 40 DDB_GOOSEIN_40
Virtual Input 40 - received from GOOSE message
1800 Virtual Input 41 DDB_GOOSEIN_41
Virtual Input 41 - received from GOOSE message
1801 Virtual Input 42 DDB_GOOSEIN_42
Virtual Input 42 - received from GOOSE message
1802 Virtual Input 43 DDB_GOOSEIN_43
Virtual Input 43 - received from GOOSE message
1803 Virtual Input 44 DDB_GOOSEIN_44
Virtual Input 44 - received from GOOSE message

B202 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1804 Virtual Input 45 DDB_GOOSEIN_45
Virtual Input 45 - received from GOOSE message
1805 Virtual Input 46 DDB_GOOSEIN_46
Virtual Input 46 - received from GOOSE message
1806 Virtual Input 47 DDB_GOOSEIN_47
Virtual Input 47 - received from GOOSE message
1807 Virtual Input 48 DDB_GOOSEIN_48
Virtual Input 48 - received from GOOSE message
1808 Virtual Input 49 DDB_GOOSEIN_49
Virtual Input 49 - received from GOOSE message
1809 Virtual Input 50 DDB_GOOSEIN_50
Virtual Input 50 - received from GOOSE message
1810 Virtual Input 51 DDB_GOOSEIN_51
Virtual Input 51 - received from GOOSE message
1811 Virtual Input 52 DDB_GOOSEIN_52
Virtual Input 52 - received from GOOSE message
1812 Virtual Input 53 DDB_GOOSEIN_53
Virtual Input 53 - received from GOOSE message
1813 Virtual Input 54 DDB_GOOSEIN_54
Virtual Input 54 - received from GOOSE message
1814 Virtual Input 55 DDB_GOOSEIN_55
Virtual Input 55 - received from GOOSE message
1815 Virtual Input 56 DDB_GOOSEIN_56
Virtual Input 56 - received from GOOSE message
1816 Virtual Input 57 DDB_GOOSEIN_57
Virtual Input 57 - received from GOOSE message
1817 Virtual Input 58 DDB_GOOSEIN_58
Virtual Input 58 - received from GOOSE message
1818 Virtual Input 59 DDB_GOOSEIN_59
Virtual Input 59 - received from GOOSE message
1819 Virtual Input 60 DDB_GOOSEIN_60
Virtual Input 60 - received from GOOSE message
1820 Virtual Input 61 DDB_GOOSEIN_61
Virtual Input 61 - received from GOOSE message
1821 Virtual Input 62 DDB_GOOSEIN_62
Virtual Input 62 - received from GOOSE message
1822 Virtual Input 63 DDB_GOOSEIN_63
Virtual Input 63 - received from GOOSE message
1823 Virtual Input 64 DDB_GOOSEIN_64
Virtual Input 64 - received from GOOSE message
1824 Quality VIP 33 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_33
GOOSE virtual input 33 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1825 Quality VIP 34 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_34
GOOSE virtual input 34 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1826 Quality VIP 35 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_35
GOOSE virtual input 35 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1827 Quality VIP 36 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_36
GOOSE virtual input 36 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1828 Quality VIP 37 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_37
GOOSE virtual input 37 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1829 Quality VIP 38 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_38
GOOSE virtual input 38 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1830 Quality VIP 39 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_39
GOOSE virtual input 39 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1831 Quality VIP 40 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_40
GOOSE virtual input 40 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1832 Quality VIP 41 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_41
GOOSE virtual input 41 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B203
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1833 Quality VIP 42 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_42
GOOSE virtual input 42 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1834 Quality VIP 43 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_43
GOOSE virtual input 43 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1835 Quality VIP 44 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_44
GOOSE virtual input 44 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1836 Quality VIP 45 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_45
GOOSE virtual input 45 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1837 Quality VIP 46 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_46
GOOSE virtual input 46 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1838 Quality VIP 47 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_47
GOOSE virtual input 47 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1839 Quality VIP 48 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_48
GOOSE virtual input 48 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1840 Quality VIP 49 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_49
GOOSE virtual input 49 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1841 Quality VIP 50 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_50
GOOSE virtual input 50 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1842 Quality VIP 51 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_51
GOOSE virtual input 51 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1843 Quality VIP 52 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_52
GOOSE virtual input 52 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1844 Quality VIP 53 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_53
GOOSE virtual input 53 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1845 Quality VIP 54 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_54
GOOSE virtual input 54 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1846 Quality VIP 55 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_55
GOOSE virtual input 55 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1847 Quality VIP 56 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_56
GOOSE virtual input 56 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1848 Quality VIP 57 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_57
GOOSE virtual input 57 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1849 Quality VIP 58 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_58
GOOSE virtual input 58 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1850 Quality VIP 59 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_59
GOOSE virtual input 59 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1851 Quality VIP 60 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_60
GOOSE virtual input 60 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1852 Quality VIP 61 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_61
GOOSE virtual input 61 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1853 Quality VIP 62 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_62
GOOSE virtual input 62 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1854 Quality VIP 63 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_63
GOOSE virtual input 63 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1855 Quality VIP 64 DDB_VIP_QUALITY_64
GOOSE virtual input 64 - provides the Quality attributes of any data object in an incoming GOOSE message
1856 PubPres VIP 33 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_33
GOOSE virtual input 33- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1857 PubPres VIP 34 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_34
GOOSE virtual input 34- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1858 PubPres VIP 35 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_35
GOOSE virtual input 35- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1859 PubPres VIP 36 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_36
GOOSE virtual input 36- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1860 PubPres VIP 37 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_37
GOOSE virtual input 37- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1861 PubPres VIP 38 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_38
GOOSE virtual input 38- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.

B204 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1862 PubPres VIP 39 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_39
GOOSE virtual input 39- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1863 PubPres VIP 40 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_40
GOOSE virtual input 40- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1864 PubPres VIP 41 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_41
GOOSE virtual input 41- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1865 PubPres VIP 42 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_42
GOOSE virtual input 42- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1866 PubPres VIP 43 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_43
GOOSE virtual input 43- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1867 PubPres VIP 44 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_44
GOOSE virtual input 44- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1868 PubPres VIP 45 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_45
GOOSE virtual input 45- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1869 PubPres VIP 46 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_46
GOOSE virtual input 46- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1870 PubPres VIP 47 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_47
GOOSE virtual input 47- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1871 PubPres VIP 48 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_48
GOOSE virtual input 48- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1872 PubPres VIP 49 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_49
GOOSE virtual input 49- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1873 PubPres VIP 50 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_50
GOOSE virtual input 50- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1874 PubPres VIP 51 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_51
GOOSE virtual input 51- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1875 PubPres VIP 52 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_52
GOOSE virtual input 52- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1876 PubPres VIP 53 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_53
GOOSE virtual input 53- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1877 PubPres VIP 54 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_54
GOOSE virtual input 54- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1878 PubPres VIP 55 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_55
GOOSE virtual input 55- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1879 PubPres VIP 56 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_56
GOOSE virtual input 56- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1880 PubPres VIP 57 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_57
GOOSE virtual input 57- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1881 PubPres VIP 58 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_58
GOOSE virtual input 58- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1882 PubPres VIP 59 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_59
GOOSE virtual input 59- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1883 PubPres VIP 60 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_60
GOOSE virtual input 60- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1884 PubPres VIP 61 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_61
GOOSE virtual input 61- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1885 PubPres VIP 62 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_62
GOOSE virtual input 62- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1886 PubPres VIP 63 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_63
GOOSE virtual input 63- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1887 PubPres VIP 64 DDB_VIP_PUB_PRES_64
GOOSE virtual input 64- indicates if the GOOSE publisher responsible for publishing the data that derives a virtual input is present.
1888 Virtual Output33 DDB_GOOSEOUT_33
Virtual output 33 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1889 Virtual Output34 DDB_GOOSEOUT_34
Virtual output 34 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1890 Virtual Output35 DDB_GOOSEOUT_35
Virtual output 35 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B205
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1891 Virtual Output36 DDB_GOOSEOUT_36
Virtual output 36 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1892 Virtual Output37 DDB_GOOSEOUT_37
Virtual output 37 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1893 Virtual Output38 DDB_GOOSEOUT_38
Virtual output 38 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1894 Virtual Output39 DDB_GOOSEOUT_39
Virtual output 39 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1895 Virtual Output40 DDB_GOOSEOUT_40
Virtual output 40 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1896 Virtual Output41 DDB_GOOSEOUT_41
Virtual output 41 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1897 Virtual Output42 DDB_GOOSEOUT_42
Virtual output 42 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1898 Virtual Output43 DDB_GOOSEOUT_43
Virtual output 43 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1899 Virtual Output44 DDB_GOOSEOUT_44
Virtual output 44 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1900 Virtual Output45 DDB_GOOSEOUT_45
Virtual output 45 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1901 Virtual Output46 DDB_GOOSEOUT_46
Virtual output 46 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1902 Virtual Output47 DDB_GOOSEOUT_47
Virtual output 47 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1903 Virtual Output48 DDB_GOOSEOUT_48
Virtual output 48 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1904 Virtual Output49 DDB_GOOSEOUT_49
Virtual output 49 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1905 Virtual Output50 DDB_GOOSEOUT_50
Virtual output 50 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1906 Virtual Output51 DDB_GOOSEOUT_51
Virtual output 51 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1907 Virtual Output52 DDB_GOOSEOUT_52
Virtual output 52 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1908 Virtual Output53 DDB_GOOSEOUT_53
Virtual output 53 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1909 Virtual Output54 DDB_GOOSEOUT_54
Virtual output 54 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1910 Virtual Output55 DDB_GOOSEOUT_55
Virtual output 55 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1911 Virtual Output56 DDB_GOOSEOUT_56
Virtual output 56 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1912 Virtual Output57 DDB_GOOSEOUT_57
Virtual output 57 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1913 Virtual Output58 DDB_GOOSEOUT_58
Virtual output 58 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1914 Virtual Output59 DDB_GOOSEOUT_59
Virtual output 59 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1915 Virtual Output60 DDB_GOOSEOUT_60
Virtual output 60 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1916 Virtual Output61 DDB_GOOSEOUT_61
Virtual output 61 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1917 Virtual Output62 DDB_GOOSEOUT_62
Virtual output 62 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1918 Virtual Output63 DDB_GOOSEOUT_63
Virtual output 63 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices
1919 Virtual Output64 DDB_GOOSEOUT_64
Virtual output 64 - allows user to control a binary signal which can be mapped via SCADA protocol output to other devices

B206 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals

ORDINAL SIGNAL NAME ELEMENT NAME


DESCRIPTION
1920 SAV Test In Hold DDB_9_2_SAV_TEST_HOLD
This DDB means the test application function is in "hold" state,ALSTOM internal Use only.
1921 SAV Test Inhibit DDB_9_2_SAV_TEST_INHIBIT
This DDB means the test application function is in "inhibit" state,ALSTOM internal Use only.
1922 SAV Alarm Test DDB_9_2_SAV_TEST_ALARM
This DDB means the IEC 61850-9-2LE test alarm(only for test),ALSTOM internal Use only.

P446SV-TM-EN-1 B207
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV

B208 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX C

WIRING DIAGRAMS
Appendix C - Wiring Diagrams P446SV

P446SV-TM-EN-1
Issue: Revision: Title:
DRAWING OUTLINE UPDATED. CID BLIN-8BHLDT EXTERNAL CONNECTION DIAGRAM: COMMS OPTIONS
J MICOM Px40 PLATFORM
Drg
Date: 30/11/2010 Name: W.LINTERN ALSTOM GRID UK LTD Sht: 1
CAD DATA 1:1 DIMENSIONS: mm No:
Substation Automation Solutions
DO NOT SCALE Next -
Date: Chkd: (STAFFORD)
10Px4001 Sht:
MiCOM P446 (PART) MiCOM P446 (PART)
F11
WATCHDOG
F12 CONTACT
D1
- F13
OPTO 1 WATCHDOG
D2 F14 CONTACT
+
D3 NOTE 3
-
OPTO 2 E1
D4
+ E2 RELAY 1
D5 E3
-
D6 OPTO 3 E4 RELAY 2
RJ45 +
E5
TX+ 1 D7
- E6 RELAY 3
TX- 2 OPTO 4
D8 E7
100 BASE-TX RX+ 3 +
E8 RELAY 4
4 D9
SLOT C IEC 61850-9-2 LE SK6 -
OPTO 5 E9
5 D10
(SAMPLE ANALOGUE VALUE ONLY) + E10 RELAY 5
RX- 6
D11 E11
7 -
OPTO 6 E12 RELAY 6
8 D12
+ E13
D13 E14
- RELAY 7
D14 OPTO 7 E15
100 BASE-FX +
TX E16
D15
SLOT C IEC 61850-9-2 LE - E17
OPTO 8 RELAY 8
(SAMPLE ANALOGUE VALUE ONLY) D16 E18
RX +
D17
COMMON
D18 CONNECTION
SLOT A COMMS
NOTE 2.

F17
-
SEE DRAWING
EIA485/
TX1 KBUS 10Px4001.
F18
PORT +
F16
RX1 SCN
FIBRE OPTIC
SLOT B
COMMUNICATION
TX2

RX2

F1 *
-
AC OR DC
x F2
+
CASE
EARTH

* POWER SUPPLY VERSION 24-48V (NOMINAL) D.C. ONLY

NOTES .
1. PIN TERMINAL (P.C.B. TYPE)
2. FOR COMMS OPTIONS SEE DRAWING 10Px4001

Issue: Revision: Title:


SWOO-9R7BPJ. SLOT POSITIONS ADDED TO COMMS. EXT CONN DIAG - DISTANCE 40TE WITH NCIT
D 8 OPTO INPUTS, 8 RELAY OUTPUTS
Drg
Date: 03/12/2014 Name: S.WOOTTON ALSTOM GRID UK LTD Sht: 1
CAD DATA 1:1 DIMENSIONS: mm No:
Substation Automation Solutions
DO NOT SCALE Next
Date: Chkd: (STAFFORD)
10P44607 2
Sht:
CUSTOMER SETTING DEFAULT SETTING D1
-
Not Used OPTO 1 D2 F11
+ WATCHDOG
D3 MiCOM P446 F12 CONTACT
- (PART) F13
Block CB1/2 AR OPTO 2 D4 WATCHDOG
+ F14 CONTACT DEFAULT SETTING CUSTOMER SETTING
D5
- E1
L3 Aid 1 Receive OPTO 3 D6 E2 RELAY 1 R1 Trip Z1
+
D7 E3
-
OPTO 4 E4 RELAY 2 R2 Any Start
L4 Aid 1 COS/LGS D8
+ E5
D9
- E6 RELAY 3 R3 Any Trip
L5 Reset LEDs OPTO 5 D10
+ E7
D11 RELAY 4 R4 General Alarm
- E8
MCB/VTS OPTO 6 D12 E9
+
D13 E10 RELAY 5 R5 IM64 1
-
CB1 Healthy OPTO 7 D14 E11
+ E12 RELAY 6 CB1 Fail Trip
D15
- E13
CB2 Healthy OPTO 8 D16
+ E14 RELAY 7
D17 Control Close CB1
E15
COMMON
CONNECTION D18 E16
E17 Control Trip CB1
RELAY 8
E18

Issue: Revision: Title:


INITIAL ISSUE. NOT ISSUED ON B. SWOO-9HDL3E EXT CONN DIAG DISTANCE 40TE WITH NCIT
C 8 OPTO INPUTS & 8 RELAY OUTPUTS
Drg
Date: 18/06/2014 Name: S.WOOTTON ALSTOM GRID UK LTD Sht: 2
CAD DATA 1:1 DIMENSIONS: mm No:
Substation Automation Solutions
DO NOT SCALE Next -
Date: Chkd: (STAFFORD)
10P44607 Sht:
Imagination at work

Grid Solutions
St Leonards Building
Redhill Business Park
Stafford, ST16 1WT, UK
+44 (0) 1785 250 070
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact

© 2017 General Electric. All rights reserved. Information contained in this document is indicative only. No representation or warranty is given or
should be relied on that it is complete or correct or will apply to any particular project. This will depend on the technical and commercial
circumstances. It is provided without liability and is subject to change without notice. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties, without
express written authority, is strictly prohibited.

P446SV-TM-EN-1

You might also like